diff options
author | Guo Mang <mang.guo@intel.com> | 2016-12-22 15:55:38 +0800 |
---|---|---|
committer | Guo Mang <mang.guo@intel.com> | 2016-12-26 19:14:37 +0800 |
commit | 7f05fa00f73038b425002566d3afe6c3ade2ccdb (patch) | |
tree | 297e208d4ade33a8bb3d5d20f72c53e0d134e003 /MdeModulePkg/Library | |
parent | ed2ecce34b3830562c4239093a41ba92d76d5f31 (diff) | |
download | edk2-platforms-7f05fa00f73038b425002566d3afe6c3ade2ccdb.tar.xz |
MdeModulePkg: Move to new location
Contributed-under: TianoCore Contribution Agreement 1.0
Signed-off-by: Guo Mang <mang.guo@intel.com>
Diffstat (limited to 'MdeModulePkg/Library')
236 files changed, 0 insertions, 61994 deletions
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 054131fd3e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,78 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Implements NULL authenticated variable services.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/AuthVariableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-/**
- Initialization for authenticated varibale services.
- If this initialization returns error status, other APIs will not work
- and expect to be not called then.
-
- @param[in] AuthVarLibContextIn Pointer to input auth variable lib context.
- @param[out] AuthVarLibContextOut Pointer to output auth variable lib context.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Function successfully executed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER If AuthVarLibContextIn == NULL or AuthVarLibContextOut == NULL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Fail to allocate enough resource.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Unsupported to process authenticated variable.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-AuthVariableLibInitialize (
- IN AUTH_VAR_LIB_CONTEXT_IN *AuthVarLibContextIn,
- OUT AUTH_VAR_LIB_CONTEXT_OUT *AuthVarLibContextOut
- )
-{
- //
- // Do nothing, just return EFI_UNSUPPORTED.
- //
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-/**
- Process variable with EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS/EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS set.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Name of the variable.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Variable vendor GUID.
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data.
- @param[in] Attributes Attribute value of the variable.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The firmware has successfully stored the variable and its data as
- defined by the Attributes.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Invalid parameter.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED Variable is write-protected.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is not enough resource.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION The variable is with EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS
- or EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACESS
- set, but the AuthInfo does NOT pass the validation
- check carried out by the firmware.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Unsupported to process authenticated variable.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-AuthVariableLibProcessVariable (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN UINT32 Attributes
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 900fef5d49..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Provides NULL authenticated variable services.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = AuthVariableLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = AuthVariableLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 435CB0E4-7C9A-4BB7-9907-8FD4643E978A
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = AuthVariableLib|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- AuthVariableLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 02237fffe2..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/AuthVariableLibNull/AuthVariableLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseIpmiLibNull/BaseIpmiLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseIpmiLibNull/BaseIpmiLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index a7db3f13f8..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseIpmiLibNull/BaseIpmiLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,53 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- A emptry template implementation of Ipmi Library.
-
- Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/IpmiLib.h>
-
-
-/**
- This service enables submitting commands via Ipmi.
-
- @param[in] NetFunction Net function of the command.
- @param[in] Command IPMI Command.
- @param[in] RequestData Command Request Data.
- @param[in] RequestDataSize Size of Command Request Data.
- @param[out] ResponseData Command Response Data. The completion code is the first byte of response data.
- @param[in, out] ResponseDataSize Size of Command Response Data.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The command byte stream was successfully submit to the device and a response was successfully received.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The command was not successfully sent to the device or a response was not successfully received from the device.
- @retval EFI_NOT_READY Ipmi Device is not ready for Ipmi command access.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Ipmi Device hardware error.
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT The command time out.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The command was not successfully sent to the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The resource allcation is out of resource or data size error.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpmiSubmitCommand (
- IN UINT8 NetFunction,
- IN UINT8 Command,
- IN UINT8 *RequestData,
- IN UINT32 RequestDataSize,
- OUT UINT8 *ResponseData,
- IN OUT UINT32 *ResponseDataSize
- )
-{
- //
- // Do nothing, just return EFI_UNSUPPORTED.
- //
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseIpmiLibNull/BaseIpmiLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseIpmiLibNull/BaseIpmiLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index fc9d06d24b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseIpmiLibNull/BaseIpmiLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,38 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null Instance of IPMI Library.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = BaseIpmiLibNull
- FILE_GUID = 46805D61-0BB8-4680-A9BE-C96C751AB5A4
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = IpmiLib
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- BaseIpmiLibNull.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index bd1a31a36e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,37 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null Platform Hook Library instance.
-
- Copyright (c) 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Base.h>
-#include <Library/PlatformHookLib.h>
-
-/**
- Performs platform specific initialization required for the CPU to access
- the hardware associated with a SerialPortLib instance. This function does
- not intiailzie the serial port hardware itself. Instead, it initializes
- hardware devices that are required for the CPU to access the serial port
- hardware. This function may be called more than once.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The platform specific initialization succeeded.
- @retval RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR The platform specific initialization could not be completed.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PlatformHookSerialPortInitialize (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 6d5195576f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,35 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null Platform Hook Library instance.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = BasePlatformHookLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = BasePlatformHookLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = EBC3AEAD-CC13-49b0-A678-5BED93956955
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PlatformHookLib
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- BasePlatformHookLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index b45b1ae3ce..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BasePlatformHookLibNull/BasePlatformHookLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index d21a77401c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,79 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null Reset System Library instance that only generates ASSERT() conditions.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Base.h>
-
-#include <Library/ResetSystemLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-/**
- This function causes a system-wide reset (cold reset), in which
- all circuitry within the system returns to its initial state. This type of reset
- is asynchronous to system operation and operates without regard to
- cycle boundaries.
-
- If this function returns, it means that the system does not support cold reset.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ResetCold (
- VOID
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-}
-
-/**
- This function causes a system-wide initialization (warm reset), in which all processors
- are set to their initial state. Pending cycles are not corrupted.
-
- If this function returns, it means that the system does not support warm reset.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ResetWarm (
- VOID
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-}
-
-/**
- This function causes the system to enter a power state equivalent
- to the ACPI G2/S5 or G3 states.
-
- If this function returns, it means that the system does not support shut down reset.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ResetShutdown (
- VOID
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-}
-
-/**
- This function causes the system to enter S3 and then wake up immediately.
-
- If this function returns, it means that the system does not support S3 feature.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EnterS3WithImmediateWake (
- VOID
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 96e0ebb212..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,38 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null Reset System Library instance that only generates ASSERT() conditions.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2007 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = BaseResetSystemLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = BaseResetSystemLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 667A8B1C-9C97-4b2a-AE7E-568772FE45F3
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = ResetSystemLib
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- BaseResetSystemLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index a097a82b30..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseResetSystemLibNull/BaseResetSystemLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.c deleted file mode 100644 index f4fc31913b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1100 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- 16550 UART Serial Port library functions
-
- (C) Copyright 2014 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P.<BR>
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Base.h>
-#include <IndustryStandard/Pci.h>
-#include <Library/SerialPortLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/IoLib.h>
-#include <Library/PciLib.h>
-#include <Library/PlatformHookLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-
-//
-// PCI Defintions.
-//
-#define PCI_BRIDGE_32_BIT_IO_SPACE 0x01
-
-//
-// 16550 UART register offsets and bitfields
-//
-#define R_UART_RXBUF 0
-#define R_UART_TXBUF 0
-#define R_UART_BAUD_LOW 0
-#define R_UART_BAUD_HIGH 1
-#define R_UART_FCR 2
-#define B_UART_FCR_FIFOE BIT0
-#define B_UART_FCR_FIFO64 BIT5
-#define R_UART_LCR 3
-#define B_UART_LCR_DLAB BIT7
-#define R_UART_MCR 4
-#define B_UART_MCR_DTRC BIT0
-#define B_UART_MCR_RTS BIT1
-#define R_UART_LSR 5
-#define B_UART_LSR_RXRDY BIT0
-#define B_UART_LSR_TXRDY BIT5
-#define B_UART_LSR_TEMT BIT6
-#define R_UART_MSR 6
-#define B_UART_MSR_CTS BIT4
-#define B_UART_MSR_DSR BIT5
-#define B_UART_MSR_RI BIT6
-#define B_UART_MSR_DCD BIT7
-
-//
-// 4-byte structure for each PCI node in PcdSerialPciDeviceInfo
-//
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 Device;
- UINT8 Function;
- UINT16 PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister;
-} PCI_UART_DEVICE_INFO;
-
-/**
- Read an 8-bit 16550 register. If PcdSerialUseMmio is TRUE, then the value is read from
- MMIO space. If PcdSerialUseMmio is FALSE, then the value is read from I/O space. The
- parameter Offset is added to the base address of the 16550 registers that is specified
- by PcdSerialRegisterBase.
-
- @param Base The base address register of UART device.
- @param Offset The offset of the 16550 register to read.
-
- @return The value read from the 16550 register.
-
-**/
-UINT8
-SerialPortReadRegister (
- UINTN Base,
- UINTN Offset
- )
-{
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio)) {
- return MmioRead8 (Base + Offset * PcdGet32 (PcdSerialRegisterStride));
- } else {
- return IoRead8 (Base + Offset * PcdGet32 (PcdSerialRegisterStride));
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Write an 8-bit 16550 register. If PcdSerialUseMmio is TRUE, then the value is written to
- MMIO space. If PcdSerialUseMmio is FALSE, then the value is written to I/O space. The
- parameter Offset is added to the base address of the 16550 registers that is specified
- by PcdSerialRegisterBase.
-
- @param Base The base address register of UART device.
- @param Offset The offset of the 16550 register to write.
- @param Value The value to write to the 16550 register specified by Offset.
-
- @return The value written to the 16550 register.
-
-**/
-UINT8
-SerialPortWriteRegister (
- UINTN Base,
- UINTN Offset,
- UINT8 Value
- )
-{
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio)) {
- return MmioWrite8 (Base + Offset * PcdGet32 (PcdSerialRegisterStride), Value);
- } else {
- return IoWrite8 (Base + Offset * PcdGet32 (PcdSerialRegisterStride), Value);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Update the value of an 16-bit PCI configuration register in a PCI device. If the
- PCI Configuration register specified by PciAddress is already programmed with a
- non-zero value, then return the current value. Otherwise update the PCI configuration
- register specified by PciAddress with the value specified by Value and return the
- value programmed into the PCI configuration register. All values must be masked
- using the bitmask specified by Mask.
-
- @param PciAddress PCI Library address of the PCI Configuration register to update.
- @param Value The value to program into the PCI Configuration Register.
- @param Mask Bitmask of the bits to check and update in the PCI configuration register.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-SerialPortLibUpdatePciRegister16 (
- UINTN PciAddress,
- UINT16 Value,
- UINT16 Mask
- )
-{
- UINT16 CurrentValue;
-
- CurrentValue = PciRead16 (PciAddress) & Mask;
- if (CurrentValue != 0) {
- return CurrentValue;
- }
- return PciWrite16 (PciAddress, Value & Mask);
-}
-
-/**
- Update the value of an 32-bit PCI configuration register in a PCI device. If the
- PCI Configuration register specified by PciAddress is already programmed with a
- non-zero value, then return the current value. Otherwise update the PCI configuration
- register specified by PciAddress with the value specified by Value and return the
- value programmed into the PCI configuration register. All values must be masked
- using the bitmask specified by Mask.
-
- @param PciAddress PCI Library address of the PCI Configuration register to update.
- @param Value The value to program into the PCI Configuration Register.
- @param Mask Bitmask of the bits to check and update in the PCI configuration register.
-
- @return The Secondary bus number that is actually programed into the PCI to PCI Bridge device.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-SerialPortLibUpdatePciRegister32 (
- UINTN PciAddress,
- UINT32 Value,
- UINT32 Mask
- )
-{
- UINT32 CurrentValue;
-
- CurrentValue = PciRead32 (PciAddress) & Mask;
- if (CurrentValue != 0) {
- return CurrentValue;
- }
- return PciWrite32 (PciAddress, Value & Mask);
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieve the I/O or MMIO base address register for the PCI UART device.
-
- This function assumes Root Bus Numer is Zero, and enables I/O and MMIO in PCI UART
- Device if they are not already enabled.
-
- @return The base address register of the UART device.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-GetSerialRegisterBase (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINTN PciLibAddress;
- UINTN BusNumber;
- UINTN SubordinateBusNumber;
- UINT32 ParentIoBase;
- UINT32 ParentIoLimit;
- UINT16 ParentMemoryBase;
- UINT16 ParentMemoryLimit;
- UINT32 IoBase;
- UINT32 IoLimit;
- UINT16 MemoryBase;
- UINT16 MemoryLimit;
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINTN BarIndex;
- UINT32 RegisterBaseMask;
- PCI_UART_DEVICE_INFO *DeviceInfo;
-
- //
- // Get PCI Device Info
- //
- DeviceInfo = (PCI_UART_DEVICE_INFO *) PcdGetPtr (PcdSerialPciDeviceInfo);
-
- //
- // If PCI Device Info is empty, then assume fixed address UART and return PcdSerialRegisterBase
- //
- if (DeviceInfo->Device == 0xff) {
- return (UINTN)PcdGet64 (PcdSerialRegisterBase);
- }
-
- //
- // Assume PCI Bus 0 I/O window is 0-64KB and MMIO windows is 0-4GB
- //
- ParentMemoryBase = 0 >> 16;
- ParentMemoryLimit = 0xfff00000 >> 16;
- ParentIoBase = 0 >> 12;
- ParentIoLimit = 0xf000 >> 12;
-
- //
- // Enable I/O and MMIO in PCI Bridge
- // Assume Root Bus Numer is Zero.
- //
- for (BusNumber = 0; (DeviceInfo + 1)->Device != 0xff; DeviceInfo++) {
- //
- // Compute PCI Lib Address to PCI to PCI Bridge
- //
- PciLibAddress = PCI_LIB_ADDRESS (BusNumber, DeviceInfo->Device, DeviceInfo->Function, 0);
-
- //
- // Retrieve and verify the bus numbers in the PCI to PCI Bridge
- //
- BusNumber = PciRead8 (PciLibAddress + PCI_BRIDGE_SECONDARY_BUS_REGISTER_OFFSET);
- SubordinateBusNumber = PciRead8 (PciLibAddress + PCI_BRIDGE_SUBORDINATE_BUS_REGISTER_OFFSET);
- if (BusNumber == 0 || BusNumber > SubordinateBusNumber) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve and verify the I/O or MMIO decode window in the PCI to PCI Bridge
- //
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio)) {
- MemoryLimit = PciRead16 (PciLibAddress + OFFSET_OF (PCI_TYPE01, Bridge.MemoryLimit)) & 0xfff0;
- MemoryBase = PciRead16 (PciLibAddress + OFFSET_OF (PCI_TYPE01, Bridge.MemoryBase)) & 0xfff0;
-
- //
- // If PCI Bridge MMIO window is disabled, then return 0
- //
- if (MemoryLimit < MemoryBase) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // If PCI Bridge MMIO window is not in the address range decoded by the parent PCI Bridge, then return 0
- //
- if (MemoryBase < ParentMemoryBase || MemoryBase > ParentMemoryLimit || MemoryLimit > ParentMemoryLimit) {
- return 0;
- }
- ParentMemoryBase = MemoryBase;
- ParentMemoryLimit = MemoryLimit;
- } else {
- IoLimit = PciRead8 (PciLibAddress + OFFSET_OF (PCI_TYPE01, Bridge.IoLimit));
- if ((IoLimit & PCI_BRIDGE_32_BIT_IO_SPACE ) == 0) {
- IoLimit = IoLimit >> 4;
- } else {
- IoLimit = (PciRead16 (PciLibAddress + OFFSET_OF (PCI_TYPE01, Bridge.IoLimitUpper16)) << 4) | (IoLimit >> 4);
- }
- IoBase = PciRead8 (PciLibAddress + OFFSET_OF (PCI_TYPE01, Bridge.IoBase));
- if ((IoBase & PCI_BRIDGE_32_BIT_IO_SPACE ) == 0) {
- IoBase = IoBase >> 4;
- } else {
- IoBase = (PciRead16 (PciLibAddress + OFFSET_OF (PCI_TYPE01, Bridge.IoBaseUpper16)) << 4) | (IoBase >> 4);
- }
-
- //
- // If PCI Bridge I/O window is disabled, then return 0
- //
- if (IoLimit < IoBase) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // If PCI Bridge I/O window is not in the address range decoded by the parent PCI Bridge, then return 0
- //
- if (IoBase < ParentIoBase || IoBase > ParentIoLimit || IoLimit > ParentIoLimit) {
- return 0;
- }
- ParentIoBase = IoBase;
- ParentIoLimit = IoLimit;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Compute PCI Lib Address to PCI UART
- //
- PciLibAddress = PCI_LIB_ADDRESS (BusNumber, DeviceInfo->Device, DeviceInfo->Function, 0);
-
- //
- // Find the first IO or MMIO BAR
- //
- RegisterBaseMask = 0xFFFFFFF0;
- for (BarIndex = 0; BarIndex < PCI_MAX_BAR; BarIndex ++) {
- SerialRegisterBase = PciRead32 (PciLibAddress + PCI_BASE_ADDRESSREG_OFFSET + BarIndex * 4);
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio) && ((SerialRegisterBase & BIT0) == 0)) {
- //
- // MMIO BAR is found
- //
- RegisterBaseMask = 0xFFFFFFF0;
- break;
- }
-
- if ((!PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio)) && ((SerialRegisterBase & BIT0) != 0)) {
- //
- // IO BAR is found
- //
- RegisterBaseMask = 0xFFFFFFF8;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // MMIO or IO BAR is not found.
- //
- if (BarIndex == PCI_MAX_BAR) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Program UART BAR
- //
- SerialRegisterBase = SerialPortLibUpdatePciRegister32 (
- PciLibAddress + PCI_BASE_ADDRESSREG_OFFSET + BarIndex * 4,
- (UINT32)PcdGet64 (PcdSerialRegisterBase),
- RegisterBaseMask
- );
-
- //
- // Verify that the UART BAR is in the address range decoded by the parent PCI Bridge
- //
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio)) {
- if (((SerialRegisterBase >> 16) & 0xfff0) < ParentMemoryBase || ((SerialRegisterBase >> 16) & 0xfff0) > ParentMemoryLimit) {
- return 0;
- }
- } else {
- if ((SerialRegisterBase >> 12) < ParentIoBase || (SerialRegisterBase >> 12) > ParentIoLimit) {
- return 0;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Enable I/O and MMIO in PCI UART Device if they are not already enabled
- //
- PciOr16 (
- PciLibAddress + PCI_COMMAND_OFFSET,
- PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio) ? EFI_PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY_SPACE : EFI_PCI_COMMAND_IO_SPACE
- );
-
- //
- // Force D0 state if a Power Management and Status Register is specified
- //
- if (DeviceInfo->PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister != 0x00) {
- if ((PciRead16 (PciLibAddress + DeviceInfo->PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister) & (BIT0 | BIT1)) != 0x00) {
- PciAnd16 (PciLibAddress + DeviceInfo->PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister, (UINT16)~(BIT0 | BIT1));
- //
- // If PCI UART was not in D0, then make sure FIFOs are enabled, but do not reset FIFOs
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_FCR, (UINT8)(PcdGet8 (PcdSerialFifoControl) & (B_UART_FCR_FIFOE | B_UART_FCR_FIFO64)));
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Get PCI Device Info
- //
- DeviceInfo = (PCI_UART_DEVICE_INFO *) PcdGetPtr (PcdSerialPciDeviceInfo);
-
- //
- // Enable I/O or MMIO in PCI Bridge
- // Assume Root Bus Numer is Zero.
- //
- for (BusNumber = 0; (DeviceInfo + 1)->Device != 0xff; DeviceInfo++) {
- //
- // Compute PCI Lib Address to PCI to PCI Bridge
- //
- PciLibAddress = PCI_LIB_ADDRESS (BusNumber, DeviceInfo->Device, DeviceInfo->Function, 0);
-
- //
- // Enable the I/O or MMIO decode windows in the PCI to PCI Bridge
- //
- PciOr16 (
- PciLibAddress + PCI_COMMAND_OFFSET,
- PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseMmio) ? EFI_PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY_SPACE : EFI_PCI_COMMAND_IO_SPACE
- );
-
- //
- // Force D0 state if a Power Management and Status Register is specified
- //
- if (DeviceInfo->PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister != 0x00) {
- if ((PciRead16 (PciLibAddress + DeviceInfo->PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister) & (BIT0 | BIT1)) != 0x00) {
- PciAnd16 (PciLibAddress + DeviceInfo->PowerManagementStatusAndControlRegister, (UINT16)~(BIT0 | BIT1));
- }
- }
-
- BusNumber = PciRead8 (PciLibAddress + PCI_BRIDGE_SECONDARY_BUS_REGISTER_OFFSET);
- }
-
- return SerialRegisterBase;
-}
-
-/**
- Return whether the hardware flow control signal allows writing.
-
- @param SerialRegisterBase The base address register of UART device.
-
- @retval TRUE The serial port is writable.
- @retval FALSE The serial port is not writable.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-SerialPortWritable (
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase
- )
-{
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl)) {
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialDetectCable)) {
- //
- // Wait for both DSR and CTS to be set
- // DSR is set if a cable is connected.
- // CTS is set if it is ok to transmit data
- //
- // DSR CTS Description Action
- // === === ======================================== ========
- // 0 0 No cable connected. Wait
- // 0 1 No cable connected. Wait
- // 1 0 Cable connected, but not clear to send. Wait
- // 1 1 Cable connected, and clear to send. Transmit
- //
- return (BOOLEAN) ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MSR) & (B_UART_MSR_DSR | B_UART_MSR_CTS)) == (B_UART_MSR_DSR | B_UART_MSR_CTS));
- } else {
- //
- // Wait for both DSR and CTS to be set OR for DSR to be clear.
- // DSR is set if a cable is connected.
- // CTS is set if it is ok to transmit data
- //
- // DSR CTS Description Action
- // === === ======================================== ========
- // 0 0 No cable connected. Transmit
- // 0 1 No cable connected. Transmit
- // 1 0 Cable connected, but not clear to send. Wait
- // 1 1 Cable connected, and clar to send. Transmit
- //
- return (BOOLEAN) ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MSR) & (B_UART_MSR_DSR | B_UART_MSR_CTS)) != (B_UART_MSR_DSR));
- }
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Initialize the serial device hardware.
-
- If no initialization is required, then return RETURN_SUCCESS.
- If the serial device was successfully initialized, then return RETURN_SUCCESS.
- If the serial device could not be initialized, then return RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The serial device was initialized.
- @retval RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR The serial device could not be initialized.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortInitialize (
- VOID
- )
-{
- RETURN_STATUS Status;
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINT32 Divisor;
- UINT32 CurrentDivisor;
- BOOLEAN Initialized;
-
- //
- // Perform platform specific initialization required to enable use of the 16550 device
- // at the location specified by PcdSerialUseMmio and PcdSerialRegisterBase.
- //
- Status = PlatformHookSerialPortInitialize ();
- if (RETURN_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Calculate divisor for baud generator
- // Ref_Clk_Rate / Baud_Rate / 16
- //
- Divisor = PcdGet32 (PcdSerialClockRate) / (PcdGet32 (PcdSerialBaudRate) * 16);
- if ((PcdGet32 (PcdSerialClockRate) % (PcdGet32 (PcdSerialBaudRate) * 16)) >= PcdGet32 (PcdSerialBaudRate) * 8) {
- Divisor++;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the base address of the serial port in either I/O or MMIO space
- //
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-
- //
- // See if the serial port is already initialized
- //
- Initialized = TRUE;
- if ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR) & 0x3F) != (PcdGet8 (PcdSerialLineControl) & 0x3F)) {
- Initialized = FALSE;
- }
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR, (UINT8)(SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR) | B_UART_LCR_DLAB));
- CurrentDivisor = SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_BAUD_HIGH) << 8;
- CurrentDivisor |= (UINT32) SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_BAUD_LOW);
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR, (UINT8)(SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR) & ~B_UART_LCR_DLAB));
- if (CurrentDivisor != Divisor) {
- Initialized = FALSE;
- }
- if (Initialized) {
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Wait for the serial port to be ready.
- // Verify that both the transmit FIFO and the shift register are empty.
- //
- while ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LSR) & (B_UART_LSR_TEMT | B_UART_LSR_TXRDY)) != (B_UART_LSR_TEMT | B_UART_LSR_TXRDY));
-
- //
- // Configure baud rate
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR, B_UART_LCR_DLAB);
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_BAUD_HIGH, (UINT8) (Divisor >> 8));
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_BAUD_LOW, (UINT8) (Divisor & 0xff));
-
- //
- // Clear DLAB and configure Data Bits, Parity, and Stop Bits.
- // Strip reserved bits from PcdSerialLineControl
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR, (UINT8)(PcdGet8 (PcdSerialLineControl) & 0x3F));
-
- //
- // Enable and reset FIFOs
- // Strip reserved bits from PcdSerialFifoControl
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_FCR, 0x00);
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_FCR, (UINT8)(PcdGet8 (PcdSerialFifoControl) & (B_UART_FCR_FIFOE | B_UART_FCR_FIFO64)));
-
- //
- // Put Modem Control Register(MCR) into its reset state of 0x00.
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR, 0x00);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Write data from buffer to serial device.
-
- Writes NumberOfBytes data bytes from Buffer to the serial device.
- The number of bytes actually written to the serial device is returned.
- If the return value is less than NumberOfBytes, then the write operation failed.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- If NumberOfBytes is zero, then return 0.
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the data buffer to be written.
- @param NumberOfBytes Number of bytes to written to the serial device.
-
- @retval 0 NumberOfBytes is 0.
- @retval >0 The number of bytes written to the serial device.
- If this value is less than NumberOfBytes, then the write operation failed.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Buffer,
- IN UINTN NumberOfBytes
- )
-{
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINTN Result;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN FifoSize;
-
- if (Buffer == NULL) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (NumberOfBytes == 0) {
- //
- // Flush the hardware
- //
-
- //
- // Wait for both the transmit FIFO and shift register empty.
- //
- while ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LSR) & (B_UART_LSR_TEMT | B_UART_LSR_TXRDY)) != (B_UART_LSR_TEMT | B_UART_LSR_TXRDY));
-
- //
- // Wait for the hardware flow control signal
- //
- while (!SerialPortWritable (SerialRegisterBase));
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Compute the maximum size of the Tx FIFO
- //
- FifoSize = 1;
- if ((PcdGet8 (PcdSerialFifoControl) & B_UART_FCR_FIFOE) != 0) {
- if ((PcdGet8 (PcdSerialFifoControl) & B_UART_FCR_FIFO64) == 0) {
- FifoSize = 16;
- } else {
- FifoSize = PcdGet32 (PcdSerialExtendedTxFifoSize);
- }
- }
-
- Result = NumberOfBytes;
- while (NumberOfBytes != 0) {
- //
- // Wait for the serial port to be ready, to make sure both the transmit FIFO
- // and shift register empty.
- //
- while ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LSR) & B_UART_LSR_TEMT) == 0);
-
- //
- // Fill then entire Tx FIFO
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < FifoSize && NumberOfBytes != 0; Index++, NumberOfBytes--, Buffer++) {
- //
- // Wait for the hardware flow control signal
- //
- while (!SerialPortWritable (SerialRegisterBase));
-
- //
- // Write byte to the transmit buffer.
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_TXBUF, *Buffer);
- }
- }
- return Result;
-}
-
-/**
- Reads data from a serial device into a buffer.
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the data buffer to store the data read from the serial device.
- @param NumberOfBytes Number of bytes to read from the serial device.
-
- @retval 0 NumberOfBytes is 0.
- @retval >0 The number of bytes read from the serial device.
- If this value is less than NumberOfBytes, then the read operation failed.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortRead (
- OUT UINT8 *Buffer,
- IN UINTN NumberOfBytes
- )
-{
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINTN Result;
- UINT8 Mcr;
-
- if (NULL == Buffer) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- Mcr = (UINT8)(SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR) & ~B_UART_MCR_RTS);
-
- for (Result = 0; NumberOfBytes-- != 0; Result++, Buffer++) {
- //
- // Wait for the serial port to have some data.
- //
- while ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LSR) & B_UART_LSR_RXRDY) == 0) {
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl)) {
- //
- // Set RTS to let the peer send some data
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR, (UINT8)(Mcr | B_UART_MCR_RTS));
- }
- }
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl)) {
- //
- // Clear RTS to prevent peer from sending data
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR, Mcr);
- }
-
- //
- // Read byte from the receive buffer.
- //
- *Buffer = SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_RXBUF);
- }
-
- return Result;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Polls a serial device to see if there is any data waiting to be read.
-
- Polls aserial device to see if there is any data waiting to be read.
- If there is data waiting to be read from the serial device, then TRUE is returned.
- If there is no data waiting to be read from the serial device, then FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE Data is waiting to be read from the serial device.
- @retval FALSE There is no data waiting to be read from the serial device.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortPoll (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
-
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Read the serial port status
- //
- if ((SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LSR) & B_UART_LSR_RXRDY) != 0) {
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl)) {
- //
- // Clear RTS to prevent peer from sending data
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR, (UINT8)(SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR) & ~B_UART_MCR_RTS));
- }
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl)) {
- //
- // Set RTS to let the peer send some data
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR, (UINT8)(SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR) | B_UART_MCR_RTS));
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Sets the control bits on a serial device.
-
- @param Control Sets the bits of Control that are settable.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The new control bits were set on the serial device.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The serial device does not support this operation.
- @retval RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR The serial device is not functioning correctly.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortSetControl (
- IN UINT32 Control
- )
-{
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINT8 Mcr;
-
- //
- // First determine the parameter is invalid.
- //
- if ((Control & (~(EFI_SERIAL_REQUEST_TO_SEND | EFI_SERIAL_DATA_TERMINAL_READY |
- EFI_SERIAL_HARDWARE_FLOW_CONTROL_ENABLE))) != 0) {
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Read the Modem Control Register.
- //
- Mcr = SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR);
- Mcr &= (~(B_UART_MCR_DTRC | B_UART_MCR_RTS));
-
- if ((Control & EFI_SERIAL_DATA_TERMINAL_READY) == EFI_SERIAL_DATA_TERMINAL_READY) {
- Mcr |= B_UART_MCR_DTRC;
- }
-
- if ((Control & EFI_SERIAL_REQUEST_TO_SEND) == EFI_SERIAL_REQUEST_TO_SEND) {
- Mcr |= B_UART_MCR_RTS;
- }
-
- //
- // Write the Modem Control Register.
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR, Mcr);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieve the status of the control bits on a serial device.
-
- @param Control A pointer to return the current control signals from the serial device.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The control bits were read from the serial device.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The serial device does not support this operation.
- @retval RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR The serial device is not functioning correctly.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortGetControl (
- OUT UINT32 *Control
- )
-{
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINT8 Msr;
- UINT8 Mcr;
- UINT8 Lsr;
-
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- *Control = 0;
-
- //
- // Read the Modem Status Register.
- //
- Msr = SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MSR);
-
- if ((Msr & B_UART_MSR_CTS) == B_UART_MSR_CTS) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_CLEAR_TO_SEND;
- }
-
- if ((Msr & B_UART_MSR_DSR) == B_UART_MSR_DSR) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_DATA_SET_READY;
- }
-
- if ((Msr & B_UART_MSR_RI) == B_UART_MSR_RI) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_RING_INDICATE;
- }
-
- if ((Msr & B_UART_MSR_DCD) == B_UART_MSR_DCD) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_CARRIER_DETECT;
- }
-
- //
- // Read the Modem Control Register.
- //
- Mcr = SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_MCR);
-
- if ((Mcr & B_UART_MCR_DTRC) == B_UART_MCR_DTRC) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_DATA_TERMINAL_READY;
- }
-
- if ((Mcr & B_UART_MCR_RTS) == B_UART_MCR_RTS) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_REQUEST_TO_SEND;
- }
-
- if (PcdGetBool (PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl)) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_HARDWARE_FLOW_CONTROL_ENABLE;
- }
-
- //
- // Read the Line Status Register.
- //
- Lsr = SerialPortReadRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LSR);
-
- if ((Lsr & (B_UART_LSR_TEMT | B_UART_LSR_TXRDY)) == (B_UART_LSR_TEMT | B_UART_LSR_TXRDY)) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_EMPTY;
- }
-
- if ((Lsr & B_UART_LSR_RXRDY) == 0) {
- *Control |= EFI_SERIAL_INPUT_BUFFER_EMPTY;
- }
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Sets the baud rate, receive FIFO depth, transmit/receice time out, parity,
- data bits, and stop bits on a serial device.
-
- @param BaudRate The requested baud rate. A BaudRate value of 0 will use the
- device's default interface speed.
- On output, the value actually set.
- @param ReveiveFifoDepth The requested depth of the FIFO on the receive side of the
- serial interface. A ReceiveFifoDepth value of 0 will use
- the device's default FIFO depth.
- On output, the value actually set.
- @param Timeout The requested time out for a single character in microseconds.
- This timeout applies to both the transmit and receive side of the
- interface. A Timeout value of 0 will use the device's default time
- out value.
- On output, the value actually set.
- @param Parity The type of parity to use on this serial device. A Parity value of
- DefaultParity will use the device's default parity value.
- On output, the value actually set.
- @param DataBits The number of data bits to use on the serial device. A DataBits
- vaule of 0 will use the device's default data bit setting.
- On output, the value actually set.
- @param StopBits The number of stop bits to use on this serial device. A StopBits
- value of DefaultStopBits will use the device's default number of
- stop bits.
- On output, the value actually set.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The new attributes were set on the serial device.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The serial device does not support this operation.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more of the attributes has an unsupported value.
- @retval RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR The serial device is not functioning correctly.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SerialPortSetAttributes (
- IN OUT UINT64 *BaudRate,
- IN OUT UINT32 *ReceiveFifoDepth,
- IN OUT UINT32 *Timeout,
- IN OUT EFI_PARITY_TYPE *Parity,
- IN OUT UINT8 *DataBits,
- IN OUT EFI_STOP_BITS_TYPE *StopBits
- )
-{
- UINTN SerialRegisterBase;
- UINT32 SerialBaudRate;
- UINTN Divisor;
- UINT8 Lcr;
- UINT8 LcrData;
- UINT8 LcrParity;
- UINT8 LcrStop;
-
- SerialRegisterBase = GetSerialRegisterBase ();
- if (SerialRegisterBase ==0) {
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Check for default settings and fill in actual values.
- //
- if (*BaudRate == 0) {
- *BaudRate = PcdGet32 (PcdSerialBaudRate);
- }
- SerialBaudRate = (UINT32) *BaudRate;
-
- if (*DataBits == 0) {
- LcrData = (UINT8) (PcdGet8 (PcdSerialLineControl) & 0x3);
- *DataBits = LcrData + 5;
- } else {
- if ((*DataBits < 5) || (*DataBits > 8)) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Map 5..8 to 0..3
- //
- LcrData = (UINT8) (*DataBits - (UINT8) 5);
- }
-
- if (*Parity == DefaultParity) {
- LcrParity = (UINT8) ((PcdGet8 (PcdSerialLineControl) >> 3) & 0x7);
- switch (LcrParity) {
- case 0:
- *Parity = NoParity;
- break;
-
- case 3:
- *Parity = EvenParity;
- break;
-
- case 1:
- *Parity = OddParity;
- break;
-
- case 7:
- *Parity = SpaceParity;
- break;
-
- case 5:
- *Parity = MarkParity;
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- } else {
- if ((*Parity < NoParity) || (*Parity > SpaceParity)) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- switch (*Parity) {
- case NoParity:
- LcrParity = 0;
- break;
-
- case EvenParity:
- LcrParity = 3;
- break;
-
- case OddParity:
- LcrParity = 1;
- break;
-
- case SpaceParity:
- LcrParity = 7;
- break;
-
- case MarkParity:
- LcrParity = 5;
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (*StopBits == DefaultStopBits) {
- LcrStop = (UINT8) ((PcdGet8 (PcdSerialLineControl) >> 2) & 0x1);
- switch (LcrStop) {
- case 0:
- *StopBits = OneStopBit;
- break;
-
- case 1:
- if (*DataBits == 5) {
- *StopBits = OneFiveStopBits;
- } else {
- *StopBits = TwoStopBits;
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- } else {
- if ((*StopBits < OneStopBit) || (*StopBits > TwoStopBits)) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- switch (*StopBits) {
- case OneStopBit:
- LcrStop = 0;
- break;
-
- case OneFiveStopBits:
- case TwoStopBits:
- LcrStop = 1;
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Calculate divisor for baud generator
- // Ref_Clk_Rate / Baud_Rate / 16
- //
- Divisor = PcdGet32 (PcdSerialClockRate) / (SerialBaudRate * 16);
- if ((PcdGet32 (PcdSerialClockRate) % (SerialBaudRate * 16)) >= SerialBaudRate * 8) {
- Divisor++;
- }
-
- //
- // Configure baud rate
- //
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR, B_UART_LCR_DLAB);
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_BAUD_HIGH, (UINT8) (Divisor >> 8));
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_BAUD_LOW, (UINT8) (Divisor & 0xff));
-
- //
- // Clear DLAB and configure Data Bits, Parity, and Stop Bits.
- // Strip reserved bits from line control value
- //
- Lcr = (UINT8) ((LcrParity << 3) | (LcrStop << 2) | LcrData);
- SerialPortWriteRegister (SerialRegisterBase, R_UART_LCR, (UINT8) (Lcr & 0x3F));
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.inf deleted file mode 100644 index bb42f89676..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,48 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# SerialPortLib instance for 16550 UART.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = BaseSerialPortLib16550
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = BaseSerialPortLib16550.uni
- FILE_GUID = 9E7C00CF-355A-4d4e-BF60-0428CFF95540
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.1
- LIBRARY_CLASS = SerialPortLib
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- IoLib
- PlatformHookLib
- PciLib
-
-[Sources]
- BaseSerialPortLib16550.c
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialUseMmio ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialUseHardwareFlowControl ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialDetectCable ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialRegisterBase ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialBaudRate ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialLineControl ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialFifoControl ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialClockRate ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialPciDeviceInfo ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialExtendedTxFifoSize ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdSerialRegisterStride ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 641a86efc7..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSerialPortLib16550/BaseSerialPortLib16550.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index ab8a60585e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,238 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Library used for sorting routines.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved. <BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/SortLib.h>
-
-/**
- Worker function for QuickSorting. This function is identical to PerformQuickSort,
- except that is uses the pre-allocated buffer so the in place sorting does not need to
- allocate and free buffers constantly.
-
- Each element must be equal sized.
-
- if BufferToSort is NULL, then ASSERT.
- if CompareFunction is NULL, then ASSERT.
- if Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT.
-
- if Count is < 2 then perform no action.
- if Size is < 1 then perform no action.
-
- @param[in, out] BufferToSort on call a Buffer of (possibly sorted) elements
- on return a buffer of sorted elements
- @param[in] Count the number of elements in the buffer to sort
- @param[in] ElementSize Size of an element in bytes
- @param[in] CompareFunction The function to call to perform the comparison
- of any 2 elements
- @param[in] Buffer Buffer of size ElementSize for use in swapping
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-QuickSortWorker (
- IN OUT VOID *BufferToSort,
- IN CONST UINTN Count,
- IN CONST UINTN ElementSize,
- IN SORT_COMPARE CompareFunction,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- VOID *Pivot;
- UINTN LoopCount;
- UINTN NextSwapLocation;
-
- ASSERT(BufferToSort != NULL);
- ASSERT(CompareFunction != NULL);
- ASSERT(Buffer != NULL);
-
- if ( Count < 2
- || ElementSize < 1
- ){
- return;
- }
-
- NextSwapLocation = 0;
-
- //
- // pick a pivot (we choose last element)
- //
- Pivot = ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+((Count-1)*ElementSize));
-
- //
- // Now get the pivot such that all on "left" are below it
- // and everything "right" are above it
- //
- for ( LoopCount = 0
- ; LoopCount < Count -1
- ; LoopCount++
- ){
- //
- // if the element is less than the pivot
- //
- if (CompareFunction((VOID*)((UINT8*)BufferToSort+((LoopCount)*ElementSize)),Pivot) <= 0){
- //
- // swap
- //
- CopyMem (Buffer, (UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), ElementSize);
- CopyMem ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), (UINT8*)BufferToSort+((LoopCount)*ElementSize), ElementSize);
- CopyMem ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+((LoopCount)*ElementSize), Buffer, ElementSize);
-
- //
- // increment NextSwapLocation
- //
- NextSwapLocation++;
- }
- }
- //
- // swap pivot to it's final position (NextSwapLocaiton)
- //
- CopyMem (Buffer, Pivot, ElementSize);
- CopyMem (Pivot, (UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), ElementSize);
- CopyMem ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), Buffer, ElementSize);
-
- //
- // Now recurse on 2 paritial lists. neither of these will have the 'pivot' element
- // IE list is sorted left half, pivot element, sorted right half...
- //
- if (NextSwapLocation >= 2) {
- QuickSortWorker(
- BufferToSort,
- NextSwapLocation,
- ElementSize,
- CompareFunction,
- Buffer);
- }
-
- if ((Count - NextSwapLocation - 1) >= 2) {
- QuickSortWorker(
- (UINT8 *)BufferToSort + (NextSwapLocation+1) * ElementSize,
- Count - NextSwapLocation - 1,
- ElementSize,
- CompareFunction,
- Buffer);
- }
- return;
-}
-/**
- Function to perform a Quick Sort alogrithm on a buffer of comparable elements.
-
- Each element must be equal sized.
-
- if BufferToSort is NULL, then ASSERT.
- if CompareFunction is NULL, then ASSERT.
-
- if Count is < 2 then perform no action.
- if Size is < 1 then perform no action.
-
- @param[in, out] BufferToSort on call a Buffer of (possibly sorted) elements
- on return a buffer of sorted elements
- @param[in] Count the number of elements in the buffer to sort
- @param[in] ElementSize Size of an element in bytes
- @param[in] CompareFunction The function to call to perform the comparison
- of any 2 elements
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PerformQuickSort (
- IN OUT VOID *BufferToSort,
- IN CONST UINTN Count,
- IN CONST UINTN ElementSize,
- IN SORT_COMPARE CompareFunction
- )
-{
- VOID *Buffer;
-
- ASSERT(BufferToSort != NULL);
- ASSERT(CompareFunction != NULL);
-
- Buffer = AllocateZeroPool(ElementSize);
- ASSERT(Buffer != NULL);
-
- QuickSortWorker(
- BufferToSort,
- Count,
- ElementSize,
- CompareFunction,
- Buffer);
-
- FreePool(Buffer);
- return;
-}
-
-/**
- Not supported in Base version.
-
- @param[in] Buffer1 Ignored.
- @param[in] Buffer2 Ignored.
-
- ASSERT and return 0.
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-DevicePathCompare (
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer1,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer2
- )
-{
- ASSERT(FALSE);
- return 0;
-}
-
-/**
- Function to compare 2 strings without regard to case of the characters.
-
- @param[in] Buffer1 Pointer to String to compare.
- @param[in] Buffer2 Pointer to second String to compare.
-
- @retval 0 Buffer1 equal to Buffer2.
- @return < 0 Buffer1 is less than Buffer2.
- @return > 0 Buffer1 is greater than Buffer2.
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-StringNoCaseCompare (
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer1,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer2
- )
-{
- ASSERT(FALSE);
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Function to compare 2 strings.
-
- @param[in] Buffer1 Pointer to String to compare (CHAR16**).
- @param[in] Buffer2 Pointer to second String to compare (CHAR16**).
-
- @retval 0 Buffer1 equal to Buffer2.
- @return < 0 Buffer1 is less than Buffer2.
- @return > 0 Buffer1 is greater than Buffer2.
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-StringCompare (
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer1,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer2
- )
-{
- ASSERT(FALSE);
- return 0;
-}
-
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 4b493f4eb6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Library used for sorting routines.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved. <BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010006
- BASE_NAME = BaseSortLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = BaseSortLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 03F3331B-F12D-494f-BF37-E55A657F2497
- MODULE_TYPE = UEFI_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = SortLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources.common]
- BaseSortLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DebugLib
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 2163301c42..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/BaseSortLib/BaseSortLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 2fea24ac31..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,99 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- CPU Exception Handler library implementition with empty functions.
-
- Copyright (c) 2012 - 2013, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLib.h>
-
-/**
- Initializes all CPU exceptions entries and provides the default exception handlers.
-
- Caller should try to get an array of interrupt and/or exception vectors that are in use and need to
- persist by EFI_VECTOR_HANDOFF_INFO defined in PI 1.3 specification.
- If caller cannot get reserved vector list or it does not exists, set VectorInfo to NULL.
- If VectorInfo is not NULL, the exception vectors will be initialized per vector attribute accordingly.
-
- @param[in] VectorInfo Pointer to reserved vector list.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS CPU Exception Entries have been successfully initialized
- with default exception handlers.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER VectorInfo includes the invalid content if VectorInfo is not NULL.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED This function is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InitializeCpuExceptionHandlers (
- IN EFI_VECTOR_HANDOFF_INFO *VectorInfo OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Initializes all CPU interrupt/exceptions entries and provides the default interrupt/exception handlers.
-
- Caller should try to get an array of interrupt and/or exception vectors that are in use and need to
- persist by EFI_VECTOR_HANDOFF_INFO defined in PI 1.3 specification.
- If caller cannot get reserved vector list or it does not exists, set VectorInfo to NULL.
- If VectorInfo is not NULL, the exception vectors will be initialized per vector attribute accordingly.
-
- @param[in] VectorInfo Pointer to reserved vector list.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS All CPU interrupt/exception entries have been successfully initialized
- with default interrupt/exception handlers.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER VectorInfo includes the invalid content if VectorInfo is not NULL.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED This function is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InitializeCpuInterruptHandlers (
- IN EFI_VECTOR_HANDOFF_INFO *VectorInfo OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Registers a function to be called from the processor interrupt handler.
-
- This function registers and enables the handler specified by InterruptHandler for a processor
- interrupt or exception type specified by InterruptType. If InterruptHandler is NULL, then the
- handler for the processor interrupt or exception type specified by InterruptType is uninstalled.
- The installed handler is called once for each processor interrupt or exception.
- NOTE: This function should be invoked after InitializeCpuExceptionHandlers() or
- InitializeCpuInterruptHandlers() invoked, otherwise EFI_UNSUPPORTED returned.
-
- @param[in] InterruptType Defines which interrupt or exception to hook.
- @param[in] InterruptHandler A pointer to a function of type EFI_CPU_INTERRUPT_HANDLER that is called
- when a processor interrupt occurs. If this parameter is NULL, then the handler
- will be uninstalled.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The handler for the processor interrupt was successfully installed or uninstalled.
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED InterruptHandler is not NULL, and a handler for InterruptType was
- previously installed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER InterruptHandler is NULL, and a handler for InterruptType was not
- previously installed.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The interrupt specified by InterruptType is not supported,
- or this function is not supported.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RegisterCpuInterruptHandler (
- IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE InterruptType,
- IN EFI_CPU_INTERRUPT_HANDLER InterruptHandler
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index c79c5a76ee..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,36 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null instance of CPU Exception Handler Library with empty functions.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2012 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 3175E6B9-4B01-496a-9A2B-64AF02D87E34
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = CpuExceptionHandlerLib
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources.common]
- CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 9dfc23603f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull/CpuExceptionHandlerLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/Colors.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/Colors.h deleted file mode 100644 index 2db8b99614..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/Colors.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,44 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-MACRO definitions for color used in Setup Browser.
-
-Copyright (c) 2004 - 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-//
-// Unicode collation protocol in
-
-#ifndef _COLORS_H_
-#define _COLORS_H_
-
-//
-// Screen Color Settings
-//
-#define PICKLIST_HIGHLIGHT_TEXT EFI_WHITE
-#define PICKLIST_HIGHLIGHT_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_CYAN
-#define TITLE_TEXT EFI_WHITE
-#define TITLE_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_BLUE
-#define KEYHELP_TEXT EFI_LIGHTGRAY
-#define KEYHELP_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_BLACK
-#define SUBTITLE_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_LIGHTGRAY
-#define BANNER_TEXT EFI_BLUE
-#define BANNER_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_LIGHTGRAY
-#define FIELD_TEXT_GRAYED EFI_DARKGRAY
-#define FIELD_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_LIGHTGRAY
-#define POPUP_TEXT EFI_LIGHTGRAY
-#define POPUP_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_BLUE
-#define POPUP_INVERSE_TEXT EFI_LIGHTGRAY
-#define POPUP_INVERSE_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_BLACK
-#define HELP_TEXT EFI_BLUE
-#define ERROR_TEXT EFI_RED | EFI_BRIGHT
-#define INFO_TEXT EFI_YELLOW | EFI_BRIGHT
-#define ARROW_TEXT EFI_RED | EFI_BRIGHT
-#define ARROW_BACKGROUND EFI_BACKGROUND_LIGHTGRAY
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 622410359c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,958 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
- This library class defines a set of interfaces to customize Display module
-
-Copyright (c) 2013 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials are licensed and made available under
-the terms and conditions of the BSD License that accompanies this distribution.
-The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include "CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.h"
-
-EFI_GUID gCustomizedDisplayLibGuid = { 0x99fdc8fd, 0x849b, 0x4eba, { 0xad, 0x13, 0xfb, 0x96, 0x99, 0xc9, 0xa, 0x4d } };
-
-EFI_HII_HANDLE mCDLStringPackHandle;
-UINT16 gClassOfVfr; // Formset class information
-BOOLEAN gLibIsFirstForm = TRUE;
-BANNER_DATA *gBannerData;
-
-UINTN gFooterHeight;
-
-/**
-+------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
-| Setup Page |
-+------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
-
-Statement
-Statement
-Statement
-
-
-
-
-
-+------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
-| F9=Reset to Defaults F10=Save |
-| ^"=Move Highlight <Spacebar> Toggles Checkbox Esc=Exit |
-+------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
- StatusBar
-**/
-
-/**
- This funtion defines Page Frame and Backgroud.
-
- Based on the above layout, it will be responsible for HeaderHeight, FooterHeight,
- StatusBarHeight and Backgroud. And, it will reserve Screen for Statement.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page.
- @param[out] ScreenForStatement Screen to be used for Statement. (Prompt, Value and Help)
-
- @return Status
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DisplayPageFrame (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData,
- OUT EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR *ScreenForStatement
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (FormData != NULL && ScreenForStatement != NULL);
- if (FormData == NULL || ScreenForStatement == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Status = ScreenDiemensionInfoValidate (FormData);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- gClassOfVfr = FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP;
-
- ProcessExternedOpcode(FormData);
-
- //
- // Calculate the ScreenForStatement.
- //
- ScreenForStatement->BottomRow = gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - gFooterHeight;
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE) {
- ScreenForStatement->TopRow = gScreenDimensions.TopRow + FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT;
- } else {
- ScreenForStatement->TopRow = gScreenDimensions.TopRow + NONE_FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT;
- }
- ScreenForStatement->LeftColumn = gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn;
- ScreenForStatement->RightColumn = gScreenDimensions.RightColumn;
-
- if ((gLibIsFirstForm) || ((FormData->Attribute & HII_DISPLAY_MODAL) != 0)) {
- //
- // Ensure we are in Text mode
- //
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, EFI_TEXT_ATTR (EFI_LIGHTGRAY, EFI_BLACK));
- ClearLines (0, gScreenDimensions.RightColumn, 0, gScreenDimensions.BottomRow, KEYHELP_BACKGROUND);
- gLibIsFirstForm = FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Don't print frame for modal form.
- //
- if ((FormData->Attribute & HII_DISPLAY_MODAL) != 0) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE) {
- PrintBannerInfo (FormData);
- }
-
- PrintFramework (FormData);
-
- UpdateStatusBar(NV_UPDATE_REQUIRED, FormData->SettingChangedFlag);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function updates customized key panel's help information.
- The library will prepare those Strings for the basic key, ESC, Enter, Up/Down/Left/Right, +/-.
- and arrange them in Footer panel.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page. FormData has the highlighted statement.
- @param[in] Statement The statement current selected.
- @param[in] Selected Whether or not a tag be selected. TRUE means Enter has hit this question.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-RefreshKeyHelp (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData,
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_STATEMENT *Statement,
- IN BOOLEAN Selected
- )
-{
- UINTN SecCol;
- UINTN ThdCol;
- UINTN RightColumnOfHelp;
- UINTN TopRowOfHelp;
- UINTN BottomRowOfHelp;
- UINTN StartColumnOfHelp;
- EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *NumericOp;
- EFI_IFR_DATE *DateOp;
- EFI_IFR_TIME *TimeOp;
- BOOLEAN HexDisplay;
- UINTN ColumnWidth1;
- UINTN ColumnWidth2;
- UINTN ColumnWidth3;
- CHAR16 *ColumnStr1;
- CHAR16 *ColumnStr2;
- CHAR16 *ColumnStr3;
-
- ASSERT (FormData != NULL);
- if (FormData == NULL) {
- return;
- }
-
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, KEYHELP_TEXT | KEYHELP_BACKGROUND);
-
- if ((FormData->Attribute & HII_DISPLAY_MODAL) != 0) {
- return;
- }
-
- SecCol = gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn) / 3;
- ThdCol = gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn) / 3 * 2;
-
- //
- // + 2 means leave 1 space before the first hotkey info.
- //
- StartColumnOfHelp = gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + 2;
- RightColumnOfHelp = gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - 1;
- TopRowOfHelp = gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - gFooterHeight + 1;
- BottomRowOfHelp = gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - 2;
-
- ColumnWidth1 = SecCol - StartColumnOfHelp;
- ColumnWidth2 = ThdCol - SecCol;
- ColumnWidth3 = RightColumnOfHelp - ThdCol;
- ColumnStr1 = gLibEmptyString;
- ColumnStr2 = gLibEmptyString;
- ColumnStr3 = gLibEmptyString;
-
- //
- // Clean the space at gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + 1.
- //
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp - 1, BottomRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, 1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp - 1, TopRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, 1);
-
- if (Statement == NULL) {
- //
- // Print Key for Form without showable statement.
- //
- PrintHotKeyHelpString (FormData, TRUE);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, ColumnWidth1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, ColumnWidth2);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, ColumnWidth1);
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP) {
- ColumnStr3 = gEscapeString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr3, ColumnWidth3);
-
- return;
- }
-
- HexDisplay = FALSE;
- NumericOp = NULL;
- DateOp = NULL;
- TimeOp = NULL;
- if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP) {
- NumericOp = (EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *) Statement->OpCode;
- HexDisplay = (NumericOp->Flags & EFI_IFR_DISPLAY_UINT_HEX) == EFI_IFR_DISPLAY_UINT_HEX;
- } else if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_DATE_OP) {
- DateOp = (EFI_IFR_DATE *) Statement->OpCode;
- HexDisplay = (DateOp->Flags & EFI_IFR_DISPLAY_UINT_HEX) == EFI_IFR_DISPLAY_UINT_HEX;
- } else if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_TIME_OP) {
- TimeOp = (EFI_IFR_TIME *) Statement->OpCode;
- HexDisplay = (TimeOp->Flags & EFI_IFR_DISPLAY_UINT_HEX) == EFI_IFR_DISPLAY_UINT_HEX;
- }
- switch (Statement->OpCode->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_TIME_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_DATE_OP:
- if (!Selected) {
- PrintHotKeyHelpString (FormData, TRUE);
-
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP) {
- ColumnStr3 = gEscapeString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr3, ColumnWidth3);
-
- if ((Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_DATE_OP) ||
- (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_TIME_OP)) {
- PrintAt (
- ColumnWidth1,
- StartColumnOfHelp,
- BottomRowOfHelp,
- L"%c%c%c%c%s",
- ARROW_UP,
- ARROW_DOWN,
- ARROW_RIGHT,
- ARROW_LEFT,
- gMoveHighlight
- );
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, gEnterString, ColumnWidth2);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, gAdjustNumber, ColumnWidth1);
- } else {
- PrintAt (ColumnWidth1, StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, L"%c%c%s", ARROW_UP, ARROW_DOWN, gMoveHighlight);
- if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP && NumericOp != NULL && LibGetFieldFromNum(Statement->OpCode) != 0) {
- ColumnStr1 = gAdjustNumber;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, ColumnStr1, ColumnWidth1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, gEnterString, ColumnWidth2);
- }
- } else {
- PrintHotKeyHelpString (FormData, FALSE);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, gEnterCommitString, ColumnWidth2);
-
- //
- // If it is a selected numeric with manual input, display different message
- //
- if ((Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP) ||
- (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_DATE_OP) ||
- (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_TIME_OP)) {
- ColumnStr2 = HexDisplay ? gHexNumericInput : gDecNumericInput;
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, ColumnWidth1);
- } else {
- PrintAt (ColumnWidth1, StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, L"%c%c%s", ARROW_UP, ARROW_DOWN, gMoveHighlight);
- }
-
- if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode == EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP) {
- ColumnStr1 = gPlusString;
- ColumnStr3 = gMinusString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, ColumnStr1, ColumnWidth1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, TopRowOfHelp, ColumnStr3, ColumnWidth3);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, TopRowOfHelp, ColumnStr2, ColumnWidth2);
-
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, BottomRowOfHelp, gEnterEscapeString, ColumnWidth3);
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- PrintHotKeyHelpString (FormData, TRUE);
-
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP) {
- ColumnStr3 = gEscapeString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr3, ColumnWidth3);
-
- PrintAt (ColumnWidth1, StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, L"%c%c%s", ARROW_UP, ARROW_DOWN, gMoveHighlight);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, gToggleCheckBox, ColumnWidth2);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, gLibEmptyString, ColumnWidth1);
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_REF_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_PASSWORD_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_STRING_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_TEXT_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_ACTION_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_RESET_BUTTON_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_SUBTITLE_OP:
- if (!Selected) {
- PrintHotKeyHelpString (FormData, TRUE);
-
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP) {
- ColumnStr3 = gEscapeString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr3, ColumnWidth3);
-
- PrintAt (ColumnWidth1, StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, L"%c%c%s", ARROW_UP, ARROW_DOWN, gMoveHighlight);
- if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode != EFI_IFR_TEXT_OP && Statement->OpCode->OpCode != EFI_IFR_SUBTITLE_OP) {
- ColumnStr2 = gEnterString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr2, ColumnWidth2);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, ColumnStr1, ColumnWidth1);
- } else {
- PrintHotKeyHelpString (FormData, FALSE);
- if (Statement->OpCode->OpCode != EFI_IFR_REF_OP) {
- ColumnStr2 = gEnterCommitString;
- ColumnStr3 = gEnterEscapeString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, TopRowOfHelp, ColumnStr1, ColumnWidth1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (StartColumnOfHelp, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr1, ColumnWidth1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (SecCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr2, ColumnWidth2);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (ThdCol, BottomRowOfHelp, ColumnStr3, ColumnWidth3);
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Update status bar.
-
- This function updates the status bar on the bottom of menu screen. It just shows StatusBar.
- Original logic in this function should be splitted out.
-
- @param[in] MessageType The type of message to be shown. InputError or Configuration Changed.
- @param[in] State Show or Clear Message.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UpdateStatusBar (
- IN UINTN MessageType,
- IN BOOLEAN State
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR16 OptionWidth;
-
- OptionWidth = (CHAR16) ((gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn) / 3);
-
- switch (MessageType) {
- case INPUT_ERROR:
- if (State) {
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, ERROR_TEXT);
- PrintStringAt (
- gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + OptionWidth,
- gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - 1,
- gInputErrorMessage
- );
- } else {
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, KEYHELP_BACKGROUND);
- for (Index = 0; Index < (LibGetStringWidth (gInputErrorMessage) - 2) / 2; Index++) {
- PrintStringAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + OptionWidth + Index, gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - 1, L" ");
- }
- }
- break;
-
- case NV_UPDATE_REQUIRED:
- //
- // Global setting support. Show configuration change on every form.
- //
- if (State) {
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, INFO_TEXT);
- PrintStringAt (
- gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + OptionWidth * 2,
- gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - 1,
- gNvUpdateMessage
- );
- } else {
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, KEYHELP_BACKGROUND);
- for (Index = 0; Index < (LibGetStringWidth (gNvUpdateMessage) - 2) / 2; Index++) {
- PrintStringAt (
- (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + OptionWidth * 2 + Index),
- gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - 1,
- L" "
- );
- }
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Create popup window. It will replace CreateDialog().
-
- This function draws OEM/Vendor specific pop up windows.
-
- @param[out] Key User Input Key
- @param ... String to be shown in Popup. The variable argument list is terminated by a NULL.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-CreateDialog (
- OUT EFI_INPUT_KEY *Key, OPTIONAL
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- EFI_INPUT_KEY KeyValue;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN LargestString;
- UINTN LineNum;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Count;
- CHAR16 Character;
- UINTN Start;
- UINTN End;
- UINTN Top;
- UINTN Bottom;
- CHAR16 *String;
- UINTN DimensionsWidth;
- UINTN DimensionsHeight;
- UINTN CurrentAttribute;
- BOOLEAN CursorVisible;
-
- //
- // If screen dimension info is not ready, get it from console.
- //
- if (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn == 0 || gScreenDimensions.BottomRow == 0) {
- ZeroMem (&gScreenDimensions, sizeof (EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR));
- gST->ConOut->QueryMode (
- gST->ConOut,
- gST->ConOut->Mode->Mode,
- &gScreenDimensions.RightColumn,
- &gScreenDimensions.BottomRow
- );
- }
-
- DimensionsWidth = gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn;
- DimensionsHeight = gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - gScreenDimensions.TopRow;
-
- LargestString = 0;
- LineNum = 0;
- VA_START (Marker, Key);
- while ((String = VA_ARG (Marker, CHAR16 *)) != NULL) {
- LineNum ++;
-
- if ((LibGetStringWidth (String) / 2) > LargestString) {
- LargestString = (LibGetStringWidth (String) / 2);
- }
- }
- VA_END (Marker);
-
- if ((LargestString + 2) > DimensionsWidth) {
- LargestString = DimensionsWidth - 2;
- }
-
- CurrentAttribute = gST->ConOut->Mode->Attribute;
- CursorVisible = gST->ConOut->Mode->CursorVisible;
- gST->ConOut->EnableCursor (gST->ConOut, FALSE);
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, GetPopupColor ());
-
- //
- // Subtract the PopUp width from total Columns, allow for one space extra on
- // each end plus a border.
- //
- Start = (DimensionsWidth - LargestString - 2) / 2 + gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + 1;
- End = Start + LargestString + 1;
-
- Top = ((DimensionsHeight - LineNum - 2) / 2) + gScreenDimensions.TopRow - 1;
- Bottom = Top + LineNum + 2;
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_DOWN_RIGHT;
- PrintCharAt (Start, Top, Character);
- Character = BOXDRAW_HORIZONTAL;
- for (Index = Start; Index + 2 < End; Index++) {
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN)-1, (UINTN)-1, Character);
- }
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_DOWN_LEFT;
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN)-1, (UINTN)-1, Character);
- Character = BOXDRAW_VERTICAL;
-
- Count = 0;
- VA_START (Marker, Key);
- for (Index = Top; Index + 2 < Bottom; Index++, Count++) {
- String = VA_ARG (Marker, CHAR16*);
-
- if (String[0] == CHAR_NULL) {
- //
- // Passing in a NULL results in a blank space
- //
- ClearLines (Start, End, Index + 1, Index + 1, GetPopupColor ());
- } else if (String[0] == L' ') {
- //
- // Passing in a space results in the assumption that this is where typing will occur
- //
- ClearLines (Start + 1, End - 1, Index + 1, Index + 1, POPUP_INVERSE_TEXT | POPUP_INVERSE_BACKGROUND);
- PrintStringAt (
- ((DimensionsWidth - LibGetStringWidth (String) / 2) / 2) + gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + 1,
- Index + 1,
- String + 1
- );
- } else {
- //
- // This will clear the background of the line - we never know who might have been
- // here before us. This differs from the next clear in that it used the non-reverse
- // video for normal printing.
- //
- ClearLines (Start, End, Index + 1, Index + 1, GetPopupColor ());
- PrintStringAt (
- ((DimensionsWidth - LibGetStringWidth (String) / 2) / 2) + gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + 1,
- Index + 1,
- String
- );
- }
-
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, GetPopupColor ());
- PrintCharAt (Start, Index + 1, Character);
- PrintCharAt (End - 1, Index + 1, Character);
- }
- VA_END (Marker);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_UP_RIGHT;
- PrintCharAt (Start, Bottom - 1, Character);
- Character = BOXDRAW_HORIZONTAL;
- for (Index = Start; Index + 2 < End; Index++) {
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN)-1, (UINTN) -1, Character);
- }
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_UP_LEFT;
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN)-1, (UINTN) -1, Character);
-
- if (Key != NULL) {
- Status = WaitForKeyStroke (&KeyValue);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- CopyMem (Key, &KeyValue, sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY));
- }
-
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, CurrentAttribute);
- gST->ConOut->EnableCursor (gST->ConOut, CursorVisible);
-}
-
-/**
- Confirm how to handle the changed data.
-
- @return Action BROWSER_ACTION_SUBMIT, BROWSER_ACTION_DISCARD or other values.
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-ConfirmDataChange (
- VOID
- )
-{
- CHAR16 YesResponse;
- CHAR16 NoResponse;
- EFI_INPUT_KEY Key;
-
- gST->ConIn->ReadKeyStroke (gST->ConIn, &Key);
-
- YesResponse = gYesResponse[0];
- NoResponse = gNoResponse[0];
-
- //
- // If NV flag is up, prompt user
- //
- do {
- CreateDialog (&Key, gLibEmptyString, gSaveChanges, gAreYouSure, gLibEmptyString, NULL);
- } while
- (
- (Key.ScanCode != SCAN_ESC) &&
- ((Key.UnicodeChar | UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET) != (NoResponse | UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET)) &&
- ((Key.UnicodeChar | UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET) != (YesResponse | UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET))
- );
-
- if (Key.ScanCode == SCAN_ESC) {
- return BROWSER_ACTION_NONE;
- } else if ((Key.UnicodeChar | UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET) == (YesResponse | UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET)) {
- return BROWSER_ACTION_SUBMIT;
- } else {
- return BROWSER_ACTION_DISCARD;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- OEM specifies whether Setup exits Page by ESC key.
-
- This function customized the behavior that whether Setup exits Page so that
- system able to boot when configuration is not changed.
-
- @retval TRUE Exits FrontPage
- @retval FALSE Don't exit FrontPage.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-FormExitPolicy (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE ? FALSE : TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Set Timeout value for a ceratain Form to get user response.
-
- This function allows to set timeout value on a ceratain form if necessary.
- If timeout is not zero, the form will exit if user has no response in timeout.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page
-
- @return 0 No timeout for this form.
- @return > 0 Timeout value in 100 ns units.
-**/
-UINT64
-EFIAPI
-FormExitTimeout (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- )
-{
- return 0;
-}
-//
-// Print Functions
-//
-/**
- Prints a unicode string to the default console, at
- the supplied cursor position, using L"%s" format.
-
- @param Column The cursor position to print the string at. When it is -1, use current Position.
- @param Row The cursor position to print the string at. When it is -1, use current Position.
- @param String String pointer.
-
- @return Length of string printed to the console
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-PrintStringAt (
- IN UINTN Column,
- IN UINTN Row,
- IN CHAR16 *String
- )
-{
- return PrintAt (0, Column, Row, L"%s", String);
-}
-
-/**
- Prints a unicode string to the default console, at
- the supplied cursor position, using L"%s" format.
-
- @param Column The cursor position to print the string at. When it is -1, use current Position.
- @param Row The cursor position to print the string at. When it is -1, use current Position.
- @param String String pointer.
- @param Width Width for String.
-
- @return Length of string printed to the console
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-PrintStringAtWithWidth (
- IN UINTN Column,
- IN UINTN Row,
- IN CHAR16 *String,
- IN UINTN Width
- )
-{
- return PrintAt (Width, Column, Row, L"%s", String);
-}
-
-/**
- Prints a chracter to the default console, at
- the supplied cursor position, using L"%c" format.
-
- @param Column The cursor position to print the string at. When it is -1, use current Position.
- @param Row The cursor position to print the string at. When it is -1, use current Position.
- @param Character Character to print.
-
- @return Length of string printed to the console.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-PrintCharAt (
- IN UINTN Column,
- IN UINTN Row,
- CHAR16 Character
- )
-{
- return PrintAt (0, Column, Row, L"%c", Character);
-}
-
-/**
- Clear retangle with specified text attribute.
-
- @param LeftColumn Left column of retangle.
- @param RightColumn Right column of retangle.
- @param TopRow Start row of retangle.
- @param BottomRow End row of retangle.
- @param TextAttribute The character foreground and background.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ClearLines (
- IN UINTN LeftColumn,
- IN UINTN RightColumn,
- IN UINTN TopRow,
- IN UINTN BottomRow,
- IN UINTN TextAttribute
- )
-{
- CHAR16 *Buffer;
- UINTN Row;
-
- //
- // For now, allocate an arbitrarily long buffer
- //
- Buffer = AllocateZeroPool (0x10000);
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
-
- //
- // Set foreground and background as defined
- //
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, TextAttribute);
-
- //
- // Much faster to buffer the long string instead of print it a character at a time
- //
- LibSetUnicodeMem (Buffer, RightColumn - LeftColumn, L' ');
-
- //
- // Clear the desired area with the appropriate foreground/background
- //
- for (Row = TopRow; Row <= BottomRow; Row++) {
- PrintStringAt (LeftColumn, Row, Buffer);
- }
-
- gST->ConOut->SetCursorPosition (gST->ConOut, LeftColumn, TopRow);
-
- FreePool (Buffer);
-}
-
-//
-// Color Setting Functions
-//
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific popup attribute colors.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for popup color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetPopupColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return POPUP_TEXT | POPUP_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific popup attribute colors.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for popup inverse color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetPopupInverseColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return POPUP_INVERSE_TEXT | POPUP_INVERSE_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific PickList color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for pick list color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetPickListColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return PICKLIST_HIGHLIGHT_TEXT | PICKLIST_HIGHLIGHT_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific arrow color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for arrow color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetArrowColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return ARROW_TEXT | ARROW_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific info text color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for info text color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetInfoTextColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return INFO_TEXT | FIELD_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific help text color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for help text color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetHelpTextColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return HELP_TEXT | FIELD_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific grayed out text color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for grayed out text color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetGrayedTextColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return FIELD_TEXT_GRAYED | FIELD_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific highlighted text color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for highlight text color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetHighlightTextColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return PcdGet8 (PcdBrowserFieldTextHighlightColor) | PcdGet8 (PcdBrowserFieldBackgroundHighlightColor);
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific field text color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for field text color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetFieldTextColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return PcdGet8 (PcdBrowserFieldTextColor) | FIELD_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Get OEM/Vendor specific subtitle text color attribute.
-
- @retval Byte code color setting for subtitle text color.
-**/
-UINT8
-EFIAPI
-GetSubTitleTextColor (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return PcdGet8 (PcdBrowserSubtitleTextColor) | FIELD_BACKGROUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Clear Screen to the initial state.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ClearDisplayPage (
- VOID
- )
-{
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, EFI_TEXT_ATTR (EFI_LIGHTGRAY, EFI_BLACK));
- gST->ConOut->ClearScreen (gST->ConOut);
- gLibIsFirstForm = TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Constructor of Customized Display Library Instance.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-CustomizedDisplayLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- mCDLStringPackHandle = HiiAddPackages (&gCustomizedDisplayLibGuid, ImageHandle, CustomizedDisplayLibStrings, NULL);
- ASSERT (mCDLStringPackHandle != NULL);
-
- InitializeLibStrings();
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Destructor of Customized Display Library Instance.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The destructor completed successfully.
- @retval Other value The destructor did not complete successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-CustomizedDisplayLibDestructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- HiiRemovePackages(mCDLStringPackHandle);
-
- FreeLibStrings ();
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 23528948a3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,65 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Customize display library used by display engine.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2013 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = CustomizedDisplayLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = CustomizedDisplayLibModStrs.uni
- FILE_GUID = 80B92017-EC64-4923-938D-94FAEE85832E
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = CustomizedDisplayLib|DXE_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION
- CONSTRUCTOR = CustomizedDisplayLibConstructor
- DESTRUCTOR = CustomizedDisplayLibDestructor
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- CustomizedDisplayLib.c
- Colors.h
- CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.h
- CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.c
- CustomizedDisplayLib.uni
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- UefiDriverEntryPoint
- UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DebugLib
- PrintLib
- HiiLib
- DevicePathLib
- PcdLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiIfrTianoGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
-
-[Protocols]
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdBrowserSubtitleTextColor ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdBrowserFieldTextColor ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdBrowserFieldTextHighlightColor ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdBrowserFieldBackgroundHighlightColor ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdFrontPageFormSetGuid ## CONSUMES
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 18a5c3b563..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.c deleted file mode 100644 index bc14a9dd76..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,984 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
- This library class defines a set of interfaces to customize Display module
-
-Copyright (c) 2013-2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials are licensed and made available under
-the terms and conditions of the BSD License that accompanies this distribution.
-The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include "CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.h"
-
-EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR gScreenDimensions;
-CHAR16 *mLibUnknownString;
-extern EFI_HII_HANDLE mCDLStringPackHandle;
-CHAR16 *mSpaceBuffer;
-#define SPACE_BUFFER_SIZE 1000
-
-//
-// Browser Global Strings
-//
-CHAR16 *gEnterString;
-CHAR16 *gEnterCommitString;
-CHAR16 *gEnterEscapeString;
-CHAR16 *gEscapeString;
-CHAR16 *gMoveHighlight;
-CHAR16 *gDecNumericInput;
-CHAR16 *gHexNumericInput;
-CHAR16 *gToggleCheckBox;
-CHAR16 *gLibEmptyString;
-CHAR16 *gAreYouSure;
-CHAR16 *gYesResponse;
-CHAR16 *gNoResponse;
-CHAR16 *gPlusString;
-CHAR16 *gMinusString;
-CHAR16 *gAdjustNumber;
-CHAR16 *gSaveChanges;
-CHAR16 *gNvUpdateMessage;
-CHAR16 *gInputErrorMessage;
-
-/**
-
- Print banner info for front page.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page
-
-**/
-VOID
-PrintBannerInfo (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- )
-{
- UINT8 Line;
- UINT8 Alignment;
- CHAR16 *StrFrontPageBanner;
- UINT8 RowIdx;
- UINT8 ColumnIdx;
-
- //
- // ClearLines(0, LocalScreen.RightColumn, 0, BANNER_HEIGHT-1, BANNER_TEXT | BANNER_BACKGROUND);
- //
- ClearLines (
- gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn,
- gScreenDimensions.RightColumn,
- gScreenDimensions.TopRow,
- FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT - 1 + gScreenDimensions.TopRow,
- BANNER_TEXT | BANNER_BACKGROUND
- );
-
- //
- // for (Line = 0; Line < BANNER_HEIGHT; Line++) {
- //
- for (Line = (UINT8) gScreenDimensions.TopRow; Line < BANNER_HEIGHT + (UINT8) gScreenDimensions.TopRow; Line++) {
- //
- // for (Alignment = 0; Alignment < BANNER_COLUMNS; Alignment++) {
- //
- for (Alignment = (UINT8) gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn;
- Alignment < BANNER_COLUMNS + (UINT8) gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn;
- Alignment++
- ) {
- RowIdx = (UINT8) (Line - (UINT8) gScreenDimensions.TopRow);
- ColumnIdx = (UINT8) (Alignment - (UINT8) gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn);
-
- ASSERT (RowIdx < BANNER_HEIGHT && ColumnIdx < BANNER_COLUMNS);
-
- if (gBannerData!= NULL && gBannerData->Banner[RowIdx][ColumnIdx] != 0x0000) {
- StrFrontPageBanner = LibGetToken (gBannerData->Banner[RowIdx][ColumnIdx], FormData->HiiHandle);
- } else {
- continue;
- }
-
- switch (Alignment - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn) {
- case 0:
- //
- // Handle left column
- //
- PrintStringAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + BANNER_LEFT_COLUMN_INDENT, Line, StrFrontPageBanner);
- break;
-
- case 1:
- //
- // Handle center column
- //
- PrintStringAt (
- gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn) / 3,
- Line,
- StrFrontPageBanner
- );
- break;
-
- case 2:
- //
- // Handle right column
- //
- PrintStringAt (
- gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn) * 2 / 3,
- Line,
- StrFrontPageBanner
- );
- break;
- }
-
- FreePool (StrFrontPageBanner);
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Print framework and form title for a page.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page
-**/
-VOID
-PrintFramework (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR16 Character;
- CHAR16 *Buffer;
- UINTN Row;
- CHAR16 *TitleStr;
- UINTN TitleColumn;
-
- if (gClassOfVfr != FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP) {
- //
- // Only Setup page needs Framework
- //
- ClearLines (
- gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn,
- gScreenDimensions.RightColumn,
- gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - gFooterHeight,
- gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - 1,
- KEYHELP_TEXT | KEYHELP_BACKGROUND
- );
- return;
- }
-
- Buffer = AllocateZeroPool (0x10000);
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
- Character = BOXDRAW_HORIZONTAL;
- for (Index = 0; Index + 2 < (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn); Index++) {
- Buffer[Index] = Character;
- }
-
- //
- // Print Top border line
- // +------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
- // ? ?
- // +------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
- //
- gST->ConOut->SetAttribute (gST->ConOut, TITLE_TEXT | TITLE_BACKGROUND);
- Character = BOXDRAW_DOWN_RIGHT;
-
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn, gScreenDimensions.TopRow, Character);
- PrintStringAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Buffer);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_DOWN_LEFT;
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Character);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_VERTICAL;
- for (Row = gScreenDimensions.TopRow + 1; Row <= gScreenDimensions.TopRow + NONE_FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT - 2; Row++) {
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn, Row, Character);
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - 1, Row, Character);
- }
-
- //
- // Print Form Title
- //
- TitleStr = LibGetToken (FormData->FormTitle, FormData->HiiHandle);
- ASSERT (TitleStr != NULL);
- TitleColumn = (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn + gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn - LibGetStringWidth (TitleStr) / 2) / 2;
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn + 1, gScreenDimensions.TopRow + 1, gLibEmptyString, TitleColumn - gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn - 1);
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (
- TitleColumn,
- gScreenDimensions.TopRow + 1,
- TitleStr,
- gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - 1 - TitleColumn
- );
- FreePool (TitleStr);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_UP_RIGHT;
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn, gScreenDimensions.TopRow + NONE_FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT - 1, Character);
- PrintStringAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Buffer);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_UP_LEFT;
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Character);
-
- //
- // Print Bottom border line
- // +------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
- // ? ?
- // +------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
- //
- Character = BOXDRAW_DOWN_RIGHT;
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn, gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - gFooterHeight, Character);
-
- PrintStringAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Buffer);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_DOWN_LEFT;
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Character);
- Character = BOXDRAW_VERTICAL;
- for (Row = gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - gFooterHeight + 1;
- Row <= gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - 2;
- Row++
- ) {
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn, Row, Character);
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.RightColumn - 1, Row, Character);
- }
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_UP_RIGHT;
- PrintCharAt (gScreenDimensions.LeftColumn, gScreenDimensions.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - 1, Character);
-
- PrintStringAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Buffer);
-
- Character = BOXDRAW_UP_LEFT;
- PrintCharAt ((UINTN) -1, (UINTN) -1, Character);
-
- FreePool (Buffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Process some op code which is not recognized by browser core.
-
- @param OpCodeData The pointer to the op code buffer.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS Pass the statement success.
-
-**/
-VOID
-ProcessUserOpcode(
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *OpCodeData
- )
-{
- EFI_GUID * ClassGuid;
- UINT8 ClassGuidNum;
-
- ClassGuid = NULL;
- ClassGuidNum = 0;
-
- switch (OpCodeData->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_FORM_SET_OP:
- //
- // process the statement outside of form,if it is formset op, get its formsetguid or classguid and compared with gFrontPageFormSetGuid
- //
- if (CompareMem (PcdGetPtr (PcdFrontPageFormSetGuid), &((EFI_IFR_FORM_SET *) OpCodeData)->Guid, sizeof (EFI_GUID)) == 0){
- gClassOfVfr = FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE;
- } else{
- ClassGuidNum = (UINT8)(((EFI_IFR_FORM_SET *)OpCodeData)->Flags & 0x3);
- ClassGuid = (EFI_GUID *)(VOID *)((UINT8 *)OpCodeData + sizeof (EFI_IFR_FORM_SET));
- while (ClassGuidNum-- > 0){
- if (CompareGuid((EFI_GUID*)PcdGetPtr (PcdFrontPageFormSetGuid),ClassGuid)){
- gClassOfVfr = FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE;
- break;
- }
- ClassGuid ++;
- }
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_GUID_OP:
- if (CompareGuid (&gEfiIfrTianoGuid, (EFI_GUID *)((CHAR8*) OpCodeData + sizeof (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER)))) {
- //
- // Tiano specific GUIDed opcodes
- //
- switch (((EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL *) OpCodeData)->ExtendOpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_EXTEND_OP_LABEL:
- //
- // just ignore label
- //
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_EXTEND_OP_BANNER:
- //
- // Only in front page form set, we care about the banner data.
- //
- if (gClassOfVfr == FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE) {
- //
- // Initialize Driver private data
- //
- if (gBannerData == NULL) {
- gBannerData = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (BANNER_DATA));
- ASSERT (gBannerData != NULL);
- }
-
- CopyMem (
- &gBannerData->Banner[((EFI_IFR_GUID_BANNER *) OpCodeData)->LineNumber][
- ((EFI_IFR_GUID_BANNER *) OpCodeData)->Alignment],
- &((EFI_IFR_GUID_BANNER *) OpCodeData)->Title,
- sizeof (EFI_STRING_ID)
- );
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_EXTEND_OP_SUBCLASS:
- if (((EFI_IFR_GUID_SUBCLASS *) OpCodeData)->SubClass == EFI_FRONT_PAGE_SUBCLASS) {
- gClassOfVfr = FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE;
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Process some op codes which is out side of current form.
-
- @param FormData Pointer to the form data.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS Pass the statement success.
-
-**/
-VOID
-ProcessExternedOpcode (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- LIST_ENTRY *NestLink;
- FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_STATEMENT *Statement;
- FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_STATEMENT *NestStatement;
-
- Link = GetFirstNode (&FormData->StatementListOSF);
- while (!IsNull (&FormData->StatementListOSF, Link)) {
- Statement = FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_STATEMENT_FROM_LINK (Link);
- Link = GetNextNode (&FormData->StatementListOSF, Link);
-
- ProcessUserOpcode(Statement->OpCode);
- }
-
- Link = GetFirstNode (&FormData->StatementListHead);
- while (!IsNull (&FormData->StatementListHead, Link)) {
- Statement = FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_STATEMENT_FROM_LINK (Link);
- Link = GetNextNode (&FormData->StatementListHead, Link);
-
- ProcessUserOpcode(Statement->OpCode);
-
- NestLink = GetFirstNode (&Statement->NestStatementList);
- while (!IsNull (&Statement->NestStatementList, NestLink)) {
- NestStatement = FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_STATEMENT_FROM_LINK (NestLink);
- NestLink = GetNextNode (&Statement->NestStatementList, NestLink);
-
- ProcessUserOpcode(NestStatement->OpCode);
- }
-
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Validate the input screen diemenstion info.
-
- @param FormData The input form data info.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS The input screen info is acceptable.
- @return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The input screen info is not acceptable.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScreenDiemensionInfoValidate (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // Calculate total number of Register HotKeys.
- //
- Index = 0;
- if (!IsListEmpty (&FormData->HotKeyListHead)){
- Link = GetFirstNode (&FormData->HotKeyListHead);
- while (!IsNull (&FormData->HotKeyListHead, Link)) {
- Link = GetNextNode (&FormData->HotKeyListHead, Link);
- Index ++;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Show three HotKeys help information on one row.
- //
- gFooterHeight = FOOTER_HEIGHT + (Index / 3);
-
-
- ZeroMem (&gScreenDimensions, sizeof (EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR));
- gST->ConOut->QueryMode (
- gST->ConOut,
- gST->ConOut->Mode->Mode,
- &gScreenDimensions.RightColumn,
- &gScreenDimensions.BottomRow
- );
-
- //
- // Check local dimension vs. global dimension.
- //
- if (FormData->ScreenDimensions != NULL) {
- if ((gScreenDimensions.RightColumn < FormData->ScreenDimensions->RightColumn) ||
- (gScreenDimensions.BottomRow < FormData->ScreenDimensions->BottomRow)
- ) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- } else {
- //
- // Local dimension validation.
- //
- if ((FormData->ScreenDimensions->RightColumn > FormData->ScreenDimensions->LeftColumn) &&
- (FormData->ScreenDimensions->BottomRow > FormData->ScreenDimensions->TopRow) &&
- ((FormData->ScreenDimensions->RightColumn - FormData->ScreenDimensions->LeftColumn) > 2) &&
- ((FormData->ScreenDimensions->BottomRow - FormData->ScreenDimensions->TopRow) > STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT +
- FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT + gFooterHeight + 3)) {
- CopyMem (&gScreenDimensions, (VOID *) FormData->ScreenDimensions, sizeof (EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR));
- } else {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the string based on the StringId and HII Package List Handle.
-
- @param Token The String's ID.
- @param HiiHandle The package list in the HII database to search for
- the specified string.
-
- @return The output string.
-
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-LibGetToken (
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Token,
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING String;
-
- String = HiiGetString (HiiHandle, Token, NULL);
- if (String == NULL) {
- String = AllocateCopyPool (StrSize (mLibUnknownString), mLibUnknownString);
- ASSERT (String != NULL);
- }
-
- return (CHAR16 *) String;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Count the storage space of a Unicode string.
-
- This function handles the Unicode string with NARROW_CHAR
- and WIDE_CHAR control characters. NARROW_HCAR and WIDE_CHAR
- does not count in the resultant output. If a WIDE_CHAR is
- hit, then 2 Unicode character will consume an output storage
- space with size of CHAR16 till a NARROW_CHAR is hit.
-
- If String is NULL, then ASSERT ().
-
- @param String The input string to be counted.
-
- @return Storage space for the input string.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-LibGetStringWidth (
- IN CHAR16 *String
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Count;
- UINTN IncrementValue;
-
- ASSERT (String != NULL);
- if (String == NULL) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- Index = 0;
- Count = 0;
- IncrementValue = 1;
-
- do {
- //
- // Advance to the null-terminator or to the first width directive
- //
- for (;
- (String[Index] != NARROW_CHAR) && (String[Index] != WIDE_CHAR) && (String[Index] != 0);
- Index++, Count = Count + IncrementValue
- )
- ;
-
- //
- // We hit the null-terminator, we now have a count
- //
- if (String[Index] == 0) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // We encountered a narrow directive - strip it from the size calculation since it doesn't get printed
- // and also set the flag that determines what we increment by.(if narrow, increment by 1, if wide increment by 2)
- //
- if (String[Index] == NARROW_CHAR) {
- //
- // Skip to the next character
- //
- Index++;
- IncrementValue = 1;
- } else {
- //
- // Skip to the next character
- //
- Index++;
- IncrementValue = 2;
- }
- } while (String[Index] != 0);
-
- //
- // Increment by one to include the null-terminator in the size
- //
- Count++;
-
- return Count * sizeof (CHAR16);
-}
-
-/**
- Show all registered HotKey help strings on bottom Rows.
-
- @param FormData The curent input form data info.
- @param SetState Set HotKey or Clear HotKey
-
-**/
-VOID
-PrintHotKeyHelpString (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData,
- IN BOOLEAN SetState
- )
-{
- UINTN CurrentCol;
- UINTN CurrentRow;
- UINTN BottomRowOfHotKeyHelp;
- UINTN ColumnIndexWidth;
- UINTN ColumnWidth;
- UINTN ColumnIndex;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR LocalScreen;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- BROWSER_HOT_KEY *HotKey;
- CHAR16 BakChar;
- CHAR16 *ColumnStr;
-
- CopyMem (&LocalScreen, &gScreenDimensions, sizeof (EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR));
- ColumnWidth = (LocalScreen.RightColumn - LocalScreen.LeftColumn) / 3;
- BottomRowOfHotKeyHelp = LocalScreen.BottomRow - STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT - 3;
- ColumnStr = gLibEmptyString;
-
- //
- // Calculate total number of Register HotKeys.
- //
- Index = 0;
- Link = GetFirstNode (&FormData->HotKeyListHead);
- while (!IsNull (&FormData->HotKeyListHead, Link)) {
- HotKey = BROWSER_HOT_KEY_FROM_LINK (Link);
- //
- // Calculate help information Column and Row.
- //
- ColumnIndex = Index % 3;
- if (ColumnIndex == 0) {
- CurrentCol = LocalScreen.LeftColumn + 2 * ColumnWidth;
- ColumnIndexWidth = ColumnWidth - 1;
- } else if (ColumnIndex == 1) {
- CurrentCol = LocalScreen.LeftColumn + ColumnWidth;
- ColumnIndexWidth = ColumnWidth;
- } else {
- CurrentCol = LocalScreen.LeftColumn + 2;
- ColumnIndexWidth = ColumnWidth - 2;
- }
- CurrentRow = BottomRowOfHotKeyHelp - Index / 3;
-
- //
- // Help string can't exceed ColumnWidth. One Row will show three Help information.
- //
- BakChar = L'\0';
- if (StrLen (HotKey->HelpString) > ColumnIndexWidth) {
- BakChar = HotKey->HelpString[ColumnIndexWidth];
- HotKey->HelpString[ColumnIndexWidth] = L'\0';
- }
-
- //
- // Print HotKey help string on bottom Row.
- //
- if (SetState) {
- ColumnStr = HotKey->HelpString;
- }
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (CurrentCol, CurrentRow, ColumnStr, ColumnIndexWidth);
-
- if (BakChar != L'\0') {
- HotKey->HelpString[ColumnIndexWidth] = BakChar;
- }
- //
- // Get Next Hot Key.
- //
- Link = GetNextNode (&FormData->HotKeyListHead, Link);
- Index ++;
- }
-
- if (SetState) {
- //
- // Clear KeyHelp
- //
- CurrentRow = BottomRowOfHotKeyHelp - Index / 3;
- ColumnIndex = Index % 3;
- if (ColumnIndex == 0) {
- CurrentCol = LocalScreen.LeftColumn + 2 * ColumnWidth;
- ColumnIndexWidth = ColumnWidth - 1;
- ColumnIndex ++;
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (CurrentCol, CurrentRow, gLibEmptyString, ColumnIndexWidth);
- }
- if (ColumnIndex == 1) {
- CurrentCol = LocalScreen.LeftColumn + ColumnWidth;
- ColumnIndexWidth = ColumnWidth;
- PrintStringAtWithWidth (CurrentCol, CurrentRow, gLibEmptyString, ColumnIndexWidth);
- }
- }
-
- return;
-}
-
-/**
- Get step info from numeric opcode.
-
- @param[in] OpCode The input numeric op code.
-
- @return step info for this opcode.
-**/
-UINT64
-LibGetFieldFromNum (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *OpCode
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *NumericOp;
- UINT64 Step;
-
- NumericOp = (EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *) OpCode;
-
- switch (NumericOp->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE) {
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_1:
- Step = NumericOp->data.u8.Step;
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_2:
- Step = NumericOp->data.u16.Step;
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_4:
- Step = NumericOp->data.u32.Step;
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_8:
- Step = NumericOp->data.u64.Step;
- break;
-
- default:
- Step = 0;
- break;
- }
-
- return Step;
-}
-
-/**
- Initialize the HII String Token to the correct values.
-
-**/
-VOID
-InitializeLibStrings (
- VOID
- )
-{
- mLibUnknownString = L"!";
-
- gEnterString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ENTER_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gEnterCommitString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ENTER_COMMIT_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gEnterEscapeString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ENTER_ESCAPE_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gEscapeString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ESCAPE_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gMoveHighlight = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (MOVE_HIGHLIGHT), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gDecNumericInput = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (DEC_NUMERIC_INPUT), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gHexNumericInput = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (HEX_NUMERIC_INPUT), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gToggleCheckBox = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (TOGGLE_CHECK_BOX), mCDLStringPackHandle);
-
- gAreYouSure = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ARE_YOU_SURE), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gYesResponse = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ARE_YOU_SURE_YES), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gNoResponse = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ARE_YOU_SURE_NO), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gPlusString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (PLUS_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gMinusString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (MINUS_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gAdjustNumber = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (ADJUST_NUMBER), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gSaveChanges = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (SAVE_CHANGES), mCDLStringPackHandle);
-
- gLibEmptyString = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (EMPTY_STRING), mCDLStringPackHandle);
-
- gNvUpdateMessage = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (NV_UPDATE_MESSAGE), mCDLStringPackHandle);
- gInputErrorMessage = LibGetToken (STRING_TOKEN (INPUT_ERROR_MESSAGE), mCDLStringPackHandle);
-
- //
- // SpaceBuffer;
- //
- mSpaceBuffer = AllocatePool ((SPACE_BUFFER_SIZE + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16));
- ASSERT (mSpaceBuffer != NULL);
- LibSetUnicodeMem (mSpaceBuffer, SPACE_BUFFER_SIZE, L' ');
- mSpaceBuffer[SPACE_BUFFER_SIZE] = L'\0';
-}
-
-
-/**
- Free the HII String.
-
-**/
-VOID
-FreeLibStrings (
- VOID
- )
-{
- FreePool (gEnterString);
- FreePool (gEnterCommitString);
- FreePool (gEnterEscapeString);
- FreePool (gEscapeString);
- FreePool (gMoveHighlight);
- FreePool (gDecNumericInput);
- FreePool (gHexNumericInput);
- FreePool (gToggleCheckBox);
-
- FreePool (gAreYouSure);
- FreePool (gYesResponse);
- FreePool (gNoResponse);
- FreePool (gPlusString);
- FreePool (gMinusString);
- FreePool (gAdjustNumber);
- FreePool (gSaveChanges);
-
- FreePool (gLibEmptyString);
-
- FreePool (gNvUpdateMessage);
- FreePool (gInputErrorMessage);
-
- FreePool (mSpaceBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Wait for a key to be pressed by user.
-
- @param Key The key which is pressed by user.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The function always completed successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-WaitForKeyStroke (
- OUT EFI_INPUT_KEY *Key
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
-
- while (TRUE) {
- Status = gST->ConIn->ReadKeyStroke (gST->ConIn, Key);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- break;
- }
-
- if (Status != EFI_NOT_READY) {
- continue;
- }
-
- gBS->WaitForEvent (1, &gST->ConIn->WaitForKey, &Index);
- }
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Set Buffer to Value for Size bytes.
-
- @param Buffer Memory to set.
- @param Size Number of bytes to set
- @param Value Value of the set operation.
-
-**/
-VOID
-LibSetUnicodeMem (
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Size,
- IN CHAR16 Value
- )
-{
- CHAR16 *Ptr;
-
- Ptr = Buffer;
- while ((Size--) != 0) {
- *(Ptr++) = Value;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- The internal function prints to the EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL
- protocol instance.
-
- @param Width Width of string to be print.
- @param Column The position of the output string.
- @param Row The position of the output string.
- @param Out The EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL instance.
- @param Fmt The format string.
- @param Args The additional argument for the variables in the format string.
-
- @return Number of Unicode character printed.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-PrintInternal (
- IN UINTN Width,
- IN UINTN Column,
- IN UINTN Row,
- IN EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL *Out,
- IN CHAR16 *Fmt,
- IN VA_LIST Args
- )
-{
- CHAR16 *Buffer;
- CHAR16 *BackupBuffer;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN PreviousIndex;
- UINTN Count;
- UINTN TotalCount;
- UINTN PrintWidth;
- UINTN CharWidth;
-
- //
- // For now, allocate an arbitrarily long buffer
- //
- Buffer = AllocateZeroPool (0x10000);
- BackupBuffer = AllocateZeroPool (0x10000);
- ASSERT (Buffer);
- ASSERT (BackupBuffer);
-
- if (Column != (UINTN) -1) {
- Out->SetCursorPosition (Out, Column, Row);
- }
-
- UnicodeVSPrint (Buffer, 0x10000, Fmt, Args);
-
- Out->Mode->Attribute = Out->Mode->Attribute & 0x7f;
-
- Out->SetAttribute (Out, Out->Mode->Attribute);
-
- Index = 0;
- PreviousIndex = 0;
- Count = 0;
- TotalCount = 0;
- PrintWidth = 0;
- CharWidth = 1;
-
- do {
- for (; (Buffer[Index] != NARROW_CHAR) && (Buffer[Index] != WIDE_CHAR) && (Buffer[Index] != 0); Index++) {
- BackupBuffer[Index] = Buffer[Index];
- }
-
- if (Buffer[Index] == 0) {
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Print this out, we are about to switch widths
- //
- Out->OutputString (Out, &BackupBuffer[PreviousIndex]);
- Count = StrLen (&BackupBuffer[PreviousIndex]);
- PrintWidth += Count * CharWidth;
- TotalCount += Count;
-
- //
- // Preserve the current index + 1, since this is where we will start printing from next
- //
- PreviousIndex = Index + 1;
-
- //
- // We are at a narrow or wide character directive. Set attributes and strip it and print it
- //
- if (Buffer[Index] == NARROW_CHAR) {
- //
- // Preserve bits 0 - 6 and zero out the rest
- //
- Out->Mode->Attribute = Out->Mode->Attribute & 0x7f;
- Out->SetAttribute (Out, Out->Mode->Attribute);
- CharWidth = 1;
- } else {
- //
- // Must be wide, set bit 7 ON
- //
- Out->Mode->Attribute = Out->Mode->Attribute | EFI_WIDE_ATTRIBUTE;
- Out->SetAttribute (Out, Out->Mode->Attribute);
- CharWidth = 2;
- }
-
- Index++;
-
- } while (Buffer[Index] != 0);
-
- //
- // We hit the end of the string - print it
- //
- Out->OutputString (Out, &BackupBuffer[PreviousIndex]);
- Count = StrLen (&BackupBuffer[PreviousIndex]);
- PrintWidth += Count * CharWidth;
- TotalCount += Count;
- if (PrintWidth < Width) {
- Out->Mode->Attribute = Out->Mode->Attribute & 0x7f;
- Out->SetAttribute (Out, Out->Mode->Attribute);
- Out->OutputString (Out, &mSpaceBuffer[SPACE_BUFFER_SIZE - Width + PrintWidth]);
- }
-
- FreePool (Buffer);
- FreePool (BackupBuffer);
- return TotalCount;
-}
-
-/**
- Prints a formatted unicode string to the default console, at
- the supplied cursor position.
-
- @param Width Width of String to be printed.
- @param Column The cursor position to print the string at.
- @param Row The cursor position to print the string at.
- @param Fmt Format string.
- @param ... Variable argument list for format string.
-
- @return Length of string printed to the console
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-PrintAt (
- IN UINTN Width,
- IN UINTN Column,
- IN UINTN Row,
- IN CHAR16 *Fmt,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Args;
- UINTN LengthOfPrinted;
-
- VA_START (Args, Fmt);
- LengthOfPrinted = PrintInternal (Width, Column, Row, gST->ConOut, Fmt, Args);
- VA_END (Args);
- return LengthOfPrinted;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.h deleted file mode 100644 index 7342b508b0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibInternal.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,297 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
- This library class defines a set of interfaces to customize Display module
-
-Copyright (c) 2013, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials are licensed and made available under
-the terms and conditions of the BSD License that accompanies this distribution.
-The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef __CUSTOMIZED_DISPLAY_LIB_INTERNAL_H__
-#define __CUSTOMIZED_DISPLAY_LIB_INTERNAL_H__
-
-
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/SimpleTextOut.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleTextIn.h>
-#include <Protocol/FormBrowser2.h>
-#include <Protocol/FormBrowserEx2.h>
-#include <Protocol/DisplayProtocol.h>
-#include <Protocol/DevicePath.h>
-#include <Protocol/UnicodeCollation.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiConfigAccess.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiConfigRouting.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiDatabase.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiString.h>
-#include <Protocol/UserManager.h>
-#include <Protocol/DevicePathFromText.h>
-
-#include <Guid/MdeModuleHii.h>
-#include <Guid/HiiPlatformSetupFormset.h>
-#include <Guid/HiiFormMapMethodGuid.h>
-
-#include <Library/PrintLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiDriverEntryPoint.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/HiiLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-#include <Library/CustomizedDisplayLib.h>
-
-#include "Colors.h"
-
-
-
-#define FORMSET_CLASS_PLATFORM_SETUP 0x0001
-#define FORMSET_CLASS_FRONT_PAGE 0x0002
-
-
-#define FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT 6
-#define NONE_FRONT_PAGE_HEADER_HEIGHT 3
-#define FOOTER_HEIGHT 4
-#define STATUS_BAR_HEIGHT 1
-
-//
-// Screen definitions
-//
-#define BANNER_HEIGHT 6
-#define BANNER_COLUMNS 3
-#define BANNER_LEFT_COLUMN_INDENT 1
-
-//
-// Character definitions
-//
-#define UPPER_LOWER_CASE_OFFSET 0x20
-
-//
-// This is the Input Error Message
-//
-#define INPUT_ERROR 1
-
-//
-// This is the NV RAM update required Message
-//
-#define NV_UPDATE_REQUIRED 2
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_STRING_ID Banner[BANNER_HEIGHT][BANNER_COLUMNS];
-} BANNER_DATA;
-
-extern UINT16 gClassOfVfr; // Formset class information
-extern BANNER_DATA *gBannerData;
-extern EFI_SCREEN_DESCRIPTOR gScreenDimensions;
-extern UINTN gFooterHeight;
-
-//
-// Browser Global Strings
-//
-extern CHAR16 *gEnterString;
-extern CHAR16 *gEnterCommitString;
-extern CHAR16 *gEnterEscapeString;
-extern CHAR16 *gEscapeString;
-extern CHAR16 *gMoveHighlight;
-extern CHAR16 *gDecNumericInput;
-extern CHAR16 *gHexNumericInput;
-extern CHAR16 *gToggleCheckBox;
-extern CHAR16 *gLibEmptyString;
-extern CHAR16 *gAreYouSure;
-extern CHAR16 *gYesResponse;
-extern CHAR16 *gNoResponse;
-extern CHAR16 *gPlusString;
-extern CHAR16 *gMinusString;
-extern CHAR16 *gAdjustNumber;
-extern CHAR16 *gSaveChanges;
-extern CHAR16 *gNvUpdateMessage;
-extern CHAR16 *gInputErrorMessage;
-/**
-
- Print banner info for front page.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page
-
-**/
-VOID
-PrintBannerInfo (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- );
-
-/**
- Print framework and form title for a page.
-
- @param[in] FormData Form Data to be shown in Page
-**/
-VOID
-PrintFramework (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- );
-
-/**
- Validate the input screen diemenstion info.
-
- @param FormData The input form data info.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS The input screen info is acceptable.
- @return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The input screen info is not acceptable.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScreenDiemensionInfoValidate (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- );
-
-/**
- Get the string based on the StringId and HII Package List Handle.
-
- @param Token The String's ID.
- @param HiiHandle The package list in the HII database to search for
- the specified string.
-
- @return The output string.
-
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-LibGetToken (
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Token,
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle
- );
-
-/**
- Count the storage space of a Unicode string.
-
- This function handles the Unicode string with NARROW_CHAR
- and WIDE_CHAR control characters. NARROW_HCAR and WIDE_CHAR
- does not count in the resultant output. If a WIDE_CHAR is
- hit, then 2 Unicode character will consume an output storage
- space with size of CHAR16 till a NARROW_CHAR is hit.
-
- If String is NULL, then ASSERT ().
-
- @param String The input string to be counted.
-
- @return Storage space for the input string.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-LibGetStringWidth (
- IN CHAR16 *String
- );
-
-/**
- Show all registered HotKey help strings on bottom Rows.
-
- @param FormData The curent input form data info.
- @param SetState Set HotKey or Clear HotKey
-
-**/
-VOID
-PrintHotKeyHelpString (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData,
- IN BOOLEAN SetState
- );
-
-/**
- Get step info from numeric opcode.
-
- @param[in] OpCode The input numeric op code.
-
- @return step info for this opcode.
-**/
-UINT64
-LibGetFieldFromNum (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *OpCode
- );
-
-/**
- Initialize the HII String Token to the correct values.
-
-**/
-VOID
-InitializeLibStrings (
- VOID
- );
-
-/**
- Free the HII String.
-
-**/
-VOID
-FreeLibStrings (
- VOID
- );
-
-/**
- Wait for a key to be pressed by user.
-
- @param Key The key which is pressed by user.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The function always completed successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-WaitForKeyStroke (
- OUT EFI_INPUT_KEY *Key
- );
-
-/**
- Set Buffer to Value for Size bytes.
-
- @param Buffer Memory to set.
- @param Size Number of bytes to set
- @param Value Value of the set operation.
-
-**/
-VOID
-LibSetUnicodeMem (
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Size,
- IN CHAR16 Value
- );
-
-/**
- Prints a formatted unicode string to the default console, at
- the supplied cursor position.
-
- @param Width Width of String to be printed.
- @param Column The cursor position to print the string at.
- @param Row The cursor position to print the string at.
- @param Fmt Format string.
- @param ... Variable argument list for format string.
-
- @return Length of string printed to the console
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-PrintAt (
- IN UINTN Width,
- IN UINTN Column,
- IN UINTN Row,
- IN CHAR16 *Fmt,
- ...
- );
-
-/**
- Process some op codes which is out side of current form.
-
- @param FormData Pointer to the form data.
-
-**/
-VOID
-ProcessExternedOpcode (
- IN FORM_DISPLAY_ENGINE_FORM *FormData
- );
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibModStrs.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibModStrs.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 64046df4c0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/CustomizedDisplayLib/CustomizedDisplayLibModStrs.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 09e1366189..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,72 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Debug Agent library implementition with empty functions.
-
- Copyright (c) 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/DebugAgentLib.h>
-
-/**
- Initialize debug agent.
-
- This function is used to set up debug environment to support source level debugging.
- If certain Debug Agent Library instance has to save some private data in the stack,
- this function must work on the mode that doesn't return to the caller, then
- the caller needs to wrap up all rest of logic after InitializeDebugAgent() into one
- function and pass it into InitializeDebugAgent(). InitializeDebugAgent() is
- responsible to invoke the passing-in function at the end of InitializeDebugAgent().
-
- If the parameter Function is not NULL, Debug Agent Libary instance will invoke it by
- passing in the Context to be its parameter.
-
- If Function() is NULL, Debug Agent Library instance will return after setup debug
- environment.
-
- @param[in] InitFlag Init flag is used to decide the initialize process.
- @param[in] Context Context needed according to InitFlag; it was optional.
- @param[in] Function Continue function called by debug agent library; it was
- optional.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-InitializeDebugAgent (
- IN UINT32 InitFlag,
- IN VOID *Context, OPTIONAL
- IN DEBUG_AGENT_CONTINUE Function OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- if (Function != NULL) {
- Function (Context);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Enable/Disable the interrupt of debug timer and return the interrupt state
- prior to the operation.
-
- If EnableStatus is TRUE, enable the interrupt of debug timer.
- If EnableStatus is FALSE, disable the interrupt of debug timer.
-
- @param[in] EnableStatus Enable/Disable.
-
- @return FALSE always.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-SaveAndSetDebugTimerInterrupt (
- IN BOOLEAN EnableStatus
- )
-{
- return FALSE;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index ce1eab2623..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,36 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null instance of Debug Agent Library with empty functions.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DebugAgentLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DebugAgentLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 4904B42F-9FC0-4c2e-BB3F-A2AB35123530
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = DebugAgentLib
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources.common]
- DebugAgentLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 797c0f4076..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DebugAgentLibNull/DebugAgentLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index fb5c25536f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,51 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null Dxe Capsule Library instance does nothing and returns unsupport status.
-
-Copyright (c) 2007 - 2008, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include <Uefi.h>
-#include <Library/CapsuleLib.h>
-
-/**
- The firmware checks whether the capsule image is supported
- by the CapsuleGuid in CapsuleHeader or other specific information in capsule image.
-
- @param CapsuleHeader Point to the UEFI capsule image to be checked.
-
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Input capsule is not supported by the firmware.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SupportCapsuleImage (
- IN EFI_CAPSULE_HEADER *CapsuleHeader
- )
-{
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-/**
- The firmware specific implementation processes the capsule image
- if it recognized the format of this capsule image.
-
- @param CapsuleHeader Point to the UEFI capsule image to be processed.
-
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Capsule image is not supported by the firmware.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ProcessCapsuleImage (
- IN EFI_CAPSULE_HEADER *CapsuleHeader
- )
-{
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index b836607aae..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,38 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# NULL Dxe Capsule library instance.
-# It can make core modules pass package level build.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeCapsuleLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeCapsuleLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 4004de5a-09a5-4f0c-94d7-82322e096aa7
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = CapsuleLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeCapsuleLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index f669eccc71..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCapsuleLibNull/DxeCapsuleLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 0747f6e697..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,46 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Memory Allocation Library instance dedicated to DXE Core.
-# The implementation borrows the DxeCore Memory Allocation services as the primitive
-# for memory allocation instead of using UEFI boot servces in an indirect way.
-# It is assumed that this library instance must be linked with DxeCore in this package.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2008 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 632F3FAC-1CA4-4725-BAA2-BDECCF9A111C
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_CORE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = MemoryAllocationLib|DXE_CORE
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- MemoryAllocationLib.c
- DxeCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
-
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 6fffafc5ed..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h deleted file mode 100644 index 04ad3d6da3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,106 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Contains function prototypes for Memory Services in DxeCore.
-
- This header file borrows the DxeCore Memory Allocation services as the primitive
- for memory allocation.
-
- Copyright (c) 2008, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _DXE_CORE_MEMORY_ALLOCATION_SERVICES_H_
-#define _DXE_CORE_MEMORY_ALLOCATION_SERVICES_H_
-
-
-/**
- Allocates pages from the memory map.
-
- @param Type The type of allocation to perform
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to turn the allocated pages
- into
- @param NumberOfPages The number of pages to allocate
- @param Memory A pointer to receive the base allocated memory
- address
-
- @return Status. On success, Memory is filled in with the base address allocated
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Parameters violate checking rules defined in
- spec.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Could not allocate pages match the requirement.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough pages to allocate.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Pages successfully allocated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-CoreAllocatePages (
- IN EFI_ALLOCATE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN NumberOfPages,
- IN OUT EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS *Memory
- );
-
-
-
-/**
- Frees previous allocated pages.
-
- @param Memory Base address of memory being freed
- @param NumberOfPages The number of pages to free
-
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Could not find the entry that covers the range
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Address not aligned
- @return EFI_SUCCESS -Pages successfully freed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-CoreFreePages (
- IN EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Memory,
- IN UINTN NumberOfPages
- );
-
-
-/**
- Allocate pool of a particular type.
-
- @param PoolType Type of pool to allocate
- @param Size The amount of pool to allocate
- @param Buffer The address to return a pointer to the allocated
- pool
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER PoolType not valid
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Size exceeds max pool size or allocation failed.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Pool successfully allocated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-CoreAllocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN Size,
- OUT VOID **Buffer
- );
-
-/**
- Frees pool.
-
- @param Buffer The allocated pool entry to free
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Buffer is not a valid value.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Pool successfully freed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-CoreFreePool (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- );
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/MemoryAllocationLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/MemoryAllocationLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index d7d9ff311e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCoreMemoryAllocationLib/MemoryAllocationLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,823 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Support routines for memory allocation routines based
- on boot services for Dxe phase drivers.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include "DxeCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h"
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of a certain memory type.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of a certain memory type and returns a pointer to the allocated
- buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL is returned.
- If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocatePages (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Memory;
-
- if (Pages == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = CoreAllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, MemoryType, Pages, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- return (VOID *) (UINTN) Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of type EfiBootServicesData and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL
- is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is
- returned.
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocatePages (
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePages (EfiBootServicesData, Pages);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL
- is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is
- returned.
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimePages (
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePages (EfiRuntimeServicesData, Pages);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL
- is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is
- returned.
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedPages (
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePages (EfiReservedMemoryType, Pages);
-}
-
-/**
- Frees one or more 4KB pages that were previously allocated with one of the page allocation
- functions in the Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages from the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer
- must have been allocated on a previous call to the page allocation services of the Memory
- Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free allocated pages, then this function will
- perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with a page allocation function in the Memory Allocation Library,
- then ASSERT().
- If Pages is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer of pages to free.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-FreePages (
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (Pages != 0);
- Status = CoreFreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer, Pages);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of a certain memory type at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of a certain memory type with an alignment
- specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is returned.
- If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the request, then
- NULL is returned.
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocateAlignedPages (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Memory;
- UINTN AlignedMemory;
- UINTN AlignmentMask;
- UINTN UnalignedPages;
- UINTN RealPages;
-
- //
- // Alignment must be a power of two or zero.
- //
- ASSERT ((Alignment & (Alignment - 1)) == 0);
-
- if (Pages == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
- if (Alignment > EFI_PAGE_SIZE) {
- //
- // Calculate the total number of pages since alignment is larger than page size.
- //
- AlignmentMask = Alignment - 1;
- RealPages = Pages + EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment);
- //
- // Make sure that Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) does not overflow.
- //
- ASSERT (RealPages > Pages);
-
- Status = CoreAllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, MemoryType, RealPages, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- AlignedMemory = ((UINTN) Memory + AlignmentMask) & ~AlignmentMask;
- UnalignedPages = EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (AlignedMemory - (UINTN) Memory);
- if (UnalignedPages > 0) {
- //
- // Free first unaligned page(s).
- //
- Status = CoreFreePages (Memory, UnalignedPages);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- Memory = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (AlignedMemory + EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE (Pages));
- UnalignedPages = RealPages - Pages - UnalignedPages;
- if (UnalignedPages > 0) {
- //
- // Free last unaligned page(s).
- //
- Status = CoreFreePages (Memory, UnalignedPages);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Do not over-allocate pages in this case.
- //
- Status = CoreAllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, MemoryType, Pages, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- AlignedMemory = (UINTN) Memory;
- }
- return (VOID *) AlignedMemory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiBootServicesData at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of type EfiBootServicesData with an
- alignment specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is
- returned. If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateAlignedPages (
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateAlignedPages (EfiBootServicesData, Pages, Alignment);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData with an
- alignment specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is
- returned. If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateAlignedRuntimePages (
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateAlignedPages (EfiRuntimeServicesData, Pages, Alignment);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType with an
- alignment specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is
- returned. If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateAlignedReservedPages (
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateAlignedPages (EfiReservedMemoryType, Pages, Alignment);
-}
-
-/**
- Frees one or more 4KB pages that were previously allocated with one of the aligned page
- allocation functions in the Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages from the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer
- must have been allocated on a previous call to the aligned page allocation services of the Memory
- Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free allocated pages, then this function will
- perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with an aligned page allocation function in the Memory Allocation
- Library, then ASSERT().
- If Pages is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer of pages to free.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-FreeAlignedPages (
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (Pages != 0);
- Status = CoreFreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer, Pages);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type and returns a
- pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VOID *Memory;
-
- Memory = NULL;
-
- Status = CoreAllocatePool (MemoryType, AllocationSize, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Memory = NULL;
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiBootServicesData and returns a
- pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocatePool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePool (EfiBootServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData and returns
- a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimePool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiReservedMemoryType and returns
- a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePool (EfiReservedMemoryType, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type, clears the buffer
- with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid
- buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request,
- then NULL is returned.
-
- @param PoolType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocateZeroPool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- VOID *Memory;
-
- Memory = InternalAllocatePool (PoolType, AllocationSize);
- if (Memory != NULL) {
- Memory = ZeroMem (Memory, AllocationSize);
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiBootServicesData, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateZeroPool (EfiBootServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimeZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateZeroPool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiReservedMemoryType, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateZeroPool (EfiReservedMemoryType, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param PoolType The type of pool to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocateCopyPool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- VOID *Memory;
-
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
- ASSERT (AllocationSize <= (MAX_ADDRESS - (UINTN) Buffer + 1));
-
- Memory = InternalAllocatePool (PoolType, AllocationSize);
- if (Memory != NULL) {
- Memory = CopyMem (Memory, Buffer, AllocationSize);
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiBootServicesData, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateCopyPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateCopyPool (EfiBootServicesData, AllocationSize, Buffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimeCopyPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateCopyPool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize, Buffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiReservedMemoryType, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedCopyPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateCopyPool (EfiReservedMemoryType, AllocationSize, Buffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of a specified memory type.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of the type
- specified by PoolType. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param PoolType The type of pool to allocate.
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalReallocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- VOID *NewBuffer;
-
- NewBuffer = InternalAllocateZeroPool (PoolType, NewSize);
- if (NewBuffer != NULL && OldBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (NewBuffer, OldBuffer, MIN (OldSize, NewSize));
- FreePool (OldBuffer);
- }
- return NewBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiBootServicesData. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-ReallocatePool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return InternalReallocatePool (EfiBootServicesData, OldSize, NewSize, OldBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiRuntimeServicesData. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-ReallocateRuntimePool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return InternalReallocatePool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, OldSize, NewSize, OldBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiReservedMemoryType. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-ReallocateReservedPool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return InternalReallocatePool (EfiReservedMemoryType, OldSize, NewSize, OldBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Frees a buffer that was previously allocated with one of the pool allocation functions in the
- Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer must have been allocated on a previous call to the
- pool allocation services of the Memory Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free pool
- resources, then this function will perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with a pool allocation function in the Memory Allocation Library,
- then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-FreePool (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = CoreFreePool (Buffer);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 0eb8e579d7..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,847 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Performance library instance mainly used by DxeCore.
-
- This library provides the performance measurement interfaces and initializes performance
- logging for DXE phase. It first initializes its private global data structure for
- performance logging and saves the performance GUIDed HOB passed from PEI phase.
- It initializes DXE phase performance logging by publishing the Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol,
- which are consumed by DxePerformanceLib to logging performance data in DXE phase.
-
- This library is mainly used by DxeCore to start performance logging to ensure that
- Performance Protocol is installed at the very beginning of DXE phase.
-
-Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include "DxeCorePerformanceLibInternal.h"
-
-
-//
-// The data structure to hold global performance data.
-//
-GAUGE_DATA_HEADER *mGaugeData;
-
-//
-// The current maximum number of logging entries. If current number of
-// entries exceeds this value, it will re-allocate a larger array and
-// migration the old data to the larger array.
-//
-UINT32 mMaxGaugeRecords;
-
-//
-// The handle to install Performance Protocol instance.
-//
-EFI_HANDLE mHandle = NULL;
-
-//
-// Interfaces for Performance Protocol.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL mPerformanceInterface = {
- StartGauge,
- EndGauge,
- GetGauge
- };
-
-//
-// Interfaces for PerformanceEx Protocol.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL mPerformanceExInterface = {
- StartGaugeEx,
- EndGaugeEx,
- GetGaugeEx
- };
-
-/**
- Searches in the gauge array with keyword Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
-
- This internal function searches for the gauge entry in the gauge array.
- If there is an entry that exactly matches the given keywords
- and its end time stamp is zero, then the index of that gauge entry is returned;
- otherwise, the the number of gauge entries in the array is returned.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier.
-
- @retval The index of gauge entry in the array.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-InternalSearchForGaugeEntry (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Index2;
- UINT32 NumberOfEntries;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
-
- if (Token == NULL) {
- Token = "";
- }
- if (Module == NULL) {
- Module = "";
- }
-
- NumberOfEntries = mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries;
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- Index2 = 0;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- Index2 = NumberOfEntries - 1 - Index;
- if (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].EndTimeStamp == 0 &&
- (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Handle == (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Handle) &&
- AsciiStrnCmp (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Token, Token, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH) == 0 &&
- AsciiStrnCmp (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Module, Module, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH) == 0 &&
- (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Identifier == Identifier)) {
- Index = Index2;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- return Index;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINTN GaugeDataSize;
- GAUGE_DATA_HEADER *NewGaugeData;
- UINTN OldGaugeDataSize;
- GAUGE_DATA_HEADER *OldGaugeData;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- Index = mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries;
- if (Index >= mMaxGaugeRecords) {
- //
- // Try to enlarge the scale of gauge array.
- //
- OldGaugeData = mGaugeData;
- OldGaugeDataSize = sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_HEADER) + sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX) * mMaxGaugeRecords;
-
- GaugeDataSize = sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_HEADER) + sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX) * mMaxGaugeRecords * 2;
-
- NewGaugeData = AllocateZeroPool (GaugeDataSize);
- if (NewGaugeData == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- mGaugeData = NewGaugeData;
- mMaxGaugeRecords *= 2;
-
- //
- // Initialize new data array and migrate old data one.
- //
- mGaugeData = CopyMem (mGaugeData, OldGaugeData, OldGaugeDataSize);
-
- FreePool (OldGaugeData);
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Handle = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Handle;
-
- if (Token != NULL) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Token, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, Token, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH);
- }
- if (Module != NULL) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Module, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, Module, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH);
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = 0;
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Identifier = Identifier;
-
- if (TimeStamp == 0) {
- TimeStamp = GetPerformanceCounter ();
- }
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].StartTimeStamp = TimeStamp;
-
- mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries++;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- if (TimeStamp == 0) {
- TimeStamp = GetPerformanceCounter ();
- }
-
- Index = InternalSearchForGaugeEntry (Handle, Token, Module, Identifier);
- if (Index >= mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = TimeStamp;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGauge and EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntryEx stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntryEx The indirect pointer to the extended gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntryEx is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntryEx is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGaugeEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX **GaugeDataEntryEx
- )
-{
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
-
- NumberOfEntries = (UINTN) (mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries);
- if (LogEntryKey > NumberOfEntries) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (LogEntryKey == NumberOfEntries) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- if (GaugeDataEntryEx == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- *GaugeDataEntryEx = &GaugeEntryExArray[LogEntryKey];
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, and Module and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGaugeEx and EndGaugeEx of PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntry stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntry The indirect pointer to the gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntry is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntry is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGauge (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **GaugeDataEntry
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryEx;
-
- GaugeEntryEx = NULL;
-
- Status = GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey, &GaugeEntryEx);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- if (GaugeDataEntry == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *GaugeDataEntry = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY *) GaugeEntryEx;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Dumps all the PEI performance log to DXE performance gauge array.
-
- This internal function dumps all the PEI performance log to the DXE performance gauge array.
- It retrieves the optional GUID HOB for PEI performance and then saves the performance data
- to DXE performance data structures.
-
-**/
-VOID
-InternalGetPeiPerformance (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_HOB_GUID_TYPE *GuidHob;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER *LogHob;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *LogEntryArray;
- UINT32 *LogIdArray;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 NumberOfEntries;
-
- NumberOfEntries = 0;
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- //
- // Dump PEI Log Entries to DXE Guage Data structure.
- //
- GuidHob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gPerformanceProtocolGuid);
- if (GuidHob != NULL) {
- LogHob = GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (GuidHob);
- LogEntryArray = (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *) (LogHob + 1);
-
- NumberOfEntries = LogHob->NumberOfEntries;
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Handle = LogEntryArray[Index].Handle;
- AsciiStrCpyS (GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Token, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, LogEntryArray[Index].Token);
- AsciiStrCpyS (GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Module, DXE_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, LogEntryArray[Index].Module);
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].StartTimeStamp = LogEntryArray[Index].StartTimeStamp;
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = LogEntryArray[Index].EndTimeStamp;
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Identifier = 0;
- }
-
- GuidHob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gPerformanceExProtocolGuid);
- if (GuidHob != NULL) {
- LogIdArray = GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (GuidHob);
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Identifier = LogIdArray[Index];
- }
- }
- }
- mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries = NumberOfEntries;
-}
-
-/**
- The constructor function initializes Performance infrastructure for DXE phase.
-
- The constructor function publishes Performance and PerformanceEx protocol, allocates memory to log DXE performance
- and merges PEI performance data to DXE performance log.
- It will ASSERT() if one of these operations fails and it will always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DxeCorePerformanceLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (!PerformanceMeasurementEnabled ()) {
- //
- // Do not initialize performance infrastructure if not required.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- //
- // Install the protocol interfaces.
- //
- Status = gBS->InstallMultipleProtocolInterfaces (
- &mHandle,
- &gPerformanceProtocolGuid,
- &mPerformanceInterface,
- &gPerformanceExProtocolGuid,
- &mPerformanceExInterface,
- NULL
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- mMaxGaugeRecords = INIT_DXE_GAUGE_DATA_ENTRIES + PcdGet8 (PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries);
-
- mGaugeData = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_HEADER) + (sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX) * mMaxGaugeRecords));
- ASSERT (mGaugeData != NULL);
-
- InternalGetPeiPerformance ();
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- return (RETURN_STATUS) StartGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- return (RETURN_STATUS) EndGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeData;
-
- GaugeData = NULL;
-
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
- ASSERT (Token != NULL);
- ASSERT (Module != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (EndTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (Identifier != NULL);
-
- Status = GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey++, &GaugeData);
-
- //
- // Make sure that LogEntryKey is a valid log entry key,
- //
- ASSERT (Status != EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- //
- return 0;
- }
-
- ASSERT (GaugeData != NULL);
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) GaugeData->Handle;
- *Token = GaugeData->Token;
- *Module = GaugeData->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = GaugeData->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = GaugeData->EndTimeStamp;
- *Identifier = GaugeData->Identifier;
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, and Module and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurementEx and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, and EndTimeStamp.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp
- )
-{
- UINT32 Identifier;
- return GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (LogEntryKey, Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp, &Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if the performance measurement macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-PerformanceMeasurementEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8(PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask) & PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 5f290634c5..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,70 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Performance library instance mainly for DxeCore usage.
-#
-# This library provides the performance measurement interfaces and initializes performance
-# logging for DXE phase. It first initializes its private global data structure for
-# performance logging and saves the performance GUIDed HOB passed from PEI phase.
-# It initializes DXE phase performance logging by publishing the Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol,
-# which is consumed by DxePerformanceLib to logging performance data in DXE phase.
-# This library is mainly used by DxeCore to start performance logging to ensure that
-# Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol are installed at the very beginning of DXE phase.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeCorePerformanceLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeCorePerformanceLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = D0F78BBF-0A30-4c63-8A48-0F618A4AFACD
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_CORE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PerformanceLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
- CONSTRUCTOR = DxeCorePerformanceLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeCorePerformanceLib.c
- DxeCorePerformanceLibInternal.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- PcdLib
- TimerLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- BaseLib
- HobLib
- DebugLib
-
-
-[Guids]
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## HOB
- ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # Install protocol
- gPerformanceProtocolGuid
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## HOB
- ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # Install protocol
- gPerformanceExProtocolGuid
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 094a214862..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLibInternal.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLibInternal.h deleted file mode 100644 index 2b9ccd2fee..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCorePerformanceLib/DxeCorePerformanceLibInternal.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,233 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Master header files for DxeCorePerformanceLib instance.
-
- This header file holds the prototypes of the Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol published by this
- library instance at its constructor.
-
-Copyright (c) 2006 - 2012, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _DXE_CORE_PERFORMANCE_LIB_INTERNAL_H_
-#define _DXE_CORE_PERFORMANCE_LIB_INTERNAL_H_
-
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/HobLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/TimerLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-
-//
-// Interface declarations for PerformanceEx Protocol.
-//
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- );
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- );
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGauge and EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntryEx stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntryEx The indirect pointer to the extended gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntryEx is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntryEx is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGaugeEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX **GaugeDataEntryEx
- );
-
-//
-// Interface declarations for Performance Protocol.
-//
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- );
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, and Module and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- );
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGaugeEx and EndGaugeEx of PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntry stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntry The indirect pointer to the gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntry is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntry is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGauge (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **GaugeDataEntry
- );
-
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index de1b1368da..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,236 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
- This library registers CRC32 guided section handler
- to parse CRC32 encapsulation section and extract raw data.
- It uses UEFI boot service CalculateCrc32 to authenticate 32 bit CRC value.
-
-Copyright (c) 2007 - 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-#include <Guid/Crc32GuidedSectionExtraction.h>
-#include <Protocol/SecurityPolicy.h>
-#include <Library/ExtractGuidedSectionLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-
-///
-/// CRC32 Guided Section header
-///
-typedef struct {
- EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION GuidedSectionHeader; ///< EFI guided section header
- UINT32 CRC32Checksum; ///< 32bit CRC check sum
-} CRC32_SECTION_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 GuidedSectionHeader; ///< EFI guided section header
- UINT32 CRC32Checksum; ///< 32bit CRC check sum
-} CRC32_SECTION2_HEADER;
-
-/**
-
- GetInfo gets raw data size and attribute of the input guided section.
- It first checks whether the input guid section is supported.
- If not, EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER will return.
-
- @param InputSection Buffer containing the input GUIDed section to be processed.
- @param OutputBufferSize The size of OutputBuffer.
- @param ScratchBufferSize The size of ScratchBuffer.
- @param SectionAttribute The attribute of the input guided section.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The size of destination buffer, the size of scratch buffer and
- the attribute of the input section are successull retrieved.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The GUID in InputSection does not match this instance guid.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-Crc32GuidedSectionGetInfo (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT UINT32 *OutputBufferSize,
- OUT UINT32 *ScratchBufferSize,
- OUT UINT16 *SectionAttribute
- )
-{
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Retrieve the size and attribute of the input section data.
- //
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->Attributes;
- *ScratchBufferSize = 0;
- *OutputBufferSize = SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- } else {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Retrieve the size and attribute of the input section data.
- //
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->Attributes;
- *ScratchBufferSize = 0;
- *OutputBufferSize = SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
-
- Extraction handler tries to extract raw data from the input guided section.
- It also does authentication check for 32bit CRC value in the input guided section.
- It first checks whether the input guid section is supported.
- If not, EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER will return.
-
- @param InputSection Buffer containing the input GUIDed section to be processed.
- @param OutputBuffer Buffer to contain the output raw data allocated by the caller.
- @param ScratchBuffer A pointer to a caller-allocated buffer for function internal use.
- @param AuthenticationStatus A pointer to a caller-allocated UINT32 that indicates the
- authentication status of the output buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Section Data and Auth Status is extracted successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The GUID in InputSection does not match this instance guid.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-Crc32GuidedSectionHandler (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT VOID **OutputBuffer,
- IN VOID *ScratchBuffer, OPTIONAL
- OUT UINT32 *AuthenticationStatus
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 SectionCrc32Checksum;
- UINT32 Crc32Checksum;
- UINT32 OutputBufferSize;
- VOID *DummyInterface;
-
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get section Crc32 checksum.
- //
- SectionCrc32Checksum = ((CRC32_SECTION2_HEADER *) InputSection)->CRC32Checksum;
- *OutputBuffer = (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- OutputBufferSize = SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
-
- //
- // Implicitly CRC32 GUIDed section should have STATUS_VALID bit set
- //
- ASSERT (((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->Attributes & EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_AUTH_STATUS_VALID);
- *AuthenticationStatus = EFI_AUTH_STATUS_IMAGE_SIGNED;
- } else {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get section Crc32 checksum.
- //
- SectionCrc32Checksum = ((CRC32_SECTION_HEADER *) InputSection)->CRC32Checksum;
- *OutputBuffer = (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- OutputBufferSize = SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
-
- //
- // Implicitly CRC32 GUIDed section should have STATUS_VALID bit set
- //
- ASSERT (((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->Attributes & EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_AUTH_STATUS_VALID);
- *AuthenticationStatus = EFI_AUTH_STATUS_IMAGE_SIGNED;
- }
-
- //
- // Init Checksum value to Zero.
- //
- Crc32Checksum = 0;
-
- //
- // Check whether there exists EFI_SECURITY_POLICY_PROTOCOL_GUID.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiSecurityPolicyProtocolGuid, NULL, &DummyInterface);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // If SecurityPolicy Protocol exist, AUTH platform override bit is set.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_AUTH_STATUS_PLATFORM_OVERRIDE;
- } else {
- //
- // Calculate CRC32 Checksum of Image
- //
- Status = gBS->CalculateCrc32 (*OutputBuffer, OutputBufferSize, &Crc32Checksum);
- if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) {
- if (Crc32Checksum != SectionCrc32Checksum) {
- //
- // If Crc32 checksum is not matched, AUTH tested failed bit is set.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_AUTH_STATUS_TEST_FAILED;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // If Crc32 checksum is not calculated, AUTH not tested bit is set.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_AUTH_STATUS_NOT_TESTED;
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Register the handler to extract CRC32 guided section.
-
- @param ImageHandle ImageHandle of the loaded driver.
- @param SystemTable Pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Register successfully.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory to register this handler.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- return ExtractGuidedSectionRegisterHandlers (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- Crc32GuidedSectionGetInfo,
- Crc32GuidedSectionHandler
- );
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index d244897ab6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,55 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Dxe Crc32 Guided Section Extract library.
-#
-# This library doesn't produce any library class. The constructor function uses
-# ExtractGuidedSectionLib service to register CRC32 guided section handler
-# that parses CRC32 encapsulation section and extracts raw data.
-#
-# It uses UEFI boot service CalculateCrc32 to authenticate 32 bit CRC value.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 387A2490-81FC-4E7C-8E0A-3E58C30FCD0B
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
- CONSTRUCTOR = DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- ExtractGuidedSectionLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSecurityPolicyProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES # Set platform override AUTH status if exist
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 7e6e0c4e8e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/DxeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index cad57024cd..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,388 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Debug Print Error Level library instance that provide compatibility with the
- "err" shell command. This includes support for the Debug Mask Protocol
- supports for global debug print error level mask stored in an EFI Variable.
- This library instance only support DXE Phase modules.
-
- Copyright (c) 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <Library/DebugPrintErrorLevelLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/HobLib.h>
-
-#include <Guid/DebugMask.h>
-
-///
-/// Debug Mask Protocol function prototypes
-///
-
-/**
- Retrieves the current debug print error level mask for a module are returns
- it in CurrentDebugMask.
-
- @param This The protocol instance pointer.
- @param CurrentDebugMask Pointer to the debug print error level mask that
- is returned.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current debug print error level mask was
- returned in CurrentDebugMask.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER CurrentDebugMask is NULL.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The current debug print error level mask could
- not be retrieved.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetDebugMask (
- IN EFI_DEBUG_MASK_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN OUT UINTN *CurrentDebugMask
- );
-
-/**
- Sets the current debug print error level mask for a module to the value
- specified by NewDebugMask.
-
- @param This The protocol instance pointer.
- @param NewDebugMask The new debug print error level mask for this module.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current debug print error level mask was
- set to the value specified by NewDebugMask.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The current debug print error level mask could
- not be set to the value specified by NewDebugMask.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetDebugMask (
- IN EFI_DEBUG_MASK_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN UINTN NewDebugMask
- );
-
-///
-/// Debug Mask Protocol instance
-///
-EFI_DEBUG_MASK_PROTOCOL mDebugMaskProtocol = {
- EFI_DEBUG_MASK_REVISION,
- GetDebugMask,
- SetDebugMask
-};
-
-///
-/// Global variable that is set to TRUE after the first attempt is made to
-/// retrieve the global error level mask through the EFI Varibale Services.
-/// This variable prevents the EFI Variable Services from being called fort
-/// every DEBUG() macro.
-///
-BOOLEAN mGlobalErrorLevelInitialized = FALSE;
-
-///
-/// Global variable that contains the current debug error level mask for the
-/// module that is using this library instance. This variable is initially
-/// set to the PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel value. If the EFI Variable exists that
-/// contains the global debug print error level mask, then that overrides the
-/// PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel value. The EFI Variable can optionally be
-/// discovered via a HOB so early DXE drivers can access the variable. If the
-/// Debug Mask Protocol SetDebugMask() service is called, then that overrides
-/// the PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel and the EFI Variable setting.
-///
-UINT32 mDebugPrintErrorLevel = 0;
-
-///
-/// Global variable that is used to cache a pointer to the EFI System Table
-/// that is required to access the EFI Variable Services to get and set
-/// the global debug print error level mask value. The UefiBootServicesTableLib
-/// is not used to prevent a circular dependency between these libraries.
-///
-EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *mSystemTable = NULL;
-
-/**
- The constructor function caches the PCI Express Base Address and creates a
- Set Virtual Address Map event to convert physical address to virtual addresses.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor completed successfully.
- @retval Other value The constructor did not complete successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Initialize the error level mask from PCD setting.
- //
- mDebugPrintErrorLevel = PcdGet32 (PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel);
-
- //
- // Install Debug Mask Protocol onto ImageHandle
- //
- mSystemTable = SystemTable;
- Status = SystemTable->BootServices->InstallMultipleProtocolInterfaces (
- &ImageHandle,
- &gEfiDebugMaskProtocolGuid, &mDebugMaskProtocol,
- NULL
- );
-
- //
- // Attempt to retrieve the global debug print error level mask from the EFI Variable
- // If the EFI Variable can not be accessed when this module's library constructors are
- // executed a HOB can be used to set the global debug print error level. If no value
- // was found then the EFI Variable access will be reattempted on every DEBUG() print
- // from this module until the EFI Variable services are available.
- //
- GetDebugPrintErrorLevel ();
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- The destructor function frees any allocated buffers and closes the Set Virtual
- Address Map event.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The destructor completed successfully.
- @retval Other value The destructor did not complete successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLibDestructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- //
- // Uninstall the Debug Mask Protocol from ImageHandle
- //
- return SystemTable->BootServices->UninstallMultipleProtocolInterfaces (
- ImageHandle,
- &gEfiDebugMaskProtocolGuid, &mDebugMaskProtocol,
- NULL
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Returns the debug print error level mask for the current module.
-
- @return Debug print error level mask for the current module.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-GetDebugPrintErrorLevel (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_TPL CurrentTpl;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN GlobalErrorLevel;
- VOID *Hob;
-
- //
- // If the constructor has not been executed yet, then just return the PCD value.
- // This case should only occur if debug print is generated by a library
- // constructor for this module
- //
- if (mSystemTable == NULL) {
- return PcdGet32 (PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel);
- }
-
- //
- // Check to see if an attempt has been made to retrieve the global debug print
- // error level mask. Since this library instance stores the global debug print
- // error level mask in an EFI Variable, the EFI Variable should only be accessed
- // once to reduce the overhead of reading the EFI Variable on every debug print
- //
- if (!mGlobalErrorLevelInitialized) {
- //
- // Make sure the TPL Level is low enough for EFI Variable Services to be called
- //
- CurrentTpl = mSystemTable->BootServices->RaiseTPL (TPL_HIGH_LEVEL);
- mSystemTable->BootServices->RestoreTPL (CurrentTpl);
- if (CurrentTpl <= TPL_CALLBACK) {
- //
- // Attempt to retrieve the global debug print error level mask from the
- // EFI Variable
- //
- Size = sizeof (GlobalErrorLevel);
- Status = mSystemTable->RuntimeServices->GetVariable (
- DEBUG_MASK_VARIABLE_NAME,
- &gEfiGenericVariableGuid,
- NULL,
- &Size,
- &GlobalErrorLevel
- );
- if (Status != EFI_NOT_AVAILABLE_YET) {
- //
- // If EFI Variable Services are available, then set a flag so the EFI
- // Variable will not be read again by this module.
- //
- mGlobalErrorLevelInitialized = TRUE;
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // If the EFI Varible exists, then set this module's module's mask to
- // the global debug print error level mask value.
- //
- mDebugPrintErrorLevel = (UINT32)GlobalErrorLevel;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // If variable services are not yet availible optionally get the global
- // debug print error level mask from a HOB.
- //
- Hob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gEfiGenericVariableGuid);
- if (Hob != NULL) {
- if (GET_GUID_HOB_DATA_SIZE (Hob) == sizeof (UINT32)) {
- mDebugPrintErrorLevel = *(UINT32 *)GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (Hob);
- mGlobalErrorLevelInitialized = TRUE;
- }
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Return the current mask value for this module.
- //
- return mDebugPrintErrorLevel;
-}
-
-/**
- Sets the global debug print error level mask fpr the entire platform.
-
- @param ErrorLevel Global debug print error level
-
- @retval TRUE The debug print error level mask was sucessfully set.
- @retval FALSE The debug print error level mask could not be set.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-SetDebugPrintErrorLevel (
- UINT32 ErrorLevel
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_TPL CurrentTpl;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN GlobalErrorLevel;
-
- //
- // Make sure the constructor has been executed
- //
- if (mSystemTable != NULL) {
- //
- // Make sure the TPL Level is low enough for EFI Variable Services
- //
- CurrentTpl = mSystemTable->BootServices->RaiseTPL (TPL_HIGH_LEVEL);
- mSystemTable->BootServices->RestoreTPL (CurrentTpl);
- if (CurrentTpl <= TPL_CALLBACK) {
- //
- // Attempt to store the global debug print error level mask in an EFI Variable
- //
- GlobalErrorLevel = (UINTN)ErrorLevel;
- Size = sizeof (GlobalErrorLevel);
- Status = mSystemTable->RuntimeServices->SetVariable (
- DEBUG_MASK_VARIABLE_NAME,
- &gEfiGenericVariableGuid,
- (EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE | EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS),
- Size,
- &GlobalErrorLevel
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // If the EFI Variable was updated, then update the mask value for this
- // module and return TRUE.
- //
- mGlobalErrorLevelInitialized = TRUE;
- mDebugPrintErrorLevel = ErrorLevel;
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
- }
- //
- // Return FALSE since the EFI Variable could not be updated.
- //
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves the current debug print error level mask for a module are returns
- it in CurrentDebugMask.
-
- @param This The protocol instance pointer.
- @param CurrentDebugMask Pointer to the debug print error level mask that
- is returned.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current debug print error level mask was
- returned in CurrentDebugMask.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER CurrentDebugMask is NULL.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The current debug print error level mask could
- not be retrieved.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetDebugMask (
- IN EFI_DEBUG_MASK_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN OUT UINTN *CurrentDebugMask
- )
-{
- if (CurrentDebugMask == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the current debug mask from mDebugPrintErrorLevel
- //
- *CurrentDebugMask = (UINTN)mDebugPrintErrorLevel;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Sets the current debug print error level mask for a module to the value
- specified by NewDebugMask.
-
- @param This The protocol instance pointer.
- @param NewDebugMask The new debug print error level mask for this module.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current debug print error level mask was
- set to the value specified by NewDebugMask.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The current debug print error level mask could
- not be set to the value specified by NewDebugMask.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetDebugMask (
- IN EFI_DEBUG_MASK_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN UINTN NewDebugMask
- )
-{
- //
- // Store the new debug mask into mDebugPrintErrorLevel
- //
- mDebugPrintErrorLevel = (UINT32)NewDebugMask;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index b471af7a88..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,54 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Debug Print Error Level library instance that provide compatibility with the "err" shell command.
-# This includes support for the Debug Mask Protocol supports for global debug print error level mask
-# stored in an EFI Variable. This library instance only support DXE Phase modules.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2011 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 1D564EC9-9373-49a4-9E3F-E4D7B9974C84
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = DebugPrintErrorLevelLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLibConstructor
- DESTRUCTOR = DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLibDestructor
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- HobLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiDebugMaskProtocolGuid ## PRODUCES
-
-[Guids]
- ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## Variable:L"EFIDebug"
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"EFIDebug"
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## HOB
- gEfiGenericVariableGuid
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index b1e53686ae..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib/DxeDebugPrintErrorLevelLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DpcLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DpcLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 6eda8ca0fb..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DpcLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,100 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Help functions to access UDP service.
-
-Copyright (c) 2005 - 2007, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Protocol/Dpc.h>
-
-//
-// Pointer to the DPC Protocol
-//
-EFI_DPC_PROTOCOL *mDpc;
-
-/**
- This constructor function caches the EFI_DPC_PROTOCOL pointer.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param[in] SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DpcLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Locate the EFI_DPC_PROTOCOL in the handle database
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiDpcProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **)&mDpc);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Add a Deferred Procedure Call to the end of the DPC queue.
-
- @param[in] DpcTpl The EFI_TPL that the DPC should be invoked.
- @param[in] DpcProcedure Pointer to the DPC's function.
- @param[in] DpcContext Pointer to the DPC's context. Passed to DpcProcedure
- when DpcProcedure is invoked.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The DPC was queued.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER DpcTpl is not a valid EFI_TPL.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER DpcProcedure is NULL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources available to
- add the DPC to the queue.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-QueueDpc (
- IN EFI_TPL DpcTpl,
- IN EFI_DPC_PROCEDURE DpcProcedure,
- IN VOID *DpcContext OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- //
- // Call the EFI_DPC_PROTOCOL to queue the DPC
- //
- return mDpc->QueueDpc (mDpc, DpcTpl, DpcProcedure, DpcContext);
-}
-
-/**
- Dispatch the queue of DPCs. ALL DPCs that have been queued with a DpcTpl
- value greater than or equal to the current TPL are invoked in the order that
- they were queued. DPCs with higher DpcTpl values are invoked before DPCs with
- lower DpcTpl values.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS One or more DPCs were invoked.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No DPCs were invoked.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-DispatchDpc (
- VOID
- )
-{
- //
- // Call the EFI_DPC_PROTOCOL to dispatch previously queued DPCs
- //
- return mDpc->DispatchDpc (mDpc);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DxeDpcLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DxeDpcLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index d541acd5a9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DxeDpcLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,46 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# This library instance provides DPC service by consuming EFI DPC Protocol.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2007 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeDpcLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeDpcLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 38897D86-FF36-4472-AE64-1DB9AE715C81
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = DpcLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = DpcLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DpcLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiDpcProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_SAL_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_SMM_DRIVER]
- gEfiDpcProtocolGuid
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DxeDpcLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DxeDpcLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 3624f669f8..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeDpcLib/DxeDpcLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 143baabdec..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1427 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This library is used to share code between UEFI network stack modules.
- It provides the helper routines to parse the HTTP message byte stream.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at<BR>
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-#include <Library/NetLib.h>
-#include <Library/HttpLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-
-#define BIT(x) (1 << x)
-
-#define NET_IS_HEX_CHAR(Ch) \
- ((('0' <= (Ch)) && ((Ch) <= '9')) || \
- (('A' <= (Ch)) && ((Ch) <= 'F')) || \
- (('a' <= (Ch)) && ((Ch) <= 'f')))
-
-//
-// Field index of the HTTP URL parse result.
-//
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_SCHEME 0
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_AUTHORITY 1
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_PATH 2
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_QUERY 3
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_FRAGMENT 4
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_USERINFO 5
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST 6
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT 7
-#define HTTP_URI_FIELD_MAX 8
-
-//
-// Structure to store the parse result of a HTTP URL.
-//
-typedef struct {
- UINT32 Offset;
- UINT32 Length;
-} HTTP_URL_FILED_DATA;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 FieldBitMap;
- HTTP_URL_FILED_DATA FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_MAX];
-} HTTP_URL_PARSER;
-
-typedef enum {
- UrlParserUrlStart,
- UrlParserScheme,
- UrlParserSchemeColon, // ":"
- UrlParserSchemeColonSlash, // ":/"
- UrlParserSchemeColonSlashSlash, // "://"
- UrlParserAuthority,
- UrlParserAtInAuthority,
- UrlParserPath,
- UrlParserQueryStart, // "?"
- UrlParserQuery,
- UrlParserFragmentStart, // "#"
- UrlParserFragment,
- UrlParserUserInfo,
- UrlParserHostStart, // "@"
- UrlParserHost,
- UrlParserHostIpv6, // "["(Ipv6 address) "]"
- UrlParserPortStart, // ":"
- UrlParserPort,
- UrlParserStateMax
-} HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE;
-
-/**
- Decode a percent-encoded URI component to the ASCII character.
-
- Decode the input component in Buffer according to RFC 3986. The caller is responsible to make
- sure ResultBuffer points to a buffer with size equal or greater than ((AsciiStrSize (Buffer))
- in bytes.
-
- @param[in] Buffer The pointer to a percent-encoded URI component.
- @param[in] BufferLength Length of Buffer in bytes.
- @param[out] ResultBuffer Point to the buffer to store the decode result.
- @param[out] ResultLength Length of decoded string in ResultBuffer in bytes.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully decoded the URI.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Buffer is not a valid percent-encoded string.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UriPercentDecode (
- IN CHAR8 *Buffer,
- IN UINT32 BufferLength,
- OUT CHAR8 *ResultBuffer,
- OUT UINT32 *ResultLength
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Offset;
- CHAR8 HexStr[3];
-
- if (Buffer == NULL || BufferLength == 0 || ResultBuffer == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Index = 0;
- Offset = 0;
- HexStr[2] = '\0';
- while (Index < BufferLength) {
- if (Buffer[Index] == '%') {
- if (!NET_IS_HEX_CHAR (Buffer[Index+1]) || !NET_IS_HEX_CHAR (Buffer[Index+2])) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- HexStr[0] = Buffer[Index+1];
- HexStr[1] = Buffer[Index+2];
- ResultBuffer[Offset] = (CHAR8) AsciiStrHexToUintn (HexStr);
- Index += 3;
- } else {
- ResultBuffer[Offset] = Buffer[Index];
- Index++;
- }
- Offset++;
- }
-
- *ResultLength = (UINT32) Offset;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function return the updated state accroding to the input state and next character of
- the authority.
-
- @param[in] Char Next character.
- @param[in] State Current value of the parser state machine.
- @param[in] IsRightBracket TRUE if there is an sign ']' in the authority component and
- indicates the next part is ':' before Port.
-
- @return Updated state value.
-**/
-HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE
-NetHttpParseAuthorityChar (
- IN CHAR8 Char,
- IN HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE State,
- IN BOOLEAN *IsRightBracket
- )
-{
-
- //
- // RFC 3986:
- // The authority component is preceded by a double slash ("//") and is
- // terminated by the next slash ("/"), question mark ("?"), or number
- // sign ("#") character, or by the end of the URI.
- //
- if (Char == ' ' || Char == '\r' || Char == '\n') {
- return UrlParserStateMax;
- }
-
- //
- // authority = [ userinfo "@" ] host [ ":" port ]
- //
- switch (State) {
- case UrlParserUserInfo:
- if (Char == '@') {
- return UrlParserHostStart;
- }
- break;
-
- case UrlParserHost:
- case UrlParserHostStart:
- if (Char == '[') {
- return UrlParserHostIpv6;
- }
-
- if (Char == ':') {
- return UrlParserPortStart;
- }
-
- return UrlParserHost;
-
- case UrlParserHostIpv6:
- if (Char == ']') {
- *IsRightBracket = TRUE;
- }
-
- if (Char == ':' && *IsRightBracket) {
- return UrlParserPortStart;
- }
- return UrlParserHostIpv6;
-
- case UrlParserPort:
- case UrlParserPortStart:
- return UrlParserPort;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-
- return State;
-}
-
-/**
- This function parse the authority component of the input URL and update the parser.
-
- @param[in] Url The pointer to a HTTP URL string.
- @param[in] FoundAt TRUE if there is an at sign ('@') in the authority component.
- @param[in, out] UrlParser Pointer to the buffer of the parse result.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully parse the authority.
- @retval Other Error happened.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-NetHttpParseAuthority (
- IN CHAR8 *Url,
- IN BOOLEAN FoundAt,
- IN OUT HTTP_URL_PARSER *UrlParser
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Char;
- CHAR8 *Authority;
- UINT32 Length;
- HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE State;
- UINT32 Field;
- UINT32 OldField;
- BOOLEAN IsrightBracket;
-
- ASSERT ((UrlParser->FieldBitMap & BIT (HTTP_URI_FIELD_AUTHORITY)) != 0);
-
- //
- // authority = [ userinfo "@" ] host [ ":" port ]
- //
- if (FoundAt) {
- State = UrlParserUserInfo;
- } else {
- State = UrlParserHost;
- }
-
- IsrightBracket = FALSE;
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_MAX;
- OldField = Field;
- Authority = Url + UrlParser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_AUTHORITY].Offset;
- Length = UrlParser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_AUTHORITY].Length;
- for (Char = Authority; Char < Authority + Length; Char++) {
- State = NetHttpParseAuthorityChar (*Char, State, &IsrightBracket);
- switch (State) {
- case UrlParserStateMax:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
-
- case UrlParserHostStart:
- case UrlParserPortStart:
- continue;
-
- case UrlParserUserInfo:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_USERINFO;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserHost:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserHostIpv6:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserPort:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT;
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- //
- // Field not changed, count the length.
- //
- ASSERT (Field < HTTP_URI_FIELD_MAX);
- if (Field == OldField) {
- UrlParser->FieldData[Field].Length++;
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // New field start
- //
- UrlParser->FieldBitMap |= BIT (Field);
- UrlParser->FieldData[Field].Offset = (UINT32) (Char - Url);
- UrlParser->FieldData[Field].Length = 1;
- OldField = Field;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function return the updated state accroding to the input state and next character of a URL.
-
- @param[in] Char Next character.
- @param[in] State Current value of the parser state machine.
-
- @return Updated state value.
-
-**/
-HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE
-NetHttpParseUrlChar (
- IN CHAR8 Char,
- IN HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE State
- )
-{
- if (Char == ' ' || Char == '\r' || Char == '\n') {
- return UrlParserStateMax;
- }
-
- //
- // http_URL = "http:" "//" host [ ":" port ] [ abs_path [ "?" query ]]
- //
- // Request-URI = "*" | absolute-URI | path-absolute | authority
- //
- // absolute-URI = scheme ":" hier-part [ "?" query ]
- // path-absolute = "/" [ segment-nz *( "/" segment ) ]
- // authority = [ userinfo "@" ] host [ ":" port ]
- //
- switch (State) {
- case UrlParserUrlStart:
- if (Char == '*' || Char == '/') {
- return UrlParserPath;
- }
- return UrlParserScheme;
-
- case UrlParserScheme:
- if (Char == ':') {
- return UrlParserSchemeColon;
- }
- break;
-
- case UrlParserSchemeColon:
- if (Char == '/') {
- return UrlParserSchemeColonSlash;
- }
- break;
-
- case UrlParserSchemeColonSlash:
- if (Char == '/') {
- return UrlParserSchemeColonSlashSlash;
- }
- break;
-
- case UrlParserAtInAuthority:
- if (Char == '@') {
- return UrlParserStateMax;
- }
-
- case UrlParserAuthority:
- case UrlParserSchemeColonSlashSlash:
- if (Char == '@') {
- return UrlParserAtInAuthority;
- }
- if (Char == '/') {
- return UrlParserPath;
- }
- if (Char == '?') {
- return UrlParserQueryStart;
- }
- if (Char == '#') {
- return UrlParserFragmentStart;
- }
- return UrlParserAuthority;
-
- case UrlParserPath:
- if (Char == '?') {
- return UrlParserQueryStart;
- }
- if (Char == '#') {
- return UrlParserFragmentStart;
- }
- break;
-
- case UrlParserQuery:
- case UrlParserQueryStart:
- if (Char == '#') {
- return UrlParserFragmentStart;
- }
- return UrlParserQuery;
-
- case UrlParserFragmentStart:
- return UrlParserFragment;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-
- return State;
-}
-/**
- Create a URL parser for the input URL string.
-
- This function will parse and dereference the input HTTP URL into it components. The original
- content of the URL won't be modified and the result will be returned in UrlParser, which can
- be used in other functions like NetHttpUrlGetHostName().
-
- @param[in] Url The pointer to a HTTP URL string.
- @param[in] Length Length of Url in bytes.
- @param[in] IsConnectMethod Whether the Url is used in HTTP CONNECT method or not.
- @param[out] UrlParser Pointer to the returned buffer to store the parse result.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully dereferenced the HTTP URL.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER UrlParser is NULL or Url is not a valid HTTP URL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Could not allocate needed resources.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpParseUrl (
- IN CHAR8 *Url,
- IN UINT32 Length,
- IN BOOLEAN IsConnectMethod,
- OUT VOID **UrlParser
- )
-{
- HTTP_URL_PARSE_STATE State;
- CHAR8 *Char;
- UINT32 Field;
- UINT32 OldField;
- BOOLEAN FoundAt;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- HTTP_URL_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (Url == NULL || Length == 0 || UrlParser == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (HTTP_URL_PARSER));
- if (Parser == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- if (IsConnectMethod) {
- //
- // According to RFC 2616, the authority form is only used by the CONNECT method.
- //
- State = UrlParserAuthority;
- } else {
- State = UrlParserUrlStart;
- }
-
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_MAX;
- OldField = Field;
- FoundAt = FALSE;
- for (Char = Url; Char < Url + Length; Char++) {
- //
- // Update state machine accoring to next char.
- //
- State = NetHttpParseUrlChar (*Char, State);
-
- switch (State) {
- case UrlParserStateMax:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
-
- case UrlParserSchemeColon:
- case UrlParserSchemeColonSlash:
- case UrlParserSchemeColonSlashSlash:
- case UrlParserQueryStart:
- case UrlParserFragmentStart:
- //
- // Skip all the delimiting char: "://" "?" "@"
- //
- continue;
-
- case UrlParserScheme:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_SCHEME;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserAtInAuthority:
- FoundAt = TRUE;
- case UrlParserAuthority:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_AUTHORITY;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserPath:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_PATH;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserQuery:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_QUERY;
- break;
-
- case UrlParserFragment:
- Field = HTTP_URI_FIELD_FRAGMENT;
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- //
- // Field not changed, count the length.
- //
- ASSERT (Field < HTTP_URI_FIELD_MAX);
- if (Field == OldField) {
- Parser->FieldData[Field].Length++;
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // New field start
- //
- Parser->FieldBitMap |= BIT (Field);
- Parser->FieldData[Field].Offset = (UINT32) (Char - Url);
- Parser->FieldData[Field].Length = 1;
- OldField = Field;
- }
-
- //
- // If has authority component, continue to parse the username, host and port.
- //
- if ((Parser->FieldBitMap & BIT (HTTP_URI_FIELD_AUTHORITY)) != 0) {
- Status = NetHttpParseAuthority (Url, FoundAt, Parser);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
-
- *UrlParser = Parser;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the Hostname from a HTTP URL.
-
- This function will return the HostName according to the Url and previous parse result ,and
- it is the caller's responsibility to free the buffer returned in *HostName.
-
- @param[in] Url The pointer to a HTTP URL string.
- @param[in] UrlParser URL Parse result returned by NetHttpParseUrl().
- @param[out] HostName Pointer to a buffer to store the HostName.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully get the required component.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Uri is NULL or HostName is NULL or UrlParser is invalid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No hostName component in the URL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Could not allocate needed resources.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpUrlGetHostName (
- IN CHAR8 *Url,
- IN VOID *UrlParser,
- OUT CHAR8 **HostName
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Name;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 ResultLength;
- HTTP_URL_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (Url == NULL || UrlParser == NULL || HostName == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = (HTTP_URL_PARSER*) UrlParser;
-
- if ((Parser->FieldBitMap & BIT (HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST)) == 0) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- Name = AllocatePool (Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Length + 1);
- if (Name == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Status = UriPercentDecode (
- Url + Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Offset,
- Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Length,
- Name,
- &ResultLength
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Name[ResultLength] = '\0';
- *HostName = Name;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Get the IPv4 address from a HTTP URL.
-
- This function will return the IPv4 address according to the Url and previous parse result.
-
- @param[in] Url The pointer to a HTTP URL string.
- @param[in] UrlParser URL Parse result returned by NetHttpParseUrl().
- @param[out] Ip4Address Pointer to a buffer to store the IP address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully get the required component.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Uri is NULL or Ip4Address is NULL or UrlParser is invalid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No IPv4 address component in the URL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Could not allocate needed resources.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpUrlGetIp4 (
- IN CHAR8 *Url,
- IN VOID *UrlParser,
- OUT EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS *Ip4Address
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Ip4String;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 ResultLength;
- HTTP_URL_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (Url == NULL || UrlParser == NULL || Ip4Address == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = (HTTP_URL_PARSER*) UrlParser;
-
- if ((Parser->FieldBitMap & BIT (HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST)) == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Ip4String = AllocatePool (Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Length + 1);
- if (Ip4String == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Status = UriPercentDecode (
- Url + Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Offset,
- Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Length,
- Ip4String,
- &ResultLength
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Ip4String[ResultLength] = '\0';
- Status = NetLibAsciiStrToIp4 (Ip4String, Ip4Address);
- FreePool (Ip4String);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the IPv6 address from a HTTP URL.
-
- This function will return the IPv6 address according to the Url and previous parse result.
-
- @param[in] Url The pointer to a HTTP URL string.
- @param[in] UrlParser URL Parse result returned by NetHttpParseUrl().
- @param[out] Ip6Address Pointer to a buffer to store the IP address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully get the required component.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Uri is NULL or Ip6Address is NULL or UrlParser is invalid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No IPv6 address component in the URL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Could not allocate needed resources.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpUrlGetIp6 (
- IN CHAR8 *Url,
- IN VOID *UrlParser,
- OUT EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6Address
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Ip6String;
- CHAR8 *Ptr;
- UINT32 Length;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 ResultLength;
- HTTP_URL_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (Url == NULL || UrlParser == NULL || Ip6Address == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = (HTTP_URL_PARSER*) UrlParser;
-
- if ((Parser->FieldBitMap & BIT (HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST)) == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // IP-literal = "[" ( IPv6address / IPvFuture ) "]"
- //
- Length = Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Length;
- if (Length < 2) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Ptr = Url + Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_HOST].Offset;
- if ((Ptr[0] != '[') || (Ptr[Length - 1] != ']')) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Ip6String = AllocatePool (Length);
- if (Ip6String == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Status = UriPercentDecode (
- Ptr + 1,
- Length - 2,
- Ip6String,
- &ResultLength
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Ip6String[ResultLength] = '\0';
- Status = NetLibAsciiStrToIp6 (Ip6String, Ip6Address);
- FreePool (Ip6String);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the port number from a HTTP URL.
-
- This function will return the port number according to the Url and previous parse result.
-
- @param[in] Url The pointer to a HTTP URL string.
- @param[in] UrlParser URL Parse result returned by NetHttpParseUrl().
- @param[out] Port Pointer to a buffer to store the port number.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully get the required component.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Uri is NULL or Port is NULL or UrlParser is invalid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No port number in the URL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Could not allocate needed resources.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpUrlGetPort (
- IN CHAR8 *Url,
- IN VOID *UrlParser,
- OUT UINT16 *Port
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *PortString;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 ResultLength;
- HTTP_URL_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (Url == NULL || UrlParser == NULL || Port == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = (HTTP_URL_PARSER*) UrlParser;
-
- if ((Parser->FieldBitMap & BIT (HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT)) == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- PortString = AllocatePool (Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT].Length + 1);
- if (PortString == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Status = UriPercentDecode (
- Url + Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT].Offset,
- Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT].Length,
- PortString,
- &ResultLength
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- PortString[ResultLength] = '\0';
- *Port = (UINT16) AsciiStrDecimalToUintn (Url + Parser->FieldData[HTTP_URI_FIELD_PORT].Offset);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Release the resource of the URL parser.
-
- @param[in] UrlParser Pointer to the parser.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-HttpUrlFreeParser (
- IN VOID *UrlParser
- )
-{
- FreePool (UrlParser);
-}
-
-/**
- Find a specified header field according to the field name.
-
- @param[in] HeaderCount Number of HTTP header structures in Headers list.
- @param[in] Headers Array containing list of HTTP headers.
- @param[in] FieldName Null terminated string which describes a field name.
-
- @return Pointer to the found header or NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_HTTP_HEADER *
-HttpIoFindHeader (
- IN UINTN HeaderCount,
- IN EFI_HTTP_HEADER *Headers,
- IN CHAR8 *FieldName
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- if (HeaderCount == 0 || Headers == NULL || FieldName == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HeaderCount; Index++){
- //
- // Field names are case-insensitive (RFC 2616).
- //
- if (AsciiStriCmp (Headers[Index].FieldName, FieldName) == 0) {
- return &Headers[Index];
- }
- }
- return NULL;
-}
-
-typedef enum {
- BodyParserBodyStart,
- BodyParserBodyIdentity,
- BodyParserChunkSizeStart,
- BodyParserChunkSize,
- BodyParserChunkSizeEndCR,
- BodyParserChunkExtStart,
- BodyParserChunkDataStart,
- BodyParserChunkDataEnd,
- BodyParserChunkDataEndCR,
- BodyParserTrailer,
- BodyParserLastCRLF,
- BodyParserLastCRLFEnd,
- BodyParserComplete,
- BodyParserStateMax
-} HTTP_BODY_PARSE_STATE;
-
-typedef struct {
- BOOLEAN IgnoreBody; // "MUST NOT" include a message-body
- BOOLEAN IsChunked; // "chunked" transfer-coding.
- BOOLEAN ContentLengthIsValid;
- UINTN ContentLength; // Entity length (not the message-body length), invalid until ContentLengthIsValid is TRUE
-
- HTTP_BODY_PARSER_CALLBACK Callback;
- VOID *Context;
- UINTN ParsedBodyLength;
- HTTP_BODY_PARSE_STATE State;
- UINTN CurrentChunkSize;
- UINTN CurrentChunkParsedSize;
-} HTTP_BODY_PARSER;
-
-/**
-
- Convert an Ascii char to its uppercase.
-
- @param[in] Char Ascii character.
-
- @return Uppercase value of the input Char.
-
-**/
-CHAR8
-HttpIoCharToUpper (
- IN CHAR8 Char
- )
-{
- if (Char >= 'a' && Char <= 'z') {
- return Char - ('a' - 'A');
- }
-
- return Char;
-}
-
-/**
- Convert an hexadecimal char to a value of type UINTN.
-
- @param[in] Char Ascii character.
-
- @return Value translated from Char.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-HttpIoHexCharToUintn (
- IN CHAR8 Char
- )
-{
- if (Char >= '0' && Char <= '9') {
- return Char - '0';
- }
-
- return (10 + HttpIoCharToUpper (Char) - 'A');
-}
-
-/**
- Get the value of the content length if there is a "Content-Length" header.
-
- @param[in] HeaderCount Number of HTTP header structures in Headers.
- @param[in] Headers Array containing list of HTTP headers.
- @param[out] ContentLength Pointer to save the value of the content length.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully get the content length.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No "Content-Length" header in the Headers.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-HttpIoParseContentLengthHeader (
- IN UINTN HeaderCount,
- IN EFI_HTTP_HEADER *Headers,
- OUT UINTN *ContentLength
- )
-{
- EFI_HTTP_HEADER *Header;
-
- Header = HttpIoFindHeader (HeaderCount, Headers, "Content-Length");
- if (Header == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- *ContentLength = AsciiStrDecimalToUintn (Header->FieldValue);
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
-
- Check whether the HTTP message is using the "chunked" transfer-coding.
-
- @param[in] HeaderCount Number of HTTP header structures in Headers.
- @param[in] Headers Array containing list of HTTP headers.
-
- @return The message is "chunked" transfer-coding (TRUE) or not (FALSE).
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-HttpIoIsChunked (
- IN UINTN HeaderCount,
- IN EFI_HTTP_HEADER *Headers
- )
-{
- EFI_HTTP_HEADER *Header;
-
-
- Header = HttpIoFindHeader (HeaderCount, Headers, "Transfer-Encoding");
- if (Header == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if (AsciiStriCmp (Header->FieldValue, "identity") != 0) {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the HTTP message should have a message-body.
-
- @param[in] Method The HTTP method (e.g. GET, POST) for this HTTP message.
- @param[in] StatusCode Response status code returned by the remote host.
-
- @return The message should have a message-body (FALSE) or not (TRUE).
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-HttpIoNoMessageBody (
- IN EFI_HTTP_METHOD Method,
- IN EFI_HTTP_STATUS_CODE StatusCode
- )
-{
- //
- // RFC 2616:
- // All responses to the HEAD request method
- // MUST NOT include a message-body, even though the presence of entity-
- // header fields might lead one to believe they do. All 1xx
- // (informational), 204 (no content), and 304 (not modified) responses
- // MUST NOT include a message-body. All other responses do include a
- // message-body, although it MAY be of zero length.
- //
- if (Method == HttpMethodHead) {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- if ((StatusCode == HTTP_STATUS_100_CONTINUE) ||
- (StatusCode == HTTP_STATUS_101_SWITCHING_PROTOCOLS) ||
- (StatusCode == HTTP_STATUS_204_NO_CONTENT) ||
- (StatusCode == HTTP_STATUS_304_NOT_MODIFIED))
- {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Initialize a HTTP message-body parser.
-
- This function will create and initialize a HTTP message parser according to caller provided HTTP message
- header information. It is the caller's responsibility to free the buffer returned in *UrlParser by HttpFreeMsgParser().
-
- @param[in] Method The HTTP method (e.g. GET, POST) for this HTTP message.
- @param[in] StatusCode Response status code returned by the remote host.
- @param[in] HeaderCount Number of HTTP header structures in Headers.
- @param[in] Headers Array containing list of HTTP headers.
- @param[in] Callback Callback function that is invoked when parsing the HTTP message-body,
- set to NULL to ignore all events.
- @param[in] Context Pointer to the context that will be passed to Callback.
- @param[out] MsgParser Pointer to the returned buffer to store the message parser.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully initialized the parser.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Could not allocate needed resources.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER MsgParser is NULL or HeaderCount is not NULL but Headers is NULL.
- @retval Others Failed to initialize the parser.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpInitMsgParser (
- IN EFI_HTTP_METHOD Method,
- IN EFI_HTTP_STATUS_CODE StatusCode,
- IN UINTN HeaderCount,
- IN EFI_HTTP_HEADER *Headers,
- IN HTTP_BODY_PARSER_CALLBACK Callback,
- IN VOID *Context,
- OUT VOID **MsgParser
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- HTTP_BODY_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (HeaderCount != 0 && Headers == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (MsgParser == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (HTTP_BODY_PARSER));
- if (Parser == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Parser->State = BodyParserBodyStart;
-
- //
- // Determine the message length accroding to RFC 2616.
- // 1. Check whether the message "MUST NOT" have a message-body.
- //
- Parser->IgnoreBody = HttpIoNoMessageBody (Method, StatusCode);
- //
- // 2. Check whether the message using "chunked" transfer-coding.
- //
- Parser->IsChunked = HttpIoIsChunked (HeaderCount, Headers);
- //
- // 3. Check whether the message has a Content-Length header field.
- //
- Status = HttpIoParseContentLengthHeader (HeaderCount, Headers, &Parser->ContentLength);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Parser->ContentLengthIsValid = TRUE;
- }
- //
- // 4. Range header is not supported now, so we won't meet media type "multipart/byteranges".
- // 5. By server closing the connection
- //
-
- //
- // Set state to skip body parser if the message shouldn't have a message body.
- //
- if (Parser->IgnoreBody) {
- Parser->State = BodyParserComplete;
- } else {
- Parser->Callback = Callback;
- Parser->Context = Context;
- }
-
- *MsgParser = Parser;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse message body.
-
- Parse BodyLength of message-body. This function can be called repeatedly to parse the message-body partially.
-
- @param[in, out] MsgParser Pointer to the message parser.
- @param[in] BodyLength Length in bytes of the Body.
- @param[in] Body Pointer to the buffer of the message-body to be parsed.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully parse the message-body.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER MsgParser is NULL or Body is NULL or BodyLength is 0.
- @retval Others Operation aborted.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpParseMessageBody (
- IN OUT VOID *MsgParser,
- IN UINTN BodyLength,
- IN CHAR8 *Body
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Char;
- UINTN RemainderLengthInThis;
- UINTN LengthForCallback;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- HTTP_BODY_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (BodyLength == 0 || Body == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (MsgParser == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = (HTTP_BODY_PARSER*) MsgParser;
-
- if (Parser->IgnoreBody) {
- Parser->State = BodyParserComplete;
- if (Parser->Callback != NULL) {
- Status = Parser->Callback (
- BodyParseEventOnComplete,
- Body,
- 0,
- Parser->Context
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if (Parser->State == BodyParserBodyStart) {
- Parser->ParsedBodyLength = 0;
- if (Parser->IsChunked) {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkSizeStart;
- } else {
- Parser->State = BodyParserBodyIdentity;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // The message body might be truncated in anywhere, so we need to parse is byte-by-byte.
- //
- for (Char = Body; Char < Body + BodyLength; ) {
-
- switch (Parser->State) {
- case BodyParserStateMax:
- return EFI_ABORTED;
-
- case BodyParserBodyIdentity:
- //
- // Identity transfer-coding, just notify user to save the body data.
- //
- if (Parser->Callback != NULL) {
- Status = Parser->Callback (
- BodyParseEventOnData,
- Char,
- MIN (BodyLength, Parser->ContentLength - Parser->ParsedBodyLength),
- Parser->Context
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
- Char += MIN (BodyLength, Parser->ContentLength - Parser->ParsedBodyLength);
- Parser->ParsedBodyLength += MIN (BodyLength, Parser->ContentLength - Parser->ParsedBodyLength);
- if (Parser->ParsedBodyLength == Parser->ContentLength) {
- Parser->State = BodyParserComplete;
- if (Parser->Callback != NULL) {
- Status = Parser->Callback (
- BodyParseEventOnComplete,
- Char,
- 0,
- Parser->Context
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
- }
- break;
-
- case BodyParserChunkSizeStart:
- //
- // First byte of chunk-size, the chunk-size might be truncated.
- //
- Parser->CurrentChunkSize = 0;
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkSize;
- case BodyParserChunkSize:
- if (!NET_IS_HEX_CHAR (*Char)) {
- if (*Char == ';') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkExtStart;
- Char++;
- } else if (*Char == '\r') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkSizeEndCR;
- Char++;
- } else {
- Parser->State = BodyParserStateMax;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- if (Parser->CurrentChunkSize > (((~((UINTN) 0)) - 16) / 16)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- Parser->CurrentChunkSize = Parser->CurrentChunkSize * 16 + HttpIoHexCharToUintn (*Char);
- Char++;
- break;
-
- case BodyParserChunkExtStart:
- //
- // Ignore all the chunk extensions.
- //
- if (*Char == '\r') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkSizeEndCR;
- }
- Char++;
- break;
-
- case BodyParserChunkSizeEndCR:
- if (*Char != '\n') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserStateMax;
- break;
- }
- Char++;
- if (Parser->CurrentChunkSize == 0) {
- //
- // The last chunk has been parsed and now assumed the state
- // of HttpBodyParse is ParserLastCRLF. So it need to decide
- // whether the rest message is trailer or last CRLF in the next round.
- //
- Parser->ContentLengthIsValid = TRUE;
- Parser->State = BodyParserLastCRLF;
- break;
- }
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkDataStart;
- Parser->CurrentChunkParsedSize = 0;
- break;
-
- case BodyParserLastCRLF:
- //
- // Judge the byte is belong to the Last CRLF or trailer, and then
- // configure the state of HttpBodyParse to corresponding state.
- //
- if (*Char == '\r') {
- Char++;
- Parser->State = BodyParserLastCRLFEnd;
- break;
- } else {
- Parser->State = BodyParserTrailer;
- break;
- }
-
- case BodyParserLastCRLFEnd:
- if (*Char == '\n') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserComplete;
- Char++;
- if (Parser->Callback != NULL) {
- Status = Parser->Callback (
- BodyParseEventOnComplete,
- Char,
- 0,
- Parser->Context
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
- break;
- } else {
- Parser->State = BodyParserStateMax;
- break;
- }
-
- case BodyParserTrailer:
- if (*Char == '\r') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkSizeEndCR;
- }
- Char++;
- break;
-
- case BodyParserChunkDataStart:
- //
- // First byte of chunk-data, the chunk data also might be truncated.
- //
- RemainderLengthInThis = BodyLength - (Char - Body);
- LengthForCallback = MIN (Parser->CurrentChunkSize - Parser->CurrentChunkParsedSize, RemainderLengthInThis);
- if (Parser->Callback != NULL) {
- Status = Parser->Callback (
- BodyParseEventOnData,
- Char,
- LengthForCallback,
- Parser->Context
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
- Char += LengthForCallback;
- Parser->ContentLength += LengthForCallback;
- Parser->CurrentChunkParsedSize += LengthForCallback;
- if (Parser->CurrentChunkParsedSize == Parser->CurrentChunkSize) {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkDataEnd;
- }
- break;
-
- case BodyParserChunkDataEnd:
- if (*Char == '\r') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkDataEndCR;
- } else {
- Parser->State = BodyParserStateMax;
- }
- Char++;
- break;
-
- case BodyParserChunkDataEndCR:
- if (*Char != '\n') {
- Parser->State = BodyParserStateMax;
- break;
- }
- Char++;
- Parser->State = BodyParserChunkSizeStart;
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-
- }
-
- if (Parser->State == BodyParserStateMax) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the message-body is complete or not.
-
- @param[in] MsgParser Pointer to the message parser.
-
- @retval TRUE Message-body is complete.
- @retval FALSE Message-body is not complete.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-HttpIsMessageComplete (
- IN VOID *MsgParser
- )
-{
- HTTP_BODY_PARSER *Parser;
-
- Parser = (HTTP_BODY_PARSER*) MsgParser;
-
- if (Parser->State == BodyParserComplete) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the content length of the entity.
-
- Note that in trunk transfer, the entity length is not valid until the whole message body is received.
-
- @param[in] MsgParser Pointer to the message parser.
- @param[out] ContentLength Pointer to store the length of the entity.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully to get the entity length.
- @retval EFI_NOT_READY Entity length is not valid yet.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER MsgParser is NULL or ContentLength is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HttpGetEntityLength (
- IN VOID *MsgParser,
- OUT UINTN *ContentLength
- )
-{
- HTTP_BODY_PARSER *Parser;
-
- if (MsgParser == NULL || ContentLength == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Parser = (HTTP_BODY_PARSER*) MsgParser;
-
- if (!Parser->ContentLengthIsValid) {
- return EFI_NOT_READY;
- }
-
- *ContentLength = Parser->ContentLength;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Release the resource of the message parser.
-
- @param[in] MsgParser Pointer to the message parser.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-HttpFreeMsgParser (
- IN VOID *MsgParser
- )
-{
- FreePool (MsgParser);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index e26f6fa691..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,42 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# It provides the helper routines to parse the HTTP message byte stream.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeHttpLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeHttpLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = ABBAB4CD-EA88-45b9-8234-C8A7450531FC
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = HttpLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeHttpLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 806c443929..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeHttpLib/DxeHttpLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index cc93c2b89c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2150 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- IpIo Library.
-
-(C) Copyright 2014 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P.<BR>
-Copyright (c) 2005 - 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/Udp4.h>
-
-#include <Library/IpIoLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/DpcLib.h>
-
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED LIST_ENTRY mActiveIpIoList = {
- &mActiveIpIoList,
- &mActiveIpIoList
-};
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED EFI_IP4_CONFIG_DATA mIp4IoDefaultIpConfigData = {
- EFI_IP_PROTO_UDP,
- FALSE,
- TRUE,
- FALSE,
- FALSE,
- FALSE,
- {{0, 0, 0, 0}},
- {{0, 0, 0, 0}},
- 0,
- 255,
- FALSE,
- FALSE,
- 0,
- 0
-};
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED EFI_IP6_CONFIG_DATA mIp6IoDefaultIpConfigData = {
- EFI_IP_PROTO_UDP,
- FALSE,
- TRUE,
- FALSE,
- {{0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0}},
- {{0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0}},
- 0,
- 255,
- 0,
- 0,
- 0
-};
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED ICMP_ERROR_INFO mIcmpErrMap[10] = {
- {FALSE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_NET
- {FALSE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_HOST
- {TRUE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_PROTOCOL
- {TRUE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_PORT
- {TRUE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_MSGSIZE
- {FALSE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_SRCFAIL
- {FALSE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_TIMXCEED_INTRANS
- {FALSE, TRUE }, // ICMP_ERR_TIMEXCEED_REASS
- {FALSE, FALSE}, // ICMP_ERR_QUENCH
- {FALSE, TRUE } // ICMP_ERR_PARAMPROB
-};
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED ICMP_ERROR_INFO mIcmp6ErrMap[10] = {
- {FALSE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_NET
- {FALSE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_HOST
- {TRUE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_PROTOCOL
- {TRUE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_PORT
- {TRUE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_PACKAGE_TOOBIG
- {FALSE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_TIMXCEED_HOPLIMIT
- {FALSE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_TIMXCEED_REASS
- {FALSE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_HEADER
- {FALSE, TRUE}, // ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_NEXHEADER
- {FALSE, TRUE} // ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_IPV6OPTION
-};
-
-
-/**
- Notify function for IP transmit token.
-
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoTransmitHandlerDpc (
- IN VOID *Context
- );
-
-
-/**
- Notify function for IP transmit token.
-
- @param[in] Event The event signaled.
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoTransmitHandler (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- );
-
-
-/**
- This function create an IP child ,open the IP protocol, and return the opened
- IP protocol as Interface.
-
- @param[in] ControllerHandle The controller handle.
- @param[in] ImageHandle The image handle.
- @param[in] ChildHandle Pointer to the buffer to save the IP child handle.
- @param[in] IpVersion The version of the IP protocol to use, either
- IPv4 or IPv6.
- @param[out] Interface Pointer used to get the IP protocol interface.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The IP child is created and the IP protocol
- interface is retrieved.
- @retval Others The required operation failed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-IpIoCreateIpChildOpenProtocol (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ControllerHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE *ChildHandle,
- IN UINT8 IpVersion,
- OUT VOID **Interface
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_GUID *ServiceBindingGuid;
- EFI_GUID *IpProtocolGuid;
-
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiIp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- IpProtocolGuid = &gEfiIp4ProtocolGuid;
- } else if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6){
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiIp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- IpProtocolGuid = &gEfiIp6ProtocolGuid;
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Create an IP child.
- //
- Status = NetLibCreateServiceChild (
- ControllerHandle,
- ImageHandle,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- ChildHandle
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Open the IP protocol installed on the *ChildHandle.
- //
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- *ChildHandle,
- IpProtocolGuid,
- Interface,
- ImageHandle,
- ControllerHandle,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_DRIVER
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // On failure, destroy the IP child.
- //
- NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- ControllerHandle,
- ImageHandle,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- *ChildHandle
- );
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- This function close the previously openned IP protocol and destroy the IP child.
-
- @param[in] ControllerHandle The controller handle.
- @param[in] ImageHandle The image handle.
- @param[in] ChildHandle The child handle of the IP child.
- @param[in] IpVersion The version of the IP protocol to use, either
- IPv4 or IPv6.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The IP protocol is closed and the relevant IP child
- is destroyed.
- @retval Others The required operation failed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-IpIoCloseProtocolDestroyIpChild (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ControllerHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ChildHandle,
- IN UINT8 IpVersion
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_GUID *ServiceBindingGuid;
- EFI_GUID *IpProtocolGuid;
-
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiIp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- IpProtocolGuid = &gEfiIp4ProtocolGuid;
- } else if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6) {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiIp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- IpProtocolGuid = &gEfiIp6ProtocolGuid;
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Close the previously openned IP protocol.
- //
- gBS->CloseProtocol (
- ChildHandle,
- IpProtocolGuid,
- ImageHandle,
- ControllerHandle
- );
-
- //
- // Destroy the IP child.
- //
- Status = NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- ControllerHandle,
- ImageHandle,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- ChildHandle
- );
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function handles ICMPv4 packets. It is the worker function of
- IpIoIcmpHandler.
-
- @param[in] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in, out] Pkt Pointer to the ICMPv4 packet.
- @param[in] Session Pointer to the net session of this ICMPv4 packet.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The ICMPv4 packet is handled successfully.
- @retval EFI_ABORTED This type of ICMPv4 packet is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-IpIoIcmpv4Handler (
- IN IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Pkt,
- IN EFI_NET_SESSION_DATA *Session
- )
-{
- IP4_ICMP_ERROR_HEAD *IcmpHdr;
- EFI_IP4_HEADER *IpHdr;
- UINT8 IcmpErr;
- UINT8 *PayLoadHdr;
- UINT8 Type;
- UINT8 Code;
- UINT32 TrimBytes;
-
- ASSERT (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4);
-
- IcmpHdr = NET_PROTO_HDR (Pkt, IP4_ICMP_ERROR_HEAD);
- IpHdr = (EFI_IP4_HEADER *) (&IcmpHdr->IpHead);
-
- //
- // Check the ICMP packet length.
- //
- if (Pkt->TotalSize < ICMP_ERRLEN (IpHdr)) {
-
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- Type = IcmpHdr->Head.Type;
- Code = IcmpHdr->Head.Code;
-
- //
- // Analyze the ICMP Error in this ICMP pkt
- //
- switch (Type) {
- case ICMP_TYPE_UNREACH:
- switch (Code) {
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_NET:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_HOST:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_PROTOCOL:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_PORT:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_SRCFAIL:
- IcmpErr = (UINT8) (ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_NET + Code);
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_NEEDFRAG:
- IcmpErr = ICMP_ERR_MSGSIZE;
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_NET_UNKNOWN:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_NET_PROHIB:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_TOSNET:
- IcmpErr = ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_NET;
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_HOST_UNKNOWN:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_ISOLATED:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_HOST_PROHIB:
- case ICMP_CODE_UNREACH_TOSHOST:
- IcmpErr = ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_HOST;
-
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_TYPE_TIMXCEED:
- if (Code > 1) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpErr = (UINT8) (Code + ICMP_ERR_TIMXCEED_INTRANS);
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_TYPE_PARAMPROB:
- if (Code > 1) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpErr = ICMP_ERR_PARAMPROB;
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_TYPE_SOURCEQUENCH:
- if (Code != 0) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpErr = ICMP_ERR_QUENCH;
-
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Notify user the ICMP pkt only containing payload except
- // IP and ICMP header
- //
- PayLoadHdr = (UINT8 *) ((UINT8 *) IpHdr + EFI_IP4_HEADER_LEN (IpHdr));
- TrimBytes = (UINT32) (PayLoadHdr - (UINT8 *) IcmpHdr);
-
- NetbufTrim (Pkt, TrimBytes, TRUE);
-
- IpIo->PktRcvdNotify (EFI_ICMP_ERROR, IcmpErr, Session, Pkt, IpIo->RcvdContext);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function handles ICMPv6 packets. It is the worker function of
- IpIoIcmpHandler.
-
- @param[in] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in, out] Pkt Pointer to the ICMPv6 packet.
- @param[in] Session Pointer to the net session of this ICMPv6 packet.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The ICMPv6 packet is handled successfully.
- @retval EFI_ABORTED This type of ICMPv6 packet is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-IpIoIcmpv6Handler (
- IN IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Pkt,
- IN EFI_NET_SESSION_DATA *Session
- )
-{
- IP6_ICMP_ERROR_HEAD *IcmpHdr;
- EFI_IP6_HEADER *IpHdr;
- UINT8 IcmpErr;
- UINT8 *PayLoadHdr;
- UINT8 Type;
- UINT8 Code;
- UINT8 NextHeader;
- UINT32 TrimBytes;
- BOOLEAN Flag;
-
- ASSERT (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6);
-
- //
- // Check the ICMPv6 packet length.
- //
- if (Pkt->TotalSize < sizeof (IP6_ICMP_ERROR_HEAD)) {
-
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpHdr = NET_PROTO_HDR (Pkt, IP6_ICMP_ERROR_HEAD);
- Type = IcmpHdr->Head.Type;
- Code = IcmpHdr->Head.Code;
-
- //
- // Analyze the ICMPv6 Error in this ICMPv6 packet
- //
- switch (Type) {
- case ICMP_V6_DEST_UNREACHABLE:
- switch (Code) {
- case ICMP_V6_NO_ROUTE_TO_DEST:
- case ICMP_V6_BEYOND_SCOPE:
- case ICMP_V6_ROUTE_REJECTED:
- IcmpErr = ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_NET;
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_V6_COMM_PROHIBITED:
- case ICMP_V6_ADDR_UNREACHABLE:
- case ICMP_V6_SOURCE_ADDR_FAILED:
- IcmpErr = ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_HOST;
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_V6_PORT_UNREACHABLE:
- IcmpErr = ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_PORT;
-
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_V6_PACKET_TOO_BIG:
- if (Code >= 1) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpErr = ICMP6_ERR_PACKAGE_TOOBIG;
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_V6_TIME_EXCEEDED:
- if (Code > 1) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpErr = (UINT8) (ICMP6_ERR_TIMXCEED_HOPLIMIT + Code);
-
- break;
-
- case ICMP_V6_PARAMETER_PROBLEM:
- if (Code > 3) {
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- IcmpErr = (UINT8) (ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_HEADER + Code);
-
- break;
-
- default:
-
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Notify user the ICMPv6 packet only containing payload except
- // IPv6 basic header, extension header and ICMP header
- //
-
- IpHdr = (EFI_IP6_HEADER *) (&IcmpHdr->IpHead);
- NextHeader = IpHdr->NextHeader;
- PayLoadHdr = (UINT8 *) ((UINT8 *) IcmpHdr + sizeof (IP6_ICMP_ERROR_HEAD));
- Flag = TRUE;
-
- do {
- switch (NextHeader) {
- case EFI_IP_PROTO_UDP:
- case EFI_IP_PROTO_TCP:
- case EFI_IP_PROTO_ICMP:
- case IP6_NO_NEXT_HEADER:
- Flag = FALSE;
-
- break;
-
- case IP6_HOP_BY_HOP:
- case IP6_DESTINATION:
- //
- // The Hdr Ext Len is 8-bit unsigned integer in 8-octet units, not including
- // the first 8 octets.
- //
- NextHeader = *(PayLoadHdr);
- PayLoadHdr = (UINT8 *) (PayLoadHdr + (*(PayLoadHdr + 1) + 1) * 8);
-
- break;
-
- case IP6_FRAGMENT:
- //
- // The Fragment Header Length is 8 octets.
- //
- NextHeader = *(PayLoadHdr);
- PayLoadHdr = (UINT8 *) (PayLoadHdr + 8);
-
- break;
-
- default:
-
- return EFI_ABORTED;
- }
- } while (Flag);
-
- TrimBytes = (UINT32) (PayLoadHdr - (UINT8 *) IcmpHdr);
-
- NetbufTrim (Pkt, TrimBytes, TRUE);
-
- IpIo->PktRcvdNotify (EFI_ICMP_ERROR, IcmpErr, Session, Pkt, IpIo->RcvdContext);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function handles ICMP packets.
-
- @param[in] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in, out] Pkt Pointer to the ICMP packet.
- @param[in] Session Pointer to the net session of this ICMP packet.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The ICMP packet is handled successfully.
- @retval EFI_ABORTED This type of ICMP packet is not supported.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The IP protocol version in IP_IO is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-IpIoIcmpHandler (
- IN IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Pkt,
- IN EFI_NET_SESSION_DATA *Session
- )
-{
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
-
- return IpIoIcmpv4Handler (IpIo, Pkt, Session);
-
- } else if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6) {
-
- return IpIoIcmpv6Handler (IpIo, Pkt, Session);
-
- } else {
-
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Free function for receive token of IP_IO. It is used to
- signal the recycle event to notify IP to recycle the
- data buffer.
-
- @param[in] Event The event to be signaled.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoExtFree (
- IN VOID *Event
- )
-{
- gBS->SignalEvent ((EFI_EVENT) Event);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Create a send entry to wrap a packet before sending
- out it through IP.
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in, out] Pkt Pointer to the packet.
- @param[in] Sender Pointer to the IP sender.
- @param[in] Context Pointer to the context.
- @param[in] NotifyData Pointer to the notify data.
- @param[in] Dest Pointer to the destination IP address.
- @param[in] Override Pointer to the overriden IP_IO data.
-
- @return Pointer to the data structure created to wrap the packet. If NULL,
- @return resource limit occurred.
-
-**/
-IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *
-IpIoCreateSndEntry (
- IN OUT IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Pkt,
- IN IP_IO_IP_PROTOCOL Sender,
- IN VOID *Context OPTIONAL,
- IN VOID *NotifyData OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_IP_ADDRESS *Dest OPTIONAL,
- IN IP_IO_OVERRIDE *Override
- )
-{
- IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *SndEntry;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- NET_FRAGMENT *ExtFragment;
- UINT32 FragmentCount;
- IP_IO_OVERRIDE *OverrideData;
- IP_IO_IP_TX_DATA *TxData;
- EFI_IP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *Ip4TxData;
- EFI_IP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *Ip6TxData;
-
- if ((IpIo->IpVersion != IP_VERSION_4) && (IpIo->IpVersion != IP_VERSION_6)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Event = NULL;
- TxData = NULL;
- OverrideData = NULL;
-
- //
- // Allocate resource for SndEntry
- //
- SndEntry = AllocatePool (sizeof (IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY));
- if (NULL == SndEntry) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- IpIoTransmitHandler,
- SndEntry,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- FragmentCount = Pkt->BlockOpNum;
-
- //
- // Allocate resource for TxData
- //
- TxData = (IP_IO_IP_TX_DATA *) AllocatePool (
- sizeof (IP_IO_IP_TX_DATA) + sizeof (NET_FRAGMENT) * (FragmentCount - 1)
- );
-
- if (NULL == TxData) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- //
- // Build a fragment table to contain the fragments in the packet.
- //
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- ExtFragment = (NET_FRAGMENT *) TxData->Ip4TxData.FragmentTable;
- } else {
- ExtFragment = (NET_FRAGMENT *) TxData->Ip6TxData.FragmentTable;
- }
-
- NetbufBuildExt (Pkt, ExtFragment, &FragmentCount);
-
-
- //
- // Allocate resource for OverrideData if needed
- //
- if (NULL != Override) {
-
- OverrideData = AllocateCopyPool (sizeof (IP_IO_OVERRIDE), Override);
- if (NULL == OverrideData) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Set other fields of TxData except the fragment table
- //
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
-
- Ip4TxData = &TxData->Ip4TxData;
-
- IP4_COPY_ADDRESS (&Ip4TxData->DestinationAddress, Dest);
-
- Ip4TxData->OverrideData = &OverrideData->Ip4OverrideData;
- Ip4TxData->OptionsLength = 0;
- Ip4TxData->OptionsBuffer = NULL;
- Ip4TxData->TotalDataLength = Pkt->TotalSize;
- Ip4TxData->FragmentCount = FragmentCount;
-
- //
- // Set the fields of SndToken
- //
- SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token.Event = Event;
- SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token.Packet.TxData = Ip4TxData;
- } else {
-
- Ip6TxData = &TxData->Ip6TxData;
-
- if (Dest != NULL) {
- CopyMem (&Ip6TxData->DestinationAddress, Dest, sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS));
- } else {
- ZeroMem (&Ip6TxData->DestinationAddress, sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS));
- }
-
- Ip6TxData->OverrideData = &OverrideData->Ip6OverrideData;
- Ip6TxData->DataLength = Pkt->TotalSize;
- Ip6TxData->FragmentCount = FragmentCount;
- Ip6TxData->ExtHdrsLength = 0;
- Ip6TxData->ExtHdrs = NULL;
-
- //
- // Set the fields of SndToken
- //
- SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token.Event = Event;
- SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token.Packet.TxData = Ip6TxData;
- }
-
- //
- // Set the fields of SndEntry
- //
- SndEntry->IpIo = IpIo;
- SndEntry->Ip = Sender;
- SndEntry->Context = Context;
- SndEntry->NotifyData = NotifyData;
-
- SndEntry->Pkt = Pkt;
- NET_GET_REF (Pkt);
-
- InsertTailList (&IpIo->PendingSndList, &SndEntry->Entry);
-
- return SndEntry;
-
-ON_ERROR:
-
- if (OverrideData != NULL) {
- FreePool (OverrideData);
- }
-
- if (TxData != NULL) {
- FreePool (TxData);
- }
-
- if (SndEntry != NULL) {
- FreePool (SndEntry);
- }
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Destroy the SndEntry.
-
- This function pairs with IpIoCreateSndEntry().
-
- @param[in] SndEntry Pointer to the send entry to be destroyed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-IpIoDestroySndEntry (
- IN IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *SndEntry
- )
-{
- EFI_EVENT Event;
- IP_IO_IP_TX_DATA *TxData;
- IP_IO_OVERRIDE *Override;
-
- if (SndEntry->IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Event = SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token.Event;
- TxData = (IP_IO_IP_TX_DATA *) SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token.Packet.TxData;
- Override = (IP_IO_OVERRIDE *) TxData->Ip4TxData.OverrideData;
- } else if (SndEntry->IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6) {
- Event = SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token.Event;
- TxData = (IP_IO_IP_TX_DATA *) SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token.Packet.TxData;
- Override = (IP_IO_OVERRIDE *) TxData->Ip6TxData.OverrideData;
- } else {
- return ;
- }
-
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
-
- FreePool (TxData);
-
- if (NULL != Override) {
- FreePool (Override);
- }
-
- NetbufFree (SndEntry->Pkt);
-
- RemoveEntryList (&SndEntry->Entry);
-
- FreePool (SndEntry);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Notify function for IP transmit token.
-
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoTransmitHandlerDpc (
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- IP_IO *IpIo;
- IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *SndEntry;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- SndEntry = (IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *) Context;
-
- IpIo = SndEntry->IpIo;
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Status = SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token.Status;
- } else if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6){
- Status = SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token.Status;
- } else {
- return ;
- }
-
- if ((IpIo->PktSentNotify != NULL) && (SndEntry->NotifyData != NULL)) {
- IpIo->PktSentNotify (
- Status,
- SndEntry->Context,
- SndEntry->Ip,
- SndEntry->NotifyData
- );
- }
-
- IpIoDestroySndEntry (SndEntry);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Notify function for IP transmit token.
-
- @param[in] Event The event signaled.
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoTransmitHandler (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- //
- // Request IpIoTransmitHandlerDpc as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK
- //
- QueueDpc (TPL_CALLBACK, IpIoTransmitHandlerDpc, Context);
-}
-
-
-/**
- The dummy handler for the dummy IP receive token.
-
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoDummyHandlerDpc (
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- IP_IO_IP_INFO *IpInfo;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_EVENT RecycleEvent;
-
- IpInfo = (IP_IO_IP_INFO *) Context;
-
- if ((IpInfo->IpVersion != IP_VERSION_4) && (IpInfo->IpVersion != IP_VERSION_6)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- RecycleEvent = NULL;
-
- if (IpInfo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Status = IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token.Status;
-
- if (IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token.Packet.RxData != NULL) {
- RecycleEvent = IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token.Packet.RxData->RecycleSignal;
- }
- } else {
- Status = IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token.Status;
-
- if (IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token.Packet.RxData != NULL) {
- RecycleEvent = IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token.Packet.RxData->RecycleSignal;
- }
- }
-
-
-
- if (EFI_ABORTED == Status) {
- //
- // The reception is actively aborted by the consumer, directly return.
- //
- return;
- } else if (EFI_SUCCESS == Status) {
- //
- // Recycle the RxData.
- //
- ASSERT (RecycleEvent != NULL);
-
- gBS->SignalEvent (RecycleEvent);
- }
-
- //
- // Continue the receive.
- //
- if (IpInfo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip4->Receive (
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip4,
- &IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token
- );
- } else {
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip6->Receive (
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip6,
- &IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token
- );
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- This function add IpIoDummyHandlerDpc to the end of the DPC queue.
-
- @param[in] Event The event signaled.
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoDummyHandler (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- //
- // Request IpIoDummyHandlerDpc as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK
- //
- QueueDpc (TPL_CALLBACK, IpIoDummyHandlerDpc, Context);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Notify function for the IP receive token, used to process
- the received IP packets.
-
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoListenHandlerDpc (
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- IP_IO *IpIo;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IP_IO_IP_RX_DATA *RxData;
- EFI_NET_SESSION_DATA Session;
- NET_BUF *Pkt;
-
- IpIo = (IP_IO *) Context;
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Status = IpIo->RcvToken.Ip4Token.Status;
- RxData = (IP_IO_IP_RX_DATA *) IpIo->RcvToken.Ip4Token.Packet.RxData;
- } else if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6) {
- Status = IpIo->RcvToken.Ip6Token.Status;
- RxData = (IP_IO_IP_RX_DATA *) IpIo->RcvToken.Ip6Token.Packet.RxData;
- } else {
- return;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ABORTED == Status) {
- //
- // The reception is actively aborted by the consumer, directly return.
- //
- return;
- }
-
- if (((EFI_SUCCESS != Status) && (EFI_ICMP_ERROR != Status)) || (NULL == RxData)) {
- //
- // @bug Only process the normal packets and the icmp error packets, if RxData is NULL
- // @bug with Status == EFI_SUCCESS or EFI_ICMP_ERROR, just resume the receive although
- // @bug this should be a bug of the low layer (IP).
- //
- goto Resume;
- }
-
- if (NULL == IpIo->PktRcvdNotify) {
- goto CleanUp;
- }
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- if ((EFI_IP4 (RxData->Ip4RxData.Header->SourceAddress) != 0) &&
- !NetIp4IsUnicast (EFI_NTOHL (((EFI_IP4_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->Header->SourceAddress), 0)) {
- //
- // The source address is not zero and it's not a unicast IP address, discard it.
- //
- goto CleanUp;
- }
-
- //
- // Create a netbuffer representing IPv4 packet
- //
- Pkt = NetbufFromExt (
- (NET_FRAGMENT *) RxData->Ip4RxData.FragmentTable,
- RxData->Ip4RxData.FragmentCount,
- 0,
- 0,
- IpIoExtFree,
- RxData->Ip4RxData.RecycleSignal
- );
- if (NULL == Pkt) {
- goto CleanUp;
- }
-
- //
- // Create a net session
- //
- Session.Source.Addr[0] = EFI_IP4 (RxData->Ip4RxData.Header->SourceAddress);
- Session.Dest.Addr[0] = EFI_IP4 (RxData->Ip4RxData.Header->DestinationAddress);
- Session.IpHdr.Ip4Hdr = RxData->Ip4RxData.Header;
- Session.IpHdrLen = RxData->Ip4RxData.HeaderLength;
- Session.IpVersion = IP_VERSION_4;
- } else {
-
- if (!NetIp6IsValidUnicast(&RxData->Ip6RxData.Header->SourceAddress)) {
- goto CleanUp;
- }
-
- //
- // Create a netbuffer representing IPv6 packet
- //
- Pkt = NetbufFromExt (
- (NET_FRAGMENT *) RxData->Ip6RxData.FragmentTable,
- RxData->Ip6RxData.FragmentCount,
- 0,
- 0,
- IpIoExtFree,
- RxData->Ip6RxData.RecycleSignal
- );
- if (NULL == Pkt) {
- goto CleanUp;
- }
-
- //
- // Create a net session
- //
- CopyMem (
- &Session.Source,
- &RxData->Ip6RxData.Header->SourceAddress,
- sizeof(EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
- CopyMem (
- &Session.Dest,
- &RxData->Ip6RxData.Header->DestinationAddress,
- sizeof(EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
- Session.IpHdr.Ip6Hdr = RxData->Ip6RxData.Header;
- Session.IpHdrLen = RxData->Ip6RxData.HeaderLength;
- Session.IpVersion = IP_VERSION_6;
- }
-
- if (EFI_SUCCESS == Status) {
-
- IpIo->PktRcvdNotify (EFI_SUCCESS, 0, &Session, Pkt, IpIo->RcvdContext);
- } else {
- //
- // Status is EFI_ICMP_ERROR
- //
- Status = IpIoIcmpHandler (IpIo, Pkt, &Session);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- NetbufFree (Pkt);
- }
- }
-
- goto Resume;
-
-CleanUp:
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- gBS->SignalEvent (RxData->Ip4RxData.RecycleSignal);
- } else {
- gBS->SignalEvent (RxData->Ip6RxData.RecycleSignal);
- }
-
-Resume:
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- IpIo->Ip.Ip4->Receive (IpIo->Ip.Ip4, &(IpIo->RcvToken.Ip4Token));
- } else {
- IpIo->Ip.Ip6->Receive (IpIo->Ip.Ip6, &(IpIo->RcvToken.Ip6Token));
- }
-}
-
-/**
- This function add IpIoListenHandlerDpc to the end of the DPC queue.
-
- @param[in] Event The event signaled.
- @param[in] Context The context passed in by the event notifier.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoListenHandler (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- //
- // Request IpIoListenHandlerDpc as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK
- //
- QueueDpc (TPL_CALLBACK, IpIoListenHandlerDpc, Context);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Create a new IP_IO instance.
-
- This function uses IP4/IP6 service binding protocol in Controller to create
- an IP4/IP6 child (aka IP4/IP6 instance).
-
- @param[in] Image The image handle of the driver or application that
- consumes IP_IO.
- @param[in] Controller The controller handle that has IP4 or IP6 service
- binding protocol installed.
- @param[in] IpVersion The version of the IP protocol to use, either
- IPv4 or IPv6.
-
- @return Pointer to a newly created IP_IO instance, or NULL if failed.
-
-**/
-IP_IO *
-EFIAPI
-IpIoCreate (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Image,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN UINT8 IpVersion
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IP_IO *IpIo;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
-
- ASSERT ((IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) || (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6));
-
- IpIo = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (IP_IO));
- if (NULL == IpIo) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- InitializeListHead (&(IpIo->PendingSndList));
- InitializeListHead (&(IpIo->IpList));
- IpIo->Controller = Controller;
- IpIo->Image = Image;
- IpIo->IpVersion = IpVersion;
- Event = NULL;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- IpIoListenHandler,
- IpIo,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ReleaseIpIo;
- }
-
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- IpIo->RcvToken.Ip4Token.Event = Event;
- } else {
- IpIo->RcvToken.Ip6Token.Event = Event;
- }
-
- //
- // Create an IP child and open IP protocol
- //
- Status = IpIoCreateIpChildOpenProtocol (
- Controller,
- Image,
- &IpIo->ChildHandle,
- IpVersion,
- (VOID **)&(IpIo->Ip)
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ReleaseIpIo;
- }
-
- return IpIo;
-
-ReleaseIpIo:
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- gBS->FreePool (IpIo);
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Open an IP_IO instance for use.
-
- This function is called after IpIoCreate(). It is used for configuring the IP
- instance and register the callbacks and their context data for sending and
- receiving IP packets.
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to an IP_IO instance that needs
- to open.
- @param[in] OpenData The configuration data and callbacks for
- the IP_IO instance.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The IP_IO instance opened with OpenData
- successfully.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED The IP_IO instance is configured, avoid to
- reopen it.
- @retval Others Error condition occurred.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpIoOpen (
- IN OUT IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN IP_IO_OPEN_DATA *OpenData
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT8 IpVersion;
-
- if (IpIo->IsConfigured) {
- return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- }
-
- IpVersion = IpIo->IpVersion;
-
- ASSERT ((IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) || (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6));
-
- //
- // configure ip
- //
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip4->Configure (
- IpIo->Ip.Ip4,
- &OpenData->IpConfigData.Ip4CfgData
- );
- } else {
-
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip6->Configure (
- IpIo->Ip.Ip6,
- &OpenData->IpConfigData.Ip6CfgData
- );
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // @bug To delete the default route entry in this Ip, if it is:
- // @bug (0.0.0.0, 0.0.0.0, 0.0.0.0). Delete this statement if Ip modified
- // @bug its code
- //
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip4->Routes (
- IpIo->Ip.Ip4,
- TRUE,
- &mZeroIp4Addr,
- &mZeroIp4Addr,
- &mZeroIp4Addr
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) && (EFI_NOT_FOUND != Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
-
- IpIo->PktRcvdNotify = OpenData->PktRcvdNotify;
- IpIo->PktSentNotify = OpenData->PktSentNotify;
-
- IpIo->RcvdContext = OpenData->RcvdContext;
- IpIo->SndContext = OpenData->SndContext;
-
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- IpIo->Protocol = OpenData->IpConfigData.Ip4CfgData.DefaultProtocol;
-
- //
- // start to listen incoming packet
- //
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip4->Receive (
- IpIo->Ip.Ip4,
- &(IpIo->RcvToken.Ip4Token)
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- IpIo->Ip.Ip4->Configure (IpIo->Ip.Ip4, NULL);
- goto ErrorExit;
- }
-
- } else {
-
- IpIo->Protocol = OpenData->IpConfigData.Ip6CfgData.DefaultProtocol;
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip6->Receive (
- IpIo->Ip.Ip6,
- &(IpIo->RcvToken.Ip6Token)
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- IpIo->Ip.Ip6->Configure (IpIo->Ip.Ip6, NULL);
- goto ErrorExit;
- }
- }
-
- IpIo->IsConfigured = TRUE;
- InsertTailList (&mActiveIpIoList, &IpIo->Entry);
-
-ErrorExit:
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Stop an IP_IO instance.
-
- This function is paired with IpIoOpen(). The IP_IO will be unconfigured and all
- the pending send/receive tokens will be canceled.
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance that needs to stop.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The IP_IO instance stopped successfully.
- @retval Others Error condition occurred.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpIoStop (
- IN OUT IP_IO *IpIo
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IP_IO_IP_INFO *IpInfo;
- UINT8 IpVersion;
-
- if (!IpIo->IsConfigured) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- IpVersion = IpIo->IpVersion;
-
- ASSERT ((IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) || (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6));
-
- //
- // Remove the IpIo from the active IpIo list.
- //
- RemoveEntryList (&IpIo->Entry);
-
- //
- // Configure NULL Ip
- //
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip4->Configure (IpIo->Ip.Ip4, NULL);
- } else {
- Status = IpIo->Ip.Ip6->Configure (IpIo->Ip.Ip6, NULL);
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- IpIo->IsConfigured = FALSE;
-
- //
- // Detroy the Ip List used by IpIo
- //
-
- while (!IsListEmpty (&(IpIo->IpList))) {
- IpInfo = NET_LIST_HEAD (&(IpIo->IpList), IP_IO_IP_INFO, Entry);
-
- IpIoRemoveIp (IpIo, IpInfo);
- }
-
- //
- // All pending send tokens should be flushed by reseting the IP instances.
- //
- ASSERT (IsListEmpty (&IpIo->PendingSndList));
-
- //
- // Close the receive event.
- //
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- gBS->CloseEvent (IpIo->RcvToken.Ip4Token.Event);
- } else {
- gBS->CloseEvent (IpIo->RcvToken.Ip6Token.Event);
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Destroy an IP_IO instance.
-
- This function is paired with IpIoCreate(). The IP_IO will be closed first.
- Resource will be freed afterwards. See IpIoCloseProtocolDestroyIpChild().
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance that needs to be
- destroyed.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The IP_IO instance destroyed successfully.
- @retval Others Error condition occurred.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpIoDestroy (
- IN OUT IP_IO *IpIo
- )
-{
- //
- // Stop the IpIo.
- //
- IpIoStop (IpIo);
-
- //
- // Close the IP protocol and destroy the child.
- //
- IpIoCloseProtocolDestroyIpChild (
- IpIo->Controller,
- IpIo->Image,
- IpIo->ChildHandle,
- IpIo->IpVersion
- );
-
- gBS->FreePool (IpIo);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Send out an IP packet.
-
- This function is called after IpIoOpen(). The data to be sent are wrapped in
- Pkt. The IP instance wrapped in IpIo is used for sending by default but can be
- overriden by Sender. Other sending configs, like source address and gateway
- address etc., are specified in OverrideData.
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to an IP_IO instance used for sending IP
- packet.
- @param[in, out] Pkt Pointer to the IP packet to be sent.
- @param[in] Sender The IP protocol instance used for sending.
- @param[in] Context Optional context data.
- @param[in] NotifyData Optional notify data.
- @param[in] Dest The destination IP address to send this packet to.
- @param[in] OverrideData The data to override some configuration of the IP
- instance used for sending.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation is completed successfully.
- @retval EFI_NOT_STARTED The IpIo is not configured.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpIoSend (
- IN OUT IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Pkt,
- IN IP_IO_IP_INFO *Sender OPTIONAL,
- IN VOID *Context OPTIONAL,
- IN VOID *NotifyData OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_IP_ADDRESS *Dest,
- IN IP_IO_OVERRIDE *OverrideData OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IP_IO_IP_PROTOCOL Ip;
- IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *SndEntry;
-
- ASSERT ((IpIo->IpVersion != IP_VERSION_4) || (Dest != NULL));
-
- if (!IpIo->IsConfigured) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- Ip = (NULL == Sender) ? IpIo->Ip : Sender->Ip;
-
- //
- // create a new SndEntry
- //
- SndEntry = IpIoCreateSndEntry (IpIo, Pkt, Ip, Context, NotifyData, Dest, OverrideData);
- if (NULL == SndEntry) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Send this Packet
- //
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- Status = Ip.Ip4->Transmit (
- Ip.Ip4,
- &SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token
- );
- } else {
- Status = Ip.Ip6->Transmit (
- Ip.Ip6,
- &SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token
- );
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- IpIoDestroySndEntry (SndEntry);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Cancel the IP transmit token which wraps this Packet.
-
- @param[in] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in] Packet Pointer to the packet of NET_BUF to cancel.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoCancelTxToken (
- IN IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN VOID *Packet
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Node;
- IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY *SndEntry;
- IP_IO_IP_PROTOCOL Ip;
-
- ASSERT ((IpIo != NULL) && (Packet != NULL));
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (Node, &IpIo->PendingSndList) {
-
- SndEntry = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Node, IP_IO_SEND_ENTRY, Entry);
-
- if (SndEntry->Pkt == Packet) {
-
- Ip = SndEntry->Ip;
-
- if (IpIo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Ip.Ip4->Cancel (
- Ip.Ip4,
- &SndEntry->SndToken.Ip4Token
- );
- } else {
- Ip.Ip6->Cancel (
- Ip.Ip6,
- &SndEntry->SndToken.Ip6Token
- );
- }
-
- break;
- }
- }
-
-}
-
-
-/**
- Add a new IP instance for sending data.
-
- The function is used to add the IP_IO to the IP_IO sending list. The caller
- can later use IpIoFindSender() to get the IP_IO and call IpIoSend() to send
- data.
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to a IP_IO instance to add a new IP
- instance for sending purpose.
-
- @return Pointer to the created IP_IO_IP_INFO structure, NULL if failed.
-
-**/
-IP_IO_IP_INFO *
-EFIAPI
-IpIoAddIp (
- IN OUT IP_IO *IpIo
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IP_IO_IP_INFO *IpInfo;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
-
- ASSERT (IpIo != NULL);
-
- IpInfo = AllocatePool (sizeof (IP_IO_IP_INFO));
- if (IpInfo == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Init this IpInfo, set the Addr and SubnetMask to 0 before we configure the IP
- // instance.
- //
- InitializeListHead (&IpInfo->Entry);
- IpInfo->ChildHandle = NULL;
- ZeroMem (&IpInfo->Addr, sizeof (IpInfo->Addr));
- ZeroMem (&IpInfo->PreMask, sizeof (IpInfo->PreMask));
-
- IpInfo->RefCnt = 1;
- IpInfo->IpVersion = IpIo->IpVersion;
-
- //
- // Create the IP instance and open the IP protocol.
- //
- Status = IpIoCreateIpChildOpenProtocol (
- IpIo->Controller,
- IpIo->Image,
- &IpInfo->ChildHandle,
- IpInfo->IpVersion,
- (VOID **) &IpInfo->Ip
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ReleaseIpInfo;
- }
-
- //
- // Create the event for the DummyRcvToken.
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- IpIoDummyHandler,
- IpInfo,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ReleaseIpChild;
- }
-
- if (IpInfo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token.Event = Event;
- } else {
- IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token.Event = Event;
- }
-
- //
- // Link this IpInfo into the IpIo.
- //
- InsertTailList (&IpIo->IpList, &IpInfo->Entry);
-
- return IpInfo;
-
-ReleaseIpChild:
-
- IpIoCloseProtocolDestroyIpChild (
- IpIo->Controller,
- IpIo->Image,
- IpInfo->ChildHandle,
- IpInfo->IpVersion
- );
-
-ReleaseIpInfo:
-
- gBS->FreePool (IpInfo);
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Configure the IP instance of this IpInfo and start the receiving if IpConfigData
- is not NULL.
-
- @param[in, out] IpInfo Pointer to the IP_IO_IP_INFO instance.
- @param[in, out] IpConfigData The IP configure data used to configure the IP
- instance, if NULL the IP instance is reset. If
- UseDefaultAddress is set to TRUE, and the configure
- operation succeeds, the default address information
- is written back in this IpConfigData.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The IP instance of this IpInfo is configured successfully
- or no need to reconfigure it.
- @retval Others Configuration fails.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpIoConfigIp (
- IN OUT IP_IO_IP_INFO *IpInfo,
- IN OUT VOID *IpConfigData OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IP_IO_IP_PROTOCOL Ip;
- UINT8 IpVersion;
- EFI_IP4_MODE_DATA Ip4ModeData;
- EFI_IP6_MODE_DATA Ip6ModeData;
-
- ASSERT (IpInfo != NULL);
-
- if (IpInfo->RefCnt > 1) {
- //
- // This IP instance is shared, don't reconfigure it until it has only one
- // consumer. Currently, only the tcp children cloned from their passive parent
- // will share the same IP. So this cases only happens while IpConfigData is NULL,
- // let the last consumer clean the IP instance.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- IpVersion = IpInfo->IpVersion;
- ASSERT ((IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) || (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6));
-
- Ip = IpInfo->Ip;
-
- if (IpInfo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) {
- Status = Ip.Ip4->Configure (Ip.Ip4, IpConfigData);
- } else {
- Status = Ip.Ip6->Configure (Ip.Ip6, IpConfigData);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto OnExit;
- }
-
- if (IpConfigData != NULL) {
- if (IpInfo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
-
- if (((EFI_IP4_CONFIG_DATA *) IpConfigData)->UseDefaultAddress) {
- Ip.Ip4->GetModeData (
- Ip.Ip4,
- &Ip4ModeData,
- NULL,
- NULL
- );
-
- IP4_COPY_ADDRESS (&((EFI_IP4_CONFIG_DATA*) IpConfigData)->StationAddress, &Ip4ModeData.ConfigData.StationAddress);
- IP4_COPY_ADDRESS (&((EFI_IP4_CONFIG_DATA*) IpConfigData)->SubnetMask, &Ip4ModeData.ConfigData.SubnetMask);
- }
-
- CopyMem (
- &IpInfo->Addr.Addr,
- &((EFI_IP4_CONFIG_DATA *) IpConfigData)->StationAddress,
- sizeof (IP4_ADDR)
- );
- CopyMem (
- &IpInfo->PreMask.SubnetMask,
- &((EFI_IP4_CONFIG_DATA *) IpConfigData)->SubnetMask,
- sizeof (IP4_ADDR)
- );
-
- Status = Ip.Ip4->Receive (
- Ip.Ip4,
- &IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Ip.Ip4->Configure (Ip.Ip4, NULL);
- }
- } else {
- Ip.Ip6->GetModeData (
- Ip.Ip6,
- &Ip6ModeData,
- NULL,
- NULL
- );
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.IsConfigured) {
- CopyMem (
- &((EFI_IP6_CONFIG_DATA *) IpConfigData)->StationAddress,
- &Ip6ModeData.ConfigData.StationAddress,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.AddressList != NULL) {
- FreePool (Ip6ModeData.AddressList);
- }
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.GroupTable != NULL) {
- FreePool (Ip6ModeData.GroupTable);
- }
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.RouteTable != NULL) {
- FreePool (Ip6ModeData.RouteTable);
- }
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.NeighborCache != NULL) {
- FreePool (Ip6ModeData.NeighborCache);
- }
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.PrefixTable != NULL) {
- FreePool (Ip6ModeData.PrefixTable);
- }
-
- if (Ip6ModeData.IcmpTypeList != NULL) {
- FreePool (Ip6ModeData.IcmpTypeList);
- }
-
- } else {
- Status = EFI_NO_MAPPING;
- goto OnExit;
- }
-
- CopyMem (
- &IpInfo->Addr,
- &Ip6ModeData.ConfigData.StationAddress,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- Status = Ip.Ip6->Receive (
- Ip.Ip6,
- &IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Ip.Ip6->Configure (Ip.Ip6, NULL);
- }
- }
- } else {
- //
- // The IP instance is reset, set the stored Addr and SubnetMask to zero.
- //
- ZeroMem (&IpInfo->Addr, sizeof (IpInfo->Addr));
- ZeroMem (&IpInfo->PreMask, sizeof (IpInfo->PreMask));
- }
-
-OnExit:
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Destroy an IP instance maintained in IpIo->IpList for
- sending purpose.
-
- This function pairs with IpIoAddIp(). The IpInfo is previously created by
- IpIoAddIp(). The IP_IO_IP_INFO::RefCnt is decremented and the IP instance
- will be dstroyed if the RefCnt is zero.
-
- @param[in] IpIo Pointer to the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in] IpInfo Pointer to the IpInfo to be removed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-IpIoRemoveIp (
- IN IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN IP_IO_IP_INFO *IpInfo
- )
-{
-
- UINT8 IpVersion;
-
- ASSERT (IpInfo->RefCnt > 0);
-
- NET_PUT_REF (IpInfo);
-
- if (IpInfo->RefCnt > 0) {
-
- return;
- }
-
- IpVersion = IpIo->IpVersion;
-
- ASSERT ((IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) || (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6));
-
- RemoveEntryList (&IpInfo->Entry);
-
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip4->Configure (
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip4,
- NULL
- );
- IpIoCloseProtocolDestroyIpChild (
- IpIo->Controller,
- IpIo->Image,
- IpInfo->ChildHandle,
- IP_VERSION_4
- );
-
- gBS->CloseEvent (IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip4Token.Event);
-
- } else {
-
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip6->Configure (
- IpInfo->Ip.Ip6,
- NULL
- );
-
- IpIoCloseProtocolDestroyIpChild (
- IpIo->Controller,
- IpIo->Image,
- IpInfo->ChildHandle,
- IP_VERSION_6
- );
-
- gBS->CloseEvent (IpInfo->DummyRcvToken.Ip6Token.Event);
- }
-
- FreePool (IpInfo);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Find the first IP protocol maintained in IpIo whose local
- address is the same as Src.
-
- This function is called when the caller needs the IpIo to send data to the
- specified Src. The IpIo was added previously by IpIoAddIp().
-
- @param[in, out] IpIo Pointer to the pointer of the IP_IO instance.
- @param[in] IpVersion The version of the IP protocol to use, either
- IPv4 or IPv6.
- @param[in] Src The local IP address.
-
- @return Pointer to the IP protocol can be used for sending purpose and its local
- address is the same with Src.
-
-**/
-IP_IO_IP_INFO *
-EFIAPI
-IpIoFindSender (
- IN OUT IP_IO **IpIo,
- IN UINT8 IpVersion,
- IN EFI_IP_ADDRESS *Src
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *IpIoEntry;
- IP_IO *IpIoPtr;
- LIST_ENTRY *IpInfoEntry;
- IP_IO_IP_INFO *IpInfo;
-
- ASSERT ((IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4) || (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6));
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (IpIoEntry, &mActiveIpIoList) {
- IpIoPtr = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (IpIoEntry, IP_IO, Entry);
-
- if (((*IpIo != NULL) && (*IpIo != IpIoPtr)) || (IpIoPtr->IpVersion != IpVersion)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (IpInfoEntry, &IpIoPtr->IpList) {
- IpInfo = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (IpInfoEntry, IP_IO_IP_INFO, Entry);
- if (IpInfo->IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4){
-
- if (EFI_IP4_EQUAL (&IpInfo->Addr.v4, &Src->v4)) {
- *IpIo = IpIoPtr;
- return IpInfo;
- }
-
- } else {
-
- if (EFI_IP6_EQUAL (&IpInfo->Addr.v6, &Src->v6)) {
- *IpIo = IpIoPtr;
- return IpInfo;
- }
- }
-
- }
- }
-
- //
- // No match.
- //
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Get the ICMP error map information.
-
- The ErrorStatus will be returned. The IsHard and Notify are optional. If they
- are not NULL, this routine will fill them.
-
- @param[in] IcmpError IcmpError Type.
- @param[in] IpVersion The version of the IP protocol to use,
- either IPv4 or IPv6.
- @param[out] IsHard If TRUE, indicates that it is a hard error.
- @param[out] Notify If TRUE, SockError needs to be notified.
-
- @return ICMP Error Status, such as EFI_NETWORK_UNREACHABLE.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpIoGetIcmpErrStatus (
- IN UINT8 IcmpError,
- IN UINT8 IpVersion,
- OUT BOOLEAN *IsHard OPTIONAL,
- OUT BOOLEAN *Notify OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_4 ) {
- ASSERT (IcmpError <= ICMP_ERR_PARAMPROB);
-
- if (IsHard != NULL) {
- *IsHard = mIcmpErrMap[IcmpError].IsHard;
- }
-
- if (Notify != NULL) {
- *Notify = mIcmpErrMap[IcmpError].Notify;
- }
-
- switch (IcmpError) {
- case ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_NET:
- return EFI_NETWORK_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP_ERR_TIMXCEED_INTRANS:
- case ICMP_ERR_TIMXCEED_REASS:
- case ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_HOST:
- return EFI_HOST_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_PROTOCOL:
- return EFI_PROTOCOL_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_PORT:
- return EFI_PORT_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP_ERR_MSGSIZE:
- case ICMP_ERR_UNREACH_SRCFAIL:
- case ICMP_ERR_QUENCH:
- case ICMP_ERR_PARAMPROB:
- return EFI_ICMP_ERROR;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- } else if (IpVersion == IP_VERSION_6) {
-
- ASSERT (IcmpError <= ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_IPV6OPTION);
-
- if (IsHard != NULL) {
- *IsHard = mIcmp6ErrMap[IcmpError].IsHard;
- }
-
- if (Notify != NULL) {
- *Notify = mIcmp6ErrMap[IcmpError].Notify;
- }
-
- switch (IcmpError) {
- case ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_NET:
- return EFI_NETWORK_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_HOST:
- case ICMP6_ERR_TIMXCEED_HOPLIMIT:
- case ICMP6_ERR_TIMXCEED_REASS:
- return EFI_HOST_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_PROTOCOL:
- return EFI_PROTOCOL_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP6_ERR_UNREACH_PORT:
- return EFI_PORT_UNREACHABLE;
-
- case ICMP6_ERR_PACKAGE_TOOBIG:
- case ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_HEADER:
- case ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_NEXHEADER:
- case ICMP6_ERR_PARAMPROB_IPV6OPTION:
- return EFI_ICMP_ERROR;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- } else {
- //
- // Should never be here
- //
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Refresh the remote peer's Neighbor Cache entries.
-
- This function is called when the caller needs the IpIo to refresh the existing
- IPv6 neighbor cache entries since the neighbor is considered reachable by the
- node has recently received a confirmation that packets sent recently to the
- neighbor were received by its IP layer.
-
- @param[in] IpIo Pointer to an IP_IO instance
- @param[in] Neighbor The IP address of the neighbor
- @param[in] Timeout Time in 100-ns units that this entry will
- remain in the neighbor cache. A value of
- zero means that the entry is permanent.
- A value of non-zero means that the entry is
- dynamic and will be deleted after Timeout.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation is completed successfully.
- @retval EFI_NOT_STARTED The IpIo is not configured.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Neighbor Address is invalid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The neighbor cache entry is not in the
- neighbor table.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-IpIoRefreshNeighbor (
- IN IP_IO *IpIo,
- IN EFI_IP_ADDRESS *Neighbor,
- IN UINT32 Timeout
- )
-{
- EFI_IP6_PROTOCOL *Ip;
-
- if (!IpIo->IsConfigured || IpIo->IpVersion != IP_VERSION_6) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- Ip = IpIo->Ip.Ip6;
-
- return Ip->Neighbors (Ip, FALSE, &Neighbor->v6, NULL, Timeout, TRUE);
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index f62a36fd50..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,53 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# This library instance provides IP services upon EFI IPv4/IPv6 Protocols.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeIpIoLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeIpIoLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = A302F877-8625-425c-B1EC-7487B62C4FDA
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = IpIoLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeIpIoLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- IpIoLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DpcLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiIp4ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiIp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiIp6ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiIp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 5545a50671..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpIoLib/DxeIpIoLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.c deleted file mode 100644 index d15c6bd561..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,81 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Implementation of Ipmi Library in DXE Phase for SMS.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-#include <Protocol/IpmiProtocol.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-IPMI_PROTOCOL *mIpmiProtocol = NULL;
-
-/**
- This service enables submitting commands via Ipmi.
-
- @param[in] NetFunction Net function of the command.
- @param[in] Command IPMI Command.
- @param[in] RequestData Command Request Data.
- @param[in] RequestDataSize Size of Command Request Data.
- @param[out] ResponseData Command Response Data. The completion code is the first byte of response data.
- @param[in, out] ResponseDataSize Size of Command Response Data.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The command byte stream was successfully submit to the device and a response was successfully received.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The command was not successfully sent to the device or a response was not successfully received from the device.
- @retval EFI_NOT_READY Ipmi Device is not ready for Ipmi command access.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Ipmi Device hardware error.
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT The command time out.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The command was not successfully sent to the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The resource allcation is out of resource or data size error.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpmiSubmitCommand (
- IN UINT8 NetFunction,
- IN UINT8 Command,
- IN UINT8 *RequestData,
- IN UINT32 RequestDataSize,
- OUT UINT8 *ResponseData,
- IN OUT UINT32 *ResponseDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (mIpmiProtocol == NULL) {
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gIpmiProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **) &mIpmiProtocol
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Dxe Ipmi Protocol is not installed. So, IPMI device is not present.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "IpmiSubmitCommand in Dxe Phase under SMS Status - %r\n", Status));
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- }
-
- Status = mIpmiProtocol->IpmiSubmitCommand (
- mIpmiProtocol,
- NetFunction,
- Command,
- RequestData,
- RequestDataSize,
- ResponseData,
- ResponseDataSize
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 5b56b39656..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol/DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Instance of IPMI Library in DXE phase for SMS.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol
- FILE_GUID = 62408AD5-4EAC-432B-AB9B-C4B85BFAED02
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = IpmiLib|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_DRIVER DXE_CORE UEFI_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeIpmiLibIpmiProtocol.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- DebugLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gIpmiProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 6a84847039..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,3334 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Network library.
-
-Copyright (c) 2005 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-(C) Copyright 2015 Hewlett Packard Enterprise Development LP<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <IndustryStandard/SmBios.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/DriverBinding.h>
-#include <Protocol/ServiceBinding.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleNetwork.h>
-#include <Protocol/ManagedNetwork.h>
-#include <Protocol/Ip4Config2.h>
-#include <Protocol/ComponentName.h>
-#include <Protocol/ComponentName2.h>
-
-#include <Guid/SmBios.h>
-
-#include <Library/NetLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-#include <Library/PrintLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiLib.h>
-
-#define NIC_ITEM_CONFIG_SIZE sizeof (NIC_IP4_CONFIG_INFO) + sizeof (EFI_IP4_ROUTE_TABLE) * MAX_IP4_CONFIG_IN_VARIABLE
-#define DEFAULT_ZERO_START ((UINTN) ~0)
-
-//
-// All the supported IP4 maskes in host byte order.
-//
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED IP4_ADDR gIp4AllMasks[IP4_MASK_NUM] = {
- 0x00000000,
- 0x80000000,
- 0xC0000000,
- 0xE0000000,
- 0xF0000000,
- 0xF8000000,
- 0xFC000000,
- 0xFE000000,
-
- 0xFF000000,
- 0xFF800000,
- 0xFFC00000,
- 0xFFE00000,
- 0xFFF00000,
- 0xFFF80000,
- 0xFFFC0000,
- 0xFFFE0000,
-
- 0xFFFF0000,
- 0xFFFF8000,
- 0xFFFFC000,
- 0xFFFFE000,
- 0xFFFFF000,
- 0xFFFFF800,
- 0xFFFFFC00,
- 0xFFFFFE00,
-
- 0xFFFFFF00,
- 0xFFFFFF80,
- 0xFFFFFFC0,
- 0xFFFFFFE0,
- 0xFFFFFFF0,
- 0xFFFFFFF8,
- 0xFFFFFFFC,
- 0xFFFFFFFE,
- 0xFFFFFFFF,
-};
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS mZeroIp4Addr = {{0, 0, 0, 0}};
-
-//
-// Any error level digitally larger than mNetDebugLevelMax
-// will be silently discarded.
-//
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED UINTN mNetDebugLevelMax = NETDEBUG_LEVEL_ERROR;
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED UINT32 mSyslogPacketSeq = 0xDEADBEEF;
-
-//
-// You can change mSyslogDstMac mSyslogDstIp and mSyslogSrcIp
-// here to direct the syslog packets to the syslog deamon. The
-// default is broadcast to both the ethernet and IP.
-//
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED UINT8 mSyslogDstMac[NET_ETHER_ADDR_LEN] = {0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff};
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED UINT32 mSyslogDstIp = 0xffffffff;
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED UINT32 mSyslogSrcIp = 0;
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CHAR8 *mMonthName[] = {
- "Jan",
- "Feb",
- "Mar",
- "Apr",
- "May",
- "Jun",
- "Jul",
- "Aug",
- "Sep",
- "Oct",
- "Nov",
- "Dec"
-};
-
-//
-// VLAN device path node template
-//
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED VLAN_DEVICE_PATH mNetVlanDevicePathTemplate = {
- {
- MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH,
- MSG_VLAN_DP,
- {
- (UINT8) (sizeof (VLAN_DEVICE_PATH)),
- (UINT8) ((sizeof (VLAN_DEVICE_PATH)) >> 8)
- }
- },
- 0
-};
-
-/**
- Locate the handles that support SNP, then open one of them
- to send the syslog packets. The caller isn't required to close
- the SNP after use because the SNP is opened by HandleProtocol.
-
- @return The point to SNP if one is properly openned. Otherwise NULL
-
-**/
-EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *
-SyslogLocateSnp (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *Snp;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // Locate the handles which has SNP installed.
- //
- Handles = NULL;
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || (HandleCount == 0)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Try to open one of the ethernet SNP protocol to send packet
- //
- Snp = NULL;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handles[Index],
- &gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &Snp
- );
-
- if ((Status == EFI_SUCCESS) && (Snp != NULL) &&
- (Snp->Mode->IfType == NET_IFTYPE_ETHERNET) &&
- (Snp->Mode->MaxPacketSize >= NET_SYSLOG_PACKET_LEN)) {
-
- break;
- }
-
- Snp = NULL;
- }
-
- FreePool (Handles);
- return Snp;
-}
-
-/**
- Transmit a syslog packet synchronously through SNP. The Packet
- already has the ethernet header prepended. This function should
- fill in the source MAC because it will try to locate a SNP each
- time it is called to avoid the problem if SNP is unloaded.
- This code snip is copied from MNP.
-
- @param[in] Packet The Syslog packet
- @param[in] Length The length of the packet
-
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Failed to locate a usable SNP protocol
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT Timeout happened to send the packet.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Packet is sent.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-SyslogSendPacket (
- IN CHAR8 *Packet,
- IN UINT32 Length
- )
-{
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *Snp;
- ETHER_HEAD *Ether;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_EVENT TimeoutEvent;
- UINT8 *TxBuf;
-
- Snp = SyslogLocateSnp ();
-
- if (Snp == NULL) {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-
- Ether = (ETHER_HEAD *) Packet;
- CopyMem (Ether->SrcMac, Snp->Mode->CurrentAddress.Addr, NET_ETHER_ADDR_LEN);
-
- //
- // Start the timeout event.
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_TIMER,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &TimeoutEvent
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->SetTimer (TimeoutEvent, TimerRelative, NET_SYSLOG_TX_TIMEOUT);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- for (;;) {
- //
- // Transmit the packet through SNP.
- //
- Status = Snp->Transmit (Snp, 0, Length, Packet, NULL, NULL, NULL);
-
- if ((Status != EFI_SUCCESS) && (Status != EFI_NOT_READY)) {
- Status = EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // If Status is EFI_SUCCESS, the packet is put in the transmit queue.
- // if Status is EFI_NOT_READY, the transmit engine of the network
- // interface is busy. Both need to sync SNP.
- //
- TxBuf = NULL;
-
- do {
- //
- // Get the recycled transmit buffer status.
- //
- Snp->GetStatus (Snp, NULL, (VOID **) &TxBuf);
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (gBS->CheckEvent (TimeoutEvent))) {
- Status = EFI_TIMEOUT;
- break;
- }
-
- } while (TxBuf == NULL);
-
- if ((Status == EFI_SUCCESS) || (Status == EFI_TIMEOUT)) {
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Status is EFI_NOT_READY. Restart the timer event and
- // call Snp->Transmit again.
- //
- gBS->SetTimer (TimeoutEvent, TimerRelative, NET_SYSLOG_TX_TIMEOUT);
- }
-
- gBS->SetTimer (TimeoutEvent, TimerCancel, 0);
-
-ON_EXIT:
- gBS->CloseEvent (TimeoutEvent);
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Build a syslog packet, including the Ethernet/Ip/Udp headers
- and user's message.
-
- @param[in] Level Syslog servity level
- @param[in] Module The module that generates the log
- @param[in] File The file that contains the current log
- @param[in] Line The line of code in the File that contains the current log
- @param[in] Message The log message
- @param[in] BufLen The lenght of the Buf
- @param[out] Buf The buffer to put the packet data
-
- @return The length of the syslog packet built.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-SyslogBuildPacket (
- IN UINT32 Level,
- IN UINT8 *Module,
- IN UINT8 *File,
- IN UINT32 Line,
- IN UINT8 *Message,
- IN UINT32 BufLen,
- OUT CHAR8 *Buf
- )
-{
- ETHER_HEAD *Ether;
- IP4_HEAD *Ip4;
- EFI_UDP_HEADER *Udp4;
- EFI_TIME Time;
- UINT32 Pri;
- UINT32 Len;
-
- //
- // Fill in the Ethernet header. Leave alone the source MAC.
- // SyslogSendPacket will fill in the address for us.
- //
- Ether = (ETHER_HEAD *) Buf;
- CopyMem (Ether->DstMac, mSyslogDstMac, NET_ETHER_ADDR_LEN);
- ZeroMem (Ether->SrcMac, NET_ETHER_ADDR_LEN);
-
- Ether->EtherType = HTONS (0x0800); // IPv4 protocol
-
- Buf += sizeof (ETHER_HEAD);
- BufLen -= sizeof (ETHER_HEAD);
-
- //
- // Fill in the IP header
- //
- Ip4 = (IP4_HEAD *) Buf;
- Ip4->HeadLen = 5;
- Ip4->Ver = 4;
- Ip4->Tos = 0;
- Ip4->TotalLen = 0;
- Ip4->Id = (UINT16) mSyslogPacketSeq;
- Ip4->Fragment = 0;
- Ip4->Ttl = 16;
- Ip4->Protocol = 0x11;
- Ip4->Checksum = 0;
- Ip4->Src = mSyslogSrcIp;
- Ip4->Dst = mSyslogDstIp;
-
- Buf += sizeof (IP4_HEAD);
- BufLen -= sizeof (IP4_HEAD);
-
- //
- // Fill in the UDP header, Udp checksum is optional. Leave it zero.
- //
- Udp4 = (EFI_UDP_HEADER *) Buf;
- Udp4->SrcPort = HTONS (514);
- Udp4->DstPort = HTONS (514);
- Udp4->Length = 0;
- Udp4->Checksum = 0;
-
- Buf += sizeof (EFI_UDP_HEADER);
- BufLen -= sizeof (EFI_UDP_HEADER);
-
- //
- // Build the syslog message body with <PRI> Timestamp machine module Message
- //
- Pri = ((NET_SYSLOG_FACILITY & 31) << 3) | (Level & 7);
- gRT->GetTime (&Time, NULL);
- ASSERT ((Time.Month <= 12) && (Time.Month >= 1));
-
- //
- // Use %a to format the ASCII strings, %s to format UNICODE strings
- //
- Len = 0;
- Len += (UINT32) AsciiSPrint (
- Buf,
- BufLen,
- "<%d> %a %d %d:%d:%d ",
- Pri,
- mMonthName [Time.Month-1],
- Time.Day,
- Time.Hour,
- Time.Minute,
- Time.Second
- );
- Len--;
-
- Len += (UINT32) AsciiSPrint (
- Buf + Len,
- BufLen - Len,
- "Tiano %a: %a (Line: %d File: %a)",
- Module,
- Message,
- Line,
- File
- );
- Len--;
-
- //
- // OK, patch the IP length/checksum and UDP length fields.
- //
- Len += sizeof (EFI_UDP_HEADER);
- Udp4->Length = HTONS ((UINT16) Len);
-
- Len += sizeof (IP4_HEAD);
- Ip4->TotalLen = HTONS ((UINT16) Len);
- Ip4->Checksum = (UINT16) (~NetblockChecksum ((UINT8 *) Ip4, sizeof (IP4_HEAD)));
-
- return Len + sizeof (ETHER_HEAD);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocate a buffer, then format the message to it. This is a
- help function for the NET_DEBUG_XXX macros. The PrintArg of
- these macros treats the variable length print parameters as a
- single parameter, and pass it to the NetDebugASPrint. For
- example, NET_DEBUG_TRACE ("Tcp", ("State transit to %a\n", Name))
- if extracted to:
-
- NetDebugOutput (
- NETDEBUG_LEVEL_TRACE,
- "Tcp",
- __FILE__,
- __LINE__,
- NetDebugASPrint ("State transit to %a\n", Name)
- )
-
- @param Format The ASCII format string.
- @param ... The variable length parameter whose format is determined
- by the Format string.
-
- @return The buffer containing the formatted message,
- or NULL if failed to allocate memory.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-EFIAPI
-NetDebugASPrint (
- IN CHAR8 *Format,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- CHAR8 *Buf;
-
- Buf = (CHAR8 *) AllocatePool (NET_DEBUG_MSG_LEN);
-
- if (Buf == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- VA_START (Marker, Format);
- AsciiVSPrint (Buf, NET_DEBUG_MSG_LEN, Format, Marker);
- VA_END (Marker);
-
- return Buf;
-}
-
-/**
- Builds an UDP4 syslog packet and send it using SNP.
-
- This function will locate a instance of SNP then send the message through it.
- Because it isn't open the SNP BY_DRIVER, apply caution when using it.
-
- @param Level The servity level of the message.
- @param Module The Moudle that generates the log.
- @param File The file that contains the log.
- @param Line The exact line that contains the log.
- @param Message The user message to log.
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Any input parameter is invalid.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate memory for the packet
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The log is discard because that it is more verbose
- than the mNetDebugLevelMax. Or, it has been sent out.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetDebugOutput (
- IN UINT32 Level,
- IN UINT8 *Module,
- IN UINT8 *File,
- IN UINT32 Line,
- IN UINT8 *Message
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Packet;
- UINT32 Len;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Check whether the message should be sent out
- //
- if (Message == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (Level > mNetDebugLevelMax) {
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate a maxium of 1024 bytes, the caller should ensure
- // that the message plus the ethernet/ip/udp header is shorter
- // than this
- //
- Packet = (CHAR8 *) AllocatePool (NET_SYSLOG_PACKET_LEN);
-
- if (Packet == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- //
- // Build the message: Ethernet header + IP header + Udp Header + user data
- //
- Len = SyslogBuildPacket (
- Level,
- Module,
- File,
- Line,
- Message,
- NET_SYSLOG_PACKET_LEN,
- Packet
- );
-
- mSyslogPacketSeq++;
- Status = SyslogSendPacket (Packet, Len);
- FreePool (Packet);
-
-ON_EXIT:
- FreePool (Message);
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Return the length of the mask.
-
- Return the length of the mask, the correct value is from 0 to 32.
- If the mask is invalid, return the invalid length 33, which is IP4_MASK_NUM.
- NetMask is in the host byte order.
-
- @param[in] NetMask The netmask to get the length from.
-
- @return The length of the netmask, IP4_MASK_NUM if the mask is invalid.
-
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-NetGetMaskLength (
- IN IP4_ADDR NetMask
- )
-{
- INTN Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < IP4_MASK_NUM; Index++) {
- if (NetMask == gIp4AllMasks[Index]) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- return Index;
-}
-
-
-
-/**
- Return the class of the IP address, such as class A, B, C.
- Addr is in host byte order.
-
- The address of class A starts with 0.
- If the address belong to class A, return IP4_ADDR_CLASSA.
- The address of class B starts with 10.
- If the address belong to class B, return IP4_ADDR_CLASSB.
- The address of class C starts with 110.
- If the address belong to class C, return IP4_ADDR_CLASSC.
- The address of class D starts with 1110.
- If the address belong to class D, return IP4_ADDR_CLASSD.
- The address of class E starts with 1111.
- If the address belong to class E, return IP4_ADDR_CLASSE.
-
-
- @param[in] Addr The address to get the class from.
-
- @return IP address class, such as IP4_ADDR_CLASSA.
-
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-NetGetIpClass (
- IN IP4_ADDR Addr
- )
-{
- UINT8 ByteOne;
-
- ByteOne = (UINT8) (Addr >> 24);
-
- if ((ByteOne & 0x80) == 0) {
- return IP4_ADDR_CLASSA;
-
- } else if ((ByteOne & 0xC0) == 0x80) {
- return IP4_ADDR_CLASSB;
-
- } else if ((ByteOne & 0xE0) == 0xC0) {
- return IP4_ADDR_CLASSC;
-
- } else if ((ByteOne & 0xF0) == 0xE0) {
- return IP4_ADDR_CLASSD;
-
- } else {
- return IP4_ADDR_CLASSE;
-
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Check whether the IP is a valid unicast address according to
- the netmask. If NetMask is zero, use the IP address's class to get the default mask.
-
- If Ip is 0, IP is not a valid unicast address.
- Class D address is used for multicasting and class E address is reserved for future. If Ip
- belongs to class D or class E, IP is not a valid unicast address.
- If all bits of the host address of IP are 0 or 1, IP is also not a valid unicast address.
-
- @param[in] Ip The IP to check against.
- @param[in] NetMask The mask of the IP.
-
- @return TRUE if IP is a valid unicast address on the network, otherwise FALSE.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetIp4IsUnicast (
- IN IP4_ADDR Ip,
- IN IP4_ADDR NetMask
- )
-{
- INTN Class;
-
- Class = NetGetIpClass (Ip);
-
- if ((Ip == 0) || (Class >= IP4_ADDR_CLASSD)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if (NetMask == 0) {
- NetMask = gIp4AllMasks[Class << 3];
- }
-
- if (((Ip &~NetMask) == ~NetMask) || ((Ip &~NetMask) == 0)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the incoming IPv6 address is a valid unicast address.
-
- If the address is a multicast address has binary 0xFF at the start, it is not
- a valid unicast address. If the address is unspecified ::, it is not a valid
- unicast address to be assigned to any node. If the address is loopback address
- ::1, it is also not a valid unicast address to be assigned to any physical
- interface.
-
- @param[in] Ip6 The IPv6 address to check against.
-
- @return TRUE if Ip6 is a valid unicast address on the network, otherwise FALSE.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetIp6IsValidUnicast (
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6
- )
-{
- UINT8 Byte;
- UINT8 Index;
-
- if (Ip6->Addr[0] == 0xFF) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < 15; Index++) {
- if (Ip6->Addr[Index] != 0) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- Byte = Ip6->Addr[Index];
-
- if (Byte == 0x0 || Byte == 0x1) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the incoming Ipv6 address is the unspecified address or not.
-
- @param[in] Ip6 - Ip6 address, in network order.
-
- @retval TRUE - Yes, unspecified
- @retval FALSE - No
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetIp6IsUnspecifiedAddr (
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6
- )
-{
- UINT8 Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < 16; Index++) {
- if (Ip6->Addr[Index] != 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the incoming Ipv6 address is a link-local address.
-
- @param[in] Ip6 - Ip6 address, in network order.
-
- @retval TRUE - Yes, link-local address
- @retval FALSE - No
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetIp6IsLinkLocalAddr (
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6
- )
-{
- UINT8 Index;
-
- ASSERT (Ip6 != NULL);
-
- if (Ip6->Addr[0] != 0xFE) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if (Ip6->Addr[1] != 0x80) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- for (Index = 2; Index < 8; Index++) {
- if (Ip6->Addr[Index] != 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the Ipv6 address1 and address2 are on the connected network.
-
- @param[in] Ip1 - Ip6 address1, in network order.
- @param[in] Ip2 - Ip6 address2, in network order.
- @param[in] PrefixLength - The prefix length of the checking net.
-
- @retval TRUE - Yes, connected.
- @retval FALSE - No.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetIp6IsNetEqual (
- EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip1,
- EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip2,
- UINT8 PrefixLength
- )
-{
- UINT8 Byte;
- UINT8 Bit;
- UINT8 Mask;
-
- ASSERT ((Ip1 != NULL) && (Ip2 != NULL) && (PrefixLength < IP6_PREFIX_NUM));
-
- if (PrefixLength == 0) {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- Byte = (UINT8) (PrefixLength / 8);
- Bit = (UINT8) (PrefixLength % 8);
-
- if (CompareMem (Ip1, Ip2, Byte) != 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if (Bit > 0) {
- Mask = (UINT8) (0xFF << (8 - Bit));
-
- ASSERT (Byte < 16);
- if ((Ip1->Addr[Byte] & Mask) != (Ip2->Addr[Byte] & Mask)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Switches the endianess of an IPv6 address
-
- This function swaps the bytes in a 128-bit IPv6 address to switch the value
- from little endian to big endian or vice versa. The byte swapped value is
- returned.
-
- @param Ip6 Points to an IPv6 address
-
- @return The byte swapped IPv6 address.
-
-**/
-EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *
-EFIAPI
-Ip6Swap128 (
- EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6
- )
-{
- UINT64 High;
- UINT64 Low;
-
- CopyMem (&High, Ip6, sizeof (UINT64));
- CopyMem (&Low, &Ip6->Addr[8], sizeof (UINT64));
-
- High = SwapBytes64 (High);
- Low = SwapBytes64 (Low);
-
- CopyMem (Ip6, &Low, sizeof (UINT64));
- CopyMem (&Ip6->Addr[8], &High, sizeof (UINT64));
-
- return Ip6;
-}
-
-/**
- Initialize a random seed using current time and monotonic count.
-
- Get current time and monotonic count first. Then initialize a random seed
- based on some basic mathematics operation on the hour, day, minute, second,
- nanosecond and year of the current time and the monotonic count value.
-
- @return The random seed initialized with current time.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-NetRandomInitSeed (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_TIME Time;
- UINT32 Seed;
- UINT64 MonotonicCount;
-
- gRT->GetTime (&Time, NULL);
- Seed = (~Time.Hour << 24 | Time.Day << 16 | Time.Minute << 8 | Time.Second);
- Seed ^= Time.Nanosecond;
- Seed ^= Time.Year << 7;
-
- gBS->GetNextMonotonicCount (&MonotonicCount);
- Seed += (UINT32) MonotonicCount;
-
- return Seed;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extract a UINT32 from a byte stream.
-
- Copy a UINT32 from a byte stream, then converts it from Network
- byte order to host byte order. Use this function to avoid alignment error.
-
- @param[in] Buf The buffer to extract the UINT32.
-
- @return The UINT32 extracted.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-NetGetUint32 (
- IN UINT8 *Buf
- )
-{
- UINT32 Value;
-
- CopyMem (&Value, Buf, sizeof (UINT32));
- return NTOHL (Value);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Put a UINT32 to the byte stream in network byte order.
-
- Converts a UINT32 from host byte order to network byte order. Then copy it to the
- byte stream.
-
- @param[in, out] Buf The buffer to put the UINT32.
- @param[in] Data The data to be converted and put into the byte stream.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetPutUint32 (
- IN OUT UINT8 *Buf,
- IN UINT32 Data
- )
-{
- Data = HTONL (Data);
- CopyMem (Buf, &Data, sizeof (UINT32));
-}
-
-
-/**
- Remove the first node entry on the list, and return the removed node entry.
-
- Removes the first node Entry from a doubly linked list. It is up to the caller of
- this function to release the memory used by the first node if that is required. On
- exit, the removed node is returned.
-
- If Head is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Head was not initialized, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumLinkedListLength is not zero, and the number of nodes in the
- linked list including the head node is greater than or equal to PcdMaximumLinkedListLength,
- then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Head The list header.
-
- @return The first node entry that is removed from the list, NULL if the list is empty.
-
-**/
-LIST_ENTRY *
-EFIAPI
-NetListRemoveHead (
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *Head
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *First;
-
- ASSERT (Head != NULL);
-
- if (IsListEmpty (Head)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- First = Head->ForwardLink;
- Head->ForwardLink = First->ForwardLink;
- First->ForwardLink->BackLink = Head;
-
- DEBUG_CODE (
- First->ForwardLink = (LIST_ENTRY *) NULL;
- First->BackLink = (LIST_ENTRY *) NULL;
- );
-
- return First;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Remove the last node entry on the list and and return the removed node entry.
-
- Removes the last node entry from a doubly linked list. It is up to the caller of
- this function to release the memory used by the first node if that is required. On
- exit, the removed node is returned.
-
- If Head is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Head was not initialized, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumLinkedListLength is not zero, and the number of nodes in the
- linked list including the head node is greater than or equal to PcdMaximumLinkedListLength,
- then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Head The list head.
-
- @return The last node entry that is removed from the list, NULL if the list is empty.
-
-**/
-LIST_ENTRY *
-EFIAPI
-NetListRemoveTail (
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *Head
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Last;
-
- ASSERT (Head != NULL);
-
- if (IsListEmpty (Head)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Last = Head->BackLink;
- Head->BackLink = Last->BackLink;
- Last->BackLink->ForwardLink = Head;
-
- DEBUG_CODE (
- Last->ForwardLink = (LIST_ENTRY *) NULL;
- Last->BackLink = (LIST_ENTRY *) NULL;
- );
-
- return Last;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Insert a new node entry after a designated node entry of a doubly linked list.
-
- Inserts a new node entry donated by NewEntry after the node entry donated by PrevEntry
- of the doubly linked list.
-
- @param[in, out] PrevEntry The previous entry to insert after.
- @param[in, out] NewEntry The new entry to insert.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetListInsertAfter (
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *PrevEntry,
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *NewEntry
- )
-{
- NewEntry->BackLink = PrevEntry;
- NewEntry->ForwardLink = PrevEntry->ForwardLink;
- PrevEntry->ForwardLink->BackLink = NewEntry;
- PrevEntry->ForwardLink = NewEntry;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Insert a new node entry before a designated node entry of a doubly linked list.
-
- Inserts a new node entry donated by NewEntry after the node entry donated by PostEntry
- of the doubly linked list.
-
- @param[in, out] PostEntry The entry to insert before.
- @param[in, out] NewEntry The new entry to insert.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetListInsertBefore (
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *PostEntry,
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *NewEntry
- )
-{
- NewEntry->ForwardLink = PostEntry;
- NewEntry->BackLink = PostEntry->BackLink;
- PostEntry->BackLink->ForwardLink = NewEntry;
- PostEntry->BackLink = NewEntry;
-}
-
-/**
- Safe destroy nodes in a linked list, and return the length of the list after all possible operations finished.
-
- Destroy network child instance list by list traversals is not safe due to graph dependencies between nodes.
- This function performs a safe traversal to destroy these nodes by checking to see if the node being destroyed
- has been removed from the list or not.
- If it has been removed, then restart the traversal from the head.
- If it hasn't been removed, then continue with the next node directly.
- This function will end the iterate and return the CallBack's last return value if error happens,
- or retrun EFI_SUCCESS if 2 complete passes are made with no changes in the number of children in the list.
-
- @param[in] List The head of the list.
- @param[in] CallBack Pointer to the callback function to destroy one node in the list.
- @param[in] Context Pointer to the callback function's context: corresponds to the
- parameter Context in NET_DESTROY_LINK_LIST_CALLBACK.
- @param[out] ListLength The length of the link list if the function returns successfully.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Two complete passes are made with no changes in the number of children.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The input parameter is invalid.
- @retval Others Return the CallBack's last return value.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetDestroyLinkList (
- IN LIST_ENTRY *List,
- IN NET_DESTROY_LINK_LIST_CALLBACK CallBack,
- IN VOID *Context, OPTIONAL
- OUT UINTN *ListLength OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- UINTN PreviousLength;
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- LIST_ENTRY *Ptr;
- UINTN Length;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (List == NULL || CallBack == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Length = 0;
- do {
- PreviousLength = Length;
- Entry = GetFirstNode (List);
- while (!IsNull (List, Entry)) {
- Status = CallBack (Entry, Context);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Walk through the list to see whether the Entry has been removed or not.
- // If the Entry still exists, just try to destroy the next one.
- // If not, go back to the start point to iterate the list again.
- //
- for (Ptr = List->ForwardLink; Ptr != List; Ptr = Ptr->ForwardLink) {
- if (Ptr == Entry) {
- break;
- }
- }
- if (Ptr == Entry) {
- Entry = GetNextNode (List, Entry);
- } else {
- Entry = GetFirstNode (List);
- }
- }
- for (Length = 0, Ptr = List->ForwardLink; Ptr != List; Length++, Ptr = Ptr->ForwardLink);
- } while (Length != PreviousLength);
-
- if (ListLength != NULL) {
- *ListLength = Length;
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function checks the input Handle to see if it's one of these handles in ChildHandleBuffer.
-
- @param[in] Handle Handle to be checked.
- @param[in] NumberOfChildren Number of Handles in ChildHandleBuffer.
- @param[in] ChildHandleBuffer An array of child handles to be freed. May be NULL
- if NumberOfChildren is 0.
-
- @retval TURE Found the input Handle in ChildHandleBuffer.
- @retval FALSE Can't find the input Handle in ChildHandleBuffer.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetIsInHandleBuffer (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle,
- IN UINTN NumberOfChildren,
- IN EFI_HANDLE *ChildHandleBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- if (NumberOfChildren == 0 || ChildHandleBuffer == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfChildren; Index++) {
- if (Handle == ChildHandleBuffer[Index]) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Initialize the netmap. Netmap is a reposity to keep the <Key, Value> pairs.
-
- Initialize the forward and backward links of two head nodes donated by Map->Used
- and Map->Recycled of two doubly linked lists.
- Initializes the count of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap to zero.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If the address of Map->Used is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If the address of Map->Recycled is NULl, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to initialize.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetMapInit (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map
- )
-{
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
-
- InitializeListHead (&Map->Used);
- InitializeListHead (&Map->Recycled);
- Map->Count = 0;
-}
-
-
-/**
- To clean up the netmap, that is, release allocated memories.
-
- Removes all nodes of the Used doubly linked list and free memory of all related netmap items.
- Removes all nodes of the Recycled doubly linked list and free memory of all related netmap items.
- The number of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap is set to be zero.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to clean up.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetMapClean (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map
- )
-{
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- LIST_ENTRY *Next;
-
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH_SAFE (Entry, Next, &Map->Used) {
- Item = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
-
- RemoveEntryList (&Item->Link);
- Map->Count--;
-
- gBS->FreePool (Item);
- }
-
- ASSERT ((Map->Count == 0) && IsListEmpty (&Map->Used));
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH_SAFE (Entry, Next, &Map->Recycled) {
- Item = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
-
- RemoveEntryList (&Item->Link);
- gBS->FreePool (Item);
- }
-
- ASSERT (IsListEmpty (&Map->Recycled));
-}
-
-
-/**
- Test whether the netmap is empty and return true if it is.
-
- If the number of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap is zero, return TRUE.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
-
- @param[in] Map The net map to test.
-
- @return TRUE if the netmap is empty, otherwise FALSE.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-NetMapIsEmpty (
- IN NET_MAP *Map
- )
-{
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
- return (BOOLEAN) (Map->Count == 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Return the number of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap.
-
- @param[in] Map The netmap to get the entry number.
-
- @return The entry number in the netmap.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-NetMapGetCount (
- IN NET_MAP *Map
- )
-{
- return Map->Count;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Return one allocated item.
-
- If the Recycled doubly linked list of the netmap is empty, it will try to allocate
- a batch of items if there are enough resources and add corresponding nodes to the begining
- of the Recycled doubly linked list of the netmap. Otherwise, it will directly remove
- the fist node entry of the Recycled doubly linked list and return the corresponding item.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to allocate item for.
-
- @return The allocated item. If NULL, the
- allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_MAP_ITEM *
-NetMapAllocItem (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map
- )
-{
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
- LIST_ENTRY *Head;
- UINTN Index;
-
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
-
- Head = &Map->Recycled;
-
- if (IsListEmpty (Head)) {
- for (Index = 0; Index < NET_MAP_INCREAMENT; Index++) {
- Item = AllocatePool (sizeof (NET_MAP_ITEM));
-
- if (Item == NULL) {
- if (Index == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- break;
- }
-
- InsertHeadList (Head, &Item->Link);
- }
- }
-
- Item = NET_LIST_HEAD (Head, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
- NetListRemoveHead (Head);
-
- return Item;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Allocate an item to save the <Key, Value> pair to the head of the netmap.
-
- Allocate an item to save the <Key, Value> pair and add corresponding node entry
- to the beginning of the Used doubly linked list. The number of the <Key, Value>
- pairs in the netmap increase by 1.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to insert into.
- @param[in] Key The user's key.
- @param[in] Value The user's value for the key.
-
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate the memory for the item.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The item is inserted to the head.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetMapInsertHead (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map,
- IN VOID *Key,
- IN VOID *Value OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
-
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
-
- Item = NetMapAllocItem (Map);
-
- if (Item == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Item->Key = Key;
- Item->Value = Value;
- InsertHeadList (&Map->Used, &Item->Link);
-
- Map->Count++;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Allocate an item to save the <Key, Value> pair to the tail of the netmap.
-
- Allocate an item to save the <Key, Value> pair and add corresponding node entry
- to the tail of the Used doubly linked list. The number of the <Key, Value>
- pairs in the netmap increase by 1.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to insert into.
- @param[in] Key The user's key.
- @param[in] Value The user's value for the key.
-
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate the memory for the item.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The item is inserted to the tail.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetMapInsertTail (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map,
- IN VOID *Key,
- IN VOID *Value OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
-
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
-
- Item = NetMapAllocItem (Map);
-
- if (Item == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Item->Key = Key;
- Item->Value = Value;
- InsertTailList (&Map->Used, &Item->Link);
-
- Map->Count++;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Check whether the item is in the Map and return TRUE if it is.
-
- @param[in] Map The netmap to search within.
- @param[in] Item The item to search.
-
- @return TRUE if the item is in the netmap, otherwise FALSE.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-NetItemInMap (
- IN NET_MAP *Map,
- IN NET_MAP_ITEM *Item
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *ListEntry;
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (ListEntry, &Map->Used) {
- if (ListEntry == &Item->Link) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Find the key in the netmap and returns the point to the item contains the Key.
-
- Iterate the Used doubly linked list of the netmap to get every item. Compare the key of every
- item with the key to search. It returns the point to the item contains the Key if found.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] Map The netmap to search within.
- @param[in] Key The key to search.
-
- @return The point to the item contains the Key, or NULL if Key isn't in the map.
-
-**/
-NET_MAP_ITEM *
-EFIAPI
-NetMapFindKey (
- IN NET_MAP *Map,
- IN VOID *Key
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
-
- ASSERT (Map != NULL);
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (Entry, &Map->Used) {
- Item = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
-
- if (Item->Key == Key) {
- return Item;
- }
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Remove the node entry of the item from the netmap and return the key of the removed item.
-
- Remove the node entry of the item from the Used doubly linked list of the netmap.
- The number of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap decrease by 1. Then add the node
- entry of the item to the Recycled doubly linked list of the netmap. If Value is not NULL,
- Value will point to the value of the item. It returns the key of the removed item.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Item is NULL, then ASSERT().
- if item in not in the netmap, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to remove the item from.
- @param[in, out] Item The item to remove.
- @param[out] Value The variable to receive the value if not NULL.
-
- @return The key of the removed item.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-NetMapRemoveItem (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map,
- IN OUT NET_MAP_ITEM *Item,
- OUT VOID **Value OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- ASSERT ((Map != NULL) && (Item != NULL));
- ASSERT (NetItemInMap (Map, Item));
-
- RemoveEntryList (&Item->Link);
- Map->Count--;
- InsertHeadList (&Map->Recycled, &Item->Link);
-
- if (Value != NULL) {
- *Value = Item->Value;
- }
-
- return Item->Key;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Remove the first node entry on the netmap and return the key of the removed item.
-
- Remove the first node entry from the Used doubly linked list of the netmap.
- The number of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap decrease by 1. Then add the node
- entry to the Recycled doubly linked list of the netmap. If parameter Value is not NULL,
- parameter Value will point to the value of the item. It returns the key of the removed item.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If the Used doubly linked list is empty, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to remove the head from.
- @param[out] Value The variable to receive the value if not NULL.
-
- @return The key of the item removed.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-NetMapRemoveHead (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map,
- OUT VOID **Value OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
-
- //
- // Often, it indicates a programming error to remove
- // the first entry in an empty list
- //
- ASSERT (Map && !IsListEmpty (&Map->Used));
-
- Item = NET_LIST_HEAD (&Map->Used, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
- RemoveEntryList (&Item->Link);
- Map->Count--;
- InsertHeadList (&Map->Recycled, &Item->Link);
-
- if (Value != NULL) {
- *Value = Item->Value;
- }
-
- return Item->Key;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Remove the last node entry on the netmap and return the key of the removed item.
-
- Remove the last node entry from the Used doubly linked list of the netmap.
- The number of the <Key, Value> pairs in the netmap decrease by 1. Then add the node
- entry to the Recycled doubly linked list of the netmap. If parameter Value is not NULL,
- parameter Value will point to the value of the item. It returns the key of the removed item.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If the Used doubly linked list is empty, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in, out] Map The netmap to remove the tail from.
- @param[out] Value The variable to receive the value if not NULL.
-
- @return The key of the item removed.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-NetMapRemoveTail (
- IN OUT NET_MAP *Map,
- OUT VOID **Value OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
-
- //
- // Often, it indicates a programming error to remove
- // the last entry in an empty list
- //
- ASSERT (Map && !IsListEmpty (&Map->Used));
-
- Item = NET_LIST_TAIL (&Map->Used, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
- RemoveEntryList (&Item->Link);
- Map->Count--;
- InsertHeadList (&Map->Recycled, &Item->Link);
-
- if (Value != NULL) {
- *Value = Item->Value;
- }
-
- return Item->Key;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Iterate through the netmap and call CallBack for each item.
-
- It will contiue the traverse if CallBack returns EFI_SUCCESS, otherwise, break
- from the loop. It returns the CallBack's last return value. This function is
- delete safe for the current item.
-
- If Map is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If CallBack is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] Map The Map to iterate through.
- @param[in] CallBack The callback function to call for each item.
- @param[in] Arg The opaque parameter to the callback.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS There is no item in the netmap or CallBack for each item
- return EFI_SUCCESS.
- @retval Others It returns the CallBack's last return value.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetMapIterate (
- IN NET_MAP *Map,
- IN NET_MAP_CALLBACK CallBack,
- IN VOID *Arg OPTIONAL
- )
-{
-
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- LIST_ENTRY *Next;
- LIST_ENTRY *Head;
- NET_MAP_ITEM *Item;
- EFI_STATUS Result;
-
- ASSERT ((Map != NULL) && (CallBack != NULL));
-
- Head = &Map->Used;
-
- if (IsListEmpty (Head)) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH_SAFE (Entry, Next, Head) {
- Item = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_MAP_ITEM, Link);
- Result = CallBack (Map, Item, Arg);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Result)) {
- return Result;
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- This is the default unload handle for all the network drivers.
-
- Disconnect the driver specified by ImageHandle from all the devices in the handle database.
- Uninstall all the protocols installed in the driver entry point.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle The drivers' driver image.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The image is unloaded.
- @retval Others Failed to unload the image.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibDefaultUnload (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE *DeviceHandleBuffer;
- UINTN DeviceHandleCount;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Index2;
- EFI_DRIVER_BINDING_PROTOCOL *DriverBinding;
- EFI_COMPONENT_NAME_PROTOCOL *ComponentName;
- EFI_COMPONENT_NAME2_PROTOCOL *ComponentName2;
-
- //
- // Get the list of all the handles in the handle database.
- // If there is an error getting the list, then the unload
- // operation fails.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- AllHandles,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &DeviceHandleCount,
- &DeviceHandleBuffer
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < DeviceHandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DeviceHandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiDriverBindingProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &DriverBinding
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- if (DriverBinding->ImageHandle != ImageHandle) {
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // Disconnect the driver specified by ImageHandle from all
- // the devices in the handle database.
- //
- for (Index2 = 0; Index2 < DeviceHandleCount; Index2++) {
- Status = gBS->DisconnectController (
- DeviceHandleBuffer[Index2],
- DriverBinding->DriverBindingHandle,
- NULL
- );
- }
-
- //
- // Uninstall all the protocols installed in the driver entry point
- //
- gBS->UninstallProtocolInterface (
- DriverBinding->DriverBindingHandle,
- &gEfiDriverBindingProtocolGuid,
- DriverBinding
- );
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DeviceHandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiComponentNameProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &ComponentName
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- gBS->UninstallProtocolInterface (
- DriverBinding->DriverBindingHandle,
- &gEfiComponentNameProtocolGuid,
- ComponentName
- );
- }
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DeviceHandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiComponentName2ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &ComponentName2
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- gBS->UninstallProtocolInterface (
- DriverBinding->DriverBindingHandle,
- &gEfiComponentName2ProtocolGuid,
- ComponentName2
- );
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Free the buffer containing the list of handles from the handle database
- //
- if (DeviceHandleBuffer != NULL) {
- gBS->FreePool (DeviceHandleBuffer);
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-
-/**
- Create a child of the service that is identified by ServiceBindingGuid.
-
- Get the ServiceBinding Protocol first, then use it to create a child.
-
- If ServiceBindingGuid is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ChildHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] Controller The controller which has the service installed.
- @param[in] Image The image handle used to open service.
- @param[in] ServiceBindingGuid The service's Guid.
- @param[in, out] ChildHandle The handle to receive the create child.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The child is successfully created.
- @retval Others Failed to create the child.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibCreateServiceChild (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Image,
- IN EFI_GUID *ServiceBindingGuid,
- IN OUT EFI_HANDLE *ChildHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SERVICE_BINDING_PROTOCOL *Service;
-
-
- ASSERT ((ServiceBindingGuid != NULL) && (ChildHandle != NULL));
-
- //
- // Get the ServiceBinding Protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- Controller,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- (VOID **) &Service,
- Image,
- Controller,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_GET_PROTOCOL
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Create a child
- //
- Status = Service->CreateChild (Service, ChildHandle);
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Destroy a child of the service that is identified by ServiceBindingGuid.
-
- Get the ServiceBinding Protocol first, then use it to destroy a child.
-
- If ServiceBindingGuid is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] Controller The controller which has the service installed.
- @param[in] Image The image handle used to open service.
- @param[in] ServiceBindingGuid The service's Guid.
- @param[in] ChildHandle The child to destroy.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The child is successfully destroyed.
- @retval Others Failed to destroy the child.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Image,
- IN EFI_GUID *ServiceBindingGuid,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ChildHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SERVICE_BINDING_PROTOCOL *Service;
-
- ASSERT (ServiceBindingGuid != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get the ServiceBinding Protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- Controller,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- (VOID **) &Service,
- Image,
- Controller,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_GET_PROTOCOL
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // destroy the child
- //
- Status = Service->DestroyChild (Service, ChildHandle);
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Get handle with Simple Network Protocol installed on it.
-
- There should be MNP Service Binding Protocol installed on the input ServiceHandle.
- If Simple Network Protocol is already installed on the ServiceHandle, the
- ServiceHandle will be returned. If SNP is not installed on the ServiceHandle,
- try to find its parent handle with SNP installed.
-
- @param[in] ServiceHandle The handle where network service binding protocols are
- installed on.
- @param[out] Snp The pointer to store the address of the SNP instance.
- This is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return The SNP handle, or NULL if not found.
-
-**/
-EFI_HANDLE
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetSnpHandle (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ServiceHandle,
- OUT EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL **Snp OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *SnpInstance;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- EFI_HANDLE SnpHandle;
-
- //
- // Try to open SNP from ServiceHandle
- //
- SnpInstance = NULL;
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (ServiceHandle, &gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &SnpInstance);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- if (Snp != NULL) {
- *Snp = SnpInstance;
- }
- return ServiceHandle;
- }
-
- //
- // Failed to open SNP, try to get SNP handle by LocateDevicePath()
- //
- DevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (ServiceHandle);
- if (DevicePath == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- SnpHandle = NULL;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid, &DevicePath, &SnpHandle);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Failed to find SNP handle
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (SnpHandle, &gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &SnpInstance);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- if (Snp != NULL) {
- *Snp = SnpInstance;
- }
- return SnpHandle;
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieve VLAN ID of a VLAN device handle.
-
- Search VLAN device path node in Device Path of specified ServiceHandle and
- return its VLAN ID. If no VLAN device path node found, then this ServiceHandle
- is not a VLAN device handle, and 0 will be returned.
-
- @param[in] ServiceHandle The handle where network service binding protocols are
- installed on.
-
- @return VLAN ID of the device handle, or 0 if not a VLAN device.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetVlanId (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ServiceHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Node;
-
- DevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (ServiceHandle);
- if (DevicePath == NULL) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- Node = DevicePath;
- while (!IsDevicePathEnd (Node)) {
- if (Node->Type == MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH && Node->SubType == MSG_VLAN_DP) {
- return ((VLAN_DEVICE_PATH *) Node)->VlanId;
- }
- Node = NextDevicePathNode (Node);
- }
-
- return 0;
-}
-
-/**
- Find VLAN device handle with specified VLAN ID.
-
- The VLAN child device handle is created by VLAN Config Protocol on ControllerHandle.
- This function will append VLAN device path node to the parent device path,
- and then use LocateDevicePath() to find the correct VLAN device handle.
-
- @param[in] ControllerHandle The handle where network service binding protocols are
- installed on.
- @param[in] VlanId The configured VLAN ID for the VLAN device.
-
- @return The VLAN device handle, or NULL if not found.
-
-**/
-EFI_HANDLE
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetVlanHandle (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ControllerHandle,
- IN UINT16 VlanId
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *ParentDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *VlanDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- VLAN_DEVICE_PATH VlanNode;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
-
- ParentDevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (ControllerHandle);
- if (ParentDevicePath == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Construct VLAN device path
- //
- CopyMem (&VlanNode, &mNetVlanDevicePathTemplate, sizeof (VLAN_DEVICE_PATH));
- VlanNode.VlanId = VlanId;
- VlanDevicePath = AppendDevicePathNode (
- ParentDevicePath,
- (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) &VlanNode
- );
- if (VlanDevicePath == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Find VLAN device handle
- //
- Handle = NULL;
- DevicePath = VlanDevicePath;
- gBS->LocateDevicePath (
- &gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid,
- &DevicePath,
- &Handle
- );
- if (!IsDevicePathEnd (DevicePath)) {
- //
- // Device path is not exactly match
- //
- Handle = NULL;
- }
-
- FreePool (VlanDevicePath);
- return Handle;
-}
-
-/**
- Get MAC address associated with the network service handle.
-
- There should be MNP Service Binding Protocol installed on the input ServiceHandle.
- If SNP is installed on the ServiceHandle or its parent handle, MAC address will
- be retrieved from SNP. If no SNP found, try to get SNP mode data use MNP.
-
- @param[in] ServiceHandle The handle where network service binding protocols are
- installed on.
- @param[out] MacAddress The pointer to store the returned MAC address.
- @param[out] AddressSize The length of returned MAC address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS MAC address is returned successfully.
- @retval Others Failed to get SNP mode data.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetMacAddress (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ServiceHandle,
- OUT EFI_MAC_ADDRESS *MacAddress,
- OUT UINTN *AddressSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *Snp;
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_MODE *SnpMode;
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_MODE SnpModeData;
- EFI_MANAGED_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *Mnp;
- EFI_SERVICE_BINDING_PROTOCOL *MnpSb;
- EFI_HANDLE *SnpHandle;
- EFI_HANDLE MnpChildHandle;
-
- ASSERT (MacAddress != NULL);
- ASSERT (AddressSize != NULL);
-
- //
- // Try to get SNP handle
- //
- Snp = NULL;
- SnpHandle = NetLibGetSnpHandle (ServiceHandle, &Snp);
- if (SnpHandle != NULL) {
- //
- // SNP found, use it directly
- //
- SnpMode = Snp->Mode;
- } else {
- //
- // Failed to get SNP handle, try to get MAC address from MNP
- //
- MnpChildHandle = NULL;
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- ServiceHandle,
- &gEfiManagedNetworkServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &MnpSb
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Create a MNP child
- //
- Status = MnpSb->CreateChild (MnpSb, &MnpChildHandle);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Open MNP protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- MnpChildHandle,
- &gEfiManagedNetworkProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &Mnp
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- MnpSb->DestroyChild (MnpSb, MnpChildHandle);
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Try to get SNP mode from MNP
- //
- Status = Mnp->GetModeData (Mnp, NULL, &SnpModeData);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) && (Status != EFI_NOT_STARTED)) {
- MnpSb->DestroyChild (MnpSb, MnpChildHandle);
- return Status;
- }
- SnpMode = &SnpModeData;
-
- //
- // Destroy the MNP child
- //
- MnpSb->DestroyChild (MnpSb, MnpChildHandle);
- }
-
- *AddressSize = SnpMode->HwAddressSize;
- CopyMem (MacAddress->Addr, SnpMode->CurrentAddress.Addr, SnpMode->HwAddressSize);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Convert MAC address of the NIC associated with specified Service Binding Handle
- to a unicode string. Callers are responsible for freeing the string storage.
-
- Locate simple network protocol associated with the Service Binding Handle and
- get the mac address from SNP. Then convert the mac address into a unicode
- string. It takes 2 unicode characters to represent a 1 byte binary buffer.
- Plus one unicode character for the null-terminator.
-
- @param[in] ServiceHandle The handle where network service binding protocol is
- installed on.
- @param[in] ImageHandle The image handle used to act as the agent handle to
- get the simple network protocol. This parameter is
- optional and may be NULL.
- @param[out] MacString The pointer to store the address of the string
- representation of the mac address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert the mac address a unicode string successfully.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough memory resource.
- @retval Others Failed to open the simple network protocol.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetMacString (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ServiceHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle, OPTIONAL
- OUT CHAR16 **MacString
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_MAC_ADDRESS MacAddress;
- UINT8 *HwAddress;
- UINTN HwAddressSize;
- UINT16 VlanId;
- CHAR16 *String;
- UINTN Index;
-
- ASSERT (MacString != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get MAC address of the network device
- //
- Status = NetLibGetMacAddress (ServiceHandle, &MacAddress, &HwAddressSize);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // It takes 2 unicode characters to represent a 1 byte binary buffer.
- // If VLAN is configured, it will need extra 5 characters like "\0005".
- // Plus one unicode character for the null-terminator.
- //
- String = AllocateZeroPool ((2 * HwAddressSize + 5 + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16));
- if (String == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- *MacString = String;
-
- //
- // Convert the MAC address into a unicode string.
- //
- HwAddress = &MacAddress.Addr[0];
- for (Index = 0; Index < HwAddressSize; Index++) {
- String += UnicodeValueToString (String, PREFIX_ZERO | RADIX_HEX, *(HwAddress++), 2);
- }
-
- //
- // Append VLAN ID if any
- //
- VlanId = NetLibGetVlanId (ServiceHandle);
- if (VlanId != 0) {
- *String++ = L'\\';
- String += UnicodeValueToString (String, PREFIX_ZERO | RADIX_HEX, VlanId, 4);
- }
-
- //
- // Null terminate the Unicode string
- //
- *String = L'\0';
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Detect media status for specified network device.
-
- The underlying UNDI driver may or may not support reporting media status from
- GET_STATUS command (PXE_STATFLAGS_GET_STATUS_NO_MEDIA_SUPPORTED). This routine
- will try to invoke Snp->GetStatus() to get the media status: if media already
- present, it return directly; if media not present, it will stop SNP and then
- restart SNP to get the latest media status, this give chance to get the correct
- media status for old UNDI driver which doesn't support reporting media status
- from GET_STATUS command.
- Note: there will be two limitations for current algorithm:
- 1) for UNDI with this capability, in case of cable is not attached, there will
- be an redundant Stop/Start() process;
- 2) for UNDI without this capability, in case that network cable is attached when
- Snp->Initialize() is invoked while network cable is unattached later,
- NetLibDetectMedia() will report MediaPresent as TRUE, causing upper layer
- apps to wait for timeout time.
-
- @param[in] ServiceHandle The handle where network service binding protocols are
- installed on.
- @param[out] MediaPresent The pointer to store the media status.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Media detection success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER ServiceHandle is not valid network device handle.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Network device does not support media detection.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR SNP is in unknown state.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibDetectMedia (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ServiceHandle,
- OUT BOOLEAN *MediaPresent
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE SnpHandle;
- EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL *Snp;
- UINT32 InterruptStatus;
- UINT32 OldState;
- EFI_MAC_ADDRESS *MCastFilter;
- UINT32 MCastFilterCount;
- UINT32 EnableFilterBits;
- UINT32 DisableFilterBits;
- BOOLEAN ResetMCastFilters;
-
- ASSERT (MediaPresent != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get SNP handle
- //
- Snp = NULL;
- SnpHandle = NetLibGetSnpHandle (ServiceHandle, &Snp);
- if (SnpHandle == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check whether SNP support media detection
- //
- if (!Snp->Mode->MediaPresentSupported) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Invoke Snp->GetStatus() to refresh MediaPresent field in SNP mode data
- //
- Status = Snp->GetStatus (Snp, &InterruptStatus, NULL);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- if (Snp->Mode->MediaPresent) {
- //
- // Media is present, return directly
- //
- *MediaPresent = TRUE;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Till now, GetStatus() report no media; while, in case UNDI not support
- // reporting media status from GetStatus(), this media status may be incorrect.
- // So, we will stop SNP and then restart it to get the correct media status.
- //
- OldState = Snp->Mode->State;
- if (OldState >= EfiSimpleNetworkMaxState) {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-
- MCastFilter = NULL;
-
- if (OldState == EfiSimpleNetworkInitialized) {
- //
- // SNP is already in use, need Shutdown/Stop and then Start/Initialize
- //
-
- //
- // Backup current SNP receive filter settings
- //
- EnableFilterBits = Snp->Mode->ReceiveFilterSetting;
- DisableFilterBits = Snp->Mode->ReceiveFilterMask ^ EnableFilterBits;
-
- ResetMCastFilters = TRUE;
- MCastFilterCount = Snp->Mode->MCastFilterCount;
- if (MCastFilterCount != 0) {
- MCastFilter = AllocateCopyPool (
- MCastFilterCount * sizeof (EFI_MAC_ADDRESS),
- Snp->Mode->MCastFilter
- );
- ASSERT (MCastFilter != NULL);
-
- ResetMCastFilters = FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Shutdown/Stop the simple network
- //
- Status = Snp->Shutdown (Snp);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = Snp->Stop (Snp);
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Exit;
- }
-
- //
- // Start/Initialize the simple network
- //
- Status = Snp->Start (Snp);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = Snp->Initialize (Snp, 0, 0);
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Exit;
- }
-
- //
- // Here we get the correct media status
- //
- *MediaPresent = Snp->Mode->MediaPresent;
-
- //
- // Restore SNP receive filter settings
- //
- Status = Snp->ReceiveFilters (
- Snp,
- EnableFilterBits,
- DisableFilterBits,
- ResetMCastFilters,
- MCastFilterCount,
- MCastFilter
- );
-
- if (MCastFilter != NULL) {
- FreePool (MCastFilter);
- }
-
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // SNP is not in use, it's in state of EfiSimpleNetworkStopped or EfiSimpleNetworkStarted
- //
- if (OldState == EfiSimpleNetworkStopped) {
- //
- // SNP not start yet, start it
- //
- Status = Snp->Start (Snp);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Exit;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Initialize the simple network
- //
- Status = Snp->Initialize (Snp, 0, 0);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- goto Exit;
- }
-
- //
- // Here we get the correct media status
- //
- *MediaPresent = Snp->Mode->MediaPresent;
-
- //
- // Shut down the simple network
- //
- Snp->Shutdown (Snp);
-
-Exit:
- if (OldState == EfiSimpleNetworkStopped) {
- //
- // Original SNP sate is Stopped, restore to original state
- //
- Snp->Stop (Snp);
- }
-
- if (MCastFilter != NULL) {
- FreePool (MCastFilter);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Check the default address used by the IPv4 driver is static or dynamic (acquired
- from DHCP).
-
- If the controller handle does not have the EFI_IP4_CONFIG2_PROTOCOL installed, the
- default address is static. If failed to get the policy from Ip4 Config2 Protocol,
- the default address is static. Otherwise, get the result from Ip4 Config2 Protocol.
-
- @param[in] Controller The controller handle which has the EFI_IP4_CONFIG2_PROTOCOL
- relative with the default address to judge.
-
- @retval TRUE If the default address is static.
- @retval FALSE If the default address is acquired from DHCP.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-NetLibDefaultAddressIsStatic (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_IP4_CONFIG2_PROTOCOL *Ip4Config2;
- UINTN DataSize;
- EFI_IP4_CONFIG2_POLICY Policy;
- BOOLEAN IsStatic;
-
- Ip4Config2 = NULL;
-
- DataSize = sizeof (EFI_IP4_CONFIG2_POLICY);
-
- IsStatic = TRUE;
-
- //
- // Get Ip4Config2 policy.
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Controller, &gEfiIp4Config2ProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &Ip4Config2);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- Status = Ip4Config2->GetData (Ip4Config2, Ip4Config2DataTypePolicy, &DataSize, &Policy);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- IsStatic = (BOOLEAN) (Policy == Ip4Config2PolicyStatic);
-
-ON_EXIT:
-
- return IsStatic;
-}
-
-/**
- Create an IPv4 device path node.
-
- The header type of IPv4 device path node is MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH.
- The header subtype of IPv4 device path node is MSG_IPv4_DP.
- Get other info from parameters to make up the whole IPv4 device path node.
-
- @param[in, out] Node Pointer to the IPv4 device path node.
- @param[in] Controller The controller handle.
- @param[in] LocalIp The local IPv4 address.
- @param[in] LocalPort The local port.
- @param[in] RemoteIp The remote IPv4 address.
- @param[in] RemotePort The remote port.
- @param[in] Protocol The protocol type in the IP header.
- @param[in] UseDefaultAddress Whether this instance is using default address or not.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetLibCreateIPv4DPathNode (
- IN OUT IPv4_DEVICE_PATH *Node,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN IP4_ADDR LocalIp,
- IN UINT16 LocalPort,
- IN IP4_ADDR RemoteIp,
- IN UINT16 RemotePort,
- IN UINT16 Protocol,
- IN BOOLEAN UseDefaultAddress
- )
-{
- Node->Header.Type = MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH;
- Node->Header.SubType = MSG_IPv4_DP;
- SetDevicePathNodeLength (&Node->Header, sizeof (IPv4_DEVICE_PATH));
-
- CopyMem (&Node->LocalIpAddress, &LocalIp, sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS));
- CopyMem (&Node->RemoteIpAddress, &RemoteIp, sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS));
-
- Node->LocalPort = LocalPort;
- Node->RemotePort = RemotePort;
-
- Node->Protocol = Protocol;
-
- if (!UseDefaultAddress) {
- Node->StaticIpAddress = TRUE;
- } else {
- Node->StaticIpAddress = NetLibDefaultAddressIsStatic (Controller);
- }
-
- //
- // Set the Gateway IP address to default value 0:0:0:0.
- // Set the Subnet mask to default value 255:255:255:0.
- //
- ZeroMem (&Node->GatewayIpAddress, sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS));
- SetMem (&Node->SubnetMask, sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS), 0xff);
- Node->SubnetMask.Addr[3] = 0;
-}
-
-/**
- Create an IPv6 device path node.
-
- The header type of IPv6 device path node is MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH.
- The header subtype of IPv6 device path node is MSG_IPv6_DP.
- Get other info from parameters to make up the whole IPv6 device path node.
-
- @param[in, out] Node Pointer to the IPv6 device path node.
- @param[in] Controller The controller handle.
- @param[in] LocalIp The local IPv6 address.
- @param[in] LocalPort The local port.
- @param[in] RemoteIp The remote IPv6 address.
- @param[in] RemotePort The remote port.
- @param[in] Protocol The protocol type in the IP header.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetLibCreateIPv6DPathNode (
- IN OUT IPv6_DEVICE_PATH *Node,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *LocalIp,
- IN UINT16 LocalPort,
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *RemoteIp,
- IN UINT16 RemotePort,
- IN UINT16 Protocol
- )
-{
- Node->Header.Type = MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH;
- Node->Header.SubType = MSG_IPv6_DP;
- SetDevicePathNodeLength (&Node->Header, sizeof (IPv6_DEVICE_PATH));
-
- CopyMem (&Node->LocalIpAddress, LocalIp, sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS));
- CopyMem (&Node->RemoteIpAddress, RemoteIp, sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS));
-
- Node->LocalPort = LocalPort;
- Node->RemotePort = RemotePort;
-
- Node->Protocol = Protocol;
-
- //
- // Set default value to IPAddressOrigin, PrefixLength.
- // Set the Gateway IP address to unspecified address.
- //
- Node->IpAddressOrigin = 0;
- Node->PrefixLength = IP6_PREFIX_LENGTH;
- ZeroMem (&Node->GatewayIpAddress, sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS));
-}
-
-/**
- Find the UNDI/SNP handle from controller and protocol GUID.
-
- For example, IP will open a MNP child to transmit/receive
- packets, when MNP is stopped, IP should also be stopped. IP
- needs to find its own private data which is related the IP's
- service binding instance that is install on UNDI/SNP handle.
- Now, the controller is either a MNP or ARP child handle. But
- IP opens these handle BY_DRIVER, use that info, we can get the
- UNDI/SNP handle.
-
- @param[in] Controller Then protocol handle to check.
- @param[in] ProtocolGuid The protocol that is related with the handle.
-
- @return The UNDI/SNP handle or NULL for errors.
-
-**/
-EFI_HANDLE
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetNicHandle (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN EFI_GUID *ProtocolGuid
- )
-{
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_INFORMATION_ENTRY *OpenBuffer;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN OpenCount;
- UINTN Index;
-
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocolInformation (
- Controller,
- ProtocolGuid,
- &OpenBuffer,
- &OpenCount
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Handle = NULL;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < OpenCount; Index++) {
- if ((OpenBuffer[Index].Attributes & EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_DRIVER) != 0) {
- Handle = OpenBuffer[Index].ControllerHandle;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- gBS->FreePool (OpenBuffer);
- return Handle;
-}
-
-/**
- Convert one Null-terminated ASCII string (decimal dotted) to EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS.
-
- @param[in] String The pointer to the Ascii string.
- @param[out] Ip4Address The pointer to the converted IPv4 address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert to IPv4 address successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The string is mal-formated or Ip4Address is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibAsciiStrToIp4 (
- IN CONST CHAR8 *String,
- OUT EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS *Ip4Address
- )
-{
- UINT8 Index;
- CHAR8 *Ip4Str;
- CHAR8 *TempStr;
- UINTN NodeVal;
-
- if ((String == NULL) || (Ip4Address == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Ip4Str = (CHAR8 *) String;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < 4; Index++) {
- TempStr = Ip4Str;
-
- while ((*Ip4Str != '\0') && (*Ip4Str != '.')) {
- Ip4Str++;
- }
-
- //
- // The IPv4 address is X.X.X.X
- //
- if (*Ip4Str == '.') {
- if (Index == 3) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- } else {
- if (Index != 3) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Convert the string to IPv4 address. AsciiStrDecimalToUintn stops at the
- // first character that is not a valid decimal character, '.' or '\0' here.
- //
- NodeVal = AsciiStrDecimalToUintn (TempStr);
- if (NodeVal > 0xFF) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Ip4Address->Addr[Index] = (UINT8) NodeVal;
-
- Ip4Str++;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Convert one Null-terminated ASCII string to EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS. The format of the
- string is defined in RFC 4291 - Text Pepresentation of Addresses.
-
- @param[in] String The pointer to the Ascii string.
- @param[out] Ip6Address The pointer to the converted IPv6 address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert to IPv6 address successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The string is mal-formated or Ip6Address is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibAsciiStrToIp6 (
- IN CONST CHAR8 *String,
- OUT EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6Address
- )
-{
- UINT8 Index;
- CHAR8 *Ip6Str;
- CHAR8 *TempStr;
- CHAR8 *TempStr2;
- UINT8 NodeCnt;
- UINT8 TailNodeCnt;
- UINT8 AllowedCnt;
- UINTN NodeVal;
- BOOLEAN Short;
- BOOLEAN Update;
- BOOLEAN LeadZero;
- UINT8 LeadZeroCnt;
- UINT8 Cnt;
-
- if ((String == NULL) || (Ip6Address == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Ip6Str = (CHAR8 *) String;
- AllowedCnt = 6;
- LeadZeroCnt = 0;
-
- //
- // An IPv6 address leading with : looks strange.
- //
- if (*Ip6Str == ':') {
- if (*(Ip6Str + 1) != ':') {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- } else {
- AllowedCnt = 7;
- }
- }
-
- ZeroMem (Ip6Address, sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS));
-
- NodeCnt = 0;
- TailNodeCnt = 0;
- Short = FALSE;
- Update = FALSE;
- LeadZero = FALSE;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < 15; Index = (UINT8) (Index + 2)) {
- TempStr = Ip6Str;
-
- while ((*Ip6Str != '\0') && (*Ip6Str != ':')) {
- Ip6Str++;
- }
-
- if ((*Ip6Str == '\0') && (Index != 14)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (*Ip6Str == ':') {
- if (*(Ip6Str + 1) == ':') {
- if ((NodeCnt > 6) ||
- ((*(Ip6Str + 2) != '\0') && (AsciiStrHexToUintn (Ip6Str + 2) == 0))) {
- //
- // ::0 looks strange. report error to user.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if ((NodeCnt == 6) && (*(Ip6Str + 2) != '\0') &&
- (AsciiStrHexToUintn (Ip6Str + 2) != 0)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Skip the abbreviation part of IPv6 address.
- //
- TempStr2 = Ip6Str + 2;
- while ((*TempStr2 != '\0')) {
- if (*TempStr2 == ':') {
- if (*(TempStr2 + 1) == ':') {
- //
- // :: can only appear once in IPv6 address.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- TailNodeCnt++;
- if (TailNodeCnt >= (AllowedCnt - NodeCnt)) {
- //
- // :: indicates one or more groups of 16 bits of zeros.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
- TempStr2++;
- }
-
- Short = TRUE;
- Update = TRUE;
-
- Ip6Str = Ip6Str + 2;
- } else {
- if (*(Ip6Str + 1) == '\0') {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- Ip6Str++;
- NodeCnt++;
- if ((Short && (NodeCnt > 6)) || (!Short && (NodeCnt > 7))) {
- //
- // There are more than 8 groups of 16 bits of zeros.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Convert the string to IPv6 address. AsciiStrHexToUintn stops at the first
- // character that is not a valid hexadecimal character, ':' or '\0' here.
- //
- NodeVal = AsciiStrHexToUintn (TempStr);
- if ((NodeVal > 0xFFFF) || (Index > 14)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (NodeVal != 0) {
- if ((*TempStr == '0') &&
- ((*(TempStr + 2) == ':') || (*(TempStr + 3) == ':') ||
- (*(TempStr + 2) == '\0') || (*(TempStr + 3) == '\0'))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if ((*TempStr == '0') && (*(TempStr + 4) != '\0') &&
- (*(TempStr + 4) != ':')) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- } else {
- if (((*TempStr == '0') && (*(TempStr + 1) == '0') &&
- ((*(TempStr + 2) == ':') || (*(TempStr + 2) == '\0'))) ||
- ((*TempStr == '0') && (*(TempStr + 1) == '0') && (*(TempStr + 2) == '0') &&
- ((*(TempStr + 3) == ':') || (*(TempStr + 3) == '\0')))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
- Cnt = 0;
- while ((TempStr[Cnt] != ':') && (TempStr[Cnt] != '\0')) {
- Cnt++;
- }
- if (LeadZeroCnt == 0) {
- if ((Cnt == 4) && (*TempStr == '0')) {
- LeadZero = TRUE;
- LeadZeroCnt++;
- }
- if ((Cnt != 0) && (Cnt < 4)) {
- LeadZero = FALSE;
- LeadZeroCnt++;
- }
- } else {
- if ((Cnt == 4) && (*TempStr == '0') && !LeadZero) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if ((Cnt != 0) && (Cnt < 4) && LeadZero) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
- Ip6Address->Addr[Index] = (UINT8) (NodeVal >> 8);
- Ip6Address->Addr[Index + 1] = (UINT8) (NodeVal & 0xFF);
-
- //
- // Skip the groups of zeros by ::
- //
- if (Short && Update) {
- Index = (UINT8) (16 - (TailNodeCnt + 2) * 2);
- Update = FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- if ((!Short && Index != 16) || (*Ip6Str != '\0')) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Convert one Null-terminated Unicode string (decimal dotted) to EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS.
-
- @param[in] String The pointer to the Ascii string.
- @param[out] Ip4Address The pointer to the converted IPv4 address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert to IPv4 address successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The string is mal-formated or Ip4Address is NULL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Fail to perform the operation due to lack of resource.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibStrToIp4 (
- IN CONST CHAR16 *String,
- OUT EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS *Ip4Address
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Ip4Str;
- UINTN StringSize;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if ((String == NULL) || (Ip4Address == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- StringSize = StrLen (String) + 1;
- Ip4Str = (CHAR8 *) AllocatePool (StringSize * sizeof (CHAR8));
- if (Ip4Str == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- UnicodeStrToAsciiStrS (String, Ip4Str, StringSize);
-
- Status = NetLibAsciiStrToIp4 (Ip4Str, Ip4Address);
-
- FreePool (Ip4Str);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Convert one Null-terminated Unicode string to EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS. The format of
- the string is defined in RFC 4291 - Text Pepresentation of Addresses.
-
- @param[in] String The pointer to the Ascii string.
- @param[out] Ip6Address The pointer to the converted IPv6 address.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert to IPv6 address successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The string is mal-formated or Ip6Address is NULL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Fail to perform the operation due to lack of resource.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibStrToIp6 (
- IN CONST CHAR16 *String,
- OUT EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6Address
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Ip6Str;
- UINTN StringSize;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if ((String == NULL) || (Ip6Address == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- StringSize = StrLen (String) + 1;
- Ip6Str = (CHAR8 *) AllocatePool (StringSize * sizeof (CHAR8));
- if (Ip6Str == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- UnicodeStrToAsciiStrS (String, Ip6Str, StringSize);
-
- Status = NetLibAsciiStrToIp6 (Ip6Str, Ip6Address);
-
- FreePool (Ip6Str);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Convert one Null-terminated Unicode string to EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS and prefix length.
- The format of the string is defined in RFC 4291 - Text Pepresentation of Addresses
- Prefixes: ipv6-address/prefix-length.
-
- @param[in] String The pointer to the Ascii string.
- @param[out] Ip6Address The pointer to the converted IPv6 address.
- @param[out] PrefixLength The pointer to the converted prefix length.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert to IPv6 address successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The string is mal-formated or Ip6Address is NULL.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Fail to perform the operation due to lack of resource.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibStrToIp6andPrefix (
- IN CONST CHAR16 *String,
- OUT EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6Address,
- OUT UINT8 *PrefixLength
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *Ip6Str;
- UINTN StringSize;
- CHAR8 *PrefixStr;
- CHAR8 *TempStr;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT8 Length;
-
- if ((String == NULL) || (Ip6Address == NULL) || (PrefixLength == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- StringSize = StrLen (String) + 1;
- Ip6Str = (CHAR8 *) AllocatePool (StringSize * sizeof (CHAR8));
- if (Ip6Str == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- UnicodeStrToAsciiStrS (String, Ip6Str, StringSize);
-
- //
- // Get the sub string describing prefix length.
- //
- TempStr = Ip6Str;
- while (*TempStr != '\0' && (*TempStr != '/')) {
- TempStr++;
- }
-
- if (*TempStr == '/') {
- PrefixStr = TempStr + 1;
- } else {
- PrefixStr = NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the sub string describing IPv6 address and convert it.
- //
- *TempStr = '\0';
-
- Status = NetLibAsciiStrToIp6 (Ip6Str, Ip6Address);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Exit;
- }
-
- //
- // If input string doesn't indicate the prefix length, return 0xff.
- //
- Length = 0xFF;
-
- //
- // Convert the string to prefix length
- //
- if (PrefixStr != NULL) {
-
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- Length = 0;
- while (*PrefixStr != '\0') {
- if (NET_IS_DIGIT (*PrefixStr)) {
- Length = (UINT8) (Length * 10 + (*PrefixStr - '0'));
- if (Length >= IP6_PREFIX_NUM) {
- goto Exit;
- }
- } else {
- goto Exit;
- }
-
- PrefixStr++;
- }
- }
-
- *PrefixLength = Length;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
-
-Exit:
-
- FreePool (Ip6Str);
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
-
- Convert one EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS to Null-terminated Unicode string.
- The text representation of address is defined in RFC 4291.
-
- @param[in] Ip6Address The pointer to the IPv6 address.
- @param[out] String The buffer to return the converted string.
- @param[in] StringSize The length in bytes of the input String.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Convert to string successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The input parameter is invalid.
- @retval EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL The BufferSize is too small for the result. BufferSize has been
- updated with the size needed to complete the request.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibIp6ToStr (
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Ip6Address,
- OUT CHAR16 *String,
- IN UINTN StringSize
- )
-{
- UINT16 Ip6Addr[8];
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN LongestZerosStart;
- UINTN LongestZerosLength;
- UINTN CurrentZerosStart;
- UINTN CurrentZerosLength;
- CHAR16 Buffer[sizeof"ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff"];
- CHAR16 *Ptr;
-
- if (Ip6Address == NULL || String == NULL || StringSize == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Convert the UINT8 array to an UINT16 array for easy handling.
- //
- ZeroMem (Ip6Addr, sizeof (Ip6Addr));
- for (Index = 0; Index < 16; Index++) {
- Ip6Addr[Index / 2] |= (Ip6Address->Addr[Index] << ((1 - (Index % 2)) << 3));
- }
-
- //
- // Find the longest zeros and mark it.
- //
- CurrentZerosStart = DEFAULT_ZERO_START;
- CurrentZerosLength = 0;
- LongestZerosStart = DEFAULT_ZERO_START;
- LongestZerosLength = 0;
- for (Index = 0; Index < 8; Index++) {
- if (Ip6Addr[Index] == 0) {
- if (CurrentZerosStart == DEFAULT_ZERO_START) {
- CurrentZerosStart = Index;
- CurrentZerosLength = 1;
- } else {
- CurrentZerosLength++;
- }
- } else {
- if (CurrentZerosStart != DEFAULT_ZERO_START) {
- if (CurrentZerosLength > 2 && (LongestZerosStart == (DEFAULT_ZERO_START) || CurrentZerosLength > LongestZerosLength)) {
- LongestZerosStart = CurrentZerosStart;
- LongestZerosLength = CurrentZerosLength;
- }
- CurrentZerosStart = DEFAULT_ZERO_START;
- CurrentZerosLength = 0;
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (CurrentZerosStart != DEFAULT_ZERO_START && CurrentZerosLength > 2) {
- if (LongestZerosStart == DEFAULT_ZERO_START || LongestZerosLength < CurrentZerosLength) {
- LongestZerosStart = CurrentZerosStart;
- LongestZerosLength = CurrentZerosLength;
- }
- }
-
- Ptr = Buffer;
- for (Index = 0; Index < 8; Index++) {
- if (LongestZerosStart != DEFAULT_ZERO_START && Index >= LongestZerosStart && Index < LongestZerosStart + LongestZerosLength) {
- if (Index == LongestZerosStart) {
- *Ptr++ = L':';
- }
- continue;
- }
- if (Index != 0) {
- *Ptr++ = L':';
- }
- Ptr += UnicodeSPrint(Ptr, 10, L"%x", Ip6Addr[Index]);
- }
-
- if (LongestZerosStart != DEFAULT_ZERO_START && LongestZerosStart + LongestZerosLength == 8) {
- *Ptr++ = L':';
- }
- *Ptr = L'\0';
-
- if ((UINTN)Ptr - (UINTN)Buffer > StringSize) {
- return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
- }
-
- StrCpyS (String, StringSize / sizeof (CHAR16), Buffer);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function obtains the system guid from the smbios table.
-
- @param[out] SystemGuid The pointer of the returned system guid.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully obtained the system guid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Did not find the SMBIOS table.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetLibGetSystemGuid (
- OUT EFI_GUID *SystemGuid
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SMBIOS_TABLE_ENTRY_POINT *SmbiosTable;
- SMBIOS_TABLE_3_0_ENTRY_POINT *Smbios30Table;
- SMBIOS_STRUCTURE_POINTER Smbios;
- SMBIOS_STRUCTURE_POINTER SmbiosEnd;
- CHAR8 *String;
-
- SmbiosTable = NULL;
- Status = EfiGetSystemConfigurationTable (&gEfiSmbios3TableGuid, (VOID **) &Smbios30Table);
- if (!(EFI_ERROR (Status) || Smbios30Table == NULL)) {
- Smbios.Hdr = (SMBIOS_STRUCTURE *) (UINTN) Smbios30Table->TableAddress;
- SmbiosEnd.Raw = (UINT8 *) (UINTN) (Smbios30Table->TableAddress + Smbios30Table->TableMaximumSize);
- } else {
- Status = EfiGetSystemConfigurationTable (&gEfiSmbiosTableGuid, (VOID **) &SmbiosTable);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || SmbiosTable == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- Smbios.Hdr = (SMBIOS_STRUCTURE *) (UINTN) SmbiosTable->TableAddress;
- SmbiosEnd.Raw = (UINT8 *) (UINTN) (SmbiosTable->TableAddress + SmbiosTable->TableLength);
- }
-
- do {
- if (Smbios.Hdr->Type == 1) {
- if (Smbios.Hdr->Length < 0x19) {
- //
- // Older version did not support UUID.
- //
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // SMBIOS tables are byte packed so we need to do a byte copy to
- // prevend alignment faults on Itanium-based platform.
- //
- CopyMem (SystemGuid, &Smbios.Type1->Uuid, sizeof (EFI_GUID));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Go to the next SMBIOS structure. Each SMBIOS structure may include 2 parts:
- // 1. Formatted section; 2. Unformatted string section. So, 2 steps are needed
- // to skip one SMBIOS structure.
- //
-
- //
- // Step 1: Skip over formatted section.
- //
- String = (CHAR8 *) (Smbios.Raw + Smbios.Hdr->Length);
-
- //
- // Step 2: Skip over unformated string section.
- //
- do {
- //
- // Each string is terminated with a NULL(00h) BYTE and the sets of strings
- // is terminated with an additional NULL(00h) BYTE.
- //
- for ( ; *String != 0; String++) {
- }
-
- if (*(UINT8*)++String == 0) {
- //
- // Pointer to the next SMBIOS structure.
- //
- Smbios.Raw = (UINT8 *)++String;
- break;
- }
- } while (TRUE);
- } while (Smbios.Raw < SmbiosEnd.Raw);
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 1ff3a4fe55..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,65 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# This library instance provides the basic network services.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# (C) Copyright 2015 Hewlett Packard Enterprise Development LP<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeNetLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeNetLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = db6dcef3-9f4e-4340-9351-fc35aa8a5888
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NetLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeNetLib.c
- NetBuffer.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib
- UefiLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- DevicePathLib
- PrintLib
-
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiSmbiosTableGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## SystemTable
- gEfiSmbios3TableGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## SystemTable
-
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiManagedNetworkProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiManagedNetworkServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiIp4Config2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiComponentNameProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiComponentName2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index bd74cfacbd..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/DxeNetLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/NetBuffer.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/NetBuffer.c deleted file mode 100644 index bbbdbc048a..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeNetLib/NetBuffer.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1892 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Network library functions providing net buffer operation support.
-
-Copyright (c) 2005 - 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Library/NetLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-
-
-/**
- Allocate and build up the sketch for a NET_BUF.
-
- The net buffer allocated has the BlockOpNum's NET_BLOCK_OP, and its associated
- NET_VECTOR has the BlockNum's NET_BLOCK. But all the NET_BLOCK_OP and
- NET_BLOCK remain un-initialized.
-
- @param[in] BlockNum The number of NET_BLOCK in the vector of net buffer
- @param[in] BlockOpNum The number of NET_BLOCK_OP in the net buffer
-
- @return Pointer to the allocated NET_BUF, or NULL if the
- allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-NetbufAllocStruct (
- IN UINT32 BlockNum,
- IN UINT32 BlockOpNum
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
- NET_VECTOR *Vector;
-
- ASSERT (BlockOpNum >= 1);
-
- //
- // Allocate three memory blocks.
- //
- Nbuf = AllocateZeroPool (NET_BUF_SIZE (BlockOpNum));
-
- if (Nbuf == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Nbuf->Signature = NET_BUF_SIGNATURE;
- Nbuf->RefCnt = 1;
- Nbuf->BlockOpNum = BlockOpNum;
- InitializeListHead (&Nbuf->List);
-
- if (BlockNum != 0) {
- Vector = AllocateZeroPool (NET_VECTOR_SIZE (BlockNum));
-
- if (Vector == NULL) {
- goto FreeNbuf;
- }
-
- Vector->Signature = NET_VECTOR_SIGNATURE;
- Vector->RefCnt = 1;
- Vector->BlockNum = BlockNum;
- Nbuf->Vector = Vector;
- }
-
- return Nbuf;
-
-FreeNbuf:
-
- FreePool (Nbuf);
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Allocate a single block NET_BUF. Upon allocation, all the
- free space is in the tail room.
-
- @param[in] Len The length of the block.
-
- @return Pointer to the allocated NET_BUF, or NULL if the
- allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufAlloc (
- IN UINT32 Len
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
- NET_VECTOR *Vector;
- UINT8 *Bulk;
-
- ASSERT (Len > 0);
-
- Nbuf = NetbufAllocStruct (1, 1);
-
- if (Nbuf == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Bulk = AllocatePool (Len);
-
- if (Bulk == NULL) {
- goto FreeNBuf;
- }
-
- Vector = Nbuf->Vector;
- Vector->Len = Len;
-
- Vector->Block[0].Bulk = Bulk;
- Vector->Block[0].Len = Len;
-
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].BlockHead = Bulk;
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].BlockTail = Bulk + Len;
-
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Head = Bulk;
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Tail = Bulk;
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Size = 0;
-
- return Nbuf;
-
-FreeNBuf:
- FreePool (Nbuf);
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Free the net vector.
-
- Decrease the reference count of the net vector by one. The real resource free
- operation isn't performed until the reference count of the net vector is
- decreased to 0.
-
- @param[in] Vector Pointer to the NET_VECTOR to be freed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-NetbufFreeVector (
- IN NET_VECTOR *Vector
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
-
- ASSERT (Vector != NULL);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Vector, NET_VECTOR_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Vector->RefCnt > 0);
-
- Vector->RefCnt--;
-
- if (Vector->RefCnt > 0) {
- return;
- }
-
- if (Vector->Free != NULL) {
- //
- // Call external free function to free the vector if it
- // isn't NULL. If NET_VECTOR_OWN_FIRST is set, release the
- // first block since it is allocated by us
- //
- if ((Vector->Flag & NET_VECTOR_OWN_FIRST) != 0) {
- gBS->FreePool (Vector->Block[0].Bulk);
- }
-
- Vector->Free (Vector->Arg);
-
- } else {
- //
- // Free each memory block associated with the Vector
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < Vector->BlockNum; Index++) {
- gBS->FreePool (Vector->Block[Index].Bulk);
- }
- }
-
- FreePool (Vector);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Free the net buffer and its associated NET_VECTOR.
-
- Decrease the reference count of the net buffer by one. Free the associated net
- vector and itself if the reference count of the net buffer is decreased to 0.
- The net vector free operation just decrease the reference count of the net
- vector by one and do the real resource free operation when the reference count
- of the net vector is 0.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the NET_BUF to be freed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufFree (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf
- )
-{
- ASSERT (Nbuf != NULL);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Nbuf->RefCnt > 0);
-
- Nbuf->RefCnt--;
-
- if (Nbuf->RefCnt == 0) {
- //
- // Update Vector only when NBuf is to be released. That is,
- // all the sharing of Nbuf increse Vector's RefCnt by one
- //
- NetbufFreeVector (Nbuf->Vector);
- FreePool (Nbuf);
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Create a copy of the net buffer that shares the associated net vector.
-
- The reference count of the newly created net buffer is set to 1. The reference
- count of the associated net vector is increased by one.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer to be cloned.
-
- @return Pointer to the cloned net buffer, or NULL if the
- allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufClone (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *Clone;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- Clone = AllocatePool (NET_BUF_SIZE (Nbuf->BlockOpNum));
-
- if (Clone == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Clone->Signature = NET_BUF_SIGNATURE;
- Clone->RefCnt = 1;
- InitializeListHead (&Clone->List);
-
- Clone->Ip = Nbuf->Ip;
- Clone->Tcp = Nbuf->Tcp;
-
- CopyMem (Clone->ProtoData, Nbuf->ProtoData, NET_PROTO_DATA);
-
- NET_GET_REF (Nbuf->Vector);
-
- Clone->Vector = Nbuf->Vector;
- Clone->BlockOpNum = Nbuf->BlockOpNum;
- Clone->TotalSize = Nbuf->TotalSize;
- CopyMem (Clone->BlockOp, Nbuf->BlockOp, sizeof (NET_BLOCK_OP) * Nbuf->BlockOpNum);
-
- return Clone;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Create a duplicated copy of the net buffer with data copied and HeadSpace
- bytes of head space reserved.
-
- The duplicated net buffer will allocate its own memory to hold the data of the
- source net buffer.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer to be duplicated from.
- @param[in, out] Duplicate Pointer to the net buffer to duplicate to, if
- NULL a new net buffer is allocated.
- @param[in] HeadSpace Length of the head space to reserve.
-
- @return Pointer to the duplicated net buffer, or NULL if
- the allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufDuplicate (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Duplicate OPTIONAL,
- IN UINT32 HeadSpace
- )
-{
- UINT8 *Dst;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- if (Duplicate == NULL) {
- Duplicate = NetbufAlloc (Nbuf->TotalSize + HeadSpace);
- }
-
- if (Duplicate == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Don't set the IP and TCP head point, since it is most
- // like that they are pointing to the memory of Nbuf.
- //
- CopyMem (Duplicate->ProtoData, Nbuf->ProtoData, NET_PROTO_DATA);
- NetbufReserve (Duplicate, HeadSpace);
-
- Dst = NetbufAllocSpace (Duplicate, Nbuf->TotalSize, NET_BUF_TAIL);
- NetbufCopy (Nbuf, 0, Nbuf->TotalSize, Dst);
-
- return Duplicate;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Free a list of net buffers.
-
- @param[in, out] Head Pointer to the head of linked net buffers.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufFreeList (
- IN OUT LIST_ENTRY *Head
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- LIST_ENTRY *Next;
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
-
- Entry = Head->ForwardLink;
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH_SAFE (Entry, Next, Head) {
- Nbuf = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_BUF, List);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- RemoveEntryList (Entry);
- NetbufFree (Nbuf);
- }
-
- ASSERT (IsListEmpty (Head));
-}
-
-
-/**
- Get the index of NET_BLOCK_OP that contains the byte at Offset in the net
- buffer.
-
- This can be used to, for example, retrieve the IP header in the packet. It
- also can be used to get the fragment that contains the byte which is used
- mainly by the library implementation itself.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Offset The offset of the byte.
- @param[out] Index Index of the NET_BLOCK_OP that contains the byte at
- Offset.
-
- @return Pointer to the Offset'th byte of data in the net buffer, or NULL
- if there is no such data in the net buffer.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufGetByte (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT32 Offset,
- OUT UINT32 *Index OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- UINT32 Loop;
- UINT32 Len;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- if (Offset >= Nbuf->TotalSize) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- BlockOp = Nbuf->BlockOp;
- Len = 0;
-
- for (Loop = 0; Loop < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Loop++) {
-
- if (Len + BlockOp[Loop].Size <= Offset) {
- Len += BlockOp[Loop].Size;
- continue;
- }
-
- if (Index != NULL) {
- *Index = Loop;
- }
-
- return BlockOp[Loop].Head + (Offset - Len);
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-
-/**
- Set the NET_BLOCK and corresponding NET_BLOCK_OP in the net buffer and
- corresponding net vector according to the bulk pointer and bulk length.
-
- All the pointers in the Index'th NET_BLOCK and NET_BLOCK_OP are set to the
- bulk's head and tail respectively. So, this function alone can't be used by
- NetbufAlloc.
-
- @param[in, out] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Bulk Pointer to the data.
- @param[in] Len Length of the bulk data.
- @param[in] Index The data block index in the net buffer the bulk
- data should belong to.
-
-**/
-VOID
-NetbufSetBlock (
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT8 *Bulk,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN UINT32 Index
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- NET_BLOCK *Block;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf->Vector, NET_VECTOR_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum);
-
- Block = &(Nbuf->Vector->Block[Index]);
- BlockOp = &(Nbuf->BlockOp[Index]);
- Block->Len = Len;
- Block->Bulk = Bulk;
- BlockOp->BlockHead = Bulk;
- BlockOp->BlockTail = Bulk + Len;
- BlockOp->Head = Bulk;
- BlockOp->Tail = Bulk + Len;
- BlockOp->Size = Len;
-}
-
-
-
-/**
- Set the NET_BLOCK_OP in the net buffer. The corresponding NET_BLOCK
- structure is left untouched.
-
- Some times, there is no 1:1 relationship between NET_BLOCK and NET_BLOCK_OP.
- For example, that in NetbufGetFragment.
-
- @param[in, out] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Bulk Pointer to the data.
- @param[in] Len Length of the bulk data.
- @param[in] Index The data block index in the net buffer the bulk
- data should belong to.
-
-**/
-VOID
-NetbufSetBlockOp (
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT8 *Bulk,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN UINT32 Index
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum);
-
- BlockOp = &(Nbuf->BlockOp[Index]);
- BlockOp->BlockHead = Bulk;
- BlockOp->BlockTail = Bulk + Len;
- BlockOp->Head = Bulk;
- BlockOp->Tail = Bulk + Len;
- BlockOp->Size = Len;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Helper function for NetbufGetFragment. NetbufGetFragment may allocate the
- first block to reserve HeadSpace bytes header space. So it needs to create a
- new net vector for the first block and can avoid copy for the remaining data
- by sharing the old net vector.
-
- @param[in] Arg Point to the old NET_VECTOR.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufGetFragmentFree (
- IN VOID *Arg
- )
-{
- NET_VECTOR *Vector;
-
- Vector = (NET_VECTOR *)Arg;
- NetbufFreeVector (Vector);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Create a NET_BUF structure which contains Len byte data of Nbuf starting from
- Offset.
-
- A new NET_BUF structure will be created but the associated data in NET_VECTOR
- is shared. This function exists to do IP packet fragmentation.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer to be extracted.
- @param[in] Offset Starting point of the data to be included in the new
- net buffer.
- @param[in] Len Bytes of data to be included in the new net buffer.
- @param[in] HeadSpace Bytes of head space to reserve for protocol header.
-
- @return Pointer to the cloned net buffer, or NULL if the
- allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufGetFragment (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT32 Offset,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN UINT32 HeadSpace
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *Child;
- NET_VECTOR *Vector;
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- UINT32 CurBlockOp;
- UINT32 BlockOpNum;
- UINT8 *FirstBulk;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 First;
- UINT32 Last;
- UINT32 FirstSkip;
- UINT32 FirstLen;
- UINT32 LastLen;
- UINT32 Cur;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- if ((Len == 0) || (Offset + Len > Nbuf->TotalSize)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // First find the first and last BlockOp that contains
- // the valid data, and compute the offset of the first
- // BlockOp and length of the last BlockOp
- //
- BlockOp = Nbuf->BlockOp;
- Cur = 0;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Index++) {
- if (Offset < Cur + BlockOp[Index].Size) {
- break;
- }
-
- Cur += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- }
-
- //
- // First is the index of the first BlockOp, FirstSkip is
- // the offset of the first byte in the first BlockOp.
- //
- First = Index;
- FirstSkip = Offset - Cur;
- FirstLen = BlockOp[Index].Size - FirstSkip;
-
- Last = 0;
- LastLen = 0;
-
- if (Len > FirstLen) {
- Cur += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- Index++;
-
- for (; Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Index++) {
- if (Offset + Len <= Cur + BlockOp[Index].Size) {
- Last = Index;
- LastLen = Offset + Len - Cur;
- break;
- }
-
- Cur += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- }
-
- } else {
- Last = First;
- LastLen = Len;
- FirstLen = Len;
- }
-
- ASSERT (Last >= First);
- BlockOpNum = Last - First + 1;
- CurBlockOp = 0;
-
- if (HeadSpace != 0) {
- //
- // Allocate an extra block to accomdate the head space.
- //
- BlockOpNum++;
-
- Child = NetbufAllocStruct (1, BlockOpNum);
-
- if (Child == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- FirstBulk = AllocatePool (HeadSpace);
-
- if (FirstBulk == NULL) {
- goto FreeChild;
- }
-
- Vector = Child->Vector;
- Vector->Free = NetbufGetFragmentFree;
- Vector->Arg = Nbuf->Vector;
- Vector->Flag = NET_VECTOR_OWN_FIRST;
- Vector->Len = HeadSpace;
-
- //
- // Reserve the head space in the first block
- //
- NetbufSetBlock (Child, FirstBulk, HeadSpace, 0);
- Child->BlockOp[0].Head += HeadSpace;
- Child->BlockOp[0].Size = 0;
- CurBlockOp++;
-
- } else {
- Child = NetbufAllocStruct (0, BlockOpNum);
-
- if (Child == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Child->Vector = Nbuf->Vector;
- }
-
- NET_GET_REF (Nbuf->Vector);
- Child->TotalSize = Len;
-
- //
- // Set all the BlockOp up, the first and last one are special
- // and need special process.
- //
- NetbufSetBlockOp (
- Child,
- Nbuf->BlockOp[First].Head + FirstSkip,
- FirstLen,
- CurBlockOp++
- );
-
- for (Index = First + 1; Index < Last; Index++) {
- NetbufSetBlockOp (
- Child,
- BlockOp[Index].Head,
- BlockOp[Index].Size,
- CurBlockOp++
- );
- }
-
- if (First != Last) {
- NetbufSetBlockOp (
- Child,
- BlockOp[Last].Head,
- LastLen,
- CurBlockOp
- );
- }
-
- CopyMem (Child->ProtoData, Nbuf->ProtoData, NET_PROTO_DATA);
- return Child;
-
-FreeChild:
-
- FreePool (Child);
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-
-/**
- Build a NET_BUF from external blocks.
-
- A new NET_BUF structure will be created from external blocks. Additional block
- of memory will be allocated to hold reserved HeadSpace bytes of header room
- and existing HeadLen bytes of header but the external blocks are shared by the
- net buffer to avoid data copying.
-
- @param[in] ExtFragment Pointer to the data block.
- @param[in] ExtNum The number of the data blocks.
- @param[in] HeadSpace The head space to be reserved.
- @param[in] HeadLen The length of the protocol header, This function
- will pull that number of data into a linear block.
- @param[in] ExtFree Pointer to the caller provided free function.
- @param[in] Arg The argument passed to ExtFree when ExtFree is
- called.
-
- @return Pointer to the net buffer built from the data blocks,
- or NULL if the allocation failed due to resource
- limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufFromExt (
- IN NET_FRAGMENT *ExtFragment,
- IN UINT32 ExtNum,
- IN UINT32 HeadSpace,
- IN UINT32 HeadLen,
- IN NET_VECTOR_EXT_FREE ExtFree,
- IN VOID *Arg OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
- NET_VECTOR *Vector;
- NET_FRAGMENT SavedFragment;
- UINT32 SavedIndex;
- UINT32 TotalLen;
- UINT32 BlockNum;
- UINT8 *FirstBlock;
- UINT32 FirstBlockLen;
- UINT8 *Header;
- UINT32 CurBlock;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Len;
- UINT32 Copied;
-
- ASSERT ((ExtFragment != NULL) && (ExtNum > 0) && (ExtFree != NULL));
-
- SavedFragment.Bulk = NULL;
- SavedFragment.Len = 0;
-
- FirstBlockLen = 0;
- FirstBlock = NULL;
- BlockNum = ExtNum;
- Index = 0;
- TotalLen = 0;
- SavedIndex = 0;
- Len = 0;
- Copied = 0;
-
- //
- // No need to consolidate the header if the first block is
- // longer than the header length or there is only one block.
- //
- if ((ExtFragment[0].Len >= HeadLen) || (ExtNum == 1)) {
- HeadLen = 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate an extra block if we need to:
- // 1. Allocate some header space
- // 2. aggreate the packet header
- //
- if ((HeadSpace != 0) || (HeadLen != 0)) {
- FirstBlockLen = HeadLen + HeadSpace;
- FirstBlock = AllocatePool (FirstBlockLen);
-
- if (FirstBlock == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- BlockNum++;
- }
-
- //
- // Copy the header to the first block, reduce the NET_BLOCK
- // to allocate by one for each block that is completely covered
- // by the first bulk.
- //
- if (HeadLen != 0) {
- Len = HeadLen;
- Header = FirstBlock + HeadSpace;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < ExtNum; Index++) {
- if (Len >= ExtFragment[Index].Len) {
- CopyMem (Header, ExtFragment[Index].Bulk, ExtFragment[Index].Len);
-
- Copied += ExtFragment[Index].Len;
- Len -= ExtFragment[Index].Len;
- Header += ExtFragment[Index].Len;
- TotalLen += ExtFragment[Index].Len;
- BlockNum--;
-
- if (Len == 0) {
- //
- // Increament the index number to point to the next
- // non-empty fragment.
- //
- Index++;
- break;
- }
-
- } else {
- CopyMem (Header, ExtFragment[Index].Bulk, Len);
-
- Copied += Len;
- TotalLen += Len;
-
- //
- // Adjust the block structure to exclude the data copied,
- // So, the left-over block can be processed as other blocks.
- // But it must be recovered later. (SavedIndex > 0) always
- // holds since we don't aggreate the header if the first block
- // is bigger enough that the header is continuous
- //
- SavedIndex = Index;
- SavedFragment = ExtFragment[Index];
- ExtFragment[Index].Bulk += Len;
- ExtFragment[Index].Len -= Len;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- Nbuf = NetbufAllocStruct (BlockNum, BlockNum);
-
- if (Nbuf == NULL) {
- goto FreeFirstBlock;
- }
-
- Vector = Nbuf->Vector;
- Vector->Free = ExtFree;
- Vector->Arg = Arg;
- Vector->Flag = ((FirstBlockLen != 0) ? NET_VECTOR_OWN_FIRST : 0);
-
- //
- // Set the first block up which may contain
- // some head space and aggregated header
- //
- CurBlock = 0;
-
- if (FirstBlockLen != 0) {
- NetbufSetBlock (Nbuf, FirstBlock, HeadSpace + Copied, 0);
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Head += HeadSpace;
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Size = Copied;
-
- CurBlock++;
- }
-
- for (; Index < ExtNum; Index++) {
- NetbufSetBlock (Nbuf, ExtFragment[Index].Bulk, ExtFragment[Index].Len, CurBlock);
- TotalLen += ExtFragment[Index].Len;
- CurBlock++;
- }
-
- Vector->Len = TotalLen + HeadSpace;
- Nbuf->TotalSize = TotalLen;
-
- if (SavedIndex != 0) {
- ExtFragment[SavedIndex] = SavedFragment;
- }
-
- return Nbuf;
-
-FreeFirstBlock:
- if (FirstBlock != NULL) {
- FreePool (FirstBlock);
- }
- return NULL;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Build a fragment table to contain the fragments in the net buffer. This is the
- opposite operation of the NetbufFromExt.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Point to the net buffer.
- @param[in, out] ExtFragment Pointer to the data block.
- @param[in, out] ExtNum The number of the data blocks.
-
- @retval EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL The number of non-empty block is bigger than
- ExtNum.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Fragment table is built successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-NetbufBuildExt (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN OUT NET_FRAGMENT *ExtFragment,
- IN OUT UINT32 *ExtNum
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Current;
-
- Current = 0;
-
- for (Index = 0; (Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum); Index++) {
- if (Nbuf->BlockOp[Index].Size == 0) {
- continue;
- }
-
- if (Current < *ExtNum) {
- ExtFragment[Current].Bulk = Nbuf->BlockOp[Index].Head;
- ExtFragment[Current].Len = Nbuf->BlockOp[Index].Size;
- Current++;
- } else {
- return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
- }
- }
-
- *ExtNum = Current;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Build a net buffer from a list of net buffers.
-
- All the fragments will be collected from the list of NEW_BUF and then a new
- net buffer will be created through NetbufFromExt.
-
- @param[in] BufList A List of the net buffer.
- @param[in] HeadSpace The head space to be reserved.
- @param[in] HeaderLen The length of the protocol header, This function
- will pull that number of data into a linear block.
- @param[in] ExtFree Pointer to the caller provided free function.
- @param[in] Arg The argument passed to ExtFree when ExtFree is called.
-
- @return Pointer to the net buffer built from the list of net
- buffers.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufFromBufList (
- IN LIST_ENTRY *BufList,
- IN UINT32 HeadSpace,
- IN UINT32 HeaderLen,
- IN NET_VECTOR_EXT_FREE ExtFree,
- IN VOID *Arg OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- NET_FRAGMENT *Fragment;
- UINT32 FragmentNum;
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Current;
-
- //
- //Compute how many blocks are there
- //
- FragmentNum = 0;
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (Entry, BufList) {
- Nbuf = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_BUF, List);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- FragmentNum += Nbuf->BlockOpNum;
- }
-
- //
- //Allocate and copy block points
- //
- Fragment = AllocatePool (sizeof (NET_FRAGMENT) * FragmentNum);
-
- if (Fragment == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Current = 0;
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (Entry, BufList) {
- Nbuf = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_BUF, List);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Index++) {
- if (Nbuf->BlockOp[Index].Size != 0) {
- Fragment[Current].Bulk = Nbuf->BlockOp[Index].Head;
- Fragment[Current].Len = Nbuf->BlockOp[Index].Size;
- Current++;
- }
- }
- }
-
- Nbuf = NetbufFromExt (Fragment, Current, HeadSpace, HeaderLen, ExtFree, Arg);
- FreePool (Fragment);
-
- return Nbuf;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reserve some space in the header room of the net buffer.
-
- Upon allocation, all the space are in the tail room of the buffer. Call this
- function to move some space to the header room. This function is quite limited
- in that it can only reserve space from the first block of an empty NET_BUF not
- built from the external. But it should be enough for the network stack.
-
- @param[in, out] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Len The length of buffer to be reserved from the header.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufReserve (
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT32 Len
- )
-{
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf->Vector, NET_VECTOR_SIGNATURE);
-
- ASSERT ((Nbuf->BlockOpNum == 1) && (Nbuf->TotalSize == 0));
- ASSERT ((Nbuf->Vector->Free == NULL) && (Nbuf->Vector->Len >= Len));
-
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Head += Len;
- Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Tail += Len;
-
- ASSERT (Nbuf->BlockOp[0].Tail <= Nbuf->BlockOp[0].BlockTail);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Allocate Len bytes of space from the header or tail of the buffer.
-
- @param[in, out] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Len The length of the buffer to be allocated.
- @param[in] FromHead The flag to indicate whether reserve the data
- from head (TRUE) or tail (FALSE).
-
- @return Pointer to the first byte of the allocated buffer,
- or NULL if there is no sufficient space.
-
-**/
-UINT8*
-EFIAPI
-NetbufAllocSpace (
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN BOOLEAN FromHead
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT8 *SavedTail;
-
- Index = 0;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf->Vector, NET_VECTOR_SIGNATURE);
-
- ASSERT (Len > 0);
-
- if (FromHead) {
- //
- // Allocate some space from head. If the buffer is empty,
- // allocate from the first block. If it isn't, allocate
- // from the first non-empty block, or the block before that.
- //
- if (Nbuf->TotalSize == 0) {
- Index = 0;
- } else {
- NetbufGetByte (Nbuf, 0, &Index);
-
- if ((NET_HEADSPACE(&(Nbuf->BlockOp[Index])) < Len) && (Index > 0)) {
- Index--;
- }
- }
-
- BlockOp = &(Nbuf->BlockOp[Index]);
-
- if (NET_HEADSPACE (BlockOp) < Len) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- BlockOp->Head -= Len;
- BlockOp->Size += Len;
- Nbuf->TotalSize += Len;
-
- return BlockOp->Head;
-
- } else {
- //
- // Allocate some space from the tail. If the buffer is empty,
- // allocate from the first block. If it isn't, allocate
- // from the last non-empty block, or the block after that.
- //
- if (Nbuf->TotalSize == 0) {
- Index = 0;
- } else {
- NetbufGetByte (Nbuf, Nbuf->TotalSize - 1, &Index);
-
- if ((NET_TAILSPACE(&(Nbuf->BlockOp[Index])) < Len) &&
- (Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum - 1)) {
-
- Index++;
- }
- }
-
- BlockOp = &(Nbuf->BlockOp[Index]);
-
- if (NET_TAILSPACE (BlockOp) < Len) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- SavedTail = BlockOp->Tail;
-
- BlockOp->Tail += Len;
- BlockOp->Size += Len;
- Nbuf->TotalSize += Len;
-
- return SavedTail;
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Trim a single NET_BLOCK by Len bytes from the header or tail.
-
- @param[in, out] BlockOp Pointer to the NET_BLOCK.
- @param[in] Len The length of the data to be trimmed.
- @param[in] FromHead The flag to indicate whether trim data from head
- (TRUE) or tail (FALSE).
-
-**/
-VOID
-NetblockTrim (
- IN OUT NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN BOOLEAN FromHead
- )
-{
- ASSERT ((BlockOp != NULL) && (BlockOp->Size >= Len));
-
- BlockOp->Size -= Len;
-
- if (FromHead) {
- BlockOp->Head += Len;
- } else {
- BlockOp->Tail -= Len;
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Trim Len bytes from the header or tail of the net buffer.
-
- @param[in, out] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Len The length of the data to be trimmed.
- @param[in] FromHead The flag to indicate whether trim data from head
- (TRUE) or tail (FALSE).
-
- @return Length of the actually trimmed data, which is possible to be less
- than Len because the TotalSize of Nbuf is less than Len.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-NetbufTrim (
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN BOOLEAN FromHead
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Trimmed;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- if (Len > Nbuf->TotalSize) {
- Len = Nbuf->TotalSize;
- }
-
- //
- // If FromTail is true, iterate backward. That
- // is, init Index to NBuf->BlockNum - 1, and
- // decrease it by 1 during each loop. Otherwise,
- // iterate forward. That is, init Index to 0, and
- // increase it by 1 during each loop.
- //
- Trimmed = 0;
- Nbuf->TotalSize -= Len;
-
- Index = (FromHead ? 0 : Nbuf->BlockOpNum - 1);
- BlockOp = Nbuf->BlockOp;
-
- for (;;) {
- if (BlockOp[Index].Size == 0) {
- Index += (FromHead ? 1 : -1);
- continue;
- }
-
- if (Len > BlockOp[Index].Size) {
- Len -= BlockOp[Index].Size;
- Trimmed += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- NetblockTrim (&BlockOp[Index], BlockOp[Index].Size, FromHead);
- } else {
- Trimmed += Len;
- NetblockTrim (&BlockOp[Index], Len, FromHead);
- break;
- }
-
- Index += (FromHead ? 1 : -1);
- }
-
- return Trimmed;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Copy Len bytes of data from the specific offset of the net buffer to the
- destination memory.
-
- The Len bytes of data may cross the several fragments of the net buffer.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
- @param[in] Offset The sequence number of the first byte to copy.
- @param[in] Len Length of the data to copy.
- @param[in] Dest The destination of the data to copy to.
-
- @return The length of the actual copied data, or 0 if the offset
- specified exceeds the total size of net buffer.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-NetbufCopy (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf,
- IN UINT32 Offset,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- IN UINT8 *Dest
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- UINT32 Skip;
- UINT32 Left;
- UINT32 Copied;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Cur;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Dest);
-
- if ((Len == 0) || (Nbuf->TotalSize <= Offset)) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (Nbuf->TotalSize - Offset < Len) {
- Len = Nbuf->TotalSize - Offset;
- }
-
- BlockOp = Nbuf->BlockOp;
-
- //
- // Skip to the offset. Don't make "Offset-By-One" error here.
- // Cur + BLOCK.SIZE is the first sequence number of next block.
- // So, (Offset < Cur + BLOCK.SIZE) means that the first byte
- // is in the current block. if (Offset == Cur + BLOCK.SIZE), the
- // first byte is the next block's first byte.
- //
- Cur = 0;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Index++) {
- if (BlockOp[Index].Size == 0) {
- continue;
- }
-
- if (Offset < Cur + BlockOp[Index].Size) {
- break;
- }
-
- Cur += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- }
-
- //
- // Cur is the sequence number of the first byte in the block
- // Offset - Cur is the number of bytes before first byte to
- // to copy in the current block.
- //
- Skip = Offset - Cur;
- Left = BlockOp[Index].Size - Skip;
-
- if (Len <= Left) {
- CopyMem (Dest, BlockOp[Index].Head + Skip, Len);
- return Len;
- }
-
- CopyMem (Dest, BlockOp[Index].Head + Skip, Left);
-
- Dest += Left;
- Len -= Left;
- Copied = Left;
-
- Index++;
-
- for (; Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Index++) {
- if (Len > BlockOp[Index].Size) {
- Len -= BlockOp[Index].Size;
- Copied += BlockOp[Index].Size;
-
- CopyMem (Dest, BlockOp[Index].Head, BlockOp[Index].Size);
- Dest += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- } else {
- Copied += Len;
- CopyMem (Dest, BlockOp[Index].Head, Len);
- break;
- }
- }
-
- return Copied;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Initiate the net buffer queue.
-
- @param[in, out] NbufQue Pointer to the net buffer queue to be initialized.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueInit (
- IN OUT NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue
- )
-{
- NbufQue->Signature = NET_QUE_SIGNATURE;
- NbufQue->RefCnt = 1;
- InitializeListHead (&NbufQue->List);
-
- InitializeListHead (&NbufQue->BufList);
- NbufQue->BufSize = 0;
- NbufQue->BufNum = 0;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Allocate and initialize a net buffer queue.
-
- @return Pointer to the allocated net buffer queue, or NULL if the
- allocation failed due to resource limit.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF_QUEUE *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueAlloc (
- VOID
- )
-{
- NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue;
-
- NbufQue = AllocatePool (sizeof (NET_BUF_QUEUE));
- if (NbufQue == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- NetbufQueInit (NbufQue);
-
- return NbufQue;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Free a net buffer queue.
-
- Decrease the reference count of the net buffer queue by one. The real resource
- free operation isn't performed until the reference count of the net buffer
- queue is decreased to 0.
-
- @param[in] NbufQue Pointer to the net buffer queue to be freed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueFree (
- IN NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue
- )
-{
- ASSERT (NbufQue != NULL);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (NbufQue, NET_QUE_SIGNATURE);
-
- NbufQue->RefCnt--;
-
- if (NbufQue->RefCnt == 0) {
- NetbufQueFlush (NbufQue);
- FreePool (NbufQue);
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Append a net buffer to the net buffer queue.
-
- @param[in, out] NbufQue Pointer to the net buffer queue.
- @param[in, out] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer to be appended.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueAppend (
- IN OUT NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue,
- IN OUT NET_BUF *Nbuf
- )
-{
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (NbufQue, NET_QUE_SIGNATURE);
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- InsertTailList (&NbufQue->BufList, &Nbuf->List);
-
- NbufQue->BufSize += Nbuf->TotalSize;
- NbufQue->BufNum++;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Remove a net buffer from the head in the specific queue and return it.
-
- @param[in, out] NbufQue Pointer to the net buffer queue.
-
- @return Pointer to the net buffer removed from the specific queue,
- or NULL if there is no net buffer in the specific queue.
-
-**/
-NET_BUF *
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueRemove (
- IN OUT NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *First;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (NbufQue, NET_QUE_SIGNATURE);
-
- if (NbufQue->BufNum == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- First = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (NbufQue->BufList.ForwardLink, NET_BUF, List);
-
- NetListRemoveHead (&NbufQue->BufList);
-
- NbufQue->BufSize -= First->TotalSize;
- NbufQue->BufNum--;
- return First;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Copy Len bytes of data from the net buffer queue at the specific offset to the
- destination memory.
-
- The copying operation is the same as NetbufCopy but applies to the net buffer
- queue instead of the net buffer.
-
- @param[in] NbufQue Pointer to the net buffer queue.
- @param[in] Offset The sequence number of the first byte to copy.
- @param[in] Len Length of the data to copy.
- @param[out] Dest The destination of the data to copy to.
-
- @return The length of the actual copied data, or 0 if the offset
- specified exceeds the total size of net buffer queue.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueCopy (
- IN NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue,
- IN UINT32 Offset,
- IN UINT32 Len,
- OUT UINT8 *Dest
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
- UINT32 Skip;
- UINT32 Left;
- UINT32 Cur;
- UINT32 Copied;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (NbufQue, NET_QUE_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Dest != NULL);
-
- if ((Len == 0) || (NbufQue->BufSize <= Offset)) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (NbufQue->BufSize - Offset < Len) {
- Len = NbufQue->BufSize - Offset;
- }
-
- //
- // skip to the Offset
- //
- Cur = 0;
- Nbuf = NULL;
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH (Entry, &NbufQue->BufList) {
- Nbuf = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_BUF, List);
-
- if (Offset < Cur + Nbuf->TotalSize) {
- break;
- }
-
- Cur += Nbuf->TotalSize;
- }
-
- ASSERT (Nbuf != NULL);
-
- //
- // Copy the data in the first buffer.
- //
- Skip = Offset - Cur;
- Left = Nbuf->TotalSize - Skip;
-
- if (Len < Left) {
- return NetbufCopy (Nbuf, Skip, Len, Dest);
- }
-
- NetbufCopy (Nbuf, Skip, Left, Dest);
- Dest += Left;
- Len -= Left;
- Copied = Left;
-
- //
- // Iterate over the others
- //
- Entry = Entry->ForwardLink;
-
- while ((Len > 0) && (Entry != &NbufQue->BufList)) {
- Nbuf = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_BUF, List);
-
- if (Len > Nbuf->TotalSize) {
- Len -= Nbuf->TotalSize;
- Copied += Nbuf->TotalSize;
-
- NetbufCopy (Nbuf, 0, Nbuf->TotalSize, Dest);
- Dest += Nbuf->TotalSize;
-
- } else {
- NetbufCopy (Nbuf, 0, Len, Dest);
- Copied += Len;
- break;
- }
-
- Entry = Entry->ForwardLink;
- }
-
- return Copied;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Trim Len bytes of data from the buffer queue and free any net buffer
- that is completely trimmed.
-
- The trimming operation is the same as NetbufTrim but applies to the net buffer
- queue instead of the net buffer.
-
- @param[in, out] NbufQue Pointer to the net buffer queue.
- @param[in] Len Length of the data to trim.
-
- @return The actual length of the data trimmed.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueTrim (
- IN OUT NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue,
- IN UINT32 Len
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- LIST_ENTRY *Next;
- NET_BUF *Nbuf;
- UINT32 Trimmed;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (NbufQue, NET_QUE_SIGNATURE);
-
- if (Len == 0) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (Len > NbufQue->BufSize) {
- Len = NbufQue->BufSize;
- }
-
- NbufQue->BufSize -= Len;
- Trimmed = 0;
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH_SAFE (Entry, Next, &NbufQue->BufList) {
- Nbuf = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, NET_BUF, List);
-
- if (Len >= Nbuf->TotalSize) {
- Trimmed += Nbuf->TotalSize;
- Len -= Nbuf->TotalSize;
-
- RemoveEntryList (Entry);
- NetbufFree (Nbuf);
-
- NbufQue->BufNum--;
-
- if (Len == 0) {
- break;
- }
-
- } else {
- Trimmed += NetbufTrim (Nbuf, Len, NET_BUF_HEAD);
- break;
- }
- }
-
- return Trimmed;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Flush the net buffer queue.
-
- @param[in, out] NbufQue Pointer to the queue to be flushed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-NetbufQueFlush (
- IN OUT NET_BUF_QUEUE *NbufQue
- )
-{
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (NbufQue, NET_QUE_SIGNATURE);
-
- NetbufFreeList (&NbufQue->BufList);
-
- NbufQue->BufNum = 0;
- NbufQue->BufSize = 0;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Compute the checksum for a bulk of data.
-
- @param[in] Bulk Pointer to the data.
- @param[in] Len Length of the data, in bytes.
-
- @return The computed checksum.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-EFIAPI
-NetblockChecksum (
- IN UINT8 *Bulk,
- IN UINT32 Len
- )
-{
- register UINT32 Sum;
-
- Sum = 0;
-
- while (Len > 1) {
- Sum += *(UINT16 *) Bulk;
- Bulk += 2;
- Len -= 2;
- }
-
- //
- // Add left-over byte, if any
- //
- if (Len > 0) {
- Sum += *(UINT8 *) Bulk;
- }
-
- //
- // Fold 32-bit sum to 16 bits
- //
- while ((Sum >> 16) != 0) {
- Sum = (Sum & 0xffff) + (Sum >> 16);
-
- }
-
- return (UINT16) Sum;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Add two checksums.
-
- @param[in] Checksum1 The first checksum to be added.
- @param[in] Checksum2 The second checksum to be added.
-
- @return The new checksum.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-EFIAPI
-NetAddChecksum (
- IN UINT16 Checksum1,
- IN UINT16 Checksum2
- )
-{
- UINT32 Sum;
-
- Sum = Checksum1 + Checksum2;
-
- //
- // two UINT16 can only add up to a carry of 1.
- //
- if ((Sum >> 16) != 0) {
- Sum = (Sum & 0xffff) + 1;
-
- }
-
- return (UINT16) Sum;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Compute the checksum for a NET_BUF.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf Pointer to the net buffer.
-
- @return The computed checksum.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-EFIAPI
-NetbufChecksum (
- IN NET_BUF *Nbuf
- )
-{
- NET_BLOCK_OP *BlockOp;
- UINT32 Offset;
- UINT16 TotalSum;
- UINT16 BlockSum;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
-
- TotalSum = 0;
- Offset = 0;
- BlockOp = Nbuf->BlockOp;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Nbuf->BlockOpNum; Index++) {
- if (BlockOp[Index].Size == 0) {
- continue;
- }
-
- BlockSum = NetblockChecksum (BlockOp[Index].Head, BlockOp[Index].Size);
-
- if ((Offset & 0x01) != 0) {
- //
- // The checksum starts with an odd byte, swap
- // the checksum before added to total checksum
- //
- BlockSum = SwapBytes16 (BlockSum);
- }
-
- TotalSum = NetAddChecksum (BlockSum, TotalSum);
- Offset += BlockOp[Index].Size;
- }
-
- return TotalSum;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Compute the checksum for TCP/UDP pseudo header.
-
- Src and Dst are in network byte order, and Len is in host byte order.
-
- @param[in] Src The source address of the packet.
- @param[in] Dst The destination address of the packet.
- @param[in] Proto The protocol type of the packet.
- @param[in] Len The length of the packet.
-
- @return The computed checksum.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-EFIAPI
-NetPseudoHeadChecksum (
- IN IP4_ADDR Src,
- IN IP4_ADDR Dst,
- IN UINT8 Proto,
- IN UINT16 Len
- )
-{
- NET_PSEUDO_HDR Hdr;
-
- //
- // Zero the memory to relieve align problems
- //
- ZeroMem (&Hdr, sizeof (Hdr));
-
- Hdr.SrcIp = Src;
- Hdr.DstIp = Dst;
- Hdr.Protocol = Proto;
- Hdr.Len = HTONS (Len);
-
- return NetblockChecksum ((UINT8 *) &Hdr, sizeof (Hdr));
-}
-
-/**
- Compute the checksum for TCP6/UDP6 pseudo header.
-
- Src and Dst are in network byte order, and Len is in host byte order.
-
- @param[in] Src The source address of the packet.
- @param[in] Dst The destination address of the packet.
- @param[in] NextHeader The protocol type of the packet.
- @param[in] Len The length of the packet.
-
- @return The computed checksum.
-
-**/
-UINT16
-EFIAPI
-NetIp6PseudoHeadChecksum (
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Src,
- IN EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS *Dst,
- IN UINT8 NextHeader,
- IN UINT32 Len
- )
-{
- NET_IP6_PSEUDO_HDR Hdr;
-
- //
- // Zero the memory to relieve align problems
- //
- ZeroMem (&Hdr, sizeof (Hdr));
-
- IP6_COPY_ADDRESS (&Hdr.SrcIp, Src);
- IP6_COPY_ADDRESS (&Hdr.DstIp, Dst);
-
- Hdr.NextHeader = NextHeader;
- Hdr.Len = HTONL (Len);
-
- return NetblockChecksum ((UINT8 *) &Hdr, sizeof (Hdr));
-}
-
-/**
- The function frees the net buffer which allocated by the IP protocol. It releases
- only the net buffer and doesn't call the external free function.
-
- This function should be called after finishing the process of mIpSec->ProcessExt()
- for outbound traffic. The (EFI_IPSEC2_PROTOCOL)->ProcessExt() allocates a new
- buffer for the ESP, so there needs a function to free the old net buffer.
-
- @param[in] Nbuf The network buffer to be freed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-NetIpSecNetbufFree (
- NET_BUF *Nbuf
- )
-{
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf, NET_BUF_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Nbuf->RefCnt > 0);
-
- Nbuf->RefCnt--;
-
- if (Nbuf->RefCnt == 0) {
-
- //
- // Update Vector only when NBuf is to be released. That is,
- // all the sharing of Nbuf increse Vector's RefCnt by one
- //
- NET_CHECK_SIGNATURE (Nbuf->Vector, NET_VECTOR_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT (Nbuf->Vector->RefCnt > 0);
-
- Nbuf->Vector->RefCnt--;
-
- if (Nbuf->Vector->RefCnt > 0) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // If NET_VECTOR_OWN_FIRST is set, release the first block since it is
- // allocated by us
- //
- if ((Nbuf->Vector->Flag & NET_VECTOR_OWN_FIRST) != 0) {
- FreePool (Nbuf->Vector->Block[0].Bulk);
- }
- FreePool (Nbuf->Vector);
- FreePool (Nbuf);
- }
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 2ddd983126..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,429 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Performance Library
-
- This library instance provides infrastructure for DXE phase drivers to log performance
- data. It consumes PerformanceEx or Performance Protocol published by DxeCorePerformanceLib
- to log performance data. If both PerformanceEx and Performance Protocol is not available, it does not log any
- performance information.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2012, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-
-//
-// The cached Performance Protocol and PerformanceEx Protocol interface.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL *mPerformance = NULL;
-PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL *mPerformanceEx = NULL;
-
-/**
- The function caches the pointers to PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol.
-
- The function locates PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol from protocol database.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS PerformanceEx protocol or Performance Protocol is successfully located.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Both PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol are not located to log performance.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetPerformanceProtocol (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL *Performance;
- PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL *PerformanceEx;
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL || mPerformance != NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gPerformanceExProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &PerformanceEx);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (PerformanceEx != NULL);
- //
- // Cache PerformanceEx Protocol.
- //
- mPerformanceEx = PerformanceEx;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gPerformanceProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &Performance);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (Performance != NULL);
- //
- // Cache performance protocol.
- //
- mPerformance = Performance;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->StartGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->StartGauge (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- return (RETURN_STATUS) Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->EndGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->EndGauge (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- return (RETURN_STATUS) Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeData;
-
- GaugeData = NULL;
-
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
- ASSERT (Token != NULL);
- ASSERT (Module != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (EndTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (Identifier != NULL);
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey++, &GaugeData);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->GetGauge (LogEntryKey++, (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **) &GaugeData);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Make sure that LogEntryKey is a valid log entry key,
- //
- ASSERT (Status != EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- //
- return 0;
- }
-
- ASSERT (GaugeData != NULL);
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) GaugeData->Handle;
- *Token = GaugeData->Token;
- *Module = GaugeData->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = GaugeData->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = GaugeData->EndTimeStamp;
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- *Identifier = GaugeData->Identifier;
- } else {
- *Identifier = 0;
- }
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, and Module.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurementEx and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, and EndTimeStamp.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp
- )
-{
- UINT32 Identifier;
- return GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (LogEntryKey, Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp, &Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if the performance measurement macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-PerformanceMeasurementEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8(PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask) & PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index edc63c6f0b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,57 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Performance library instance used in DXE phase.
-#
-# This library instance provides infrastructure for DXE phase drivers to log performance
-# data. It consumes PerformanceEx or Performance Protocol published by DxeCorePerformanceLib
-# to log performance data. If both PerformanceEx and Performance Protocol are not available,
-# it does not log any performance information.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxePerformanceLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxePerformanceLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 8B8B4CCC-65FC-41a5-8067-308B8E42CCF2
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PerformanceLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxePerformanceLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- DebugLib
-
-
-[Guids]
- gPerformanceProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Locate protocol
- gPerformanceExProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Locate protocol
-
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index d2997bce98..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePerformanceLib/DxePerformanceLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 3d09b4be4d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Library instance that implements Print Library class based on protocol gEfiPrint2ProtocolGuid.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.uni
- FILE_GUID = 55D460DB-8FEA-415a-B95D-70145AE0675C
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PrintLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = PrintLibConstructor
-
-[Sources]
- PrintLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiPrint2ProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_SAL_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_SMM_DRIVER]
- gEfiPrint2ProtocolGuid
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 96a8bd0a09..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/PrintLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/PrintLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 4acdcb8714..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol/PrintLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1921 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Instance of Print Library based on gEfiPrint2ProtocolGuid.
-
- Implement the print library instance by wrap the interface
- provided in the Print2 protocol. This protocol is defined as the internal
- protocol related to this implementation, not in the public spec. So, this
- library instance is only for this code base.
-
-Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-#include <Base.h>
-#include <Protocol/Print2.h>
-
-#include <Library/PrintLib.h>
-
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-EFI_PRINT2_PROTOCOL *mPrint2Protocol = NULL;
-
-/**
- The constructor function caches the pointer to Print2 protocol.
-
- The constructor function locates Print2 protocol from protocol database.
- It will ASSERT() if that operation fails and it will always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PrintLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = SystemTable->BootServices->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiPrint2ProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID**) &mPrint2Protocol
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- ASSERT (mPrint2Protocol != NULL);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Worker function that converts a VA_LIST to a BASE_LIST based on a Null-terminated
- format string.
-
- @param AsciiFormat TRUE if Format is an ASCII string. FALSE if Format is a Unicode string.
- @param Format Null-terminated format string.
- @param VaListMarker VA_LIST style variable argument list consumed by processing Format.
- @param BaseListMarker BASE_LIST style variable argument list consumed by processing Format.
- @param Size The size, in bytes, of the BaseListMarker buffer.
-
- @return The number of bytes in BaseListMarker. 0 if BaseListMarker is too small.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-DxePrintLibPrint2ProtocolVaListToBaseList (
- IN BOOLEAN AsciiFormat,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Format,
- IN VA_LIST VaListMarker,
- OUT BASE_LIST BaseListMarker,
- IN UINTN Size
- )
-{
- BASE_LIST BaseListStart;
- UINTN BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- UINTN FormatMask;
- UINTN FormatCharacter;
- BOOLEAN Long;
- BOOLEAN Done;
-
- ASSERT (Format != NULL);
- ASSERT (BaseListMarker != NULL);
-
- BaseListStart = BaseListMarker;
-
- if (AsciiFormat) {
- ASSERT (AsciiStrSize (Format) != 0);
- BytesPerFormatCharacter = 1;
- FormatMask = 0xff;
- } else {
- ASSERT (StrSize ((CHAR16 *) Format) != 0);
- BytesPerFormatCharacter = 2;
- FormatMask = 0xffff;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the first character from the format string
- //
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
-
- while (FormatCharacter != 0) {
- if (FormatCharacter == '%') {
- Long = FALSE;
-
- //
- // Parse Flags and Width
- //
- for (Done = FALSE; !Done; ) {
- //
- // Get the next character from the format string
- //
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
-
- //
- // Get the next character from the format string
- //
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
-
- switch (FormatCharacter) {
- case '.':
- case '-':
- case '+':
- case ' ':
- case ',':
- case '0':
- case '1':
- case '2':
- case '3':
- case '4':
- case '5':
- case '6':
- case '7':
- case '8':
- case '9':
- break;
- case 'L':
- case 'l':
- Long = TRUE;
- break;
- case '*':
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN);
- break;
- case '\0':
- //
- // Make no output if Format string terminates unexpectedly when
- // looking up for flag, width, precision and type.
- //
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- //
- // break skipped on purpose.
- //
- default:
- Done = TRUE;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Handle each argument type
- //
- switch (FormatCharacter) {
- case 'p':
- if (sizeof (VOID *) > 4) {
- Long = TRUE;
- }
- case 'X':
- case 'x':
- case 'u':
- case 'd':
- if (Long) {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, INT64) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, INT64);
- } else {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, int) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, int);
- }
- break;
- case 's':
- case 'S':
- case 'a':
- case 'g':
- case 't':
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, VOID *) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, VOID *);
- break;
- case 'c':
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN);
- break;
- case 'r':
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, RETURN_STATUS) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, RETURN_STATUS);
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // If BASE_LIST is larger than Size, then return FALSE
- //
- if ((UINTN)((UINT8 *)BaseListMarker - (UINT8 *)BaseListStart) > Size) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the next character from the format string
- //
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
-
- //
- // Get the next character from the format string
- //
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- }
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in an output buffer based on
- a Null-terminated Unicode format string and a VA_LIST argument list
-
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The Unicode string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on the
- contents of the format string.
- The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0 or 1, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated Unicode string
- contains more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker VA_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeVSPrint (
- OUT CHAR16 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- IN VA_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- UINT64 BaseListMarker[256 / sizeof (UINT64)];
-
- DxePrintLibPrint2ProtocolVaListToBaseList (
- FALSE,
- (CHAR8 *)FormatString,
- Marker,
- (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker,
- sizeof (BaseListMarker) - 8
- );
-
- return UnicodeBSPrint (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in an output buffer based on
- a Null-terminated Unicode format string and a BASE_LIST argument list
-
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The Unicode string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on the
- contents of the format string.
- The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0 or 1, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated Unicode string
- contains more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker BASE_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeBSPrint (
- OUT CHAR16 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- IN BASE_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- return mPrint2Protocol->UnicodeBSPrint (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- Unicode format string and variable argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The Unicode string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list based on the contents of the format string.
- The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0 or 1, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated Unicode string
- contains more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param ... Variable argument list whose contents are accessed based on the
- format string specified by FormatString.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeSPrint (
- OUT CHAR16 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- UINTN NumberOfPrinted;
-
- VA_START (Marker, FormatString);
- NumberOfPrinted = UnicodeVSPrint (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
- VA_END (Marker);
- return NumberOfPrinted;
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and a VA_LIST argument list
-
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The Unicode string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on the
- contents of the format string.
- The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0 or 1, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated Unicode string
- contains more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker VA_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeVSPrintAsciiFormat (
- OUT CHAR16 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- IN VA_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- UINT64 BaseListMarker[256 / sizeof (UINT64)];
-
- DxePrintLibPrint2ProtocolVaListToBaseList (
- TRUE,
- FormatString,
- Marker,
- (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker,
- sizeof (BaseListMarker) - 8
- );
-
- return UnicodeBSPrintAsciiFormat (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and a BASE_LIST argument list
-
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The Unicode string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on the
- contents of the format string.
- The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0 or 1, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated Unicode string
- contains more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker BASE_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeBSPrintAsciiFormat (
- OUT CHAR16 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- IN BASE_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- return mPrint2Protocol->UnicodeBSPrintAsciiFormat (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and variable argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated Unicode string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The Unicode string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list based on the contents of the
- format string.
- The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0 or 1, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and StartOfBuffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 1 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated Unicode string
- contains more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param ... Variable argument list whose contents are accessed based on the
- format string specified by FormatString.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeSPrintAsciiFormat (
- OUT CHAR16 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- UINTN NumberOfPrinted;
-
- VA_START (Marker, FormatString);
- NumberOfPrinted = UnicodeVSPrintAsciiFormat (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
- VA_END (Marker);
- return NumberOfPrinted;
-}
-
-/**
- Converts a decimal value to a Null-terminated Unicode string.
-
- Converts the decimal number specified by Value to a Null-terminated Unicode
- string specified by Buffer containing at most Width characters. No padding of spaces
- is ever performed. If Width is 0 then a width of MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS is assumed.
- The number of Unicode characters in Buffer is returned not including the Null-terminator.
- If the conversion contains more than Width characters, then only the first
- Width characters are returned, and the total number of characters
- required to perform the conversion is returned.
- Additional conversion parameters are specified in Flags.
-
- The Flags bit LEFT_JUSTIFY is always ignored.
- All conversions are left justified in Buffer.
- If Width is 0, PREFIX_ZERO is ignored in Flags.
- If COMMA_TYPE is set in Flags, then PREFIX_ZERO is ignored in Flags, and commas
- are inserted every 3rd digit starting from the right.
- If RADIX_HEX is set in Flags, then the output buffer will be
- formatted in hexadecimal format.
- If Value is < 0 and RADIX_HEX is not set in Flags, then the fist character in Buffer is a '-'.
- If PREFIX_ZERO is set in Flags and PREFIX_ZERO is not being ignored,
- then Buffer is padded with '0' characters so the combination of the optional '-'
- sign character, '0' characters, digit characters for Value, and the Null-terminator
- add up to Width characters.
- If both COMMA_TYPE and RADIX_HEX are set in Flags, then ASSERT().
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Buffer is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If unsupported bits are set in Flags, then ASSERT().
- If both COMMA_TYPE and RADIX_HEX are set in Flags, then ASSERT().
- If Width >= MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS, then ASSERT()
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- Unicode string.
- @param Flags The bitmask of flags that specify left justification, zero pad, and commas.
- @param Value The 64-bit signed value to convert to a string.
- @param Width The maximum number of Unicode characters to place in Buffer, not including
- the Null-terminator.
-
- @return The number of Unicode characters in Buffer not including the Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-UnicodeValueToString (
- IN OUT CHAR16 *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Flags,
- IN INT64 Value,
- IN UINTN Width
- )
-{
- return mPrint2Protocol->UnicodeValueToString (Buffer, Flags, Value, Width);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and a VA_LIST argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The ASCII string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on
- the contents of the format string.
- The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 0 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated ASCII string
- contains more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker VA_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiVSPrint (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- IN VA_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- UINT64 BaseListMarker[256 / sizeof (UINT64)];
-
- DxePrintLibPrint2ProtocolVaListToBaseList (
- TRUE,
- FormatString,
- Marker,
- (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker,
- sizeof (BaseListMarker) - 8
- );
-
- return AsciiBSPrint (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and a BASE_LIST argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The ASCII string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on
- the contents of the format string.
- The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 0 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated ASCII string
- contains more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker BASE_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiBSPrint (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- IN BASE_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- return mPrint2Protocol->AsciiBSPrint (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and variable argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The ASCII string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list based on the contents of the
- format string.
- The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 0 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated ASCII string
- contains more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param ... Variable argument list whose contents are accessed based on the
- format string specified by FormatString.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiSPrint (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- UINTN NumberOfPrinted;
-
- VA_START (Marker, FormatString);
- NumberOfPrinted = AsciiVSPrint (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
- VA_END (Marker);
- return NumberOfPrinted;
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and a VA_LIST argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The ASCII string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on
- the contents of the format string.
- The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 0 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated ASCII string
- contains more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker VA_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiVSPrintUnicodeFormat (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- IN VA_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- UINT64 BaseListMarker[256 / sizeof (UINT64)];
-
- DxePrintLibPrint2ProtocolVaListToBaseList (
- FALSE,
- (CHAR8 *)FormatString,
- Marker,
- (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker,
- sizeof (BaseListMarker) - 8
- );
-
- return AsciiBSPrintUnicodeFormat (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, (BASE_LIST)BaseListMarker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and a BASE_LIST argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The ASCII string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list specified by Marker based on
- the contents of the format string.
- The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 0 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated ASCII string
- contains more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param Marker BASE_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiBSPrintUnicodeFormat (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- IN BASE_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- return mPrint2Protocol->AsciiBSPrintUnicodeFormat (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
-}
-
-/**
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in an output buffer based on a Null-terminated
- ASCII format string and variable argument list.
-
- Produces a Null-terminated ASCII string in the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer
- and BufferSize.
- The ASCII string is produced by parsing the format string specified by FormatString.
- Arguments are pulled from the variable argument list based on the contents of the
- format string.
- The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer is returned not including
- the Null-terminator.
- If BufferSize is 0, then no output buffer is produced and 0 is returned.
-
- If BufferSize > 0 and StartOfBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If BufferSize > 0 and FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero, and FormatString contains more than
- PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength Unicode characters not including the Null-terminator, then
- ASSERT().
- If PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero, and produced Null-terminated ASCII string
- contains more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength ASCII characters not including the
- Null-terminator, then ASSERT().
-
- @param StartOfBuffer A pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param BufferSize The size, in bytes, of the output buffer specified by StartOfBuffer.
- @param FormatString Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param ... Variable argument list whose contents are accessed based on the
- format string specified by FormatString.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in the produced output buffer not including the
- Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiSPrintUnicodeFormat (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- UINTN NumberOfPrinted;
-
- VA_START (Marker, FormatString);
- NumberOfPrinted = AsciiVSPrintUnicodeFormat (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, FormatString, Marker);
- VA_END (Marker);
- return NumberOfPrinted;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Converts a decimal value to a Null-terminated ASCII string.
-
- Converts the decimal number specified by Value to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- specified by Buffer containing at most Width characters. No padding of spaces
- is ever performed.
- If Width is 0 then a width of MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS is assumed.
- The number of ASCII characters in Buffer is returned not including the Null-terminator.
- If the conversion contains more than Width characters, then only the first Width
- characters are returned, and the total number of characters required to perform
- the conversion is returned.
- Additional conversion parameters are specified in Flags.
- The Flags bit LEFT_JUSTIFY is always ignored.
- All conversions are left justified in Buffer.
- If Width is 0, PREFIX_ZERO is ignored in Flags.
- If COMMA_TYPE is set in Flags, then PREFIX_ZERO is ignored in Flags, and commas
- are inserted every 3rd digit starting from the right.
- If RADIX_HEX is set in Flags, then the output buffer will be
- formatted in hexadecimal format.
- If Value is < 0 and RADIX_HEX is not set in Flags, then the fist character in Buffer is a '-'.
- If PREFIX_ZERO is set in Flags and PREFIX_ZERO is not being ignored,
- then Buffer is padded with '0' characters so the combination of the optional '-'
- sign character, '0' characters, digit characters for Value, and the Null-terminator
- add up to Width characters.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If unsupported bits are set in Flags, then ASSERT().
- If both COMMA_TYPE and RADIX_HEX are set in Flags, then ASSERT().
- If Width >= MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS, then ASSERT()
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the output buffer for the produced Null-terminated
- ASCII string.
- @param Flags The bitmask of flags that specify left justification, zero pad, and commas.
- @param Value The 64-bit signed value to convert to a string.
- @param Width The maximum number of ASCII characters to place in Buffer, not including
- the Null-terminator.
-
- @return The number of ASCII characters in Buffer not including the Null-terminator.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-AsciiValueToString (
- OUT CHAR8 *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Flags,
- IN INT64 Value,
- IN UINTN Width
- )
-{
- return mPrint2Protocol->AsciiValueToString (Buffer, Flags, Value, Width);
-}
-
-#define PREFIX_SIGN BIT1
-#define PREFIX_BLANK BIT2
-#define LONG_TYPE BIT4
-#define OUTPUT_UNICODE BIT6
-#define FORMAT_UNICODE BIT8
-#define PAD_TO_WIDTH BIT9
-#define ARGUMENT_UNICODE BIT10
-#define PRECISION BIT11
-#define ARGUMENT_REVERSED BIT12
-#define COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT BIT13
-#define UNSIGNED_TYPE BIT14
-
-//
-// Record date and time information
-//
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 Year;
- UINT8 Month;
- UINT8 Day;
- UINT8 Hour;
- UINT8 Minute;
- UINT8 Second;
- UINT8 Pad1;
- UINT32 Nanosecond;
- INT16 TimeZone;
- UINT8 Daylight;
- UINT8 Pad2;
-} TIME;
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST CHAR8 mHexStr[] = {'0','1','2','3','4','5','6','7','8','9','A','B','C','D','E','F'};
-
-/**
- Internal function that convert a number to a string in Buffer.
-
- Print worker function that converts a decimal or hexadecimal number to an ASCII string in Buffer.
-
- @param Buffer Location to place the ASCII string of Value.
- @param Value The value to convert to a Decimal or Hexadecimal string in Buffer.
- @param Radix Radix of the value
-
- @return A pointer to the end of buffer filled with ASCII string.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-InternalPrintLibValueToString (
- IN OUT CHAR8 *Buffer,
- IN INT64 Value,
- IN UINTN Radix
- )
-{
- UINT32 Remainder;
-
- //
- // Loop to convert one digit at a time in reverse order
- //
- *Buffer = 0;
- do {
- Value = (INT64)DivU64x32Remainder ((UINT64)Value, (UINT32)Radix, &Remainder);
- *(++Buffer) = mHexStr[Remainder];
- } while (Value != 0);
-
- //
- // Return pointer of the end of filled buffer.
- //
- return Buffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Worker function that produces a Null-terminated string in an output buffer
- based on a Null-terminated format string and a VA_LIST argument list.
-
- VSPrint function to process format and place the results in Buffer. Since a
- VA_LIST is used this routine allows the nesting of Vararg routines. Thus
- this is the main print working routine.
-
- If COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT is set in Flags, Buffer will not be modified at all.
-
- @param[out] Buffer The character buffer to print the results of the
- parsing of Format into.
- @param[in] BufferSize The maximum number of characters to put into
- buffer.
- @param[in] Flags Initial flags value.
- Can only have FORMAT_UNICODE, OUTPUT_UNICODE,
- and COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT set.
- @param[in] Format A Null-terminated format string.
- @param[in] VaListMarker VA_LIST style variable argument list consumed by
- processing Format.
- @param[in] BaseListMarker BASE_LIST style variable argument list consumed
- by processing Format.
-
- @return The number of characters printed not including the Null-terminator.
- If COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT was set returns the same, but without any
- modification to Buffer.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-InternalPrintLibSPrintMarker (
- OUT CHAR8 *Buffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN UINTN Flags,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Format,
- IN VA_LIST VaListMarker, OPTIONAL
- IN BASE_LIST BaseListMarker OPTIONAL
- );
-
-/**
- Worker function that produces a Null-terminated string in an output buffer
- based on a Null-terminated format string and variable argument list.
-
- VSPrint function to process format and place the results in Buffer. Since a
- VA_LIST is used this routine allows the nesting of Vararg routines. Thus
- this is the main print working routine
-
- @param StartOfBuffer The character buffer to print the results of the parsing
- of Format into.
- @param BufferSize The maximum number of characters to put into buffer.
- Zero means no limit.
- @param Flags Initial flags value.
- Can only have FORMAT_UNICODE and OUTPUT_UNICODE set
- @param FormatString A Null-terminated format string.
- @param ... The variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of characters printed.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-InternalPrintLibSPrint (
- OUT CHAR8 *StartOfBuffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN UINTN Flags,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- ...
- )
-{
- VA_LIST Marker;
- UINTN NumberOfPrinted;
-
- VA_START (Marker, FormatString);
- NumberOfPrinted = InternalPrintLibSPrintMarker (StartOfBuffer, BufferSize, Flags, FormatString, Marker, NULL);
- VA_END (Marker);
- return NumberOfPrinted;
-}
-
-#define WARNING_STATUS_NUMBER 5
-#define ERROR_STATUS_NUMBER 33
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST CHAR8 * CONST mStatusString[] = {
- "Success", // RETURN_SUCCESS = 0
- "Warning Unknown Glyph", // RETURN_WARN_UNKNOWN_GLYPH = 1
- "Warning Delete Failure", // RETURN_WARN_DELETE_FAILURE = 2
- "Warning Write Failure", // RETURN_WARN_WRITE_FAILURE = 3
- "Warning Buffer Too Small", // RETURN_WARN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL = 4
- "Warning Stale Data", // RETURN_WARN_STALE_DATA = 5
- "Load Error", // RETURN_LOAD_ERROR = 1 | MAX_BIT
- "Invalid Parameter", // RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER = 2 | MAX_BIT
- "Unsupported", // RETURN_UNSUPPORTED = 3 | MAX_BIT
- "Bad Buffer Size", // RETURN_BAD_BUFFER_SIZE = 4 | MAX_BIT
- "Buffer Too Small", // RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL, = 5 | MAX_BIT
- "Not Ready", // RETURN_NOT_READY = 6 | MAX_BIT
- "Device Error", // RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR = 7 | MAX_BIT
- "Write Protected", // RETURN_WRITE_PROTECTED = 8 | MAX_BIT
- "Out of Resources", // RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES = 9 | MAX_BIT
- "Volume Corrupt", // RETURN_VOLUME_CORRUPTED = 10 | MAX_BIT
- "Volume Full", // RETURN_VOLUME_FULL = 11 | MAX_BIT
- "No Media", // RETURN_NO_MEDIA = 12 | MAX_BIT
- "Media changed", // RETURN_MEDIA_CHANGED = 13 | MAX_BIT
- "Not Found", // RETURN_NOT_FOUND = 14 | MAX_BIT
- "Access Denied", // RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED = 15 | MAX_BIT
- "No Response", // RETURN_NO_RESPONSE = 16 | MAX_BIT
- "No mapping", // RETURN_NO_MAPPING = 17 | MAX_BIT
- "Time out", // RETURN_TIMEOUT = 18 | MAX_BIT
- "Not started", // RETURN_NOT_STARTED = 19 | MAX_BIT
- "Already started", // RETURN_ALREADY_STARTED = 20 | MAX_BIT
- "Aborted", // RETURN_ABORTED = 21 | MAX_BIT
- "ICMP Error", // RETURN_ICMP_ERROR = 22 | MAX_BIT
- "TFTP Error", // RETURN_TFTP_ERROR = 23 | MAX_BIT
- "Protocol Error", // RETURN_PROTOCOL_ERROR = 24 | MAX_BIT
- "Incompatible Version", // RETURN_INCOMPATIBLE_VERSION = 25 | MAX_BIT
- "Security Violation", // RETURN_SECURITY_VIOLATION = 26 | MAX_BIT
- "CRC Error", // RETURN_CRC_ERROR = 27 | MAX_BIT
- "End of Media", // RETURN_END_OF_MEDIA = 28 | MAX_BIT
- "Reserved (29)", // RESERVED = 29 | MAX_BIT
- "Reserved (30)", // RESERVED = 30 | MAX_BIT
- "End of File", // RETURN_END_OF_FILE = 31 | MAX_BIT
- "Invalid Language", // RETURN_INVALID_LANGUAGE = 32 | MAX_BIT
- "Compromised Data" // RETURN_COMPROMISED_DATA = 33 | MAX_BIT
-};
-
-/**
- Internal function that places the character into the Buffer.
-
- Internal function that places ASCII or Unicode character into the Buffer.
-
- @param Buffer The buffer to place the Unicode or ASCII string.
- @param EndBuffer The end of the input Buffer. No characters will be
- placed after that.
- @param Length The count of character to be placed into Buffer.
- (Negative value indicates no buffer fill.)
- @param Character The character to be placed into Buffer.
- @param Increment The character increment in Buffer.
-
- @return Buffer.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (
- OUT CHAR8 *Buffer,
- IN CHAR8 *EndBuffer,
- IN INTN Length,
- IN UINTN Character,
- IN INTN Increment
- )
-{
- INTN Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Length && Buffer < EndBuffer; Index++) {
- *Buffer = (CHAR8) Character;
- if (Increment != 1) {
- *(Buffer + 1) = (CHAR8)(Character >> 8);
- }
- Buffer += Increment;
- }
-
- return Buffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Worker function that produces a Null-terminated string in an output buffer
- based on a Null-terminated format string and a VA_LIST argument list.
-
- VSPrint function to process format and place the results in Buffer. Since a
- VA_LIST is used this routine allows the nesting of Vararg routines. Thus
- this is the main print working routine.
-
- If COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT is set in Flags, Buffer will not be modified at all.
-
- @param[out] Buffer The character buffer to print the results of the
- parsing of Format into.
- @param[in] BufferSize The maximum number of characters to put into
- buffer.
- @param[in] Flags Initial flags value.
- Can only have FORMAT_UNICODE, OUTPUT_UNICODE,
- and COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT set.
- @param[in] Format A Null-terminated format string.
- @param[in] VaListMarker VA_LIST style variable argument list consumed by
- processing Format.
- @param[in] BaseListMarker BASE_LIST style variable argument list consumed
- by processing Format.
-
- @return The number of characters printed not including the Null-terminator.
- If COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT was set returns the same, but without any
- modification to Buffer.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-InternalPrintLibSPrintMarker (
- OUT CHAR8 *Buffer,
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN UINTN Flags,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Format,
- IN VA_LIST VaListMarker, OPTIONAL
- IN BASE_LIST BaseListMarker OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *OriginalBuffer;
- CHAR8 *EndBuffer;
- CHAR8 ValueBuffer[MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS];
- UINT32 BytesPerOutputCharacter;
- UINTN BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- UINTN FormatMask;
- UINTN FormatCharacter;
- UINTN Width;
- UINTN Precision;
- INT64 Value;
- CONST CHAR8 *ArgumentString;
- UINTN Character;
- GUID *TmpGuid;
- TIME *TmpTime;
- UINTN Count;
- UINTN ArgumentMask;
- INTN BytesPerArgumentCharacter;
- UINTN ArgumentCharacter;
- BOOLEAN Done;
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR8 Prefix;
- BOOLEAN ZeroPad;
- BOOLEAN Comma;
- UINTN Digits;
- UINTN Radix;
- RETURN_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 GuidData1;
- UINT16 GuidData2;
- UINT16 GuidData3;
- UINTN LengthToReturn;
-
- //
- // If you change this code be sure to match the 2 versions of this function.
- // Nearly identical logic is found in the BasePrintLib and
- // DxePrintLibPrint2Protocol (both PrintLib instances).
- //
-
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) != 0) {
- if (BufferSize == 0) {
- Buffer = NULL;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // We can run without a Buffer for counting only.
- //
- if (BufferSize == 0) {
- return 0;
- }
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
- }
-
- if ((Flags & OUTPUT_UNICODE) != 0) {
- BytesPerOutputCharacter = 2;
- } else {
- BytesPerOutputCharacter = 1;
- }
-
- LengthToReturn = 0;
- EndBuffer = NULL;
- OriginalBuffer = NULL;
-
- //
- // Reserve space for the Null terminator.
- //
- if (Buffer != NULL) {
- BufferSize--;
- OriginalBuffer = Buffer;
-
- //
- // Set the tag for the end of the input Buffer.
- //
- EndBuffer = Buffer + BufferSize * BytesPerOutputCharacter;
- }
-
- if ((Flags & FORMAT_UNICODE) != 0) {
- //
- // Make sure format string cannot contain more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength
- // Unicode characters if PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero.
- //
- ASSERT (StrSize ((CHAR16 *) Format) != 0);
- BytesPerFormatCharacter = 2;
- FormatMask = 0xffff;
- } else {
- //
- // Make sure format string cannot contain more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength
- // Ascii characters if PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero.
- //
- ASSERT (AsciiStrSize (Format) != 0);
- BytesPerFormatCharacter = 1;
- FormatMask = 0xff;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the first character from the format string
- //
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
-
- //
- // Loop until the end of the format string is reached or the output buffer is full
- //
- while (FormatCharacter != 0) {
- if ((Buffer != NULL) && (Buffer >= EndBuffer)) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // Clear all the flag bits except those that may have been passed in
- //
- Flags &= (UINTN) (OUTPUT_UNICODE | FORMAT_UNICODE | COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT);
-
- //
- // Set the default width to zero, and the default precision to 1
- //
- Width = 0;
- Precision = 1;
- Prefix = 0;
- Comma = FALSE;
- ZeroPad = FALSE;
- Count = 0;
- Digits = 0;
-
- switch (FormatCharacter) {
- case '%':
- //
- // Parse Flags and Width
- //
- for (Done = FALSE; !Done; ) {
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- switch (FormatCharacter) {
- case '.':
- Flags |= PRECISION;
- break;
- case '-':
- Flags |= LEFT_JUSTIFY;
- break;
- case '+':
- Flags |= PREFIX_SIGN;
- break;
- case ' ':
- Flags |= PREFIX_BLANK;
- break;
- case ',':
- Flags |= COMMA_TYPE;
- break;
- case 'L':
- case 'l':
- Flags |= LONG_TYPE;
- break;
- case '*':
- if ((Flags & PRECISION) == 0) {
- Flags |= PAD_TO_WIDTH;
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- Width = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN);
- } else {
- Width = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN);
- }
- } else {
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- Precision = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN);
- } else {
- Precision = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN);
- }
- }
- break;
- case '0':
- if ((Flags & PRECISION) == 0) {
- Flags |= PREFIX_ZERO;
- }
- case '1':
- case '2':
- case '3':
- case '4':
- case '5':
- case '6':
- case '7':
- case '8':
- case '9':
- for (Count = 0; ((FormatCharacter >= '0') && (FormatCharacter <= '9')); ){
- Count = (Count * 10) + FormatCharacter - '0';
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- }
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- if ((Flags & PRECISION) == 0) {
- Flags |= PAD_TO_WIDTH;
- Width = Count;
- } else {
- Precision = Count;
- }
- break;
-
- case '\0':
- //
- // Make no output if Format string terminates unexpectedly when
- // looking up for flag, width, precision and type.
- //
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- Precision = 0;
- //
- // break skipped on purpose.
- //
- default:
- Done = TRUE;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Handle each argument type
- //
- switch (FormatCharacter) {
- case 'p':
- //
- // Flag space, +, 0, L & l are invalid for type p.
- //
- Flags &= ~((UINTN) (PREFIX_BLANK | PREFIX_SIGN | PREFIX_ZERO | LONG_TYPE));
- if (sizeof (VOID *) > 4) {
- Flags |= LONG_TYPE;
- }
- //
- // break skipped on purpose
- //
- case 'X':
- Flags |= PREFIX_ZERO;
- //
- // break skipped on purpose
- //
- case 'x':
- Flags |= RADIX_HEX;
- //
- // break skipped on purpose
- //
- case 'u':
- if ((Flags & RADIX_HEX) == 0) {
- Flags &= ~((UINTN) (PREFIX_SIGN));
- Flags |= UNSIGNED_TYPE;
- }
- //
- // break skipped on purpose
- //
- case 'd':
- if ((Flags & LONG_TYPE) == 0) {
- //
- // 'd', 'u', 'x', and 'X' that are not preceded by 'l' or 'L' are assumed to be type "int".
- // This assumption is made so the format string definition is compatible with the ANSI C
- // Specification for formatted strings. It is recommended that the Base Types be used
- // everywhere, but in this one case, compliance with ANSI C is more important, and
- // provides an implementation that is compatible with that largest possible set of CPU
- // architectures. This is why the type "int" is used in this one case.
- //
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- Value = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, int);
- } else {
- Value = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, int);
- }
- } else {
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- Value = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, INT64);
- } else {
- Value = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, INT64);
- }
- }
- if ((Flags & PREFIX_BLANK) != 0) {
- Prefix = ' ';
- }
- if ((Flags & PREFIX_SIGN) != 0) {
- Prefix = '+';
- }
- if ((Flags & COMMA_TYPE) != 0) {
- Comma = TRUE;
- }
- if ((Flags & RADIX_HEX) == 0) {
- Radix = 10;
- if (Comma) {
- Flags &= ~((UINTN) PREFIX_ZERO);
- Precision = 1;
- }
- if (Value < 0 && (Flags & UNSIGNED_TYPE) == 0) {
- Flags |= PREFIX_SIGN;
- Prefix = '-';
- Value = -Value;
- } else if ((Flags & UNSIGNED_TYPE) != 0 && (Flags & LONG_TYPE) == 0) {
- //
- // 'd', 'u', 'x', and 'X' that are not preceded by 'l' or 'L' are assumed to be type "int".
- // This assumption is made so the format string definition is compatible with the ANSI C
- // Specification for formatted strings. It is recommended that the Base Types be used
- // everywhere, but in this one case, compliance with ANSI C is more important, and
- // provides an implementation that is compatible with that largest possible set of CPU
- // architectures. This is why the type "unsigned int" is used in this one case.
- //
- Value = (unsigned int)Value;
- }
- } else {
- Radix = 16;
- Comma = FALSE;
- if ((Flags & LONG_TYPE) == 0 && Value < 0) {
- //
- // 'd', 'u', 'x', and 'X' that are not preceded by 'l' or 'L' are assumed to be type "int".
- // This assumption is made so the format string definition is compatible with the ANSI C
- // Specification for formatted strings. It is recommended that the Base Types be used
- // everywhere, but in this one case, compliance with ANSI C is more important, and
- // provides an implementation that is compatible with that largest possible set of CPU
- // architectures. This is why the type "unsigned int" is used in this one case.
- //
- Value = (unsigned int)Value;
- }
- }
- //
- // Convert Value to a reversed string
- //
- Count = InternalPrintLibValueToString (ValueBuffer, Value, Radix) - ValueBuffer;
- if (Value == 0 && Precision == 0) {
- Count = 0;
- }
- ArgumentString = (CHAR8 *)ValueBuffer + Count;
-
- Digits = Count % 3;
- if (Digits != 0) {
- Digits = 3 - Digits;
- }
- if (Comma && Count != 0) {
- Count += ((Count - 1) / 3);
- }
- if (Prefix != 0) {
- Count++;
- Precision++;
- }
- Flags |= ARGUMENT_REVERSED;
- ZeroPad = TRUE;
- if ((Flags & PREFIX_ZERO) != 0) {
- if ((Flags & LEFT_JUSTIFY) == 0) {
- if ((Flags & PAD_TO_WIDTH) != 0) {
- if ((Flags & PRECISION) == 0) {
- Precision = Width;
- }
- }
- }
- }
- break;
-
- case 's':
- case 'S':
- Flags |= ARGUMENT_UNICODE;
- //
- // break skipped on purpose
- //
- case 'a':
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- ArgumentString = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, CHAR8 *);
- } else {
- ArgumentString = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, CHAR8 *);
- }
- if (ArgumentString == NULL) {
- Flags &= (~(UINTN)ARGUMENT_UNICODE);
- ArgumentString = "<null string>";
- }
- //
- // Set the default precision for string to be zero if not specified.
- //
- if ((Flags & PRECISION) == 0) {
- Precision = 0;
- }
- break;
-
- case 'c':
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- Character = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN) & 0xffff;
- } else {
- Character = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN) & 0xffff;
- }
- ArgumentString = (CHAR8 *)&Character;
- Flags |= ARGUMENT_UNICODE;
- break;
-
- case 'g':
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- TmpGuid = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, GUID *);
- } else {
- TmpGuid = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, GUID *);
- }
- if (TmpGuid == NULL) {
- ArgumentString = "<null guid>";
- } else {
- GuidData1 = ReadUnaligned32 (&(TmpGuid->Data1));
- GuidData2 = ReadUnaligned16 (&(TmpGuid->Data2));
- GuidData3 = ReadUnaligned16 (&(TmpGuid->Data3));
- InternalPrintLibSPrint (
- ValueBuffer,
- MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS,
- 0,
- "%08x-%04x-%04x-%02x%02x-%02x%02x%02x%02x%02x%02x",
- GuidData1,
- GuidData2,
- GuidData3,
- TmpGuid->Data4[0],
- TmpGuid->Data4[1],
- TmpGuid->Data4[2],
- TmpGuid->Data4[3],
- TmpGuid->Data4[4],
- TmpGuid->Data4[5],
- TmpGuid->Data4[6],
- TmpGuid->Data4[7]
- );
- ArgumentString = ValueBuffer;
- }
- break;
-
- case 't':
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- TmpTime = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, TIME *);
- } else {
- TmpTime = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, TIME *);
- }
- if (TmpTime == NULL) {
- ArgumentString = "<null time>";
- } else {
- InternalPrintLibSPrint (
- ValueBuffer,
- MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS,
- 0,
- "%02d/%02d/%04d %02d:%02d",
- TmpTime->Month,
- TmpTime->Day,
- TmpTime->Year,
- TmpTime->Hour,
- TmpTime->Minute
- );
- ArgumentString = ValueBuffer;
- }
- break;
-
- case 'r':
- if (BaseListMarker == NULL) {
- Status = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, RETURN_STATUS);
- } else {
- Status = BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, RETURN_STATUS);
- }
- ArgumentString = ValueBuffer;
- if (RETURN_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Clear error bit
- //
- Index = Status & ~MAX_BIT;
- if (Index > 0 && Index <= ERROR_STATUS_NUMBER) {
- ArgumentString = mStatusString [Index + WARNING_STATUS_NUMBER];
- }
- } else {
- Index = Status;
- if (Index <= WARNING_STATUS_NUMBER) {
- ArgumentString = mStatusString [Index];
- }
- }
- if (ArgumentString == ValueBuffer) {
- InternalPrintLibSPrint ((CHAR8 *) ValueBuffer, MAXIMUM_VALUE_CHARACTERS, 0, "%08X", Status);
- }
- break;
-
- case '\r':
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- if (FormatCharacter == '\n') {
- //
- // Translate '\r\n' to '\r\n'
- //
- ArgumentString = "\r\n";
- } else {
- //
- // Translate '\r' to '\r'
- //
- ArgumentString = "\r";
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- }
- break;
-
- case '\n':
- //
- // Translate '\n' to '\r\n' and '\n\r' to '\r\n'
- //
- ArgumentString = "\r\n";
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- if (FormatCharacter != '\r') {
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- }
- break;
-
- case '%':
- default:
- //
- // if the type is '%' or unknown, then print it to the screen
- //
- ArgumentString = (CHAR8 *)&FormatCharacter;
- Flags |= ARGUMENT_UNICODE;
- break;
- }
- break;
-
- case '\r':
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- if (FormatCharacter == '\n') {
- //
- // Translate '\r\n' to '\r\n'
- //
- ArgumentString = "\r\n";
- } else {
- //
- // Translate '\r' to '\r'
- //
- ArgumentString = "\r";
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- }
- break;
-
- case '\n':
- //
- // Translate '\n' to '\r\n' and '\n\r' to '\r\n'
- //
- ArgumentString = "\r\n";
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- if (FormatCharacter != '\r') {
- Format -= BytesPerFormatCharacter;
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- ArgumentString = (CHAR8 *)&FormatCharacter;
- Flags |= ARGUMENT_UNICODE;
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the ArgumentString attriubutes
- //
- if ((Flags & ARGUMENT_UNICODE) != 0) {
- ArgumentMask = 0xffff;
- BytesPerArgumentCharacter = 2;
- } else {
- ArgumentMask = 0xff;
- BytesPerArgumentCharacter = 1;
- }
- if ((Flags & ARGUMENT_REVERSED) != 0) {
- BytesPerArgumentCharacter = -BytesPerArgumentCharacter;
- } else {
- //
- // Compute the number of characters in ArgumentString and store it in Count
- // ArgumentString is either null-terminated, or it contains Precision characters
- //
- for (Count = 0; Count < Precision || ((Flags & PRECISION) == 0); Count++) {
- ArgumentCharacter = ((ArgumentString[Count * BytesPerArgumentCharacter] & 0xff) | ((ArgumentString[Count * BytesPerArgumentCharacter + 1]) << 8)) & ArgumentMask;
- if (ArgumentCharacter == 0) {
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (Precision < Count) {
- Precision = Count;
- }
-
- //
- // Pad before the string
- //
- if ((Flags & (PAD_TO_WIDTH | LEFT_JUSTIFY)) == (PAD_TO_WIDTH)) {
- LengthToReturn += ((Width - Precision) * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, Width - Precision, ' ', BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- }
-
- if (ZeroPad) {
- if (Prefix != 0) {
- LengthToReturn += (1 * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, 1, Prefix, BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- }
- LengthToReturn += ((Precision - Count) * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, Precision - Count, '0', BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- } else {
- LengthToReturn += ((Precision - Count) * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, Precision - Count, ' ', BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- if (Prefix != 0) {
- LengthToReturn += (1 * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, 1, Prefix, BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Output the Prefix character if it is present
- //
- Index = 0;
- if (Prefix != 0) {
- Index++;
- }
-
- //
- // Copy the string into the output buffer performing the required type conversions
- //
- while (Index < Count) {
- ArgumentCharacter = ((*ArgumentString & 0xff) | (*(ArgumentString + 1) << 8)) & ArgumentMask;
-
- LengthToReturn += (1 * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, 1, ArgumentCharacter, BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- ArgumentString += BytesPerArgumentCharacter;
- Index++;
- if (Comma) {
- Digits++;
- if (Digits == 3) {
- Digits = 0;
- Index++;
- if (Index < Count) {
- LengthToReturn += (1 * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, 1, ',', BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Pad after the string
- //
- if ((Flags & (PAD_TO_WIDTH | LEFT_JUSTIFY)) == (PAD_TO_WIDTH | LEFT_JUSTIFY)) {
- LengthToReturn += ((Width - Precision) * BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) == 0 && Buffer != NULL) {
- Buffer = InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer, Width - Precision, ' ', BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Get the next character from the format string
- //
- Format += BytesPerFormatCharacter;
-
- //
- // Get the next character from the format string
- //
- FormatCharacter = ((*Format & 0xff) | (*(Format + 1) << 8)) & FormatMask;
- }
-
- if ((Flags & COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT) != 0) {
- return (LengthToReturn / BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- }
-
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
- //
- // Null terminate the Unicode or ASCII string
- //
- InternalPrintLibFillBuffer (Buffer, EndBuffer + BytesPerOutputCharacter, 1, 0, BytesPerOutputCharacter);
- //
- // Make sure output buffer cannot contain more than PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength
- // Unicode characters if PcdMaximumUnicodeStringLength is not zero.
- //
- ASSERT ((((Flags & OUTPUT_UNICODE) == 0)) || (StrSize ((CHAR16 *) OriginalBuffer) != 0));
- //
- // Make sure output buffer cannot contain more than PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength
- // ASCII characters if PcdMaximumAsciiStringLength is not zero.
- //
- ASSERT ((((Flags & OUTPUT_UNICODE) != 0)) || (AsciiStrSize (OriginalBuffer) != 0));
-
- return ((Buffer - OriginalBuffer) / BytesPerOutputCharacter);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns the number of characters that would be produced by if the formatted
- output were produced not including the Null-terminator.
-
- If FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If FormatString is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] FormatString A Null-terminated Unicode format string.
- @param[in] Marker VA_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of characters that would be produced, not including the
- Null-terminator.
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-SPrintLength (
- IN CONST CHAR16 *FormatString,
- IN VA_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- ASSERT(FormatString != NULL);
- return InternalPrintLibSPrintMarker (NULL, 0, FORMAT_UNICODE | OUTPUT_UNICODE | COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT, (CHAR8 *)FormatString, Marker, NULL);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns the number of characters that would be produced by if the formatted
- output were produced not including the Null-terminator.
-
- If FormatString is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] FormatString A Null-terminated ASCII format string.
- @param[in] Marker VA_LIST marker for the variable argument list.
-
- @return The number of characters that would be produced, not including the
- Null-terminator.
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-SPrintLengthAsciiFormat (
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FormatString,
- IN VA_LIST Marker
- )
-{
- ASSERT(FormatString != NULL);
- return InternalPrintLibSPrintMarker (NULL, 0, OUTPUT_UNICODE | COUNT_ONLY_NO_PRINT, (CHAR8 *)FormatString, Marker, NULL);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/DxeReportStatusCodeLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/DxeReportStatusCodeLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 962cf8b05b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/DxeReportStatusCodeLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,57 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# DXE report status code library.
-#
-# Retrieve status code and report status code in DXE phase.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeReportStatusCodeLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = EBF144C8-70F5-4e09-ADE2-F41F5C59AFDA
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = ReportStatusCodeLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER SMM_CORE
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- ReportStatusCodeLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- PcdLib
- DevicePathLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
- gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiStatusCodeRuntimeProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask ## CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/DxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/DxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 61da4060f5..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/DxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index ce843cc47f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,631 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Report Status Code Library for DXE Phase.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/ReportStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/StatusCode.h>
-
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeId.h>
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeDebug.h>
-
-//
-// Define the maximum extended data size that is supported when a status code is
-// reported at TPL_HIGH_LEVEL.
-//
-#define MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE 0x200
-
-EFI_STATUS_CODE_PROTOCOL *mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol = NULL;
-
-/**
- Locate the report status code service.
-
- Retrieve ReportStatusCode() API of Report Status Code Protocol.
-
-**/
-VOID
-InternalGetReportStatusCode (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol != NULL) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Check gBS just in case ReportStatusCode is called before gBS is initialized.
- //
- if (gBS != NULL && gBS->LocateProtocol != NULL) {
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiStatusCodeRuntimeProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID**) &mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol = NULL;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Internal worker function that reports a status code through the Report Status Code Protocol.
-
- If status code service is not cached, then this function checks if Report Status Code
- Protocol is available in system. If Report Status Code Protocol is not available, then
- EFI_UNSUPPORTED is returned. If Report Status Code Protocol is present, then it is
- cached in mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol. Finally this function reports status
- code through the Report Status Code Protocol.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. This is an optional parameter that may be
- NULL.
- @param Data Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report Status Code Protocol is not available.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Status code type is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- if ((ReportProgressCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- (ReportErrorCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ||
- (ReportDebugCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_DEBUG_CODE)) {
- //
- // If mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol is NULL, then check if Report Status Code Protocol is available in system.
- //
- InternalGetReportStatusCode ();
- if (mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol == NULL) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // A Report Status Code Protocol is present in system, so pass in all the parameters to the service.
- //
- return mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol->ReportStatusCode (Type, Value, Instance, (EFI_GUID *)CallerId, Data);
- }
-
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Converts a status code to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType and Value to an 8-bit POST code
- and returns the 8-bit POST code in PostCode. If CodeType is an
- EFI_PROGRESS_CODE or CodeType is an EFI_ERROR_CODE, then bits 0..4 of PostCode
- are set to bits 16..20 of Value, and bits 5..7 of PostCode are set to bits
- 24..26 of Value., and TRUE is returned. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param PostCode A pointer to the 8-bit POST code value to return.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType and Value was converted
- to an 8-bit POST code and returned in PostCode.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType and Value could not be
- converted to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-CodeTypeToPostCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- OUT UINT8 *PostCode
- )
-{
- //
- // If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT()
- //
- ASSERT (PostCode != NULL);
-
- //
- // Convert Value to an 8 bit post code
- //
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ) {
- *PostCode = (UINT8) ((((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_CLASS_MASK) >> 24) << 5) |
- (((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SUBCLASS_MASK) >> 16) & 0x1f));
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts ASSERT() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data to the ASSERT()
- arguments specified by Filename, Description, and LineNumber. If CodeType is
- an EFI_ERROR_CODE, and CodeType has a severity of EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED, and
- Value has an operation mask of EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE, extract
- Filename, Description, and LineNumber from the optional data area of the
- status code buffer specified by Data. The optional data area of Data contains
- a Null-terminated ASCII string for the FileName, followed by a Null-terminated
- ASCII string for the Description, followed by a 32-bit LineNumber. If the
- ASSERT() information could be extracted from Data, then return TRUE.
- Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Filename is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Description is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If LineNumber is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param Filename Pointer to the source file name that generated the ASSERT().
- @param Description Pointer to the description of the ASSERT().
- @param LineNumber Pointer to source line number that generated the ASSERT().
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data was
- converted ASSERT() arguments specified by Filename, Description,
- and LineNumber.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data could
- not be converted to ASSERT() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractAssertInfo (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT CHAR8 **Filename,
- OUT CHAR8 **Description,
- OUT UINT32 *LineNumber
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *AssertData;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (Filename != NULL);
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
- ASSERT (LineNumber != NULL);
-
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) &&
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SEVERITY_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED) &&
- ((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_OPERATION_MASK) == EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE)) {
- AssertData = (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *)(Data + 1);
- *Filename = (CHAR8 *)(AssertData + 1);
- *Description = *Filename + AsciiStrLen (*Filename) + 1;
- *LineNumber = AssertData->LineNumber;
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts DEBUG() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by Data to the DEBUG() arguments specified
- by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format. If type GUID in Data is
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID, then extract ErrorLevel, Marker, and
- Format from the optional data area of the status code buffer specified by Data.
- The optional data area of Data contains a 32-bit ErrorLevel followed by Marker
- which is 12 UINTN parameters, followed by a Null-terminated ASCII string for
- the Format. If the DEBUG() information could be extracted from Data, then
- return TRUE. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ErrorLevel is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Marker is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Format is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param ErrorLevel Pointer to error level mask for a debug message.
- @param Marker Pointer to the variable argument list associated with Format.
- @param Format Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII format string of a
- debug message.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by Data was converted DEBUG() arguments
- specified by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by Data could not be converted to
- DEBUG() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractDebugInfo (
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT UINT32 *ErrorLevel,
- OUT BASE_LIST *Marker,
- OUT CHAR8 **Format
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_INFO *DebugInfo;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (ErrorLevel != NULL);
- ASSERT (Marker != NULL);
- ASSERT (Format != NULL);
-
- //
- // If the GUID type is not EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID then return FALSE
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (&Data->Type, &gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the debug information from the status code record
- //
- DebugInfo = (EFI_DEBUG_INFO *)(Data + 1);
-
- *ErrorLevel = DebugInfo->ErrorLevel;
-
- //
- // The first 12 * sizeof (UINT64) bytes following EFI_DEBUG_INFO are for variable arguments
- // of format in DEBUG string. Its address is returned in Marker and has to be 64-bit aligned.
- // It must be noticed that EFI_DEBUG_INFO follows EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA, whose size is
- // 20 bytes. The size of EFI_DEBUG_INFO is 4 bytes, so we can ensure that Marker
- // returned is 64-bit aligned.
- // 64-bit aligned is a must, otherwise retrieving 64-bit parameter from BASE_LIST will
- // cause unalignment exception.
- //
- *Marker = (BASE_LIST) (DebugInfo + 1);
- *Format = (CHAR8 *)(((UINT64 *)*Marker) + 12);
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code.
-
- Reports the status code specified by the parameters Type and Value. Status
- code also require an instance, caller ID, and extended data. This function
- passed in a zero instance, NULL extended data, and a caller ID of
- gEfiCallerIdGuid, which is the GUID for the module.
-
- ReportStatusCode()must actively prevent recusrsion. If ReportStatusCode()
- is called while processing another any other Report Status Code Library function,
- then ReportStatusCode() must return immediately.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR There status code could not be reported due to a
- device error.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value
- )
-{
- return InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, 0, &gEfiCallerIdGuid, NULL);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with a Device Path Protocol as the extended data.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- Device Path Protocol specified by DevicePath. This function is responsible
- for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and the device
- path. The standard header is filled in with a GUID of
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported with a zero
- instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If DevicePath is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param DevicePath Pointer to the Device Path Protocol to be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by DevicePath.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- ASSERT (DevicePath != NULL);
- return ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData (
- Type,
- Value,
- (VOID *)DevicePath,
- GetDevicePathSize (DevicePath)
- );
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with an extended data buffer.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- extended data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize. ExtendedData
- is assumed to be one of the data structures specified in Related Definitions.
- These data structure do not have the standard header, so this function is
- responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled
- in with a GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported
- with a zero instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedDataSize is 0, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer to be reported.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer to
- be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- ASSERT (ExtendedData != NULL);
- ASSERT (ExtendedDataSize != 0);
- return ReportStatusCodeEx (
- Type,
- Value,
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- ExtendedData,
- ExtendedDataSize
- );
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with full parameters.
-
- The function reports a status code. If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize
- is 0, then an extended data buffer is not reported. If ExtendedData is not
- NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not 0, then an extended data buffer is allocated.
- ExtendedData is assumed not have the standard status code header, so this function
- is responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled in
- with a GUID specified by ExtendedDataGuid. If ExtendedDataGuid is NULL, then a
- GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid is used. The status code is reported with
- an instance specified by Instance and a caller ID specified by CallerId. If
- CallerId is NULL, then a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
-
- ReportStatusCodeEx()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeEx() is called while processing another any
- other Report Status Code Library function, then
- ReportStatusCodeEx() must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedData is not NULL and ExtendedDataSize is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. If this parameter is NULL, then a caller
- ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
- @param ExtendedDataGuid Pointer to the GUID for the extended data buffer.
- If this parameter is NULL, then a the status code
- standard header is filled in with
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate
- the extended data section if it was specified.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeEx (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *ExtendedDataGuid OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData OPTIONAL,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *StatusCodeData;
- EFI_TPL Tpl;
- UINT64 Buffer[(MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE / sizeof (UINT64)) + 1];
-
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData == NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize != 0)));
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData != NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize == 0)));
-
- if (gBS == NULL || gBS->AllocatePool == NULL || gBS->FreePool == NULL) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the current TPL
- //
- Tpl = gBS->RaiseTPL (TPL_HIGH_LEVEL);
- gBS->RestoreTPL (Tpl);
-
- StatusCodeData = NULL;
- if (Tpl <= TPL_NOTIFY) {
- //
- // Allocate space for the Status Code Header and its buffer
- //
- gBS->AllocatePool (EfiBootServicesData, sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA) + ExtendedDataSize, (VOID **)&StatusCodeData);
- }
-
- if (StatusCodeData == NULL) {
- //
- // If a buffer could not be allocated, then see if the local variable Buffer can be used
- //
- if (ExtendedDataSize > (MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE - sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA))) {
- //
- // The local variable Buffer not large enough to hold the extended data associated
- // with the status code being reported.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "Status code extended data is too large to be reported!\n"));
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- StatusCodeData = (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *)Buffer;
- }
-
- //
- // Fill in the extended data header
- //
- StatusCodeData->HeaderSize = (UINT16) sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA);
- StatusCodeData->Size = (UINT16) ExtendedDataSize;
- if (ExtendedDataGuid == NULL) {
- ExtendedDataGuid = &gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid;
- }
- CopyGuid (&StatusCodeData->Type, ExtendedDataGuid);
-
- //
- // Fill in the extended data buffer
- //
- if (ExtendedData != NULL) {
- CopyMem (StatusCodeData + 1, ExtendedData, ExtendedDataSize);
- }
-
- //
- // Report the status code
- //
- if (CallerId == NULL) {
- CallerId = &gEfiCallerIdGuid;
- }
- Status = InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, Instance, CallerId, StatusCodeData);
-
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer
- //
- if (StatusCodeData != (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *)Buffer) {
- gBS->FreePool (StatusCodeData);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_PROGRESS_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportProgressCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_ERROR_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportErrorCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_DEBUG_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportDebugCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index b96d78664d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,533 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Provides generic security measurement functions for DXE module.
-
-Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-#include <Protocol/LoadFile.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/DxeServicesLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/SecurityManagementLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-
-#define SECURITY_HANDLER_TABLE_SIZE 0x10
-
-//
-// Secruity Operation on Image and none Image.
-//
-#define EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK (EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_VERIFY_IMAGE \
- | EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_DEFER_IMAGE_LOAD \
- | EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE)
-#define EFI_AUTH_NONE_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK (EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_CONNECT_POLICY \
- | EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_AUTHENTICATION_STATE)
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT32 SecurityOperation;
- SECURITY_FILE_AUTHENTICATION_STATE_HANDLER SecurityHandler;
-} SECURITY_INFO;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT32 Security2Operation;
- SECURITY2_FILE_AUTHENTICATION_HANDLER Security2Handler;
-} SECURITY2_INFO;
-
-UINT32 mCurrentAuthOperation = 0;
-UINT32 mNumberOfSecurityHandler = 0;
-UINT32 mMaxNumberOfSecurityHandler = 0;
-SECURITY_INFO *mSecurityTable = NULL;
-
-UINT32 mCurrentAuthOperation2 = 0;
-UINT32 mNumberOfSecurity2Handler = 0;
-UINT32 mMaxNumberOfSecurity2Handler = 0;
-SECURITY2_INFO *mSecurity2Table = NULL;
-
-/**
- Reallocates more global memory to store the registered Handler list.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Reallocate memory successfully.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory to allocated.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReallocateSecurityHandlerTable (
- )
-{
- //
- // Reallocate memory for security info structure.
- //
- mSecurityTable = ReallocatePool (
- mMaxNumberOfSecurityHandler * sizeof (SECURITY_INFO),
- (mMaxNumberOfSecurityHandler + SECURITY_HANDLER_TABLE_SIZE) * sizeof (SECURITY_INFO),
- mSecurityTable
- );
-
- //
- // No enough resource is allocated.
- //
- if (mSecurityTable == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Increase max handler number
- //
- mMaxNumberOfSecurityHandler = mMaxNumberOfSecurityHandler + SECURITY_HANDLER_TABLE_SIZE;
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether an operation is valid according to the requirement of current operation,
- which must make sure that the measure image operation is the last one.
-
- @param CurrentAuthOperation Current operation.
- @param CheckAuthOperation Operation to be checked.
-
- @retval TRUE Operation is valid for current operation.
- @retval FALSE Operation is invalid for current operation.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-CheckAuthenticationOperation (
- IN UINT32 CurrentAuthOperation,
- IN UINT32 CheckAuthOperation
- )
-{
- //
- // Make sure new auth operation can be recognized.
- //
- ASSERT ((CheckAuthOperation & ~(EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK | EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_AUTHENTICATION_STATE | EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_IMAGE_REQUIRED)) == 0);
-
- //
- // When current operation includes measure image operation,
- // only another measure image operation or none operation will be allowed.
- //
- if ((CurrentAuthOperation & EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) {
- if (((CheckAuthOperation & EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) ||
- ((CheckAuthOperation & EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK) == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_NONE)) {
- return TRUE;
- } else {
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // When current operation doesn't include measure image operation,
- // any new operation will be allowed.
- //
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Register security measurement handler with its operation type. The different
- handler with the same operation can all be registered.
-
- If SecurityHandler is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If no enough resources available to register new handler, then ASSERT().
- If AuthenticationOperation is not recongnized, then ASSERT().
- If the previous register handler can't be executed before the later register handler, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] SecurityHandler Security measurement service handler to be registered.
- @param[in] AuthenticationOperation Operation type is specified for the registered handler.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The handlers were registered successfully.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RegisterSecurityHandler (
- IN SECURITY_FILE_AUTHENTICATION_STATE_HANDLER SecurityHandler,
- IN UINT32 AuthenticationOperation
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (SecurityHandler != NULL);
-
- //
- // Make sure AuthenticationOperation is valid in the register order.
- //
- ASSERT (CheckAuthenticationOperation (mCurrentAuthOperation, AuthenticationOperation));
- mCurrentAuthOperation = mCurrentAuthOperation | AuthenticationOperation;
-
- //
- // Check whether the handler lists is enough to store new handler.
- //
- if (mNumberOfSecurityHandler == mMaxNumberOfSecurityHandler) {
- //
- // Allocate more resources for new handler.
- //
- Status = ReallocateSecurityHandlerTable();
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
-
- //
- // Register new handler into the handler list.
- //
- mSecurityTable[mNumberOfSecurityHandler].SecurityOperation = AuthenticationOperation;
- mSecurityTable[mNumberOfSecurityHandler].SecurityHandler = SecurityHandler;
- mNumberOfSecurityHandler ++;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Execute registered handlers until one returns an error and that error is returned.
- If none of the handlers return an error, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned.
-
- Before exectue handler, get the image buffer by file device path if a handler
- requires the image file. And return the image buffer to each handler when exectue handler.
-
- The handlers are executed in same order to their registered order.
-
- @param[in] AuthenticationStatus
- This is the authentication type returned from the Section
- Extraction protocol. See the Section Extraction Protocol
- Specification for details on this type.
- @param[in] FilePath This is a pointer to the device path of the file that is
- being dispatched. This will optionally be used for logging.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The file specified by File did authenticate when more
- than one security handler services were registered,
- or the file did not authenticate when no security
- handler service was registered. And the platform policy
- dictates that the DXE Core may use File.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER File is NULL.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION The file specified by File did not authenticate, and
- the platform policy dictates that File should be placed
- in the untrusted state. A file may be promoted from
- the untrusted to the trusted state at a future time
- with a call to the Trust() DXE Service.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED The file specified by File did not authenticate, and
- the platform policy dictates that File should not be
- used for any purpose.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ExecuteSecurityHandlers (
- IN UINT32 AuthenticationStatus,
- IN CONST EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 HandlerAuthenticationStatus;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
- UINTN FileSize;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Node;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePathToVerfiy;
-
- if (FilePath == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Directly return successfully when no handler is registered.
- //
- if (mNumberOfSecurityHandler == 0) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- FileBuffer = NULL;
- FileSize = 0;
- HandlerAuthenticationStatus = AuthenticationStatus;
- FilePathToVerfiy = (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) FilePath;
- //
- // Run security handler in same order to their registered list
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < mNumberOfSecurityHandler; Index ++) {
- if ((mSecurityTable[Index].SecurityOperation & EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_IMAGE_REQUIRED) == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_IMAGE_REQUIRED) {
- //
- // Try get file buffer when the handler requires image buffer.
- //
- if (FileBuffer == NULL) {
- Node = FilePathToVerfiy;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiLoadFileProtocolGuid, &Node, &Handle);
- //
- // Try to get image by FALSE boot policy for the exact boot file path.
- //
- FileBuffer = GetFileBufferByFilePath (FALSE, FilePath, &FileSize, &AuthenticationStatus);
- if (FileBuffer == NULL) {
- //
- // Try to get image by TRUE boot policy for the inexact boot file path.
- //
- FileBuffer = GetFileBufferByFilePath (TRUE, FilePath, &FileSize, &AuthenticationStatus);
- }
- if ((FileBuffer != NULL) && (!EFI_ERROR (Status))) {
- //
- // LoadFile () may cause the device path of the Handle be updated.
- //
- FilePathToVerfiy = AppendDevicePath (DevicePathFromHandle (Handle), Node);
- }
- }
- }
- Status = mSecurityTable[Index].SecurityHandler (
- HandlerAuthenticationStatus,
- FilePathToVerfiy,
- FileBuffer,
- FileSize
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (FileBuffer);
- }
- if (FilePathToVerfiy != FilePath) {
- FreePool (FilePathToVerfiy);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates more global memory to store the registered Securit2Handler list.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Reallocate memory successfully.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory to allocated.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReallocateSecurity2HandlerTable (
- )
-{
- //
- // Reallocate memory for security info structure.
- //
- mSecurity2Table = ReallocatePool (
- mMaxNumberOfSecurity2Handler * sizeof (SECURITY2_INFO),
- (mMaxNumberOfSecurity2Handler + SECURITY_HANDLER_TABLE_SIZE) * sizeof (SECURITY2_INFO),
- mSecurity2Table
- );
-
- //
- // No enough resource is allocated.
- //
- if (mSecurity2Table == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Increase max handler number
- //
- mMaxNumberOfSecurity2Handler = mMaxNumberOfSecurity2Handler + SECURITY_HANDLER_TABLE_SIZE;
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether an operation is valid according to the requirement of current operation,
- which must make sure that the measure image operation is the last one.
-
- If AuthenticationOperation is not recongnized, return FALSE.
- If AuthenticationOperation is EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_NONE, return FALSE.
- If AuthenticationOperation includes security operation and authentication operation, return FALSE.
- If the previous register handler can't be executed before the later register handler, return FALSE.
-
- @param CurrentAuthOperation Current operation.
- @param CheckAuthOperation Operation to be checked.
-
- @retval TRUE Operation is valid for current operation.
- @retval FALSE Operation is invalid for current operation.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-CheckAuthentication2Operation (
- IN UINT32 CurrentAuthOperation,
- IN UINT32 CheckAuthOperation
- )
-{
- //
- // Make sure new auth operation can be recognized.
- //
- if (CheckAuthOperation == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_NONE) {
- return FALSE;
- }
- if ((CheckAuthOperation & ~(EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK |
- EFI_AUTH_NONE_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK |
- EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_IMAGE_REQUIRED)) != 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // When current operation includes measure image operation,
- // only another measure image or none image operation will be allowed.
- //
- if ((CurrentAuthOperation & EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) {
- if (((CheckAuthOperation & EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) == EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_MEASURE_IMAGE) ||
- ((CheckAuthOperation & EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK) == 0)) {
- return TRUE;
- } else {
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Any other operation will be allowed.
- //
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Register security measurement handler with its operation type. Different
- handlers with the same operation can all be registered.
-
- If Security2Handler is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If no enough resources available to register new handler, then ASSERT().
- If AuthenticationOperation is not recongnized, then ASSERT().
- If AuthenticationOperation is EFI_AUTH_OPERATION_NONE, then ASSERT().
- If the previous register handler can't be executed before the later register handler, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] Security2Handler The security measurement service handler to be registered.
- @param[in] AuthenticationOperation The operation type is specified for the registered handler.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The handlers were registered successfully.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RegisterSecurity2Handler (
- IN SECURITY2_FILE_AUTHENTICATION_HANDLER Security2Handler,
- IN UINT32 AuthenticationOperation
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (Security2Handler != NULL);
-
- //
- // Make sure AuthenticationOperation is valid in the register order.
- //
- ASSERT (CheckAuthentication2Operation (mCurrentAuthOperation2, AuthenticationOperation));
- mCurrentAuthOperation2 = mCurrentAuthOperation2 | AuthenticationOperation;
-
- //
- // Check whether the handler lists is enough to store new handler.
- //
- if (mNumberOfSecurity2Handler == mMaxNumberOfSecurity2Handler) {
- //
- // Allocate more resources for new handler.
- //
- Status = ReallocateSecurity2HandlerTable();
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
-
- //
- // Register new handler into the handler list.
- //
- mSecurity2Table[mNumberOfSecurity2Handler].Security2Operation = AuthenticationOperation;
- mSecurity2Table[mNumberOfSecurity2Handler].Security2Handler = Security2Handler;
- mNumberOfSecurity2Handler ++;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Execute registered handlers based on input AuthenticationOperation until
- one returns an error and that error is returned.
-
- If none of the handlers return an error, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned.
- The handlers those satisfy AuthenticationOperation will only be executed.
- The handlers are executed in same order to their registered order.
-
- @param[in] AuthenticationOperation
- The operation type specifies which handlers will be executed.
- @param[in] AuthenticationStatus
- The authentication status for the input file.
- @param[in] File This is a pointer to the device path of the file that is
- being dispatched. This will optionally be used for logging.
- @param[in] FileBuffer A pointer to the buffer with the UEFI file image
- @param[in] FileSize The size of File buffer.
- @param[in] BootPolicy A boot policy that was used to call LoadImage() UEFI service.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The file specified by DevicePath and non-NULL
- FileBuffer did authenticate, and the platform policy dictates
- that the DXE Foundation may use the file.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The device path specified by NULL device path DevicePath
- and non-NULL FileBuffer did authenticate, and the platform
- policy dictates that the DXE Foundation may execute the image in
- FileBuffer.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS FileBuffer is NULL and current user has permission to start
- UEFI device drivers on the device path specified by DevicePath.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION The file specified by File or FileBuffer did not
- authenticate, and the platform policy dictates that
- the file should be placed in the untrusted state.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION FileBuffer FileBuffer is NULL and the user has no
- permission to start UEFI device drivers on the device path specified
- by DevicePath.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION FileBuffer is not NULL and the user has no permission to load
- drivers from the device path specified by DevicePath. The
- image has been added into the list of the deferred images.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED The file specified by File did not authenticate, and
- the platform policy dictates that the DXE
- Foundation may not use File.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER File and FileBuffer are both NULL.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ExecuteSecurity2Handlers (
- IN UINT32 AuthenticationOperation,
- IN UINT32 AuthenticationStatus,
- IN CONST EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *File,
- IN VOID *FileBuffer,
- IN UINTN FileSize,
- IN BOOLEAN BootPolicy
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Invalid case if File and FileBuffer are both NULL.
- //
- if (File == NULL && FileBuffer == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Directly return successfully when no handler is registered.
- //
- if (mNumberOfSecurity2Handler == 0) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Run security handler in same order to their registered list
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < mNumberOfSecurity2Handler; Index ++) {
- //
- // If FileBuffer is not NULL, the input is Image, which will be handled by EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK operation.
- // If FileBuffer is NULL, the input is not Image, which will be handled by EFI_AUTH_NONE_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK operation.
- // Other cases are ignored.
- //
- if ((FileBuffer != NULL && (mSecurity2Table[Index].Security2Operation & EFI_AUTH_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK) != 0) ||
- (FileBuffer == NULL && (mSecurity2Table[Index].Security2Operation & EFI_AUTH_NONE_IMAGE_OPERATION_MASK) != 0)) {
- //
- // Execute registered handlers based on input AuthenticationOperation
- //
- if ((mSecurity2Table[Index].Security2Operation & AuthenticationOperation) != 0) {
- Status = mSecurity2Table[Index].Security2Handler (
- AuthenticationStatus,
- File,
- FileBuffer,
- FileSize,
- BootPolicy
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 0f8a13b99d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,48 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Instance of SecurityManagementLib Library for DXE phase.
-#
-# This library provides generic security measurement functions for DXE module.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeSecurityManagementLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeSecurityManagementLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 7F61122C-19DF-47c3-BA0D-6C1149E30FA1
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = SecurityManagementLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeSecurityManagementLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- DebugLib
- DxeServicesLib
- DevicePathLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiLoadFileProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 6ead295caf..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSecurityManagementLib/DxeSecurityManagementLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 7af6478bec..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,866 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Performance library instance used in DXE phase to dump both PEI/DXE and SMM performance data.
-
- This library instance allows a DXE driver or UEFI application to dump both PEI/DXE and SMM performance data.
- StartPerformanceMeasurement(), EndPerformanceMeasurement(), StartPerformanceMeasurementEx()
- and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx() are not implemented.
-
- Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/SmmCommunication.h>
-
-#include <Guid/PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable.h>
-#include <Library/UefiLib.h>
-
-#define SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE (OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, Data) + sizeof (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE))
-
-EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *mSmmCommunication = NULL;
-UINT8 *mSmmPerformanceBuffer;
-GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY *mGaugeData = NULL;
-UINTN mGaugeNumberOfEntries = 0;
-GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *mGaugeDataEx = NULL;
-UINTN mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx = 0;
-
-BOOLEAN mNoSmmPerfHandler = FALSE;
-BOOLEAN mNoSmmPerfExHandler = FALSE;
-
-//
-// The cached Performance Protocol and PerformanceEx Protocol interface.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL *mPerformance = NULL;
-PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL *mPerformanceEx = NULL;
-
-/**
- The function caches the pointer to SMM Communication protocol.
-
- The function locates SMM Communication protocol from protocol database.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS SMM Communication protocol is successfully located.
- @retval Other SMM Communication protocol is not located to log performance.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetCommunicationProtocol (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *Communication;
-
- if (mSmmCommunication != NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &Communication);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (Communication != NULL);
- //
- // Cache SMM Communication protocol.
- //
- mSmmCommunication = Communication;
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- The function caches the pointers to PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol.
-
- The function locates PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol from protocol database.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS PerformanceEx protocol or Performance Protocol is successfully located.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Both PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol are not located to log performance.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetPerformanceProtocol (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL *Performance;
- PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL *PerformanceEx;
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL || mPerformance != NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gPerformanceExProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &PerformanceEx);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (PerformanceEx != NULL);
- //
- // Cache PerformanceEx Protocol.
- //
- mPerformanceEx = PerformanceEx;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gPerformanceProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &Performance);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (Performance != NULL);
- //
- // Cache performance protocol.
- //
- mPerformance = Performance;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, and Module.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetByPerformanceProtocol (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeData;
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey++, &GaugeData);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->GetGauge (LogEntryKey++, (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **) &GaugeData);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Make sure that LogEntryKey is a valid log entry key,
- //
- ASSERT (Status != EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- //
- return 0;
- }
-
- ASSERT (GaugeData != NULL);
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) GaugeData->Handle;
- *Token = GaugeData->Token;
- *Module = GaugeData->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = GaugeData->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = GaugeData->EndTimeStamp;
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- *Identifier = GaugeData->Identifier;
- } else {
- *Identifier = 0;
- }
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Retrieves all previous logged performance measurement.
- Function will use SMM communicate protocol to get all previous SMM performance measurement data.
- If success, data buffer will be returned. If fail function will return NULL.
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
-
- @retval !NULL Get all gauge data success.
- @retval NULL Get all gauge data failed.
-**/
-GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY *
-EFIAPI
-GetAllSmmGaugeData (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *SmmCommBufferHeader;
- SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE *SmmPerfCommData;
- UINTN CommSize;
- UINTN DataSize;
- EDKII_PI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_REGION_TABLE *PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable;
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_MEMORY_DESCRIPTOR *Entry;
- UINT8 *Buffer;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
- UINTN EntriesGot;
-
- if (mNoSmmPerfHandler) {
- //
- // Not try to get the SMM gauge data again
- // if no SMM Performance handler found.
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- if (LogEntryKey != 0) {
- if (mGaugeData != NULL) {
- return mGaugeData;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Reget the SMM gauge data at the first entry get.
- //
- if (mGaugeData != NULL) {
- FreePool (mGaugeData);
- mGaugeData = NULL;
- mGaugeNumberOfEntries = 0;
- }
- }
-
- Status = GetCommunicationProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = EfiGetSystemConfigurationTable (
- &gEdkiiPiSmmCommunicationRegionTableGuid,
- (VOID **) &PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- ASSERT (PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable != NULL);
- Entry = (EFI_MEMORY_DESCRIPTOR *) (PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable + 1);
- Size = 0;
- for (Index = 0; Index < PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable->NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- if (Entry->Type == EfiConventionalMemory) {
- Size = EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE ((UINTN) Entry->NumberOfPages);
- if (Size >= (SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE + sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY))) {
- break;
- }
- }
- Entry = (EFI_MEMORY_DESCRIPTOR *) ((UINT8 *) Entry + PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable->DescriptorSize);
- }
- ASSERT (Index < PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable->NumberOfEntries);
- mSmmPerformanceBuffer = (UINT8 *) (UINTN) Entry->PhysicalStart;
-
- //
- // Initialize communicate buffer
- //
- SmmCommBufferHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)mSmmPerformanceBuffer;
- SmmPerfCommData = (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE *)SmmCommBufferHeader->Data;
- ZeroMem((UINT8*)SmmPerfCommData, sizeof(SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE));
-
- CopyGuid (&SmmCommBufferHeader->HeaderGuid, &gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid);
- SmmCommBufferHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE);
- CommSize = SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE;
-
- //
- // Get total number of SMM gauge entries
- //
- SmmPerfCommData->Function = SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_ENTRY_NUMBER;
- Status = mSmmCommunication->Communicate (mSmmCommunication, mSmmPerformanceBuffer, &CommSize);
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND) {
- mNoSmmPerfHandler = TRUE;
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || EFI_ERROR (SmmPerfCommData->ReturnStatus) || SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- mGaugeNumberOfEntries = SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries;
-
- Buffer = mSmmPerformanceBuffer + SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE;
- NumberOfEntries = (Size - SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE) / sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY);
- DataSize = mGaugeNumberOfEntries * sizeof(GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY);
- mGaugeData = AllocateZeroPool(DataSize);
- ASSERT (mGaugeData != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get all SMM gauge data
- //
- SmmPerfCommData->Function = SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_DATA;
- SmmPerfCommData->GaugeData = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY *) Buffer;
- EntriesGot = 0;
- do {
- SmmPerfCommData->LogEntryKey = EntriesGot;
- if ((mGaugeNumberOfEntries - EntriesGot) >= NumberOfEntries) {
- SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries = NumberOfEntries;
- } else {
- SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries = mGaugeNumberOfEntries - EntriesGot;
- }
- Status = mSmmCommunication->Communicate (mSmmCommunication, mSmmPerformanceBuffer, &CommSize);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || EFI_ERROR (SmmPerfCommData->ReturnStatus)) {
- FreePool (mGaugeData);
- mGaugeData = NULL;
- mGaugeNumberOfEntries = 0;
- return NULL;
- } else {
- CopyMem (&mGaugeData[EntriesGot], Buffer, SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries * sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY));
- }
- EntriesGot += SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries;
- } while (EntriesGot < mGaugeNumberOfEntries);
-
- return mGaugeData;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves all previous logged performance measurement.
- Function will use SMM communicate protocol to get all previous SMM performance measurement data.
- If success, data buffer will be returned. If fail function will return NULL.
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
-
- @retval !NULL Get all gauge data success.
- @retval NULL Get all gauge data failed.
-**/
-GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *
-EFIAPI
-GetAllSmmGaugeDataEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *SmmCommBufferHeader;
- SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX *SmmPerfCommData;
- UINTN CommSize;
- UINTN DataSize;
- EDKII_PI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_REGION_TABLE *PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable;
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_MEMORY_DESCRIPTOR *Entry;
- UINT8 *Buffer;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
- UINTN EntriesGot;
-
- if (mNoSmmPerfExHandler) {
- //
- // Not try to get the SMM gauge data again
- // if no SMM PerformanceEx handler found.
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- if (LogEntryKey != 0) {
- if (mGaugeDataEx != NULL) {
- return mGaugeDataEx;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Reget the SMM gauge data at the first entry get.
- //
- if (mGaugeDataEx != NULL) {
- FreePool (mGaugeDataEx);
- mGaugeDataEx = NULL;
- mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx = 0;
- }
- }
-
- Status = GetCommunicationProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = EfiGetSystemConfigurationTable (
- &gEdkiiPiSmmCommunicationRegionTableGuid,
- (VOID **) &PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- ASSERT (PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable != NULL);
- Entry = (EFI_MEMORY_DESCRIPTOR *) (PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable + 1);
- Size = 0;
- for (Index = 0; Index < PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable->NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- if (Entry->Type == EfiConventionalMemory) {
- Size = EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE ((UINTN) Entry->NumberOfPages);
- if (Size >= (SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE + sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX))) {
- break;
- }
- }
- Entry = (EFI_MEMORY_DESCRIPTOR *) ((UINT8 *) Entry + PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable->DescriptorSize);
- }
- ASSERT (Index < PiSmmCommunicationRegionTable->NumberOfEntries);
- mSmmPerformanceBuffer = (UINT8 *) (UINTN) Entry->PhysicalStart;
- //
- // Initialize communicate buffer
- //
- SmmCommBufferHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)mSmmPerformanceBuffer;
- SmmPerfCommData = (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX *)SmmCommBufferHeader->Data;
- ZeroMem((UINT8*)SmmPerfCommData, sizeof(SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX));
-
- CopyGuid (&SmmCommBufferHeader->HeaderGuid, &gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid);
- SmmCommBufferHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX);
- CommSize = SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE;
-
- //
- // Get total number of SMM gauge entries
- //
- SmmPerfCommData->Function = SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_ENTRY_NUMBER;
- Status = mSmmCommunication->Communicate (mSmmCommunication, mSmmPerformanceBuffer, &CommSize);
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND) {
- mNoSmmPerfExHandler = TRUE;
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || EFI_ERROR (SmmPerfCommData->ReturnStatus) || SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx = SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries;
-
- Buffer = mSmmPerformanceBuffer + SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE;
- NumberOfEntries = (Size - SMM_PERFORMANCE_COMMUNICATION_BUFFER_SIZE) / sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX);
- DataSize = mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx * sizeof(GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX);
- mGaugeDataEx = AllocateZeroPool(DataSize);
- ASSERT (mGaugeDataEx != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get all SMM gauge data
- //
- SmmPerfCommData->Function = SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_DATA;
- SmmPerfCommData->GaugeDataEx = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) Buffer;
- EntriesGot = 0;
- do {
- SmmPerfCommData->LogEntryKey = EntriesGot;
- if ((mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx - EntriesGot) >= NumberOfEntries) {
- SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries = NumberOfEntries;
- } else {
- SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries = mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx - EntriesGot;
- }
- Status = mSmmCommunication->Communicate (mSmmCommunication, mSmmPerformanceBuffer, &CommSize);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || EFI_ERROR (SmmPerfCommData->ReturnStatus)) {
- FreePool (mGaugeDataEx);
- mGaugeDataEx = NULL;
- mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx = 0;
- return NULL;
- } else {
- CopyMem (&mGaugeDataEx[EntriesGot], Buffer, SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries * sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX));
- }
- EntriesGot += SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries;
- } while (EntriesGot < mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx);
-
- return mGaugeDataEx;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeData;
-
- GaugeData = NULL;
-
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
- ASSERT (Token != NULL);
- ASSERT (Module != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (EndTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (Identifier != NULL);
-
- mGaugeDataEx = GetAllSmmGaugeDataEx (LogEntryKey);
- if (mGaugeDataEx != NULL) {
- if (LogEntryKey >= mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx) {
- //
- // Try to get the data by Performance Protocol.
- //
- LogEntryKey = LogEntryKey - mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx;
- LogEntryKey = GetByPerformanceProtocol (
- LogEntryKey,
- Handle,
- Token,
- Module,
- StartTimeStamp,
- EndTimeStamp,
- Identifier
- );
- if (LogEntryKey == 0) {
- //
- // Last entry.
- //
- return LogEntryKey;
- } else {
- return (LogEntryKey + mGaugeNumberOfEntriesEx);
- }
- }
-
- GaugeData = &mGaugeDataEx[LogEntryKey++];
- *Identifier = GaugeData->Identifier;
- } else {
- mGaugeData = GetAllSmmGaugeData (LogEntryKey);
- if (mGaugeData != NULL) {
- if (LogEntryKey >= mGaugeNumberOfEntries) {
- //
- // Try to get the data by Performance Protocol.
- //
- LogEntryKey = LogEntryKey - mGaugeNumberOfEntries;
- LogEntryKey = GetByPerformanceProtocol (
- LogEntryKey,
- Handle,
- Token,
- Module,
- StartTimeStamp,
- EndTimeStamp,
- Identifier
- );
- if (LogEntryKey == 0) {
- //
- // Last entry.
- //
- return LogEntryKey;
- } else {
- return (LogEntryKey + mGaugeNumberOfEntries);
- }
- }
-
- GaugeData = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) &mGaugeData[LogEntryKey++];
- *Identifier = 0;
- } else {
- return GetByPerformanceProtocol (
- LogEntryKey,
- Handle,
- Token,
- Module,
- StartTimeStamp,
- EndTimeStamp,
- Identifier
- );
- }
- }
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) GaugeData->Handle;
- *Token = GaugeData->Token;
- *Module = GaugeData->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = GaugeData->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = GaugeData->EndTimeStamp;
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurementEx and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, and EndTimeStamp.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp
- )
-{
- UINT32 Identifier;
- return GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (LogEntryKey, Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp, &Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if the performance measurement macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-PerformanceMeasurementEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8(PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask) & PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 2b057704f8..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,68 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Performance library instance used in DXE phase to dump SMM performance data.
-#
-# This library instance allows a DXE driver or UEFI application to dump both PEI/DXE and SMM performance data.
-# StartPerformanceMeasurement(), EndPerformanceMeasurement(), StartPerformanceMeasurementEx()
-# and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx() are not implemented.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2011 - 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeSmmPerformanceLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeSmmPerformanceLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = DA80C15C-0B4D-4e75-8946-4043DE559B0C
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PerformanceLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeSmmPerformanceLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- PcdLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- UefiLib
-
-[Guids]
- gPerformanceProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Locate protocol
- gPerformanceExProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Locate protocol
- gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # Used to do smm communication
- gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # Used to do smm communication
- gEdkiiPiSmmCommunicationRegionTableGuid ## CONSUMES ## SystemTable
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_DRIVER, Depex.common.DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER]
- gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index b92de07144..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeSmmPerformanceLib/DxeSmmPerformanceLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 17183e1a6c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1007 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This library is used to share code between UEFI network stack modules.
- It provides the helper routines to access TCP service.
-
-Copyright (c) 2010 - 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at<BR>
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Library/TcpIoLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-
-/**
- The common notify function associated with various TcpIo events.
-
- @param[in] Event The event signaled.
- @param[in] Context The context.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoCommonNotify (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- if ((Event == NULL) || (Context == NULL)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- *((BOOLEAN *) Context) = TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- The internal function for delay configuring TCP6 when IP6 driver is still in DAD.
-
- @param[in] Tcp6 The EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL protocol instance.
- @param[in] Tcp6ConfigData The Tcp6 configuration data.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operational settings successfully
- completed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more parameters are invalid.
- @retval Others Failed to finish the operation.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-TcpIoGetMapping (
- IN EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6,
- IN EFI_TCP6_CONFIG_DATA *Tcp6ConfigData
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
-
- if ((Tcp6 == NULL) || (Tcp6ConfigData == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Event = NULL;
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_TIMER,
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->SetTimer (
- Event,
- TimerRelative,
- TCP_GET_MAPPING_TIMEOUT
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- while (EFI_ERROR (gBS->CheckEvent (Event))) {
-
- Tcp6->Poll (Tcp6);
-
- Status = Tcp6->Configure (Tcp6, Tcp6ConfigData);
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
-ON_EXIT:
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Create a TCP socket with the specified configuration data.
-
- @param[in] Image The handle of the driver image.
- @param[in] Controller The handle of the controller.
- @param[in] TcpVersion The version of Tcp, TCP_VERSION_4 or TCP_VERSION_6.
- @param[in] ConfigData The Tcp configuration data.
- @param[out] TcpIo The TcpIo.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The TCP socket is created and configured.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more parameters are invalid.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED One or more of the control options are not
- supported in the implementation.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate memory.
- @retval Others Failed to create the TCP socket or configure it.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoCreateSocket (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Image,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN UINT8 TcpVersion,
- IN TCP_IO_CONFIG_DATA *ConfigData,
- OUT TCP_IO *TcpIo
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
- EFI_GUID *ServiceBindingGuid;
- EFI_GUID *ProtocolGuid;
- VOID **Interface;
- EFI_TCP4_OPTION ControlOption;
- EFI_TCP4_CONFIG_DATA Tcp4ConfigData;
- EFI_TCP4_ACCESS_POINT *AccessPoint4;
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_CONFIG_DATA Tcp6ConfigData;
- EFI_TCP6_ACCESS_POINT *AccessPoint6;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
- EFI_TCP4_RECEIVE_DATA *RxData;
-
- if ((Image == NULL) || (Controller == NULL) || (ConfigData == NULL) || (TcpIo == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
-
- ZeroMem (TcpIo, sizeof (TCP_IO));
-
- if (TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiTcp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- ProtocolGuid = &gEfiTcp4ProtocolGuid;
- Interface = (VOID **) (&TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4);
- } else if (TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_6) {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiTcp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- ProtocolGuid = &gEfiTcp6ProtocolGuid;
- Interface = (VOID **) (&TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6);
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- TcpIo->TcpVersion = TcpVersion;
-
- //
- // Create the TCP child instance and get the TCP protocol.
- //
- Status = NetLibCreateServiceChild (
- Controller,
- Image,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- &TcpIo->Handle
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- TcpIo->Handle,
- ProtocolGuid,
- Interface,
- Image,
- Controller,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_DRIVER
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || (*Interface == NULL)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- if (TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
- } else {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
- }
-
- TcpIo->Image = Image;
- TcpIo->Controller = Controller;
-
- //
- // Set the configuration parameters.
- //
- ControlOption.ReceiveBufferSize = 0x200000;
- ControlOption.SendBufferSize = 0x200000;
- ControlOption.MaxSynBackLog = 0;
- ControlOption.ConnectionTimeout = 0;
- ControlOption.DataRetries = 6;
- ControlOption.FinTimeout = 0;
- ControlOption.TimeWaitTimeout = 0;
- ControlOption.KeepAliveProbes = 4;
- ControlOption.KeepAliveTime = 0;
- ControlOption.KeepAliveInterval = 0;
- ControlOption.EnableNagle = FALSE;
- ControlOption.EnableTimeStamp = FALSE;
- ControlOption.EnableWindowScaling = TRUE;
- ControlOption.EnableSelectiveAck = FALSE;
- ControlOption.EnablePathMtuDiscovery = FALSE;
-
- if (TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4ConfigData.TypeOfService = 8;
- Tcp4ConfigData.TimeToLive = 255;
- Tcp4ConfigData.ControlOption = &ControlOption;
-
- AccessPoint4 = &Tcp4ConfigData.AccessPoint;
-
- ZeroMem (AccessPoint4, sizeof (EFI_TCP4_ACCESS_POINT));
- AccessPoint4->StationPort = ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.StationPort;
- AccessPoint4->RemotePort = ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.RemotePort;
- AccessPoint4->ActiveFlag = ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.ActiveFlag;
-
- CopyMem (
- &AccessPoint4->StationAddress,
- &ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.LocalIp,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
- CopyMem (
- &AccessPoint4->SubnetMask,
- &ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.SubnetMask,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
- CopyMem (
- &AccessPoint4->RemoteAddress,
- &ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.RemoteIp,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- ASSERT (Tcp4 != NULL);
-
- //
- // Configure the TCP4 protocol.
- //
- Status = Tcp4->Configure (Tcp4, &Tcp4ConfigData);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- if (!EFI_IP4_EQUAL (&ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.Gateway, &mZeroIp4Addr)) {
- //
- // The gateway is not zero. Add the default route manually.
- //
- Status = Tcp4->Routes (
- Tcp4,
- FALSE,
- &mZeroIp4Addr,
- &mZeroIp4Addr,
- &ConfigData->Tcp4IoConfigData.Gateway
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
- }
- } else {
- Tcp6ConfigData.TrafficClass = 0;
- Tcp6ConfigData.HopLimit = 255;
- Tcp6ConfigData.ControlOption = (EFI_TCP6_OPTION *) &ControlOption;
-
- AccessPoint6 = &Tcp6ConfigData.AccessPoint;
-
- ZeroMem (AccessPoint6, sizeof (EFI_TCP6_ACCESS_POINT));
- AccessPoint6->StationPort = ConfigData->Tcp6IoConfigData.StationPort;
- AccessPoint6->RemotePort = ConfigData->Tcp6IoConfigData.RemotePort;
- AccessPoint6->ActiveFlag = ConfigData->Tcp6IoConfigData.ActiveFlag;
-
- IP6_COPY_ADDRESS (&AccessPoint6->RemoteAddress, &ConfigData->Tcp6IoConfigData.RemoteIp);
-
-
- ASSERT (Tcp6 != NULL);
- //
- // Configure the TCP6 protocol.
- //
- Status = Tcp6->Configure (Tcp6, &Tcp6ConfigData);
- if (Status == EFI_NO_MAPPING) {
- Status = TcpIoGetMapping (Tcp6, &Tcp6ConfigData);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Create events for variuos asynchronous operations.
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- TcpIoCommonNotify,
- &TcpIo->IsConnDone,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- TcpIo->ConnToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event = Event;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- TcpIoCommonNotify,
- &TcpIo->IsListenDone,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event = Event;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- TcpIoCommonNotify,
- &TcpIo->IsTxDone,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event = Event;
-
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- TcpIoCommonNotify,
- &TcpIo->IsRxDone,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event = Event;
-
- RxData = (EFI_TCP4_RECEIVE_DATA *) AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (EFI_TCP4_RECEIVE_DATA));
- if (RxData == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.Packet.RxData = RxData;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- TcpIoCommonNotify,
- &TcpIo->IsCloseDone,
- &Event
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_ERROR;
- }
-
- TcpIo->CloseToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event = Event;
-
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-
-ON_ERROR:
-
- TcpIoDestroySocket (TcpIo);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Destroy the socket.
-
- @param[in] TcpIo The TcpIo which wraps the socket to be destroyed.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoDestroySocket (
- IN TCP_IO *TcpIo
- )
-{
- EFI_EVENT Event;
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
- UINT8 TcpVersion;
- EFI_GUID *ServiceBindingGuid;
- EFI_GUID *ProtocolGuid;
- EFI_HANDLE ChildHandle;
-
- if (TcpIo == NULL) {
- return ;
- }
-
- TcpVersion = TcpIo->TcpVersion;
-
- if ((TcpVersion != TCP_VERSION_4) && (TcpVersion != TCP_VERSION_6)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- Event = TcpIo->ConnToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event;
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- Event = TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event;
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- Event = TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event;
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- Event = TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event;
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- Event = TcpIo->CloseToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Event;
-
- if (Event != NULL) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
- }
-
- if (TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.Packet.RxData != NULL) {
- FreePool (TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.Packet.RxData);
- }
-
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
-
-
- if (TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiTcp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- ProtocolGuid = &gEfiTcp4ProtocolGuid;
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
- if (Tcp4 != NULL) {
- Tcp4->Configure (Tcp4, NULL);
- }
- } else {
- ServiceBindingGuid = &gEfiTcp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid;
- ProtocolGuid = &gEfiTcp6ProtocolGuid;
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
- if (Tcp6 != NULL) {
- Tcp6->Configure (Tcp6, NULL);
- }
- }
-
- if ((Tcp4 != NULL) || (Tcp6 != NULL)) {
-
- gBS->CloseProtocol (
- TcpIo->Handle,
- ProtocolGuid,
- TcpIo->Image,
- TcpIo->Controller
- );
- }
-
- ChildHandle = NULL;
-
- if (TcpIo->IsListenDone) {
- if (TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp4;
- if (Tcp4 != NULL) {
- Tcp4->Configure (Tcp4, NULL);
- ChildHandle = TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp4Token.NewChildHandle;
- }
- } else {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp6;
- if (Tcp6 != NULL) {
- Tcp6->Configure (Tcp6, NULL);
- ChildHandle = TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp6Token.NewChildHandle;
- }
- }
-
- if (ChildHandle != NULL) {
-
- gBS->CloseProtocol (
- ChildHandle,
- ProtocolGuid,
- TcpIo->Image,
- TcpIo->Controller
- );
- }
- }
-
- NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- TcpIo->Controller,
- TcpIo->Image,
- ServiceBindingGuid,
- TcpIo->Handle
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Connect to the other endpoint of the TCP socket.
-
- @param[in, out] TcpIo The TcpIo wrapping the TCP socket.
- @param[in] Timeout The time to wait for connection done.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Connect to the other endpoint of the TCP socket
- successfully.
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT Failed to connect to the other endpoint of the
- TCP socket in the specified time period.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more parameters are invalid.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED One or more of the control options are not
- supported in the implementation.
- @retval Others Other errors as indicated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoConnect (
- IN OUT TCP_IO *TcpIo,
- IN EFI_EVENT Timeout
- )
-{
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if ((TcpIo == NULL) || (TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4 == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- TcpIo->IsConnDone = FALSE;
-
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
-
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
- Status = Tcp4->Connect (Tcp4, &TcpIo->ConnToken.Tcp4Token);
- } else if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_6) {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
- Status = Tcp6->Connect (Tcp6, &TcpIo->ConnToken.Tcp6Token);
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- while (!TcpIo->IsConnDone && EFI_ERROR (gBS->CheckEvent (Timeout))) {
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4->Poll (Tcp4);
- } else {
- Tcp6->Poll (Tcp6);
- }
- }
-
- if (!TcpIo->IsConnDone) {
- Status = EFI_TIMEOUT;
- } else {
- Status = TcpIo->ConnToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Status;
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Accept the incomding request from the other endpoint of the TCP socket.
-
- @param[in, out] TcpIo The TcpIo wrapping the TCP socket.
- @param[in] Timeout The time to wait for connection done.
-
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Connect to the other endpoint of the TCP socket
- successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more parameters are invalid.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED One or more of the control options are not
- supported in the implementation.
-
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT Failed to connect to the other endpoint of the
- TCP socket in the specified time period.
- @retval Others Other errors as indicated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoAccept (
- IN OUT TCP_IO *TcpIo,
- IN EFI_EVENT Timeout
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_GUID *ProtocolGuid;
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
-
- if ((TcpIo == NULL) || (TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4 == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- TcpIo->IsListenDone = FALSE;
-
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
-
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
- Status = Tcp4->Accept (Tcp4, &TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp4Token);
- } else if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_6) {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
- Status = Tcp6->Accept (Tcp6, &TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp6Token);
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- while (!TcpIo->IsListenDone && EFI_ERROR (gBS->CheckEvent (Timeout))) {
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4->Poll (Tcp4);
- } else {
- Tcp6->Poll (Tcp6);
- }
- }
-
- if (!TcpIo->IsListenDone) {
- Status = EFI_TIMEOUT;
- } else {
- Status = TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Status;
- }
-
- //
- // The new TCP instance handle created for the established connection is
- // in ListenToken.
- //
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- ProtocolGuid = &gEfiTcp4ProtocolGuid;
- } else {
- ProtocolGuid = &gEfiTcp6ProtocolGuid;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- TcpIo->ListenToken.Tcp4Token.NewChildHandle,
- ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) (&TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp4),
- TcpIo->Image,
- TcpIo->Controller,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_DRIVER
- );
-
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Reset the socket.
-
- @param[in, out] TcpIo The TcpIo wrapping the TCP socket.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoReset (
- IN OUT TCP_IO *TcpIo
- )
-{
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if ((TcpIo == NULL) || (TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4 == NULL)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- TcpIo->IsCloseDone = FALSE;
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
-
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- TcpIo->CloseToken.Tcp4Token.AbortOnClose = TRUE;
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
- Status = Tcp4->Close (Tcp4, &TcpIo->CloseToken.Tcp4Token);
- } else if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_6) {
- TcpIo->CloseToken.Tcp6Token.AbortOnClose = TRUE;
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
- Status = Tcp6->Close (Tcp6, &TcpIo->CloseToken.Tcp6Token);
- } else {
- return ;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- while (!TcpIo->IsCloseDone) {
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4->Poll (Tcp4);
- } else {
- Tcp6->Poll (Tcp6);
- }
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Transmit the Packet to the other endpoint of the socket.
-
- @param[in] TcpIo The TcpIo wrapping the TCP socket.
- @param[in] Packet The packet to transmit.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The packet is trasmitted.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more parameters are invalid.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED One or more of the control options are not
- supported in the implementation.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate memory.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR An unexpected network or system error occurred.
- @retval Others Other errors as indicated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoTransmit (
- IN TCP_IO *TcpIo,
- IN NET_BUF *Packet
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VOID *Data;
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
- UINTN Size;
-
- if ((TcpIo == NULL) || (TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4 == NULL)|| (Packet == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
-
- Size = sizeof (EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA) +
- (Packet->BlockOpNum - 1) * sizeof (EFI_TCP4_FRAGMENT_DATA);
- } else if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_6) {
- Size = sizeof (EFI_TCP6_TRANSMIT_DATA) +
- (Packet->BlockOpNum - 1) * sizeof (EFI_TCP6_FRAGMENT_DATA);
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- Data = AllocatePool (Size);
- if (Data == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- ((EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->Push = TRUE;
- ((EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->Urgent = FALSE;
- ((EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->DataLength = Packet->TotalSize;
-
- //
- // Build the fragment table.
- //
- ((EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentCount = Packet->BlockOpNum;
-
- NetbufBuildExt (
- Packet,
- (NET_FRAGMENT *) &((EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentTable[0],
- &((EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentCount
- );
-
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
- Status = EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
-
- //
- // Trasnmit the packet.
- //
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp4Token.Packet.TxData = (EFI_TCP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data;
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
- if (TcpIo->IsListenDone) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp4;
- }
-
- if (Tcp4 == NULL) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- Status = Tcp4->Transmit (Tcp4, &TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp4Token);
- } else {
- TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp6Token.Packet.TxData = (EFI_TCP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data;
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
- if (TcpIo->IsListenDone) {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp6;
- }
-
- if (Tcp6 == NULL) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- Status = Tcp6->Transmit (Tcp6, &TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp6Token);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- while (!TcpIo->IsTxDone) {
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4->Poll (Tcp4);
- } else {
- Tcp6->Poll (Tcp6);
- }
- }
-
- TcpIo->IsTxDone = FALSE;
- Status = TcpIo->TxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Status;
-
-ON_EXIT:
-
- FreePool (Data);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Receive data from the socket.
-
- @param[in, out] TcpIo The TcpIo which wraps the socket to be destroyed.
- @param[in] Packet The buffer to hold the data copy from the socket rx buffer.
- @param[in] AsyncMode Is this receive asyncronous or not.
- @param[in] Timeout The time to wait for receiving the amount of data the Packet
- can hold.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The required amount of data is received from the socket.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER One or more parameters are invalid.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR An unexpected network or system error occurred.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate momery.
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT Failed to receive the required amount of data in the
- specified time period.
- @retval Others Other errors as indicated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-TcpIoReceive (
- IN OUT TCP_IO *TcpIo,
- IN NET_BUF *Packet,
- IN BOOLEAN AsyncMode,
- IN EFI_EVENT Timeout
- )
-{
- EFI_TCP4_PROTOCOL *Tcp4;
- EFI_TCP6_PROTOCOL *Tcp6;
- EFI_TCP4_RECEIVE_DATA *RxData;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- NET_FRAGMENT *Fragment;
- UINT32 FragmentCount;
- UINT32 CurrentFragment;
-
- if ((TcpIo == NULL) || (TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4 == NULL)|| (Packet == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- RxData = TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.Packet.RxData;
- if (RxData == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Tcp4 = NULL;
- Tcp6 = NULL;
-
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp4;
-
- if (TcpIo->IsListenDone) {
- Tcp4 = TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp4;
- }
-
- if (Tcp4 == NULL) {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-
- } else if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_6) {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->Tcp.Tcp6;
-
- if (TcpIo->IsListenDone) {
- Tcp6 = TcpIo->NewTcp.Tcp6;
- }
-
- if (Tcp6 == NULL) {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-
- } else {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- FragmentCount = Packet->BlockOpNum;
- Fragment = AllocatePool (FragmentCount * sizeof (NET_FRAGMENT));
- if (Fragment == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
- //
- // Build the fragment table.
- //
- NetbufBuildExt (Packet, Fragment, &FragmentCount);
-
- RxData->FragmentCount = 1;
- CurrentFragment = 0;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
-
- while (CurrentFragment < FragmentCount) {
- RxData->DataLength = Fragment[CurrentFragment].Len;
- RxData->FragmentTable[0].FragmentLength = Fragment[CurrentFragment].Len;
- RxData->FragmentTable[0].FragmentBuffer = Fragment[CurrentFragment].Bulk;
-
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Status = Tcp4->Receive (Tcp4, &TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token);
- } else {
- Status = Tcp6->Receive (Tcp6, &TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp6Token);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- while (!TcpIo->IsRxDone && ((Timeout == NULL) || EFI_ERROR (gBS->CheckEvent (Timeout)))) {
- //
- // Poll until some data is received or an error occurs.
- //
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4->Poll (Tcp4);
- } else {
- Tcp6->Poll (Tcp6);
- }
- }
-
- if (!TcpIo->IsRxDone) {
- //
- // Timeout occurs, cancel the receive request.
- //
- if (TcpIo->TcpVersion == TCP_VERSION_4) {
- Tcp4->Cancel (Tcp4, &TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken);
- } else {
- Tcp6->Cancel (Tcp6, &TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp6Token.CompletionToken);
- }
-
- Status = EFI_TIMEOUT;
- goto ON_EXIT;
- } else {
- TcpIo->IsRxDone = FALSE;
- }
-
- Status = TcpIo->RxToken.Tcp4Token.CompletionToken.Status;
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto ON_EXIT;
- }
-
- Fragment[CurrentFragment].Len -= RxData->FragmentTable[0].FragmentLength;
- if (Fragment[CurrentFragment].Len == 0) {
- CurrentFragment++;
- } else {
- Fragment[CurrentFragment].Bulk += RxData->FragmentTable[0].FragmentLength;
- }
- }
-
-ON_EXIT:
-
- if (Fragment != NULL) {
- FreePool (Fragment);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 4f11c6f0c8..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,51 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# This library instance provides TCP services by EFI TCPv4/TCPv6 Protocols.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeTcpIoLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeTcpIoLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = D4608509-1AB0-4cc7-827A-AB8E1E7BD3E6
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = TcpIoLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeTcpIoLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- TcpIoLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseMemoryLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiTcp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiTcp4ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiTcp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiTcp6ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 064d9e59b6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeTcpIoLib/DxeTcpIoLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUdpIoLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUdpIoLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index e1d72f3f1c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUdpIoLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1067 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Help functions to access UDP service, it is used by both the DHCP and MTFTP.
-
-Copyright (c) 2005 - 2012, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at<BR>
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/Udp4.h>
-#include <Protocol/Udp6.h>
-
-#include <Library/UdpIoLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DpcLib.h>
-
-
-/**
- Free a UDP_TX_TOKEN. The TX event is closed.
-
- @param[in] TxToken The UDP_TX_TOKEN to release.
-
-**/
-VOID
-UdpIoFreeTxToken (
- IN UDP_TX_TOKEN *TxToken
- )
-{
-
- if (TxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (TxToken->Token.Udp4.Event);
- } else if (TxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (TxToken->Token.Udp6.Event);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- FreePool (TxToken);
-}
-
-/**
- Free a UDP_RX_TOKEN. The RX event is closed.
-
- @param[in] RxToken The UDP_RX_TOKEN to release.
-
-**/
-VOID
-UdpIoFreeRxToken (
- IN UDP_RX_TOKEN *RxToken
- )
-{
- if (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (RxToken->Token.Udp4.Event);
- } else if (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION) {
- gBS->CloseEvent (RxToken->Token.Udp6.Event);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- FreePool (RxToken);
-}
-
-/**
- The callback function when the packet is sent by UDP.
-
- It will remove the packet from the local list then call
- the packet owner's callback function set by UdpIoSendDatagram.
-
- @param[in] Context The UDP TX Token.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoOnDgramSentDpc (
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- UDP_TX_TOKEN *TxToken;
-
- TxToken = (UDP_TX_TOKEN *) Context;
- ASSERT (TxToken->Signature == UDP_IO_TX_SIGNATURE);
- ASSERT ((TxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (TxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- RemoveEntryList (&TxToken->Link);
-
- if (TxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- TxToken->CallBack (TxToken->Packet, NULL, TxToken->Token.Udp4.Status, TxToken->Context);
- } else {
- TxToken->CallBack (TxToken->Packet, NULL, TxToken->Token.Udp6.Status, TxToken->Context);
- }
-
- UdpIoFreeTxToken (TxToken);
-}
-
-/**
- Request UdpIoOnDgramSentDpc as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK.
-
- @param[in] Event The event signaled.
- @param[in] Context The UDP TX Token.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoOnDgramSent (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- //
- // Request UdpIoOnDgramSentDpc as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK
- //
- QueueDpc (TPL_CALLBACK, UdpIoOnDgramSentDpc, Context);
-}
-
-/**
- Recycle the received UDP data.
-
- @param[in] Context The UDP_RX_TOKEN.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoRecycleDgram (
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- UDP_RX_TOKEN *RxToken;
-
- RxToken = (UDP_RX_TOKEN *) Context;
-
- if (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- gBS->SignalEvent (RxToken->Token.Udp4.Packet.RxData->RecycleSignal);
- } else if (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION) {
- gBS->SignalEvent (RxToken->Token.Udp6.Packet.RxData->RecycleSignal);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- UdpIoFreeRxToken (RxToken);
-}
-
-/**
- The event handle for UDP receive request.
-
- It will build a NET_BUF from the recieved UDP data, then deliver it
- to the receiver.
-
- @param[in] Context The UDP RX token.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoOnDgramRcvdDpc (
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VOID *Token;
- VOID *RxData;
- VOID *Session;
- UDP_RX_TOKEN *RxToken;
- UDP_END_POINT EndPoint;
- NET_BUF *Netbuf;
-
- RxToken = (UDP_RX_TOKEN *) Context;
-
- ZeroMem (&EndPoint, sizeof(UDP_END_POINT));
-
- ASSERT ((RxToken->Signature == UDP_IO_RX_SIGNATURE) &&
- (RxToken == RxToken->UdpIo->RecvRequest));
-
- ASSERT ((RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- //
- // Clear the receive request first in case that the caller
- // wants to restart the receive in the callback.
- //
- RxToken->UdpIo->RecvRequest = NULL;
-
- if (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- Token = &RxToken->Token.Udp4;
- RxData = ((EFI_UDP4_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Packet.RxData;
- Status = ((EFI_UDP4_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Status;
- } else {
- Token = &RxToken->Token.Udp6;
- RxData = ((EFI_UDP6_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Packet.RxData;
- Status = ((EFI_UDP6_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Status;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || RxData == NULL) {
- if (Status != EFI_ABORTED) {
- //
- // Invoke the CallBack only if the reception is not actively aborted.
- //
- RxToken->CallBack (NULL, NULL, Status, RxToken->Context);
- }
-
- UdpIoFreeRxToken (RxToken);
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Build a NET_BUF from the UDP receive data, then deliver it up.
- //
- if (RxToken->UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
-
- Netbuf = NetbufFromExt (
- (NET_FRAGMENT *)((EFI_UDP4_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->FragmentTable,
- ((EFI_UDP4_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->FragmentCount,
- 0,
- (UINT32) RxToken->HeadLen,
- UdpIoRecycleDgram,
- RxToken
- );
-
- if (Netbuf == NULL) {
- gBS->SignalEvent (((EFI_UDP4_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->RecycleSignal);
- RxToken->CallBack (NULL, NULL, EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES, RxToken->Context);
-
- UdpIoFreeRxToken (RxToken);
- return;
- }
-
- Session = &((EFI_UDP4_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->UdpSession;
- EndPoint.LocalPort = ((EFI_UDP4_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->DestinationPort;
- EndPoint.RemotePort = ((EFI_UDP4_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->SourcePort;
-
- CopyMem (
- &EndPoint.LocalAddr,
- &((EFI_UDP4_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->DestinationAddress,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- CopyMem (
- &EndPoint.RemoteAddr,
- &((EFI_UDP4_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->SourceAddress,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- EndPoint.LocalAddr.Addr[0] = NTOHL (EndPoint.LocalAddr.Addr[0]);
- EndPoint.RemoteAddr.Addr[0] = NTOHL (EndPoint.RemoteAddr.Addr[0]);
- } else {
-
- Netbuf = NetbufFromExt (
- (NET_FRAGMENT *)((EFI_UDP6_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->FragmentTable,
- ((EFI_UDP6_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->FragmentCount,
- 0,
- (UINT32) RxToken->HeadLen,
- UdpIoRecycleDgram,
- RxToken
- );
-
- if (Netbuf == NULL) {
- gBS->SignalEvent (((EFI_UDP6_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->RecycleSignal);
- RxToken->CallBack (NULL, NULL, EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES, RxToken->Context);
-
- UdpIoFreeRxToken (RxToken);
- return;
- }
-
- Session = &((EFI_UDP6_RECEIVE_DATA *) RxData)->UdpSession;
- EndPoint.LocalPort = ((EFI_UDP6_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->DestinationPort;
- EndPoint.RemotePort = ((EFI_UDP6_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->SourcePort;
-
- CopyMem (
- &EndPoint.LocalAddr,
- &((EFI_UDP6_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->DestinationAddress,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- CopyMem (
- &EndPoint.RemoteAddr,
- &((EFI_UDP6_SESSION_DATA *) Session)->SourceAddress,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- Ip6Swap128 (&EndPoint.LocalAddr.v6);
- Ip6Swap128 (&EndPoint.RemoteAddr.v6);
- }
-
- RxToken->CallBack (Netbuf, &EndPoint, EFI_SUCCESS, RxToken->Context);
-}
-
-/**
- Request UdpIoOnDgramRcvdDpc() as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK.
-
- @param[in] Event The UDP receive request event.
- @param[in] Context The UDP RX token.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoOnDgramRcvd (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- //
- // Request UdpIoOnDgramRcvdDpc as a DPC at TPL_CALLBACK
- //
- QueueDpc (TPL_CALLBACK, UdpIoOnDgramRcvdDpc, Context);
-}
-
-/**
- Create a UDP_RX_TOKEN to wrap the request.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UdpIo to receive packets from.
- @param[in] CallBack The function to call when receive finished.
- @param[in] Context The opaque parameter to the CallBack.
- @param[in] HeadLen The head length to reserver for the packet.
-
- @return The Wrapped request or NULL if failed to allocate resources or some errors happened.
-
-**/
-UDP_RX_TOKEN *
-UdpIoCreateRxToken (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo,
- IN UDP_IO_CALLBACK CallBack,
- IN VOID *Context,
- IN UINT32 HeadLen
- )
-{
- UDP_RX_TOKEN *Token;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- Token = AllocatePool (sizeof (UDP_RX_TOKEN));
-
- if (Token == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Token->Signature = UDP_IO_RX_SIGNATURE;
- Token->UdpIo = UdpIo;
- Token->CallBack = CallBack;
- Token->Context = Context;
- Token->HeadLen = HeadLen;
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
-
- Token->Token.Udp4.Status = EFI_NOT_READY;
- Token->Token.Udp4.Packet.RxData = NULL;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- UdpIoOnDgramRcvd,
- Token,
- &Token->Token.Udp4.Event
- );
- } else {
-
- Token->Token.Udp6.Status = EFI_NOT_READY;
- Token->Token.Udp6.Packet.RxData = NULL;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- UdpIoOnDgramRcvd,
- Token,
- &Token->Token.Udp6.Event
- );
- }
-
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (Token);
- return NULL;
- }
-
- return Token;
-}
-
-/**
- Wrap a transmit request into a new created UDP_TX_TOKEN.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UdpIo to send packet to.
- @param[in] Packet The user's packet.
- @param[in] EndPoint The local and remote access point.
- @param[in] Gateway The overrided next hop.
- @param[in] CallBack The function to call when transmission completed.
- @param[in] Context The opaque parameter to the call back.
-
- @return The wrapped transmission request or NULL if failed to allocate resources
- or for some errors.
-
-**/
-UDP_TX_TOKEN *
-UdpIoCreateTxToken (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo,
- IN NET_BUF *Packet,
- IN UDP_END_POINT *EndPoint OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_IP_ADDRESS *Gateway OPTIONAL,
- IN UDP_IO_CALLBACK CallBack,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- UDP_TX_TOKEN *TxToken;
- VOID *Token;
- VOID *Data;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 Count;
- UINTN Size;
- IP4_ADDR Ip;
-
- ASSERT (Packet != NULL);
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- Size = sizeof (UDP_TX_TOKEN) + sizeof (EFI_UDP4_FRAGMENT_DATA) * (Packet->BlockOpNum - 1);
- } else {
- Size = sizeof (UDP_TX_TOKEN) + sizeof (EFI_UDP6_FRAGMENT_DATA) * (Packet->BlockOpNum - 1);
- }
-
- TxToken = AllocatePool (Size);
-
- if (TxToken == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- TxToken->Signature = UDP_IO_TX_SIGNATURE;
- InitializeListHead (&TxToken->Link);
-
- TxToken->UdpIo = UdpIo;
- TxToken->CallBack = CallBack;
- TxToken->Packet = Packet;
- TxToken->Context = Context;
-
- Token = &(TxToken->Token);
- Count = Packet->BlockOpNum;
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
-
- ((EFI_UDP4_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Status = EFI_NOT_READY;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- UdpIoOnDgramSent,
- TxToken,
- &((EFI_UDP4_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Event
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (TxToken);
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Data = &(TxToken->Data.Udp4);
- ((EFI_UDP4_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Packet.TxData = Data;
-
- ((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->UdpSessionData = NULL;
- ((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->GatewayAddress = NULL;
- ((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->DataLength = Packet->TotalSize;
-
- NetbufBuildExt (
- Packet,
- (NET_FRAGMENT *)((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentTable,
- &Count
- );
-
- ((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentCount = Count;
-
- if (EndPoint != NULL) {
- Ip = HTONL (EndPoint->LocalAddr.Addr[0]);
- CopyMem (
- &TxToken->Session.Udp4.SourceAddress,
- &Ip,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- Ip = HTONL (EndPoint->RemoteAddr.Addr[0]);
- CopyMem (
- &TxToken->Session.Udp4.DestinationAddress,
- &Ip,
- sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- TxToken->Session.Udp4.SourcePort = EndPoint->LocalPort;
- TxToken->Session.Udp4.DestinationPort = EndPoint->RemotePort;
- ((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->UdpSessionData = &(TxToken->Session.Udp4);
- }
-
- if (Gateway != NULL && (Gateway->Addr[0] != 0)) {
- Ip = HTONL (Gateway->Addr[0]);
- CopyMem (&TxToken->Gateway, &Ip, sizeof (EFI_IPv4_ADDRESS));
- ((EFI_UDP4_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->GatewayAddress = &TxToken->Gateway;
- }
-
- } else {
-
- ((EFI_UDP6_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Status = EFI_NOT_READY;
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- UdpIoOnDgramSent,
- TxToken,
- &((EFI_UDP6_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Event
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (TxToken);
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Data = &(TxToken->Data.Udp6);
- ((EFI_UDP6_COMPLETION_TOKEN *) Token)->Packet.TxData = Data;
- ((EFI_UDP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->UdpSessionData = NULL;
- ((EFI_UDP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->DataLength = Packet->TotalSize;
-
- NetbufBuildExt (
- Packet,
- (NET_FRAGMENT *)((EFI_UDP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentTable,
- &Count
- );
-
- ((EFI_UDP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->FragmentCount = Count;
-
- if (EndPoint != NULL) {
- CopyMem (
- &TxToken->Session.Udp6.SourceAddress,
- &EndPoint->LocalAddr.v6,
- sizeof(EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- CopyMem (
- &TxToken->Session.Udp6.DestinationAddress,
- &EndPoint->RemoteAddr.v6,
- sizeof(EFI_IPv6_ADDRESS)
- );
-
- TxToken->Session.Udp6.SourcePort = EndPoint->LocalPort;
- TxToken->Session.Udp6.DestinationPort = EndPoint->RemotePort;
- ((EFI_UDP6_TRANSMIT_DATA *) Data)->UdpSessionData = &(TxToken->Session.Udp6);
- }
- }
-
- return TxToken;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a UDP_IO to access the UDP service. It creates and configures
- a UDP child.
-
- It locates the UDP service binding prototype on the Controller parameter
- uses the UDP service binding prototype to create a UDP child (also known as
- a UDP instance) configures the UDP child by calling Configure function prototype.
- Any failures in creating or configuring the UDP child return NULL for failure.
-
- @param[in] Controller The controller that has the UDP service binding.
- protocol installed.
- @param[in] ImageHandle The image handle for the driver.
- @param[in] Configure The function to configure the created UDP child.
- @param[in] UdpVersion The UDP protocol version, UDP4 or UDP6.
- @param[in] Context The opaque parameter for the Configure funtion.
-
- @return Newly-created UDP_IO or NULL if failed.
-
-**/
-UDP_IO *
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoCreateIo (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Controller,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN UDP_IO_CONFIG Configure,
- IN UINT8 UdpVersion,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- UDP_IO *UdpIo;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (Configure != NULL);
- ASSERT ((UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) || (UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- UdpIo = AllocatePool (sizeof (UDP_IO));
-
- if (UdpIo == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- UdpIo->UdpVersion = UdpVersion;
- UdpIo->Signature = UDP_IO_SIGNATURE;
- InitializeListHead (&UdpIo->Link);
- UdpIo->RefCnt = 1;
-
- UdpIo->Controller = Controller;
- UdpIo->Image = ImageHandle;
-
- InitializeListHead (&UdpIo->SentDatagram);
- UdpIo->RecvRequest = NULL;
- UdpIo->UdpHandle = NULL;
-
- if (UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- //
- // Create a UDP child then open and configure it
- //
- Status = NetLibCreateServiceChild (
- Controller,
- ImageHandle,
- &gEfiUdp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- &UdpIo->UdpHandle
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto FREE_MEM;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- UdpIo->UdpHandle,
- &gEfiUdp4ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4,
- ImageHandle,
- Controller,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_DRIVER
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto FREE_CHILD;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Configure (UdpIo, Context))) {
- goto CLOSE_PROTOCOL;
- }
-
- Status = UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->GetModeData (
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &UdpIo->SnpMode
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto CLOSE_PROTOCOL;
- }
-
- } else {
-
- Status = NetLibCreateServiceChild (
- Controller,
- ImageHandle,
- &gEfiUdp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- &UdpIo->UdpHandle
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto FREE_MEM;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- UdpIo->UdpHandle,
- &gEfiUdp6ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6,
- ImageHandle,
- Controller,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_DRIVER
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto FREE_CHILD;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Configure (UdpIo, Context))) {
- goto CLOSE_PROTOCOL;
- }
-
- Status = UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->GetModeData (
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &UdpIo->SnpMode
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto CLOSE_PROTOCOL;
- }
- }
-
- return UdpIo;
-
-CLOSE_PROTOCOL:
- if (UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- gBS->CloseProtocol (UdpIo->UdpHandle, &gEfiUdp4ProtocolGuid, ImageHandle, Controller);
- } else {
- gBS->CloseProtocol (UdpIo->UdpHandle, &gEfiUdp6ProtocolGuid, ImageHandle, Controller);
- }
-
-FREE_CHILD:
- if (UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- Controller,
- ImageHandle,
- &gEfiUdp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- UdpIo->UdpHandle
- );
- } else {
- NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- Controller,
- ImageHandle,
- &gEfiUdp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- UdpIo->UdpHandle
- );
- }
-
-FREE_MEM:
- FreePool (UdpIo);
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Cancel all the sent datagram that pass the selection criteria of ToCancel.
- If ToCancel is NULL, all the datagrams are cancelled.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UDP_IO to cancel packet.
- @param[in] IoStatus The IoStatus to return to the packet owners.
- @param[in] ToCancel The select funtion to test whether to cancel this
- packet or not.
- @param[in] Context The opaque parameter to the ToCancel.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoCancelDgrams (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo,
- IN EFI_STATUS IoStatus,
- IN UDP_IO_TO_CANCEL ToCancel, OPTIONAL
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Entry;
- LIST_ENTRY *Next;
- UDP_TX_TOKEN *TxToken;
-
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- NET_LIST_FOR_EACH_SAFE (Entry, Next, &UdpIo->SentDatagram) {
- TxToken = NET_LIST_USER_STRUCT (Entry, UDP_TX_TOKEN, Link);
-
- if ((ToCancel == NULL) || (ToCancel (TxToken, Context))) {
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->Cancel (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4, &TxToken->Token.Udp4);
- } else {
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->Cancel (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6, &TxToken->Token.Udp6);
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Free the UDP_IO and all its related resources.
-
- The function will cancel all sent datagram and receive request.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UDP_IO to free.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The UDP_IO is freed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoFreeIo (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo
- )
-{
- UDP_RX_TOKEN *RxToken;
-
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- //
- // Cancel all the sent datagram and receive requests. The
- // callbacks of transmit requests are executed to allow the
- // caller to release the resource. The callback of receive
- // request are NOT executed. This is because it is most
- // likely that the current user of the UDP IO port is closing
- // itself.
- //
- UdpIoCancelDgrams (UdpIo, EFI_ABORTED, NULL, NULL);
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
-
- if ((RxToken = UdpIo->RecvRequest) != NULL) {
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->Cancel (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4, &RxToken->Token.Udp4);
- }
-
- //
- // Close then destroy the Udp4 child
- //
- gBS->CloseProtocol (
- UdpIo->UdpHandle,
- &gEfiUdp4ProtocolGuid,
- UdpIo->Image,
- UdpIo->Controller
- );
-
- NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- UdpIo->Controller,
- UdpIo->Image,
- &gEfiUdp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- UdpIo->UdpHandle
- );
-
- } else {
-
- if ((RxToken = UdpIo->RecvRequest) != NULL) {
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->Cancel (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6, &RxToken->Token.Udp6);
- }
-
- //
- // Close then destroy the Udp6 child
- //
- gBS->CloseProtocol (
- UdpIo->UdpHandle,
- &gEfiUdp6ProtocolGuid,
- UdpIo->Image,
- UdpIo->Controller
- );
-
- NetLibDestroyServiceChild (
- UdpIo->Controller,
- UdpIo->Image,
- &gEfiUdp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid,
- UdpIo->UdpHandle
- );
- }
-
- if (!IsListEmpty(&UdpIo->Link)) {
- RemoveEntryList (&UdpIo->Link);
- }
-
- FreePool (UdpIo);
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Clean up the UDP_IO without freeing it. The function is called when
- user wants to re-use the UDP_IO later.
-
- It will release all the transmitted datagrams and receive request. It will
- also configure NULL for the UDP instance.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UDP_IO to clean up.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoCleanIo (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo
- )
-{
- UDP_RX_TOKEN *RxToken;
-
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- //
- // Cancel all the sent datagram and receive requests.
- //
- UdpIoCancelDgrams (UdpIo, EFI_ABORTED, NULL, NULL);
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- if ((RxToken = UdpIo->RecvRequest) != NULL) {
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->Cancel (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4, &RxToken->Token.Udp4);
- }
-
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->Configure (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4, NULL);
-
- } else {
- if ((RxToken = UdpIo->RecvRequest) != NULL) {
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->Cancel (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6, &RxToken->Token.Udp6);
- }
-
- UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->Configure (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6, NULL);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Send a packet through the UDP_IO.
-
- The packet will be wrapped in UDP_TX_TOKEN. Function Callback will be called
- when the packet is sent. The optional parameter EndPoint overrides the default
- address pair if specified.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UDP_IO to send the packet through.
- @param[in] Packet The packet to send.
- @param[in] EndPoint The local and remote access point. Override the
- default address pair set during configuration.
- @param[in] Gateway The gateway to use.
- @param[in] CallBack The function being called when packet is
- transmitted or failed.
- @param[in] Context The opaque parameter passed to CallBack.
-
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate resource for the packet.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The packet is successfully delivered to UDP for
- transmission.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoSendDatagram (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo,
- IN NET_BUF *Packet,
- IN UDP_END_POINT *EndPoint OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_IP_ADDRESS *Gateway OPTIONAL,
- IN UDP_IO_CALLBACK CallBack,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- UDP_TX_TOKEN *TxToken;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- TxToken = UdpIoCreateTxToken (UdpIo, Packet, EndPoint, Gateway, CallBack, Context);
-
- if (TxToken == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Insert the tx token into SendDatagram list before transmitting it. Remove
- // it from the list if the returned status is not EFI_SUCCESS.
- //
- InsertHeadList (&UdpIo->SentDatagram, &TxToken->Link);
-
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- Status = UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->Transmit (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4, &TxToken->Token.Udp4);
- } else {
- Status = UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->Transmit (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6, &TxToken->Token.Udp6);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- RemoveEntryList (&TxToken->Link);
- UdpIoFreeTxToken (TxToken);
- return Status;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- The select function to cancel a single sent datagram.
-
- @param[in] Token The UDP_TX_TOKEN to test against
- @param[in] Context The NET_BUF of the sent datagram
-
- @retval TRUE The packet is to be cancelled.
- @retval FALSE The packet is not to be cancelled.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoCancelSingleDgram (
- IN UDP_TX_TOKEN *Token,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- NET_BUF *Packet;
-
- Packet = (NET_BUF *) Context;
-
- if (Token->Packet == Packet) {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Cancel a single sent datagram.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UDP_IO to cancel the packet from
- @param[in] Packet The packet to cancel
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoCancelSentDatagram (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo,
- IN NET_BUF *Packet
- )
-{
- UdpIoCancelDgrams (UdpIo, EFI_ABORTED, UdpIoCancelSingleDgram, Packet);
-}
-
-/**
- Issue a receive request to the UDP_IO.
-
- This function is called when upper-layer needs packet from UDP for processing.
- Only one receive request is acceptable at a time so a common usage model is
- to invoke this function inside its Callback function when the former packet
- is processed.
-
- @param[in] UdpIo The UDP_IO to receive the packet from.
- @param[in] CallBack The call back function to execute when the packet
- is received.
- @param[in] Context The opaque context passed to Callback.
- @param[in] HeadLen The length of the upper-layer's protocol header.
-
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED There is already a pending receive request. Only
- one receive request is supported at a time.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Failed to allocate needed resources.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The receive request is issued successfully.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The UDP version in UDP_IO is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UdpIoRecvDatagram (
- IN UDP_IO *UdpIo,
- IN UDP_IO_CALLBACK CallBack,
- IN VOID *Context,
- IN UINT32 HeadLen
- )
-{
- UDP_RX_TOKEN *RxToken;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT ((UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) ||
- (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP6_VERSION));
-
- if (UdpIo->RecvRequest != NULL) {
- return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
- }
-
- RxToken = UdpIoCreateRxToken (UdpIo, CallBack, Context, HeadLen);
-
- if (RxToken == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- UdpIo->RecvRequest = RxToken;
- if (UdpIo->UdpVersion == UDP_IO_UDP4_VERSION) {
- Status = UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4->Receive (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp4, &RxToken->Token.Udp4);
- } else {
- Status = UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6->Receive (UdpIo->Protocol.Udp6, &RxToken->Token.Udp6);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- UdpIo->RecvRequest = NULL;
- UdpIoFreeRxToken (RxToken);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUdpIoLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUdpIoLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index a9683c9a74..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUdpIoLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,53 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# This library instance provides UDP services by consuming EFI UDPv4/UDPv6 Protocols.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2008 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeUpdIoLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeUpdIoLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 7E615AA1-41EE-49d4-B7E9-1D7A60AA5C8D
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = UdpIoLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DxeUdpIoLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- UdpIoLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DpcLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiUdp4ServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiUdp4ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiUdp6ServiceBindingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiUdp6ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUpdIoLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUpdIoLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 0e96b4b76b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/DxeUdpIoLib/DxeUpdIoLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 5d7b52c06e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,139 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
-Copyright (c) 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-/**
- This function will save confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the confidential information
- @param Length the length of the confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0
- @retval RETURN_ALREADY_STARTED the requested GUID already exist.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES no enough resource to save the information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SaveLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will set lockbox attributes.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Attributes the attributes of the lockbox
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER attributes is invalid.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetLockBoxAttributes (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINT64 Attributes
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will update confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the original confidential information
- @param Offset the offset of the original confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the updated confidential information
- @param Length the length of the updated confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the original buffer to too small to hold new information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UpdateLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINTN Offset,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the restored confidential information
- NULL means restored to original address, Length MUST be NULL at same time.
- @param Length the length of the restored confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or one of Buffer and Length is NULL.
- @retval RETURN_WRITE_PROTECTED Buffer and Length are NULL, but the LockBox has no
- LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE attribute.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the Length is too small to hold the confidential information.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED not allow to restore to the address
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer, OPTIONAL
- IN OUT UINTN *Length OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from all lockbox which have RestoreInPlace attribute.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 1018a69e81..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,39 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# NULL LockBox library instance.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = LockBoxNullLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = LockBoxNullLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 0BA38EBD-E190-4df7-8EC4-0A6E2B43772D
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = LockBoxLib|PEIM DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER UEFI_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION DXE_SMM_DRIVER
-
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- LockBoxNullLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 5466eb1b67..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LockBoxNullLib/LockBoxNullLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/F86GuidedSectionExtraction.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/F86GuidedSectionExtraction.c deleted file mode 100644 index ada9a809fa..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/F86GuidedSectionExtraction.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,218 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LZMA Decompress GUIDed Section Extraction Library, which produces LZMA custom
- decompression algorithm with the converter for the different arch code.
- It wraps Lzma decompress interfaces to GUIDed Section Extraction interfaces
- and registers them into GUIDed handler table.
-
- Copyright (c) 2012, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h"
-#include "Sdk/C/Bra.h"
-
-/**
- Examines a GUIDed section and returns the size of the decoded buffer and the
- size of an scratch buffer required to actually decode the data in a GUIDed section.
-
- Examines a GUIDed section specified by InputSection.
- If GUID for InputSection does not match the GUID that this handler supports,
- then RETURN_UNSUPPORTED is returned.
- If the required information can not be retrieved from InputSection,
- then RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
- If the GUID of InputSection does match the GUID that this handler supports,
- then the size required to hold the decoded buffer is returned in OututBufferSize,
- the size of an optional scratch buffer is returned in ScratchSize, and the Attributes field
- from EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION header of InputSection is returned in SectionAttribute.
-
- If InputSection is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If OutputBufferSize is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ScratchBufferSize is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If SectionAttribute is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
-
- @param[in] InputSection A pointer to a GUIDed section of an FFS formatted file.
- @param[out] OutputBufferSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, of an output buffer required
- if the buffer specified by InputSection were decoded.
- @param[out] ScratchBufferSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, required as scratch space
- if the buffer specified by InputSection were decoded.
- @param[out] SectionAttribute A pointer to the attributes of the GUIDed section. See the Attributes
- field of EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION in the PI Specification.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The information about InputSection was returned.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The section specified by InputSection does not match the GUID this handler supports.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER The information can not be retrieved from the section specified by InputSection.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaArchGuidedSectionGetInfo (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT UINT32 *OutputBufferSize,
- OUT UINT32 *ScratchBufferSize,
- OUT UINT16 *SectionAttribute
- )
-{
- ASSERT (InputSection != NULL);
- ASSERT (OutputBufferSize != NULL);
- ASSERT (ScratchBufferSize != NULL);
- ASSERT (SectionAttribute != NULL);
-
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gLzmaF86CustomDecompressGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->Attributes;
-
- return LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- OutputBufferSize,
- ScratchBufferSize
- );
- } else {
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gLzmaF86CustomDecompressGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->Attributes;
-
- return LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- OutputBufferSize,
- ScratchBufferSize
- );
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Decompress a LZAM compressed GUIDed section into a caller allocated output buffer.
-
- Decodes the GUIDed section specified by InputSection.
- If GUID for InputSection does not match the GUID that this handler supports, then RETURN_UNSUPPORTED is returned.
- If the data in InputSection can not be decoded, then RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
- If the GUID of InputSection does match the GUID that this handler supports, then InputSection
- is decoded into the buffer specified by OutputBuffer and the authentication status of this
- decode operation is returned in AuthenticationStatus. If the decoded buffer is identical to the
- data in InputSection, then OutputBuffer is set to point at the data in InputSection. Otherwise,
- the decoded data will be placed in caller allocated buffer specified by OutputBuffer.
-
- If InputSection is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If OutputBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ScratchBuffer is NULL and this decode operation requires a scratch buffer, then ASSERT().
- If AuthenticationStatus is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
-
- @param[in] InputSection A pointer to a GUIDed section of an FFS formatted file.
- @param[out] OutputBuffer A pointer to a buffer that contains the result of a decode operation.
- @param[out] ScratchBuffer A caller allocated buffer that may be required by this function
- as a scratch buffer to perform the decode operation.
- @param[out] AuthenticationStatus
- A pointer to the authentication status of the decoded output buffer.
- See the definition of authentication status in the EFI_PEI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PPI
- section of the PI Specification. EFI_AUTH_STATUS_PLATFORM_OVERRIDE must
- never be set by this handler.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The buffer specified by InputSection was decoded.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The section specified by InputSection does not match the GUID this handler supports.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER The section specified by InputSection can not be decoded.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaArchGuidedSectionExtraction (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT VOID **OutputBuffer,
- OUT VOID *ScratchBuffer, OPTIONAL
- OUT UINT32 *AuthenticationStatus
- )
-{
- EFI_GUID *InputGuid;
- VOID *Source;
- UINTN SourceSize;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 X86State;
- UINT32 OutputBufferSize;
- UINT32 ScratchBufferSize;
-
- ASSERT (OutputBuffer != NULL);
- ASSERT (InputSection != NULL);
-
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- InputGuid = &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid);
- Source = (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- SourceSize = SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- } else {
- InputGuid = &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid);
- Source = (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- SourceSize = SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- }
-
- if (!CompareGuid (&gLzmaF86CustomDecompressGuid, InputGuid)) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Authentication is set to Zero, which may be ignored.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus = 0;
-
- Status = LzmaUefiDecompress (
- Source,
- SourceSize,
- *OutputBuffer,
- ScratchBuffer
- );
-
- //
- // After decompress, the data need to be converted to the raw data.
- //
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- Source,
- (UINT32) SourceSize,
- &OutputBufferSize,
- &ScratchBufferSize
- );
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- x86_Convert_Init(X86State);
- x86_Convert(*OutputBuffer, OutputBufferSize, 0, &X86State, 0);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Register LzmaArchDecompress and LzmaArchDecompressGetInfo handlers with LzmaF86CustomDecompressGuid.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Register successfully.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory to store this handler.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaArchDecompressLibConstructor (
- )
-{
- return ExtractGuidedSectionRegisterHandlers (
- &gLzmaF86CustomDecompressGuid,
- LzmaArchGuidedSectionGetInfo,
- LzmaArchGuidedSectionExtraction
- );
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/GuidedSectionExtraction.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/GuidedSectionExtraction.c deleted file mode 100644 index f19e0d28cd..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/GuidedSectionExtraction.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,201 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LZMA Decompress GUIDed Section Extraction Library.
- It wraps Lzma decompress interfaces to GUIDed Section Extraction interfaces
- and registers them into GUIDed handler table.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h"
-
-/**
- Examines a GUIDed section and returns the size of the decoded buffer and the
- size of an scratch buffer required to actually decode the data in a GUIDed section.
-
- Examines a GUIDed section specified by InputSection.
- If GUID for InputSection does not match the GUID that this handler supports,
- then RETURN_UNSUPPORTED is returned.
- If the required information can not be retrieved from InputSection,
- then RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
- If the GUID of InputSection does match the GUID that this handler supports,
- then the size required to hold the decoded buffer is returned in OututBufferSize,
- the size of an optional scratch buffer is returned in ScratchSize, and the Attributes field
- from EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION header of InputSection is returned in SectionAttribute.
-
- If InputSection is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If OutputBufferSize is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ScratchBufferSize is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If SectionAttribute is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
-
- @param[in] InputSection A pointer to a GUIDed section of an FFS formatted file.
- @param[out] OutputBufferSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, of an output buffer required
- if the buffer specified by InputSection were decoded.
- @param[out] ScratchBufferSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, required as scratch space
- if the buffer specified by InputSection were decoded.
- @param[out] SectionAttribute A pointer to the attributes of the GUIDed section. See the Attributes
- field of EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION in the PI Specification.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The information about InputSection was returned.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The section specified by InputSection does not match the GUID this handler supports.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER The information can not be retrieved from the section specified by InputSection.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaGuidedSectionGetInfo (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT UINT32 *OutputBufferSize,
- OUT UINT32 *ScratchBufferSize,
- OUT UINT16 *SectionAttribute
- )
-{
- ASSERT (InputSection != NULL);
- ASSERT (OutputBufferSize != NULL);
- ASSERT (ScratchBufferSize != NULL);
- ASSERT (SectionAttribute != NULL);
-
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gLzmaCustomDecompressGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->Attributes;
-
- return LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- OutputBufferSize,
- ScratchBufferSize
- );
- } else {
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gLzmaCustomDecompressGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->Attributes;
-
- return LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- OutputBufferSize,
- ScratchBufferSize
- );
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Decompress a LZAM compressed GUIDed section into a caller allocated output buffer.
-
- Decodes the GUIDed section specified by InputSection.
- If GUID for InputSection does not match the GUID that this handler supports, then RETURN_UNSUPPORTED is returned.
- If the data in InputSection can not be decoded, then RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
- If the GUID of InputSection does match the GUID that this handler supports, then InputSection
- is decoded into the buffer specified by OutputBuffer and the authentication status of this
- decode operation is returned in AuthenticationStatus. If the decoded buffer is identical to the
- data in InputSection, then OutputBuffer is set to point at the data in InputSection. Otherwise,
- the decoded data will be placed in caller allocated buffer specified by OutputBuffer.
-
- If InputSection is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If OutputBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ScratchBuffer is NULL and this decode operation requires a scratch buffer, then ASSERT().
- If AuthenticationStatus is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
-
- @param[in] InputSection A pointer to a GUIDed section of an FFS formatted file.
- @param[out] OutputBuffer A pointer to a buffer that contains the result of a decode operation.
- @param[out] ScratchBuffer A caller allocated buffer that may be required by this function
- as a scratch buffer to perform the decode operation.
- @param[out] AuthenticationStatus
- A pointer to the authentication status of the decoded output buffer.
- See the definition of authentication status in the EFI_PEI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PPI
- section of the PI Specification. EFI_AUTH_STATUS_PLATFORM_OVERRIDE must
- never be set by this handler.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The buffer specified by InputSection was decoded.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED The section specified by InputSection does not match the GUID this handler supports.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER The section specified by InputSection can not be decoded.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaGuidedSectionExtraction (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT VOID **OutputBuffer,
- OUT VOID *ScratchBuffer, OPTIONAL
- OUT UINT32 *AuthenticationStatus
- )
-{
- ASSERT (OutputBuffer != NULL);
- ASSERT (InputSection != NULL);
-
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gLzmaCustomDecompressGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Authentication is set to Zero, which may be ignored.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus = 0;
-
- return LzmaUefiDecompress (
- (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- *OutputBuffer,
- ScratchBuffer
- );
- } else {
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gLzmaCustomDecompressGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Authentication is set to Zero, which may be ignored.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus = 0;
-
- return LzmaUefiDecompress (
- (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset,
- *OutputBuffer,
- ScratchBuffer
- );
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Register LzmaDecompress and LzmaDecompressGetInfo handlers with LzmaCustomerDecompressGuid.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Register successfully.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory to store this handler.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaDecompressLibConstructor (
- )
-{
- return ExtractGuidedSectionRegisterHandlers (
- &gLzmaCustomDecompressGuid,
- LzmaGuidedSectionGetInfo,
- LzmaGuidedSectionExtraction
- );
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LZMA-SDK-README.txt b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LZMA-SDK-README.txt deleted file mode 100644 index e05b3bb853..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LZMA-SDK-README.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,4 +0,0 @@ -LzmaCustomDecompressLib is based on the LZMA SDK 4.65.
-LZMA SDK 4.65 was placed in the public domain on
-2009-02-03. It was released on the
-http://www.7-zip.org/sdk.html website.
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaArchCustomDecompressLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaArchCustomDecompressLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index ec7585d55b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaArchCustomDecompressLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,66 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# LzmaArchCustomDecompressLib produces LZMA custom decompression algorithm with the converter for the different arch code.
-#
-# It is based on the LZMA SDK 4.65.
-# LZMA SDK 4.65 was placed in the public domain on 2009-02-03.
-# It was released on the http://www.7-zip.org/sdk.html website.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2012 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = LzmaArchDecompressLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = LzmaArchDecompressLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = A853C1D2-E003-4cc4-9DD1-8824AD79FE48
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL
- CONSTRUCTOR = LzmaArchDecompressLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- LzmaDecompress.c
- Sdk/C/Bra.h
- Sdk/C/LzFind.c
- Sdk/C/LzmaDec.c
- Sdk/C/7zVersion.h
- Sdk/C/CpuArch.h
- Sdk/C/LzFind.h
- Sdk/C/LzHash.h
- Sdk/C/LzmaDec.h
- Sdk/C/Types.h
- UefiLzma.h
- LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h
-
-[Sources.Ia32, Sources.X64]
- Sdk/C/Bra86.c
- F86GuidedSectionExtraction.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[Guids.Ia32, Guids.X64]
- gLzmaF86CustomDecompressGuid ## PRODUCES ## GUID # specifies LZMA custom decompress algorithm with converter for x86 code.
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- ExtractGuidedSectionLib
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaArchDecompressLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaArchDecompressLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 1830dae73c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaArchDecompressLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaCustomDecompressLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaCustomDecompressLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index f5624fd039..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaCustomDecompressLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# LzmaCustomDecompressLib produces LZMA custom decompression algorithm.
-#
-# It is based on the LZMA SDK 4.65.
-# LZMA SDK 4.65 was placed in the public domain on 2009-02-03.
-# It was released on the http://www.7-zip.org/sdk.html website.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = LzmaDecompressLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = LzmaDecompressLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 35194660-7421-44ad-9636-e44885f092d1
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL
- CONSTRUCTOR = LzmaDecompressLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- LzmaDecompress.c
- Sdk/C/LzFind.c
- Sdk/C/LzmaDec.c
- Sdk/C/7zVersion.h
- Sdk/C/CpuArch.h
- Sdk/C/LzFind.h
- Sdk/C/LzHash.h
- Sdk/C/LzmaDec.h
- Sdk/C/Types.h
- GuidedSectionExtraction.c
- UefiLzma.h
- LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[Guids]
- gLzmaCustomDecompressGuid ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # specifies LZMA custom decompress algorithm.
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- ExtractGuidedSectionLib
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompress.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompress.c deleted file mode 100644 index e32b6a3025..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompress.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,220 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LZMA Decompress interfaces
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h"
-#include "Sdk/C/Types.h"
-#include "Sdk/C/7zVersion.h"
-#include "Sdk/C/LzmaDec.h"
-
-#define SCRATCH_BUFFER_REQUEST_SIZE SIZE_64KB
-
-typedef struct
-{
- ISzAlloc Functions;
- VOID *Buffer;
- UINTN BufferSize;
-} ISzAllocWithData;
-
-/**
- Allocation routine used by LZMA decompression.
-
- @param P Pointer to the ISzAlloc instance
- @param Size The size in bytes to be allocated
-
- @return The allocated pointer address, or NULL on failure
-**/
-VOID *
-SzAlloc (
- VOID *P,
- size_t Size
- )
-{
- VOID *Addr;
- ISzAllocWithData *Private;
-
- Private = (ISzAllocWithData*) P;
-
- if (Private->BufferSize >= Size) {
- Addr = Private->Buffer;
- Private->Buffer = (VOID*) ((UINT8*)Addr + Size);
- Private->BufferSize -= Size;
- return Addr;
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return NULL;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Free routine used by LZMA decompression.
-
- @param P Pointer to the ISzAlloc instance
- @param Address The address to be freed
-**/
-VOID
-SzFree (
- VOID *P,
- VOID *Address
- )
-{
- //
- // We use the 'scratch buffer' for allocations, so there is no free
- // operation required. The scratch buffer will be freed by the caller
- // of the decompression code.
- //
-}
-
-#define LZMA_HEADER_SIZE (LZMA_PROPS_SIZE + 8)
-
-/**
- Get the size of the uncompressed buffer by parsing EncodeData header.
-
- @param EncodedData Pointer to the compressed data.
-
- @return The size of the uncompressed buffer.
-**/
-UINT64
-GetDecodedSizeOfBuf(
- UINT8 *EncodedData
- )
-{
- UINT64 DecodedSize;
- INTN Index;
-
- /* Parse header */
- DecodedSize = 0;
- for (Index = LZMA_PROPS_SIZE + 7; Index >= LZMA_PROPS_SIZE; Index--)
- DecodedSize = LShiftU64(DecodedSize, 8) + EncodedData[Index];
-
- return DecodedSize;
-}
-
-//
-// LZMA functions and data as defined in local LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h
-//
-
-/**
- Given a Lzma compressed source buffer, this function retrieves the size of
- the uncompressed buffer and the size of the scratch buffer required
- to decompress the compressed source buffer.
-
- Retrieves the size of the uncompressed buffer and the temporary scratch buffer
- required to decompress the buffer specified by Source and SourceSize.
- The size of the uncompressed buffer is returned in DestinationSize,
- the size of the scratch buffer is returned in ScratchSize, and RETURN_SUCCESS is returned.
- This function does not have scratch buffer available to perform a thorough
- checking of the validity of the source data. It just retrieves the "Original Size"
- field from the LZMA_HEADER_SIZE beginning bytes of the source data and output it as DestinationSize.
- And ScratchSize is specific to the decompression implementation.
-
- If SourceSize is less than LZMA_HEADER_SIZE, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Source The source buffer containing the compressed data.
- @param SourceSize The size, in bytes, of the source buffer.
- @param DestinationSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, of the uncompressed buffer
- that will be generated when the compressed buffer specified
- by Source and SourceSize is decompressed.
- @param ScratchSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, of the scratch buffer that
- is required to decompress the compressed buffer specified
- by Source and SourceSize.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The size of the uncompressed data was returned
- in DestinationSize and the size of the scratch
- buffer was returned in ScratchSize.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- IN CONST VOID *Source,
- IN UINT32 SourceSize,
- OUT UINT32 *DestinationSize,
- OUT UINT32 *ScratchSize
- )
-{
- UInt64 DecodedSize;
-
- ASSERT(SourceSize >= LZMA_HEADER_SIZE);
-
- DecodedSize = GetDecodedSizeOfBuf((UINT8*)Source);
-
- *DestinationSize = (UINT32)DecodedSize;
- *ScratchSize = SCRATCH_BUFFER_REQUEST_SIZE;
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Decompresses a Lzma compressed source buffer.
-
- Extracts decompressed data to its original form.
- If the compressed source data specified by Source is successfully decompressed
- into Destination, then RETURN_SUCCESS is returned. If the compressed source data
- specified by Source is not in a valid compressed data format,
- then RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
-
- @param Source The source buffer containing the compressed data.
- @param SourceSize The size of source buffer.
- @param Destination The destination buffer to store the decompressed data
- @param Scratch A temporary scratch buffer that is used to perform the decompression.
- This is an optional parameter that may be NULL if the
- required scratch buffer size is 0.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Decompression completed successfully, and
- the uncompressed buffer is returned in Destination.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER
- The source buffer specified by Source is corrupted
- (not in a valid compressed format).
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaUefiDecompress (
- IN CONST VOID *Source,
- IN UINTN SourceSize,
- IN OUT VOID *Destination,
- IN OUT VOID *Scratch
- )
-{
- SRes LzmaResult;
- ELzmaStatus Status;
- SizeT DecodedBufSize;
- SizeT EncodedDataSize;
- ISzAllocWithData AllocFuncs;
-
- AllocFuncs.Functions.Alloc = SzAlloc;
- AllocFuncs.Functions.Free = SzFree;
- AllocFuncs.Buffer = Scratch;
- AllocFuncs.BufferSize = SCRATCH_BUFFER_REQUEST_SIZE;
-
- DecodedBufSize = (SizeT)GetDecodedSizeOfBuf((UINT8*)Source);
- EncodedDataSize = (SizeT) (SourceSize - LZMA_HEADER_SIZE);
-
- LzmaResult = LzmaDecode(
- Destination,
- &DecodedBufSize,
- (Byte*)((UINT8*)Source + LZMA_HEADER_SIZE),
- &EncodedDataSize,
- Source,
- LZMA_PROPS_SIZE,
- LZMA_FINISH_END,
- &Status,
- &(AllocFuncs.Functions)
- );
-
- if (LzmaResult == SZ_OK) {
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompressLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompressLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 498e4e1088..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompressLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h deleted file mode 100644 index 3096e91dbe..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/LzmaDecompressLibInternal.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,96 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LZMA Decompress Library internal header file declares Lzma decompress interfaces.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef __LZMADECOMPRESSLIB_INTERNAL_H__
-#define __LZMADECOMPRESSLIB_INTERNAL_H__
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/ExtractGuidedSectionLib.h>
-#include <Guid/LzmaDecompress.h>
-
-/**
- Given a Lzma compressed source buffer, this function retrieves the size of
- the uncompressed buffer and the size of the scratch buffer required
- to decompress the compressed source buffer.
-
- Retrieves the size of the uncompressed buffer and the temporary scratch buffer
- required to decompress the buffer specified by Source and SourceSize.
- The size of the uncompressed buffer is returned in DestinationSize,
- the size of the scratch buffer is returned in ScratchSize, and RETURN_SUCCESS is returned.
- This function does not have scratch buffer available to perform a thorough
- checking of the validity of the source data. It just retrieves the "Original Size"
- field from the LZMA_HEADER_SIZE beginning bytes of the source data and output it as DestinationSize.
- And ScratchSize is specific to the decompression implementation.
-
- If SourceSize is less than LZMA_HEADER_SIZE, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Source The source buffer containing the compressed data.
- @param SourceSize The size, in bytes, of the source buffer.
- @param DestinationSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, of the uncompressed buffer
- that will be generated when the compressed buffer specified
- by Source and SourceSize is decompressed.
- @param ScratchSize A pointer to the size, in bytes, of the scratch buffer that
- is required to decompress the compressed buffer specified
- by Source and SourceSize.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The size of the uncompressed data was returned
- in DestinationSize and the size of the scratch
- buffer was returned in ScratchSize.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaUefiDecompressGetInfo (
- IN CONST VOID *Source,
- IN UINT32 SourceSize,
- OUT UINT32 *DestinationSize,
- OUT UINT32 *ScratchSize
- );
-
-/**
- Decompresses a Lzma compressed source buffer.
-
- Extracts decompressed data to its original form.
- If the compressed source data specified by Source is successfully decompressed
- into Destination, then RETURN_SUCCESS is returned. If the compressed source data
- specified by Source is not in a valid compressed data format,
- then RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
-
- @param Source The source buffer containing the compressed data.
- @param SourceSize The size of source buffer.
- @param Destination The destination buffer to store the decompressed data
- @param Scratch A temporary scratch buffer that is used to perform the decompression.
- This is an optional parameter that may be NULL if the
- required scratch buffer size is 0.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Decompression completed successfully, and
- the uncompressed buffer is returned in Destination.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER
- The source buffer specified by Source is corrupted
- (not in a valid compressed format).
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-LzmaUefiDecompress (
- IN CONST VOID *Source,
- IN UINTN SourceSize,
- IN OUT VOID *Destination,
- IN OUT VOID *Scratch
- );
-
-#endif
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/7zVersion.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/7zVersion.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5a6bcadac6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/7zVersion.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,7 +0,0 @@ -#define MY_VER_MAJOR 4
-#define MY_VER_MINOR 65
-#define MY_VER_BUILD 0
-#define MY_VERSION "4.65"
-#define MY_DATE "2009-02-03"
-#define MY_COPYRIGHT ": Igor Pavlov : Public domain"
-#define MY_VERSION_COPYRIGHT_DATE MY_VERSION " " MY_COPYRIGHT " : " MY_DATE
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Bra.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Bra.h deleted file mode 100644 index b9018eb991..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Bra.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,60 +0,0 @@ -/* Bra.h -- Branch converters for executables
-2008-10-04 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain */
-
-#ifndef __BRA_H
-#define __BRA_H
-
-#include "Types.h"
-
-/*
-These functions convert relative addresses to absolute addresses
-in CALL instructions to increase the compression ratio.
-
- In:
- data - data buffer
- size - size of data
- ip - current virtual Instruction Pinter (IP) value
- state - state variable for x86 converter
- encoding - 0 (for decoding), 1 (for encoding)
-
- Out:
- state - state variable for x86 converter
-
- Returns:
- The number of processed bytes. If you call these functions with multiple calls,
- you must start next call with first byte after block of processed bytes.
-
- Type Endian Alignment LookAhead
-
- x86 little 1 4
- ARMT little 2 2
- ARM little 4 0
- PPC big 4 0
- SPARC big 4 0
- IA64 little 16 0
-
- size must be >= Alignment + LookAhead, if it's not last block.
- If (size < Alignment + LookAhead), converter returns 0.
-
- Example:
-
- UInt32 ip = 0;
- for ()
- {
- ; size must be >= Alignment + LookAhead, if it's not last block
- SizeT processed = Convert(data, size, ip, 1);
- data += processed;
- size -= processed;
- ip += processed;
- }
-*/
-
-#define x86_Convert_Init(state) { state = 0; }
-SizeT x86_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, UInt32 *state, int encoding);
-SizeT ARM_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, int encoding);
-SizeT ARMT_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, int encoding);
-SizeT PPC_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, int encoding);
-SizeT SPARC_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, int encoding);
-SizeT IA64_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, int encoding);
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Bra86.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Bra86.c deleted file mode 100644 index 93566cb212..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Bra86.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,85 +0,0 @@ -/* Bra86.c -- Converter for x86 code (BCJ)
-2008-10-04 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain */
-
-#include "Bra.h"
-
-#define Test86MSByte(b) ((b) == 0 || (b) == 0xFF)
-
-const Byte kMaskToAllowedStatus[8] = {1, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0};
-const Byte kMaskToBitNumber[8] = {0, 1, 2, 2, 3, 3, 3, 3};
-
-SizeT x86_Convert(Byte *data, SizeT size, UInt32 ip, UInt32 *state, int encoding)
-{
- SizeT bufferPos = 0, prevPosT;
- UInt32 prevMask = *state & 0x7;
- if (size < 5)
- return 0;
- ip += 5;
- prevPosT = (SizeT)0 - 1;
-
- for (;;)
- {
- Byte *p = data + bufferPos;
- Byte *limit = data + size - 4;
- for (; p < limit; p++)
- if ((*p & 0xFE) == 0xE8)
- break;
- bufferPos = (SizeT)(p - data);
- if (p >= limit)
- break;
- prevPosT = bufferPos - prevPosT;
- if (prevPosT > 3)
- prevMask = 0;
- else
- {
- prevMask = (prevMask << ((int)prevPosT - 1)) & 0x7;
- if (prevMask != 0)
- {
- Byte b = p[4 - kMaskToBitNumber[prevMask]];
- if (!kMaskToAllowedStatus[prevMask] || Test86MSByte(b))
- {
- prevPosT = bufferPos;
- prevMask = ((prevMask << 1) & 0x7) | 1;
- bufferPos++;
- continue;
- }
- }
- }
- prevPosT = bufferPos;
-
- if (Test86MSByte(p[4]))
- {
- UInt32 src = ((UInt32)p[4] << 24) | ((UInt32)p[3] << 16) | ((UInt32)p[2] << 8) | ((UInt32)p[1]);
- UInt32 dest;
- for (;;)
- {
- Byte b;
- int index;
- if (encoding)
- dest = (ip + (UInt32)bufferPos) + src;
- else
- dest = src - (ip + (UInt32)bufferPos);
- if (prevMask == 0)
- break;
- index = kMaskToBitNumber[prevMask] * 8;
- b = (Byte)(dest >> (24 - index));
- if (!Test86MSByte(b))
- break;
- src = dest ^ ((1 << (32 - index)) - 1);
- }
- p[4] = (Byte)(~(((dest >> 24) & 1) - 1));
- p[3] = (Byte)(dest >> 16);
- p[2] = (Byte)(dest >> 8);
- p[1] = (Byte)dest;
- bufferPos += 5;
- }
- else
- {
- prevMask = ((prevMask << 1) & 0x7) | 1;
- bufferPos++;
- }
- }
- prevPosT = bufferPos - prevPosT;
- *state = ((prevPosT > 3) ? 0 : ((prevMask << ((int)prevPosT - 1)) & 0x7));
- return bufferPos;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/CpuArch.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/CpuArch.h deleted file mode 100644 index 006361f2f2..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/CpuArch.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,69 +0,0 @@ -/* CpuArch.h
-2008-08-05
-Igor Pavlov
-Public domain */
-
-#ifndef __CPUARCH_H
-#define __CPUARCH_H
-
-/*
-LITTLE_ENDIAN_UNALIGN means:
- 1) CPU is LITTLE_ENDIAN
- 2) it's allowed to make unaligned memory accesses
-if LITTLE_ENDIAN_UNALIGN is not defined, it means that we don't know
-about these properties of platform.
-*/
-
-#if defined(_M_IX86) || defined(_M_X64) || defined(_M_AMD64) || defined(__i386__) || defined(__x86_64__)
-#define LITTLE_ENDIAN_UNALIGN
-#endif
-
-#ifdef LITTLE_ENDIAN_UNALIGN
-
-#define GetUi16(p) (*(const UInt16 *)(p))
-#define GetUi32(p) (*(const UInt32 *)(p))
-#define GetUi64(p) (*(const UInt64 *)(p))
-#define SetUi32(p, d) *(UInt32 *)(p) = (d);
-
-#else
-
-#define GetUi16(p) (((const Byte *)(p))[0] | ((UInt16)((const Byte *)(p))[1] << 8))
-
-#define GetUi32(p) ( \
- ((const Byte *)(p))[0] | \
- ((UInt32)((const Byte *)(p))[1] << 8) | \
- ((UInt32)((const Byte *)(p))[2] << 16) | \
- ((UInt32)((const Byte *)(p))[3] << 24))
-
-#define GetUi64(p) (GetUi32(p) | ((UInt64)GetUi32(((const Byte *)(p)) + 4) << 32))
-
-#define SetUi32(p, d) { UInt32 _x_ = (d); \
- ((Byte *)(p))[0] = (Byte)_x_; \
- ((Byte *)(p))[1] = (Byte)(_x_ >> 8); \
- ((Byte *)(p))[2] = (Byte)(_x_ >> 16); \
- ((Byte *)(p))[3] = (Byte)(_x_ >> 24); }
-
-#endif
-
-#if defined(LITTLE_ENDIAN_UNALIGN) && defined(_WIN64) && (_MSC_VER >= 1300)
-
-#pragma intrinsic(_byteswap_ulong)
-#pragma intrinsic(_byteswap_uint64)
-#define GetBe32(p) _byteswap_ulong(*(const UInt32 *)(const Byte *)(p))
-#define GetBe64(p) _byteswap_uint64(*(const UInt64 *)(const Byte *)(p))
-
-#else
-
-#define GetBe32(p) ( \
- ((UInt32)((const Byte *)(p))[0] << 24) | \
- ((UInt32)((const Byte *)(p))[1] << 16) | \
- ((UInt32)((const Byte *)(p))[2] << 8) | \
- ((const Byte *)(p))[3] )
-
-#define GetBe64(p) (((UInt64)GetBe32(p) << 32) | GetBe32(((const Byte *)(p)) + 4))
-
-#endif
-
-#define GetBe16(p) (((UInt16)((const Byte *)(p))[0] << 8) | ((const Byte *)(p))[1])
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzFind.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzFind.c deleted file mode 100644 index 492cea2e41..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzFind.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,770 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LzFind.c
-
- Based on LZMA SDK 4.65:
- LzFind.c -- Match finder for LZ algorithms
- 2008-10-04 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain
-
- Copyright (c) 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef EFIAPI
-
-#include <string.h>
-
-#endif // !EFIAPI
-
-#include "LzFind.h"
-#include "LzHash.h"
-
-#define kEmptyHashValue 0
-#define kMaxValForNormalize ((UInt32)0xFFFFFFFF)
-#define kNormalizeStepMin (1 << 10) /* it must be power of 2 */
-#define kNormalizeMask (~(kNormalizeStepMin - 1))
-#define kMaxHistorySize ((UInt32)3 << 30)
-
-#define kStartMaxLen 3
-
-static void LzInWindow_Free(CMatchFinder *p, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- if (!p->directInput)
- {
- alloc->Free(alloc, p->bufferBase);
- p->bufferBase = 0;
- }
-}
-
-/* keepSizeBefore + keepSizeAfter + keepSizeReserv must be < 4G) */
-
-static int LzInWindow_Create(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 keepSizeReserv, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- UInt32 blockSize = p->keepSizeBefore + p->keepSizeAfter + keepSizeReserv;
- if (p->directInput)
- {
- p->blockSize = blockSize;
- return 1;
- }
- if (p->bufferBase == 0 || p->blockSize != blockSize)
- {
- LzInWindow_Free(p, alloc);
- p->blockSize = blockSize;
- p->bufferBase = (Byte *)alloc->Alloc(alloc, (size_t)blockSize);
- }
- return (p->bufferBase != 0);
-}
-
-Byte *MatchFinder_GetPointerToCurrentPos(CMatchFinder *p) { return p->buffer; }
-Byte MatchFinder_GetIndexByte(CMatchFinder *p, Int32 index) { return p->buffer[index]; }
-
-UInt32 MatchFinder_GetNumAvailableBytes(CMatchFinder *p) { return p->streamPos - p->pos; }
-
-void MatchFinder_ReduceOffsets(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 subValue)
-{
- p->posLimit -= subValue;
- p->pos -= subValue;
- p->streamPos -= subValue;
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_ReadBlock(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- if (p->streamEndWasReached || p->result != SZ_OK)
- return;
- for (;;)
- {
- Byte *dest = p->buffer + (p->streamPos - p->pos);
- size_t size = (p->bufferBase + p->blockSize - dest);
- if (size == 0)
- return;
- p->result = p->stream->Read(p->stream, dest, &size);
- if (p->result != SZ_OK)
- return;
- if (size == 0)
- {
- p->streamEndWasReached = 1;
- return;
- }
- p->streamPos += (UInt32)size;
- if (p->streamPos - p->pos > p->keepSizeAfter)
- return;
- }
-}
-
-void MatchFinder_MoveBlock(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- memmove(p->bufferBase,
- p->buffer - p->keepSizeBefore,
- (size_t)(p->streamPos - p->pos + p->keepSizeBefore));
- p->buffer = p->bufferBase + p->keepSizeBefore;
-}
-
-int MatchFinder_NeedMove(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- /* if (p->streamEndWasReached) return 0; */
- return ((size_t)(p->bufferBase + p->blockSize - p->buffer) <= p->keepSizeAfter);
-}
-
-void MatchFinder_ReadIfRequired(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- if (p->streamEndWasReached)
- return;
- if (p->keepSizeAfter >= p->streamPos - p->pos)
- MatchFinder_ReadBlock(p);
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_CheckAndMoveAndRead(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- if (MatchFinder_NeedMove(p))
- MatchFinder_MoveBlock(p);
- MatchFinder_ReadBlock(p);
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_SetDefaultSettings(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- p->cutValue = 32;
- p->btMode = 1;
- p->numHashBytes = 4;
- /* p->skipModeBits = 0; */
- p->directInput = 0;
- p->bigHash = 0;
-}
-
-#define kCrcPoly 0xEDB88320
-
-void MatchFinder_Construct(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- UInt32 i;
- p->bufferBase = 0;
- p->directInput = 0;
- p->hash = 0;
- MatchFinder_SetDefaultSettings(p);
-
- for (i = 0; i < 256; i++)
- {
- UInt32 r = i;
- int j;
- for (j = 0; j < 8; j++)
- r = (r >> 1) ^ (kCrcPoly & ~((r & 1) - 1));
- p->crc[i] = r;
- }
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_FreeThisClassMemory(CMatchFinder *p, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- alloc->Free(alloc, p->hash);
- p->hash = 0;
-}
-
-void MatchFinder_Free(CMatchFinder *p, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- MatchFinder_FreeThisClassMemory(p, alloc);
- LzInWindow_Free(p, alloc);
-}
-
-static CLzRef* AllocRefs(UInt32 num, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- size_t sizeInBytes = (size_t)num * sizeof(CLzRef);
- if (sizeInBytes / sizeof(CLzRef) != num)
- return 0;
- return (CLzRef *)alloc->Alloc(alloc, sizeInBytes);
-}
-
-int MatchFinder_Create(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 historySize,
- UInt32 keepAddBufferBefore, UInt32 matchMaxLen, UInt32 keepAddBufferAfter,
- ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- UInt32 sizeReserv;
- if (historySize > kMaxHistorySize)
- {
- MatchFinder_Free(p, alloc);
- return 0;
- }
- sizeReserv = historySize >> 1;
- if (historySize > ((UInt32)2 << 30))
- sizeReserv = historySize >> 2;
- sizeReserv += (keepAddBufferBefore + matchMaxLen + keepAddBufferAfter) / 2 + (1 << 19);
-
- p->keepSizeBefore = historySize + keepAddBufferBefore + 1;
- p->keepSizeAfter = matchMaxLen + keepAddBufferAfter;
- /* we need one additional byte, since we use MoveBlock after pos++ and before dictionary using */
- if (LzInWindow_Create(p, sizeReserv, alloc))
- {
- UInt32 newCyclicBufferSize = (historySize /* >> p->skipModeBits */) + 1;
- UInt32 hs;
- p->matchMaxLen = matchMaxLen;
- {
- p->fixedHashSize = 0;
- if (p->numHashBytes == 2)
- hs = (1 << 16) - 1;
- else
- {
- hs = historySize - 1;
- hs |= (hs >> 1);
- hs |= (hs >> 2);
- hs |= (hs >> 4);
- hs |= (hs >> 8);
- hs >>= 1;
- /* hs >>= p->skipModeBits; */
- hs |= 0xFFFF; /* don't change it! It's required for Deflate */
- if (hs > (1 << 24))
- {
- if (p->numHashBytes == 3)
- hs = (1 << 24) - 1;
- else
- hs >>= 1;
- }
- }
- p->hashMask = hs;
- hs++;
- if (p->numHashBytes > 2) p->fixedHashSize += kHash2Size;
- if (p->numHashBytes > 3) p->fixedHashSize += kHash3Size;
- if (p->numHashBytes > 4) p->fixedHashSize += kHash4Size;
- hs += p->fixedHashSize;
- }
-
- {
- UInt32 prevSize = p->hashSizeSum + p->numSons;
- UInt32 newSize;
- p->historySize = historySize;
- p->hashSizeSum = hs;
- p->cyclicBufferSize = newCyclicBufferSize;
- p->numSons = (p->btMode ? newCyclicBufferSize * 2 : newCyclicBufferSize);
- newSize = p->hashSizeSum + p->numSons;
- if (p->hash != 0 && prevSize == newSize)
- return 1;
- MatchFinder_FreeThisClassMemory(p, alloc);
- p->hash = AllocRefs(newSize, alloc);
- if (p->hash != 0)
- {
- p->son = p->hash + p->hashSizeSum;
- return 1;
- }
- }
- }
- MatchFinder_Free(p, alloc);
- return 0;
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_SetLimits(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- UInt32 limit = kMaxValForNormalize - p->pos;
- UInt32 limit2 = p->cyclicBufferSize - p->cyclicBufferPos;
- if (limit2 < limit)
- limit = limit2;
- limit2 = p->streamPos - p->pos;
- if (limit2 <= p->keepSizeAfter)
- {
- if (limit2 > 0)
- limit2 = 1;
- }
- else
- limit2 -= p->keepSizeAfter;
- if (limit2 < limit)
- limit = limit2;
- {
- UInt32 lenLimit = p->streamPos - p->pos;
- if (lenLimit > p->matchMaxLen)
- lenLimit = p->matchMaxLen;
- p->lenLimit = lenLimit;
- }
- p->posLimit = p->pos + limit;
-}
-
-void MatchFinder_Init(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- UInt32 i;
- for (i = 0; i < p->hashSizeSum; i++)
- p->hash[i] = kEmptyHashValue;
- p->cyclicBufferPos = 0;
- p->buffer = p->bufferBase;
- p->pos = p->streamPos = p->cyclicBufferSize;
- p->result = SZ_OK;
- p->streamEndWasReached = 0;
- MatchFinder_ReadBlock(p);
- MatchFinder_SetLimits(p);
-}
-
-static UInt32 MatchFinder_GetSubValue(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- return (p->pos - p->historySize - 1) & kNormalizeMask;
-}
-
-void MatchFinder_Normalize3(UInt32 subValue, CLzRef *items, UInt32 numItems)
-{
- UInt32 i;
- for (i = 0; i < numItems; i++)
- {
- UInt32 value = items[i];
- if (value <= subValue)
- value = kEmptyHashValue;
- else
- value -= subValue;
- items[i] = value;
- }
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_Normalize(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- UInt32 subValue = MatchFinder_GetSubValue(p);
- MatchFinder_Normalize3(subValue, p->hash, p->hashSizeSum + p->numSons);
- MatchFinder_ReduceOffsets(p, subValue);
-}
-
-static void MatchFinder_CheckLimits(CMatchFinder *p)
-{
- if (p->pos == kMaxValForNormalize)
- MatchFinder_Normalize(p);
- if (!p->streamEndWasReached && p->keepSizeAfter == p->streamPos - p->pos)
- MatchFinder_CheckAndMoveAndRead(p);
- if (p->cyclicBufferPos == p->cyclicBufferSize)
- p->cyclicBufferPos = 0;
- MatchFinder_SetLimits(p);
-}
-
-static UInt32 * Hc_GetMatchesSpec(UInt32 lenLimit, UInt32 curMatch, UInt32 pos, const Byte *cur, CLzRef *son,
- UInt32 _cyclicBufferPos, UInt32 _cyclicBufferSize, UInt32 cutValue,
- UInt32 *distances, UInt32 maxLen)
-{
- son[_cyclicBufferPos] = curMatch;
- for (;;)
- {
- UInt32 delta = pos - curMatch;
- if (cutValue-- == 0 || delta >= _cyclicBufferSize)
- return distances;
- {
- const Byte *pb = cur - delta;
- curMatch = son[_cyclicBufferPos - delta + ((delta > _cyclicBufferPos) ? _cyclicBufferSize : 0)];
- if (pb[maxLen] == cur[maxLen] && *pb == *cur)
- {
- UInt32 len = 0;
- while (++len != lenLimit)
- if (pb[len] != cur[len])
- break;
- if (maxLen < len)
- {
- *distances++ = maxLen = len;
- *distances++ = delta - 1;
- if (len == lenLimit)
- return distances;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-UInt32 * GetMatchesSpec1(UInt32 lenLimit, UInt32 curMatch, UInt32 pos, const Byte *cur, CLzRef *son,
- UInt32 _cyclicBufferPos, UInt32 _cyclicBufferSize, UInt32 cutValue,
- UInt32 *distances, UInt32 maxLen)
-{
- CLzRef *ptr0 = son + (_cyclicBufferPos << 1) + 1;
- CLzRef *ptr1 = son + (_cyclicBufferPos << 1);
- UInt32 len0 = 0, len1 = 0;
- for (;;)
- {
- UInt32 delta = pos - curMatch;
- if (cutValue-- == 0 || delta >= _cyclicBufferSize)
- {
- *ptr0 = *ptr1 = kEmptyHashValue;
- return distances;
- }
- {
- CLzRef *pair = son + ((_cyclicBufferPos - delta + ((delta > _cyclicBufferPos) ? _cyclicBufferSize : 0)) << 1);
- const Byte *pb = cur - delta;
- UInt32 len = (len0 < len1 ? len0 : len1);
- if (pb[len] == cur[len])
- {
- if (++len != lenLimit && pb[len] == cur[len])
- while (++len != lenLimit)
- if (pb[len] != cur[len])
- break;
- if (maxLen < len)
- {
- *distances++ = maxLen = len;
- *distances++ = delta - 1;
- if (len == lenLimit)
- {
- *ptr1 = pair[0];
- *ptr0 = pair[1];
- return distances;
- }
- }
- }
- if (pb[len] < cur[len])
- {
- *ptr1 = curMatch;
- ptr1 = pair + 1;
- curMatch = *ptr1;
- len1 = len;
- }
- else
- {
- *ptr0 = curMatch;
- ptr0 = pair;
- curMatch = *ptr0;
- len0 = len;
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-static void SkipMatchesSpec(UInt32 lenLimit, UInt32 curMatch, UInt32 pos, const Byte *cur, CLzRef *son,
- UInt32 _cyclicBufferPos, UInt32 _cyclicBufferSize, UInt32 cutValue)
-{
- CLzRef *ptr0 = son + (_cyclicBufferPos << 1) + 1;
- CLzRef *ptr1 = son + (_cyclicBufferPos << 1);
- UInt32 len0 = 0, len1 = 0;
- for (;;)
- {
- UInt32 delta = pos - curMatch;
- if (cutValue-- == 0 || delta >= _cyclicBufferSize)
- {
- *ptr0 = *ptr1 = kEmptyHashValue;
- return;
- }
- {
- CLzRef *pair = son + ((_cyclicBufferPos - delta + ((delta > _cyclicBufferPos) ? _cyclicBufferSize : 0)) << 1);
- const Byte *pb = cur - delta;
- UInt32 len = (len0 < len1 ? len0 : len1);
- if (pb[len] == cur[len])
- {
- while (++len != lenLimit)
- if (pb[len] != cur[len])
- break;
- {
- if (len == lenLimit)
- {
- *ptr1 = pair[0];
- *ptr0 = pair[1];
- return;
- }
- }
- }
- if (pb[len] < cur[len])
- {
- *ptr1 = curMatch;
- ptr1 = pair + 1;
- curMatch = *ptr1;
- len1 = len;
- }
- else
- {
- *ptr0 = curMatch;
- ptr0 = pair;
- curMatch = *ptr0;
- len0 = len;
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-#define MOVE_POS \
- ++p->cyclicBufferPos; \
- p->buffer++; \
- if (++p->pos == p->posLimit) MatchFinder_CheckLimits(p);
-
-#define MOVE_POS_RET MOVE_POS return offset;
-
-static void MatchFinder_MovePos(CMatchFinder *p) { MOVE_POS; }
-
-#define GET_MATCHES_HEADER2(minLen, ret_op) \
- UInt32 lenLimit; UInt32 hashValue; const Byte *cur; UInt32 curMatch; \
- lenLimit = p->lenLimit; { if (lenLimit < minLen) { MatchFinder_MovePos(p); ret_op; }} \
- cur = p->buffer;
-
-#define GET_MATCHES_HEADER(minLen) GET_MATCHES_HEADER2(minLen, return 0)
-#define SKIP_HEADER(minLen) GET_MATCHES_HEADER2(minLen, continue)
-
-#define MF_PARAMS(p) p->pos, p->buffer, p->son, p->cyclicBufferPos, p->cyclicBufferSize, p->cutValue
-
-#define GET_MATCHES_FOOTER(offset, maxLen) \
- offset = (UInt32)(GetMatchesSpec1(lenLimit, curMatch, MF_PARAMS(p), \
- distances + offset, maxLen) - distances); MOVE_POS_RET;
-
-#define SKIP_FOOTER \
- SkipMatchesSpec(lenLimit, curMatch, MF_PARAMS(p)); MOVE_POS;
-
-static UInt32 Bt2_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances)
-{
- UInt32 offset;
- GET_MATCHES_HEADER(2)
- HASH2_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[hashValue];
- p->hash[hashValue] = p->pos;
- offset = 0;
- GET_MATCHES_FOOTER(offset, 1)
-}
-
-UInt32 Bt3Zip_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances)
-{
- UInt32 offset;
- GET_MATCHES_HEADER(3)
- HASH_ZIP_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[hashValue];
- p->hash[hashValue] = p->pos;
- offset = 0;
- GET_MATCHES_FOOTER(offset, 2)
-}
-
-static UInt32 Bt3_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances)
-{
- UInt32 hash2Value, delta2, maxLen, offset;
- GET_MATCHES_HEADER(3)
-
- HASH3_CALC;
-
- delta2 = p->pos - p->hash[hash2Value];
- curMatch = p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hashValue];
-
- p->hash[hash2Value] =
- p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hashValue] = p->pos;
-
-
- maxLen = 2;
- offset = 0;
- if (delta2 < p->cyclicBufferSize && *(cur - delta2) == *cur)
- {
- for (; maxLen != lenLimit; maxLen++)
- if (cur[(ptrdiff_t)maxLen - delta2] != cur[maxLen])
- break;
- distances[0] = maxLen;
- distances[1] = delta2 - 1;
- offset = 2;
- if (maxLen == lenLimit)
- {
- SkipMatchesSpec(lenLimit, curMatch, MF_PARAMS(p));
- MOVE_POS_RET;
- }
- }
- GET_MATCHES_FOOTER(offset, maxLen)
-}
-
-static UInt32 Bt4_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances)
-{
- UInt32 hash2Value, hash3Value, delta2, delta3, maxLen, offset;
- GET_MATCHES_HEADER(4)
-
- HASH4_CALC;
-
- delta2 = p->pos - p->hash[ hash2Value];
- delta3 = p->pos - p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hash3Value];
- curMatch = p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue];
-
- p->hash[ hash2Value] =
- p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hash3Value] =
- p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue] = p->pos;
-
- maxLen = 1;
- offset = 0;
- if (delta2 < p->cyclicBufferSize && *(cur - delta2) == *cur)
- {
- distances[0] = maxLen = 2;
- distances[1] = delta2 - 1;
- offset = 2;
- }
- if (delta2 != delta3 && delta3 < p->cyclicBufferSize && *(cur - delta3) == *cur)
- {
- maxLen = 3;
- distances[offset + 1] = delta3 - 1;
- offset += 2;
- delta2 = delta3;
- }
- if (offset != 0)
- {
- for (; maxLen != lenLimit; maxLen++)
- if (cur[(ptrdiff_t)maxLen - delta2] != cur[maxLen])
- break;
- distances[offset - 2] = maxLen;
- if (maxLen == lenLimit)
- {
- SkipMatchesSpec(lenLimit, curMatch, MF_PARAMS(p));
- MOVE_POS_RET;
- }
- }
- if (maxLen < 3)
- maxLen = 3;
- GET_MATCHES_FOOTER(offset, maxLen)
-}
-
-static UInt32 Hc4_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances)
-{
- UInt32 hash2Value, hash3Value, delta2, delta3, maxLen, offset;
- GET_MATCHES_HEADER(4)
-
- HASH4_CALC;
-
- delta2 = p->pos - p->hash[ hash2Value];
- delta3 = p->pos - p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hash3Value];
- curMatch = p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue];
-
- p->hash[ hash2Value] =
- p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hash3Value] =
- p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue] = p->pos;
-
- maxLen = 1;
- offset = 0;
- if (delta2 < p->cyclicBufferSize && *(cur - delta2) == *cur)
- {
- distances[0] = maxLen = 2;
- distances[1] = delta2 - 1;
- offset = 2;
- }
- if (delta2 != delta3 && delta3 < p->cyclicBufferSize && *(cur - delta3) == *cur)
- {
- maxLen = 3;
- distances[offset + 1] = delta3 - 1;
- offset += 2;
- delta2 = delta3;
- }
- if (offset != 0)
- {
- for (; maxLen != lenLimit; maxLen++)
- if (cur[(ptrdiff_t)maxLen - delta2] != cur[maxLen])
- break;
- distances[offset - 2] = maxLen;
- if (maxLen == lenLimit)
- {
- p->son[p->cyclicBufferPos] = curMatch;
- MOVE_POS_RET;
- }
- }
- if (maxLen < 3)
- maxLen = 3;
- offset = (UInt32)(Hc_GetMatchesSpec(lenLimit, curMatch, MF_PARAMS(p),
- distances + offset, maxLen) - (distances));
- MOVE_POS_RET
-}
-
-UInt32 Hc3Zip_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances)
-{
- UInt32 offset;
- GET_MATCHES_HEADER(3)
- HASH_ZIP_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[hashValue];
- p->hash[hashValue] = p->pos;
- offset = (UInt32)(Hc_GetMatchesSpec(lenLimit, curMatch, MF_PARAMS(p),
- distances, 2) - (distances));
- MOVE_POS_RET
-}
-
-static void Bt2_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num)
-{
- do
- {
- SKIP_HEADER(2)
- HASH2_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[hashValue];
- p->hash[hashValue] = p->pos;
- SKIP_FOOTER
- }
- while (--num != 0);
-}
-
-void Bt3Zip_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num)
-{
- do
- {
- SKIP_HEADER(3)
- HASH_ZIP_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[hashValue];
- p->hash[hashValue] = p->pos;
- SKIP_FOOTER
- }
- while (--num != 0);
-}
-
-static void Bt3_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num)
-{
- do
- {
- UInt32 hash2Value;
- SKIP_HEADER(3)
- HASH3_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hashValue];
- p->hash[hash2Value] =
- p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hashValue] = p->pos;
- SKIP_FOOTER
- }
- while (--num != 0);
-}
-
-static void Bt4_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num)
-{
- do
- {
- UInt32 hash2Value, hash3Value;
- SKIP_HEADER(4)
- HASH4_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue];
- p->hash[ hash2Value] =
- p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hash3Value] = p->pos;
- p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue] = p->pos;
- SKIP_FOOTER
- }
- while (--num != 0);
-}
-
-static void Hc4_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num)
-{
- do
- {
- UInt32 hash2Value, hash3Value;
- SKIP_HEADER(4)
- HASH4_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue];
- p->hash[ hash2Value] =
- p->hash[kFix3HashSize + hash3Value] =
- p->hash[kFix4HashSize + hashValue] = p->pos;
- p->son[p->cyclicBufferPos] = curMatch;
- MOVE_POS
- }
- while (--num != 0);
-}
-
-void Hc3Zip_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num)
-{
- do
- {
- SKIP_HEADER(3)
- HASH_ZIP_CALC;
- curMatch = p->hash[hashValue];
- p->hash[hashValue] = p->pos;
- p->son[p->cyclicBufferPos] = curMatch;
- MOVE_POS
- }
- while (--num != 0);
-}
-
-void MatchFinder_CreateVTable(CMatchFinder *p, IMatchFinder *vTable)
-{
- vTable->Init = (Mf_Init_Func)MatchFinder_Init;
- vTable->GetIndexByte = (Mf_GetIndexByte_Func)MatchFinder_GetIndexByte;
- vTable->GetNumAvailableBytes = (Mf_GetNumAvailableBytes_Func)MatchFinder_GetNumAvailableBytes;
- vTable->GetPointerToCurrentPos = (Mf_GetPointerToCurrentPos_Func)MatchFinder_GetPointerToCurrentPos;
- if (!p->btMode)
- {
- vTable->GetMatches = (Mf_GetMatches_Func)Hc4_MatchFinder_GetMatches;
- vTable->Skip = (Mf_Skip_Func)Hc4_MatchFinder_Skip;
- }
- else if (p->numHashBytes == 2)
- {
- vTable->GetMatches = (Mf_GetMatches_Func)Bt2_MatchFinder_GetMatches;
- vTable->Skip = (Mf_Skip_Func)Bt2_MatchFinder_Skip;
- }
- else if (p->numHashBytes == 3)
- {
- vTable->GetMatches = (Mf_GetMatches_Func)Bt3_MatchFinder_GetMatches;
- vTable->Skip = (Mf_Skip_Func)Bt3_MatchFinder_Skip;
- }
- else
- {
- vTable->GetMatches = (Mf_GetMatches_Func)Bt4_MatchFinder_GetMatches;
- vTable->Skip = (Mf_Skip_Func)Bt4_MatchFinder_Skip;
- }
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzFind.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzFind.h deleted file mode 100644 index 423d67e0c3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzFind.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,107 +0,0 @@ -/* LzFind.h -- Match finder for LZ algorithms
-2008-10-04 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain */
-
-#ifndef __LZFIND_H
-#define __LZFIND_H
-
-#include "Types.h"
-
-typedef UInt32 CLzRef;
-
-typedef struct _CMatchFinder
-{
- Byte *buffer;
- UInt32 pos;
- UInt32 posLimit;
- UInt32 streamPos;
- UInt32 lenLimit;
-
- UInt32 cyclicBufferPos;
- UInt32 cyclicBufferSize; /* it must be = (historySize + 1) */
-
- UInt32 matchMaxLen;
- CLzRef *hash;
- CLzRef *son;
- UInt32 hashMask;
- UInt32 cutValue;
-
- Byte *bufferBase;
- ISeqInStream *stream;
- int streamEndWasReached;
-
- UInt32 blockSize;
- UInt32 keepSizeBefore;
- UInt32 keepSizeAfter;
-
- UInt32 numHashBytes;
- int directInput;
- int btMode;
- /* int skipModeBits; */
- int bigHash;
- UInt32 historySize;
- UInt32 fixedHashSize;
- UInt32 hashSizeSum;
- UInt32 numSons;
- SRes result;
- UInt32 crc[256];
-} CMatchFinder;
-
-#define Inline_MatchFinder_GetPointerToCurrentPos(p) ((p)->buffer)
-#define Inline_MatchFinder_GetIndexByte(p, index) ((p)->buffer[(Int32)(index)])
-
-#define Inline_MatchFinder_GetNumAvailableBytes(p) ((p)->streamPos - (p)->pos)
-
-int MatchFinder_NeedMove(CMatchFinder *p);
-Byte *MatchFinder_GetPointerToCurrentPos(CMatchFinder *p);
-void MatchFinder_MoveBlock(CMatchFinder *p);
-void MatchFinder_ReadIfRequired(CMatchFinder *p);
-
-void MatchFinder_Construct(CMatchFinder *p);
-
-/* Conditions:
- historySize <= 3 GB
- keepAddBufferBefore + matchMaxLen + keepAddBufferAfter < 511MB
-*/
-int MatchFinder_Create(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 historySize,
- UInt32 keepAddBufferBefore, UInt32 matchMaxLen, UInt32 keepAddBufferAfter,
- ISzAlloc *alloc);
-void MatchFinder_Free(CMatchFinder *p, ISzAlloc *alloc);
-void MatchFinder_Normalize3(UInt32 subValue, CLzRef *items, UInt32 numItems);
-void MatchFinder_ReduceOffsets(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 subValue);
-
-UInt32 * GetMatchesSpec1(UInt32 lenLimit, UInt32 curMatch, UInt32 pos, const Byte *buffer, CLzRef *son,
- UInt32 _cyclicBufferPos, UInt32 _cyclicBufferSize, UInt32 _cutValue,
- UInt32 *distances, UInt32 maxLen);
-
-/*
-Conditions:
- Mf_GetNumAvailableBytes_Func must be called before each Mf_GetMatchLen_Func.
- Mf_GetPointerToCurrentPos_Func's result must be used only before any other function
-*/
-
-typedef void (*Mf_Init_Func)(void *object);
-typedef Byte (*Mf_GetIndexByte_Func)(void *object, Int32 index);
-typedef UInt32 (*Mf_GetNumAvailableBytes_Func)(void *object);
-typedef const Byte * (*Mf_GetPointerToCurrentPos_Func)(void *object);
-typedef UInt32 (*Mf_GetMatches_Func)(void *object, UInt32 *distances);
-typedef void (*Mf_Skip_Func)(void *object, UInt32);
-
-typedef struct _IMatchFinder
-{
- Mf_Init_Func Init;
- Mf_GetIndexByte_Func GetIndexByte;
- Mf_GetNumAvailableBytes_Func GetNumAvailableBytes;
- Mf_GetPointerToCurrentPos_Func GetPointerToCurrentPos;
- Mf_GetMatches_Func GetMatches;
- Mf_Skip_Func Skip;
-} IMatchFinder;
-
-void MatchFinder_CreateVTable(CMatchFinder *p, IMatchFinder *vTable);
-
-void MatchFinder_Init(CMatchFinder *p);
-UInt32 Bt3Zip_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances);
-UInt32 Hc3Zip_MatchFinder_GetMatches(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 *distances);
-void Bt3Zip_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num);
-void Hc3Zip_MatchFinder_Skip(CMatchFinder *p, UInt32 num);
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzHash.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzHash.h deleted file mode 100644 index c923417501..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzHash.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,54 +0,0 @@ -/* LzHash.h -- HASH functions for LZ algorithms
-2008-10-04 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain */
-
-#ifndef __LZHASH_H
-#define __LZHASH_H
-
-#define kHash2Size (1 << 10)
-#define kHash3Size (1 << 16)
-#define kHash4Size (1 << 20)
-
-#define kFix3HashSize (kHash2Size)
-#define kFix4HashSize (kHash2Size + kHash3Size)
-#define kFix5HashSize (kHash2Size + kHash3Size + kHash4Size)
-
-#define HASH2_CALC hashValue = cur[0] | ((UInt32)cur[1] << 8);
-
-#define HASH3_CALC { \
- UInt32 temp = p->crc[cur[0]] ^ cur[1]; \
- hash2Value = temp & (kHash2Size - 1); \
- hashValue = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8)) & p->hashMask; }
-
-#define HASH4_CALC { \
- UInt32 temp = p->crc[cur[0]] ^ cur[1]; \
- hash2Value = temp & (kHash2Size - 1); \
- hash3Value = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8)) & (kHash3Size - 1); \
- hashValue = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8) ^ (p->crc[cur[3]] << 5)) & p->hashMask; }
-
-#define HASH5_CALC { \
- UInt32 temp = p->crc[cur[0]] ^ cur[1]; \
- hash2Value = temp & (kHash2Size - 1); \
- hash3Value = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8)) & (kHash3Size - 1); \
- hash4Value = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8) ^ (p->crc[cur[3]] << 5)); \
- hashValue = (hash4Value ^ (p->crc[cur[4]] << 3)) & p->hashMask; \
- hash4Value &= (kHash4Size - 1); }
-
-/* #define HASH_ZIP_CALC hashValue = ((cur[0] | ((UInt32)cur[1] << 8)) ^ p->crc[cur[2]]) & 0xFFFF; */
-#define HASH_ZIP_CALC hashValue = ((cur[2] | ((UInt32)cur[0] << 8)) ^ p->crc[cur[1]]) & 0xFFFF;
-
-
-#define MT_HASH2_CALC \
- hash2Value = (p->crc[cur[0]] ^ cur[1]) & (kHash2Size - 1);
-
-#define MT_HASH3_CALC { \
- UInt32 temp = p->crc[cur[0]] ^ cur[1]; \
- hash2Value = temp & (kHash2Size - 1); \
- hash3Value = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8)) & (kHash3Size - 1); }
-
-#define MT_HASH4_CALC { \
- UInt32 temp = p->crc[cur[0]] ^ cur[1]; \
- hash2Value = temp & (kHash2Size - 1); \
- hash3Value = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8)) & (kHash3Size - 1); \
- hash4Value = (temp ^ ((UInt32)cur[2] << 8) ^ (p->crc[cur[3]] << 5)) & (kHash4Size - 1); }
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzmaDec.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzmaDec.c deleted file mode 100644 index e3db4edbb4..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzmaDec.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1026 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LzmaDec.c
-
- Based on LZMA SDK 4.65:
- LzmaDec.c -- LZMA Decoder
- 2008-11-06 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain
-
- Copyright (c) 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "LzmaDec.h"
-
-#ifndef EFIAPI
-
-#include <string.h>
-
-#endif // !EFIAPI
-
-#define kNumTopBits 24
-#define kTopValue ((UInt32)1 << kNumTopBits)
-
-#define kNumBitModelTotalBits 11
-#define kBitModelTotal (1 << kNumBitModelTotalBits)
-#define kNumMoveBits 5
-
-#define RC_INIT_SIZE 5
-
-#define NORMALIZE if (range < kTopValue) { range <<= 8; code = (code << 8) | (*buf++); }
-
-#define IF_BIT_0(p) ttt = *(p); NORMALIZE; bound = (range >> kNumBitModelTotalBits) * ttt; if (code < bound)
-#define UPDATE_0(p) range = bound; *(p) = (CLzmaProb)(ttt + ((kBitModelTotal - ttt) >> kNumMoveBits));
-#define UPDATE_1(p) range -= bound; code -= bound; *(p) = (CLzmaProb)(ttt - (ttt >> kNumMoveBits));
-#define GET_BIT2(p, i, A0, A1) IF_BIT_0(p) \
- { UPDATE_0(p); i = (i + i); A0; } else \
- { UPDATE_1(p); i = (i + i) + 1; A1; }
-#define GET_BIT(p, i) GET_BIT2(p, i, ; , ;)
-
-#define TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i) { GET_BIT((probs + i), i); }
-#define TREE_DECODE(probs, limit, i) \
- { i = 1; do { TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); } while (i < limit); i -= limit; }
-
-/* #define _LZMA_SIZE_OPT */
-
-#ifdef _LZMA_SIZE_OPT
-#define TREE_6_DECODE(probs, i) TREE_DECODE(probs, (1 << 6), i)
-#else
-#define TREE_6_DECODE(probs, i) \
- { i = 1; \
- TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); \
- TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); \
- TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); \
- TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); \
- TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); \
- TREE_GET_BIT(probs, i); \
- i -= 0x40; }
-#endif
-
-#define NORMALIZE_CHECK if (range < kTopValue) { if (buf >= bufLimit) return DUMMY_ERROR; range <<= 8; code = (code << 8) | (*buf++); }
-
-#define IF_BIT_0_CHECK(p) ttt = *(p); NORMALIZE_CHECK; bound = (range >> kNumBitModelTotalBits) * ttt; if (code < bound)
-#define UPDATE_0_CHECK range = bound;
-#define UPDATE_1_CHECK range -= bound; code -= bound;
-#define GET_BIT2_CHECK(p, i, A0, A1) IF_BIT_0_CHECK(p) \
- { UPDATE_0_CHECK; i = (i + i); A0; } else \
- { UPDATE_1_CHECK; i = (i + i) + 1; A1; }
-#define GET_BIT_CHECK(p, i) GET_BIT2_CHECK(p, i, ; , ;)
-#define TREE_DECODE_CHECK(probs, limit, i) \
- { i = 1; do { GET_BIT_CHECK(probs + i, i) } while (i < limit); i -= limit; }
-
-
-#define kNumPosBitsMax 4
-#define kNumPosStatesMax (1 << kNumPosBitsMax)
-
-#define kLenNumLowBits 3
-#define kLenNumLowSymbols (1 << kLenNumLowBits)
-#define kLenNumMidBits 3
-#define kLenNumMidSymbols (1 << kLenNumMidBits)
-#define kLenNumHighBits 8
-#define kLenNumHighSymbols (1 << kLenNumHighBits)
-
-#define LenChoice 0
-#define LenChoice2 (LenChoice + 1)
-#define LenLow (LenChoice2 + 1)
-#define LenMid (LenLow + (kNumPosStatesMax << kLenNumLowBits))
-#define LenHigh (LenMid + (kNumPosStatesMax << kLenNumMidBits))
-#define kNumLenProbs (LenHigh + kLenNumHighSymbols)
-
-
-#define kNumStates 12
-#define kNumLitStates 7
-
-#define kStartPosModelIndex 4
-#define kEndPosModelIndex 14
-#define kNumFullDistances (1 << (kEndPosModelIndex >> 1))
-
-#define kNumPosSlotBits 6
-#define kNumLenToPosStates 4
-
-#define kNumAlignBits 4
-#define kAlignTableSize (1 << kNumAlignBits)
-
-#define kMatchMinLen 2
-#define kMatchSpecLenStart (kMatchMinLen + kLenNumLowSymbols + kLenNumMidSymbols + kLenNumHighSymbols)
-
-#define IsMatch 0
-#define IsRep (IsMatch + (kNumStates << kNumPosBitsMax))
-#define IsRepG0 (IsRep + kNumStates)
-#define IsRepG1 (IsRepG0 + kNumStates)
-#define IsRepG2 (IsRepG1 + kNumStates)
-#define IsRep0Long (IsRepG2 + kNumStates)
-#define PosSlot (IsRep0Long + (kNumStates << kNumPosBitsMax))
-#define SpecPos (PosSlot + (kNumLenToPosStates << kNumPosSlotBits))
-#define Align (SpecPos + kNumFullDistances - kEndPosModelIndex)
-#define LenCoder (Align + kAlignTableSize)
-#define RepLenCoder (LenCoder + kNumLenProbs)
-#define Literal (RepLenCoder + kNumLenProbs)
-
-#define LZMA_BASE_SIZE 1846
-#define LZMA_LIT_SIZE 768
-
-#define LzmaProps_GetNumProbs(p) ((UInt32)LZMA_BASE_SIZE + (LZMA_LIT_SIZE << ((p)->lc + (p)->lp)))
-
-#if Literal != LZMA_BASE_SIZE
-StopCompilingDueBUG
-#endif
-
-static const Byte kLiteralNextStates[kNumStates * 2] =
-{
- 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 4, 5,
- 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 10, 10, 10, 10, 10
-};
-
-#define LZMA_DIC_MIN (1 << 12)
-
-/* First LZMA-symbol is always decoded.
-And it decodes new LZMA-symbols while (buf < bufLimit), but "buf" is without last normalization
-Out:
- Result:
- SZ_OK - OK
- SZ_ERROR_DATA - Error
- p->remainLen:
- < kMatchSpecLenStart : normal remain
- = kMatchSpecLenStart : finished
- = kMatchSpecLenStart + 1 : Flush marker
- = kMatchSpecLenStart + 2 : State Init Marker
-*/
-
-static int MY_FAST_CALL LzmaDec_DecodeReal(CLzmaDec *p, SizeT limit, const Byte *bufLimit)
-{
- CLzmaProb *probs = p->probs;
-
- unsigned state = p->state;
- UInt32 rep0 = p->reps[0], rep1 = p->reps[1], rep2 = p->reps[2], rep3 = p->reps[3];
- unsigned pbMask = ((unsigned)1 << (p->prop.pb)) - 1;
- unsigned lpMask = ((unsigned)1 << (p->prop.lp)) - 1;
- unsigned lc = p->prop.lc;
-
- Byte *dic = p->dic;
- SizeT dicBufSize = p->dicBufSize;
- SizeT dicPos = p->dicPos;
-
- UInt32 processedPos = p->processedPos;
- UInt32 checkDicSize = p->checkDicSize;
- unsigned len = 0;
-
- const Byte *buf = p->buf;
- UInt32 range = p->range;
- UInt32 code = p->code;
-
- do
- {
- CLzmaProb *prob;
- UInt32 bound;
- unsigned ttt;
- unsigned posState = processedPos & pbMask;
-
- prob = probs + IsMatch + (state << kNumPosBitsMax) + posState;
- IF_BIT_0(prob)
- {
- unsigned symbol;
- UPDATE_0(prob);
- prob = probs + Literal;
- if (checkDicSize != 0 || processedPos != 0)
- prob += (LZMA_LIT_SIZE * (((processedPos & lpMask) << lc) +
- (dic[(dicPos == 0 ? dicBufSize : dicPos) - 1] >> (8 - lc))));
-
- if (state < kNumLitStates)
- {
- symbol = 1;
- do { GET_BIT(prob + symbol, symbol) } while (symbol < 0x100);
- }
- else
- {
- unsigned matchByte = p->dic[(dicPos - rep0) + ((dicPos < rep0) ? dicBufSize : 0)];
- unsigned offs = 0x100;
- symbol = 1;
- do
- {
- unsigned bit;
- CLzmaProb *probLit;
- matchByte <<= 1;
- bit = (matchByte & offs);
- probLit = prob + offs + bit + symbol;
- GET_BIT2(probLit, symbol, offs &= ~bit, offs &= bit)
- }
- while (symbol < 0x100);
- }
- dic[dicPos++] = (Byte)symbol;
- processedPos++;
-
- state = kLiteralNextStates[state];
- /* if (state < 4) state = 0; else if (state < 10) state -= 3; else state -= 6; */
- continue;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1(prob);
- prob = probs + IsRep + state;
- IF_BIT_0(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0(prob);
- state += kNumStates;
- prob = probs + LenCoder;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1(prob);
- if (checkDicSize == 0 && processedPos == 0)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- prob = probs + IsRepG0 + state;
- IF_BIT_0(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0(prob);
- prob = probs + IsRep0Long + (state << kNumPosBitsMax) + posState;
- IF_BIT_0(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0(prob);
- dic[dicPos] = dic[(dicPos - rep0) + ((dicPos < rep0) ? dicBufSize : 0)];
- dicPos++;
- processedPos++;
- state = state < kNumLitStates ? 9 : 11;
- continue;
- }
- UPDATE_1(prob);
- }
- else
- {
- UInt32 distance;
- UPDATE_1(prob);
- prob = probs + IsRepG1 + state;
- IF_BIT_0(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0(prob);
- distance = rep1;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1(prob);
- prob = probs + IsRepG2 + state;
- IF_BIT_0(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0(prob);
- distance = rep2;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1(prob);
- distance = rep3;
- rep3 = rep2;
- }
- rep2 = rep1;
- }
- rep1 = rep0;
- rep0 = distance;
- }
- state = state < kNumLitStates ? 8 : 11;
- prob = probs + RepLenCoder;
- }
- {
- unsigned limit2, offset;
- CLzmaProb *probLen = prob + LenChoice;
- IF_BIT_0(probLen)
- {
- UPDATE_0(probLen);
- probLen = prob + LenLow + (posState << kLenNumLowBits);
- offset = 0;
- limit2 = (1 << kLenNumLowBits);
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1(probLen);
- probLen = prob + LenChoice2;
- IF_BIT_0(probLen)
- {
- UPDATE_0(probLen);
- probLen = prob + LenMid + (posState << kLenNumMidBits);
- offset = kLenNumLowSymbols;
- limit2 = (1 << kLenNumMidBits);
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1(probLen);
- probLen = prob + LenHigh;
- offset = kLenNumLowSymbols + kLenNumMidSymbols;
- limit2 = (1 << kLenNumHighBits);
- }
- }
- TREE_DECODE(probLen, limit2, len);
- len += offset;
- }
-
- if (state >= kNumStates)
- {
- UInt32 distance;
- prob = probs + PosSlot +
- ((len < kNumLenToPosStates ? len : kNumLenToPosStates - 1) << kNumPosSlotBits);
- TREE_6_DECODE(prob, distance);
- if (distance >= kStartPosModelIndex)
- {
- unsigned posSlot = (unsigned)distance;
- int numDirectBits = (int)(((distance >> 1) - 1));
- distance = (2 | (distance & 1));
- if (posSlot < kEndPosModelIndex)
- {
- distance <<= numDirectBits;
- prob = probs + SpecPos + distance - posSlot - 1;
- {
- UInt32 mask = 1;
- unsigned i = 1;
- do
- {
- GET_BIT2(prob + i, i, ; , distance |= mask);
- mask <<= 1;
- }
- while (--numDirectBits != 0);
- }
- }
- else
- {
- numDirectBits -= kNumAlignBits;
- do
- {
- NORMALIZE
- range >>= 1;
-
- {
- UInt32 t;
- code -= range;
- t = (0 - ((UInt32)code >> 31)); /* (UInt32)((Int32)code >> 31) */
- distance = (distance << 1) + (t + 1);
- code += range & t;
- }
- /*
- distance <<= 1;
- if (code >= range)
- {
- code -= range;
- distance |= 1;
- }
- */
- }
- while (--numDirectBits != 0);
- prob = probs + Align;
- distance <<= kNumAlignBits;
- {
- unsigned i = 1;
- GET_BIT2(prob + i, i, ; , distance |= 1);
- GET_BIT2(prob + i, i, ; , distance |= 2);
- GET_BIT2(prob + i, i, ; , distance |= 4);
- GET_BIT2(prob + i, i, ; , distance |= 8);
- }
- if (distance == (UInt32)0xFFFFFFFF)
- {
- len += kMatchSpecLenStart;
- state -= kNumStates;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- rep3 = rep2;
- rep2 = rep1;
- rep1 = rep0;
- rep0 = distance + 1;
- if (checkDicSize == 0)
- {
- if (distance >= processedPos)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- }
- else if (distance >= checkDicSize)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- state = (state < kNumStates + kNumLitStates) ? kNumLitStates : kNumLitStates + 3;
- /* state = kLiteralNextStates[state]; */
- }
-
- len += kMatchMinLen;
-
- if (limit == dicPos)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- {
- SizeT rem = limit - dicPos;
- unsigned curLen = ((rem < len) ? (unsigned)rem : len);
- SizeT pos = (dicPos - rep0) + ((dicPos < rep0) ? dicBufSize : 0);
-
- processedPos += curLen;
-
- len -= curLen;
- if (pos + curLen <= dicBufSize)
- {
- Byte *dest = dic + dicPos;
- ptrdiff_t src = (ptrdiff_t)pos - (ptrdiff_t)dicPos;
- const Byte *lim = dest + curLen;
- dicPos += curLen;
- do
- *((volatile Byte *)dest) = (Byte)*(dest + src);
- while (++dest != lim);
- }
- else
- {
- do
- {
- dic[dicPos++] = dic[pos];
- if (++pos == dicBufSize)
- pos = 0;
- }
- while (--curLen != 0);
- }
- }
- }
- }
- while (dicPos < limit && buf < bufLimit);
- NORMALIZE;
- p->buf = buf;
- p->range = range;
- p->code = code;
- p->remainLen = len;
- p->dicPos = dicPos;
- p->processedPos = processedPos;
- p->reps[0] = rep0;
- p->reps[1] = rep1;
- p->reps[2] = rep2;
- p->reps[3] = rep3;
- p->state = state;
-
- return SZ_OK;
-}
-
-static void MY_FAST_CALL LzmaDec_WriteRem(CLzmaDec *p, SizeT limit)
-{
- if (p->remainLen != 0 && p->remainLen < kMatchSpecLenStart)
- {
- Byte *dic = p->dic;
- SizeT dicPos = p->dicPos;
- SizeT dicBufSize = p->dicBufSize;
- unsigned len = p->remainLen;
- UInt32 rep0 = p->reps[0];
- if (limit - dicPos < len)
- len = (unsigned)(limit - dicPos);
-
- if (p->checkDicSize == 0 && p->prop.dicSize - p->processedPos <= len)
- p->checkDicSize = p->prop.dicSize;
-
- p->processedPos += len;
- p->remainLen -= len;
- while (len-- != 0)
- {
- dic[dicPos] = dic[(dicPos - rep0) + ((dicPos < rep0) ? dicBufSize : 0)];
- dicPos++;
- }
- p->dicPos = dicPos;
- }
-}
-
-static int MY_FAST_CALL LzmaDec_DecodeReal2(CLzmaDec *p, SizeT limit, const Byte *bufLimit)
-{
- do
- {
- SizeT limit2 = limit;
- if (p->checkDicSize == 0)
- {
- UInt32 rem = p->prop.dicSize - p->processedPos;
- if (limit - p->dicPos > rem)
- limit2 = p->dicPos + rem;
- }
- RINOK(LzmaDec_DecodeReal(p, limit2, bufLimit));
- if (p->processedPos >= p->prop.dicSize)
- p->checkDicSize = p->prop.dicSize;
- LzmaDec_WriteRem(p, limit);
- }
- while (p->dicPos < limit && p->buf < bufLimit && p->remainLen < kMatchSpecLenStart);
-
- if (p->remainLen > kMatchSpecLenStart)
- {
- p->remainLen = kMatchSpecLenStart;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
-typedef enum
-{
- DUMMY_ERROR, /* unexpected end of input stream */
- DUMMY_LIT,
- DUMMY_MATCH,
- DUMMY_REP
-} ELzmaDummy;
-
-static ELzmaDummy LzmaDec_TryDummy(const CLzmaDec *p, const Byte *buf, SizeT inSize)
-{
- UInt32 range = p->range;
- UInt32 code = p->code;
- const Byte *bufLimit = buf + inSize;
- CLzmaProb *probs = p->probs;
- unsigned state = p->state;
- ELzmaDummy res;
-
- {
- CLzmaProb *prob;
- UInt32 bound;
- unsigned ttt;
- unsigned posState = (p->processedPos) & ((1 << p->prop.pb) - 1);
-
- prob = probs + IsMatch + (state << kNumPosBitsMax) + posState;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK
-
- /* if (bufLimit - buf >= 7) return DUMMY_LIT; */
-
- prob = probs + Literal;
- if (p->checkDicSize != 0 || p->processedPos != 0)
- prob += (LZMA_LIT_SIZE *
- ((((p->processedPos) & ((1 << (p->prop.lp)) - 1)) << p->prop.lc) +
- (p->dic[(p->dicPos == 0 ? p->dicBufSize : p->dicPos) - 1] >> (8 - p->prop.lc))));
-
- if (state < kNumLitStates)
- {
- unsigned symbol = 1;
- do { GET_BIT_CHECK(prob + symbol, symbol) } while (symbol < 0x100);
- }
- else
- {
- unsigned matchByte = p->dic[p->dicPos - p->reps[0] +
- ((p->dicPos < p->reps[0]) ? p->dicBufSize : 0)];
- unsigned offs = 0x100;
- unsigned symbol = 1;
- do
- {
- unsigned bit;
- CLzmaProb *probLit;
- matchByte <<= 1;
- bit = (matchByte & offs);
- probLit = prob + offs + bit + symbol;
- GET_BIT2_CHECK(probLit, symbol, offs &= ~bit, offs &= bit)
- }
- while (symbol < 0x100);
- }
- res = DUMMY_LIT;
- }
- else
- {
- unsigned len;
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
-
- prob = probs + IsRep + state;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- state = 0;
- prob = probs + LenCoder;
- res = DUMMY_MATCH;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- res = DUMMY_REP;
- prob = probs + IsRepG0 + state;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- prob = probs + IsRep0Long + (state << kNumPosBitsMax) + posState;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- NORMALIZE_CHECK;
- return DUMMY_REP;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- }
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- prob = probs + IsRepG1 + state;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- prob = probs + IsRepG2 + state;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(prob)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- }
- }
- }
- state = kNumStates;
- prob = probs + RepLenCoder;
- }
- {
- unsigned limit, offset;
- CLzmaProb *probLen = prob + LenChoice;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(probLen)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- probLen = prob + LenLow + (posState << kLenNumLowBits);
- offset = 0;
- limit = 1 << kLenNumLowBits;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- probLen = prob + LenChoice2;
- IF_BIT_0_CHECK(probLen)
- {
- UPDATE_0_CHECK;
- probLen = prob + LenMid + (posState << kLenNumMidBits);
- offset = kLenNumLowSymbols;
- limit = 1 << kLenNumMidBits;
- }
- else
- {
- UPDATE_1_CHECK;
- probLen = prob + LenHigh;
- offset = kLenNumLowSymbols + kLenNumMidSymbols;
- limit = 1 << kLenNumHighBits;
- }
- }
- TREE_DECODE_CHECK(probLen, limit, len);
- len += offset;
- }
-
- if (state < 4)
- {
- unsigned posSlot;
- prob = probs + PosSlot +
- ((len < kNumLenToPosStates ? len : kNumLenToPosStates - 1) <<
- kNumPosSlotBits);
- TREE_DECODE_CHECK(prob, 1 << kNumPosSlotBits, posSlot);
- if (posSlot >= kStartPosModelIndex)
- {
- int numDirectBits = ((posSlot >> 1) - 1);
-
- /* if (bufLimit - buf >= 8) return DUMMY_MATCH; */
-
- if (posSlot < kEndPosModelIndex)
- {
- prob = probs + SpecPos + ((2 | (posSlot & 1)) << numDirectBits) - posSlot - 1;
- }
- else
- {
- numDirectBits -= kNumAlignBits;
- do
- {
- NORMALIZE_CHECK
- range >>= 1;
- code -= range & (((code - range) >> 31) - 1);
- /* if (code >= range) code -= range; */
- }
- while (--numDirectBits != 0);
- prob = probs + Align;
- numDirectBits = kNumAlignBits;
- }
- {
- unsigned i = 1;
- do
- {
- GET_BIT_CHECK(prob + i, i);
- }
- while (--numDirectBits != 0);
- }
- }
- }
- }
- }
- NORMALIZE_CHECK;
- return res;
-}
-
-static void LzmaDec_InitRc(CLzmaDec *p, const Byte *data)
-{
- p->code = ((UInt32)data[1] << 24) | ((UInt32)data[2] << 16) | ((UInt32)data[3] << 8) | ((UInt32)data[4]);
- p->range = 0xFFFFFFFF;
- p->needFlush = 0;
-}
-
-void LzmaDec_InitDicAndState(CLzmaDec *p, Bool initDic, Bool initState)
-{
- p->needFlush = 1;
- p->remainLen = 0;
- p->tempBufSize = 0;
-
- if (initDic)
- {
- p->processedPos = 0;
- p->checkDicSize = 0;
- p->needInitState = 1;
- }
- if (initState)
- p->needInitState = 1;
-}
-
-void LzmaDec_Init(CLzmaDec *p)
-{
- p->dicPos = 0;
- LzmaDec_InitDicAndState(p, True, True);
-}
-
-static void LzmaDec_InitStateReal(CLzmaDec *p)
-{
- UInt32 numProbs = Literal + ((UInt32)LZMA_LIT_SIZE << (p->prop.lc + p->prop.lp));
- UInt32 i;
- CLzmaProb *probs = p->probs;
- for (i = 0; i < numProbs; i++)
- probs[i] = kBitModelTotal >> 1;
- p->reps[0] = p->reps[1] = p->reps[2] = p->reps[3] = 1;
- p->state = 0;
- p->needInitState = 0;
-}
-
-SRes LzmaDec_DecodeToDic(CLzmaDec *p, SizeT dicLimit, const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen,
- ELzmaFinishMode finishMode, ELzmaStatus *status)
-{
- SizeT inSize = *srcLen;
- (*srcLen) = 0;
- LzmaDec_WriteRem(p, dicLimit);
-
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NOT_SPECIFIED;
-
- while (p->remainLen != kMatchSpecLenStart)
- {
- int checkEndMarkNow;
-
- if (p->needFlush != 0)
- {
- for (; inSize > 0 && p->tempBufSize < RC_INIT_SIZE; (*srcLen)++, inSize--)
- p->tempBuf[p->tempBufSize++] = *src++;
- if (p->tempBufSize < RC_INIT_SIZE)
- {
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NEEDS_MORE_INPUT;
- return SZ_OK;
- }
- if (p->tempBuf[0] != 0)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
-
- LzmaDec_InitRc(p, p->tempBuf);
- p->tempBufSize = 0;
- }
-
- checkEndMarkNow = 0;
- if (p->dicPos >= dicLimit)
- {
- if (p->remainLen == 0 && p->code == 0)
- {
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_MAYBE_FINISHED_WITHOUT_MARK;
- return SZ_OK;
- }
- if (finishMode == LZMA_FINISH_ANY)
- {
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED;
- return SZ_OK;
- }
- if (p->remainLen != 0)
- {
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED;
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- }
- checkEndMarkNow = 1;
- }
-
- if (p->needInitState)
- LzmaDec_InitStateReal(p);
-
- if (p->tempBufSize == 0)
- {
- SizeT processed;
- const Byte *bufLimit;
- if (inSize < LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX || checkEndMarkNow)
- {
- int dummyRes = LzmaDec_TryDummy(p, src, inSize);
- if (dummyRes == DUMMY_ERROR)
- {
- memcpy(p->tempBuf, src, inSize);
- p->tempBufSize = (unsigned)inSize;
- (*srcLen) += inSize;
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NEEDS_MORE_INPUT;
- return SZ_OK;
- }
- if (checkEndMarkNow && dummyRes != DUMMY_MATCH)
- {
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED;
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- }
- bufLimit = src;
- }
- else
- bufLimit = src + inSize - LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX;
- p->buf = src;
- if (LzmaDec_DecodeReal2(p, dicLimit, bufLimit) != 0)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- processed = (SizeT)(p->buf - src);
- (*srcLen) += processed;
- src += processed;
- inSize -= processed;
- }
- else
- {
- unsigned rem = p->tempBufSize, lookAhead = 0;
- while (rem < LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX && lookAhead < inSize)
- p->tempBuf[rem++] = src[lookAhead++];
- p->tempBufSize = rem;
- if (rem < LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX || checkEndMarkNow)
- {
- int dummyRes = LzmaDec_TryDummy(p, p->tempBuf, rem);
- if (dummyRes == DUMMY_ERROR)
- {
- (*srcLen) += lookAhead;
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NEEDS_MORE_INPUT;
- return SZ_OK;
- }
- if (checkEndMarkNow && dummyRes != DUMMY_MATCH)
- {
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED;
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- }
- }
- p->buf = p->tempBuf;
- if (LzmaDec_DecodeReal2(p, dicLimit, p->buf) != 0)
- return SZ_ERROR_DATA;
- lookAhead -= (rem - (unsigned)(p->buf - p->tempBuf));
- (*srcLen) += lookAhead;
- src += lookAhead;
- inSize -= lookAhead;
- p->tempBufSize = 0;
- }
- }
- if (p->code == 0)
- *status = LZMA_STATUS_FINISHED_WITH_MARK;
- return (p->code == 0) ? SZ_OK : SZ_ERROR_DATA;
-}
-
-SRes LzmaDec_DecodeToBuf(CLzmaDec *p, Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen, const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode, ELzmaStatus *status)
-{
- SizeT outSize = *destLen;
- SizeT inSize = *srcLen;
- *srcLen = *destLen = 0;
- for (;;)
- {
- SizeT inSizeCur = inSize, outSizeCur, dicPos;
- ELzmaFinishMode curFinishMode;
- SRes res;
- if (p->dicPos == p->dicBufSize)
- p->dicPos = 0;
- dicPos = p->dicPos;
- if (outSize > p->dicBufSize - dicPos)
- {
- outSizeCur = p->dicBufSize;
- curFinishMode = LZMA_FINISH_ANY;
- }
- else
- {
- outSizeCur = dicPos + outSize;
- curFinishMode = finishMode;
- }
-
- res = LzmaDec_DecodeToDic(p, outSizeCur, src, &inSizeCur, curFinishMode, status);
- src += inSizeCur;
- inSize -= inSizeCur;
- *srcLen += inSizeCur;
- outSizeCur = p->dicPos - dicPos;
- memcpy(dest, p->dic + dicPos, outSizeCur);
- dest += outSizeCur;
- outSize -= outSizeCur;
- *destLen += outSizeCur;
- if (res != 0)
- return res;
- if (outSizeCur == 0 || outSize == 0)
- return SZ_OK;
- }
-}
-
-void LzmaDec_FreeProbs(CLzmaDec *p, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- alloc->Free(alloc, p->probs);
- p->probs = 0;
-}
-
-static void LzmaDec_FreeDict(CLzmaDec *p, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- alloc->Free(alloc, p->dic);
- p->dic = 0;
-}
-
-void LzmaDec_Free(CLzmaDec *p, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- LzmaDec_FreeProbs(p, alloc);
- LzmaDec_FreeDict(p, alloc);
-}
-
-SRes LzmaProps_Decode(CLzmaProps *p, const Byte *data, unsigned size)
-{
- UInt32 dicSize;
- Byte d;
-
- if (size < LZMA_PROPS_SIZE)
- return SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED;
- else
- dicSize = data[1] | ((UInt32)data[2] << 8) | ((UInt32)data[3] << 16) | ((UInt32)data[4] << 24);
-
- if (dicSize < LZMA_DIC_MIN)
- dicSize = LZMA_DIC_MIN;
- p->dicSize = dicSize;
-
- d = data[0];
- if (d >= (9 * 5 * 5))
- return SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED;
-
- p->lc = d % 9;
- d /= 9;
- p->pb = d / 5;
- p->lp = d % 5;
-
- return SZ_OK;
-}
-
-static SRes LzmaDec_AllocateProbs2(CLzmaDec *p, const CLzmaProps *propNew, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- UInt32 numProbs = LzmaProps_GetNumProbs(propNew);
- if (p->probs == 0 || numProbs != p->numProbs)
- {
- LzmaDec_FreeProbs(p, alloc);
- p->probs = (CLzmaProb *)alloc->Alloc(alloc, numProbs * sizeof(CLzmaProb));
- p->numProbs = numProbs;
- if (p->probs == 0)
- return SZ_ERROR_MEM;
- }
- return SZ_OK;
-}
-
-SRes LzmaDec_AllocateProbs(CLzmaDec *p, const Byte *props, unsigned propsSize, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- CLzmaProps propNew;
- RINOK(LzmaProps_Decode(&propNew, props, propsSize));
- RINOK(LzmaDec_AllocateProbs2(p, &propNew, alloc));
- p->prop = propNew;
- return SZ_OK;
-}
-
-SRes LzmaDec_Allocate(CLzmaDec *p, const Byte *props, unsigned propsSize, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- CLzmaProps propNew;
- SizeT dicBufSize;
- RINOK(LzmaProps_Decode(&propNew, props, propsSize));
- RINOK(LzmaDec_AllocateProbs2(p, &propNew, alloc));
- dicBufSize = propNew.dicSize;
- if (p->dic == 0 || dicBufSize != p->dicBufSize)
- {
- LzmaDec_FreeDict(p, alloc);
- p->dic = (Byte *)alloc->Alloc(alloc, dicBufSize);
- if (p->dic == 0)
- {
- LzmaDec_FreeProbs(p, alloc);
- return SZ_ERROR_MEM;
- }
- }
- p->dicBufSize = dicBufSize;
- p->prop = propNew;
- return SZ_OK;
-}
-
-SRes LzmaDecode(Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen, const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen,
- const Byte *propData, unsigned propSize, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode,
- ELzmaStatus *status, ISzAlloc *alloc)
-{
- CLzmaDec p;
- SRes res;
- SizeT inSize = *srcLen;
- SizeT outSize = *destLen;
- *srcLen = *destLen = 0;
- if (inSize < RC_INIT_SIZE)
- return SZ_ERROR_INPUT_EOF;
-
- LzmaDec_Construct(&p);
- res = LzmaDec_AllocateProbs(&p, propData, propSize, alloc);
- if (res != 0)
- return res;
- p.dic = dest;
- p.dicBufSize = outSize;
-
- LzmaDec_Init(&p);
-
- *srcLen = inSize;
- res = LzmaDec_DecodeToDic(&p, outSize, src, srcLen, finishMode, status);
-
- if (res == SZ_OK && *status == LZMA_STATUS_NEEDS_MORE_INPUT)
- res = SZ_ERROR_INPUT_EOF;
-
- (*destLen) = p.dicPos;
- LzmaDec_FreeProbs(&p, alloc);
- return res;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzmaDec.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzmaDec.h deleted file mode 100644 index ad7d7057a4..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/LzmaDec.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,223 +0,0 @@ -/* LzmaDec.h -- LZMA Decoder
-2008-10-04 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain */
-
-#ifndef __LZMADEC_H
-#define __LZMADEC_H
-
-#include "Types.h"
-
-/* #define _LZMA_PROB32 */
-/* _LZMA_PROB32 can increase the speed on some CPUs,
- but memory usage for CLzmaDec::probs will be doubled in that case */
-
-#ifdef _LZMA_PROB32
-#define CLzmaProb UInt32
-#else
-#define CLzmaProb UInt16
-#endif
-
-
-/* ---------- LZMA Properties ---------- */
-
-#define LZMA_PROPS_SIZE 5
-
-typedef struct _CLzmaProps
-{
- unsigned lc, lp, pb;
- UInt32 dicSize;
-} CLzmaProps;
-
-/* LzmaProps_Decode - decodes properties
-Returns:
- SZ_OK
- SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED - Unsupported properties
-*/
-
-SRes LzmaProps_Decode(CLzmaProps *p, const Byte *data, unsigned size);
-
-
-/* ---------- LZMA Decoder state ---------- */
-
-/* LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX = number of required input bytes for worst case.
- Num bits = log2((2^11 / 31) ^ 22) + 26 < 134 + 26 = 160; */
-
-#define LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX 20
-
-typedef struct
-{
- CLzmaProps prop;
- CLzmaProb *probs;
- Byte *dic;
- const Byte *buf;
- UInt32 range, code;
- SizeT dicPos;
- SizeT dicBufSize;
- UInt32 processedPos;
- UInt32 checkDicSize;
- unsigned state;
- UInt32 reps[4];
- unsigned remainLen;
- int needFlush;
- int needInitState;
- UInt32 numProbs;
- unsigned tempBufSize;
- Byte tempBuf[LZMA_REQUIRED_INPUT_MAX];
-} CLzmaDec;
-
-#define LzmaDec_Construct(p) { (p)->dic = 0; (p)->probs = 0; }
-
-void LzmaDec_Init(CLzmaDec *p);
-
-/* There are two types of LZMA streams:
- 0) Stream with end mark. That end mark adds about 6 bytes to compressed size.
- 1) Stream without end mark. You must know exact uncompressed size to decompress such stream. */
-
-typedef enum
-{
- LZMA_FINISH_ANY, /* finish at any point */
- LZMA_FINISH_END /* block must be finished at the end */
-} ELzmaFinishMode;
-
-/* ELzmaFinishMode has meaning only if the decoding reaches output limit !!!
-
- You must use LZMA_FINISH_END, when you know that current output buffer
- covers last bytes of block. In other cases you must use LZMA_FINISH_ANY.
-
- If LZMA decoder sees end marker before reaching output limit, it returns SZ_OK,
- and output value of destLen will be less than output buffer size limit.
- You can check status result also.
-
- You can use multiple checks to test data integrity after full decompression:
- 1) Check Result and "status" variable.
- 2) Check that output(destLen) = uncompressedSize, if you know real uncompressedSize.
- 3) Check that output(srcLen) = compressedSize, if you know real compressedSize.
- You must use correct finish mode in that case. */
-
-typedef enum
-{
- LZMA_STATUS_NOT_SPECIFIED, /* use main error code instead */
- LZMA_STATUS_FINISHED_WITH_MARK, /* stream was finished with end mark. */
- LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED, /* stream was not finished */
- LZMA_STATUS_NEEDS_MORE_INPUT, /* you must provide more input bytes */
- LZMA_STATUS_MAYBE_FINISHED_WITHOUT_MARK /* there is probability that stream was finished without end mark */
-} ELzmaStatus;
-
-/* ELzmaStatus is used only as output value for function call */
-
-
-/* ---------- Interfaces ---------- */
-
-/* There are 3 levels of interfaces:
- 1) Dictionary Interface
- 2) Buffer Interface
- 3) One Call Interface
- You can select any of these interfaces, but don't mix functions from different
- groups for same object. */
-
-
-/* There are two variants to allocate state for Dictionary Interface:
- 1) LzmaDec_Allocate / LzmaDec_Free
- 2) LzmaDec_AllocateProbs / LzmaDec_FreeProbs
- You can use variant 2, if you set dictionary buffer manually.
- For Buffer Interface you must always use variant 1.
-
-LzmaDec_Allocate* can return:
- SZ_OK
- SZ_ERROR_MEM - Memory allocation error
- SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED - Unsupported properties
-*/
-
-SRes LzmaDec_AllocateProbs(CLzmaDec *p, const Byte *props, unsigned propsSize, ISzAlloc *alloc);
-void LzmaDec_FreeProbs(CLzmaDec *p, ISzAlloc *alloc);
-
-SRes LzmaDec_Allocate(CLzmaDec *state, const Byte *prop, unsigned propsSize, ISzAlloc *alloc);
-void LzmaDec_Free(CLzmaDec *state, ISzAlloc *alloc);
-
-/* ---------- Dictionary Interface ---------- */
-
-/* You can use it, if you want to eliminate the overhead for data copying from
- dictionary to some other external buffer.
- You must work with CLzmaDec variables directly in this interface.
-
- STEPS:
- LzmaDec_Constr()
- LzmaDec_Allocate()
- for (each new stream)
- {
- LzmaDec_Init()
- while (it needs more decompression)
- {
- LzmaDec_DecodeToDic()
- use data from CLzmaDec::dic and update CLzmaDec::dicPos
- }
- }
- LzmaDec_Free()
-*/
-
-/* LzmaDec_DecodeToDic
-
- The decoding to internal dictionary buffer (CLzmaDec::dic).
- You must manually update CLzmaDec::dicPos, if it reaches CLzmaDec::dicBufSize !!!
-
-finishMode:
- It has meaning only if the decoding reaches output limit (dicLimit).
- LZMA_FINISH_ANY - Decode just dicLimit bytes.
- LZMA_FINISH_END - Stream must be finished after dicLimit.
-
-Returns:
- SZ_OK
- status:
- LZMA_STATUS_FINISHED_WITH_MARK
- LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED
- LZMA_STATUS_NEEDS_MORE_INPUT
- LZMA_STATUS_MAYBE_FINISHED_WITHOUT_MARK
- SZ_ERROR_DATA - Data error
-*/
-
-SRes LzmaDec_DecodeToDic(CLzmaDec *p, SizeT dicLimit,
- const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode, ELzmaStatus *status);
-
-
-/* ---------- Buffer Interface ---------- */
-
-/* It's zlib-like interface.
- See LzmaDec_DecodeToDic description for information about STEPS and return results,
- but you must use LzmaDec_DecodeToBuf instead of LzmaDec_DecodeToDic and you don't need
- to work with CLzmaDec variables manually.
-
-finishMode:
- It has meaning only if the decoding reaches output limit (*destLen).
- LZMA_FINISH_ANY - Decode just destLen bytes.
- LZMA_FINISH_END - Stream must be finished after (*destLen).
-*/
-
-SRes LzmaDec_DecodeToBuf(CLzmaDec *p, Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen,
- const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode, ELzmaStatus *status);
-
-
-/* ---------- One Call Interface ---------- */
-
-/* LzmaDecode
-
-finishMode:
- It has meaning only if the decoding reaches output limit (*destLen).
- LZMA_FINISH_ANY - Decode just destLen bytes.
- LZMA_FINISH_END - Stream must be finished after (*destLen).
-
-Returns:
- SZ_OK
- status:
- LZMA_STATUS_FINISHED_WITH_MARK
- LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED
- LZMA_STATUS_MAYBE_FINISHED_WITHOUT_MARK
- SZ_ERROR_DATA - Data error
- SZ_ERROR_MEM - Memory allocation error
- SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED - Unsupported properties
- SZ_ERROR_INPUT_EOF - It needs more bytes in input buffer (src).
-*/
-
-SRes LzmaDecode(Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen, const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen,
- const Byte *propData, unsigned propSize, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode,
- ELzmaStatus *status, ISzAlloc *alloc);
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Types.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Types.h deleted file mode 100644 index 30b16e3bb0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/C/Types.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,231 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Types.h
-
- Based on LZMA SDK 4.65:
- Types.h -- Basic types
- 2008-11-23 : Igor Pavlov : Public domain
-
- Copyright (c) 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef __7Z_TYPES_H
-#define __7Z_TYPES_H
-
-#ifdef EFIAPI
-
-#include "UefiLzma.h"
-
-#else
-
-#include <stddef.h>
-
-#ifdef _WIN32
-#include <windows.h>
-#endif
-
-#endif
-
-#define SZ_OK 0
-
-#define SZ_ERROR_DATA 1
-#define SZ_ERROR_MEM 2
-#define SZ_ERROR_CRC 3
-#define SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED 4
-#define SZ_ERROR_PARAM 5
-#define SZ_ERROR_INPUT_EOF 6
-#define SZ_ERROR_OUTPUT_EOF 7
-#define SZ_ERROR_READ 8
-#define SZ_ERROR_WRITE 9
-#define SZ_ERROR_PROGRESS 10
-#define SZ_ERROR_FAIL 11
-#define SZ_ERROR_THREAD 12
-
-#define SZ_ERROR_ARCHIVE 16
-#define SZ_ERROR_NO_ARCHIVE 17
-
-typedef int SRes;
-
-#ifdef _WIN32
-typedef DWORD WRes;
-#else
-typedef int WRes;
-#endif
-
-#ifndef RINOK
-#define RINOK(x) { int __result__ = (x); if (__result__ != 0) return __result__; }
-#endif
-
-typedef unsigned char Byte;
-typedef short Int16;
-typedef unsigned short UInt16;
-
-#ifdef _LZMA_UINT32_IS_ULONG
-typedef long Int32;
-typedef unsigned long UInt32;
-#else
-typedef int Int32;
-typedef unsigned int UInt32;
-#endif
-
-#ifdef _SZ_NO_INT_64
-
-/* define _SZ_NO_INT_64, if your compiler doesn't support 64-bit integers.
- NOTES: Some code will work incorrectly in that case! */
-
-typedef long Int64;
-typedef unsigned long UInt64;
-
-#else
-
-#if defined(_MSC_VER) || defined(__BORLANDC__)
-typedef __int64 Int64;
-typedef unsigned __int64 UInt64;
-#else
-typedef long long int Int64;
-typedef unsigned long long int UInt64;
-#endif
-
-#endif
-
-#ifdef _LZMA_NO_SYSTEM_SIZE_T
-typedef UInt32 SizeT;
-#else
-typedef size_t SizeT;
-#endif
-
-typedef int Bool;
-#define True 1
-#define False 0
-
-
-#ifdef _MSC_VER
-
-#if _MSC_VER >= 1300
-#define MY_NO_INLINE __declspec(noinline)
-#else
-#define MY_NO_INLINE
-#endif
-
-#define MY_CDECL __cdecl
-#define MY_STD_CALL __stdcall
-#define MY_FAST_CALL MY_NO_INLINE __fastcall
-
-#else
-
-#define MY_CDECL
-#define MY_STD_CALL
-#define MY_FAST_CALL
-
-#endif
-
-
-/* The following interfaces use first parameter as pointer to structure */
-
-typedef struct
-{
- SRes (*Read)(void *p, void *buf, size_t *size);
- /* if (input(*size) != 0 && output(*size) == 0) means end_of_stream.
- (output(*size) < input(*size)) is allowed */
-} ISeqInStream;
-
-/* it can return SZ_ERROR_INPUT_EOF */
-SRes SeqInStream_Read(ISeqInStream *stream, void *buf, size_t size);
-SRes SeqInStream_Read2(ISeqInStream *stream, void *buf, size_t size, SRes errorType);
-SRes SeqInStream_ReadByte(ISeqInStream *stream, Byte *buf);
-
-typedef struct
-{
- size_t (*Write)(void *p, const void *buf, size_t size);
- /* Returns: result - the number of actually written bytes.
- (result < size) means error */
-} ISeqOutStream;
-
-typedef enum
-{
- SZ_SEEK_SET = 0,
- SZ_SEEK_CUR = 1,
- SZ_SEEK_END = 2
-} ESzSeek;
-
-typedef struct
-{
- SRes (*Read)(void *p, void *buf, size_t *size); /* same as ISeqInStream::Read */
- SRes (*Seek)(void *p, Int64 *pos, ESzSeek origin);
-} ISeekInStream;
-
-typedef struct
-{
- SRes (*Look)(void *p, void **buf, size_t *size);
- /* if (input(*size) != 0 && output(*size) == 0) means end_of_stream.
- (output(*size) > input(*size)) is not allowed
- (output(*size) < input(*size)) is allowed */
- SRes (*Skip)(void *p, size_t offset);
- /* offset must be <= output(*size) of Look */
-
- SRes (*Read)(void *p, void *buf, size_t *size);
- /* reads directly (without buffer). It's same as ISeqInStream::Read */
- SRes (*Seek)(void *p, Int64 *pos, ESzSeek origin);
-} ILookInStream;
-
-SRes LookInStream_LookRead(ILookInStream *stream, void *buf, size_t *size);
-SRes LookInStream_SeekTo(ILookInStream *stream, UInt64 offset);
-
-/* reads via ILookInStream::Read */
-SRes LookInStream_Read2(ILookInStream *stream, void *buf, size_t size, SRes errorType);
-SRes LookInStream_Read(ILookInStream *stream, void *buf, size_t size);
-
-#define LookToRead_BUF_SIZE (1 << 14)
-
-typedef struct
-{
- ILookInStream s;
- ISeekInStream *realStream;
- size_t pos;
- size_t size;
- Byte buf[LookToRead_BUF_SIZE];
-} CLookToRead;
-
-void LookToRead_CreateVTable(CLookToRead *p, int lookahead);
-void LookToRead_Init(CLookToRead *p);
-
-typedef struct
-{
- ISeqInStream s;
- ILookInStream *realStream;
-} CSecToLook;
-
-void SecToLook_CreateVTable(CSecToLook *p);
-
-typedef struct
-{
- ISeqInStream s;
- ILookInStream *realStream;
-} CSecToRead;
-
-void SecToRead_CreateVTable(CSecToRead *p);
-
-typedef struct
-{
- SRes (*Progress)(void *p, UInt64 inSize, UInt64 outSize);
- /* Returns: result. (result != SZ_OK) means break.
- Value (UInt64)(Int64)-1 for size means unknown value. */
-} ICompressProgress;
-
-typedef struct
-{
- void *(*Alloc)(void *p, size_t size);
- void (*Free)(void *p, void *address); /* address can be 0 */
-} ISzAlloc;
-
-#define IAlloc_Alloc(p, size) (p)->Alloc((p), size)
-#define IAlloc_Free(p, a) (p)->Free((p), a)
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/history.txt b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/history.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 9bed5ebbef..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/history.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,236 +0,0 @@ -HISTORY of the LZMA SDK
------------------------
-
-4.65 2009-02-03
--------------------------
-- Some minor fixes
-
-
-4.63 2008-12-31
--------------------------
-- Some minor fixes
-
-
-4.61 beta 2008-11-23
--------------------------
-- The bug in ANSI-C LZMA Decoder was fixed:
- If encoded stream was corrupted, decoder could access memory
- outside of allocated range.
-- Some changes in ANSI-C 7z Decoder interfaces.
-- LZMA SDK is placed in the public domain.
-
-
-4.60 beta 2008-08-19
--------------------------
-- Some minor fixes.
-
-
-4.59 beta 2008-08-13
--------------------------
-- The bug was fixed:
- LZMA Encoder in fast compression mode could access memory outside of
- allocated range in some rare cases.
-
-
-4.58 beta 2008-05-05
--------------------------
-- ANSI-C LZMA Decoder was rewritten for speed optimizations.
-- ANSI-C LZMA Encoder was included to LZMA SDK.
-- C++ LZMA code now is just wrapper over ANSI-C code.
-
-
-4.57 2007-12-12
--------------------------
-- Speed optimizations in Ñ++ LZMA Decoder.
-- Small changes for more compatibility with some C/C++ compilers.
-
-
-4.49 beta 2007-07-05
--------------------------
-- .7z ANSI-C Decoder:
- - now it supports BCJ and BCJ2 filters
- - now it supports files larger than 4 GB.
- - now it supports "Last Write Time" field for files.
-- C++ code for .7z archives compressing/decompressing from 7-zip
- was included to LZMA SDK.
-
-
-4.43 2006-06-04
--------------------------
-- Small changes for more compatibility with some C/C++ compilers.
-
-
-4.42 2006-05-15
--------------------------
-- Small changes in .h files in ANSI-C version.
-
-
-4.39 beta 2006-04-14
--------------------------
-- The bug in versions 4.33b:4.38b was fixed:
- C++ version of LZMA encoder could not correctly compress
- files larger than 2 GB with HC4 match finder (-mfhc4).
-
-
-4.37 beta 2005-04-06
--------------------------
-- Fixes in C++ code: code could no be compiled if _NO_EXCEPTIONS was defined.
-
-
-4.35 beta 2005-03-02
--------------------------
-- The bug was fixed in C++ version of LZMA Decoder:
- If encoded stream was corrupted, decoder could access memory
- outside of allocated range.
-
-
-4.34 beta 2006-02-27
--------------------------
-- Compressing speed and memory requirements for compressing were increased
-- LZMA now can use only these match finders: HC4, BT2, BT3, BT4
-
-
-4.32 2005-12-09
--------------------------
-- Java version of LZMA SDK was included
-
-
-4.30 2005-11-20
--------------------------
-- Compression ratio was improved in -a2 mode
-- Speed optimizations for compressing in -a2 mode
-- -fb switch now supports values up to 273
-- The bug in 7z_C (7zIn.c) was fixed:
- It used Alloc/Free functions from different memory pools.
- So if program used two memory pools, it worked incorrectly.
-- 7z_C: .7z format supporting was improved
-- LZMA# SDK (C#.NET version) was included
-
-
-4.27 (Updated) 2005-09-21
--------------------------
-- Some GUIDs/interfaces in C++ were changed.
- IStream.h:
- ISequentialInStream::Read now works as old ReadPart
- ISequentialOutStream::Write now works as old WritePart
-
-
-4.27 2005-08-07
--------------------------
-- The bug in LzmaDecodeSize.c was fixed:
- if _LZMA_IN_CB and _LZMA_OUT_READ were defined,
- decompressing worked incorrectly.
-
-
-4.26 2005-08-05
--------------------------
-- Fixes in 7z_C code and LzmaTest.c:
- previous versions could work incorrectly,
- if malloc(0) returns 0
-
-
-4.23 2005-06-29
--------------------------
-- Small fixes in C++ code
-
-
-4.22 2005-06-10
--------------------------
-- Small fixes
-
-
-4.21 2005-06-08
--------------------------
-- Interfaces for ANSI-C LZMA Decoder (LzmaDecode.c) were changed
-- New additional version of ANSI-C LZMA Decoder with zlib-like interface:
- - LzmaStateDecode.h
- - LzmaStateDecode.c
- - LzmaStateTest.c
-- ANSI-C LZMA Decoder now can decompress files larger than 4 GB
-
-
-4.17 2005-04-18
--------------------------
-- New example for RAM->RAM compressing/decompressing:
- LZMA + BCJ (filter for x86 code):
- - LzmaRam.h
- - LzmaRam.cpp
- - LzmaRamDecode.h
- - LzmaRamDecode.c
- - -f86 switch for lzma.exe
-
-
-4.16 2005-03-29
--------------------------
-- The bug was fixed in LzmaDecode.c (ANSI-C LZMA Decoder):
- If _LZMA_OUT_READ was defined, and if encoded stream was corrupted,
- decoder could access memory outside of allocated range.
-- Speed optimization of ANSI-C LZMA Decoder (now it's about 20% faster).
- Old version of LZMA Decoder now is in file LzmaDecodeSize.c.
- LzmaDecodeSize.c can provide slightly smaller code than LzmaDecode.c
-- Small speed optimization in LZMA C++ code
-- filter for SPARC's code was added
-- Simplified version of .7z ANSI-C Decoder was included
-
-
-4.06 2004-09-05
--------------------------
-- The bug in v4.05 was fixed:
- LZMA-Encoder didn't release output stream in some cases.
-
-
-4.05 2004-08-25
--------------------------
-- Source code of filters for x86, IA-64, ARM, ARM-Thumb
- and PowerPC code was included to SDK
-- Some internal minor changes
-
-
-4.04 2004-07-28
--------------------------
-- More compatibility with some C++ compilers
-
-
-4.03 2004-06-18
--------------------------
-- "Benchmark" command was added. It measures compressing
- and decompressing speed and shows rating values.
- Also it checks hardware errors.
-
-
-4.02 2004-06-10
--------------------------
-- C++ LZMA Encoder/Decoder code now is more portable
- and it can be compiled by GCC on Linux.
-
-
-4.01 2004-02-15
--------------------------
-- Some detection of data corruption was enabled.
- LzmaDecode.c / RangeDecoderReadByte
- .....
- {
- rd->ExtraBytes = 1;
- return 0xFF;
- }
-
-
-4.00 2004-02-13
--------------------------
-- Original version of LZMA SDK
-
-
-
-HISTORY of the LZMA
--------------------
- 2001-2008: Improvements to LZMA compressing/decompressing code,
- keeping compatibility with original LZMA format
- 1996-2001: Development of LZMA compression format
-
- Some milestones:
-
- 2001-08-30: LZMA compression was added to 7-Zip
- 1999-01-02: First version of 7-Zip was released
-
-
-End of document
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/lzma.txt b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/lzma.txt deleted file mode 100644 index d4f4af929a..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/Sdk/lzma.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,594 +0,0 @@ -LZMA SDK 4.65
--------------
-
-LZMA SDK provides the documentation, samples, header files, libraries,
-and tools you need to develop applications that use LZMA compression.
-
-LZMA is default and general compression method of 7z format
-in 7-Zip compression program (www.7-zip.org). LZMA provides high
-compression ratio and very fast decompression.
-
-LZMA is an improved version of famous LZ77 compression algorithm.
-It was improved in way of maximum increasing of compression ratio,
-keeping high decompression speed and low memory requirements for
-decompressing.
-
-
-
-LICENSE
--------
-
-LZMA SDK is written and placed in the public domain by Igor Pavlov.
-
-
-LZMA SDK Contents
------------------
-
-LZMA SDK includes:
-
- - ANSI-C/C++/C#/Java source code for LZMA compressing and decompressing
- - Compiled file->file LZMA compressing/decompressing program for Windows system
-
-
-UNIX/Linux version
-------------------
-To compile C++ version of file->file LZMA encoding, go to directory
-C++/7zip/Compress/LZMA_Alone
-and call make to recompile it:
- make -f makefile.gcc clean all
-
-In some UNIX/Linux versions you must compile LZMA with static libraries.
-To compile with static libraries, you can use
-LIB = -lm -static
-
-
-Files
----------------------
-lzma.txt - LZMA SDK description (this file)
-7zFormat.txt - 7z Format description
-7zC.txt - 7z ANSI-C Decoder description
-methods.txt - Compression method IDs for .7z
-lzma.exe - Compiled file->file LZMA encoder/decoder for Windows
-history.txt - history of the LZMA SDK
-
-
-Source code structure
----------------------
-
-C/ - C files
- 7zCrc*.* - CRC code
- Alloc.* - Memory allocation functions
- Bra*.* - Filters for x86, IA-64, ARM, ARM-Thumb, PowerPC and SPARC code
- LzFind.* - Match finder for LZ (LZMA) encoders
- LzFindMt.* - Match finder for LZ (LZMA) encoders for multithreading encoding
- LzHash.h - Additional file for LZ match finder
- LzmaDec.* - LZMA decoding
- LzmaEnc.* - LZMA encoding
- LzmaLib.* - LZMA Library for DLL calling
- Types.h - Basic types for another .c files
- Threads.* - The code for multithreading.
-
- LzmaLib - LZMA Library (.DLL for Windows)
-
- LzmaUtil - LZMA Utility (file->file LZMA encoder/decoder).
-
- Archive - files related to archiving
- 7z - 7z ANSI-C Decoder
-
-CPP/ -- CPP files
-
- Common - common files for C++ projects
- Windows - common files for Windows related code
-
- 7zip - files related to 7-Zip Project
-
- Common - common files for 7-Zip
-
- Compress - files related to compression/decompression
-
- Copy - Copy coder
- RangeCoder - Range Coder (special code of compression/decompression)
- LZMA - LZMA compression/decompression on C++
- LZMA_Alone - file->file LZMA compression/decompression
- Branch - Filters for x86, IA-64, ARM, ARM-Thumb, PowerPC and SPARC code
-
- Archive - files related to archiving
-
- Common - common files for archive handling
- 7z - 7z C++ Encoder/Decoder
-
- Bundles - Modules that are bundles of other modules
-
- Alone7z - 7zr.exe: Standalone version of 7z.exe that supports only 7z/LZMA/BCJ/BCJ2
- Format7zR - 7zr.dll: Reduced version of 7za.dll: extracting/compressing to 7z/LZMA/BCJ/BCJ2
- Format7zExtractR - 7zxr.dll: Reduced version of 7zxa.dll: extracting from 7z/LZMA/BCJ/BCJ2.
-
- UI - User Interface files
-
- Client7z - Test application for 7za.dll, 7zr.dll, 7zxr.dll
- Common - Common UI files
- Console - Code for console archiver
-
-
-
-CS/ - C# files
- 7zip
- Common - some common files for 7-Zip
- Compress - files related to compression/decompression
- LZ - files related to LZ (Lempel-Ziv) compression algorithm
- LZMA - LZMA compression/decompression
- LzmaAlone - file->file LZMA compression/decompression
- RangeCoder - Range Coder (special code of compression/decompression)
-
-Java/ - Java files
- SevenZip
- Compression - files related to compression/decompression
- LZ - files related to LZ (Lempel-Ziv) compression algorithm
- LZMA - LZMA compression/decompression
- RangeCoder - Range Coder (special code of compression/decompression)
-
-
-C/C++ source code of LZMA SDK is part of 7-Zip project.
-7-Zip source code can be downloaded from 7-Zip's SourceForge page:
-
- http://sourceforge.net/projects/sevenzip/
-
-
-
-LZMA features
--------------
- - Variable dictionary size (up to 1 GB)
- - Estimated compressing speed: about 2 MB/s on 2 GHz CPU
- - Estimated decompressing speed:
- - 20-30 MB/s on 2 GHz Core 2 or AMD Athlon 64
- - 1-2 MB/s on 200 MHz ARM, MIPS, PowerPC or other simple RISC
- - Small memory requirements for decompressing (16 KB + DictionarySize)
- - Small code size for decompressing: 5-8 KB
-
-LZMA decoder uses only integer operations and can be
-implemented in any modern 32-bit CPU (or on 16-bit CPU with some conditions).
-
-Some critical operations that affect the speed of LZMA decompression:
- 1) 32*16 bit integer multiply
- 2) Misspredicted branches (penalty mostly depends from pipeline length)
- 3) 32-bit shift and arithmetic operations
-
-The speed of LZMA decompressing mostly depends from CPU speed.
-Memory speed has no big meaning. But if your CPU has small data cache,
-overall weight of memory speed will slightly increase.
-
-
-How To Use
-----------
-
-Using LZMA encoder/decoder executable
---------------------------------------
-
-Usage: LZMA <e|d> inputFile outputFile [<switches>...]
-
- e: encode file
-
- d: decode file
-
- b: Benchmark. There are two tests: compressing and decompressing
- with LZMA method. Benchmark shows rating in MIPS (million
- instructions per second). Rating value is calculated from
- measured speed and it is normalized with Intel's Core 2 results.
- Also Benchmark checks possible hardware errors (RAM
- errors in most cases). Benchmark uses these settings:
- (-a1, -d21, -fb32, -mfbt4). You can change only -d parameter.
- Also you can change the number of iterations. Example for 30 iterations:
- LZMA b 30
- Default number of iterations is 10.
-
-<Switches>
-
-
- -a{N}: set compression mode 0 = fast, 1 = normal
- default: 1 (normal)
-
- d{N}: Sets Dictionary size - [0, 30], default: 23 (8MB)
- The maximum value for dictionary size is 1 GB = 2^30 bytes.
- Dictionary size is calculated as DictionarySize = 2^N bytes.
- For decompressing file compressed by LZMA method with dictionary
- size D = 2^N you need about D bytes of memory (RAM).
-
- -fb{N}: set number of fast bytes - [5, 273], default: 128
- Usually big number gives a little bit better compression ratio
- and slower compression process.
-
- -lc{N}: set number of literal context bits - [0, 8], default: 3
- Sometimes lc=4 gives gain for big files.
-
- -lp{N}: set number of literal pos bits - [0, 4], default: 0
- lp switch is intended for periodical data when period is
- equal 2^N. For example, for 32-bit (4 bytes)
- periodical data you can use lp=2. Often it's better to set lc0,
- if you change lp switch.
-
- -pb{N}: set number of pos bits - [0, 4], default: 2
- pb switch is intended for periodical data
- when period is equal 2^N.
-
- -mf{MF_ID}: set Match Finder. Default: bt4.
- Algorithms from hc* group doesn't provide good compression
- ratio, but they often works pretty fast in combination with
- fast mode (-a0).
-
- Memory requirements depend from dictionary size
- (parameter "d" in table below).
-
- MF_ID Memory Description
-
- bt2 d * 9.5 + 4MB Binary Tree with 2 bytes hashing.
- bt3 d * 11.5 + 4MB Binary Tree with 3 bytes hashing.
- bt4 d * 11.5 + 4MB Binary Tree with 4 bytes hashing.
- hc4 d * 7.5 + 4MB Hash Chain with 4 bytes hashing.
-
- -eos: write End Of Stream marker. By default LZMA doesn't write
- eos marker, since LZMA decoder knows uncompressed size
- stored in .lzma file header.
-
- -si: Read data from stdin (it will write End Of Stream marker).
- -so: Write data to stdout
-
-
-Examples:
-
-1) LZMA e file.bin file.lzma -d16 -lc0
-
-compresses file.bin to file.lzma with 64 KB dictionary (2^16=64K)
-and 0 literal context bits. -lc0 allows to reduce memory requirements
-for decompression.
-
-
-2) LZMA e file.bin file.lzma -lc0 -lp2
-
-compresses file.bin to file.lzma with settings suitable
-for 32-bit periodical data (for example, ARM or MIPS code).
-
-3) LZMA d file.lzma file.bin
-
-decompresses file.lzma to file.bin.
-
-
-Compression ratio hints
------------------------
-
-Recommendations
----------------
-
-To increase the compression ratio for LZMA compressing it's desirable
-to have aligned data (if it's possible) and also it's desirable to locate
-data in such order, where code is grouped in one place and data is
-grouped in other place (it's better than such mixing: code, data, code,
-data, ...).
-
-
-Filters
--------
-You can increase the compression ratio for some data types, using
-special filters before compressing. For example, it's possible to
-increase the compression ratio on 5-10% for code for those CPU ISAs:
-x86, IA-64, ARM, ARM-Thumb, PowerPC, SPARC.
-
-You can find C source code of such filters in C/Bra*.* files
-
-You can check the compression ratio gain of these filters with such
-7-Zip commands (example for ARM code):
-No filter:
- 7z a a1.7z a.bin -m0=lzma
-
-With filter for little-endian ARM code:
- 7z a a2.7z a.bin -m0=arm -m1=lzma
-
-It works in such manner:
-Compressing = Filter_encoding + LZMA_encoding
-Decompressing = LZMA_decoding + Filter_decoding
-
-Compressing and decompressing speed of such filters is very high,
-so it will not increase decompressing time too much.
-Moreover, it reduces decompression time for LZMA_decoding,
-since compression ratio with filtering is higher.
-
-These filters convert CALL (calling procedure) instructions
-from relative offsets to absolute addresses, so such data becomes more
-compressible.
-
-For some ISAs (for example, for MIPS) it's impossible to get gain from such filter.
-
-
-LZMA compressed file format
----------------------------
-Offset Size Description
- 0 1 Special LZMA properties (lc,lp, pb in encoded form)
- 1 4 Dictionary size (little endian)
- 5 8 Uncompressed size (little endian). -1 means unknown size
- 13 Compressed data
-
-
-ANSI-C LZMA Decoder
-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
-
-Please note that interfaces for ANSI-C code were changed in LZMA SDK 4.58.
-If you want to use old interfaces you can download previous version of LZMA SDK
-from sourceforge.net site.
-
-To use ANSI-C LZMA Decoder you need the following files:
-1) LzmaDec.h + LzmaDec.c + Types.h
-LzmaUtil/LzmaUtil.c is example application that uses these files.
-
-
-Memory requirements for LZMA decoding
--------------------------------------
-
-Stack usage of LZMA decoding function for local variables is not
-larger than 200-400 bytes.
-
-LZMA Decoder uses dictionary buffer and internal state structure.
-Internal state structure consumes
- state_size = (4 + (1.5 << (lc + lp))) KB
-by default (lc=3, lp=0), state_size = 16 KB.
-
-
-How To decompress data
-----------------------
-
-LZMA Decoder (ANSI-C version) now supports 2 interfaces:
-1) Single-call Decompressing
-2) Multi-call State Decompressing (zlib-like interface)
-
-You must use external allocator:
-Example:
-void *SzAlloc(void *p, size_t size) { p = p; return malloc(size); }
-void SzFree(void *p, void *address) { p = p; free(address); }
-ISzAlloc alloc = { SzAlloc, SzFree };
-
-You can use p = p; operator to disable compiler warnings.
-
-
-Single-call Decompressing
--------------------------
-When to use: RAM->RAM decompressing
-Compile files: LzmaDec.h + LzmaDec.c + Types.h
-Compile defines: no defines
-Memory Requirements:
- - Input buffer: compressed size
- - Output buffer: uncompressed size
- - LZMA Internal Structures: state_size (16 KB for default settings)
-
-Interface:
- int LzmaDecode(Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen, const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen,
- const Byte *propData, unsigned propSize, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode,
- ELzmaStatus *status, ISzAlloc *alloc);
- In:
- dest - output data
- destLen - output data size
- src - input data
- srcLen - input data size
- propData - LZMA properties (5 bytes)
- propSize - size of propData buffer (5 bytes)
- finishMode - It has meaning only if the decoding reaches output limit (*destLen).
- LZMA_FINISH_ANY - Decode just destLen bytes.
- LZMA_FINISH_END - Stream must be finished after (*destLen).
- You can use LZMA_FINISH_END, when you know that
- current output buffer covers last bytes of stream.
- alloc - Memory allocator.
-
- Out:
- destLen - processed output size
- srcLen - processed input size
-
- Output:
- SZ_OK
- status:
- LZMA_STATUS_FINISHED_WITH_MARK
- LZMA_STATUS_NOT_FINISHED
- LZMA_STATUS_MAYBE_FINISHED_WITHOUT_MARK
- SZ_ERROR_DATA - Data error
- SZ_ERROR_MEM - Memory allocation error
- SZ_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED - Unsupported properties
- SZ_ERROR_INPUT_EOF - It needs more bytes in input buffer (src).
-
- If LZMA decoder sees end_marker before reaching output limit, it returns OK result,
- and output value of destLen will be less than output buffer size limit.
-
- You can use multiple checks to test data integrity after full decompression:
- 1) Check Result and "status" variable.
- 2) Check that output(destLen) = uncompressedSize, if you know real uncompressedSize.
- 3) Check that output(srcLen) = compressedSize, if you know real compressedSize.
- You must use correct finish mode in that case. */
-
-
-Multi-call State Decompressing (zlib-like interface)
-----------------------------------------------------
-
-When to use: file->file decompressing
-Compile files: LzmaDec.h + LzmaDec.c + Types.h
-
-Memory Requirements:
- - Buffer for input stream: any size (for example, 16 KB)
- - Buffer for output stream: any size (for example, 16 KB)
- - LZMA Internal Structures: state_size (16 KB for default settings)
- - LZMA dictionary (dictionary size is encoded in LZMA properties header)
-
-1) read LZMA properties (5 bytes) and uncompressed size (8 bytes, little-endian) to header:
- unsigned char header[LZMA_PROPS_SIZE + 8];
- ReadFile(inFile, header, sizeof(header)
-
-2) Allocate CLzmaDec structures (state + dictionary) using LZMA properties
-
- CLzmaDec state;
- LzmaDec_Constr(&state);
- res = LzmaDec_Allocate(&state, header, LZMA_PROPS_SIZE, &g_Alloc);
- if (res != SZ_OK)
- return res;
-
-3) Init LzmaDec structure before any new LZMA stream. And call LzmaDec_DecodeToBuf in loop
-
- LzmaDec_Init(&state);
- for (;;)
- {
- ...
- int res = LzmaDec_DecodeToBuf(CLzmaDec *p, Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen,
- const Byte *src, SizeT *srcLen, ELzmaFinishMode finishMode);
- ...
- }
-
-
-4) Free all allocated structures
- LzmaDec_Free(&state, &g_Alloc);
-
-For full code example, look at C/LzmaUtil/LzmaUtil.c code.
-
-
-How To compress data
---------------------
-
-Compile files: LzmaEnc.h + LzmaEnc.c + Types.h +
-LzFind.c + LzFind.h + LzFindMt.c + LzFindMt.h + LzHash.h
-
-Memory Requirements:
- - (dictSize * 11.5 + 6 MB) + state_size
-
-Lzma Encoder can use two memory allocators:
-1) alloc - for small arrays.
-2) allocBig - for big arrays.
-
-For example, you can use Large RAM Pages (2 MB) in allocBig allocator for
-better compression speed. Note that Windows has bad implementation for
-Large RAM Pages.
-It's OK to use same allocator for alloc and allocBig.
-
-
-Single-call Compression with callbacks
---------------------------------------
-
-Check C/LzmaUtil/LzmaUtil.c as example,
-
-When to use: file->file decompressing
-
-1) you must implement callback structures for interfaces:
-ISeqInStream
-ISeqOutStream
-ICompressProgress
-ISzAlloc
-
-static void *SzAlloc(void *p, size_t size) { p = p; return MyAlloc(size); }
-static void SzFree(void *p, void *address) { p = p; MyFree(address); }
-static ISzAlloc g_Alloc = { SzAlloc, SzFree };
-
- CFileSeqInStream inStream;
- CFileSeqOutStream outStream;
-
- inStream.funcTable.Read = MyRead;
- inStream.file = inFile;
- outStream.funcTable.Write = MyWrite;
- outStream.file = outFile;
-
-
-2) Create CLzmaEncHandle object;
-
- CLzmaEncHandle enc;
-
- enc = LzmaEnc_Create(&g_Alloc);
- if (enc == 0)
- return SZ_ERROR_MEM;
-
-
-3) initialize CLzmaEncProps properties;
-
- LzmaEncProps_Init(&props);
-
- Then you can change some properties in that structure.
-
-4) Send LZMA properties to LZMA Encoder
-
- res = LzmaEnc_SetProps(enc, &props);
-
-5) Write encoded properties to header
-
- Byte header[LZMA_PROPS_SIZE + 8];
- size_t headerSize = LZMA_PROPS_SIZE;
- UInt64 fileSize;
- int i;
-
- res = LzmaEnc_WriteProperties(enc, header, &headerSize);
- fileSize = MyGetFileLength(inFile);
- for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
- header[headerSize++] = (Byte)(fileSize >> (8 * i));
- MyWriteFileAndCheck(outFile, header, headerSize)
-
-6) Call encoding function:
- res = LzmaEnc_Encode(enc, &outStream.funcTable, &inStream.funcTable,
- NULL, &g_Alloc, &g_Alloc);
-
-7) Destroy LZMA Encoder Object
- LzmaEnc_Destroy(enc, &g_Alloc, &g_Alloc);
-
-
-If callback function return some error code, LzmaEnc_Encode also returns that code.
-
-
-Single-call RAM->RAM Compression
---------------------------------
-
-Single-call RAM->RAM Compression is similar to Compression with callbacks,
-but you provide pointers to buffers instead of pointers to stream callbacks:
-
-HRes LzmaEncode(Byte *dest, SizeT *destLen, const Byte *src, SizeT srcLen,
- CLzmaEncProps *props, Byte *propsEncoded, SizeT *propsSize, int writeEndMark,
- ICompressProgress *progress, ISzAlloc *alloc, ISzAlloc *allocBig);
-
-Return code:
- SZ_OK - OK
- SZ_ERROR_MEM - Memory allocation error
- SZ_ERROR_PARAM - Incorrect paramater
- SZ_ERROR_OUTPUT_EOF - output buffer overflow
- SZ_ERROR_THREAD - errors in multithreading functions (only for Mt version)
-
-
-
-LZMA Defines
-------------
-
-_LZMA_SIZE_OPT - Enable some optimizations in LZMA Decoder to get smaller executable code.
-
-_LZMA_PROB32 - It can increase the speed on some 32-bit CPUs, but memory usage for
- some structures will be doubled in that case.
-
-_LZMA_UINT32_IS_ULONG - Define it if int is 16-bit on your compiler and long is 32-bit.
-
-_LZMA_NO_SYSTEM_SIZE_T - Define it if you don't want to use size_t type.
-
-
-C++ LZMA Encoder/Decoder
-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
-C++ LZMA code use COM-like interfaces. So if you want to use it,
-you can study basics of COM/OLE.
-C++ LZMA code is just wrapper over ANSI-C code.
-
-
-C++ Notes
-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
-If you use some C++ code folders in 7-Zip (for example, C++ code for .7z handling),
-you must check that you correctly work with "new" operator.
-7-Zip can be compiled with MSVC 6.0 that doesn't throw "exception" from "new" operator.
-So 7-Zip uses "CPP\Common\NewHandler.cpp" that redefines "new" operator:
-operator new(size_t size)
-{
- void *p = ::malloc(size);
- if (p == 0)
- throw CNewException();
- return p;
-}
-If you use MSCV that throws exception for "new" operator, you can compile without
-"NewHandler.cpp". So standard exception will be used. Actually some code of
-7-Zip catches any exception in internal code and converts it to HRESULT code.
-So you don't need to catch CNewException, if you call COM interfaces of 7-Zip.
-
----
-
-http://www.7-zip.org
-http://www.7-zip.org/sdk.html
-http://www.7-zip.org/support.html
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/UefiLzma.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/UefiLzma.h deleted file mode 100644 index 863b3ef66b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/LzmaCustomDecompressLib/UefiLzma.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,47 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- LZMA UEFI header file
-
- Allows LZMA code to build under UEFI (edk2) build environment
-
- Copyright (c) 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef __UEFILZMA_H__
-#define __UEFILZMA_H__
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-
-#ifdef _WIN32
-#undef _WIN32
-#endif
-
-#ifndef _SIZE_T_DEFINED
-#if !defined(_WIN64) || defined(__GNUC__)
-typedef unsigned int size_t;
-#endif
-#endif
-
-#ifdef _WIN64
-#undef _WIN64
-#endif
-
-#ifndef _PTRDIFF_T_DEFINED
-typedef int ptrdiff_t;
-#endif
-
-#define memcpy CopyMem
-#define memmove CopyMem
-
-#define _LZMA_SIZE_OPT
-
-#endif // __UEFILZMA_H__
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 0df144fe79..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null instance of OEM Hook Status Code Library with empty functions.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-/**
- Initialize OEM status code device .
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-OemHookStatusCodeInitialize (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Report status code to OEM device.
-
- @param CodeType Indicates the type of status code being reported.
- @param Value Describes the current status of a hardware or software entity.
- This included information about the class and subclass that is used to classify the entity
- as well as an operation. For progress codes, the operation is the current activity.
- For error codes, it is the exception. For debug codes, it is not defined at this time.
- @param Instance The enumeration of a hardware or software entity within the system.
- A system may contain multiple entities that match a class/subclass pairing.
- The instance differentiates between them. An instance of 0 indicates that instance information is unavailable,
- not meaningful, or not relevant. Valid instance numbers start with 1.
- @param CallerId This optional parameter may be used to identify the caller.
- This parameter allows the status code driver to apply different rules to different callers.
- @param Data This optional parameter may be used to pass additional data
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-OemHookStatusCodeReport (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN EFI_GUID *CallerId, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 32ed1a41bf..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,35 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null instance of OEM Hook Status Code Library with empty functions.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = OemHookStatusCodeLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 54D2878F-25CD-4a2b-8420-EBD18E609C76
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = OemHookStatusCodeLib
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 3e8cdd8d7f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull/OemHookStatusCodeLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 761e45b0de..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,115 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null instance of PCI Host Bridge Library with empty functions.
-
- Copyright (c) 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
- This program and the accompanying materials are licensed and made available
- under the terms and conditions of the BSD License which accompanies this
- distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT
- WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-#include <Library/PciHostBridgeLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED
-CHAR16 *mPciHostBridgeLibAcpiAddressSpaceTypeStr[] = {
- L"Mem", L"I/O", L"Bus"
-};
-
-/**
- Return all the root bridge instances in an array.
-
- @param Count Return the count of root bridge instances.
-
- @return All the root bridge instances in an array.
- The array should be passed into PciHostBridgeFreeRootBridges()
- when it's not used.
-**/
-PCI_ROOT_BRIDGE *
-EFIAPI
-PciHostBridgeGetRootBridges (
- UINTN *Count
- )
-{
- *Count = 0;
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Free the root bridge instances array returned from PciHostBridgeGetRootBridges().
-
- @param Bridges The root bridge instances array.
- @param Count The count of the array.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PciHostBridgeFreeRootBridges (
- PCI_ROOT_BRIDGE *Bridges,
- UINTN Count
- )
-{
- return;
-}
-
-/**
- Inform the platform that the resource conflict happens.
-
- @param HostBridgeHandle Handle of the Host Bridge.
- @param Configuration Pointer to PCI I/O and PCI memory resource
- descriptors. The Configuration contains the resources
- for all the root bridges. The resource for each root
- bridge is terminated with END descriptor and an
- additional END is appended indicating the end of the
- entire resources. The resource descriptor field
- values follow the description in
- EFI_PCI_HOST_BRIDGE_RESOURCE_ALLOCATION_PROTOCOL
- .SubmitResources().
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PciHostBridgeResourceConflict (
- EFI_HANDLE HostBridgeHandle,
- VOID *Configuration
- )
-{
- EFI_ACPI_ADDRESS_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR *Descriptor;
- UINTN RootBridgeIndex;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "PciHostBridge: Resource conflict happens!\n"));
-
- RootBridgeIndex = 0;
- Descriptor = (EFI_ACPI_ADDRESS_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR *) Configuration;
- while (Descriptor->Desc == ACPI_ADDRESS_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "RootBridge[%d]:\n", RootBridgeIndex++));
- for (; Descriptor->Desc == ACPI_ADDRESS_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR; Descriptor++) {
- ASSERT (Descriptor->ResType <
- (sizeof (mPciHostBridgeLibAcpiAddressSpaceTypeStr) /
- sizeof (mPciHostBridgeLibAcpiAddressSpaceTypeStr[0])
- )
- );
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, " %s: Length/Alignment = 0x%lx / 0x%lx\n",
- mPciHostBridgeLibAcpiAddressSpaceTypeStr[Descriptor->ResType],
- Descriptor->AddrLen, Descriptor->AddrRangeMax
- ));
- if (Descriptor->ResType == ACPI_ADDRESS_SPACE_TYPE_MEM) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, " Granularity/SpecificFlag = %ld / %02x%s\n",
- Descriptor->AddrSpaceGranularity, Descriptor->SpecificFlag,
- ((Descriptor->SpecificFlag &
- EFI_ACPI_MEMORY_RESOURCE_SPECIFIC_FLAG_CACHEABLE_PREFETCHABLE
- ) != 0) ? L" (Prefetchable)" : L""
- ));
- }
- }
- //
- // Skip the END descriptor for root bridge
- //
- ASSERT (Descriptor->Desc == ACPI_END_TAG_DESCRIPTOR);
- Descriptor = (EFI_ACPI_ADDRESS_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR *)(
- (EFI_ACPI_END_TAG_DESCRIPTOR *)Descriptor + 1
- );
- }
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 8df14924ad..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,38 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null instance of PCI Host Bridge Library with empty functions.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials are licensed and made available
-# under the terms and conditions of the BSD License which accompanies this
-# distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR
-# IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PciHostBridgeLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PciHostBridgeLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = A19A6C36-7053-4E2C-8BD0-E8286230E473
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PciHostBridgeLib
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build
-# tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PciHostBridgeLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.uni deleted file mode 100644 index 7b0fdee324..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PciHostBridgeLibNull/PciHostBridgeLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null @@ -1,20 +0,0 @@ -// /** @file
-// Null instance of PCI Host Bridge Library with empty functions.
-//
-// Null instance of PCI Host Bridge Library with empty functions.
-//
-// Copyright (c) 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-//
-// This program and the accompanying materials
-// are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-// which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-// http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-// THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-// WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-//
-// **/
-
-
-#string STR_MODULE_ABSTRACT #language en-US "Null instance of PCI Host Bridge Library with empty functions."
-
-#string STR_MODULE_DESCRIPTION #language en-US "Null instance of PCI Host Bridge Library with empty functions."
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 6e3dcdd690..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,312 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
- This library registers CRC32 guided section handler
- to parse CRC32 encapsulation section and extract raw data.
-
-Copyright (c) 2007 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <Guid/Crc32GuidedSectionExtraction.h>
-#include <Library/ExtractGuidedSectionLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-
-///
-/// CRC32 Guided Section header
-///
-typedef struct {
- EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION GuidedSectionHeader; ///< EFI guided section header
- UINT32 CRC32Checksum; ///< 32bit CRC check sum
-} CRC32_SECTION_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 GuidedSectionHeader; ///< EFI guided section header
- UINT32 CRC32Checksum; ///< 32bit CRC check sum
-} CRC32_SECTION2_HEADER;
-
-/**
- This internal function reverses bits for 32bit data.
-
- @param Value The data to be reversed.
-
- @return Data reversed.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibReverseBits (
- UINT32 Value
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINT32 NewValue;
-
- NewValue = 0;
- for (Index = 0; Index < 32; Index++) {
- if ((Value & (1 << Index)) != 0) {
- NewValue = NewValue | (1 << (31 - Index));
- }
- }
-
- return NewValue;
-}
-
-/**
- Calculate CRC32 for target data.
-
- @param Data The target data.
- @param DataSize The target data size.
- @param CrcOut The CRC32 for target data.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The CRC32 for target data is calculated successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Some parameter is not valid, so the CRC32 is not
- calculated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibCalculateCrc32 (
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- OUT UINT32 *CrcOut
- )
-{
- UINT32 CrcTable[256];
- UINTN TableEntry;
- UINTN Index;
- UINT32 Value;
- UINT32 Crc;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
-
- if (Data == NULL || DataSize == 0 || CrcOut == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Initialize CRC32 table.
- //
- for (TableEntry = 0; TableEntry < 256; TableEntry++) {
- Value = PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibReverseBits ((UINT32) TableEntry);
- for (Index = 0; Index < 8; Index++) {
- if ((Value & 0x80000000) != 0) {
- Value = (Value << 1) ^ 0x04c11db7;
- } else {
- Value = Value << 1;
- }
- }
- CrcTable[TableEntry] = PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibReverseBits (Value);
- }
-
- //
- // Compute CRC
- //
- Crc = 0xffffffff;
- for (Index = 0, Ptr = Data; Index < DataSize; Index++, Ptr++) {
- Crc = (Crc >> 8) ^ CrcTable[(UINT8) Crc ^ *Ptr];
- }
-
- *CrcOut = Crc ^ 0xffffffff;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
-
- GetInfo gets raw data size and attribute of the input guided section.
- It first checks whether the input guid section is supported.
- If not, EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER will return.
-
- @param InputSection Buffer containing the input GUIDed section to be processed.
- @param OutputBufferSize The size of OutputBuffer.
- @param ScratchBufferSize The size of ScratchBuffer.
- @param SectionAttribute The attribute of the input guided section.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The size of destination buffer, the size of scratch buffer and
- the attribute of the input section are successull retrieved.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The GUID in InputSection does not match this instance guid.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-Crc32GuidedSectionGetInfo (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT UINT32 *OutputBufferSize,
- OUT UINT32 *ScratchBufferSize,
- OUT UINT16 *SectionAttribute
- )
-{
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Retrieve the size and attribute of the input section data.
- //
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->Attributes;
- *ScratchBufferSize = 0;
- *OutputBufferSize = SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- } else {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Retrieve the size and attribute of the input section data.
- //
- *SectionAttribute = ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->Attributes;
- *ScratchBufferSize = 0;
- *OutputBufferSize = SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
-
- Extraction handler tries to extract raw data from the input guided section.
- It also does authentication check for 32bit CRC value in the input guided section.
- It first checks whether the input guid section is supported.
- If not, EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER will return.
-
- @param InputSection Buffer containing the input GUIDed section to be processed.
- @param OutputBuffer Buffer to contain the output raw data allocated by the caller.
- @param ScratchBuffer A pointer to a caller-allocated buffer for function internal use.
- @param AuthenticationStatus A pointer to a caller-allocated UINT32 that indicates the
- authentication status of the output buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Section Data and Auth Status is extracted successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The GUID in InputSection does not match this instance guid.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-Crc32GuidedSectionHandler (
- IN CONST VOID *InputSection,
- OUT VOID **OutputBuffer,
- IN VOID *ScratchBuffer, OPTIONAL
- OUT UINT32 *AuthenticationStatus
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 SectionCrc32Checksum;
- UINT32 Crc32Checksum;
- UINT32 OutputBufferSize;
-
- if (IS_SECTION2 (InputSection)) {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get section Crc32 checksum.
- //
- SectionCrc32Checksum = ((CRC32_SECTION2_HEADER *) InputSection)->CRC32Checksum;
- *OutputBuffer = (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- OutputBufferSize = SECTION2_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
-
- //
- // Implicitly CRC32 GUIDed section should have STATUS_VALID bit set
- //
- ASSERT (((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION2 *) InputSection)->Attributes & EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_AUTH_STATUS_VALID);
- *AuthenticationStatus = EFI_AUTH_STATUS_IMAGE_SIGNED;
- } else {
- //
- // Check whether the input guid section is recognized.
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- &(((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->SectionDefinitionGuid))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get section Crc32 checksum.
- //
- SectionCrc32Checksum = ((CRC32_SECTION_HEADER *) InputSection)->CRC32Checksum;
- *OutputBuffer = (UINT8 *) InputSection + ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
- OutputBufferSize = SECTION_SIZE (InputSection) - ((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->DataOffset;
-
- //
- // Implicitly CRC32 GUIDed section should have STATUS_VALID bit set
- //
- ASSERT (((EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection)->Attributes & EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_AUTH_STATUS_VALID);
- *AuthenticationStatus = EFI_AUTH_STATUS_IMAGE_SIGNED;
- }
-
- //
- // Init Checksum value to Zero.
- //
- Crc32Checksum = 0;
-
- //
- // Calculate CRC32 Checksum of Image
- //
- Status = PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibCalculateCrc32 (*OutputBuffer, OutputBufferSize, &Crc32Checksum);
- if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) {
- if (Crc32Checksum != SectionCrc32Checksum) {
- //
- // If Crc32 checksum is not matched, AUTH tested failed bit is set.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_AUTH_STATUS_TEST_FAILED;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // If Crc32 checksum is not calculated, AUTH not tested bit is set.
- //
- *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_AUTH_STATUS_NOT_TESTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Temp solution until PeiCore checks AUTH Status.
- //
- if ((*AuthenticationStatus & (EFI_AUTH_STATUS_TEST_FAILED | EFI_AUTH_STATUS_NOT_TESTED)) != 0) {
- return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Register the handler to extract CRC32 guided section.
-
- @param FileHandle The handle of FFS header the loaded driver.
- @param PeiServices The pointer to the PEI services.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Register successfully.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory to register this handler.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_PEI_FILE_HANDLE FileHandle,
- IN CONST EFI_PEI_SERVICES **PeiServices
- )
-{
- return ExtractGuidedSectionRegisterHandlers (
- &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid,
- Crc32GuidedSectionGetInfo,
- Crc32GuidedSectionHandler
- );
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 7134810040..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,48 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Pei Crc32 Guided Section Extract library.
-#
-# This library doesn't produce any library class. The constructor function uses
-# ExtractGuidedSectionLib service to register CRC32 guided section handler
-# that parses CRC32 encapsulation section and extracts raw data.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib
- FILE_GUID = 1EBE57F5-BE42-45f0-A1F9-FA3DC633910B
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL|PEI_CORE PEIM
- CONSTRUCTOR = PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLibConstructor
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC (EBC is for build only)
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- ExtractGuidedSectionLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionGuid ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 408aadb76d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib/PeiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 4bcf0030a0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,78 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- NULL Library class that reads Debug Mask variable and if it exists makes a
- HOB that contains the debug mask.
-
- Copyright (c) 2011, Apple, Inc. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-
-#include <Library/HobLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/PeiServicesLib.h>
-
-#include <Ppi/ReadOnlyVariable2.h>
-#include <Guid/DebugMask.h>
-
-
-/**
- The constructor reads variable and sets HOB
-
- @param FileHandle The handle of FFS header the loaded driver.
- @param PeiServices The pointer to the PEI services.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PeiDebugPrintHobLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_PEI_FILE_HANDLE FileHandle,
- IN CONST EFI_PEI_SERVICES **PeiServices
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PEI_READ_ONLY_VARIABLE2_PPI *Variable;
- UINTN Size;
- UINT64 GlobalErrorLevel;
- UINT32 HobErrorLevel;
-
- Status = PeiServicesLocatePpi (
- &gEfiPeiReadOnlyVariable2PpiGuid,
- 0,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&Variable
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Size = sizeof (GlobalErrorLevel);
- Status = Variable->GetVariable (
- Variable,
- DEBUG_MASK_VARIABLE_NAME,
- &gEfiGenericVariableGuid,
- NULL,
- &Size,
- &GlobalErrorLevel
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Build the GUID'ed HOB for DXE
- //
- HobErrorLevel = (UINT32)GlobalErrorLevel;
- BuildGuidDataHob (
- &gEfiGenericVariableGuid,
- &HobErrorLevel,
- sizeof (HobErrorLevel)
- );
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 0380dee01f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,50 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# NULL Library class that reads Debug Mask variable and if it exists makes a
-# HOB that contains the debug mask.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2011, Apple, Inc. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# Copyright (c) 2012 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiDebugPrintHobLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiDebugPrintHobLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = EB0BDD73-DABB-E74B-BF51-62DC1DA521E1
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL|PEIM
- CONSTRUCTOR = PeiDebugPrintHobLibConstructor
-
-
-[Sources]
- PeiDebugPrintHobLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PeiServicesLib
- DebugLib
-
-[Ppis]
- gEfiPeiReadOnlyVariable2PpiGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Guids]
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"EFIDebug"
- ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## HOB
- gEfiGenericVariableGuid
-
-[Depex]
- gEfiPeiReadOnlyVariable2PpiGuid
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 686c606c79..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDebugPrintHobLib/PeiDebugPrintHobLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/DebugLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/DebugLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index f1d98277a3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/DebugLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,461 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Debug Library based on report status code library.
-
- Note that if the debug message length is larger than the maximum allowable
- record length, then the debug message will be ignored directly.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeId.h>
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeDebug.h>
-
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/ReportStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugPrintErrorLevelLib.h>
-
-/**
- Prints a debug message to the debug output device if the specified error level is enabled.
-
- If any bit in ErrorLevel is also set in DebugPrintErrorLevelLib function
- GetDebugPrintErrorLevel (), then print the message specified by Format and the
- associated variable argument list to the debug output device.
-
- If Format is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- If the length of the message string specificed by Format is larger than the maximum allowable
- record length, then directly return and not print it.
-
- @param ErrorLevel The error level of the debug message.
- @param Format Format string for the debug message to print.
- @param ... Variable argument list whose contents are accessed
- based on the format string specified by Format.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-DebugPrint (
- IN UINTN ErrorLevel,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Format,
- ...
- )
-{
- UINT64 Buffer[(EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_MAX_SIZE / sizeof (UINT64)) + 1];
- EFI_DEBUG_INFO *DebugInfo;
- UINTN TotalSize;
- VA_LIST VaListMarker;
- BASE_LIST BaseListMarker;
- CHAR8 *FormatString;
- BOOLEAN Long;
-
- //
- // If Format is NULL, then ASSERT().
- //
- ASSERT (Format != NULL);
-
- //
- // Check driver Debug Level value and global debug level
- //
- if ((ErrorLevel & GetDebugPrintErrorLevel ()) == 0) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Compute the total size of the record.
- // Note that the passing-in format string and variable parameters will be constructed to
- // the following layout:
- //
- // Buffer->|------------------------|
- // | Padding | 4 bytes
- // DebugInfo->|------------------------|
- // | EFI_DEBUG_INFO | sizeof(EFI_DEBUG_INFO)
- // BaseListMarker->|------------------------|
- // | ... |
- // | variable arguments | 12 * sizeof (UINT64)
- // | ... |
- // |------------------------|
- // | Format String |
- // |------------------------|<- (UINT8 *)Buffer + sizeof(Buffer)
- //
- TotalSize = 4 + sizeof (EFI_DEBUG_INFO) + 12 * sizeof (UINT64) + AsciiStrSize (Format);
-
- //
- // If the TotalSize is larger than the maximum record size, then return
- //
- if (TotalSize > sizeof (Buffer)) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Fill in EFI_DEBUG_INFO
- //
- // Here we skip the first 4 bytes of Buffer, because we must ensure BaseListMarker is
- // 64-bit aligned, otherwise retrieving 64-bit parameter from BaseListMarker will cause
- // exception on IPF. Buffer starts at 64-bit aligned address, so skipping 4 types (sizeof(EFI_DEBUG_INFO))
- // just makes address of BaseListMarker, which follows DebugInfo, 64-bit aligned.
- //
- DebugInfo = (EFI_DEBUG_INFO *)(Buffer) + 1;
- DebugInfo->ErrorLevel = (UINT32)ErrorLevel;
- BaseListMarker = (BASE_LIST)(DebugInfo + 1);
- FormatString = (CHAR8 *)((UINT64 *)(DebugInfo + 1) + 12);
-
- //
- // Copy the Format string into the record
- //
- AsciiStrCpyS (FormatString, sizeof(Buffer) - (4 + sizeof(EFI_DEBUG_INFO) + 12 * sizeof(UINT64)), Format);
-
- //
- // The first 12 * sizeof (UINT64) bytes following EFI_DEBUG_INFO are for variable arguments
- // of format in DEBUG string, which is followed by the DEBUG format string.
- // Here we will process the variable arguments and pack them in this area.
- //
- VA_START (VaListMarker, Format);
- for (; *Format != '\0'; Format++) {
- //
- // Only format with prefix % is processed.
- //
- if (*Format != '%') {
- continue;
- }
- Long = FALSE;
- //
- // Parse Flags and Width
- //
- for (Format++; TRUE; Format++) {
- if (*Format == '.' || *Format == '-' || *Format == '+' || *Format == ' ') {
- //
- // These characters in format field are omitted.
- //
- continue;
- }
- if (*Format >= '0' && *Format <= '9') {
- //
- // These characters in format field are omitted.
- //
- continue;
- }
- if (*Format == 'L' || *Format == 'l') {
- //
- // 'L" or "l" in format field means the number being printed is a UINT64
- //
- Long = TRUE;
- continue;
- }
- if (*Format == '*') {
- //
- // '*' in format field means the precision of the field is specified by
- // a UINTN argument in the argument list.
- //
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN);
- continue;
- }
- if (*Format == '\0') {
- //
- // Make no output if Format string terminates unexpectedly when
- // looking up for flag, width, precision and type.
- //
- Format--;
- }
- //
- // When valid argument type detected or format string terminates unexpectedly,
- // the inner loop is done.
- //
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Pack variable arguments into the storage area following EFI_DEBUG_INFO.
- //
- if ((*Format == 'p') && (sizeof (VOID *) > 4)) {
- Long = TRUE;
- }
- if (*Format == 'p' || *Format == 'X' || *Format == 'x' || *Format == 'd' || *Format == 'u') {
- if (Long) {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, INT64) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, INT64);
- } else {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, int) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, int);
- }
- } else if (*Format == 's' || *Format == 'S' || *Format == 'a' || *Format == 'g' || *Format == 't') {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, VOID *) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, VOID *);
- } else if (*Format == 'c') {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, UINTN) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, UINTN);
- } else if (*Format == 'r') {
- BASE_ARG (BaseListMarker, RETURN_STATUS) = VA_ARG (VaListMarker, RETURN_STATUS);
- }
-
- //
- // If the converted BASE_LIST is larger than the 12 * sizeof (UINT64) allocated bytes, then ASSERT()
- // This indicates that the DEBUG() macro is passing in more argument than can be handled by
- // the EFI_DEBUG_INFO record
- //
- ASSERT ((CHAR8 *)BaseListMarker <= FormatString);
-
- //
- // If the converted BASE_LIST is larger than the 12 * sizeof (UINT64) allocated bytes, then return
- //
- if ((CHAR8 *)BaseListMarker > FormatString) {
- VA_END (VaListMarker);
- return;
- }
- }
- VA_END (VaListMarker);
-
- //
- // Send the DebugInfo record
- //
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE_EX (
- EFI_DEBUG_CODE,
- (EFI_SOFTWARE_DXE_BS_DRIVER | EFI_DC_UNSPECIFIED),
- 0,
- NULL,
- &gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid,
- DebugInfo,
- TotalSize
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Prints an assert message containing a filename, line number, and description.
- This may be followed by a breakpoint or a dead loop.
-
- Print a message of the form "ASSERT <FileName>(<LineNumber>): <Description>\n"
- to the debug output device. If DEBUG_PROPERTY_ASSERT_BREAKPOINT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdDebugProperyMask is set then CpuBreakpoint() is called. Otherwise, if
- DEBUG_PROPERTY_ASSERT_DEADLOOP_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is set then
- CpuDeadLoop() is called. If neither of these bits are set, then this function
- returns immediately after the message is printed to the debug output device.
- DebugAssert() must actively prevent recursion. If DebugAssert() is called while
- processing another DebugAssert(), then DebugAssert() must return immediately.
-
- If FileName is NULL, then a <FileName> string of "(NULL) Filename" is printed.
- If Description is NULL, then a <Description> string of "(NULL) Description" is printed.
-
- @param FileName Pointer to the name of the source file that generated the assert condition.
- @param LineNumber The line number in the source file that generated the assert condition
- @param Description Pointer to the description of the assert condition.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-DebugAssert (
- IN CONST CHAR8 *FileName,
- IN UINTN LineNumber,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Description
- )
-{
- UINT64 Buffer[EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_MAX_SIZE / sizeof(UINT64)];
- EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *AssertData;
- UINTN HeaderSize;
- UINTN TotalSize;
- CHAR8 *Temp;
- UINTN FileNameSize;
- UINTN DescriptionSize;
-
- //
- // Get string size
- //
- HeaderSize = sizeof (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA);
- FileNameSize = AsciiStrSize (FileName);
- DescriptionSize = AsciiStrSize (Description);
-
- //
- // Make sure it will all fit in the passed in buffer.
- //
- if (HeaderSize + FileNameSize + DescriptionSize > sizeof (Buffer)) {
- //
- // FileName + Description is too long to be filled into buffer.
- //
- if (HeaderSize + FileNameSize < sizeof (Buffer)) {
- //
- // Description has enough buffer to be truncated.
- //
- DescriptionSize = sizeof (Buffer) - HeaderSize - FileNameSize;
- } else {
- //
- // FileName is too long to be filled into buffer.
- // FileName will be truncated. Reserved one byte for Description NULL terminator.
- //
- DescriptionSize = 1;
- FileNameSize = sizeof (Buffer) - HeaderSize - DescriptionSize;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Fill in EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA
- //
- AssertData = (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *)Buffer;
- AssertData->LineNumber = (UINT32)LineNumber;
- TotalSize = sizeof (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA);
-
- //
- // Copy Ascii FileName including NULL terminator.
- //
- Temp = CopyMem (AssertData + 1, FileName, FileNameSize);
- Temp[FileNameSize - 1] = 0;
- TotalSize += FileNameSize;
-
- //
- // Copy Ascii Description include NULL terminator.
- //
- Temp = CopyMem (Temp + FileNameSize, Description, DescriptionSize);
- Temp[DescriptionSize - 1] = 0;
- TotalSize += DescriptionSize;
-
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE_EX (
- (EFI_ERROR_CODE | EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED),
- (EFI_SOFTWARE_DXE_BS_DRIVER | EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE),
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- AssertData,
- TotalSize
- );
-
- //
- // Generate a Breakpoint, DeadLoop, or NOP based on PCD settings
- //
- if ((PcdGet8 (PcdDebugPropertyMask) & DEBUG_PROPERTY_ASSERT_BREAKPOINT_ENABLED) != 0) {
- CpuBreakpoint ();
- } else if ((PcdGet8 (PcdDebugPropertyMask) & DEBUG_PROPERTY_ASSERT_DEADLOOP_ENABLED) != 0) {
- CpuDeadLoop ();
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Fills a target buffer with PcdDebugClearMemoryValue, and returns the target buffer.
-
- This function fills Length bytes of Buffer with the value specified by
- PcdDebugClearMemoryValue, and returns Buffer.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Length is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the target buffer to be filled with PcdDebugClearMemoryValue.
- @param Length Number of bytes in Buffer to fill with zeros PcdDebugClearMemoryValue.
-
- @return Buffer Pointer to the target buffer filled with PcdDebugClearMemoryValue.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-DebugClearMemory (
- OUT VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
-
- return SetMem (Buffer, Length, PcdGet8 (PcdDebugClearMemoryValue));
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if ASSERT() macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_ASSERT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdDebugProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_ASSERT_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_ASSERT_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-DebugAssertEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdDebugPropertyMask) & DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_ASSERT_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if DEBUG() macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_PRINT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdDebugProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_PRINT_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_PRINT_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-DebugPrintEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdDebugPropertyMask) & DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_PRINT_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if DEBUG_CODE() macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdDebugProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-DebugCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdDebugPropertyMask) & DEBUG_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if DEBUG_CLEAR_MEMORY() macro is enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the DEBUG_PROPERTY_CLEAR_MEMORY_ENABLED bit of
- PcdDebugProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_CLEAR_MEMORY_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The DEBUG_PROPERTY_CLEAR_MEMORY_ENABLED bit of PcdDebugProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-DebugClearMemoryEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdDebugPropertyMask) & DEBUG_PROPERTY_CLEAR_MEMORY_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if any one of the bit is set both in ErrorLevel and PcdFixedDebugPrintErrorLevel.
-
- This function compares the bit mask of ErrorLevel and PcdFixedDebugPrintErrorLevel.
-
- @retval TRUE Current ErrorLevel is supported.
- @retval FALSE Current ErrorLevel is not supported.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-DebugPrintLevelEnabled (
- IN CONST UINTN ErrorLevel
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((ErrorLevel & PcdGet32(PcdFixedDebugPrintErrorLevel)) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 55446672d7..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,54 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Debug Library based on report status code library
-#
-# Debug Library for PEIMs and DXE drivers that sends debug messages to ReportStatusCode
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.uni
- FILE_GUID = bda39d3a-451b-4350-8266-81ab10fa0523
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = DebugLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER SMM_CORE PEIM SEC PEI_CORE UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- DebugLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- ReportStatusCodeLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- BaseLib
- DebugPrintErrorLevelLib
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdDebugClearMemoryValue ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdDebugPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdFixedDebugPrintErrorLevel ## CONSUMES
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index fe2abee431..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode/PeiDxeDebugLibReportStatusCode.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.c deleted file mode 100644 index cb6a007360..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,81 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Implementation of Ipmi Library in PEI Phase for SMS.
-
- Copyright (c) 2014 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <Ppi/IpmiPpi.h>
-#include <Library/IpmiLib.h>
-#include <Library/PeiServicesLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-
-/**
- This service enables submitting commands via Ipmi.
-
- @param[in] NetFunction Net function of the command.
- @param[in] Command IPMI Command.
- @param[in] RequestData Command Request Data.
- @param[in] RequestDataSize Size of Command Request Data.
- @param[out] ResponseData Command Response Data. The completion code is the first byte of response data.
- @param[in, out] ResponseDataSize Size of Command Response Data.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The command byte stream was successfully submit to the device and a response was successfully received.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The command was not successfully sent to the device or a response was not successfully received from the device.
- @retval EFI_NOT_READY Ipmi Device is not ready for Ipmi command access.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Ipmi Device hardware error.
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT The command time out.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The command was not successfully sent to the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The resource allcation is out of resource or data size error.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpmiSubmitCommand (
- IN UINT8 NetFunction,
- IN UINT8 Command,
- IN UINT8 *RequestData,
- IN UINT32 RequestDataSize,
- OUT UINT8 *ResponseData,
- IN OUT UINT32 *ResponseDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- PEI_IPMI_PPI *IpmiPpi;
-
- Status = PeiServicesLocatePpi(
- &gPeiIpmiPpiGuid,
- 0,
- NULL,
- (VOID **) &IpmiPpi
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Ipmi Ppi is not installed. So, IPMI device is not present.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "IpmiSubmitCommand in Pei Phase under SMS Status - %r\n", Status));
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- Status = IpmiPpi->IpmiSubmitCommand (
- IpmiPpi,
- NetFunction,
- Command,
- RequestData,
- RequestDataSize,
- ResponseData,
- ResponseDataSize
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.inf deleted file mode 100644 index e2e2646f91..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi/PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Instance of IPMI Library in PEI phase for SMS.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2014 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi
- FILE_GUID = 43679142-87C4-44AD-AF02-B47F782D6CF3
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = IpmiLib|PEIM PEI_CORE
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PeiIpmiLibIpmiPpi.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- PeiServicesLib
-
-[Ppis]
- gPeiIpmiPpiGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 0b5a717caa..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,494 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Performance library instance used in PEI phase.
-
- This file implements all APIs in Performance Library class in MdePkg. It creates
- performance logging GUIDed HOB on the first performance logging and then logs the
- performance data to the GUIDed HOB. Due to the limitation of temporary RAM, the maximum
- number of performance logging entry is specified by PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries.
-
-Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/HobLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/TimerLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-
-
-/**
- Gets the GUID HOB for PEI performance.
-
- This internal function searches for the GUID HOB for PEI performance.
- If that GUID HOB is not found, it will build a new one.
- It outputs the data area of that GUID HOB to record performance log.
-
- @param PeiPerformanceLog Pointer to Pointer to PEI performance log header.
- @param PeiPerformanceIdArray Pointer to Pointer to PEI performance identifier array.
-
-**/
-VOID
-InternalGetPerformanceHobLog (
- OUT PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER **PeiPerformanceLog,
- OUT UINT32 **PeiPerformanceIdArray
- )
-{
- EFI_HOB_GUID_TYPE *GuidHob;
- UINTN PeiPerformanceSize;
-
- ASSERT (PeiPerformanceLog != NULL);
- ASSERT (PeiPerformanceIdArray != NULL);
-
- GuidHob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gPerformanceProtocolGuid);
-
- if (GuidHob != NULL) {
- //
- // PEI Performance HOB was found, then return the existing one.
- //
- *PeiPerformanceLog = GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (GuidHob);
-
- GuidHob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gPerformanceExProtocolGuid);
- ASSERT (GuidHob != NULL);
- *PeiPerformanceIdArray = GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (GuidHob);
- } else {
- //
- // PEI Performance HOB was not found, then build one.
- //
- PeiPerformanceSize = sizeof (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER) +
- sizeof (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY) * PcdGet8 (PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries);
- *PeiPerformanceLog = BuildGuidHob (&gPerformanceProtocolGuid, PeiPerformanceSize);
- *PeiPerformanceLog = ZeroMem (*PeiPerformanceLog, PeiPerformanceSize);
-
- PeiPerformanceSize = sizeof (UINT32) * PcdGet8 (PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries);
- *PeiPerformanceIdArray = BuildGuidHob (&gPerformanceExProtocolGuid, PeiPerformanceSize);
- *PeiPerformanceIdArray = ZeroMem (*PeiPerformanceIdArray, PeiPerformanceSize);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Searches in the log array with keyword Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
-
- This internal function searches for the log entry in the log array.
- If there is an entry that exactly matches the given keywords
- and its end time stamp is zero, then the index of that log entry is returned;
- otherwise, the the number of log entries in the array is returned.
-
- @param PeiPerformanceLog Pointer to the data structure containing PEI
- performance data.
- @param PeiPerformanceIdArray Pointer to PEI performance identifier array.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier.
-
- @retval The index of log entry in the array.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-InternalSearchForLogEntry (
- IN PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER *PeiPerformanceLog,
- IN UINT32 *PeiPerformanceIdArray,
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Index2;
- UINT32 NumberOfEntries;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *LogEntryArray;
-
-
- if (Token == NULL) {
- Token = "";
- }
- if (Module == NULL) {
- Module = "";
- }
- NumberOfEntries = PeiPerformanceLog->NumberOfEntries;
- LogEntryArray = (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *) (PeiPerformanceLog + 1);
-
- Index2 = 0;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- Index2 = NumberOfEntries - 1 - Index;
- if (LogEntryArray[Index2].EndTimeStamp == 0 &&
- (LogEntryArray[Index2].Handle == (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Handle) &&
- AsciiStrnCmp (LogEntryArray[Index2].Token, Token, PEI_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH) == 0 &&
- AsciiStrnCmp (LogEntryArray[Index2].Module, Module, PEI_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH) == 0 &&
- (PeiPerformanceIdArray[Index2] == Identifier)) {
- Index = Index2;
- break;
- }
- }
- return Index;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER *PeiPerformanceLog;
- UINT32 *PeiPerformanceIdArray;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *LogEntryArray;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- InternalGetPerformanceHobLog (&PeiPerformanceLog, &PeiPerformanceIdArray);
-
- if (PeiPerformanceLog->NumberOfEntries >= PcdGet8 (PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries)) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- Index = PeiPerformanceLog->NumberOfEntries++;
- LogEntryArray = (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *) (PeiPerformanceLog + 1);
- LogEntryArray[Index].Handle = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Handle;
-
- if (Token != NULL) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (LogEntryArray[Index].Token, PEI_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, Token, PEI_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH);
- }
- if (Module != NULL) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (LogEntryArray[Index].Module, PEI_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, Module, PEI_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH);
- }
-
- LogEntryArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = 0;
- PeiPerformanceIdArray[Index] = Identifier;
-
- if (TimeStamp == 0) {
- TimeStamp = GetPerformanceCounter ();
- }
- LogEntryArray[Index].StartTimeStamp = TimeStamp;
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER *PeiPerformanceLog;
- UINT32 *PeiPerformanceIdArray;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *LogEntryArray;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- if (TimeStamp == 0) {
- TimeStamp = GetPerformanceCounter ();
- }
-
- InternalGetPerformanceHobLog (&PeiPerformanceLog, &PeiPerformanceIdArray);
- Index = InternalSearchForLogEntry (PeiPerformanceLog, PeiPerformanceIdArray, Handle, Token, Module, Identifier);
- if (Index >= PeiPerformanceLog->NumberOfEntries) {
- return RETURN_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- LogEntryArray = (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *) (PeiPerformanceLog + 1);
- LogEntryArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = TimeStamp;
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance of entry entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_HEADER *PeiPerformanceLog;
- UINT32 *PeiPerformanceIdArray;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *CurrentLogEntry;
- PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *LogEntryArray;
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
-
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
- ASSERT (Token != NULL);
- ASSERT (Module != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (EndTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (Identifier != NULL);
-
- InternalGetPerformanceHobLog (&PeiPerformanceLog, &PeiPerformanceIdArray);
-
- NumberOfEntries = (UINTN) (PeiPerformanceLog->NumberOfEntries);
- LogEntryArray = (PEI_PERFORMANCE_LOG_ENTRY *) (PeiPerformanceLog + 1);
- //
- // Make sure that LogEntryKey is a valid log entry key.
- //
- ASSERT (LogEntryKey <= NumberOfEntries);
-
- if (LogEntryKey == NumberOfEntries) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- CurrentLogEntry = &(LogEntryArray[LogEntryKey]);
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) (CurrentLogEntry->Handle);
- *Token = CurrentLogEntry->Token;
- *Module = CurrentLogEntry->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = CurrentLogEntry->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = CurrentLogEntry->EndTimeStamp;
- *Identifier = PeiPerformanceIdArray[LogEntryKey++];
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, and Module.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurementEx and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, and EndTimeStamp.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance of entry entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp
- )
-{
- UINT32 Identifier;
- return GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (LogEntryKey, Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp, &Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if the performance measurement macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-PerformanceMeasurementEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8(PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask) & PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 7a5d2407ac..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Performance library instance used in PEI phase.
-#
-# This library provides the performance measurement interfaces in PEI phase, it creates
-# and consumes GUIDed HOB for performance logging. The GUIDed HOB is passed to DXE phase
-# so that it can be taken over by DxeCorePerformanceLib.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiPerformanceLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiPerformanceLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = F72DE735-B24F-4ef6-897F-70A85D01A047
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PerformanceLib|PEIM PEI_CORE SEC
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC (EBC is for build only)
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PeiPerformanceLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseMemoryLib
- PcdLib
- TimerLib
- BaseLib
- HobLib
- DebugLib
-
-
-[Guids]
- ## PRODUCES ## HOB
- ## CONSUMES ## HOB
- gPerformanceProtocolGuid
- ## PRODUCES ## HOB
- ## CONSUMES ## HOB
- gPerformanceExProtocolGuid
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdMaxPeiPerformanceLogEntries ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 3be291a988..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiPerformanceLib/PeiPerformanceLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index d77c6e544b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,34 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null Recovery Library instance does nothing and returns unsupported status.
-
- This library instance is no longer used and module using this library
- class should update to directly locate EFI_PEI_RECOVERY_MODULE_PPI defined
- in PI 1.2 specification.
-
-Copyright (c) 2006 - 2008, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <Library/RecoveryLib.h>
-
-/**
- Calling this function causes the system do recovery boot path.
-
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Recovery is not supported.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PeiRecoverFirmware (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 6c565acc40..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,39 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null Recovery library instance for PEIM module
-# This library instance is no longer used and module using this library
-# class should update to directly locate EFI_PEI_RECOVERY_MODULE_PPI defined
-# in PI 1.2 specification.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiRecoveryLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiRecoveryLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 41789FB9-02AC-4484-BD40-A3147D7EDA25
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = RecoveryLib|PEIM
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC (EBC is for build only)
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PeiRecoveryLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 6c7a2cdb7a..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiRecoveryLibNull/PeiRecoveryLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/PeiReportStatusCodeLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/PeiReportStatusCodeLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index f66ce80cd5..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/PeiReportStatusCodeLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Instance of Report Status Code Library for PEI Phase.
-#
-# Instance of Report Status Code Library for PEI Phase. It first tries to report status
-# code via PEI Status Code Service. If the service is not available, it then tries calling
-# OEM Hook Status Code Library.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiReportStatusCodeLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiReportStatusCodeLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 8c690838-7a22-45c4-aa58-a33e3e515cd4
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = ReportStatusCodeLib|SEC PEIM PEI_CORE
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC (EBC is for build only)
-#
-
-[Sources]
- ReportStatusCodeLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- PeiServicesTablePointerLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- OemHookStatusCodeLib
-
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
- gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
-
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask ## CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/PeiReportStatusCodeLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/PeiReportStatusCodeLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 53c74d809f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/PeiReportStatusCodeLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index d41d4e981d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,560 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Instance of Report Status Code Library for PEI Phase.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeId.h>
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeDebug.h>
-
-#include <Library/ReportStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/PeiServicesTablePointerLib.h>
-#include <Library/OemHookStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-
-//
-// Define the maximum extended data size that is supported in the PEI phase
-//
-#define MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE 0x200
-
-/**
- Internal worker function that reports a status code through the PEI Status Code Service or
- OEM Hook Status Code Library.
-
- This function first tries to report status code via PEI Status Code Service. If the service
- is not available, it then tries calling OEM Hook Status Code Library.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. This is an optional parameter that may be
- NULL.
- @param Data Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Status code type is not supported.
- @retval Others Failed to report status code.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- CONST EFI_PEI_SERVICES **PeiServices;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if ((ReportProgressCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- (ReportErrorCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ||
- (ReportDebugCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_DEBUG_CODE)) {
- PeiServices = GetPeiServicesTablePointer ();
- Status = (*PeiServices)->ReportStatusCode (
- PeiServices,
- Type,
- Value,
- Instance,
- (EFI_GUID *)CallerId,
- Data
- );
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_AVAILABLE_YET) {
- Status = OemHookStatusCodeInitialize ();
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return OemHookStatusCodeReport (Type, Value, Instance, (EFI_GUID *) CallerId, Data);
- }
- }
- return Status;
- }
-
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Converts a status code to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType and Value to an 8-bit POST code
- and returns the 8-bit POST code in PostCode. If CodeType is an
- EFI_PROGRESS_CODE or CodeType is an EFI_ERROR_CODE, then bits 0..4 of PostCode
- are set to bits 16..20 of Value, and bits 5..7 of PostCode are set to bits
- 24..26 of Value., and TRUE is returned. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param PostCode A pointer to the 8-bit POST code value to return.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType and Value was converted
- to an 8-bit POST code and returned in PostCode.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType and Value could not be
- converted to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-CodeTypeToPostCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- OUT UINT8 *PostCode
- )
-{
- //
- // If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT()
- //
- ASSERT (PostCode != NULL);
-
- //
- // Convert Value to an 8 bit post code
- //
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE)) {
- *PostCode = (UINT8) ((((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_CLASS_MASK) >> 24) << 5) |
- (((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SUBCLASS_MASK) >> 16) & 0x1f));
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts ASSERT() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data to the ASSERT()
- arguments specified by Filename, Description, and LineNumber. If CodeType is
- an EFI_ERROR_CODE, and CodeType has a severity of EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED, and
- Value has an operation mask of EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE, extract
- Filename, Description, and LineNumber from the optional data area of the
- status code buffer specified by Data. The optional data area of Data contains
- a Null-terminated ASCII string for the FileName, followed by a Null-terminated
- ASCII string for the Description, followed by a 32-bit LineNumber. If the
- ASSERT() information could be extracted from Data, then return TRUE.
- Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Filename is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Description is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If LineNumber is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param Filename Pointer to the source file name that generated the ASSERT().
- @param Description Pointer to the description of the ASSERT().
- @param LineNumber Pointer to source line number that generated the ASSERT().
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data was
- converted ASSERT() arguments specified by Filename, Description,
- and LineNumber.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data could
- not be converted to ASSERT() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractAssertInfo (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT CHAR8 **Filename,
- OUT CHAR8 **Description,
- OUT UINT32 *LineNumber
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *AssertData;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (Filename != NULL);
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
- ASSERT (LineNumber != NULL);
-
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) &&
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SEVERITY_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED) &&
- ((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_OPERATION_MASK) == EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE)) {
- AssertData = (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *)(Data + 1);
- *Filename = (CHAR8 *)(AssertData + 1);
- *Description = *Filename + AsciiStrLen (*Filename) + 1;
- *LineNumber = AssertData->LineNumber;
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts DEBUG() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by Data to the DEBUG() arguments specified
- by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format. If type GUID in Data is
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID, then extract ErrorLevel, Marker, and
- Format from the optional data area of the status code buffer specified by Data.
- The optional data area of Data contains a 32-bit ErrorLevel followed by Marker
- which is 12 UINTN parameters, followed by a Null-terminated ASCII string for
- the Format. If the DEBUG() information could be extracted from Data, then
- return TRUE. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ErrorLevel is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Marker is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Format is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param ErrorLevel Pointer to error level mask for a debug message.
- @param Marker Pointer to the variable argument list associated with Format.
- @param Format Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII format string of a
- debug message.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by Data was converted DEBUG() arguments
- specified by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by Data could not be converted to
- DEBUG() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractDebugInfo (
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT UINT32 *ErrorLevel,
- OUT BASE_LIST *Marker,
- OUT CHAR8 **Format
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_INFO *DebugInfo;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (ErrorLevel != NULL);
- ASSERT (Marker != NULL);
- ASSERT (Format != NULL);
-
- //
- // If the GUID type is not EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID then return FALSE
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (&Data->Type, &gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the debug information from the status code record
- //
- DebugInfo = (EFI_DEBUG_INFO *)(Data + 1);
-
- *ErrorLevel = DebugInfo->ErrorLevel;
-
- //
- // The first 12 * sizeof (UINT64) bytes following EFI_DEBUG_INFO are for variable arguments
- // of format in DEBUG string. Its address is returned in Marker and has to be 64-bit aligned.
- // It must be noticed that EFI_DEBUG_INFO follows EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA, whose size is
- // 20 bytes. The size of EFI_DEBUG_INFO is 4 bytes, so we can ensure that Marker
- // returned is 64-bit aligned.
- // 64-bit aligned is a must, otherwise retrieving 64-bit parameter from BASE_LIST will
- // cause unalignment exception.
- //
- *Marker = (BASE_LIST) (DebugInfo + 1);
- *Format = (CHAR8 *)(((UINT64 *)*Marker) + 12);
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code.
-
- Reports the status code specified by the parameters Type and Value. Status
- code also require an instance, caller ID, and extended data. This function
- passed in a zero instance, NULL extended data, and a caller ID of
- gEfiCallerIdGuid, which is the GUID for the module.
-
- ReportStatusCode()must actively prevent recusrsion. If ReportStatusCode()
- is called while processing another any other Report Status Code Library function,
- then ReportStatusCode() must return immediately.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR There status code could not be reported due to a
- device error.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value
- )
-{
- return InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, 0, &gEfiCallerIdGuid, NULL);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with a Device Path Protocol as the extended data.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- Device Path Protocol specified by DevicePath. This function is responsible
- for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and the device
- path. The standard header is filled in with a GUID of
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported with a zero
- instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If DevicePath is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param DevicePath Pointer to the Device Path Protocol to be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by DevicePath.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- ASSERT (DevicePath != NULL);
- //
- // EFI_UNSUPPORTED is returned for device path is not supported in PEI phase.
- //
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with an extended data buffer.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- extended data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize. ExtendedData
- is assumed to be one of the data structures specified in Related Definitions.
- These data structure do not have the standard header, so this function is
- responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled
- in with a GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported
- with a zero instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedDataSize is 0, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer to be reported.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer to
- be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- ASSERT (ExtendedData != NULL);
- ASSERT (ExtendedDataSize != 0);
- return ReportStatusCodeEx (
- Type,
- Value,
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- ExtendedData,
- ExtendedDataSize
- );
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with full parameters.
-
- The function reports a status code. If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize
- is 0, then an extended data buffer is not reported. If ExtendedData is not
- NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not 0, then an extended data buffer is allocated.
- ExtendedData is assumed not have the standard status code header, so this function
- is responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled in
- with a GUID specified by ExtendedDataGuid. If ExtendedDataGuid is NULL, then a
- GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDatauid is used. The status code is reported with
- an instance specified by Instance and a caller ID specified by CallerId. If
- CallerId is NULL, then a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
-
- ReportStatusCodeEx()must actively prevent recursion. If ReportStatusCodeEx()
- is called while processing another any other Report Status Code Library function,
- then ReportStatusCodeEx() must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedData is not NULL and ExtendedDataSize is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. If this parameter is NULL, then a caller
- ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
- @param ExtendedDataGuid Pointer to the GUID for the extended data buffer.
- If this parameter is NULL, then a the status code
- standard header is filled in with
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate
- the extended data section if it was specified.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeEx (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *ExtendedDataGuid OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData OPTIONAL,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *StatusCodeData;
- UINT64 Buffer[(MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE / sizeof (UINT64)) + 1];
-
- //
- // If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not zero, then ASSERT().
- //
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData == NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize != 0)));
- //
- // If ExtendedData is not NULL and ExtendedDataSize is zero, then ASSERT().
- //
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData != NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize == 0)));
-
- if (ExtendedDataSize > (MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE - sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA))) {
- //
- // The local variable Buffer not large enough to hold the extended data associated
- // with the status code being reported.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "Status code extended data is too large to be reported!\n"));
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- StatusCodeData = (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *) Buffer;
- StatusCodeData->HeaderSize = (UINT16) sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA);
- StatusCodeData->Size = (UINT16) ExtendedDataSize;
- if (ExtendedDataGuid == NULL) {
- ExtendedDataGuid = &gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid;
- }
- CopyGuid (&StatusCodeData->Type, ExtendedDataGuid);
- if (ExtendedData != NULL) {
- CopyMem (StatusCodeData + 1, ExtendedData, ExtendedDataSize);
- }
- if (CallerId == NULL) {
- CallerId = &gEfiCallerIdGuid;
- }
- return InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, Instance, CallerId, StatusCodeData);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_PROGRESS_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportProgressCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_ERROR_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportErrorCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_DEBUG_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportDebugCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 82882b8706..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,35 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null S3 Library instance does nothing and returns unsupported status.
-
- This library instance is no longer used and module using this library
- class should update to directly locate EFI_PEI_S3_RESUME_PPI defined
- in PI 1.2 specification.
-
-Copyright (c) 2006 - 2008, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <Library/S3Lib.h>
-
-/**
- This function is responsible for calling the S3 resume vector in the ACPI Tables.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCESS Success to restore config from S3.
- @retval Others Fail to restore config from S3.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-AcpiS3ResumeOs (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index f582054870..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null S3 library instance for PEIM module.
-# This library instance is no longer used and module using this library
-# class should update to directly locate EFI_PEI_S3_RESUME_PPI defined
-# in PI 1.2 specification.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PeiS3LibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PeiS3LibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 018E1925-D6A2-4a2a-8958-817610A15ADF
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = S3Lib|PEIM
-
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC (EBC is for build only)
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PeiS3LibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index ac0ce9f08d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PeiS3LibNull/PeiS3LibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptExecute.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptExecute.c deleted file mode 100644 index 45dd581b08..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptExecute.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1792 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Interpret and execute the S3 data in S3 boot script.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
- of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
- full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include "InternalBootScriptLib.h"
-
-/**
- Executes an SMBus operation to an SMBus controller. Returns when either the command has been
- executed or an error is encountered in doing the operation.
-
- The SmbusExecute() function provides a standard way to execute an operation as defined in the System
- Management Bus (SMBus) Specification. The resulting transaction will be either that the SMBus
- slave devices accept this transaction or that this function returns with error.
-
- @param SmbusAddress Address that encodes the SMBUS Slave Address, SMBUS Command, SMBUS Data Length,
- and PEC.
- @param Operation Signifies which particular SMBus hardware protocol instance that
- it will use to execute the SMBus transactions. This SMBus
- hardware protocol is defined by the SMBus Specification and is
- not related to EFI.
- @param Length Signifies the number of bytes that this operation will do. The
- maximum number of bytes can be revision specific and operation
- specific. This field will contain the actual number of bytes that
- are executed for this operation. Not all operations require this
- argument.
- @param Buffer Contains the value of data to execute to the SMBus slave device.
- Not all operations require this argument. The length of this
- buffer is identified by Length.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The last data that was returned from the access matched the poll
- exit criteria.
- @retval EFI_CRC_ERROR Checksum is not correct (PEC is incorrect).
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT Timeout expired before the operation was completed. Timeout is
- determined by the SMBus host controller device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The request could not be completed due to a lack of resources.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The request was not completed because a failure that was
- reflected in the Host Status Register bit. Device errors are a
- result of a transaction collision, illegal command field,
- unclaimed cycle (host initiated), or bus errors (collisions).
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Operation is not defined in EFI_SMBUS_OPERATION.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Length/Buffer is NULL for operations except for EfiSmbusQuickRead
- and EfiSmbusQuickWrite. Length is outside the range of valid
- values.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The SMBus operation or PEC is not supported.
- @retval EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL Buffer is not sufficient for this operation.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-SmbusExecute (
- IN UINTN SmbusAddress,
- IN EFI_SMBUS_OPERATION Operation,
- IN OUT UINTN *Length,
- IN OUT VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT8 WorkBuffer[MAX_SMBUS_BLOCK_LEN];
-
- switch (Operation) {
- case EfiSmbusQuickRead:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusQuickRead - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusQuickRead (SmbusAddress, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusQuickWrite:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusQuickWrite - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusQuickWrite (SmbusAddress, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusReceiveByte:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusReceiveByte - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusReceiveByte (SmbusAddress, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusSendByte:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusSendByte - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", SmbusAddress, (UINTN)*(UINT8 *) Buffer));
- SmBusSendByte (SmbusAddress, *(UINT8 *) Buffer, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusReadByte:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusReadByte - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusReadDataByte (SmbusAddress, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusWriteByte:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusWriteByte - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", SmbusAddress, (UINTN)*(UINT8 *) Buffer));
- SmBusWriteDataByte (SmbusAddress, *(UINT8 *) Buffer, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusReadWord:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusReadWord - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusReadDataWord (SmbusAddress, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusWriteWord:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusWriteWord - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", SmbusAddress, (UINTN)*(UINT16 *) Buffer));
- SmBusWriteDataWord (SmbusAddress, *(UINT16 *) Buffer, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusProcessCall:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusProcessCall - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", SmbusAddress, (UINTN)*(UINT16 *) Buffer));
- SmBusProcessCall (SmbusAddress, *(UINT16 *) Buffer, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusReadBlock:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusReadBlock - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusReadBlock (SmbusAddress, WorkBuffer, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusWriteBlock:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusWriteBlock - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusWriteBlock ((SmbusAddress + SMBUS_LIB_ADDRESS (0, 0, (*Length), FALSE)), Buffer, &Status);
- break;
- case EfiSmbusBWBRProcessCall:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EfiSmbusBWBRProcessCall - 0x%08x\n", SmbusAddress));
- SmBusBlockProcessCall ((SmbusAddress + SMBUS_LIB_ADDRESS (0, 0, (*Length), FALSE)), Buffer, WorkBuffer, &Status);
- break;
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Translates boot script width and address stride to MDE library interface.
-
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param AddressStride Instride for stepping input buffer.
- @param BufferStride Outstride for stepping output buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successful translation.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width or Address is invalid.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BuildLoopData (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- OUT UINTN *AddressStride,
- OUT UINTN *BufferStride
- )
-{
- UINTN AlignMask;
-
- if (Width >= S3BootScriptWidthMaximum) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *AddressStride = (UINT32)(1 << (Width & 0x03));
- *BufferStride = *AddressStride;
-
- AlignMask = *AddressStride - 1;
- if ((Address & AlignMask) != 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (Width >= S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 && Width <= S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64) {
- *AddressStride = 0;
- }
-
- if (Width >= S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 && Width <= S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- *BufferStride = 0;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Perform IO read operation
-
- @param[in] Width Width of the operation.
- @param[in] Address Address of the operation.
- @param[in] Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param[out] Buffer Pointer to the buffer to read from I/O space.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- Address is outside the legal range of I/O ports.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptIoRead (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- OUT VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN AddressStride;
- UINTN BufferStride;
- PTR Out;
-
- Out.Buf = (UINT8 *) Buffer;
-
- if (Address > MAX_IO_ADDRESS) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Status = BuildLoopData (Width, Address, &AddressStride, &BufferStride);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Loop for each iteration and move the data
- //
- for (; Count > 0; Count--, Address += AddressStride, Out.Buf += BufferStride) {
- switch (Width) {
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint8 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint8 = IoRead8 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint8 = IoRead8 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint8 = IoRead8 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint16 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint16 = IoRead16 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint16 = IoRead16 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint16 = IoRead16 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint32 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint32 = IoRead32 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint32 = IoRead32 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint32 = IoRead32 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint64 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint64 = IoRead64 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint64 = IoRead64 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) Address));
- *Out.Uint64 = IoRead64 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Perform IO write operation
-
- @param[in] Width Width of the operation.
- @param[in] Address Address of the operation.
- @param[in] Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param[in] Buffer Pointer to the buffer to write to I/O space.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- Address is outside the legal range of I/O ports.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptIoWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN AddressStride;
- UINTN BufferStride;
- UINT64 OriginalAddress;
- PTR In;
- PTR OriginalIn;
-
- In.Buf = (UINT8 *) Buffer;
-
- if (Address > MAX_IO_ADDRESS) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Status = BuildLoopData (Width, Address, &AddressStride, &BufferStride);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Loop for each iteration and move the data
- //
- OriginalAddress = Address;
- OriginalIn.Buf = In.Buf;
- for (; Count > 0; Count--, Address += AddressStride, In.Buf += BufferStride) {
- switch (Width) {
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*In.Uint8));
- IoWrite8 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint8));
- IoWrite8 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint8));
- IoWrite8 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*In.Uint16));
- IoWrite16 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint16));
- IoWrite16 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint16));
- IoWrite16 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*In.Uint32));
- IoWrite32 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint32));
- IoWrite32 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint32));
- IoWrite32 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint64 - 0x%08x (0x%016lx)\n", (UINTN)Address, *In.Uint64));
- IoWrite64 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint64);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 - 0x%08x (0x%016lx)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, *In.Uint64));
- IoWrite64 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint64);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64 - 0x%08x (0x%016lx)\n", (UINTN)Address, *OriginalIn.Uint64));
- IoWrite64 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint64);
- break;
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script Pointer to the node which is to be interpreted.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- Address is outside the legal range of I/O ports.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteIoWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINTN Count;
- VOID *Buffer;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE IoWrite;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&IoWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE));
- Width = (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) IoWrite.Width;
- Address = IoWrite.Address;
- Count = IoWrite.Count;
- Buffer = Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteIoWrite - 0x%08x, 0x%08x, 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address, Count, (UINTN)Width));
- return ScriptIoWrite(Width, Address, Count, Buffer);
-}
-/**
- Perform memory read operation
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer read from memory.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The address range specified by Address, Width, and Count
- is not valid for this EFI System.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptMemoryRead (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN OUT VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN AddressStride;
- UINTN BufferStride;
- PTR Out;
-
- Out.Buf = Buffer;
-
- Status = BuildLoopData (Width, Address, &AddressStride, &BufferStride);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Loop for each iteration and move the data
- //
- for (; Count > 0; Count--, Address += AddressStride, Out.Buf += BufferStride) {
- switch (Width) {
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint8 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint8 = MmioRead8 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint8 = MmioRead8 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint8 = MmioRead8 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint16 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint16 = MmioRead16 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint16 = MmioRead16 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint16 = MmioRead16 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint32 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint32 = MmioRead32 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint32 = MmioRead32 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint32 = MmioRead32 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint64 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint64 = MmioRead64 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint64 = MmioRead64 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64 - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address));
- *Out.Uint64 = MmioRead64 ((UINTN) Address);
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Perform memory write operation
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer write to memory.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The address range specified by Address, Width, and Count
- is not valid for this EFI System.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptMemoryWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN OUT VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN AddressStride;
- UINT64 OriginalAddress;
- UINTN BufferStride;
- PTR In;
- PTR OriginalIn;
-
- In.Buf = Buffer;
-
- Status = BuildLoopData (Width, Address, &AddressStride, &BufferStride);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Loop for each iteration and move the data
- //
- OriginalAddress = Address;
- OriginalIn.Buf = In.Buf;
- for (; Count > 0; Count--, Address += AddressStride, In.Buf += BufferStride) {
- switch (Width) {
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*In.Uint8));
- MmioWrite8 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint8));
- MmioWrite8 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint8));
- MmioWrite8 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*In.Uint16));
- MmioWrite16 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint16));
- MmioWrite16 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint16));
- MmioWrite16 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*In.Uint32));
- MmioWrite32 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint32));
- MmioWrite32 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)Address, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint32));
- MmioWrite32 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint64 - 0x%08x (0x%016lx)\n", (UINTN)Address, *In.Uint64));
- MmioWrite64 ((UINTN) Address, *In.Uint64);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 - 0x%08x (0x%016lx)\n", (UINTN)OriginalAddress, *In.Uint64));
- MmioWrite64 ((UINTN) OriginalAddress, *In.Uint64);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64 - 0x%08x (0x%016lx)\n", (UINTN)Address, *OriginalIn.Uint64));
- MmioWrite64 ((UINTN) Address, *OriginalIn.Uint64);
- break;
- default:
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param[in] Script Pointer to the node which is to be interpreted.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The address range specified by Address, Width, and Count
- is not valid for this EFI System.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteMemoryWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- VOID *Buffer;
- S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINTN Count;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE MemWrite;
-
- CopyMem((VOID*)&MemWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE));
- Width = (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH)MemWrite.Width;
- Address = MemWrite.Address;
- Count = MemWrite.Count;
- Buffer = Script + sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteMemoryWrite - 0x%08x, 0x%08x, 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Address, Count, (UINTN)Width));
- return ScriptMemoryWrite (Width,Address, Count, Buffer);
-
-}
-/**
- Performance PCI configuration read operation
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer read from PCI config space
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The read succeed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER if Width is not defined
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptPciCfgRead (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- OUT VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN AddressStride;
- UINTN BufferStride;
- PTR Out;
- UINTN PciAddress;
-
- Out.Buf = (UINT8 *) Buffer;
-
- PciAddress = PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (Address);
-
- Status = BuildLoopData (Width, PciAddress, &AddressStride, &BufferStride);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Loop for each iteration and move the data
- //
- for (; Count > 0; Count--, PciAddress += AddressStride, Out.Buf += BufferStride) {
- switch (Width) {
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint8 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint8 = PciRead8 (PciAddress);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint8 = PciRead8 (PciAddress);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint8 = PciRead8 (PciAddress);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint16 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint16 = PciRead16 (PciAddress);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint16 = PciRead16 (PciAddress);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint16 = PciRead16 (PciAddress);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint32 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint32 = PciRead32 (PciAddress);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint32 = PciRead32 (PciAddress);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32 - 0x%08x\n", PciAddress));
- *Out.Uint32 = PciRead32 (PciAddress);
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Performance PCI configuration write operation
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer write to PCI config space
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The write succeed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER if Width is not defined
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptPciCfgWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN AddressStride;
- UINTN BufferStride;
- UINTN OriginalPciAddress;
- PTR In;
- PTR OriginalIn;
- UINTN PciAddress;
-
- In.Buf = (UINT8 *) Buffer;
-
- PciAddress = PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (Address);
-
- Status = BuildLoopData (Width, PciAddress, &AddressStride, &BufferStride);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- //
- // Loop for each iteration and move the data
- //
- OriginalPciAddress = PciAddress;
- OriginalIn.Buf = In.Buf;
- for (; Count > 0; Count--, PciAddress += AddressStride, In.Buf += BufferStride) {
- switch (Width) {
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", PciAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint8));
- PciWrite8 (PciAddress, *In.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", OriginalPciAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint8));
- PciWrite8 (OriginalPciAddress, *In.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint8 - 0x%08x (0x%02x)\n", PciAddress, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint8));
- PciWrite8 (PciAddress, *OriginalIn.Uint8);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", PciAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint16));
- PciWrite16 (PciAddress, *In.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", OriginalPciAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint16));
- PciWrite16 (OriginalPciAddress, *In.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint16 - 0x%08x (0x%04x)\n", PciAddress, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint16));
- PciWrite16 (PciAddress, *OriginalIn.Uint16);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", PciAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint32));
- PciWrite32 (PciAddress, *In.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", OriginalPciAddress, (UINTN)*In.Uint32));
- PciWrite32 (OriginalPciAddress, *In.Uint32);
- break;
- case S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptWidthFillUint32 - 0x%08x (0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)PciAddress, (UINTN)*OriginalIn.Uint32));
- PciWrite32 (PciAddress, *OriginalIn.Uint32);
- break;
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Performance PCI configuration 2 read operation
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Segment Pci segment number
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer to read from PCI config space.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- Address is outside the legal range of I/O ports.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is the 'Segment' parameter is assumed as
- Zero, or else, assert.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ScriptPciCfg2Read (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT16 Segment,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- OUT VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- ASSERT (Segment==0);
-
- return ScriptPciCfgRead (Width, Address, Count, Buffer);
-}
-/**
- Performance PCI configuration 2 write operation
-
- @param Width Width of the operation.
- @param Segment Pci segment number
- @param Address Address of the operation.
- @param Count Count of the number of accesses to perform.
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer to write to PCI config space.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was written to the EFI System.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Width is invalid for this EFI System.
- Buffer is NULL.
- The Buffer is not aligned for the given Width.
- Address is outside the legal range of I/O ports.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is the 'Segment' parameter is assumed as
- Zero, or else, assert.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ScriptPciCfg2Write (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT16 Segment,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- ASSERT (Segment==0);
- return ScriptPciCfgWrite (Width, Address, Count, Buffer);
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecutePciCfgWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- VOID *Buffer;
- S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINTN Count;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE PciCfgWrite;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&PciCfgWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE));
-
- Width = (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH)PciCfgWrite.Width;
- Address = PciCfgWrite.Address;
- Count = PciCfgWrite.Count;
- Buffer = Script + sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecutePciCfgWrite - 0x%08x, 0x%08x, 0x%08x\n", PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (Address), Count, (UINTN)Width));
- return ScriptPciCfgWrite (Width, Address, Count, Buffer);
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteIoReadWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT64 Data;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE IoReadWrite;
-
- Data = 0;
-
- CopyMem((VOID*)&IoReadWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteIoReadWrite - 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", (UINTN)IoReadWrite.Address, AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Status = ScriptIoRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) IoReadWrite.Width,
- IoReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Data = (Data & AndMask) | OrMask;
- Status = ScriptIoWrite (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) IoReadWrite.Width,
- IoReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- }
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteMemoryReadWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT64 Data;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE MemReadWrite;
-
- Data = 0;
-
- CopyMem((VOID*)&MemReadWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteMemoryReadWrite - 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", (UINTN)MemReadWrite.Address, AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Status = ScriptMemoryRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) MemReadWrite.Width,
- MemReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Data = (Data & AndMask) | OrMask;
- Status = ScriptMemoryWrite (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) MemReadWrite.Width,
- MemReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- }
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CFG_READ_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecutePciCfgReadWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT64 Data;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE PciCfgReadWrite;
-
- Data = 0;
-
- CopyMem((VOID*)&PciCfgReadWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecutePciCfgReadWrite - 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (PciCfgReadWrite.Address), AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Status = ScriptPciCfgRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfgReadWrite.Width,
- PciCfgReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Data = (Data & AndMask) | OrMask;
-
- Status = ScriptPciCfgWrite (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfgReadWrite.Width,
- PciCfgReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
-
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Cannot locate smbus ppi or occur error of script execution
- @retval Others Result of script execution
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteSmbusExecute (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- UINTN SmBusAddress;
- UINTN DataSize;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE SmbusExecuteEntry;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&SmbusExecuteEntry, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE ));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteSmbusExecute - 0x%08x, 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)SmbusExecuteEntry.SmBusAddress, (UINTN)SmbusExecuteEntry.Operation));
-
- SmBusAddress = (UINTN)SmbusExecuteEntry.SmBusAddress;
- DataSize = (UINTN) SmbusExecuteEntry.DataSize;
- return SmbusExecute (
- SmBusAddress,
- (EFI_SMBUS_OPERATION) SmbusExecuteEntry.Operation,
- &DataSize,
- Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE)
- );
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteStall (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL Stall;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&Stall, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteStall - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)Stall.Duration));
-
- MicroSecondDelay ((UINTN) Stall.Duration);
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteDispatch (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- DISPATCH_ENTRYPOINT_FUNC EntryFunc;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH ScriptDispatch;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptDispatch, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH));
- EntryFunc = (DISPATCH_ENTRYPOINT_FUNC) (UINTN) (ScriptDispatch.EntryPoint);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteDispatch - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)ScriptDispatch.EntryPoint));
-
- Status = EntryFunc (NULL, NULL);
-
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2 OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteDispatch2 (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- DISPATCH_ENTRYPOINT_FUNC EntryFunc;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2 ScriptDispatch2;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptDispatch2, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteDispatch2 - 0x%08x(0x%08x)\n", (UINTN)ScriptDispatch2.EntryPoint, (UINTN)ScriptDispatch2.Context));
-
- EntryFunc = (DISPATCH_ENTRYPOINT_FUNC) (UINTN) (ScriptDispatch2.EntryPoint);
-
- Status = EntryFunc (NULL, (VOID *) (UINTN) ScriptDispatch2.Context);
-
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Data polled from memory does not equal to
- the epecting data within the Loop Times.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteMemPoll (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-{
-
- UINT64 Data;
- UINT64 LoopTimes;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL MemPoll;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&MemPoll, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteMemPoll - 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", (UINTN)MemPoll.Address, AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptMemoryRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) MemPoll.Width,
- MemPoll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) && (Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- for (LoopTimes = 0; LoopTimes < MemPoll.LoopTimes; LoopTimes++) {
- MicroSecondDelay ((UINTN)MemPoll.Duration);
-
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptMemoryRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) MemPoll.Width,
- MemPoll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) && (Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- }
-
- if (LoopTimes < MemPoll.LoopTimes) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-}
-/**
- Execute the boot script to interpret the Store arbitrary information.
- This opcode is a no-op on dispatch and is only used for debugging script issues.
-
- @param Script The pointer of node in boot script table
-
-**/
-VOID
-BootScriptExecuteInformation (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION Information;
- UINT8 *InformationData;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&Information, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION));
-
- InformationData = Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteInformation - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) InformationData));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptInformation: "));
- for (Index = 0; Index < Information.InformationLength; Index++) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%02x ", InformationData[Index]));
- }
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "\n"));
-}
-
-/**
- Execute the boot script to interpret the Label information.
-
- @param Script The pointer of node in boot script table
-
-**/
-VOID
-BootScriptExecuteLabel (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION Information;
- UINT8 *InformationData;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&Information, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION));
-
- InformationData = Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteLabel - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN) InformationData));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptLabel: "));
- for (Index = 0; Index < Information.InformationLength; Index++) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%02x ", InformationData[Index]));
- }
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "\n"));
-}
-
-/**
- calculate the mask value for 'and' and 'or' operation
- @param ScriptHeader The pointer of header of node in boot script table
- @param AndMask The Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask The Mask value for 'or' operation
- @param Script Pointer to the entry.
-
-**/
-VOID
-CheckAndOrMask (
- IN EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER *ScriptHeader,
- OUT UINT64 *AndMask,
- OUT UINT64 *OrMask,
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- UINT8 *DataPtr;
- UINTN Size;
-
- switch (ScriptHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE);
- break;
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL_OPCODE:
- Size = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL);
- break;
-
- default:
- return;
- }
-
- DataPtr = Script + Size;
-
- switch (ScriptHeader->Width) {
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint8:
- *AndMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT8*) (DataPtr + 1));
- *OrMask = (UINT64) (*DataPtr);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint16:
- *AndMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT16 *) (DataPtr + 2));
- *OrMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT16 *) DataPtr);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint32:
- *AndMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT32 *) (DataPtr + 4));
- *OrMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT32 *) DataPtr);
- break;
-
- case S3BootScriptWidthUint64:
- *AndMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT64 *) (DataPtr + 8));
- *OrMask = (UINT64) (*(UINT64 *) DataPtr);
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-
- return;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of typed node in boot script table
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Data polled from memory does not equal to
- the epecting data within the Loop Times.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecuteIoPoll (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT64 Data;
- UINT64 LoopTimes;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL IoPoll;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&IoPoll, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecuteIoPoll - 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", (UINTN)IoPoll.Address, AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptIoRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) IoPoll.Width,
- IoPoll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) && (Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- for (LoopTimes = 0; LoopTimes < IoPoll.Delay; LoopTimes++) {
- NanoSecondDelay (100);
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptIoRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) IoPoll.Width,
- IoPoll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) &&(Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- }
-
- if (LoopTimes < IoPoll.Delay) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of S3 boot script
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecutePciCfg2Write (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- VOID *Buffer;
- S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width;
- UINT16 Segment;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINTN Count;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE PciCfg2Write;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&PciCfg2Write, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE));
-
- Width = (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH)PciCfg2Write.Width;
- Segment = PciCfg2Write.Segment;
- Address = PciCfg2Write.Address;
- Count = PciCfg2Write.Count;
- Buffer = Script + sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecutePciCfg2Write - 0x%04x, 0x%08x, 0x%08x, 0x%08x\n", Segment, PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (Address), Count, (UINTN)Width));
- return ScriptPciCfg2Write (Width, Segment, Address, Count, Buffer);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of S3 boot script
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptExecutePciCfg2ReadWrite (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-{
- UINT64 Data;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE PciCfg2ReadWrite;
-
- Data = 0;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&PciCfg2ReadWrite, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptExecutePciCfg2ReadWrite - 0x%04x, 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", PciCfg2ReadWrite.Segment, PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (PciCfg2ReadWrite.Address), AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Status = ScriptPciCfg2Read (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfg2ReadWrite.Width,
- PciCfg2ReadWrite.Segment,
- PciCfg2ReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Data = (Data & AndMask) | OrMask;
- Status = ScriptPciCfg2Write (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfg2ReadWrite.Width,
- PciCfg2ReadWrite.Segment,
- PciCfg2ReadWrite.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- return Status;
-}
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of S3 boot script
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Data polled from Pci configuration space does not equal to
- epecting data within the Loop Times.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptPciCfgPoll (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-{
- UINT64 Data;
- UINT64 LoopTimes;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL PciCfgPoll;
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&PciCfgPoll, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptPciCfgPoll - 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (PciCfgPoll.Address), AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptPciCfgRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfgPoll.Width,
- PciCfgPoll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) &&(Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- for (LoopTimes = 0; LoopTimes < PciCfgPoll.Delay; LoopTimes++) {
- NanoSecondDelay (100);
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptPciCfgRead (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfgPoll.Width,
- PciCfgPoll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) &&
- (Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- }
-
- if (LoopTimes < PciCfgPoll.Delay) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Interprete the boot script node with EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL OP code.
-
- @param Script The pointer of S3 Boot Script
- @param AndMask Mask value for 'and' operation
- @param OrMask Mask value for 'or' operation
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation was executed successfully
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Data polled from Pci configuration space does not equal to
- epecting data within the Loop Times.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BootScriptPciCfg2Poll (
- IN UINT8 *Script,
- IN UINT64 AndMask,
- IN UINT64 OrMask
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT64 Data;
- UINT64 LoopTimes;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL PciCfg2Poll;
-
- Data = 0;
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&PciCfg2Poll, (VOID*)Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL));
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "BootScriptPciCfg2Poll - 0x%04x, 0x%08x, 0x%016lx, 0x%016lx\n", PciCfg2Poll.Segment, PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE (PciCfg2Poll.Address), AndMask, OrMask));
-
- Status = ScriptPciCfg2Read (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfg2Poll.Width,
- PciCfg2Poll.Segment,
- PciCfg2Poll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) && (Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- for (LoopTimes = 0; LoopTimes < PciCfg2Poll.Delay; LoopTimes++) {
- NanoSecondDelay (100);
-
- Data = 0;
- Status = ScriptPciCfg2Read (
- (S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH) PciCfg2Poll.Width,
- PciCfg2Poll.Segment,
- PciCfg2Poll.Address,
- 1,
- &Data
- );
- if ((!EFI_ERROR (Status)) && (Data & AndMask) == OrMask) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- }
-
- if (LoopTimes < PciCfg2Poll.Delay) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
- }
-
-}
-
-/**
- Executes the S3 boot script table.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The boot script table was executed successfully.
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED Invalid script table or opcode.
-
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation: When interpreting the opcode EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE_OPCODE
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE_OPCODE and EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL_OPCODE, the 'Segment' parameter is assumed as
- Zero, or else, assert.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptExecute (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT8* Script;
- UINTN StartAddress;
- UINT32 TableLength;
- UINT64 AndMask;
- UINT64 OrMask;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER ScriptHeader;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER TableHeader;
- Script = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase;
- if (Script != 0) {
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&TableHeader, Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER));
- } else {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptExecute:\n"));
- if (TableHeader.OpCode != S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TABLE_OPCODE) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "TableHeader - 0x%08x\n", Script));
-
- StartAddress = (UINTN) Script;
- TableLength = TableHeader.TableLength;
- Script = Script + TableHeader.Length;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- AndMask = 0;
- OrMask = 0;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "TableHeader.Version - 0x%04x\n", (UINTN)TableHeader.Version));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "TableHeader.TableLength - 0x%08x\n", (UINTN)TableLength));
-
- while ((UINTN) Script < (UINTN) (StartAddress + TableLength)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "ExecuteBootScript - %08x\n", (UINTN)Script));
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptHeader, Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER));
- switch (ScriptHeader.OpCode) {
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecuteMemoryWrite (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptExecuteMemoryReadWrite (
- Script,
- AndMask,
- OrMask
- );
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecuteIoWrite (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecutePciCfgWrite (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptExecutePciCfgReadWrite (
- Script,
- AndMask,
- OrMask
- );
- break;
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecutePciCfg2Write (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptExecutePciCfg2ReadWrite (
- Script,
- AndMask,
- OrMask
- );
- break;
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecuteDispatch (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecuteDispatch2 (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION_OPCODE\n"));
- BootScriptExecuteInformation (Script);
- break;
-
- case S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TERMINATE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TERMINATE_OPCODE\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptDone - %r\n", EFI_SUCCESS));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptExecuteIoReadWrite (
- Script,
- AndMask,
- OrMask
- );
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecuteSmbusExecute (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL_OPCODE\n"));
- Status = BootScriptExecuteStall (Script);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptExecuteMemPoll (Script, AndMask, OrMask);
-
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptExecuteIoPoll (Script, AndMask, OrMask);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptPciCfgPoll (Script, AndMask, OrMask);
- break;
-
- case EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL_OPCODE:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL_OPCODE\n"));
- CheckAndOrMask (&ScriptHeader, &AndMask, &OrMask, Script);
- Status = BootScriptPciCfg2Poll (Script, AndMask, OrMask);
- break;
-
- case S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_LABEL_OPCODE:
- //
- // For label
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_LABEL_OPCODE\n"));
- BootScriptExecuteLabel (Script);
- break;
- default:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptDone - %r\n", EFI_UNSUPPORTED));
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptDone - %r\n", Status));
- return Status;
- }
-
- Script = Script + ScriptHeader.Length;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "S3BootScriptDone - %r\n", Status));
-
- return Status;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptInternalFormat.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptInternalFormat.h deleted file mode 100644 index 99cb407dbd..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptInternalFormat.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,188 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This file declares the internal Framework Boot Script format used by
- the PI implementation of Script Saver and Executor.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
- of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
- full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _BOOT_SCRIPT_INTERNAL_FORMAT_H_
-#define _BOOT_SCRIPT_INTERNAL_FORMAT_H_
-
-#pragma pack(1)
-
-//
-// Boot Script Opcode Header Structure Definitions
-//
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_GENERIC_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT16 Version;
- UINT32 TableLength;
- UINT16 Reserved[2];
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT32 Count;
- UINT64 Address;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT32 Count;
- UINT64 Address;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT32 Count;
- UINT64 Address;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT32 Count;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINT16 Segment;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINT16 Segment;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT64 SmBusAddress;
- UINT32 Operation;
- UINT32 DataSize;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT64 Duration;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS EntryPoint;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS EntryPoint;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Context;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINT64 Duration;
- UINT64 LoopTimes;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 InformationLength;
-// UINT8 InformationData[InformationLength];
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINT64 Delay;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINT64 Delay;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT32 Width;
- UINT64 Address;
- UINT16 Segment;
- UINT64 Delay;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length;
-} EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE;
-
-
-#pragma pack()
-
-#define BOOT_SCRIPT_NODE_MAX_LENGTH 1024
-
-#define BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_VERSION 0x0001
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptSave.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptSave.c deleted file mode 100644 index 0459bae4c6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/BootScriptSave.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2358 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Save the S3 data to S3 boot script.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
- of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
- full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#include "InternalBootScriptLib.h"
-
-/**
-
- Data structure usage:
-
- +------------------------------+<------- PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateDataPtr
- | SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA | (mS3BootScriptTablePtr, Before SmmReadyToLock)
- | TableBase |--- PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateSmmDataPtr
- | TableLength |--|-- (mS3BootScriptTablePtr = mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr, After SmmReadyToLock InSmm)
- | TableMemoryPageNumber |--|-|----
- | AtRuntime | | | |
- | InSmm | | | |
- | BootTimeScriptLength |--|-|---|---
- | SmmLocked | | | | |
- | BackFromS3 | | | | |
- +------------------------------+ | | | |
- | | | |
- +------------------------------+<-- | | |
- | EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER | | | |
- | TableLength |----|-- | |
- +------------------------------+ | | | |
- | ...... | | | | |
- +------------------------------+<---- | | |
- | EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE | | | |
- +------------------------------+<------ | |
- | |
- | |
- mBootScriptDataBootTimeGuid LockBox: | |
- Used to restore data after back from S3| |
- to handle potential INSERT boot script | |
- at runtime. | |
- +------------------------------+ | |
- | Boot Time Boot Script | | |
- | Before SmmReadyToLock | | |
- | | | |
- | | | |
- +------------------------------+ | |
- | Boot Time Boot Script | | |
- | After SmmReadyToLock InSmm | | |
- | | | |
- +------------------------------+<-------|--|
- | |
- | |
- mBootScriptDataGuid LockBox: (IN_PLACE) | |
- Used to restore data at S3 resume. | |
- +------------------------------+ | |
- | Boot Time Boot Script | | |
- | Before SmmReadyToLock | | |
- | | | |
- | | | |
- +------------------------------+ | |
- | Boot Time Boot Script | | |
- | After SmmReadyToLock InSmm | | |
- | | | |
- +------------------------------+<-------|---
- | Runtime Boot Script | |
- | After SmmReadyToLock InSmm | |
- +------------------------------+ |
- | ...... | |
- +------------------------------+<--------
-
-
- mBootScriptTableBaseGuid LockBox: (IN_PLACE)
- +------------------------------+
- | mS3BootScriptTablePtr-> |
- | TableBase |
- +------------------------------+
-
-
- mBootScriptSmmPrivateDataGuid LockBox: (IN_PLACE)
- SMM private data with BackFromS3 = TRUE
- at runtime. S3 will help restore it to
- tell the Library the system is back from S3.
- +------------------------------+
- | SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA |
- | TableBase |
- | TableLength |
- | TableMemoryPageNumber |
- | AtRuntime |
- | InSmm |
- | BootTimeScriptLength |
- | SmmLocked |
- | BackFromS3 = TRUE |
- +------------------------------+
-
-**/
-
-SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA *mS3BootScriptTablePtr;
-
-//
-// Allocate SMM copy because we can not use mS3BootScriptTablePtr after SmmReadyToLock in InSmm.
-//
-SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA *mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr;
-
-EFI_GUID mBootScriptDataGuid = {
- 0xaea6b965, 0xdcf5, 0x4311, { 0xb4, 0xb8, 0xf, 0x12, 0x46, 0x44, 0x94, 0xd2 }
-};
-
-EFI_GUID mBootScriptDataBootTimeGuid = {
- 0xb5af1d7a, 0xb8cf, 0x4eb3, { 0x89, 0x25, 0xa8, 0x20, 0xe1, 0x6b, 0x68, 0x7d }
-};
-
-EFI_GUID mBootScriptTableBaseGuid = {
- 0x1810ab4a, 0x2314, 0x4df6, { 0x81, 0xeb, 0x67, 0xc6, 0xec, 0x5, 0x85, 0x91 }
-};
-
-EFI_GUID mBootScriptSmmPrivateDataGuid = {
- 0x627ee2da, 0x3bf9, 0x439b, { 0x92, 0x9f, 0x2e, 0xe, 0x6e, 0x9d, 0xba, 0x62 }
-};
-
-EFI_EVENT mEventDxeSmmReadyToLock = NULL;
-VOID *mRegistrationSmmExitBootServices = NULL;
-VOID *mRegistrationSmmLegacyBoot = NULL;
-VOID *mRegistrationSmmReadyToLock = NULL;
-BOOLEAN mS3BootScriptTableAllocated = FALSE;
-BOOLEAN mS3BootScriptTableSmmAllocated = FALSE;
-EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 *mBootScriptSmst = NULL;
-
-/**
- This is an internal function to add a terminate node the entry, recalculate the table
- length and fill into the table.
-
- @return the base address of the boot script table.
- **/
-UINT8*
-S3BootScriptInternalCloseTable (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINT8 *S3TableBase;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE ScriptTerminate;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER *ScriptTableInfo;
- S3TableBase = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase;
-
- if (S3TableBase == NULL) {
- //
- // the table is not exist
- //
- return S3TableBase;
- }
- //
- // Append the termination entry.
- //
- ScriptTerminate.OpCode = S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TERMINATE_OPCODE;
- ScriptTerminate.Length = (UINT8) sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE);
- CopyMem (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase + mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength, &ScriptTerminate, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE));
- //
- // fill the table length
- //
- ScriptTableInfo = (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER*)(mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase);
- ScriptTableInfo->TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE);
-
-
-
- return S3TableBase;
- //
- // NOTE: Here we did NOT adjust the mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength to
- // mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE).
- // Because maybe after SmmReadyToLock, we still need add entries into the table,
- // and the entry should be added start before this TERMINATE node.
- //
-}
-
-/**
- This function save boot script data to LockBox.
-
-**/
-VOID
-SaveBootScriptDataToLockBox (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Save whole memory copy into LockBox.
- // It will be used to restore data at S3 resume.
- //
- Status = SaveLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataGuid,
- (VOID *)mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase,
- EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableMemoryPageNumber)
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = SetLockBoxAttributes (&mBootScriptDataGuid, LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Just need save TableBase.
- // Do not update other field because they will NOT be used in S3.
- //
- Status = SaveLockBox (
- &mBootScriptTableBaseGuid,
- (VOID *)&mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase,
- sizeof(mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase)
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = SetLockBoxAttributes (&mBootScriptTableBaseGuid, LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- This is the Event call back function to notify the Library the system is entering
- SmmLocked phase.
-
- @param Event Pointer to this event
- @param Context Event handler private data
- **/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptEventCallBack (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VOID *Interface;
-
- //
- // Try to locate it because EfiCreateProtocolNotifyEvent will trigger it once when registration.
- // Just return if it is not found.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiDxeSmmReadyToLockProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &Interface
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- //
- // Here we should tell the library that we are entering SmmLocked phase.
- // and the memory page number occupied by the table should not grow anymore.
- //
- if (!mS3BootScriptTablePtr->SmmLocked) {
- //
- // Before SmmReadyToLock, we need not write the terminate node when adding a node to boot scipt table
- // or else, that will impact the performance. However, after SmmReadyToLock, we should append terminate
- // node on every add to boot script table.
- //
- S3BootScriptInternalCloseTable ();
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->SmmLocked = TRUE;
-
- //
- // Save BootScript data to lockbox
- //
- SaveBootScriptDataToLockBox ();
- }
-}
-
-/**
- This is the Event call back function is triggered in SMM to notify the Library
- the system is entering SmmLocked phase and set InSmm flag.
-
- @param Protocol Points to the protocol's unique identifier
- @param Interface Points to the interface instance
- @param Handle The handle on which the interface was installed
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS SmmEventCallback runs successfully
- **/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSmmEventCallBack (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *Protocol,
- IN VOID *Interface,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- )
-{
- //
- // Check if it is already done
- //
- if (mS3BootScriptTablePtr == mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Last chance to call-out, just make sure SmmLocked is set.
- //
- S3BootScriptEventCallBack (NULL, NULL);
-
- //
- // Save a SMM copy. If TableBase is NOT null, it means SMM copy has been ready, skip copy mem.
- //
- if (mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr->TableBase == NULL) {
- CopyMem (mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr, mS3BootScriptTablePtr, sizeof(*mS3BootScriptTablePtr));
-
- //
- // Set InSmm, we allow boot script update when InSmm, but not allow boot script outside SMM.
- // InSmm will only be checked if SmmLocked is TRUE.
- //
- mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr->InSmm = TRUE;
- }
- //
- // We should not use ACPI Reserved copy, because it is not safe.
- //
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr = mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function is to save boot time boot script data to LockBox.
-
- Because there may be INSERT boot script at runtime in SMM.
- The boot time copy will be used to restore data after back from S3.
- Otherwise the data inserted may cause some boot time boot script data lost
- if only BootScriptData used.
-
-**/
-VOID
-SaveBootTimeDataToLockBox (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // ACPI Reserved copy is not safe, restore from BootScriptData LockBox first,
- // and then save the data to BootScriptDataBootTime LockBox.
- //
- Status = RestoreLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataGuid,
- NULL,
- NULL
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Save BootScriptDataBootTime
- // It will be used to restore data after back from S3.
- //
- Status = SaveLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataBootTimeGuid,
- (VOID *) mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase,
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BootTimeScriptLength
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- This function save boot script SMM private data to LockBox with BackFromS3 = TRUE at runtime.
- S3 resume will help restore it to tell the Library the system is back from S3.
-
-**/
-VOID
-SaveSmmPriviateDataToLockBoxAtRuntime (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Save boot script SMM private data with BackFromS3 = TRUE.
- //
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BackFromS3 = TRUE;
- Status = SaveLockBox (
- &mBootScriptSmmPrivateDataGuid,
- (VOID *) mS3BootScriptTablePtr,
- sizeof (SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA)
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = SetLockBoxAttributes (&mBootScriptSmmPrivateDataGuid, LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Set BackFromS3 flag back to FALSE to indicate that now is not back from S3.
- //
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BackFromS3 = FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- This is the Event call back function is triggered in SMM to notify the Library
- the system is entering runtime phase.
-
- @param[in] Protocol Points to the protocol's unique identifier
- @param[in] Interface Points to the interface instance
- @param[in] Handle The handle on which the interface was installed
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS SmmAtRuntimeCallBack runs successfully
- **/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSmmAtRuntimeCallBack (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *Protocol,
- IN VOID *Interface,
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- )
-{
- if (!mS3BootScriptTablePtr->AtRuntime) {
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BootTimeScriptLength = (UINT32) (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE));
- SaveBootTimeDataToLockBox ();
-
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->AtRuntime = TRUE;
- SaveSmmPriviateDataToLockBoxAtRuntime ();
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Library Constructor.
- this function just identify it is a smm driver or non-smm driver linked against
- with the library
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The constructor always returns RETURN_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptLibInitialize (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA *S3TablePtr;
- SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA *S3TableSmmPtr;
- VOID *Registration;
- EFI_SMM_BASE2_PROTOCOL *SmmBase2;
- BOOLEAN InSmm;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Buffer;
-
- S3TablePtr = (SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA*)(UINTN)PcdGet64(PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateDataPtr);
- //
- // The Boot script private data is not be initialized. create it
- //
- if (S3TablePtr == 0) {
- Buffer = SIZE_4GB - 1;
- Status = gBS->AllocatePages (
- AllocateMaxAddress,
- EfiReservedMemoryType,
- EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES(sizeof(SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA)),
- &Buffer
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- mS3BootScriptTableAllocated = TRUE;
- S3TablePtr = (VOID *) (UINTN) Buffer;
-
- Status = PcdSet64S (PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateDataPtr, (UINT64) (UINTN)S3TablePtr);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- ZeroMem (S3TablePtr, sizeof(SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA));
- //
- // Create event to notify the library system enter the SmmLocked phase.
- //
- mEventDxeSmmReadyToLock = EfiCreateProtocolNotifyEvent (
- &gEfiDxeSmmReadyToLockProtocolGuid,
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- S3BootScriptEventCallBack,
- NULL,
- &Registration
- );
- ASSERT (mEventDxeSmmReadyToLock != NULL);
- }
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr = S3TablePtr;
-
- //
- // Get InSmm, we need to register SmmReadyToLock if this library is linked to SMM driver.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiSmmBase2ProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID**) &SmmBase2);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
- }
- Status = SmmBase2->InSmm (SmmBase2, &InSmm);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
- }
- if (!InSmm) {
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
- }
- //
- // Good, we are in SMM
- //
- Status = SmmBase2->GetSmstLocation (SmmBase2, &mBootScriptSmst);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- S3TableSmmPtr = (SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA*)(UINTN)PcdGet64(PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateSmmDataPtr);
- //
- // The Boot script private data in SMM is not be initialized. create it
- //
- if (S3TableSmmPtr == 0) {
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmAllocatePool (
- EfiRuntimeServicesData,
- sizeof(SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA),
- (VOID **) &S3TableSmmPtr
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- mS3BootScriptTableSmmAllocated = TRUE;
-
- Status = PcdSet64S (PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateSmmDataPtr, (UINT64) (UINTN)S3TableSmmPtr);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- ZeroMem (S3TableSmmPtr, sizeof(SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA));
-
- //
- // Register SmmExitBootServices and SmmLegacyBoot notification.
- //
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmRegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEdkiiSmmExitBootServicesProtocolGuid,
- S3BootScriptSmmAtRuntimeCallBack,
- &mRegistrationSmmExitBootServices
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmRegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEdkiiSmmLegacyBootProtocolGuid,
- S3BootScriptSmmAtRuntimeCallBack,
- &mRegistrationSmmLegacyBoot
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr = S3TableSmmPtr;
-
- //
- // Register SmmReadyToLock notification.
- //
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmRegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEfiSmmReadyToLockProtocolGuid,
- S3BootScriptSmmEventCallBack,
- &mRegistrationSmmReadyToLock
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Library Destructor to free the resources allocated by
- S3BootScriptLibInitialize() and unregister callbacks.
-
- NOTICE: The destructor doesn't support unloading as a separate action, and it
- only supports unloading if the containing driver's entry point function fails.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The destructor always returns RETURN_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptLibDeinitialize (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%a() in %a module\n", __FUNCTION__, gEfiCallerBaseName));
-
- if (mEventDxeSmmReadyToLock != NULL) {
- //
- // Close the DxeSmmReadyToLock event.
- //
- Status = gBS->CloseEvent (mEventDxeSmmReadyToLock);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
-
- if (mBootScriptSmst != NULL) {
- if (mRegistrationSmmExitBootServices != NULL) {
- //
- // Unregister SmmExitBootServices notification.
- //
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmRegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEdkiiSmmExitBootServicesProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &mRegistrationSmmExitBootServices
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- if (mRegistrationSmmLegacyBoot != NULL) {
- //
- // Unregister SmmLegacyBoot notification.
- //
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmRegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEdkiiSmmLegacyBootProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &mRegistrationSmmLegacyBoot
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- if (mRegistrationSmmReadyToLock != NULL) {
- //
- // Unregister SmmReadyToLock notification.
- //
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmRegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEfiSmmReadyToLockProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &mRegistrationSmmReadyToLock
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Free the resources allocated and set PCDs to 0.
- //
- if (mS3BootScriptTableAllocated) {
- Status = gBS->FreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) mS3BootScriptTablePtr, EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES(sizeof(SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA)));
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Status = PcdSet64S (PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateDataPtr, 0);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- if ((mBootScriptSmst != NULL) && mS3BootScriptTableSmmAllocated) {
- Status = mBootScriptSmst->SmmFreePool (mS3BootScriptTableSmmPtr);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Status = PcdSet64S (PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateSmmDataPtr, 0);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- To get the start address from which a new boot time s3 boot script entry will write into.
- If the table is not exist, the functio will first allocate a buffer for the table
- If the table buffer is not enough for the new entry, in non-smm mode, the funtion will
- invoke reallocate to enlarge buffer.
-
- @param EntryLength the new entry length.
-
- @retval the address from which the a new s3 boot script entry will write into
- **/
-UINT8*
-S3BootScriptGetBootTimeEntryAddAddress (
- UINT8 EntryLength
- )
-{
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS S3TableBase;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS NewS3TableBase;
- UINT8 *NewEntryPtr;
- UINT32 TableLength;
- UINT16 PageNumber;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER *ScriptTableInfo;
-
- S3TableBase = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)(mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase);
- if (S3TableBase == 0) {
- //
- // The table is not exist. This is the first to add entry.
- // Allocate ACPI script table space under 4G memory.
- //
- S3TableBase = 0xffffffff;
- Status = gBS->AllocatePages (
- AllocateMaxAddress,
- EfiReservedMemoryType,
- 2 + PcdGet16(PcdS3BootScriptRuntimeTableReservePageNumber),
- (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS*)&S3TableBase
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- return 0;
- }
- //
- // Fill Table Header
- //
- ScriptTableInfo = (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER*)(UINTN)S3TableBase;
- ScriptTableInfo->OpCode = S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TABLE_OPCODE;
- ScriptTableInfo->Length = (UINT8) sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER);
- ScriptTableInfo->Version = BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_VERSION;
- ScriptTableInfo->TableLength = 0; // will be calculate at CloseTable
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER);
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase = (UINT8*)(UINTN)S3TableBase;
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableMemoryPageNumber = (UINT16)(2 + PcdGet16(PcdS3BootScriptRuntimeTableReservePageNumber));
- }
-
- // Here we do not count the reserved memory for runtime script table.
- PageNumber = (UINT16) (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableMemoryPageNumber - PcdGet16(PcdS3BootScriptRuntimeTableReservePageNumber));
- TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength;
- if ((UINTN) EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE ((UINTN) PageNumber) < (UINTN) (TableLength + EntryLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE))) {
- //
- // The buffer is too small to hold the table, Reallocate the buffer
- //
- NewS3TableBase = 0xffffffff;
- Status = gBS->AllocatePages (
- AllocateMaxAddress,
- EfiReservedMemoryType,
- 2 + PageNumber + PcdGet16(PcdS3BootScriptRuntimeTableReservePageNumber),
- (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS*)&NewS3TableBase
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- return 0;
- }
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(UINTN)NewS3TableBase, (VOID*)(UINTN)S3TableBase, TableLength);
- gBS->FreePages (S3TableBase, mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableMemoryPageNumber);
-
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase = (UINT8*)(UINTN)NewS3TableBase;
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableMemoryPageNumber = (UINT16) (2 + PageNumber + PcdGet16(PcdS3BootScriptRuntimeTableReservePageNumber));
- }
- //
- // calculate the the start address for the new entry.
- //
- NewEntryPtr = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase + TableLength;
-
- //
- // update the table lenghth
- //
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength = TableLength + EntryLength;
-
- //
- // In the boot time, we will not append the termination entry to the boot script
- // table until the callers think there is no boot time data that should be added and
- // it is caller's responsibility to explicit call the CloseTable.
- //
- //
-
- return NewEntryPtr;
-}
-/**
- To get the start address from which a new runtime(after SmmReadyToLock) s3 boot script entry will write into.
- In this case, it should be ensured that there is enough buffer to hold the entry.
-
- @param EntryLength the new entry length.
-
- @retval the address from which the a new s3 runtime(after SmmReadyToLock) script entry will write into
- **/
-UINT8*
-S3BootScriptGetRuntimeEntryAddAddress (
- UINT8 EntryLength
- )
-{
- UINT8 *NewEntryPtr;
-
- NewEntryPtr = NULL;
- //
- // Check if the memory range reserved for S3 Boot Script table is large enough to hold the node.
- //
- if ((UINTN) (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + EntryLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE)) <= (UINTN) EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE ((UINTN) (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableMemoryPageNumber))) {
- NewEntryPtr = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase + mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength;
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + EntryLength;
- //
- // Append a terminate node on every insert
- //
- S3BootScriptInternalCloseTable ();
- }
- return (UINT8*)NewEntryPtr;
-}
-
-/**
- This function is to restore boot time boot script data from LockBox.
-
-**/
-VOID
-RestoreBootTimeDataFromLockBox (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN LockBoxLength;
-
- //
- // Restore boot time boot script data from LockBox.
- //
- LockBoxLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BootTimeScriptLength;
- Status = RestoreLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataBootTimeGuid,
- (VOID *) mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase,
- &LockBoxLength
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Update the data to BootScriptData LockBox.
- //
- Status = UpdateLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataGuid,
- 0,
- (VOID *) mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase,
- LockBoxLength
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Update TableLength.
- //
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength = (UINT32) (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BootTimeScriptLength - sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE));
-}
-
-/**
- To get the start address from which a new s3 boot script entry will write into.
-
- @param EntryLength the new entry length.
-
- @retval the address from which the a new s3 boot script entry will write into
- **/
-UINT8*
-S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (
- UINT8 EntryLength
- )
-{
- UINT8* NewEntryPtr;
-
- if (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->SmmLocked) {
- //
- // We need check InSmm, because after SmmReadyToLock, only SMM driver is allowed to write boot script.
- //
- if (!mS3BootScriptTablePtr->InSmm) {
- //
- // Add DEBUG ERROR, so that we can find it after SmmReadyToLock.
- // Do not use ASSERT, because we may have test to invoke this interface.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FATAL ERROR: Set boot script outside SMM after SmmReadyToLock!!!\n"));
- return NULL;
- }
-
- if (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BackFromS3) {
- //
- // Back from S3, restore boot time boot script data from LockBox
- // and set BackFromS3 flag back to FALSE.
- //
- RestoreBootTimeDataFromLockBox ();
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->BackFromS3 = FALSE;
- }
-
- NewEntryPtr = S3BootScriptGetRuntimeEntryAddAddress (EntryLength);
- } else {
- NewEntryPtr = S3BootScriptGetBootTimeEntryAddAddress (EntryLength);
- }
- return NewEntryPtr;
-
-}
-
-/**
- Sync BootScript LockBox data.
-
- @param Script The address from where the boot script has been added or updated.
-
-**/
-VOID
-SyncBootScript (
- IN UINT8 *Script
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 ScriptOffset;
- UINT32 TotalScriptLength;
-
- if (!mS3BootScriptTablePtr->SmmLocked || !mS3BootScriptTablePtr->InSmm) {
- //
- // If it is not after SmmReadyToLock in SMM,
- // just return.
- //
- return ;
- }
-
- ScriptOffset = (UINT32) (Script - mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase);
-
- TotalScriptLength = (UINT32) (mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE));
-
- //
- // Update BootScriptData
- // So in S3 resume, the data can be restored correctly.
- //
- Status = UpdateLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataGuid,
- ScriptOffset,
- (VOID *)((UINTN)mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase + ScriptOffset),
- TotalScriptLength - ScriptOffset
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Now the length field is updated, need sync to lockbox.
- // So at S3 resume, the data can be restored correctly.
- //
- Status = UpdateLockBox (
- &mBootScriptDataGuid,
- OFFSET_OF (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER, TableLength),
- &TotalScriptLength,
- sizeof (TotalScriptLength)
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- This is an function to close the S3 boot script table. The function could only be called in
- BOOT time phase. To comply with the Framework spec definition on
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SAVE_PROTOCOL.CloseTable(), this function will fulfill following things:
- 1. Closes the specified boot script table
- 2. It allocates a new memory pool to duplicate all the boot scripts in the specified table.
- Once this function is called, the table maintained by the library will be destroyed
- after it is copied into the allocated pool.
- 3. Any attempts to add a script record after calling this function will cause a new table
- to be created by the library.
- 4. The base address of the allocated pool will be returned in Address. Note that after
- using the boot script table, the CALLER is responsible for freeing the pool that is allocated
- by this function.
-
- In Spec PI1.1, this EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SAVE_PROTOCOL.CloseTable() is retired. To provides this API for now is
- for Framework Spec compatibility.
-
- If anyone does call CloseTable() on a real platform, then the caller is responsible for figuring out
- how to get the script to run at S3 resume because the boot script maintained by the lib will be
- destroyed.
-
- @return the base address of the new copy of the boot script table.
- @note this function could only called in boot time phase
-
-**/
-UINT8*
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptCloseTable (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINT8 *S3TableBase;
- UINT32 TableLength;
- UINT8 *Buffer;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER *ScriptTableInfo;
-
- S3TableBase = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase;
- if (S3TableBase == 0) {
- return 0;
- }
- //
- // Append the termination record the S3 boot script table
- //
- S3BootScriptInternalCloseTable();
- TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE);
- //
- // Allocate the buffer and copy the boot script to the buffer.
- //
- Status = gBS->AllocatePool (
- EfiBootServicesData,
- (UINTN)TableLength,
- (VOID **) &Buffer
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return 0;
- }
- CopyMem (Buffer, S3TableBase, TableLength);
-
- //
- // Destroy the table maintained by the library so that the next write operation
- // will write the record to the first entry of the table.
- //
- // Fill the table header.
- ScriptTableInfo = (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER*)S3TableBase;
- ScriptTableInfo->OpCode = S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TABLE_OPCODE;
- ScriptTableInfo->Length = (UINT8) sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER);
- ScriptTableInfo->TableLength = 0; // will be calculate at close the table
-
- mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength = sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER);
- return Buffer;
-}
-/**
- Save I/O write to boot script
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Address The base address of the I/O operations.
- @param Count The number of I/O operations to perform.
- @param Buffer The source buffer from which to write data.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveIoWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE ScriptIoWrite;
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * Count));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // save script data
- //
- ScriptIoWrite.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptIoWrite.Length = Length;
- ScriptIoWrite.Width = Width;
- ScriptIoWrite.Address = Address;
- ScriptIoWrite.Count = (UINT32) Count;
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptIoWrite, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_WRITE)), Buffer, WidthInByte * Count);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record for an I/O modify operation into a S3 boot script table
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Address The base address of the I/O operations.
- @param Data A pointer to the data to be OR-ed.
- @param DataMask A pointer to the data mask to be AND-ed with the data read from the register
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveIoReadWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE ScriptIoReadWrite;
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptIoReadWrite.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptIoReadWrite.Length = Length;
- ScriptIoReadWrite.Width = Width;
- ScriptIoReadWrite.Address = Address;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptIoReadWrite, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_READ_WRITE) + WidthInByte), DataMask, WidthInByte);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for a memory write operation into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Address The base address of the memory operations
- @param Count The number of memory operations to perform.
- @param Buffer The source buffer from which to write the data.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveMemWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE ScriptMemWrite;
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * Count));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptMemWrite.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptMemWrite.Length = Length;
- ScriptMemWrite.Width = Width;
- ScriptMemWrite.Address = Address;
- ScriptMemWrite.Count = (UINT32) Count;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptMemWrite, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_WRITE)), Buffer, WidthInByte * Count);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for a memory modify operation into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Address The base address of the memory operations. Address needs alignment if required
- @param Data A pointer to the data to be OR-ed.
- @param DataMask A pointer to the data mask to be AND-ed with the data read from the register.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveMemReadWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE ScriptMemReadWrite;
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptMemReadWrite.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptMemReadWrite.Length = Length;
- ScriptMemReadWrite.Width = Width;
- ScriptMemReadWrite.Address = Address;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptMemReadWrite , sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_READ_WRITE) + WidthInByte), DataMask, WidthInByte);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for a PCI configuration space write operation into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Address The address within the PCI configuration space.
- @param Count The number of PCI operations to perform.
- @param Buffer The source buffer from which to write the data.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSavePciCfgWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE ScriptPciWrite;
-
- if (Width == S3BootScriptWidthUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * Count));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptPciWrite.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptPciWrite.Length = Length;
- ScriptPciWrite.Width = Width;
- ScriptPciWrite.Address = Address;
- ScriptPciWrite.Count = (UINT32) Count;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptPciWrite, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_WRITE)), Buffer, WidthInByte * Count);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for a PCI configuration space modify operation into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Address The address within the PCI configuration space.
- @param Data A pointer to the data to be OR-ed.The size depends on Width.
- @param DataMask A pointer to the data mask to be AND-ed.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN__SUCCESS Opcode is added.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSavePciCfgReadWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE ScriptPciReadWrite;
-
- if (Width == S3BootScriptWidthUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptPciReadWrite.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptPciReadWrite.Length = Length;
- ScriptPciReadWrite.Width = Width;
- ScriptPciReadWrite.Address = Address;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptPciReadWrite, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem (
- (VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_READ_WRITE) + WidthInByte),
- DataMask,
- WidthInByte
- );
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for a PCI configuration 2 space write operation into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Segment The PCI segment number for Address.
- @param Address The address within the PCI configuration space.
- @param Count The number of PCI operations to perform.
- @param Buffer The source buffer from which to write the data.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is non-zero Segment and 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSavePciCfg2Write (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT16 Segment,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN UINTN Count,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE ScriptPciWrite2;
-
- if (Segment != 0 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * Count));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptPciWrite2.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptPciWrite2.Length = Length;
- ScriptPciWrite2.Width = Width;
- ScriptPciWrite2.Address = Address;
- ScriptPciWrite2.Segment = Segment;
- ScriptPciWrite2.Count = (UINT32)Count;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptPciWrite2, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_WRITE)), Buffer, WidthInByte * Count);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for a PCI configuration 2 space modify operation into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.Enumerated in S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH.
- @param Segment The PCI segment number for Address.
- @param Address The address within the PCI configuration space.
- @param Data A pointer to the data to be OR-ed. The size depends on Width.
- @param DataMask A pointer to the data mask to be AND-ed.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is non-zero Segment and 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSavePciCfg2ReadWrite (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT16 Segment,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE ScriptPciReadWrite2;
-
- if (Segment != 0 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptPciReadWrite2.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE_OPCODE;
- ScriptPciReadWrite2.Length = Length;
- ScriptPciReadWrite2.Width = Width;
- ScriptPciReadWrite2.Segment = Segment;
- ScriptPciReadWrite2.Address = Address;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptPciReadWrite2, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem (
- (VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_READ_WRITE) + WidthInByte),
- DataMask,
- WidthInByte
- );
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Checks the parameter of S3BootScriptSaveSmbusExecute().
-
- This function checks the input parameters of SmbusExecute(). If the input parameters are valid
- for certain SMBus bus protocol, it will return EFI_SUCCESS; otherwise, it will return certain
- error code based on the input SMBus bus protocol.
-
- @param SmBusAddress Address that encodes the SMBUS Slave Address, SMBUS Command, SMBUS Data Length,
- and PEC.
- @param Operation Signifies which particular SMBus hardware protocol instance that
- it will use to execute the SMBus transactions. This SMBus
- hardware protocol is defined by the SMBus Specification and is
- not related to EFI.
- @param Length Signifies the number of bytes that this operation will do. The
- maximum number of bytes can be revision specific and operation
- specific. This field will contain the actual number of bytes that
- are executed for this operation. Not all operations require this
- argument.
- @param Buffer Contains the value of data to execute to the SMBus slave device.
- Not all operations require this argument. The length of this
- buffer is identified by Length.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS All the parameters are valid for the corresponding SMBus bus
- protocol.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Operation is not defined in EFI_SMBUS_OPERATION.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Length/Buffer is NULL for operations except for EfiSmbusQuickRead
- and EfiSmbusQuickWrite. Length is outside the range of valid
- values.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The SMBus operation or PEC is not supported.
- @retval EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL Buffer is not sufficient for this operation.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-CheckParameters (
- IN UINTN SmBusAddress,
- IN EFI_SMBUS_OPERATION Operation,
- IN OUT UINTN *Length,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN RequiredLen;
- EFI_SMBUS_DEVICE_COMMAND Command;
- BOOLEAN PecCheck;
-
- Command = SMBUS_LIB_COMMAND (SmBusAddress);
- PecCheck = SMBUS_LIB_PEC (SmBusAddress);
- //
- // Set default value to be 2:
- // for SmbusReadWord, SmbusWriteWord and SmbusProcessCall.
- //
- RequiredLen = 2;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- switch (Operation) {
- case EfiSmbusQuickRead:
- case EfiSmbusQuickWrite:
- if (PecCheck || Command != 0) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
- break;
- case EfiSmbusReceiveByte:
- case EfiSmbusSendByte:
- if (Command != 0) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
- //
- // Cascade to check length parameter.
- //
- case EfiSmbusReadByte:
- case EfiSmbusWriteByte:
- RequiredLen = 1;
- //
- // Cascade to check length parameter.
- //
- case EfiSmbusReadWord:
- case EfiSmbusWriteWord:
- case EfiSmbusProcessCall:
- if (Buffer == NULL || Length == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- } else if (*Length < RequiredLen) {
- Status = EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
- }
- *Length = RequiredLen;
- break;
- case EfiSmbusReadBlock:
- case EfiSmbusWriteBlock:
- case EfiSmbusBWBRProcessCall:
- if ((Buffer == NULL) ||
- (Length == NULL) ||
- (*Length < MIN_SMBUS_BLOCK_LEN) ||
- (*Length > MAX_SMBUS_BLOCK_LEN)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record for an SMBus command execution into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param SmBusAddress Address that encodes the SMBUS Slave Address, SMBUS Command, SMBUS Data Length, and PEC.
- @param Operation Indicates which particular SMBus protocol it will use to execute the SMBus
- transactions.
- @param Length A pointer to signify the number of bytes that this operation will do.
- @param Buffer Contains the value of data to execute to the SMBUS slave device.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveSmbusExecute (
- IN UINTN SmBusAddress,
- IN EFI_SMBUS_OPERATION Operation,
- IN UINTN *Length,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN BufferLength;
- UINT8 DataSize;
- UINT8 *Script;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE ScriptSmbusExecute;
-
- if (Length == NULL) {
- BufferLength = 0;
- } else {
- BufferLength = *Length;
- }
-
- Status = CheckParameters (SmBusAddress, Operation, &BufferLength, Buffer);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- DataSize = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE) + BufferLength);
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (DataSize);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptSmbusExecute.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE_OPCODE;
- ScriptSmbusExecute.Length = DataSize;
- ScriptSmbusExecute.SmBusAddress = (UINT64) SmBusAddress;
- ScriptSmbusExecute.Operation = Operation;
- ScriptSmbusExecute.DataSize = (UINT32) BufferLength;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptSmbusExecute, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE));
- CopyMem (
- (VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_SMBUS_EXECUTE)),
- Buffer,
- BufferLength
- );
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for an execution stall on the processor into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param Duration Duration in microseconds of the stall
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveStall (
- IN UINTN Duration
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL ScriptStall;
-
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptStall.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL_OPCODE;
- ScriptStall.Length = Length;
- ScriptStall.Duration = Duration;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptStall, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_STALL));
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for dispatching specified arbitrary code into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param EntryPoint Entry point of the code to be dispatched.
- @param Context Argument to be passed into the EntryPoint of the code to be dispatched.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveDispatch2 (
- IN VOID *EntryPoint,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2 ScriptDispatch2;
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptDispatch2.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2_OPCODE;
- ScriptDispatch2.Length = Length;
- ScriptDispatch2.EntryPoint = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)EntryPoint;
- ScriptDispatch2.Context = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)Context;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptDispatch2, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_2));
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for memory reads of the memory location and continues when the exit criteria is
- satisfied or after a defined duration.
-
- Please aware, below interface is different with PI specification, Vol 5:
- EFI_S3_SAVE_STATE_PROTOCOL.Write() for EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL_OPCODE.
- "Duration" below is microseconds, while "Delay" in PI specification means
- the number of 100ns units to poll.
-
- @param Width The width of the memory operations.
- @param Address The base address of the memory operations.
- @param BitMask A pointer to the bit mask to be AND-ed with the data read from the register.
- @param BitValue A pointer to the data value after to be Masked.
- @param Duration Duration in microseconds of the stall.
- @param LoopTimes The times of the register polling.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveMemPoll (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *BitMask,
- IN VOID *BitValue,
- IN UINTN Duration,
- IN UINTN LoopTimes
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL ScriptMemPoll;
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
-
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptMemPoll.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL_OPCODE;
- ScriptMemPoll.Length = Length;
- ScriptMemPoll.Width = Width;
- ScriptMemPoll.Address = Address;
- ScriptMemPoll.Duration = Duration;
- ScriptMemPoll.LoopTimes = LoopTimes;
-
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL)), BitValue, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL) + WidthInByte), BitMask, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptMemPoll, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_MEM_POLL));
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Store arbitrary information in the boot script table. This opcode is a no-op on dispatch and is only
- used for debugging script issues.
-
- @param InformationLength Length of the data in bytes
- @param Information Information to be logged in the boot scrpit
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveInformation (
- IN UINT32 InformationLength,
- IN VOID *Information
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION ScriptInformation;
-
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION) + InformationLength);
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptInformation.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION_OPCODE;
- ScriptInformation.Length = Length;
-
-
- ScriptInformation.InformationLength = InformationLength;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptInformation, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION)), (VOID *) Information, (UINTN) InformationLength);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-
-}
-/**
- Store a string in the boot script table. This opcode is a no-op on dispatch and is only
- used for debugging script issues.
-
- @param String The string to save to boot script table
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveInformationAsciiString (
- IN CONST CHAR8 *String
- )
-{
- return S3BootScriptSaveInformation (
- (UINT32) AsciiStrLen (String) + 1,
- (VOID*) String
- );
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for dispatching specified arbitrary code into a specified boot script table.
-
- @param EntryPoint Entry point of the code to be dispatched.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveDispatch (
- IN VOID *EntryPoint
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH ScriptDispatch;
-
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptDispatch.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH_OPCODE;
- ScriptDispatch.Length = Length;
- ScriptDispatch.EntryPoint = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)EntryPoint;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptDispatch, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_DISPATCH));
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for I/O reads the I/O location and continues when the exit criteria is satisfied or after a
- defined duration.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.
- @param Address The base address of the I/O operations.
- @param Data The comparison value used for the polling exit criteria.
- @param DataMask Mask used for the polling criteria. The bits in the bytes below Width which are zero
- in Data are ignored when polling the memory address.
- @param Delay The number of 100ns units to poll. Note that timer available may be of poorer
- granularity so the delay may be longer.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSaveIoPoll (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask,
- IN UINT64 Delay
- )
-{
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 Length;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL ScriptIoPoll;
-
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptIoPoll.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL_OPCODE;
- ScriptIoPoll.Length = (UINT8) (sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
- ScriptIoPoll.Width = Width;
- ScriptIoPoll.Address = Address;
- ScriptIoPoll.Delay = Delay;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptIoPoll, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL));
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_IO_POLL) + WidthInByte), DataMask, WidthInByte);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record for PCI configuration space reads and continues when the exit criteria is satisfied or
- after a defined duration.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.
- @param Address The address within the PCI configuration space.
- @param Data The comparison value used for the polling exit criteria.
- @param DataMask Mask used for the polling criteria. The bits in the bytes below Width which are zero
- in Data are ignored when polling the memory address
- @param Delay The number of 100ns units to poll. Note that timer available may be of poorer
- granularity so the delay may be longer.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSavePciPoll (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask,
- IN UINT64 Delay
-)
-{
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- UINT8 Length;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL ScriptPciPoll;
-
- if (Width == S3BootScriptWidthUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptPciPoll.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL_OPCODE;
- ScriptPciPoll.Length = (UINT8) (sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
- ScriptPciPoll.Width = Width;
- ScriptPciPoll.Address = Address;
- ScriptPciPoll.Delay = Delay;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptPciPoll, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL));
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG_POLL) + WidthInByte), DataMask, WidthInByte);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Adds a record for PCI configuration space reads and continues when the exit criteria is satisfied or
- after a defined duration.
-
- @param Width The width of the I/O operations.
- @param Segment The PCI segment number for Address.
- @param Address The address within the PCI configuration space.
- @param Data The comparison value used for the polling exit criteria.
- @param DataMask Mask used for the polling criteria. The bits in the bytes below Width which are zero
- in Data are ignored when polling the memory address
- @param Delay The number of 100ns units to poll. Note that timer available may be of poorer
- granularity so the delay may be longer.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
- @note A known Limitations in the implementation which is non-zero Segment and 64bits operations are not supported.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptSavePci2Poll (
- IN S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_WIDTH Width,
- IN UINT16 Segment,
- IN UINT64 Address,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VOID *DataMask,
- IN UINT64 Delay
-)
-{
- UINT8 WidthInByte;
- UINT8 *Script;
- UINT8 Length;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL ScriptPci2Poll;
-
- if (Segment != 0 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFifoUint64 ||
- Width == S3BootScriptWidthFillUint64) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- WidthInByte = (UINT8) (0x01 << (Width & 0x03));
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptPci2Poll.OpCode = EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL_OPCODE;
- ScriptPci2Poll.Length = (UINT8) (sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL) + (WidthInByte * 2));
- ScriptPci2Poll.Width = Width;
- ScriptPci2Poll.Segment = Segment;
- ScriptPci2Poll.Address = Address;
- ScriptPci2Poll.Delay = Delay;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptPci2Poll, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL));
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL)), Data, WidthInByte);
- CopyMem ((UINT8 *) (Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_PCI_CONFIG2_POLL) + WidthInByte), DataMask, WidthInByte);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Do the calculation of start address from which a new s3 boot script entry will write into.
-
- @param EntryLength The new entry length.
- @param Position specifies the position in the boot script table where the opcode will be
- inserted, either before or after, depending on BeforeOrAfter.
- @param BeforeOrAfter The flag to indicate to insert the nod before or after the position.
- This parameter is effective when InsertFlag is TRUE
- @param Script return out the position from which the a new s3 boot script entry will write into
-**/
-VOID
-S3BootScriptCalculateInsertAddress (
- IN UINT8 EntryLength,
- IN VOID *Position OPTIONAL,
- IN BOOLEAN BeforeOrAfter OPTIONAL,
- OUT UINT8 **Script
- )
-{
- UINTN TableLength;
- UINT8 *S3TableBase;
- UINTN PositionOffset;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER ScriptHeader;
- //
- // The entry inserting to table is already added to the end of the table
- //
- TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength - EntryLength;
- S3TableBase = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase ;
- //
- // calculate the Position offset
- //
- if (Position != NULL) {
- PositionOffset = (UINTN) ((UINT8 *)Position - S3TableBase);
-
- //
- // If the BeforeOrAfter is FALSE, that means to insert the node right after the node.
- //
- if (!BeforeOrAfter) {
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptHeader, Position, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER));
- PositionOffset += (ScriptHeader.Length);
- }
- //
- // Insert the node before the adjusted Position
- //
- CopyMem (S3TableBase+PositionOffset+EntryLength, S3TableBase+PositionOffset, TableLength - PositionOffset);
- //
- // calculate the the start address for the new entry.
- //
- *Script = S3TableBase + PositionOffset;
-
- } else {
- if (!BeforeOrAfter) {
- //
- // Insert the node to the end of the table
- //
- *Script = S3TableBase + TableLength;
- } else {
- //
- // Insert the node to the beginning of the table
- //
- PositionOffset = (UINTN) sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER);
- CopyMem (S3TableBase+PositionOffset+EntryLength, S3TableBase+PositionOffset, TableLength - PositionOffset);
- *Script = S3TableBase + PositionOffset;
- }
- }
-}
-/**
- Move the last boot script entry to the position
-
- @param BeforeOrAfter Specifies whether the opcode is stored before (TRUE) or after (FALSE) the position
- in the boot script table specified by Position. If Position is NULL or points to
- NULL then the new opcode is inserted at the beginning of the table (if TRUE) or end
- of the table (if FALSE).
- @param Position On entry, specifies the position in the boot script table where the opcode will be
- inserted, either before or after, depending on BeforeOrAfter. On exit, specifies
- the position of the inserted opcode in the boot script table.
-
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The table is not available.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER The Position is not a valid position in the boot script table.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is inserted.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptMoveLastOpcode (
- IN BOOLEAN BeforeOrAfter,
- IN OUT VOID **Position OPTIONAL
-)
-{
- UINT8* Script;
- VOID *TempPosition;
- UINTN StartAddress;
- UINT32 TableLength;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER ScriptHeader;
- BOOLEAN ValidatePosition;
- UINT8* LastOpcode;
- UINT8 TempBootScriptEntry[BOOT_SCRIPT_NODE_MAX_LENGTH];
-
- ValidatePosition = FALSE;
- TempPosition = (Position == NULL) ? NULL:(*Position);
-
- //
- // Check that the script is initialized and synced without adding an entry to the script.
- //
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (0);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- Script = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase;
-
- StartAddress = (UINTN) Script;
- TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength;
- Script = Script + sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER);
- LastOpcode = Script;
- //
- // Find the last boot Script Entry which is not the terminate node
- //
- while ((UINTN) Script < (UINTN) (StartAddress + TableLength)) {
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptHeader, Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER));
- if (TempPosition != NULL && TempPosition == Script) {
- //
- // If the position is specified, the position must be pointed to a boot script entry start address.
- //
- ValidatePosition = TRUE;
- }
- if (ScriptHeader.OpCode != S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TERMINATE_OPCODE) {
- LastOpcode = Script;
- }
- Script = Script + ScriptHeader.Length;
- }
- //
- // If the position is specified, but not the start of a boot script entry, it is a invalid input
- //
- if (TempPosition != NULL && !ValidatePosition) {
- return RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptHeader, LastOpcode, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER));
-
- CopyMem((VOID*)TempBootScriptEntry, LastOpcode, ScriptHeader.Length);
- //
- // Find the right position to write the node in
- //
- S3BootScriptCalculateInsertAddress (
- ScriptHeader.Length,
- TempPosition,
- BeforeOrAfter,
- &Script
- );
- //
- // Copy the node to Boot script table
- //
- CopyMem((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)TempBootScriptEntry, ScriptHeader.Length);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- //
- // return out the Position
- //
- if (Position != NULL) {
- *Position = Script;
- }
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
-/**
- Create a Label node in the boot script table.
-
- @param BeforeOrAfter Specifies whether the opcode is stored before (TRUE) or after (FALSE) the position
- in the boot script table specified by Position. If Position is NULL or points to
- NULL then the new opcode is inserted at the beginning of the table (if TRUE) or end
- of the table (if FALSE).
- @param Position On entry, specifies the position in the boot script table where the opcode will be
- inserted, either before or after, depending on BeforeOrAfter. On exit, specifies
- the position of the inserted opcode in the boot script table.
- @param InformationLength Length of the label in bytes
- @param Information Label to be logged in the boot scrpit
-
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER The Position is not a valid position in the boot script table.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory for the table do operation.
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS Opcode is added.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptLabelInternal (
- IN BOOLEAN BeforeOrAfter,
- IN OUT VOID **Position OPTIONAL,
- IN UINT32 InformationLength,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Information
- )
-{
- UINT8 Length;
- UINT8 *Script;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION ScriptInformation;
-
- Length = (UINT8)(sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION) + InformationLength);
-
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (Length);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Build script data
- //
- ScriptInformation.OpCode = S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_LABEL_OPCODE;
- ScriptInformation.Length = Length;
-
-
- ScriptInformation.InformationLength = InformationLength;
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)Script, (VOID*)&ScriptInformation, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION));
- CopyMem ((VOID*)(Script + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION)), (VOID *) Information, (UINTN) InformationLength);
-
- SyncBootScript (Script);
-
- return S3BootScriptMoveLastOpcode (BeforeOrAfter, Position);
-
-}
-/**
- Find a label within the boot script table and, if not present, optionally create it.
-
- @param BeforeOrAfter Specifies whether the opcode is stored before (TRUE)
- or after (FALSE) the position in the boot script table
- specified by Position.
- @param CreateIfNotFound Specifies whether the label will be created if the label
- does not exists (TRUE) or not (FALSE).
- @param Position On entry, specifies the position in the boot script table
- where the opcode will be inserted, either before or after,
- depending on BeforeOrAfter. On exit, specifies the position
- of the inserted opcode in the boot script table.
- @param Label Points to the label which will be inserted in the boot script table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation succeeded. A record was added into the
- specified script table.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The parameter is illegal or the given boot script is not supported.
- If the opcode is unknow or not supported because of the PCD
- Feature Flags.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is insufficient memory to store the boot script.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptLabel (
- IN BOOLEAN BeforeOrAfter,
- IN BOOLEAN CreateIfNotFound,
- IN OUT VOID **Position OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Label
- )
-{
- UINT8* Script;
- UINTN StartAddress;
- UINT32 TableLength;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER ScriptHeader;
- EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER TableHeader;
- UINT32 LabelLength;
- //
- // Check NULL Label
- //
- if (Label == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Check empty Label
- //
- if (Label[0] == '\0') {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check that the script is initialized and synced without adding an entry to the script.
- // The code must search for the label first before it knows if a new entry needs
- // to be added.
- //
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (0);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Check the header and search for existing label.
- //
- Script = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase;
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&TableHeader, Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TABLE_HEADER));
- if (TableHeader.OpCode != S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TABLE_OPCODE) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- StartAddress = (UINTN) Script;
- TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength;
- Script = Script + TableHeader.Length;
- while ((UINTN) Script < (UINTN) (StartAddress + TableLength)) {
-
- CopyMem ((VOID*)&ScriptHeader, Script, sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_COMMON_HEADER));
- if (ScriptHeader.OpCode == S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_LABEL_OPCODE) {
- if (AsciiStrCmp ((CHAR8 *)(UINTN)(Script+sizeof(EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_INFORMATION)), Label) == 0) {
- (*Position) = Script;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- }
- Script = Script + ScriptHeader.Length;
- }
- if (CreateIfNotFound) {
- LabelLength = (UINT32)AsciiStrSize(Label);
- return S3BootScriptLabelInternal (BeforeOrAfter,Position, LabelLength, Label);
- } else {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Compare two positions in the boot script table and return their relative position.
- @param Position1 The positions in the boot script table to compare
- @param Position2 The positions in the boot script table to compare
- @param RelativePosition On return, points to the result of the comparison
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The operation succeeded. A record was added into the
- specified script table.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The parameter is illegal or the given boot script is not supported.
- If the opcode is unknow or not supported because of the PCD
- Feature Flags.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is insufficient memory to store the boot script.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-S3BootScriptCompare (
- IN UINT8 *Position1,
- IN UINT8 *Position2,
- OUT UINTN *RelativePosition
- )
-{
- UINT8* Script;
- UINT32 TableLength;
-
- if (RelativePosition == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check that the script is initialized and synced without adding an entry to the script.
- //
- Script = S3BootScriptGetEntryAddAddress (0);
- if (Script == NULL) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- Script = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableBase;
-
- //
- // mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength does not include the termination node, so add it up
- //
- TableLength = mS3BootScriptTablePtr->TableLength + sizeof (EFI_BOOT_SCRIPT_TERMINATE);
- if (Position1 < Script || Position1 > Script+TableLength) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (Position2 < Script || Position2 > Script+TableLength) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- *RelativePosition = (Position1 < Position2)?-1:((Position1 == Position2)?0:1);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/DxeS3BootScriptLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/DxeS3BootScriptLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index de314db479..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/DxeS3BootScriptLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,74 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# DXE S3 boot script Library.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials are
-# licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = DxeS3BootScriptLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = DxeS3BootScriptLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 57F9967B-26CD-4262-837A-55B8AA158254
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = S3BootScriptLib|DXE_CORE DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER UEFI_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION
-
-
- CONSTRUCTOR = S3BootScriptLibInitialize
- DESTRUCTOR = S3BootScriptLibDeinitialize
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- BootScriptSave.c
- BootScriptExecute.c
- InternalBootScriptLib.h
- BootScriptInternalFormat.h
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- TimerLib
- DebugLib
- PcdLib
- UefiLib
- SmbusLib
- PciLib
- IoLib
- LockBoxLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSmmBase2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiDxeSmmReadyToLockProtocolGuid ## NOTIFY
- gEfiSmmReadyToLockProtocolGuid ## NOTIFY
- gEdkiiSmmExitBootServicesProtocolGuid ## NOTIFY
- gEdkiiSmmLegacyBootProtocolGuid ## NOTIFY
-
-[Pcd]
- ## CONSUMES
- ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateDataPtr
- ## CONSUMES
- ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdS3BootScriptTablePrivateSmmDataPtr
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdS3BootScriptRuntimeTableReservePageNumber ## CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/DxeS3BootScriptLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/DxeS3BootScriptLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 775b2f8715..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/DxeS3BootScriptLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/InternalBootScriptLib.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/InternalBootScriptLib.h deleted file mode 100644 index e540278483..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiDxeS3BootScriptLib/InternalBootScriptLib.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,110 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Support for S3 boot script lib. This file defined some internal macro and internal
- data structure
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
- of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
- full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-#ifndef __INTERNAL_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB__
-#define __INTERNAL_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB__
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <Guid/EventGroup.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmBase2.h>
-#include <Protocol/DxeSmmReadyToLock.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmReadyToLock.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmExitBootServices.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmLegacyBoot.h>
-
-#include <Library/S3BootScriptLib.h>
-
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/SmbusLib.h>
-#include <Library/IoLib.h>
-#include <Library/PciLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/TimerLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiLib.h>
-#include <Library/LockBoxLib.h>
-
-#include "BootScriptInternalFormat.h"
-
-#define MAX_IO_ADDRESS 0xFFFF
-
-//
-// Macro to convert a UEFI PCI address to a PCI Library PCI address
-//
-#define PCI_ADDRESS_ENCODE(A) (UINTN)PCI_LIB_ADDRESS( \
- ((((UINTN)(A))& 0xff000000) >> 24), ((((UINTN)(A)) &0x00ff0000) >> 16), ((((UINTN)(A)) & 0xff00) >> 8), ((RShiftU64 ((A), 32) & 0xfff) | ((A)& 0xff)) \
- )
-
-
-
-typedef union {
- UINT8 volatile *Buf;
- UINT8 volatile *Uint8;
- UINT16 volatile *Uint16;
- UINT32 volatile *Uint32;
- UINT64 volatile *Uint64;
- UINTN volatile Uint;
-} PTR;
-
-
-// Minimum and maximum length for SMBus bus block protocols defined in SMBus spec 2.0.
-//
-#define MIN_SMBUS_BLOCK_LEN 1
-#define MAX_SMBUS_BLOCK_LEN 32
-
-//
-// The boot script private data.
-//
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 *TableBase;
- UINT32 TableLength; // Record the actual memory length
- UINT16 TableMemoryPageNumber; // Record the page number Allocated for the table
- BOOLEAN InSmm; // Record if this library is in SMM.
- BOOLEAN AtRuntime; // Record if current state is after SmmExitBootServices or SmmLegacyBoot.
- UINT32 BootTimeScriptLength; // Maintain boot time script length in LockBox after SmmReadyToLock in SMM.
- BOOLEAN SmmLocked; // Record if current state is after SmmReadyToLock
- BOOLEAN BackFromS3; // Indicate that the system is back from S3.
-} SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA;
-
-typedef
-EFI_STATUS
-(EFIAPI *DISPATCH_ENTRYPOINT_FUNC) (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN VOID *Context
- );
-
-extern SCRIPT_TABLE_PRIVATE_DATA *mS3BootScriptTablePtr;
-
-//
-// Define Opcode for Label which is implementation specific and no standard spec define.
-//
-#define S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_LABEL_OPCODE 0xFE
-
-///
-/// The opcode indicate the start of the boot script table.
-///
-#define S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TABLE_OPCODE 0xAA
-///
-/// The opcode indicate the end of the boot script table.
-///
-#define S3_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB_TERMINATE_OPCODE 0xFF
-
-
-#endif //__INTERNAL_BOOT_SCRIPT_LIB__
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/MemoryAllocationLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/MemoryAllocationLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 5e13a3eda2..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/MemoryAllocationLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,929 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Support routines for memory allocation routines based on SMM Core internal functions.
-
- The PI System Management Mode Core Interface Specification only allows the use
- of EfiRuntimeServicesCode and EfiRuntimeServicesData memory types for memory
- allocations as the SMRAM space should be reserved after BDS phase. The functions
- in the Memory Allocation Library use EfiBootServicesData as the default memory
- allocation type. For this SMM specific instance of the Memory Allocation Library,
- EfiRuntimeServicesData is used as the default memory type for all allocations.
- In addition, allocation for the Reserved memory types are not supported and will
- always return NULL.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiSmm.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/SmmAccess2.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include "PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h"
-
-EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR *mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges = NULL;
-UINTN mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRangeCount = 0;
-
-/**
- Check whether the start address of buffer is within any of the SMRAM ranges.
-
- @param[in] Buffer The pointer to the buffer to be checked.
-
- @retval TURE The buffer is in SMRAM ranges.
- @retval FALSE The buffer is out of SMRAM ranges.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-BufferInSmram (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRangeCount; Index ++) {
- if (((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer >= mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges[Index].CpuStart) &&
- ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer < (mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges[Index].CpuStart + mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges[Index].PhysicalSize))) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of a certain memory type.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of a certain memory type and returns a pointer to the allocated
- buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL is returned.
- If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocatePages (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Memory;
-
- if (Pages == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = SmmAllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, MemoryType, Pages, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- return (VOID *) (UINTN) Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL
- is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is
- returned.
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocatePages (
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePages (EfiRuntimeServicesData, Pages);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL
- is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is
- returned.
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimePages (
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePages (EfiRuntimeServicesData, Pages);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. The buffer returned is aligned on a 4KB boundary. If Pages is 0, then NULL
- is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is
- returned.
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedPages (
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Frees one or more 4KB pages that were previously allocated with one of the page allocation
- functions in the Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages from the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer
- must have been allocated on a previous call to the page allocation services of the Memory
- Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free allocated pages, then this function will
- perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with a page allocation function in the Memory Allocation Library,
- then ASSERT().
- If Pages is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer of pages to free.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-FreePages (
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (Pages != 0);
- if (BufferInSmram (Buffer)) {
- //
- // When Buffer is in SMRAM range, it should be allocated by SmmAllocatePages() service.
- // So, SmmFreePages() service is used to free it.
- //
- Status = SmmFreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer, Pages);
- } else {
- //
- // When Buffer is out of SMRAM range, it should be allocated by gBS->AllocatePages() service.
- // So, gBS->FreePages() service is used to free it.
- //
- Status = gBS->FreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer, Pages);
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of a certain memory type at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of a certain memory type with an alignment
- specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is returned.
- If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the request, then
- NULL is returned.
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocateAlignedPages (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Memory;
- UINTN AlignedMemory;
- UINTN AlignmentMask;
- UINTN UnalignedPages;
- UINTN RealPages;
-
- //
- // Alignment must be a power of two or zero.
- //
- ASSERT ((Alignment & (Alignment - 1)) == 0);
-
- if (Pages == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
- if (Alignment > EFI_PAGE_SIZE) {
- //
- // Calculate the total number of pages since alignment is larger than page size.
- //
- AlignmentMask = Alignment - 1;
- RealPages = Pages + EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment);
- //
- // Make sure that Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) does not overflow.
- //
- ASSERT (RealPages > Pages);
-
- Status = SmmAllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, MemoryType, RealPages, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- AlignedMemory = ((UINTN) Memory + AlignmentMask) & ~AlignmentMask;
- UnalignedPages = EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (AlignedMemory - (UINTN) Memory);
- if (UnalignedPages > 0) {
- //
- // Free first unaligned page(s).
- //
- Status = SmmFreePages (Memory, UnalignedPages);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- Memory = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (AlignedMemory + EFI_PAGES_TO_SIZE (Pages));
- UnalignedPages = RealPages - Pages - UnalignedPages;
- if (UnalignedPages > 0) {
- //
- // Free last unaligned page(s).
- //
- Status = SmmFreePages (Memory, UnalignedPages);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Do not over-allocate pages in this case.
- //
- Status = SmmAllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, MemoryType, Pages, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- AlignedMemory = (UINTN) Memory;
- }
- return (VOID *) AlignedMemory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData with an
- alignment specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is
- returned. If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateAlignedPages (
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateAlignedPages (EfiRuntimeServicesData, Pages, Alignment);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of type EfiRuntimeServicesData with an
- alignment specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is
- returned. If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateAlignedRuntimePages (
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateAlignedPages (EfiRuntimeServicesData, Pages, Alignment);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates one or more 4KB pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType at a specified alignment.
-
- Allocates the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages of type EfiReservedMemoryType with an
- alignment specified by Alignment. The allocated buffer is returned. If Pages is 0, then NULL is
- returned. If there is not enough memory at the specified alignment remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Alignment is not a power of two and Alignment is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If Pages plus EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Alignment) overflows, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to allocate.
- @param Alignment The requested alignment of the allocation. Must be a power of two.
- If Alignment is zero, then byte alignment is used.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateAlignedReservedPages (
- IN UINTN Pages,
- IN UINTN Alignment
- )
-{
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Frees one or more 4KB pages that were previously allocated with one of the aligned page
- allocation functions in the Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the number of 4KB pages specified by Pages from the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer
- must have been allocated on a previous call to the aligned page allocation services of the Memory
- Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free allocated pages, then this function will
- perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with an aligned page allocation function in the Memory Allocation
- Library, then ASSERT().
- If Pages is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer of pages to free.
- @param Pages The number of 4 KB pages to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-FreeAlignedPages (
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Pages
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (Pages != 0);
- if (BufferInSmram (Buffer)) {
- //
- // When Buffer is in SMRAM range, it should be allocated by SmmAllocatePages() service.
- // So, SmmFreePages() service is used to free it.
- //
- Status = SmmFreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer, Pages);
- } else {
- //
- // When Buffer is out of SMRAM range, it should be allocated by gBS->AllocatePages() service.
- // So, gBS->FreePages() service is used to free it.
- //
- Status = gBS->FreePages ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Buffer, Pages);
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type and returns a
- pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VOID *Memory;
-
- Memory = NULL;
-
- Status = SmmAllocatePool (MemoryType, AllocationSize, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Memory = NULL;
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData and returns a
- pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocatePool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData and returns
- a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimePool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocatePool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiReservedMemoryType and returns
- a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type, clears the buffer
- with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid
- buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request,
- then NULL is returned.
-
- @param PoolType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocateZeroPool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- VOID *Memory;
-
- Memory = InternalAllocatePool (PoolType, AllocationSize);
- if (Memory != NULL) {
- Memory = ZeroMem (Memory, AllocationSize);
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateZeroPool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimeZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateZeroPool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiReservedMemoryType, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param PoolType The type of pool to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalAllocateCopyPool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- VOID *Memory;
-
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
- ASSERT (AllocationSize <= (MAX_ADDRESS - (UINTN) Buffer + 1));
-
- Memory = InternalAllocatePool (PoolType, AllocationSize);
- if (Memory != NULL) {
- Memory = CopyMem (Memory, Buffer, AllocationSize);
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateCopyPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateCopyPool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize, Buffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiRuntimeServicesData, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateRuntimeCopyPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- return InternalAllocateCopyPool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, AllocationSize, Buffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Copies a buffer to an allocated buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiReservedMemoryType, copies
- AllocationSize bytes from Buffer to the newly allocated buffer, and returns a pointer to the
- allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there
- is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If AllocationSize is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - Buffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
- @param Buffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-AllocateReservedCopyPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of a specified memory type.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of the type
- specified by PoolType. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param PoolType The type of pool to allocate.
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalReallocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- VOID *NewBuffer;
-
- NewBuffer = InternalAllocateZeroPool (PoolType, NewSize);
- if (NewBuffer != NULL && OldBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (NewBuffer, OldBuffer, MIN (OldSize, NewSize));
- FreePool (OldBuffer);
- }
- return NewBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiRuntimeServicesData. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-ReallocatePool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return InternalReallocatePool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, OldSize, NewSize, OldBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiRuntimeServicesData.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiRuntimeServicesData. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-ReallocateRuntimePool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return InternalReallocatePool (EfiRuntimeServicesData, OldSize, NewSize, OldBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiReservedMemoryType.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiReservedMemoryType. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-ReallocateReservedPool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Frees a buffer that was previously allocated with one of the pool allocation functions in the
- Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer must have been allocated on a previous call to the
- pool allocation services of the Memory Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free pool
- resources, then this function will perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with a pool allocation function in the Memory Allocation Library,
- then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer Pointer to the buffer to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-FreePool (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (BufferInSmram (Buffer)) {
- //
- // When Buffer is in SMRAM range, it should be allocated by SmmAllocatePool() service.
- // So, SmmFreePool() service is used to free it.
- //
- Status = SmmFreePool (Buffer);
- } else {
- //
- // When Buffer is out of SMRAM range, it should be allocated by gBS->AllocatePool() service.
- // So, gBS->FreePool() service is used to free it.
- //
- Status = gBS->FreePool (Buffer);
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- The constructor function calls SmmInitializeMemoryServices to initialize memory in SMRAM.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- SMM_CORE_PRIVATE_DATA *SmmCorePrivate;
- UINTN Size;
-
- SmmCorePrivate = (SMM_CORE_PRIVATE_DATA *)ImageHandle;
- //
- // Initialize memory service using free SMRAM
- //
- SmmInitializeMemoryServices (SmmCorePrivate->SmramRangeCount, SmmCorePrivate->SmramRanges);
-
- mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRangeCount = SmmCorePrivate->SmramRangeCount;
- Size = mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRangeCount * sizeof (EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR);
- mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges = (EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR *) AllocatePool (Size);
- ASSERT (mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges != NULL);
- CopyMem (mSmmCoreMemoryAllocLibSmramRanges, SmmCorePrivate->SmramRanges, Size);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index e8f7081149..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,48 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Memory Allocation Library instance dedicated to SMM Core.
-# The implementation borrows the SMM Core Memory Allocation services as the primitive
-# for memory allocation instead of using SMM System Table servces in an indirect way.
-# It is assumed that this library instance must be linked with SMM Cre in this package.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = B618E089-9ABA-4d97-AE80-57B5BCCDA51D
- MODULE_TYPE = SMM_CORE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- PI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x0001000A
- LIBRARY_CLASS = MemoryAllocationLib|SMM_CORE
- CONSTRUCTOR = PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- MemoryAllocationLib.c
- PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSmmAccess2ProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index adfc0381c1..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h deleted file mode 100644 index a2b89acf5d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationLib/PiSmmCoreMemoryAllocationServices.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,191 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Contains function prototypes for Memory Services in the SMM Core.
-
- This header file borrows the PiSmmCore Memory Allocation services as the primitive
- for memory allocation.
-
- Copyright (c) 2008 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _PI_SMM_CORE_MEMORY_ALLOCATION_SERVICES_H_
-#define _PI_SMM_CORE_MEMORY_ALLOCATION_SERVICES_H_
-
-//
-// It should be aligned with the definition in PiSmmCore.
-//
-typedef struct {
- UINTN Signature;
-
- ///
- /// The ImageHandle passed into the entry point of the SMM IPL. This ImageHandle
- /// is used by the SMM Core to fill in the ParentImageHandle field of the Loaded
- /// Image Protocol for each SMM Driver that is dispatched by the SMM Core.
- ///
- EFI_HANDLE SmmIplImageHandle;
-
- ///
- /// The number of SMRAM ranges passed from the SMM IPL to the SMM Core. The SMM
- /// Core uses these ranges of SMRAM to initialize the SMM Core memory manager.
- ///
- UINTN SmramRangeCount;
-
- ///
- /// A table of SMRAM ranges passed from the SMM IPL to the SMM Core. The SMM
- /// Core uses these ranges of SMRAM to initialize the SMM Core memory manager.
- ///
- EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR *SmramRanges;
-
- ///
- /// The SMM Foundation Entry Point. The SMM Core fills in this field when the
- /// SMM Core is initialized. The SMM IPL is responsbile for registering this entry
- /// point with the SMM Configuration Protocol. The SMM Configuration Protocol may
- /// not be available at the time the SMM IPL and SMM Core are started, so the SMM IPL
- /// sets up a protocol notification on the SMM Configuration Protocol and registers
- /// the SMM Foundation Entry Point as soon as the SMM Configuration Protocol is
- /// available.
- ///
- EFI_SMM_ENTRY_POINT SmmEntryPoint;
-
- ///
- /// Boolean flag set to TRUE while an SMI is being processed by the SMM Core.
- ///
- BOOLEAN SmmEntryPointRegistered;
-
- ///
- /// Boolean flag set to TRUE while an SMI is being processed by the SMM Core.
- ///
- BOOLEAN InSmm;
-
- ///
- /// This field is set by the SMM Core then the SMM Core is initialized. This field is
- /// used by the SMM Base 2 Protocol and SMM Communication Protocol implementations in
- /// the SMM IPL.
- ///
- EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 *Smst;
-
- ///
- /// This field is used by the SMM Communicatioon Protocol to pass a buffer into
- /// a software SMI handler and for the software SMI handler to pass a buffer back to
- /// the caller of the SMM Communication Protocol.
- ///
- VOID *CommunicationBuffer;
-
- ///
- /// This field is used by the SMM Communicatioon Protocol to pass the size of a buffer,
- /// in bytes, into a software SMI handler and for the software SMI handler to pass the
- /// size, in bytes, of a buffer back to the caller of the SMM Communication Protocol.
- ///
- UINTN BufferSize;
-
- ///
- /// This field is used by the SMM Communication Protocol to pass the return status from
- /// a software SMI handler back to the caller of the SMM Communication Protocol.
- ///
- EFI_STATUS ReturnStatus;
-
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS PiSmmCoreImageBase;
- UINT64 PiSmmCoreImageSize;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS PiSmmCoreEntryPoint;
-} SMM_CORE_PRIVATE_DATA;
-
-/**
- Called to initialize the memory service.
-
- @param SmramRangeCount Number of SMRAM Regions
- @param SmramRanges Pointer to SMRAM Descriptors
-
-**/
-VOID
-SmmInitializeMemoryServices (
- IN UINTN SmramRangeCount,
- IN EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR *SmramRanges
- );
-
-/**
- Allocates pages from the memory map.
-
- @param Type The type of allocation to perform
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to turn the allocated pages
- into
- @param NumberOfPages The number of pages to allocate
- @param Memory A pointer to receive the base allocated memory
- address
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Parameters violate checking rules defined in spec.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Could not allocate pages match the requirement.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough pages to allocate.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Pages successfully allocated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmAllocatePages (
- IN EFI_ALLOCATE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN NumberOfPages,
- OUT EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS *Memory
- );
-
-/**
- Frees previous allocated pages.
-
- @param Memory Base address of memory being freed
- @param NumberOfPages The number of pages to free
-
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Could not find the entry that covers the range
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Address not aligned
- @return EFI_SUCCESS Pages successfully freed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmFreePages (
- IN EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Memory,
- IN UINTN NumberOfPages
- );
-
-/**
- Allocate pool of a particular type.
-
- @param PoolType Type of pool to allocate
- @param Size The amount of pool to allocate
- @param Buffer The address to return a pointer to the allocated
- pool
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER PoolType not valid
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Size exceeds max pool size or allocation failed.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Pool successfully allocated.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmAllocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE PoolType,
- IN UINTN Size,
- OUT VOID **Buffer
- );
-
-/**
- Frees pool.
-
- @param Buffer The allocated pool entry to free
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Buffer is not a valid value.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Pool successfully freed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmFreePool (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- );
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 788fafae35..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,60 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- SMM Core SMM Services Table Library.
-
- Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiSmm.h>
-#include <Library/SmmServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 *gSmst = NULL;
-extern EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 gSmmCoreSmst;
-
-/**
- The constructor function caches the pointer of SMM Services Table.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmCoreSmmServicesTableLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- gSmst = &gSmmCoreSmst;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function allows the caller to determine if the driver is executing in
- System Management Mode(SMM).
-
- This function returns TRUE if the driver is executing in SMM and FALSE if the
- driver is not executing in SMM.
-
- @retval TRUE The driver is executing in System Management Mode (SMM).
- @retval FALSE The driver is not executing in System Management Mode (SMM).
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-InSmm (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return TRUE;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 80d523c71b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,36 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# SMM Core SMM Services Table Library.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = C427146A-2EF2-4af9-A85A-E09EA65EE47D
- MODULE_TYPE = SMM_CORE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = SmmServicesTableLib|SMM_CORE
- PI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x0001000A
- CONSTRUCTOR = SmmCoreSmmServicesTableLibConstructor
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 3e0854c169..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib/PiSmmCoreSmmServicesTableLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManager.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManager.c deleted file mode 100644 index 1390e19097..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManager.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,67 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This file include all platform action which can be customized
- by IBV/OEM.
-
-Copyright (c) 2012 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/PlatformBootManagerLib.h>
-
-
-/**
- Do the platform specific action before the console is connected.
-
- Such as:
- Update console variable;
- Register new Driver#### or Boot####;
- Signal ReadyToLock event.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PlatformBootManagerBeforeConsole (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return;
-}
-
-/**
- Do the platform specific action after the console is connected.
-
- Such as:
- Dynamically switch output mode;
- Signal console ready platform customized event;
- Run diagnostics like memory testing;
- Connect certain devices;
- Dispatch aditional option roms.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PlatformBootManagerAfterConsole (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return;
-}
-
-/**
- This function is called each second during the boot manager waits the timeout.
-
- @param TimeoutRemain The remaining timeout.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PlatformBootManagerWaitCallback (
- UINT16 TimeoutRemain
- )
-{
- return;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManagerLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManagerLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index fb756ca2ff..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManagerLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,37 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Include all platform action which can be customized by IBV/OEM.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2012 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PlatformBootManagerLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PlatformBootManagerLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = 95C097CC-8943-4038-BB8A-1C70CF2E9F3C
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PlatformBootManagerLib|DXE_DRIVER
-
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PlatformBootManager.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManagerLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManagerLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 329790afb0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformBootManagerLibNull/PlatformBootManagerLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.c deleted file mode 100644 index 00b70c79e6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,36 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null Platform Hook Library instance with dependency on gPeiSerialPortPpiGuid
-
- Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Base.h>
-#include <Library/PlatformHookLib.h>
-
-/**
- Performs platform specific initialization required for the CPU to access
- the hardware associated with a SerialPortLib instance. This function does
- not initialize the serial port hardware itself. Instead, it initializes
- hardware devices that are required for the CPU to access the serial port
- hardware. This function may be called more than once.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The platform specific initialization succeeded.
- @retval RETURN_DEVICE_ERROR The platform specific initialization could not be completed.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PlatformHookSerialPortInitialize (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return RETURN_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 09074a8a4e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,38 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Null Platform Hook Library instance with dependency on gPeiSerialPortPpiGuid
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi
- FILE_GUID = 621734D8-8B5E-4c01-B330-9F89A1081710
- MODULE_TYPE = BASE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PlatformHookLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.uni
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[Depex.common.PEIM]
- gPeiSerialPortPpiGuid
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index d88a279f8e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi/PlatformHookLibSerialPortPpi.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanup.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanup.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5290aae158..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanup.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,108 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Include file for platform variable cleanup.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _PLAT_VAR_CLEANUP_
-#define _PLAT_VAR_CLEANUP_
-
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/PrintLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/HiiLib.h>
-#include <Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/Variable.h>
-#include <Protocol/VarCheck.h>
-#include <Protocol/FormBrowser2.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiConfigAccess.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiConfigRouting.h>
-#include <Protocol/DevicePath.h>
-
-#include <Guid/EventGroup.h>
-#include <Guid/MdeModuleHii.h>
-#include <Guid/ImageAuthentication.h>
-#include <Guid/VarErrorFlag.h>
-
-#include "PlatVarCleanupHii.h"
-
-//
-// This is the generated IFR binary data for each formset defined in VFR.
-// This data array is ready to be used as input of HiiAddPackages() to
-// create a packagelist (which contains Form packages, String packages, etc).
-//
-extern UINT8 PlatVarCleanupBin[];
-
-//
-// This is the generated String package data for all .UNI files.
-// This data array is ready to be used as input of HiiAddPackages() to
-// create a packagelist (which contains Form packages, String packages, etc).
-//
-extern UINT8 PlatformVarCleanupLibStrings[];
-
-#define USER_VARIABLE_NODE_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('U', 'V', 'N', 'S')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINTN Signature;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- CHAR16 *PromptString;
- LIST_ENTRY NameLink;
-} USER_VARIABLE_NODE;
-
-#define USER_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK(a) CR (a, USER_VARIABLE_NODE, Link, USER_VARIABLE_NODE_SIGNATURE)
-
-#define USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('U', 'V', 'N', 'N')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINTN Signature;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
- CHAR16 *Name;
- UINTN DataSize;
- UINT32 Attributes;
- UINT16 Index;
- EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId;
- CHAR16 *PromptString;
- CHAR16 *HelpString;
- BOOLEAN Deleted;
-} USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE;
-
-#define USER_VARIABLE_NAME_FROM_LINK(a) CR (a, USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE, Link, USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE_SIGNATURE)
-
-#pragma pack(1)
-//
-// HII specific Vendor Device Path definition.
-//
-typedef struct {
- VENDOR_DEVICE_PATH VendorDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL End;
-} HII_VENDOR_DEVICE_PATH;
-#pragma pack()
-
-#define VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('V', 'C', 'H', 'P')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINTN Signature;
- EFI_HANDLE DriverHandle;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle;
- EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL ConfigAccess;
- EFI_HII_CONFIG_ROUTING_PROTOCOL *ConfigRouting;
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA VariableCleanupData;
-} VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA;
-
-#define VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_FROM_THIS(a) CR (a, VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA, ConfigAccess, VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_SIGNATURE)
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanup.vfr b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanup.vfr deleted file mode 100644 index 7dfeafa2c4..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanup.vfr +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Platform variable cleanup Formset.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "PlatVarCleanupHii.h"
-
-formset
- guid = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_GUID,
- title = STRING_TOKEN(STR_ENTRY_TITLE),
- help = STRING_TOKEN(STR_TITLE_HELP),
-
- varstore VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA,
- varid = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_VARSTORE_ID,
- name = VariableCleanup,
- guid = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_GUID;
-
- form formid = FORM_ID_VARIABLE_CLEANUP,
- title = STRING_TOKEN(STR_TITLE);
-
- checkbox varid = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA.SelectAll,
- prompt = STRING_TOKEN(STR_SELECT_ALL_PROMPT),
- help = STRING_TOKEN(STR_SELECT_ALL_HELP),
- flags = INTERACTIVE,
- key = SELECT_ALL_QUESTION_ID,
- endcheckbox;
-
- label LABEL_START;
- label LABEL_END;
-
- endform;
-endformset;
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanupHii.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanupHii.h deleted file mode 100644 index 02af877b44..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanupHii.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Include file for platform variable cleanup HII.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _PLAT_VAR_CLEANUP_HII_
-#define _PLAT_VAR_CLEANUP_HII_
-
-//
-// {24F14D8A-D7A8-4991-91E0-96C3B7DB8456}
-//
-#define VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_GUID \
- { \
- 0x24f14d8a, 0xd7a8, 0x4991, { 0x91, 0xe0, 0x96, 0xc3, 0xb7, 0xdb, 0x84, 0x56 } \
- }
-
-#define MAX_USER_VARIABLE_COUNT 0x1000
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 SelectAll;
- //
- // FALSE is to not delete, TRUE is to delete.
- //
- UINT8 UserVariable[MAX_USER_VARIABLE_COUNT];
-} VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA;
-
-#define VARIABLE_CLEANUP_VARSTORE_ID 0x8000
-
-//
-// Field offset of structure VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA
-//
-#define VAR_OFFSET(Field) ((UINTN) &(((VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA *) 0)->Field))
-#define USER_VARIABLE_VAR_OFFSET (VAR_OFFSET (UserVariable))
-
-#define FORM_ID_VARIABLE_CLEANUP 0x8000
-
-#define LABEL_START 0x0000
-#define LABEL_END 0xFFFF
-
-#define SELECT_ALL_QUESTION_ID 0x7FFD
-#define SAVE_AND_EXIT_QUESTION_ID 0x7FFE
-#define NO_SAVE_AND_EXIT_QUESTION_ID 0x7FFF
-
-//
-// Tool automatic generated Question Id start from 1.
-// In order to avoid to conflict them, the user variable QuestionID offset is defined from 0x8000.
-//
-#define USER_VARIABLE_QUESTION_ID 0x8000
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanupLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanupLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index d99174c4b9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatVarCleanupLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1250 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Sample platform variable cleanup library implementation.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "PlatVarCleanup.h"
-
-VAR_ERROR_FLAG mLastVarErrorFlag = VAR_ERROR_FLAG_NO_ERROR;
-EDKII_VAR_CHECK_PROTOCOL *mVarCheck = NULL;
-
-///
-/// The flag to indicate whether the platform has left the DXE phase of execution.
-///
-BOOLEAN mEndOfDxe = FALSE;
-
-LIST_ENTRY mUserVariableList = INITIALIZE_LIST_HEAD_VARIABLE (mUserVariableList);
-UINT16 mUserVariableCount = 0;
-UINT16 mMarkedUserVariableCount = 0;
-
-EFI_GUID mVariableCleanupHiiGuid = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_GUID;
-CHAR16 mVarStoreName[] = L"VariableCleanup";
-
-HII_VENDOR_DEVICE_PATH mVarCleanupHiiVendorDevicePath = {
- {
- {
- HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH,
- HW_VENDOR_DP,
- {
- (UINT8) (sizeof (VENDOR_DEVICE_PATH)),
- (UINT8) ((sizeof (VENDOR_DEVICE_PATH)) >> 8)
- }
- },
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_GUID
- },
- {
- END_DEVICE_PATH_TYPE,
- END_ENTIRE_DEVICE_PATH_SUBTYPE,
- {
- (UINT8) (sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL)),
- (UINT8) ((sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL)) >> 8)
- }
- }
-};
-
-/**
- Internal get variable error flag.
-
- @return Variable error flag.
-
-**/
-VAR_ERROR_FLAG
-InternalGetVarErrorFlag (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Size;
- VAR_ERROR_FLAG ErrorFlag;
-
- Size = sizeof (ErrorFlag);
- Status = gRT->GetVariable (
- VAR_ERROR_FLAG_NAME,
- &gEdkiiVarErrorFlagGuid,
- NULL,
- &Size,
- &ErrorFlag
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%s - not found\n", VAR_ERROR_FLAG_NAME));
- return VAR_ERROR_FLAG_NO_ERROR;
- }
- return ErrorFlag;
-}
-
-/**
- Is user variable?
-
- @param[in] Name Pointer to variable name.
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to vendor guid.
-
- @retval TRUE User variable.
- @retval FALSE System variable.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-IsUserVariable (
- IN CHAR16 *Name,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY Property;
-
- ZeroMem (&Property, sizeof (Property));
- Status = mVarCheck->VariablePropertyGet (
- Name,
- Guid,
- &Property
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // No property, it is user variable.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "PlatformVarCleanup - User variable: %g:%s\n", Guid, Name));
- return TRUE;
- }
-
-// DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "PlatformVarCleanup - Variable Property: %g:%s\n", Guid, Name));
-// DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Revision - 0x%04x\n", Property.Revision));
-// DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Property - 0x%04x\n", Property.Property));
-// DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Attribute - 0x%08x\n", Property.Attributes));
-// DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinSize - 0x%x\n", Property.MinSize));
-// DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxSize - 0x%x\n", Property.MaxSize));
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Find user variable node by variable GUID.
-
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to vendor guid.
-
- @return Pointer to user variable node.
-
-**/
-USER_VARIABLE_NODE *
-FindUserVariableNodeByGuid (
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid
- )
-{
- USER_VARIABLE_NODE *UserVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
-
- for (Link = mUserVariableList.ForwardLink
- ;Link != &mUserVariableList
- ;Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- UserVariableNode = USER_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
-
- if (CompareGuid (Guid, &UserVariableNode->Guid)) {
- //
- // Found it.
- //
- return UserVariableNode;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Create new one if not found.
- //
- UserVariableNode = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (*UserVariableNode));
- ASSERT (UserVariableNode != NULL);
- UserVariableNode->Signature = USER_VARIABLE_NODE_SIGNATURE;
- CopyGuid (&UserVariableNode->Guid, Guid);
- //
- // (36 chars of "########-####-####-####-############" + 1 space + 1 terminator) * sizeof (CHAR16).
- //
- UserVariableNode->PromptString = AllocatePool ((36 + 2) * sizeof (CHAR16));
- ASSERT (UserVariableNode->PromptString != NULL);
- UnicodeSPrint (UserVariableNode->PromptString, (36 + 2) * sizeof (CHAR16), L" %g", &UserVariableNode->Guid);
- InitializeListHead (&UserVariableNode->NameLink);
- InsertTailList (&mUserVariableList, &UserVariableNode->Link);
- return UserVariableNode;
-}
-
-/**
- Create user variable node.
-
-**/
-VOID
-CreateUserVariableNode (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_STATUS GetVariableStatus;
- CHAR16 *VarName;
- UINTN MaxVarNameSize;
- UINTN VarNameSize;
- UINTN MaxDataSize;
- UINTN DataSize;
- VOID *Data;
- UINT32 Attributes;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- USER_VARIABLE_NODE *UserVariableNode;
- USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE *UserVariableNameNode;
- UINT16 Index;
- UINTN StringSize;
-
- //
- // Initialize 128 * sizeof (CHAR16) variable name size.
- //
- MaxVarNameSize = 128 * sizeof (CHAR16);
- VarName = AllocateZeroPool (MaxVarNameSize);
- ASSERT (VarName != NULL);
-
- //
- // Initialize 0x1000 variable data size.
- //
- MaxDataSize = 0x1000;
- Data = AllocateZeroPool (MaxDataSize);
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
-
- Index = 0;
- do {
- VarNameSize = MaxVarNameSize;
- Status = gRT->GetNextVariableName (&VarNameSize, VarName, &Guid);
- if (Status == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- VarName = ReallocatePool (MaxVarNameSize, VarNameSize, VarName);
- ASSERT (VarName != NULL);
- MaxVarNameSize = VarNameSize;
- Status = gRT->GetNextVariableName (&VarNameSize, VarName, &Guid);
- }
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- if (IsUserVariable (VarName, &Guid)) {
- DataSize = MaxDataSize;
- GetVariableStatus = gRT->GetVariable (VarName, &Guid, &Attributes, &DataSize, Data);
- if (GetVariableStatus == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- Data = ReallocatePool (MaxDataSize, DataSize, Data);
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- MaxDataSize = DataSize;
- GetVariableStatus = gRT->GetVariable (VarName, &Guid, &Attributes, &DataSize, Data);
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (GetVariableStatus);
-
- if ((Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE) != 0) {
- UserVariableNode = FindUserVariableNodeByGuid (&Guid);
- ASSERT (UserVariableNode != NULL);
-
- //
- // Different variables that have same variable GUID share same user variable node.
- //
- UserVariableNameNode = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (*UserVariableNameNode));
- ASSERT (UserVariableNameNode != NULL);
- UserVariableNameNode->Signature = USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE_SIGNATURE;
- UserVariableNameNode->Name = AllocateCopyPool (VarNameSize, VarName);
- UserVariableNameNode->Attributes = Attributes;
- UserVariableNameNode->DataSize = DataSize;
- UserVariableNameNode->Index = Index;
- UserVariableNameNode->QuestionId = (EFI_QUESTION_ID) (USER_VARIABLE_QUESTION_ID + Index);
- //
- // 2 space * sizeof (CHAR16) + StrSize.
- //
- StringSize = 2 * sizeof (CHAR16) + StrSize (UserVariableNameNode->Name);
- UserVariableNameNode->PromptString = AllocatePool (StringSize);
- ASSERT (UserVariableNameNode->PromptString != NULL);
- UnicodeSPrint (UserVariableNameNode->PromptString, StringSize, L" %s", UserVariableNameNode->Name);
- //
- // (33 chars of "Attribtues = 0x and DataSize = 0x" + 1 terminator + (sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINTN)) * 2) * sizeof (CHAR16).
- //
- StringSize = (33 + 1 + (sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINTN)) * 2) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- UserVariableNameNode->HelpString = AllocatePool (StringSize);
- ASSERT (UserVariableNameNode->HelpString != NULL);
- UnicodeSPrint (UserVariableNameNode->HelpString, StringSize, L"Attribtues = 0x%08x and DataSize = 0x%x", UserVariableNameNode->Attributes, UserVariableNameNode->DataSize);
- UserVariableNameNode->Deleted = FALSE;
- InsertTailList (&UserVariableNode->NameLink, &UserVariableNameNode->Link);
- Index++;
- }
- }
- }
- } while (Status != EFI_NOT_FOUND);
-
- mUserVariableCount = Index;
- ASSERT (mUserVariableCount <= MAX_USER_VARIABLE_COUNT);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "PlatformVarCleanup - User variable count: 0x%04x\n", mUserVariableCount));
-
- FreePool (VarName);
- FreePool (Data);
-}
-
-/**
- Destroy user variable nodes.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DestroyUserVariableNode (
- VOID
- )
-{
- USER_VARIABLE_NODE *UserVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE *UserVariableNameNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *NameLink;
-
- while (mUserVariableList.ForwardLink != &mUserVariableList) {
- Link = mUserVariableList.ForwardLink;
- UserVariableNode = USER_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
-
- RemoveEntryList (&UserVariableNode->Link);
-
- while (UserVariableNode->NameLink.ForwardLink != &UserVariableNode->NameLink) {
- NameLink = UserVariableNode->NameLink.ForwardLink;
- UserVariableNameNode = USER_VARIABLE_NAME_FROM_LINK (NameLink);
-
- RemoveEntryList (&UserVariableNameNode->Link);
-
- FreePool (UserVariableNameNode->Name);
- FreePool (UserVariableNameNode->PromptString);
- FreePool (UserVariableNameNode->HelpString);
- FreePool (UserVariableNameNode);
- }
-
- FreePool (UserVariableNode->PromptString);
- FreePool (UserVariableNode);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Create a time based data payload by concatenating the EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2
- descriptor with the input data. NO authentication is required in this function.
-
- @param[in, out] DataSize On input, the size of Data buffer in bytes.
- On output, the size of data returned in Data
- buffer in bytes.
- @param[in, out] Data On input, Pointer to data buffer to be wrapped or
- pointer to NULL to wrap an empty payload.
- On output, Pointer to the new payload date buffer allocated from pool,
- it's caller's responsibility to free the memory after using it.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Create time based payload successfully.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough memory resourses to create time based payload.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The parameter is invalid.
- @retval Others Unexpected error happens.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-CreateTimeBasedPayload (
- IN OUT UINTN *DataSize,
- IN OUT UINT8 **Data
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT8 *NewData;
- UINT8 *Payload;
- UINTN PayloadSize;
- EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2 *DescriptorData;
- UINTN DescriptorSize;
- EFI_TIME Time;
-
- if (Data == NULL || DataSize == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // At user physical presence, the variable does not need to be signed but the
- // parameters to the SetVariable() call still need to be prepared as authenticated
- // variable. So we create EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_2 descriptor without certificate
- // data in it.
- //
- Payload = *Data;
- PayloadSize = *DataSize;
-
- DescriptorSize = OFFSET_OF (EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2, AuthInfo) + OFFSET_OF (WIN_CERTIFICATE_UEFI_GUID, CertData);
- NewData = (UINT8 *) AllocateZeroPool (DescriptorSize + PayloadSize);
- if (NewData == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- if ((Payload != NULL) && (PayloadSize != 0)) {
- CopyMem (NewData + DescriptorSize, Payload, PayloadSize);
- }
-
- DescriptorData = (EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2 *) (NewData);
-
- ZeroMem (&Time, sizeof (EFI_TIME));
- Status = gRT->GetTime (&Time, NULL);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (NewData);
- return Status;
- }
- Time.Pad1 = 0;
- Time.Nanosecond = 0;
- Time.TimeZone = 0;
- Time.Daylight = 0;
- Time.Pad2 = 0;
- CopyMem (&DescriptorData->TimeStamp, &Time, sizeof (EFI_TIME));
-
- DescriptorData->AuthInfo.Hdr.dwLength = OFFSET_OF (WIN_CERTIFICATE_UEFI_GUID, CertData);
- DescriptorData->AuthInfo.Hdr.wRevision = 0x0200;
- DescriptorData->AuthInfo.Hdr.wCertificateType = WIN_CERT_TYPE_EFI_GUID;
- CopyGuid (&DescriptorData->AuthInfo.CertType, &gEfiCertPkcs7Guid);
-
- if (Payload != NULL) {
- FreePool (Payload);
- }
-
- *DataSize = DescriptorSize + PayloadSize;
- *Data = NewData;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Create a counter based data payload by concatenating the EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION
- descriptor with the input data. NO authentication is required in this function.
-
- @param[in, out] DataSize On input, the size of Data buffer in bytes.
- On output, the size of data returned in Data
- buffer in bytes.
- @param[in, out] Data On input, Pointer to data buffer to be wrapped or
- pointer to NULL to wrap an empty payload.
- On output, Pointer to the new payload date buffer allocated from pool,
- it's caller's responsibility to free the memory after using it.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Create counter based payload successfully.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough memory resourses to create time based payload.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The parameter is invalid.
- @retval Others Unexpected error happens.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-CreateCounterBasedPayload (
- IN OUT UINTN *DataSize,
- IN OUT UINT8 **Data
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT8 *NewData;
- UINT8 *Payload;
- UINTN PayloadSize;
- EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION *DescriptorData;
- UINTN DescriptorSize;
- UINT64 MonotonicCount;
-
- if (Data == NULL || DataSize == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // At user physical presence, the variable does not need to be signed but the
- // parameters to the SetVariable() call still need to be prepared as authenticated
- // variable. So we create EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED descriptor without certificate
- // data in it.
- //
- Payload = *Data;
- PayloadSize = *DataSize;
-
- DescriptorSize = (OFFSET_OF (EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION, AuthInfo)) + \
- (OFFSET_OF (WIN_CERTIFICATE_UEFI_GUID, CertData)) + \
- sizeof (EFI_CERT_BLOCK_RSA_2048_SHA256);
- NewData = (UINT8 *) AllocateZeroPool (DescriptorSize + PayloadSize);
- if (NewData == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- if ((Payload != NULL) && (PayloadSize != 0)) {
- CopyMem (NewData + DescriptorSize, Payload, PayloadSize);
- }
-
- DescriptorData = (EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION *) (NewData);
-
- Status = gBS->GetNextMonotonicCount (&MonotonicCount);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (NewData);
- return Status;
- }
- DescriptorData->MonotonicCount = MonotonicCount;
-
- DescriptorData->AuthInfo.Hdr.dwLength = OFFSET_OF (WIN_CERTIFICATE_UEFI_GUID, CertData) + sizeof (EFI_CERT_BLOCK_RSA_2048_SHA256);
- DescriptorData->AuthInfo.Hdr.wRevision = 0x0200;
- DescriptorData->AuthInfo.Hdr.wCertificateType = WIN_CERT_TYPE_EFI_GUID;
- CopyGuid (&DescriptorData->AuthInfo.CertType, &gEfiCertTypeRsa2048Sha256Guid);
-
- if (Payload != NULL) {
- FreePool (Payload);
- }
-
- *DataSize = DescriptorSize + PayloadSize;
- *Data = NewData;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Delete user variable.
-
- @param[in] DeleteAll Delete all user variables.
- @param[in] VariableCleanupData Pointer to variable cleanup data.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DeleteUserVariable (
- IN BOOLEAN DeleteAll,
- IN VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA *VariableCleanupData OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- USER_VARIABLE_NODE *UserVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE *UserVariableNameNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *NameLink;
- UINTN DataSize;
- UINT8 *Data;
-
- for (Link = mUserVariableList.ForwardLink
- ;Link != &mUserVariableList
- ;Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- UserVariableNode = USER_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
-
- for (NameLink = UserVariableNode->NameLink.ForwardLink
- ;NameLink != &UserVariableNode->NameLink
- ;NameLink = NameLink->ForwardLink) {
- UserVariableNameNode = USER_VARIABLE_NAME_FROM_LINK (NameLink);
-
- if (!UserVariableNameNode->Deleted && (DeleteAll || ((VariableCleanupData != NULL) && (VariableCleanupData->UserVariable[UserVariableNameNode->Index] == TRUE)))) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "PlatformVarCleanup - Delete variable: %g:%s\n", &UserVariableNode->Guid, UserVariableNameNode->Name));
- if ((UserVariableNameNode->Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS) != 0) {
- DataSize = 0;
- Data = NULL;
- Status = CreateTimeBasedPayload (&DataSize, &Data);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (UserVariableNameNode->Name, &UserVariableNode->Guid, UserVariableNameNode->Attributes, DataSize, Data);
- FreePool (Data);
- }
- } else if ((UserVariableNameNode->Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS) != 0) {
- DataSize = 0;
- Data = NULL;
- Status = CreateCounterBasedPayload (&DataSize, &Data);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (UserVariableNameNode->Name, &UserVariableNode->Guid, UserVariableNameNode->Attributes, DataSize, Data);
- FreePool (Data);
- }
- } else {
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (UserVariableNameNode->Name, &UserVariableNode->Guid, 0, 0, NULL);
- }
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- UserVariableNameNode->Deleted = TRUE;
- } else {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "PlatformVarCleanup - Delete variable fail: %g:%s\n", &UserVariableNode->Guid, UserVariableNameNode->Name));
- }
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- This function allows a caller to extract the current configuration for one
- or more named elements from the target driver.
-
- @param[in] This Points to the EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL.
- @param[in] Request A null-terminated Unicode string in <ConfigRequest> format.
- @param[out] Progress On return, points to a character in the Request string.
- Points to the string's null terminator if request was successful.
- Points to the most recent '&' before the first failing name/value
- pair (or the beginning of the string if the failure is in the
- first name/value pair) if the request was not successful.
- @param[out] Results A null-terminated Unicode string in <ConfigAltResp> format which
- has all values filled in for the names in the Request string.
- String to be allocated by the called function.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The Results is filled with the requested values.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory to store the results.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Request is illegal syntax, or unknown name.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Routing data doesn't match any storage in this driver.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VariableCleanupHiiExtractConfig (
- IN CONST EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN CONST EFI_STRING Request,
- OUT EFI_STRING *Progress,
- OUT EFI_STRING *Results
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA *Private;
- UINTN BufferSize;
- EFI_STRING ConfigRequestHdr;
- EFI_STRING ConfigRequest;
- BOOLEAN AllocatedRequest;
- UINTN Size;
-
- if (Progress == NULL || Results == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *Progress = Request;
- if ((Request != NULL) && !HiiIsConfigHdrMatch (Request, &mVariableCleanupHiiGuid, mVarStoreName)) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- ConfigRequestHdr = NULL;
- ConfigRequest = NULL;
- AllocatedRequest = FALSE;
- Size = 0;
-
- Private = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_FROM_THIS (This);
- //
- // Convert buffer data to <ConfigResp> by helper function BlockToConfig().
- //
- BufferSize = sizeof (VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA);
- ConfigRequest = Request;
- if ((Request == NULL) || (StrStr (Request, L"OFFSET") == NULL)) {
- //
- // Request has no request element, construct full request string.
- // Allocate and fill a buffer large enough to hold the <ConfigHdr> template
- // followed by "&OFFSET=0&WIDTH=WWWWWWWWWWWWWWWW" followed by a Null-terminator.
- //
- ConfigRequestHdr = HiiConstructConfigHdr (&mVariableCleanupHiiGuid, mVarStoreName, Private->HiiHandle);
- Size = (StrLen (ConfigRequestHdr) + 32 + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- ConfigRequest = AllocateZeroPool (Size);
- ASSERT (ConfigRequest != NULL);
- AllocatedRequest = TRUE;
- UnicodeSPrint (ConfigRequest, Size, L"%s&OFFSET=0&WIDTH=%016LX", ConfigRequestHdr, (UINT64)BufferSize);
- FreePool (ConfigRequestHdr);
- }
-
- Status = Private->ConfigRouting->BlockToConfig (
- Private->ConfigRouting,
- ConfigRequest,
- (UINT8 *) &Private->VariableCleanupData,
- BufferSize,
- Results,
- Progress
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Free the allocated config request string.
- //
- if (AllocatedRequest) {
- FreePool (ConfigRequest);
- ConfigRequest = NULL;
- }
- //
- // Set Progress string to the original request string or the string's null terminator.
- //
- if (Request == NULL) {
- *Progress = NULL;
- } else if (StrStr (Request, L"OFFSET") == NULL) {
- *Progress = Request + StrLen (Request);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Update user variable form.
-
- @param[in] Private Points to the VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA.
-
-**/
-VOID
-UpdateUserVariableForm (
- IN VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA *Private
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING_ID PromptStringToken;
- EFI_STRING_ID HelpStringToken;
- VOID *StartOpCodeHandle;
- VOID *EndOpCodeHandle;
- EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL *StartLabel;
- EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL *EndLabel;
- USER_VARIABLE_NODE *UserVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- USER_VARIABLE_NAME_NODE *UserVariableNameNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *NameLink;
- BOOLEAN Created;
-
- //
- // Init OpCode Handle.
- //
- StartOpCodeHandle = HiiAllocateOpCodeHandle ();
- ASSERT (StartOpCodeHandle != NULL);
-
- EndOpCodeHandle = HiiAllocateOpCodeHandle ();
- ASSERT (EndOpCodeHandle != NULL);
-
- //
- // Create Hii Extend Label OpCode as the start opcode.
- //
- StartLabel = (EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL *) HiiCreateGuidOpCode (StartOpCodeHandle, &gEfiIfrTianoGuid, NULL, sizeof (EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL));
- StartLabel->ExtendOpCode = EFI_IFR_EXTEND_OP_LABEL;
- StartLabel->Number = LABEL_START;
-
- //
- // Create Hii Extend Label OpCode as the end opcode.
- //
- EndLabel = (EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL *) HiiCreateGuidOpCode (EndOpCodeHandle, &gEfiIfrTianoGuid, NULL, sizeof (EFI_IFR_GUID_LABEL));
- EndLabel->ExtendOpCode = EFI_IFR_EXTEND_OP_LABEL;
- EndLabel->Number = LABEL_END;
-
- HiiUpdateForm (
- Private->HiiHandle,
- &mVariableCleanupHiiGuid,
- FORM_ID_VARIABLE_CLEANUP,
- StartOpCodeHandle, // LABEL_START
- EndOpCodeHandle // LABEL_END
- );
-
- for (Link = mUserVariableList.ForwardLink
- ;Link != &mUserVariableList
- ;Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- UserVariableNode = USER_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
-
- //
- // Create checkbox opcode for variables in the same variable GUID space.
- //
- Created = FALSE;
- for (NameLink = UserVariableNode->NameLink.ForwardLink
- ;NameLink != &UserVariableNode->NameLink
- ;NameLink = NameLink->ForwardLink) {
- UserVariableNameNode = USER_VARIABLE_NAME_FROM_LINK (NameLink);
-
- if (!UserVariableNameNode->Deleted) {
- if (!Created) {
- //
- // Create subtitle opcode for variable GUID.
- //
- PromptStringToken = HiiSetString (Private->HiiHandle, 0, UserVariableNode->PromptString, NULL);
- HiiCreateSubTitleOpCode (StartOpCodeHandle, PromptStringToken, 0, 0, 0);
- Created = TRUE;
- }
-
- //
- // Only create opcode for the non-deleted variables.
- //
- PromptStringToken = HiiSetString (Private->HiiHandle, 0, UserVariableNameNode->PromptString, NULL);
- HelpStringToken = HiiSetString (Private->HiiHandle, 0, UserVariableNameNode->HelpString, NULL);
- HiiCreateCheckBoxOpCode (
- StartOpCodeHandle,
- UserVariableNameNode->QuestionId,
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_VARSTORE_ID,
- (UINT16) (USER_VARIABLE_VAR_OFFSET + UserVariableNameNode->Index),
- PromptStringToken,
- HelpStringToken,
- EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK,
- Private->VariableCleanupData.UserVariable[UserVariableNameNode->Index],
- NULL
- );
- }
- }
- }
-
- HiiCreateSubTitleOpCode (
- StartOpCodeHandle,
- STRING_TOKEN (STR_NULL_STRING),
- 0,
- 0,
- 0
- );
-
- //
- // Create the "Apply changes" and "Discard changes" tags.
- //
- HiiCreateActionOpCode (
- StartOpCodeHandle,
- SAVE_AND_EXIT_QUESTION_ID,
- STRING_TOKEN (STR_SAVE_AND_EXIT),
- STRING_TOKEN (STR_NULL_STRING),
- EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK,
- 0
- );
- HiiCreateActionOpCode (
- StartOpCodeHandle,
- NO_SAVE_AND_EXIT_QUESTION_ID,
- STRING_TOKEN (STR_NO_SAVE_AND_EXIT),
- STRING_TOKEN (STR_NULL_STRING),
- EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK,
- 0
- );
-
- HiiUpdateForm (
- Private->HiiHandle,
- &mVariableCleanupHiiGuid,
- FORM_ID_VARIABLE_CLEANUP,
- StartOpCodeHandle, // LABEL_START
- EndOpCodeHandle // LABEL_END
- );
-
- HiiFreeOpCodeHandle (StartOpCodeHandle);
- HiiFreeOpCodeHandle (EndOpCodeHandle);
-}
-
-/**
- This function applies changes in a driver's configuration.
- Input is a Configuration, which has the routing data for this
- driver followed by name / value configuration pairs. The driver
- must apply those pairs to its configurable storage. If the
- driver's configuration is stored in a linear block of data
- and the driver's name / value pairs are in <BlockConfig>
- format, it may use the ConfigToBlock helper function (above) to
- simplify the job. Currently not implemented.
-
- @param[in] This Points to the EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL.
- @param[in] Configuration A null-terminated Unicode string in
- <ConfigString> format.
- @param[out] Progress A pointer to a string filled in with the
- offset of the most recent '&' before the
- first failing name / value pair (or the
- beginn ing of the string if the failure
- is in the first name / value pair) or
- the terminating NULL if all was
- successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The results have been distributed or are
- awaiting distribution.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough memory to store the
- parts of the results that must be
- stored awaiting possible future
- protocols.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETERS Passing in a NULL for the
- Results parameter would result
- in this type of error.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Target for the specified routing data
- was not found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VariableCleanupHiiRouteConfig (
- IN CONST EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN CONST EFI_STRING Configuration,
- OUT EFI_STRING *Progress
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA *Private;
- UINTN BufferSize;
-
- if (Progress == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- *Progress = Configuration;
-
- if (Configuration == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check routing data in <ConfigHdr>.
- // Note: there is no name for Name/Value storage, only GUID will be checked.
- //
- if (!HiiIsConfigHdrMatch (Configuration, &mVariableCleanupHiiGuid, mVarStoreName)) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- Private = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_FROM_THIS (This);
- //
- // Get Buffer Storage data.
- //
- BufferSize = sizeof (VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA);
- //
- // Convert <ConfigResp> to buffer data by helper function ConfigToBlock().
- //
- Status = Private->ConfigRouting->ConfigToBlock (
- Private->ConfigRouting,
- Configuration,
- (UINT8 *) &Private->VariableCleanupData,
- &BufferSize,
- Progress
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- DeleteUserVariable (FALSE, &Private->VariableCleanupData);
- //
- // For "F10" hotkey to refresh the form.
- //
-// UpdateUserVariableForm (Private);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function is called to provide results data to the driver.
- This data consists of a unique key that is used to identify
- which data is either being passed back or being asked for.
-
- @param[in] This Points to the EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL.
- @param[in] Action Specifies the type of action taken by the browser.
- @param[in] QuestionId A unique value which is sent to the original
- exporting driver so that it can identify the type
- of data to expect. The format of the data tends to
- vary based on the opcode that generated the callback.
- @param[in] Type The type of value for the question.
- @param[in] Value A pointer to the data being sent to the original
- exporting driver.
- @param[out] ActionRequest On return, points to the action requested by the
- callback function.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The callback successfully handled the action.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough storage is available to hold the
- variable and its data.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The variable could not be saved.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The specified Action is not supported by the
- callback.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VariableCleanupHiiCallback (
- IN CONST EFI_HII_CONFIG_ACCESS_PROTOCOL *This,
- IN EFI_BROWSER_ACTION Action,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN UINT8 Type,
- IN EFI_IFR_TYPE_VALUE *Value,
- OUT EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_REQUEST *ActionRequest
- )
-{
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA *Private;
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA *VariableCleanupData;
-
- Private = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_FROM_THIS (This);
-
- if ((Action != EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_CHANGING) && (Action != EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_CHANGED)) {
- //
- // All other action return unsupported.
- //
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrive uncommitted data from Form Browser.
- //
- VariableCleanupData = &Private->VariableCleanupData;
- HiiGetBrowserData (&mVariableCleanupHiiGuid, mVarStoreName, sizeof (VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA), (UINT8 *) VariableCleanupData);
- if (Action == EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_CHANGING) {
- if (Value == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- } else if (Action == EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_CHANGED) {
- if ((Value == NULL) || (ActionRequest == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if ((QuestionId >= USER_VARIABLE_QUESTION_ID) && (QuestionId < USER_VARIABLE_QUESTION_ID + MAX_USER_VARIABLE_COUNT)) {
- if (Value->b){
- //
- // Means one user variable checkbox is marked to delete but not press F10 or "Commit Changes and Exit" menu.
- //
- mMarkedUserVariableCount++;
- ASSERT (mMarkedUserVariableCount <= mUserVariableCount);
- if (mMarkedUserVariableCount == mUserVariableCount) {
- //
- // All user variables have been marked, then also mark the SelectAll checkbox.
- //
- VariableCleanupData->SelectAll = TRUE;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Means one user variable checkbox is unmarked.
- //
- mMarkedUserVariableCount--;
- //
- // Also unmark the SelectAll checkbox.
- //
- VariableCleanupData->SelectAll = FALSE;
- }
- } else {
- switch (QuestionId) {
- case SELECT_ALL_QUESTION_ID:
- if (Value->b){
- //
- // Means the SelectAll checkbox is marked to delete all user variables but not press F10 or "Commit Changes and Exit" menu.
- //
- SetMem (VariableCleanupData->UserVariable, sizeof (VariableCleanupData->UserVariable), TRUE);
- mMarkedUserVariableCount = mUserVariableCount;
- } else {
- //
- // Means the SelectAll checkbox is unmarked.
- //
- SetMem (VariableCleanupData->UserVariable, sizeof (VariableCleanupData->UserVariable), FALSE);
- mMarkedUserVariableCount = 0;
- }
- break;
- case SAVE_AND_EXIT_QUESTION_ID:
- DeleteUserVariable (FALSE, VariableCleanupData);
- *ActionRequest = EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_REQUEST_FORM_SUBMIT_EXIT;
- break;
-
- case NO_SAVE_AND_EXIT_QUESTION_ID:
- //
- // Restore local maintain data.
- //
- *ActionRequest = EFI_BROWSER_ACTION_REQUEST_FORM_DISCARD_EXIT;
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Pass changed uncommitted data back to Form Browser.
- //
- HiiSetBrowserData (&mVariableCleanupHiiGuid, mVarStoreName, sizeof (VARIABLE_CLEANUP_DATA), (UINT8 *) VariableCleanupData, NULL);
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Platform variable cleanup.
-
- @param[in] Flag Variable error flag.
- @param[in] Type Variable cleanup type.
- If it is VarCleanupManually, the interface must be called after console connected.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS No error or error processed.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The specified Flag or Type is not supported.
- For example, system error may be not supported to process and Platform should have mechanism to reset system to manufacture mode.
- Another, if system and user variables are wanted to be distinguished to process, the interface must be called after EndOfDxe.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough resource to process the error.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The specified Flag or Type is an invalid value.
- @retval Others Other failure occurs.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PlatformVarCleanup (
- IN VAR_ERROR_FLAG Flag,
- IN VAR_CLEANUP_TYPE Type
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_FORM_BROWSER2_PROTOCOL *FormBrowser2;
- VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA *Private;
-
- if (!mEndOfDxe) {
- //
- // This implementation must be called after EndOfDxe.
- //
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- if ((Type >= VarCleanupMax) || ((Flag & ((VAR_ERROR_FLAG) (VAR_ERROR_FLAG_SYSTEM_ERROR & VAR_ERROR_FLAG_USER_ERROR))) == 0)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (Flag == VAR_ERROR_FLAG_NO_ERROR) {
- //
- // Just return success if no error.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if ((Flag & (~((VAR_ERROR_FLAG) VAR_ERROR_FLAG_SYSTEM_ERROR))) == 0) {
- //
- // This sample does not support system variables cleanup.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "NOTICE - VAR_ERROR_FLAG_SYSTEM_ERROR\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "Platform should have mechanism to reset system to manufacture mode\n"));
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Continue to process VAR_ERROR_FLAG_USER_ERROR.
- //
-
- //
- // Create user variable nodes for the following processing.
- //
- CreateUserVariableNode ();
-
- switch (Type) {
- case VarCleanupAll:
- DeleteUserVariable (TRUE, NULL);
- //
- // Destroyed the created user variable nodes
- //
- DestroyUserVariableNode ();
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- break;
-
- case VarCleanupManually:
- //
- // Locate FormBrowser2 protocol.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiFormBrowser2ProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &FormBrowser2);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- Private = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_DATA));
- if (Private == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Private->Signature = VARIABLE_CLEANUP_HII_PRIVATE_SIGNATURE;
- Private->ConfigAccess.ExtractConfig = VariableCleanupHiiExtractConfig;
- Private->ConfigAccess.RouteConfig = VariableCleanupHiiRouteConfig;
- Private->ConfigAccess.Callback = VariableCleanupHiiCallback;
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **) &Private->ConfigRouting
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Install Device Path Protocol and Config Access protocol to driver handle.
- //
- Status = gBS->InstallMultipleProtocolInterfaces (
- &Private->DriverHandle,
- &gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid,
- &mVarCleanupHiiVendorDevicePath,
- &gEfiHiiConfigAccessProtocolGuid,
- &Private->ConfigAccess,
- NULL
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Publish our HII data.
- //
- Private->HiiHandle = HiiAddPackages (
- &mVariableCleanupHiiGuid,
- Private->DriverHandle,
- PlatformVarCleanupLibStrings,
- PlatVarCleanupBin,
- NULL
- );
- if (Private->HiiHandle == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Done;
- }
-
- UpdateUserVariableForm (Private);
-
- Status = FormBrowser2->SendForm (
- FormBrowser2,
- &Private->HiiHandle,
- 1,
- NULL,
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL
- );
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- break;
- }
-
-Done:
- if (Private->DriverHandle != NULL) {
- gBS->UninstallMultipleProtocolInterfaces (
- Private->DriverHandle,
- &gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid,
- &mVarCleanupHiiVendorDevicePath,
- &gEfiHiiConfigAccessProtocolGuid,
- &Private->ConfigAccess,
- NULL
- );
- }
- if (Private->HiiHandle != NULL) {
- HiiRemovePackages (Private->HiiHandle);
- }
-
- FreePool (Private);
-
- //
- // Destroyed the created user variable nodes
- //
- DestroyUserVariableNode ();
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Get last boot variable error flag.
-
- @return Last boot variable error flag.
-
-**/
-VAR_ERROR_FLAG
-EFIAPI
-GetLastBootVarErrorFlag (
- )
-{
- return mLastVarErrorFlag;
-}
-
-/**
- Notification function of END_OF_DXE.
-
- This is a notification function registered on END_OF_DXE event.
-
- @param[in] Event Event whose notification function is being invoked.
- @param[in] Context Pointer to the notification function's context.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PlatformVarCleanupEndOfDxeEvent (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- mEndOfDxe = TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- The constructor function caches the pointer to VarCheck protocol and last boot variable error flag.
-
- The constructor function locates VarCheck protocol from protocol database.
- It will ASSERT() if that operation fails and it will always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PlatformVarCleanupLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
-
- mLastVarErrorFlag = InternalGetVarErrorFlag ();
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "mLastVarErrorFlag - 0x%02x\n", mLastVarErrorFlag));
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEdkiiVarCheckProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **) &mVarCheck
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Register EFI_END_OF_DXE_EVENT_GROUP_GUID event.
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEventEx (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- PlatformVarCleanupEndOfDxeEvent,
- NULL,
- &gEfiEndOfDxeEventGroupGuid,
- &Event
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatformVarCleanupLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatformVarCleanupLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index c56a17584a..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatformVarCleanupLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,73 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Sample platform variable cleanup library instance.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = PlatformVarCleanupLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = PlatformVarCleanupLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 9C9623EB-4EF3-44e0-A931-F3A340D1A0F9
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PlatformVarCleanupLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = PlatformVarCleanupLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources.common]
- PlatVarCleanupLib.c
- PlatVarCleanup.h
- PlatVarCleanupHii.h
- PlatVarCleanup.vfr
- VfrStrings.uni
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib
- UefiLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- PrintLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- HiiLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiIfrTianoGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## GUID
- gEdkiiVarErrorFlagGuid ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"VarErrorFlag"
- gEfiEndOfDxeEventGroupGuid ## CONSUMES ## Event
- gEfiCertPkcs7Guid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
- gEfiCertTypeRsa2048Sha256Guid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiVariableArchProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEdkiiVarCheckProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES
- gEfiFormBrowser2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiHiiConfigAccessProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES
- gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
-
-[Depex]
- gEdkiiVarCheckProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiVariableArchProtocolGuid
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatformVarCleanupLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatformVarCleanupLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index e4a0debafa..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/PlatformVarCleanupLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/VfrStrings.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/VfrStrings.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 56f8e3625f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/PlatformVarCleanupLib/VfrStrings.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index e533af3d33..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,754 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- API implementation for instance of Report Status Code Library.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2012, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/ReportStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeLib.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/StatusCode.h>
-
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeId.h>
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeDebug.h>
-#include <Guid/EventGroup.h>
-
-
-//
-// Define the maximum extended data size that is supported when a status code is reported.
-//
-#define MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE 0x200
-
-EFI_STATUS_CODE_PROTOCOL *mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol = NULL;
-EFI_EVENT mReportStatusCodeLibVirtualAddressChangeEvent;
-EFI_EVENT mReportStatusCodeLibExitBootServicesEvent;
-BOOLEAN mHaveExitedBootServices = FALSE;
-
-/**
- Locate the report status code service.
-
- Retrieve ReportStatusCode() API of Report Status Code Protocol.
-
-**/
-VOID
-InternalGetReportStatusCode (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol != NULL) {
- return;
- }
-
- if (mHaveExitedBootServices) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Check gBS just in case ReportStatusCode is called before gBS is initialized.
- //
- if (gBS != NULL && gBS->LocateProtocol != NULL) {
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiStatusCodeRuntimeProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID**) &mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol = NULL;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Notification function of EVT_SIGNAL_VIRTUAL_ADDRESS_CHANGE.
-
- @param Event Event whose notification function is being invoked.
- @param Context Pointer to the notification function's context
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeLibVirtualAddressChange (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- if (mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol == NULL) {
- return;
- }
- EfiConvertPointer (0, (VOID **) &mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol);
-}
-
-/**
- Notification function of EVT_SIGNAL_EXIT_BOOT_SERVICES.
-
- @param Event Event whose notification function is being invoked.
- @param Context Pointer to the notification function's context
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeLibExitBootServices (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- //
- // Locate the report status code service before enter runtime.
- //
- InternalGetReportStatusCode ();
-
- mHaveExitedBootServices = TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- The constructor function of Runtime DXE Report Status Code Lib.
-
- This function allocates memory for extended status code data, caches
- the report status code service, and registers events.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Cache the report status code service
- //
- InternalGetReportStatusCode ();
-
- //
- // Register notify function for EVT_SIGNAL_VIRTUAL_ADDRESS_CHANGE
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEventEx (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- ReportStatusCodeLibVirtualAddressChange,
- NULL,
- &gEfiEventVirtualAddressChangeGuid,
- &mReportStatusCodeLibVirtualAddressChangeEvent
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Register notify function for EVT_SIGNAL_EXIT_BOOT_SERVICES
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEventEx (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- ReportStatusCodeLibExitBootServices,
- NULL,
- &gEfiEventExitBootServicesGuid,
- &mReportStatusCodeLibExitBootServicesEvent
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- The destructor function of Runtime DXE Report Status Code Lib.
-
- The destructor function frees memory allocated by constructor, and closes related events.
- It will ASSERT() if that related operation fails and it will always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeLibDestructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (gBS != NULL);
- Status = gBS->CloseEvent (mReportStatusCodeLibVirtualAddressChangeEvent);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = gBS->CloseEvent (mReportStatusCodeLibExitBootServicesEvent);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal worker function that reports a status code through the Report Status Code Protocol.
-
- If status code service is not cached, then this function checks if Report Status Code
- Protocol is available in system. If Report Status Code Protocol is not available, then
- EFI_UNSUPPORTED is returned. If Report Status Code Protocol is present, then it is
- cached in mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol. Finally this function reports status
- code through the Report Status Code Protocol.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. This is an optional parameter that may be
- NULL.
- @param Data Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report Status Code Protocol is not available.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Status code type is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- if ((ReportProgressCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- (ReportErrorCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ||
- (ReportDebugCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_DEBUG_CODE)) {
- //
- // If mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol is NULL, then check if Report Status Code Protocol is available in system.
- //
- InternalGetReportStatusCode ();
- if (mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol == NULL) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // A Report Status Code Protocol is present in system, so pass in all the parameters to the service.
- //
- return mReportStatusCodeLibStatusCodeProtocol->ReportStatusCode (Type, Value, Instance, (EFI_GUID *)CallerId, Data);
- }
-
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Converts a status code to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType and Value to an 8-bit POST code
- and returns the 8-bit POST code in PostCode. If CodeType is an
- EFI_PROGRESS_CODE or CodeType is an EFI_ERROR_CODE, then bits 0..4 of PostCode
- are set to bits 16..20 of Value, and bits 5..7 of PostCode are set to bits
- 24..26 of Value., and TRUE is returned. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param PostCode A pointer to the 8-bit POST code value to return.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType and Value was converted
- to an 8-bit POST code and returned in PostCode.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType and Value could not be
- converted to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-CodeTypeToPostCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- OUT UINT8 *PostCode
- )
-{
- //
- // If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT()
- //
- ASSERT (PostCode != NULL);
-
- //
- // Convert Value to an 8 bit post code
- //
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ) {
- *PostCode = (UINT8) ((((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_CLASS_MASK) >> 24) << 5) |
- (((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SUBCLASS_MASK) >> 16) & 0x1f));
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts ASSERT() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data to the ASSERT()
- arguments specified by Filename, Description, and LineNumber. If CodeType is
- an EFI_ERROR_CODE, and CodeType has a severity of EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED, and
- Value has an operation mask of EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE, extract
- Filename, Description, and LineNumber from the optional data area of the
- status code buffer specified by Data. The optional data area of Data contains
- a Null-terminated ASCII string for the FileName, followed by a Null-terminated
- ASCII string for the Description, followed by a 32-bit LineNumber. If the
- ASSERT() information could be extracted from Data, then return TRUE.
- Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Filename is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Description is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If LineNumber is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param Filename Pointer to the source file name that generated the ASSERT().
- @param Description Pointer to the description of the ASSERT().
- @param LineNumber Pointer to source line number that generated the ASSERT().
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data was
- converted ASSERT() arguments specified by Filename, Description,
- and LineNumber.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data could
- not be converted to ASSERT() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractAssertInfo (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT CHAR8 **Filename,
- OUT CHAR8 **Description,
- OUT UINT32 *LineNumber
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *AssertData;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (Filename != NULL);
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
- ASSERT (LineNumber != NULL);
-
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) &&
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SEVERITY_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED) &&
- ((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_OPERATION_MASK) == EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE)) {
- AssertData = (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *)(Data + 1);
- *Filename = (CHAR8 *)(AssertData + 1);
- *Description = *Filename + AsciiStrLen (*Filename) + 1;
- *LineNumber = AssertData->LineNumber;
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts DEBUG() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by Data to the DEBUG() arguments specified
- by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format. If type GUID in Data is
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID, then extract ErrorLevel, Marker, and
- Format from the optional data area of the status code buffer specified by Data.
- The optional data area of Data contains a 32-bit ErrorLevel followed by Marker
- which is 12 UINTN parameters, followed by a Null-terminated ASCII string for
- the Format. If the DEBUG() information could be extracted from Data, then
- return TRUE. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ErrorLevel is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Marker is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Format is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param ErrorLevel Pointer to error level mask for a debug message.
- @param Marker Pointer to the variable argument list associated with Format.
- @param Format Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII format string of a
- debug message.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by Data was converted DEBUG() arguments
- specified by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by Data could not be converted to
- DEBUG() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractDebugInfo (
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT UINT32 *ErrorLevel,
- OUT BASE_LIST *Marker,
- OUT CHAR8 **Format
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_INFO *DebugInfo;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (ErrorLevel != NULL);
- ASSERT (Marker != NULL);
- ASSERT (Format != NULL);
-
- //
- // If the GUID type is not EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID then return FALSE
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (&Data->Type, &gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the debug information from the status code record
- //
- DebugInfo = (EFI_DEBUG_INFO *)(Data + 1);
-
- *ErrorLevel = DebugInfo->ErrorLevel;
-
- //
- // The first 12 * sizeof (UINT64) bytes following EFI_DEBUG_INFO are for variable arguments
- // of format in DEBUG string. Its address is returned in Marker and has to be 64-bit aligned.
- // It must be noticed that EFI_DEBUG_INFO follows EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA, whose size is
- // 20 bytes. The size of EFI_DEBUG_INFO is 4 bytes, so we can ensure that Marker
- // returned is 64-bit aligned.
- // 64-bit aligned is a must, otherwise retrieving 64-bit parameter from BASE_LIST will
- // cause unalignment exception.
- //
- *Marker = (BASE_LIST) (DebugInfo + 1);
- *Format = (CHAR8 *)(((UINT64 *)*Marker) + 12);
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code.
-
- Reports the status code specified by the parameters Type and Value. Status
- code also require an instance, caller ID, and extended data. This function
- passed in a zero instance, NULL extended data, and a caller ID of
- gEfiCallerIdGuid, which is the GUID for the module.
-
- ReportStatusCode()must actively prevent recusrsion. If ReportStatusCode()
- is called while processing another any other Report Status Code Library function,
- then ReportStatusCode() must return immediately.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR There status code could not be reported due to a
- device error.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value
- )
-{
- return InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, 0, &gEfiCallerIdGuid, NULL);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with a Device Path Protocol as the extended data.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- Device Path Protocol specified by DevicePath. This function is responsible
- for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and the device
- path. The standard header is filled in with a GUID of
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported with a zero
- instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If DevicePath is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param DevicePath Pointer to the Device Path Protocol to be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by DevicePath.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithDevicePath (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- ASSERT (DevicePath != NULL);
- return ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData (
- Type,
- Value,
- (VOID *)DevicePath,
- GetDevicePathSize (DevicePath)
- );
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with an extended data buffer.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- extended data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize. ExtendedData
- is assumed to be one of the data structures specified in Related Definitions.
- These data structure do not have the standard header, so this function is
- responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled
- in with a GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported
- with a zero instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedDataSize is 0, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer to be reported.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer to
- be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- ASSERT (ExtendedData != NULL);
- ASSERT (ExtendedDataSize != 0);
- return ReportStatusCodeEx (
- Type,
- Value,
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- ExtendedData,
- ExtendedDataSize
- );
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with full parameters.
-
- The function reports a status code. If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize
- is 0, then an extended data buffer is not reported. If ExtendedData is not
- NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not 0, then an extended data buffer is allocated.
- ExtendedData is assumed not have the standard status code header, so this function
- is responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled in
- with a GUID specified by ExtendedDataGuid. If ExtendedDataGuid is NULL, then a
- GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid is used. The status code is reported with
- an instance specified by Instance and a caller ID specified by CallerId. If
- CallerId is NULL, then a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
-
- ReportStatusCodeEx()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeEx() is called while processing another any
- other Report Status Code Library function, then
- ReportStatusCodeEx() must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedData is not NULL and ExtendedDataSize is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. If this parameter is NULL, then a caller
- ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
- @param ExtendedDataGuid Pointer to the GUID for the extended data buffer.
- If this parameter is NULL, then a the status code
- standard header is filled in with
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate
- the extended data section if it was specified.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeEx (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *ExtendedDataGuid OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData OPTIONAL,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *StatusCodeData;
- UINT64 StatusCodeBuffer[(MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE / sizeof (UINT64)) + 1];
-
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData == NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize != 0)));
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData != NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize == 0)));
-
- if (mHaveExitedBootServices) {
- if (sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA) + ExtendedDataSize > MAX_EXTENDED_DATA_SIZE) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- StatusCodeData = (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *) StatusCodeBuffer;
- } else {
- if (gBS == NULL || gBS->AllocatePool == NULL || gBS->FreePool == NULL) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate space for the Status Code Header and its buffer
- //
- StatusCodeData = NULL;
- gBS->AllocatePool (EfiBootServicesData, sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA) + ExtendedDataSize, (VOID **)&StatusCodeData);
- if (StatusCodeData == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Fill in the extended data header
- //
- StatusCodeData->HeaderSize = (UINT16) sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA);
- StatusCodeData->Size = (UINT16) ExtendedDataSize;
- if (ExtendedDataGuid == NULL) {
- ExtendedDataGuid = &gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid;
- }
- CopyGuid (&StatusCodeData->Type, ExtendedDataGuid);
-
- //
- // Fill in the extended data buffer
- //
- if (ExtendedData != NULL) {
- CopyMem (StatusCodeData + 1, ExtendedData, ExtendedDataSize);
- }
-
- //
- // Report the status code
- //
- if (CallerId == NULL) {
- CallerId = &gEfiCallerIdGuid;
- }
- Status = InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, Instance, CallerId, StatusCodeData);
-
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer
- //
- if (!mHaveExitedBootServices) {
- gBS->FreePool (StatusCodeData);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_PROGRESS_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportProgressCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_ERROR_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportErrorCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_DEBUG_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportDebugCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 49d9933b58..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Report status code library instance which supports logging message in DXE & runtime phase.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 07D25BBB-F832-41bb-BBA0-612E9F033067
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = ReportStatusCodeLib|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = ReportStatusCodeLibConstructor
- DESTRUCTOR = ReportStatusCodeLibDestructor
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- ReportStatusCodeLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- PcdLib
- DevicePathLib
- UefiRuntimeLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
- gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
- gEfiEventVirtualAddressChangeGuid ## CONSUMES ## Event
- gEfiEventExitBootServicesGuid ## CONSUMES ## Event
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiStatusCodeRuntimeProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask ## CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 5392a9bf1b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib/RuntimeDxeReportStatusCodeLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index e59cc28d53..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1099 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Performance library instance used by SMM Core.
-
- This library provides the performance measurement interfaces and initializes performance
- logging for the SMM phase.
- It initializes SMM phase performance logging by publishing the SMM Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol,
- which is consumed by SmmPerformanceLib to logging performance data in SMM phase.
-
- This library is mainly used by SMM Core to start performance logging to ensure that
- SMM Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol are installed at the very beginning of SMM phase.
-
- Caution: This module requires additional review when modified.
- This driver will have external input - performance data and communicate buffer in SMM mode.
- This external input must be validated carefully to avoid security issue like
- buffer overflow, integer overflow.
-
- SmmPerformanceHandlerEx(), SmmPerformanceHandler() will receive untrusted input and do basic validation.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include "SmmCorePerformanceLibInternal.h"
-
-//
-// The data structure to hold global performance data.
-//
-GAUGE_DATA_HEADER *mGaugeData;
-
-//
-// The current maximum number of logging entries. If current number of
-// entries exceeds this value, it will re-allocate a larger array and
-// migration the old data to the larger array.
-//
-UINT32 mMaxGaugeRecords;
-
-//
-// The handle to install Performance Protocol instance.
-//
-EFI_HANDLE mHandle = NULL;
-
-BOOLEAN mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled;
-
-SPIN_LOCK mSmmPerfLock;
-
-//
-// Interfaces for SMM Performance Protocol.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL mPerformanceInterface = {
- StartGauge,
- EndGauge,
- GetGauge
-};
-
-//
-// Interfaces for SMM PerformanceEx Protocol.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL mPerformanceExInterface = {
- StartGaugeEx,
- EndGaugeEx,
- GetGaugeEx
-};
-
-/**
- Searches in the gauge array with keyword Handle, Token, Module and Identfier.
-
- This internal function searches for the gauge entry in the gauge array.
- If there is an entry that exactly matches the given keywords
- and its end time stamp is zero, then the index of that gauge entry is returned;
- otherwise, the the number of gauge entries in the array is returned.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier.
-
- @retval The index of gauge entry in the array.
-
-**/
-UINT32
-SmmSearchForGaugeEntry (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT32 Index2;
- UINT32 NumberOfEntries;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
-
- if (Token == NULL) {
- Token = "";
- }
- if (Module == NULL) {
- Module = "";
- }
-
- NumberOfEntries = mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries;
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- Index2 = 0;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- Index2 = NumberOfEntries - 1 - Index;
- if (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].EndTimeStamp == 0 &&
- (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Handle == (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Handle) &&
- AsciiStrnCmp (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Token, Token, SMM_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH) == 0 &&
- AsciiStrnCmp (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Module, Module, SMM_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH) == 0 &&
- (GaugeEntryExArray[Index2].Identifier == Identifier)) {
- Index = Index2;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- return Index;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINTN GaugeDataSize;
- GAUGE_DATA_HEADER *NewGaugeData;
- UINTN OldGaugeDataSize;
- GAUGE_DATA_HEADER *OldGaugeData;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- AcquireSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
-
- Index = mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries;
- if (Index >= mMaxGaugeRecords) {
- //
- // Try to enlarge the scale of gauge array.
- //
- OldGaugeData = mGaugeData;
- OldGaugeDataSize = sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_HEADER) + sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX) * mMaxGaugeRecords;
-
- GaugeDataSize = sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_HEADER) + sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX) * mMaxGaugeRecords * 2;
-
- NewGaugeData = AllocateZeroPool (GaugeDataSize);
- if (NewGaugeData == NULL) {
- ReleaseSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- mGaugeData = NewGaugeData;
- mMaxGaugeRecords *= 2;
-
- //
- // Initialize new data array and migrate old data one.
- //
- mGaugeData = CopyMem (mGaugeData, OldGaugeData, OldGaugeDataSize);
-
- FreePool (OldGaugeData);
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Handle = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) Handle;
-
- if (Token != NULL) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Token, SMM_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, Token, SMM_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH);
- }
- if (Module != NULL) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Module, SMM_PERFORMANCE_STRING_SIZE, Module, SMM_PERFORMANCE_STRING_LENGTH);
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = 0;
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].Identifier = Identifier;
-
- if (TimeStamp == 0) {
- TimeStamp = GetPerformanceCounter ();
- }
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].StartTimeStamp = TimeStamp;
-
- mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries++;
-
- ReleaseSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINT32 Index;
-
- AcquireSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
-
- if (TimeStamp == 0) {
- TimeStamp = GetPerformanceCounter ();
- }
-
- Index = SmmSearchForGaugeEntry (Handle, Token, Module, Identifier);
- if (Index >= mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries) {
- ReleaseSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
- GaugeEntryExArray[Index].EndTimeStamp = TimeStamp;
-
- ReleaseSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGauge and EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntryEx stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntryEx The indirect pointer to the extended gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntryEx is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntryEx is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGaugeEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX **GaugeDataEntryEx
- )
-{
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
-
- NumberOfEntries = (UINTN) (mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries);
- if (LogEntryKey > NumberOfEntries) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (LogEntryKey == NumberOfEntries) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- if (GaugeDataEntryEx == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- *GaugeDataEntryEx = &GaugeEntryExArray[LogEntryKey];
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, and Module and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGaugeEx and EndGaugeEx of PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntry stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntry The indirect pointer to the gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntry is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntry is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGauge (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **GaugeDataEntry
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryEx;
-
- GaugeEntryEx = NULL;
-
- Status = GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey, &GaugeEntryEx);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- if (GaugeDataEntry == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- *GaugeDataEntry = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY *) GaugeEntryEx;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Communication service SMI Handler entry.
-
- This SMI handler provides services for the performance wrapper driver.
-
- Caution: This function may receive untrusted input.
- Communicate buffer and buffer size are external input, so this function will do basic validation.
-
- @param[in] DispatchHandle The unique handle assigned to this handler by SmiHandlerRegister().
- @param[in] RegisterContext Points to an optional handler context which was specified when the
- handler was registered.
- @param[in, out] CommBuffer A pointer to a collection of data in memory that will
- be conveyed from a non-SMM environment into an SMM environment.
- @param[in, out] CommBufferSize The size of the CommBuffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The interrupt was handled and quiesced. No other handlers
- should still be called.
- @retval EFI_WARN_INTERRUPT_SOURCE_QUIESCED The interrupt has been quiesced but other handlers should
- still be called.
- @retval EFI_WARN_INTERRUPT_SOURCE_PENDING The interrupt is still pending and other handlers should still
- be called.
- @retval EFI_INTERRUPT_PENDING The interrupt could not be quiesced.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmPerformanceHandlerEx (
- IN EFI_HANDLE DispatchHandle,
- IN CONST VOID *RegisterContext,
- IN OUT VOID *CommBuffer,
- IN OUT UINTN *CommBufferSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX *SmmPerfCommData;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINT64 DataSize;
- UINTN Index;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeDataEx;
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
- UINTN LogEntryKey;
- UINTN TempCommBufferSize;
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = NULL;
-
- //
- // If input is invalid, stop processing this SMI
- //
- if (CommBuffer == NULL || CommBufferSize == NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- TempCommBufferSize = *CommBufferSize;
-
- if(TempCommBufferSize < sizeof (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX)) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if (!SmmIsBufferOutsideSmmValid ((UINTN)CommBuffer, TempCommBufferSize)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "SmmPerformanceHandlerEx: SMM communcation data buffer in SMRAM or overflow!\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- SmmPerfCommData = (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE_EX *)CommBuffer;
-
- switch (SmmPerfCommData->Function) {
- case SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_ENTRY_NUMBER :
- SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries = mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- break;
-
- case SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_DATA :
- GaugeDataEx = SmmPerfCommData->GaugeDataEx;
- NumberOfEntries = SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries;
- LogEntryKey = SmmPerfCommData->LogEntryKey;
- if (GaugeDataEx == NULL || NumberOfEntries == 0 || LogEntryKey > mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries ||
- NumberOfEntries > mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries || LogEntryKey > (mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries - NumberOfEntries)) {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Sanity check
- //
- DataSize = MultU64x32 (NumberOfEntries, sizeof(GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX));
- if (!SmmIsBufferOutsideSmmValid ((UINTN) GaugeDataEx, DataSize)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "SmmPerformanceHandlerEx: SMM Performance Data buffer in SMRAM or overflow!\n"));
- Status = EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- break;
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- CopyMem (
- (UINT8 *) &GaugeDataEx[Index],
- (UINT8 *) &GaugeEntryExArray[LogEntryKey++],
- sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX)
- );
- }
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- break;
-
- default:
- Status = EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
-
- SmmPerfCommData->ReturnStatus = Status;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Communication service SMI Handler entry.
-
- This SMI handler provides services for the performance wrapper driver.
-
- Caution: This function may receive untrusted input.
- Communicate buffer and buffer size are external input, so this function will do basic validation.
-
- @param[in] DispatchHandle The unique handle assigned to this handler by SmiHandlerRegister().
- @param[in] RegisterContext Points to an optional handler context which was specified when the
- handler was registered.
- @param[in, out] CommBuffer A pointer to a collection of data in memory that will
- be conveyed from a non-SMM environment into an SMM environment.
- @param[in, out] CommBufferSize The size of the CommBuffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The interrupt was handled and quiesced. No other handlers
- should still be called.
- @retval EFI_WARN_INTERRUPT_SOURCE_QUIESCED The interrupt has been quiesced but other handlers should
- still be called.
- @retval EFI_WARN_INTERRUPT_SOURCE_PENDING The interrupt is still pending and other handlers should still
- be called.
- @retval EFI_INTERRUPT_PENDING The interrupt could not be quiesced.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmPerformanceHandler (
- IN EFI_HANDLE DispatchHandle,
- IN CONST VOID *RegisterContext,
- IN OUT VOID *CommBuffer,
- IN OUT UINTN *CommBufferSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE *SmmPerfCommData;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeEntryExArray;
- UINT64 DataSize;
- UINTN Index;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY *GaugeData;
- UINTN NumberOfEntries;
- UINTN LogEntryKey;
- UINTN TempCommBufferSize;
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = NULL;
-
- //
- // If input is invalid, stop processing this SMI
- //
- if (CommBuffer == NULL || CommBufferSize == NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- TempCommBufferSize = *CommBufferSize;
-
- if(TempCommBufferSize < sizeof (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE)) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if (!SmmIsBufferOutsideSmmValid ((UINTN)CommBuffer, TempCommBufferSize)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "SmmPerformanceHandler: SMM communcation data buffer in SMRAM or overflow!\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- SmmPerfCommData = (SMM_PERF_COMMUNICATE *)CommBuffer;
-
- switch (SmmPerfCommData->Function) {
- case SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_ENTRY_NUMBER :
- SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries = mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- break;
-
- case SMM_PERF_FUNCTION_GET_GAUGE_DATA :
- GaugeData = SmmPerfCommData->GaugeData;
- NumberOfEntries = SmmPerfCommData->NumberOfEntries;
- LogEntryKey = SmmPerfCommData->LogEntryKey;
- if (GaugeData == NULL || NumberOfEntries == 0 || LogEntryKey > mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries ||
- NumberOfEntries > mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries || LogEntryKey > (mGaugeData->NumberOfEntries - NumberOfEntries)) {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Sanity check
- //
- DataSize = MultU64x32 (NumberOfEntries, sizeof(GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY));
- if (!SmmIsBufferOutsideSmmValid ((UINTN) GaugeData, DataSize)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "SmmPerformanceHandler: SMM Performance Data buffer in SMRAM or overflow!\n"));
- Status = EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- break;
- }
-
- GaugeEntryExArray = (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *) (mGaugeData + 1);
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfEntries; Index++) {
- CopyMem (
- (UINT8 *) &GaugeData[Index],
- (UINT8 *) &GaugeEntryExArray[LogEntryKey++],
- sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY)
- );
- }
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- break;
-
- default:
- Status = EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
-
- SmmPerfCommData->ReturnStatus = Status;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- SmmBase2 protocol notify callback function, when SMST and SMM memory service get initialized
- this function is callbacked to initialize the Smm Performance Lib
-
- @param Event The event of notify protocol.
- @param Context Notify event context.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-InitializeSmmCorePerformanceLib (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
-
- //
- // Initialize spin lock
- //
- InitializeSpinLock (&mSmmPerfLock);
-
- mMaxGaugeRecords = INIT_SMM_GAUGE_DATA_ENTRIES;
-
- mGaugeData = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_HEADER) + (sizeof (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX) * mMaxGaugeRecords));
- ASSERT (mGaugeData != NULL);
-
- //
- // Install the protocol interfaces.
- //
- Status = gSmst->SmmInstallProtocolInterface (
- &mHandle,
- &gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid,
- EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
- &mPerformanceInterface
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = gSmst->SmmInstallProtocolInterface (
- &mHandle,
- &gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid,
- EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
- &mPerformanceExInterface
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- ///
- /// Register SMM Performance SMI handler
- ///
- Handle = NULL;
- Status = gSmst->SmiHandlerRegister (SmmPerformanceHandler, &gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid, &Handle);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Status = gSmst->SmiHandlerRegister (SmmPerformanceHandlerEx, &gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid, &Handle);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- The constructor function initializes the Performance Measurement Enable flag and
- registers SmmBase2 protocol notify callback.
- It will ASSERT() if one of these operations fails and it will always return EFI_SUCCESS.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmCorePerformanceLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
- VOID *Registration;
-
- mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled = (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8(PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask) & PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED) != 0);
- if (!mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled) {
- //
- // Do not initialize performance infrastructure if not required.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Create the events to do the library init.
- //
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- InitializeSmmCorePerformanceLib,
- NULL,
- &Event
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Register for protocol notifications on this event
- //
- Status = gBS->RegisterProtocolNotify (
- &gEfiSmmBase2ProtocolGuid,
- Event,
- &Registration
- );
-
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- return (RETURN_STATUS) StartGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- return (RETURN_STATUS) EndGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeData;
-
- GaugeData = NULL;
-
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
- ASSERT (Token != NULL);
- ASSERT (Module != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (EndTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (Identifier != NULL);
-
- Status = GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey++, &GaugeData);
-
- //
- // Make sure that LogEntryKey is a valid log entry key,
- //
- ASSERT (Status != EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- //
- return 0;
- }
-
- ASSERT (GaugeData != NULL);
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) GaugeData->Handle;
- *Token = GaugeData->Token;
- *Module = GaugeData->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = GaugeData->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = GaugeData->EndTimeStamp;
- *Identifier = GaugeData->Identifier;
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, and Module and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurementEx and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, and EndTimeStamp.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp
- )
-{
- UINT32 Identifier;
- return GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (LogEntryKey, Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp, &Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if the performance measurement macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-PerformanceMeasurementEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 160a749390..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,73 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Performance library instance used by SMM Core.
-#
-# This library provides the performance measurement interfaces and initializes performance
-# logging for the SMM phase.
-# It initializes SMM phase performance logging by publishing the SMM Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol,
-# which is consumed by SmmPerformanceLib to logging performance data in SMM phase.
-# This library is mainly used by SMM Core to start performance logging to ensure that
-# SMM Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol are installed at the very beginning of SMM phase.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmCorePerformanceLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmCorePerformanceLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 36290D10-0F47-42c1-BBCE-E191C7928DCF
- MODULE_TYPE = SMM_CORE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- PI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x0001000A
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PerformanceLib|SMM_CORE
-
- CONSTRUCTOR = SmmCorePerformanceLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmCorePerformanceLib.c
- SmmCorePerformanceLibInternal.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- PcdLib
- TimerLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- SynchronizationLib
- SmmServicesTableLib
- SmmMemLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSmmBase2ProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Guids]
- ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # Install protocol
- ## CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # SmiHandlerRegister
- gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid
- ## PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # Install protocol
- ## CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # SmiHandlerRegister
- gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 40c74dc5d8..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLibInternal.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLibInternal.h deleted file mode 100644 index 8eb30320ee..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePerformanceLib/SmmCorePerformanceLibInternal.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,236 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Master header files for SmmCorePerformanceLib instance.
-
- This header file holds the prototypes of the SMM Performance and PerformanceEx Protocol published by this
- library instance at its constructor.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _SMM_CORE_PERFORMANCE_LIB_INTERNAL_H_
-#define _SMM_CORE_PERFORMANCE_LIB_INTERNAL_H_
-
-
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-
-#include <Library/SmmServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/TimerLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/SynchronizationLib.h>
-#include <Library/SmmMemLib.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/SmmBase2.h>
-
-//
-// Interface declarations for SMM PerformanceEx Protocol.
-//
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- );
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGaugeEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- );
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGauge and EndGauge of PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntryEx stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntryEx The indirect pointer to the extended gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntryEx is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntryEx is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGaugeEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX **GaugeDataEntryEx
- );
-
-//
-// Interface declarations for SMM Performance Protocol.
-//
-/**
- Adds a record at the end of the performance measurement log
- that records the start time of a performance measurement.
-
- Adds a record to the end of the performance measurement log
- that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- The end time of the new record must be set to zero.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is used to fill in the start time in the record.
- If TimeStamp is zero, the start time in the record is filled in with the value
- read from the current time stamp.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The data was read correctly from the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- );
-
-/**
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first matching record that contains a zero end time and fills in a valid end time.
-
- Searches the performance measurement log from the beginning of the log
- for the first record that matches Handle, Token, and Module and has an end time value of zero.
- If the record can not be found then return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then the end time in the record is filled in with the value specified by TimeStamp.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then the end time in the matching record
- is filled in with the current time stamp value.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndGauge (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- );
-
-/**
- Retrieves a previously logged performance measurement.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartGaugeEx and EndGaugeEx of PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Retrieves the performance log entry from the performance log specified by LogEntryKey.
- If it stands for a valid entry, then EFI_SUCCESS is returned and
- GaugeDataEntry stores the pointer to that entry.
-
- @param LogEntryKey The key for the previous performance measurement log entry.
- If 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- @param GaugeDataEntry The indirect pointer to the gauge data entry specified by LogEntryKey
- if the retrieval is successful.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The GuageDataEntry is successfully found based on LogEntryKey.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER The LogEntryKey is not a valid entry (greater than the total entry number).
- @retval EFI_INVALIDE_PARAMETER GaugeDataEntry is NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-GetGauge (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **GaugeDataEntry
- );
-
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index ef38c8fdf5..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,52 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Null instance of SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.
-
- Copyright (c) 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLib.h>
-
-/**
- Performs platform specific tasks before invoking registered SMI handlers.
-
- This function performs platform specific tasks before invoking registered SMI handlers.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The platform hook completes successfully.
- @retval Other values The paltform hook cannot complete due to some error.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PlatformHookBeforeSmmDispatch (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Performs platform specific tasks after invoking registered SMI handlers.
-
- This function performs platform specific tasks after invoking registered SMI handlers.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The platform hook completes successfully.
- @retval Other values The paltform hook cannot complete due to some error.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-PlatformHookAfterSmmDispatch (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index ff7c1d26b3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,36 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# SMM Core Platform Hook Null Library instance
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2011 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.uni
- FILE_GUID = FED6583D-2418-4760-AC96-B5E18F0A6326
- MODULE_TYPE = SMM_CORE
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- PI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x0001000A
- LIBRARY_CLASS = SmmCorePlatformHookLib|SMM_CORE
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 40d79a3804..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull/SmmCorePlatformHookLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.c deleted file mode 100644 index 70d12a2138..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,82 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Implementation of Ipmi Library for SMM.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiSmm.h>
-#include <Protocol/IpmiProtocol.h>
-#include <Library/IpmiLib.h>
-#include <Library/SmmServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-IPMI_PROTOCOL *mIpmiProtocol = NULL;
-
-/**
- This service enables submitting commands via Ipmi.
-
- @param[in] NetFunction Net function of the command.
- @param[in] Command IPMI Command.
- @param[in] RequestData Command Request Data.
- @param[in] RequestDataSize Size of Command Request Data.
- @param[out] ResponseData Command Response Data. The completion code is the first byte of response data.
- @param[in, out] ResponseDataSize Size of Command Response Data.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The command byte stream was successfully submit to the device and a response was successfully received.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The command was not successfully sent to the device or a response was not successfully received from the device.
- @retval EFI_NOT_READY Ipmi Device is not ready for Ipmi command access.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR Ipmi Device hardware error.
- @retval EFI_TIMEOUT The command time out.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The command was not successfully sent to the device.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The resource allcation is out of resource or data size error.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-IpmiSubmitCommand (
- IN UINT8 NetFunction,
- IN UINT8 Command,
- IN UINT8 *RequestData,
- IN UINT32 RequestDataSize,
- OUT UINT8 *ResponseData,
- IN OUT UINT32 *ResponseDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (mIpmiProtocol == NULL) {
- Status = gSmst->SmmLocateProtocol (
- &gSmmIpmiProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **) &mIpmiProtocol
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Smm Ipmi Protocol is not installed. So, IPMI device is not present.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "IpmiSubmitCommand for SMM Status - %r\n", Status));
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- }
-
- Status = mIpmiProtocol->IpmiSubmitCommand (
- mIpmiProtocol,
- NetFunction,
- Command,
- RequestData,
- RequestDataSize,
- ResponseData,
- ResponseDataSize
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.inf deleted file mode 100644 index f13e5a433b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol/SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Instance of SMM IPMI Library.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php.
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol
- FILE_GUID = B422FB70-E835-448D-A921-EBA460E105B6
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = IpmiLib|DXE_SMM_DRIVER SMM_CORE
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmIpmiLibSmmIpmiProtocol.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- DebugLib
- SmmServicesTableLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gSmmIpmiProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 9659f014e9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,455 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
-Copyright (c) 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/LockBoxLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmCommunication.h>
-#include <Guid/SmmLockBox.h>
-
-#include "SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h"
-
-/**
- This function will save confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the confidential information
- @param Length the length of the confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0
- @retval RETURN_ALREADY_STARTED the requested GUID already exist.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES no enough resource to save the information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SaveLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *SmmCommunication;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_SAVE *LockBoxParameterSave;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINTN) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_SAVE)];
- UINTN CommSize;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib SaveLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) || (Buffer == NULL) || (Length == 0)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunication
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterSave);
-
- LockBoxParameterSave = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_SAVE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, Data)];
- LockBoxParameterSave->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_SAVE;
- LockBoxParameterSave->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterSave);
- LockBoxParameterSave->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
- CopyMem (&LockBoxParameterSave->Guid, Guid, sizeof(*Guid));
- LockBoxParameterSave->Buffer = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)Buffer;
- LockBoxParameterSave->Length = (UINT64)Length;
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunication->Communicate (
- SmmCommunication,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterSave->Header.ReturnStatus;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib SaveLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will set lockbox attributes.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Attributes the attributes of the lockbox
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER attributes is invalid.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetLockBoxAttributes (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINT64 Attributes
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *SmmCommunication;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_SET_ATTRIBUTES *LockBoxParameterSetAttributes;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINTN) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_SET_ATTRIBUTES)];
- UINTN CommSize;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib SetLockBoxAttributes - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) ||
- ((Attributes & ~LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE) != 0)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunication
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterSetAttributes);
-
- LockBoxParameterSetAttributes = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_SET_ATTRIBUTES *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, Data)];
- LockBoxParameterSetAttributes->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_SET_ATTRIBUTES;
- LockBoxParameterSetAttributes->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterSetAttributes);
- LockBoxParameterSetAttributes->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
- CopyMem (&LockBoxParameterSetAttributes->Guid, Guid, sizeof(*Guid));
- LockBoxParameterSetAttributes->Attributes = (UINT64)Attributes;
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunication->Communicate (
- SmmCommunication,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterSetAttributes->Header.ReturnStatus;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib SetLockBoxAttributes - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will update confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the original confidential information
- @param Offset the offset of the original confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the updated confidential information
- @param Length the length of the updated confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the original buffer to too small to hold new information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UpdateLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINTN Offset,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *SmmCommunication;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_UPDATE *LockBoxParameterUpdate;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINTN) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_UPDATE)];
- UINTN CommSize;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib UpdateLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) || (Buffer == NULL) || (Length == 0)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunication
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterUpdate);
-
- LockBoxParameterUpdate = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_UPDATE *)(UINTN)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, Data)];
- LockBoxParameterUpdate->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_UPDATE;
- LockBoxParameterUpdate->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterUpdate);
- LockBoxParameterUpdate->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
- CopyMem (&LockBoxParameterUpdate->Guid, Guid, sizeof(*Guid));
- LockBoxParameterUpdate->Offset = (UINT64)Offset;
- LockBoxParameterUpdate->Buffer = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)Buffer;
- LockBoxParameterUpdate->Length = (UINT64)Length;
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunication->Communicate (
- SmmCommunication,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterUpdate->Header.ReturnStatus;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib UpdateLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the restored confidential information
- NULL means restored to original address, Length MUST be NULL at same time.
- @param Length the length of the restored confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or one of Buffer and Length is NULL.
- @retval RETURN_WRITE_PROTECTED Buffer and Length are NULL, but the LockBox has no
- LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE attribute.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the Length is too small to hold the confidential information.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED not allow to restore to the address
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer, OPTIONAL
- IN OUT UINTN *Length OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *SmmCommunication;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE *LockBoxParameterRestore;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINTN) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE)];
- UINTN CommSize;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib RestoreLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) ||
- ((Buffer == NULL) && (Length != NULL)) ||
- ((Buffer != NULL) && (Length == NULL))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunication
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestore);
-
- LockBoxParameterRestore = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, Data)];
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_RESTORE;
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestore);
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
- CopyMem (&LockBoxParameterRestore->Guid, Guid, sizeof(*Guid));
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Buffer = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)Buffer;
- if (Length != NULL) {
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Length = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)*Length;
- } else {
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Length = 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunication->Communicate (
- SmmCommunication,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- if (Length != NULL) {
- *Length = (UINTN)LockBoxParameterRestore->Length;
- }
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.ReturnStatus;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from all lockbox which have RestoreInPlace attribute.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PROTOCOL *SmmCommunication;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE *LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINTN) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE)];
- UINTN CommSize;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
- &gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunication
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace);
-
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, Data)];
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE;
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace);
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunication->Communicate (
- SmmCommunication,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.ReturnStatus;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxDxeLib RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 48cdb9c66a..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,50 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# DXE LockBox library instance.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmLockBoxDxeLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmLockBoxDxeLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 4A0054B4-3CA8-4e1b-9339-9B58D5FBB7D2
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = LockBoxLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER UEFI_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmLockBoxDxeLib.c
- SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DebugLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID # Used to do smm communication
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSmmCommunicationProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 78aa7db639..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxDxeLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h deleted file mode 100644 index 31da89af0f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,54 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
-Copyright (c) 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _SMM_LOCK_BOX_LIB_PRIVATE_H_
-#define _SMM_LOCK_BOX_LIB_PRIVATE_H_
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#pragma pack(1)
-
-//
-// Below data structure is used for lockbox registration in SMST
-//
-
-#define SMM_LOCK_BOX_SIGNATURE_32 SIGNATURE_64 ('L','O','C','K','B','_','3','2')
-#define SMM_LOCK_BOX_SIGNATURE_64 SIGNATURE_64 ('L','O','C','K','B','_','6','4')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT64 Signature;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS LockBoxDataAddress;
-} SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT;
-
-//
-// Below data structure is used for lockbox management
-//
-
-#define SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_64 ('L','O','C','K','B','O','X','D')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT64 Signature;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Buffer;
- UINT64 Length;
- UINT64 Attributes;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS SmramBuffer;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
-} SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA;
-
-#pragma pack()
-
-#endif
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index bd3204b195..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,741 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
-Copyright (c) 2010 - 2011, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiPei.h>
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-#include <PiSmm.h>
-#include <Library/PeiServicesTablePointerLib.h>
-#include <Library/PeiServicesLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/LockBoxLib.h>
-#include <Library/HobLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmCommunication.h>
-#include <Ppi/SmmCommunication.h>
-#include <Ppi/SmmAccess.h>
-#include <Guid/AcpiS3Context.h>
-#include <Guid/SmmLockBox.h>
-
-#include "SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h"
-
-#if defined (MDE_CPU_IA32)
-typedef struct _LIST_ENTRY64 LIST_ENTRY64;
-struct _LIST_ENTRY64 {
- LIST_ENTRY64 *ForwardLink;
- UINT32 Reserved1;
- LIST_ENTRY64 *BackLink;
- UINT32 Reserved2;
-};
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_TABLE_HEADER Hdr;
- UINT64 SmmFirmwareVendor;
- UINT64 SmmFirmwareRevision;
- UINT64 SmmInstallConfigurationTable;
- UINT64 SmmIoMemRead;
- UINT64 SmmIoMemWrite;
- UINT64 SmmIoIoRead;
- UINT64 SmmIoIoWrite;
- UINT64 SmmAllocatePool;
- UINT64 SmmFreePool;
- UINT64 SmmAllocatePages;
- UINT64 SmmFreePages;
- UINT64 SmmStartupThisAp;
- UINT64 CurrentlyExecutingCpu;
- UINT64 NumberOfCpus;
- UINT64 CpuSaveStateSize;
- UINT64 CpuSaveState;
- UINT64 NumberOfTableEntries;
- UINT64 SmmConfigurationTable;
-} EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2_64;
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_GUID VendorGuid;
- UINT64 VendorTable;
-} EFI_CONFIGURATION_TABLE64;
-#endif
-
-#if defined (MDE_CPU_X64)
-typedef LIST_ENTRY LIST_ENTRY64;
-typedef EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2_64;
-typedef EFI_CONFIGURATION_TABLE EFI_CONFIGURATION_TABLE64;
-#endif
-
-/**
- This function return first node of LinkList queue.
-
- @param LockBoxQueue LinkList queue
-
- @return first node of LinkList queue
-**/
-LIST_ENTRY *
-InternalInitLinkDxe (
- IN LIST_ENTRY *LinkList
- )
-{
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode)) ) {
- //
- // 32 PEI + 64 DXE
- //
- return (LIST_ENTRY *)(((LIST_ENTRY64 *)LinkList)->ForwardLink);
- } else {
- return LinkList->ForwardLink;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- This function return next node of LinkList.
-
- @param Link LinkList node
-
- @return next node of LinkList
-**/
-LIST_ENTRY *
-InternalNextLinkDxe (
- IN LIST_ENTRY *Link
- )
-{
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode)) ) {
- //
- // 32 PEI + 64 DXE
- //
- return (LIST_ENTRY *)(((LIST_ENTRY64 *)Link)->ForwardLink);
- } else {
- return Link->ForwardLink;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- This function find LockBox by GUID from SMRAM.
-
- @param LockBoxQueue The LockBox queue in SMRAM
- @param Guid The guid to indentify the LockBox
-
- @return LockBoxData
-**/
-SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *
-InternalFindLockBoxByGuidFromSmram (
- IN LIST_ENTRY *LockBoxQueue,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
-
- for (Link = InternalInitLinkDxe (LockBoxQueue);
- Link != LockBoxQueue;
- Link = InternalNextLinkDxe (Link)) {
- LockBox = BASE_CR (
- Link,
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA,
- Link
- );
- if (CompareGuid (&LockBox->Guid, Guid)) {
- return LockBox;
- }
- }
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Get VendorTable by VendorGuid in Smst.
-
- @param Signature Signature of SMM_S3_RESUME_STATE
- @param Smst SMM system table
- @param VendorGuid vendor guid
-
- @return vendor table.
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalSmstGetVendorTableByGuid (
- IN UINT64 Signature,
- IN EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 *Smst,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid
- )
-{
- EFI_CONFIGURATION_TABLE *SmmConfigurationTable;
- UINTN NumberOfTableEntries;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2_64 *Smst64;
- EFI_CONFIGURATION_TABLE64 *SmmConfigurationTable64;
-
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode))) {
- //
- // 32 PEI + 64 DXE
- //
- Smst64 = (EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2_64 *)Smst;
- SmmConfigurationTable64 = (EFI_CONFIGURATION_TABLE64 *)(UINTN)Smst64->SmmConfigurationTable;
- NumberOfTableEntries = (UINTN)Smst64->NumberOfTableEntries;
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfTableEntries; Index++) {
- if (CompareGuid (&SmmConfigurationTable64[Index].VendorGuid, VendorGuid)) {
- return (VOID *)(UINTN)SmmConfigurationTable64[Index].VendorTable;
- }
- }
- return NULL;
- } else {
- SmmConfigurationTable = Smst->SmmConfigurationTable;
- NumberOfTableEntries = Smst->NumberOfTableEntries;
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfTableEntries; Index++) {
- if (CompareGuid (&SmmConfigurationTable[Index].VendorGuid, VendorGuid)) {
- return (VOID *)SmmConfigurationTable[Index].VendorTable;
- }
- }
- return NULL;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Get SMM LockBox context.
-
- @return SMM LockBox context.
-**/
-SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *
-InternalGetSmmLockBoxContext (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR *SmramDescriptor;
- SMM_S3_RESUME_STATE *SmmS3ResumeState;
- VOID *GuidHob;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *SmmLockBoxContext;
-
- GuidHob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gEfiAcpiVariableGuid);
- ASSERT (GuidHob != NULL);
- SmramDescriptor = (EFI_SMRAM_DESCRIPTOR *) GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (GuidHob);
- SmmS3ResumeState = (SMM_S3_RESUME_STATE *)(UINTN)SmramDescriptor->CpuStart;
-
- SmmLockBoxContext = (SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *)InternalSmstGetVendorTableByGuid (
- SmmS3ResumeState->Signature,
- (EFI_SMM_SYSTEM_TABLE2 *)(UINTN)SmmS3ResumeState->Smst,
- &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid
- );
- ASSERT (SmmLockBoxContext != NULL);
-
- return SmmLockBoxContext;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from lockbox in SMRAM directly.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the restored confidential information
- NULL means restored to original address, Length MUST be NULL at same time.
- @param Length the length of the restored confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_WRITE_PROTECTED Buffer and Length are NULL, but the LockBox has no
- LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE attribute.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the Length is too small to hold the confidential information.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalRestoreLockBoxFromSmram (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer, OPTIONAL
- IN OUT UINTN *Length OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- PEI_SMM_ACCESS_PPI *SmmAccess;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *SmmLockBoxContext;
- LIST_ENTRY *LockBoxQueue;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
- VOID *RestoreBuffer;
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = PeiServicesLocatePpi (
- &gPeiSmmAccessPpiGuid,
- 0,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmAccess
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- for (Index = 0; !EFI_ERROR (Status); Index++) {
- Status = SmmAccess->Open ((EFI_PEI_SERVICES **)GetPeiServicesTablePointer (), SmmAccess, Index);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Get LockBox context
- //
- SmmLockBoxContext = InternalGetSmmLockBoxContext ();
- LockBoxQueue = (LIST_ENTRY *)(UINTN)SmmLockBoxContext->LockBoxDataAddress;
-
- //
- // We do NOT check Buffer address in SMRAM, because if SMRAM not locked, we trust the caller.
- //
-
- //
- // Restore this, Buffer and Length MUST be both NULL or both non-NULL
- //
-
- //
- // Find LockBox
- //
- LockBox = InternalFindLockBoxByGuidFromSmram (LockBoxQueue, Guid);
- if (LockBox == NULL) {
- //
- // Not found
- //
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // Set RestoreBuffer
- //
- if (Buffer != NULL) {
- //
- // restore to new buffer
- //
- RestoreBuffer = Buffer;
- } else {
- //
- // restore to original buffer
- //
- if ((LockBox->Attributes & LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE) == 0) {
- return EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED;
- }
- RestoreBuffer = (VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->Buffer;
- }
-
- //
- // Set RestoreLength
- //
- if (Length != NULL) {
- if (*Length < (UINTN)LockBox->Length) {
- //
- // Input buffer is too small to hold all data.
- //
- *Length = (UINTN)LockBox->Length;
- return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
- }
- *Length = (UINTN)LockBox->Length;
- }
-
- //
- // Restore data
- //
- CopyMem (RestoreBuffer, (VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->SmramBuffer, (UINTN)LockBox->Length);
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from all lockbox which have RestoreInPlace attribute.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalRestoreAllLockBoxInPlaceFromSmram (
- VOID
- )
-{
- PEI_SMM_ACCESS_PPI *SmmAccess;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *SmmLockBoxContext;
- LIST_ENTRY *LockBoxQueue;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = PeiServicesLocatePpi (
- &gPeiSmmAccessPpiGuid,
- 0,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmAccess
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- for (Index = 0; !EFI_ERROR (Status); Index++) {
- Status = SmmAccess->Open ((EFI_PEI_SERVICES **)GetPeiServicesTablePointer (), SmmAccess, Index);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Get LockBox context
- //
- SmmLockBoxContext = InternalGetSmmLockBoxContext ();
- LockBoxQueue = (LIST_ENTRY *)(UINTN)SmmLockBoxContext->LockBoxDataAddress;
-
- //
- // We do NOT check Buffer address in SMRAM, because if SMRAM not locked, we trust the caller.
- //
-
- //
- // Restore all, Buffer and Length MUST be NULL
- //
- for (Link = InternalInitLinkDxe (LockBoxQueue);
- Link != LockBoxQueue;
- Link = InternalNextLinkDxe (Link)) {
- LockBox = BASE_CR (
- Link,
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA,
- Link
- );
- if ((LockBox->Attributes & LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE) != 0) {
- //
- // Restore data
- //
- CopyMem ((VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->Buffer, (VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->SmramBuffer, (UINTN)LockBox->Length);
- }
- }
- //
- // Done
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will save confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the confidential information
- @param Length the length of the confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0
- @retval RETURN_ALREADY_STARTED the requested GUID already exist.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES no enough resource to save the information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SaveLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-
- //
- // No support to save at PEI phase
- //
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will set lockbox attributes.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Attributes the attributes of the lockbox
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER attributes is invalid.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetLockBoxAttributes (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINT64 Attributes
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-
- //
- // No support to save at PEI phase
- //
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will update confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the original confidential information
- @param Offset the offset of the original confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the updated confidential information
- @param Length the length of the updated confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the original buffer to too small to hold new information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UpdateLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINTN Offset,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- ASSERT (FALSE);
-
- //
- // No support to update at PEI phase
- //
- return RETURN_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the restored confidential information
- NULL means restored to original address, Length MUST be NULL at same time.
- @param Length the length of the restored confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or one of Buffer and Length is NULL.
- @retval RETURN_WRITE_PROTECTED Buffer and Length are NULL, but the LockBox has no
- LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE attribute.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the Length is too small to hold the confidential information.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED not allow to restore to the address
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer, OPTIONAL
- IN OUT UINTN *Length OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PEI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PPI *SmmCommunicationPpi;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE *LockBoxParameterRestore;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINT64) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE)];
- UINTN CommSize;
- UINT64 MessageLength;
-
- //
- // Please aware that there is UINTN in EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER. It might be UINT64 in DXE, while it is UINT32 in PEI.
- // typedef struct {
- // EFI_GUID HeaderGuid;
- // UINTN MessageLength;
- // UINT8 Data[1];
- // } EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER;
- //
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib RestoreLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) ||
- ((Buffer == NULL) && (Length != NULL)) ||
- ((Buffer != NULL) && (Length == NULL))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = PeiServicesLocatePpi (
- &gEfiPeiSmmCommunicationPpiGuid,
- 0,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunicationPpi
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode)) ) {
- MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestore);
- CopyMem (&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, MessageLength)], &MessageLength, sizeof(MessageLength));
- } else {
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestore);
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib CommBuffer - %x\n", &CommBuffer[0]));
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode)) ) {
- LockBoxParameterRestore = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, MessageLength) + sizeof(UINT64)];
- } else {
- LockBoxParameterRestore = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, MessageLength) + sizeof(UINTN)];
- }
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib LockBoxParameterRestore - %x\n", LockBoxParameterRestore));
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_RESTORE;
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestore);
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
- if (Guid != 0) {
- CopyMem (&LockBoxParameterRestore->Guid, Guid, sizeof(*Guid));
- } else {
- ZeroMem (&LockBoxParameterRestore->Guid, sizeof(*Guid));
- }
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Buffer = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)Buffer;
- if (Length != NULL) {
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Length = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)*Length;
- } else {
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Length = 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunicationPpi->Communicate (
- SmmCommunicationPpi,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_STARTED) {
- //
- // Pei SMM communication not ready yet, so we access SMRAM directly
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib Communicate - (%r)\n", Status));
- Status = InternalRestoreLockBoxFromSmram (Guid, Buffer, Length);
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)Status;
- if (Length != NULL) {
- LockBoxParameterRestore->Length = (UINT64)*Length;
- }
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- if (Length != NULL) {
- *Length = (UINTN)LockBoxParameterRestore->Length;
- }
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterRestore->Header.ReturnStatus;
- if (Status != EFI_SUCCESS) {
- // Need or MAX_BIT, because there might be case that SMM is X64 while PEI is IA32.
- Status |= MAX_BIT;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from all lockbox which have RestoreInPlace attribute.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_PEI_SMM_COMMUNICATION_PPI *SmmCommunicationPpi;
- EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE *LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace;
- EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *CommHeader;
- UINT8 CommBuffer[sizeof(EFI_GUID) + sizeof(UINT64) + sizeof(EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE)];
- UINTN CommSize;
- UINT64 MessageLength;
-
- //
- // Please aware that there is UINTN in EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER. It might be UINT64 in DXE, while it is UINT32 in PEI.
- // typedef struct {
- // EFI_GUID HeaderGuid;
- // UINTN MessageLength;
- // UINT8 Data[1];
- // } EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER;
- //
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Get needed resource
- //
- Status = PeiServicesLocatePpi (
- &gEfiPeiSmmCommunicationPpiGuid,
- 0,
- NULL,
- (VOID **)&SmmCommunicationPpi
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return EFI_NOT_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Prepare parameter
- //
- CommHeader = (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER *)&CommBuffer[0];
- CopyMem (&CommHeader->HeaderGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid, sizeof(gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid));
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode)) ) {
- MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace);
- CopyMem (&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, MessageLength)], &MessageLength, sizeof(MessageLength));
- } else {
- CommHeader->MessageLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace);
- }
-
- if ((sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT32)) && (FeaturePcdGet (PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode)) ) {
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, MessageLength) + sizeof(UINT64)];
- } else {
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace = (EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_PARAMETER_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE *)&CommBuffer[OFFSET_OF (EFI_SMM_COMMUNICATE_HEADER, MessageLength) + sizeof(UINTN)];
- }
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.Command = EFI_SMM_LOCK_BOX_COMMAND_RESTORE_ALL_IN_PLACE;
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.DataLength = sizeof(*LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace);
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)-1;
-
- //
- // Send command
- //
- CommSize = sizeof(CommBuffer);
- Status = SmmCommunicationPpi->Communicate (
- SmmCommunicationPpi,
- &CommBuffer[0],
- &CommSize
- );
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_STARTED) {
- //
- // Pei SMM communication not ready yet, so we access SMRAM directly
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib Communicate - (%r)\n", Status));
- Status = InternalRestoreAllLockBoxInPlaceFromSmram ();
- LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.ReturnStatus = (UINT64)Status;
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Status = (EFI_STATUS)LockBoxParameterRestoreAllInPlace->Header.ReturnStatus;
- if (Status != EFI_SUCCESS) {
- // Need or MAX_BIT, because there might be case that SMM is X64 while PEI is IA32.
- Status |= MAX_BIT;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxPeiLib RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace - Exit (%r)\n", Status));
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- return Status;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index dceff8f0f6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# PEI LockBox library instance.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmLockBoxPeiLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmLockBoxPeiLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 5F5E6140-E7BA-4bd6-B85F-236B5BCD8E1E
- MODULE_TYPE = PEIM
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = LockBoxLib|PEIM
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmLockBoxPeiLib.c
- SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PeiServicesTablePointerLib
- PeiServicesLib
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- HobLib
- DebugLib
-
-[FeaturePcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdDxeIplSwitchToLongMode ## CONSUMES
-
-[Guids]
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Used to do smm communication
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # SmmSystemTable
- gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid
- gEfiAcpiVariableGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## HOB
-
-[Ppis]
- gEfiPeiSmmCommunicationPpiGuid ## CONSUMES
- gPeiSmmAccessPpiGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index d4302d2543..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxPeiLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 4960df7555..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,591 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
-
-Copyright (c) 2010 - 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <PiSmm.h>
-#include <Library/SmmServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/LockBoxLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Guid/SmmLockBox.h>
-
-#include "SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h"
-
-/**
- We need handle this library carefully. Only one library instance will construct the environment.
- Below 2 global variable can only be used in constructor. They should NOT be used in any other library functions.
-**/
-SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT mSmmLockBoxContext;
-LIST_ENTRY mLockBoxQueue = INITIALIZE_LIST_HEAD_VARIABLE (mLockBoxQueue);
-
-BOOLEAN mSmmConfigurationTableInstalled = FALSE;
-
-/**
- This function return SmmLockBox context from SMST.
-
- @return SmmLockBox context from SMST.
-**/
-SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *
-InternalGetSmmLockBoxContext (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // Check if gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid is installed by someone
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < gSmst->NumberOfTableEntries; Index++) {
- if (CompareGuid (&gSmst->SmmConfigurationTable[Index].VendorGuid, &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid)) {
- //
- // Found. That means some other library instance is already run.
- // No need to install again, just return.
- //
- return (SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *)gSmst->SmmConfigurationTable[Index].VendorTable;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Not found.
- //
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Constructor for SmmLockBox library.
- This is used to set SmmLockBox context, which will be used in PEI phase in S3 boot path later.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle Image handle of this driver.
- @param[in] SystemTable A Pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCEESS
- @return Others Some error occurs.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmLockBoxSmmConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *SmmLockBoxContext;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SmmLockBoxSmmConstructor - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Check if gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid is installed by someone
- //
- SmmLockBoxContext = InternalGetSmmLockBoxContext ();
- if (SmmLockBoxContext != NULL) {
- //
- // Find it. That means some other library instance is already run.
- // No need to install again, just return.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SmmLockBoxContext - already installed\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SmmLockBoxSmmConstructor - Exit\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // If no one install this, it means this is first instance. Install it.
- //
- if (sizeof(UINTN) == sizeof(UINT64)) {
- mSmmLockBoxContext.Signature = SMM_LOCK_BOX_SIGNATURE_64;
- } else {
- mSmmLockBoxContext.Signature = SMM_LOCK_BOX_SIGNATURE_32;
- }
- mSmmLockBoxContext.LockBoxDataAddress = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)&mLockBoxQueue;
-
- Status = gSmst->SmmInstallConfigurationTable (
- gSmst,
- &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid,
- &mSmmLockBoxContext,
- sizeof(mSmmLockBoxContext)
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- mSmmConfigurationTableInstalled = TRUE;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SmmLockBoxContext - %x\n", (UINTN)&mSmmLockBoxContext));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib LockBoxDataAddress - %x\n", (UINTN)&mLockBoxQueue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SmmLockBoxSmmConstructor - Exit\n"));
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Destructor for SmmLockBox library.
- This is used to uninstall SmmLockBoxCommunication configuration table
- if it has been installed in Constructor.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle Image handle of this driver.
- @param[in] SystemTable A Pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCEESS The destructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmLockBoxSmmDestructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SmmLockBoxSmmDestructor in %a module\n", gEfiCallerBaseName));
-
- if (mSmmConfigurationTableInstalled) {
- Status = gSmst->SmmInstallConfigurationTable (
- gSmst,
- &gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid,
- NULL,
- 0
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib uninstall SmmLockBoxCommunication configuration table\n"));
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function return SmmLockBox queue address.
-
- @return SmmLockBox queue address.
-**/
-LIST_ENTRY *
-InternalGetLockBoxQueue (
- VOID
- )
-{
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_CONTEXT *SmmLockBoxContext;
-
- SmmLockBoxContext = InternalGetSmmLockBoxContext ();
- ASSERT (SmmLockBoxContext != NULL);
- if (SmmLockBoxContext == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
- return (LIST_ENTRY *)(UINTN)SmmLockBoxContext->LockBoxDataAddress;
-}
-
-/**
- This function find LockBox by GUID.
-
- @param Guid The guid to indentify the LockBox
-
- @return LockBoxData
-**/
-SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *
-InternalFindLockBoxByGuid (
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
- LIST_ENTRY *LockBoxQueue;
-
- LockBoxQueue = InternalGetLockBoxQueue ();
- ASSERT (LockBoxQueue != NULL);
-
- for (Link = LockBoxQueue->ForwardLink;
- Link != LockBoxQueue;
- Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- LockBox = BASE_CR (
- Link,
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA,
- Link
- );
- if (CompareGuid (&LockBox->Guid, Guid)) {
- return LockBox;
- }
- }
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will save confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the confidential information
- @param Length the length of the confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0
- @retval RETURN_ALREADY_STARTED the requested GUID already exist.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES no enough resource to save the information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SaveLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS SmramBuffer;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- LIST_ENTRY *LockBoxQueue;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SaveLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) || (Buffer == NULL) || (Length == 0)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SaveLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Find LockBox
- //
- LockBox = InternalFindLockBoxByGuid (Guid);
- if (LockBox != NULL) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SaveLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_ALREADY_STARTED));
- return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate SMRAM buffer
- //
- Status = gSmst->SmmAllocatePages (
- AllocateAnyPages,
- EfiRuntimeServicesData,
- EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Length),
- &SmramBuffer
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SaveLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES));
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate LockBox
- //
- Status = gSmst->SmmAllocatePool (
- EfiRuntimeServicesData,
- sizeof(*LockBox),
- (VOID **)&LockBox
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- gSmst->SmmFreePages (SmramBuffer, EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SaveLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES));
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Save data
- //
- CopyMem ((VOID *)(UINTN)SmramBuffer, (VOID *)(UINTN)Buffer, Length);
-
- //
- // Insert LockBox to queue
- //
- LockBox->Signature = SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA_SIGNATURE;
- CopyMem (&LockBox->Guid, Guid, sizeof(EFI_GUID));
- LockBox->Buffer = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS)(UINTN)Buffer;
- LockBox->Length = (UINT64)Length;
- LockBox->Attributes = 0;
- LockBox->SmramBuffer = SmramBuffer;
-
- DEBUG ((
- EFI_D_INFO,
- "LockBoxGuid - %g, SmramBuffer - 0x%lx, Length - 0x%lx\n",
- &LockBox->Guid,
- LockBox->SmramBuffer,
- LockBox->Length
- ));
-
- LockBoxQueue = InternalGetLockBoxQueue ();
- ASSERT (LockBoxQueue != NULL);
- InsertTailList (LockBoxQueue, &LockBox->Link);
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SaveLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_SUCCESS));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will set lockbox attributes.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Attributes the attributes of the lockbox
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER attributes is invalid.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetLockBoxAttributes (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINT64 Attributes
- )
-{
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SetLockBoxAttributes - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) ||
- ((Attributes & ~LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE) != 0)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SetLockBoxAttributes - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Find LockBox
- //
- LockBox = InternalFindLockBoxByGuid (Guid);
- if (LockBox == NULL) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SetLockBoxAttributes - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_NOT_FOUND));
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // Update data
- //
- LockBox->Attributes = Attributes;
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib SetLockBoxAttributes - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_SUCCESS));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will update confidential information to lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the original confidential information
- @param Offset the offset of the original confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the updated confidential information
- @param Length the length of the updated confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is saved successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or Buffer is NULL, or Length is 0.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the original buffer to too small to hold new information.
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED it is too late to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UpdateLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN UINTN Offset,
- IN VOID *Buffer,
- IN UINTN Length
- )
-{
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib UpdateLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Basic check
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) || (Buffer == NULL) || (Length == 0)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib UpdateLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Find LockBox
- //
- LockBox = InternalFindLockBoxByGuid (Guid);
- if (LockBox == NULL) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib UpdateLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_NOT_FOUND));
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // Update data
- //
- if (LockBox->Length < Offset + Length) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib UpdateLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL));
- return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
- }
- ASSERT ((UINTN)LockBox->SmramBuffer <= (MAX_ADDRESS - Offset));
- CopyMem ((VOID *)((UINTN)LockBox->SmramBuffer + Offset), Buffer, Length);
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib UpdateLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_SUCCESS));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from lockbox.
-
- @param Guid the guid to identify the confidential information
- @param Buffer the address of the restored confidential information
- NULL means restored to original address, Length MUST be NULL at same time.
- @param Length the length of the restored confidential information
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_INVALID_PARAMETER the Guid is NULL, or one of Buffer and Length is NULL.
- @retval RETURN_WRITE_PROTECTED Buffer and Length are NULL, but the LockBox has no
- LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE attribute.
- @retval RETURN_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL the Length is too small to hold the confidential information.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND the requested GUID not found.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_ACCESS_DENIED not allow to restore to the address
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreLockBox (
- IN GUID *Guid,
- IN VOID *Buffer, OPTIONAL
- IN OUT UINTN *Length OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
- VOID *RestoreBuffer;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreLockBox - Enter\n"));
-
- //
- // Restore this, Buffer and Length MUST be both NULL or both non-NULL
- //
- if ((Guid == NULL) ||
- ((Buffer == NULL) && (Length != NULL)) ||
- ((Buffer != NULL) && (Length == NULL))) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Find LockBox
- //
- LockBox = InternalFindLockBoxByGuid (Guid);
- if (LockBox == NULL) {
- //
- // Not found
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_NOT_FOUND));
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // Set RestoreBuffer
- //
- if (Buffer != NULL) {
- //
- // restore to new buffer
- //
- RestoreBuffer = Buffer;
- } else {
- //
- // restore to original buffer
- //
- if ((LockBox->Attributes & LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE) == 0) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED));
- return EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED;
- }
- RestoreBuffer = (VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->Buffer;
- }
-
- //
- // Set RestoreLength
- //
- if (Length != NULL) {
- if (*Length < (UINTN)LockBox->Length) {
- //
- // Input buffer is too small to hold all data.
- //
- *Length = (UINTN)LockBox->Length;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL));
- return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
- }
- *Length = (UINTN)LockBox->Length;
- }
-
- //
- // Restore data
- //
- CopyMem (RestoreBuffer, (VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->SmramBuffer, (UINTN)LockBox->Length);
-
- //
- // Done
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreLockBox - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_SUCCESS));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will restore confidential information from all lockbox which have RestoreInPlace attribute.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS the information is restored successfully.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_STARTED it is too early to invoke this interface
- @retval RETURN_UNSUPPORTED the service is not supported by implementaion.
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace (
- VOID
- )
-{
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA *LockBox;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- LIST_ENTRY *LockBoxQueue;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace - Enter\n"));
-
- LockBoxQueue = InternalGetLockBoxQueue ();
- ASSERT (LockBoxQueue != NULL);
-
- //
- // Restore all, Buffer and Length MUST be NULL
- //
- for (Link = LockBoxQueue->ForwardLink;
- Link != LockBoxQueue;
- Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- LockBox = BASE_CR (
- Link,
- SMM_LOCK_BOX_DATA,
- Link
- );
- if ((LockBox->Attributes & LOCK_BOX_ATTRIBUTE_RESTORE_IN_PLACE) != 0) {
- //
- // Restore data
- //
- CopyMem ((VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->Buffer, (VOID *)(UINTN)LockBox->SmramBuffer, (UINTN)LockBox->Length);
- }
- }
- //
- // Done
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "SmmLockBoxSmmLib RestoreAllLockBoxInPlace - Exit (%r)\n", EFI_SUCCESS));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index eb7ba0bb2e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,50 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# SMM LockBox library instance.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2010 - 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmLockBoxSmmLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmLockBoxSmmLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = E04894D6-290D-4171-A362-0ACFD939F3C8
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = LockBoxLib|DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = SmmLockBoxSmmConstructor
- DESTRUCTOR = SmmLockBoxSmmDestructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmLockBoxSmmLib.c
- SmmLockBoxLibPrivate.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- SmmServicesTableLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
-
-[Guids]
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # SmmSystemTable
- ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## UNDEFINED # SmmSystemTable
- gEfiSmmLockBoxCommunicationGuid
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index a3fef6620b..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmLockBoxLib/SmmLockBoxSmmLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index c01d16d1eb..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,451 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Performance Library used in SMM phase.
-
- This library instance provides infrastructure for SMM drivers to log performance
- data. It consumes SMM PerformanceEx or Performance Protocol published by SmmCorePerformanceLib
- to log performance data. If both SMM PerformanceEx and Performance Protocol are not available, it does not log any
- performance information.
-
- Copyright (c) 2011 - 2012, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/SmmServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-
-//
-// The cached SMM Performance Protocol and SMM PerformanceEx Protocol interface.
-//
-PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL *mPerformance = NULL;
-PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL *mPerformanceEx = NULL;
-BOOLEAN mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled;
-
-/**
- The constructor function initializes the Performance Measurement Enable flag
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SmmPerformanceLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
-
- mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled = (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8(PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask) & PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED) != 0);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- The function caches the pointers to SMM PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol.
-
- The function locates SMM PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol from protocol database.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS SMM PerformanceEx protocol or Performance Protocol is successfully located.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Both SMM PerformanceEx protocol and Performance Protocol are not located to log performance.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetPerformanceProtocol (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- PERFORMANCE_PROTOCOL *Performance;
- PERFORMANCE_EX_PROTOCOL *PerformanceEx;
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL || mPerformance != NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gSmst->SmmLocateProtocol (&gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &PerformanceEx);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (PerformanceEx != NULL);
- //
- // Cache PerformanceEx Protocol.
- //
- mPerformanceEx = PerformanceEx;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = gSmst->SmmLocateProtocol (&gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &Performance);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (Performance != NULL);
- //
- // Cache performance protocol.
- //
- mPerformance = Performance;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the created record
- is same as the one created by StartPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->StartGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->StartGauge (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- return (RETURN_STATUS) Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, Module and Identifier.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
- @param Identifier 32-bit identifier. If the value is 0, the found record
- is same as the one found by EndPerformanceMeasurement.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp,
- IN UINT32 Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return RETURN_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->EndGaugeEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, Identifier);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->EndGauge (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- }
-
- return (RETURN_STATUS) Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurement and EndPerformanceMeasurement,
- and then assign the Identifier with 0.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp and Identifier.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Identifier is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
- @param Identifier Pointer to the 32-bit identifier that was recorded.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT32 *Identifier
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY_EX *GaugeData;
-
- GaugeData = NULL;
-
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
- ASSERT (Token != NULL);
- ASSERT (Module != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (EndTimeStamp != NULL);
- ASSERT (Identifier != NULL);
-
- Status = GetPerformanceProtocol ();
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformanceEx->GetGaugeEx (LogEntryKey++, &GaugeData);
- } else if (mPerformance != NULL) {
- Status = mPerformance->GetGauge (LogEntryKey++, (GAUGE_DATA_ENTRY **) &GaugeData);
- } else {
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Make sure that LogEntryKey is a valid log entry key,
- //
- ASSERT (Status != EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // The LogEntryKey is the last entry (equals to the total entry number).
- //
- return 0;
- }
-
- ASSERT (GaugeData != NULL);
-
- *Handle = (VOID *) (UINTN) GaugeData->Handle;
- *Token = GaugeData->Token;
- *Module = GaugeData->Module;
- *StartTimeStamp = GaugeData->StartTimeStamp;
- *EndTimeStamp = GaugeData->EndTimeStamp;
- if (mPerformanceEx != NULL) {
- *Identifier = GaugeData->Identifier;
- } else {
- *Identifier = 0;
- }
-
- return LogEntryKey;
-}
-
-/**
- Creates a record for the beginning of a performance measurement.
-
- Creates a record that contains the Handle, Token, and Module.
- If TimeStamp is not zero, then TimeStamp is added to the record as the start time.
- If TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads the current time stamp
- and adds that time stamp value to the record as the start time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The start of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There are not enough resources to record the measurement.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-StartPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return StartPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Fills in the end time of a performance measurement.
-
- Looks up the record that matches Handle, Token, and Module.
- If the record can not be found then return RETURN_NOT_FOUND.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is not zero,
- then TimeStamp is added to the record as the end time.
- If the record is found and TimeStamp is zero, then this function reads
- the current time stamp and adds that time stamp value to the record as the end time.
-
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used
- to identify the component being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the component being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string
- that identifies the module being measured.
- @param TimeStamp 64-bit time stamp.
-
- @retval RETURN_SUCCESS The end of the measurement was recorded.
- @retval RETURN_NOT_FOUND The specified measurement record could not be found.
-
-**/
-RETURN_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EndPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN CONST VOID *Handle, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Token, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Module, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT64 TimeStamp
- )
-{
- return EndPerformanceMeasurementEx (Handle, Token, Module, TimeStamp, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Attempts to retrieve a performance measurement log entry from the performance measurement log.
- It can also retrieve the log created by StartPerformanceMeasurementEx and EndPerformanceMeasurementEx,
- and then eliminate the Identifier.
-
- Attempts to retrieve the performance log entry specified by LogEntryKey. If LogEntryKey is
- zero on entry, then an attempt is made to retrieve the first entry from the performance log,
- and the key for the second entry in the log is returned. If the performance log is empty,
- then no entry is retrieved and zero is returned. If LogEntryKey is not zero, then the performance
- log entry associated with LogEntryKey is retrieved, and the key for the next entry in the log is
- returned. If LogEntryKey is the key for the last entry in the log, then the last log entry is
- retrieved and an implementation specific non-zero key value that specifies the end of the performance
- log is returned. If LogEntryKey is equal this implementation specific non-zero key value, then no entry
- is retrieved and zero is returned. In the cases where a performance log entry can be returned,
- the log entry is returned in Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, and EndTimeStamp.
- If LogEntryKey is not a valid log entry key for the performance measurement log, then ASSERT().
- If Handle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Token is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Module is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If EndTimeStamp is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param LogEntryKey On entry, the key of the performance measurement log entry to retrieve.
- 0, then the first performance measurement log entry is retrieved.
- On exit, the key of the next performance log entry.
- @param Handle Pointer to environment specific context used to identify the component
- being measured.
- @param Token Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the component
- being measured.
- @param Module Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string that identifies the module
- being measured.
- @param StartTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was started.
- @param EndTimeStamp Pointer to the 64-bit time stamp that was recorded when the measurement
- was ended.
-
- @return The key for the next performance log entry (in general case).
-
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- IN UINTN LogEntryKey,
- OUT CONST VOID **Handle,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Token,
- OUT CONST CHAR8 **Module,
- OUT UINT64 *StartTimeStamp,
- OUT UINT64 *EndTimeStamp
- )
-{
- UINT32 Identifier;
- return GetPerformanceMeasurementEx (LogEntryKey, Handle, Token, Module, StartTimeStamp, EndTimeStamp, &Identifier);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if the performance measurement macros are enabled.
-
- This function returns TRUE if the PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The PERFORMANCE_LIBRARY_PROPERTY_MEASUREMENT_ENABLED bit of
- PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-PerformanceMeasurementEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return mPerformanceMeasurementEnabled;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index c3d01a1e51..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,57 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Performance library instance used in SMM phase.
-#
-# This library instance provides infrastructure for SMM drivers to log performance
-# data. It consumes SMM PerformanceEx or Performance Protocol published by SmmCorePerformanceLib
-# to log performance data. If both SMM PerformanceEx and Performance Protocol are not available,
-# it does not log any performance information.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2011 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmPerformanceLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmPerformanceLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 1EDD13E6-D0CD-4432-A692-FF65C9B4F039
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = PerformanceLib|DXE_SMM_DRIVER
-
- CONSTRUCTOR = SmmPerformanceLibConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- SmmPerformanceLib.c
-
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- SmmServicesTableLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
-
-[Guids]
- gSmmPerformanceProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Locate protocol
- gSmmPerformanceExProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED # Locate protocol
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdPerformanceLibraryPropertyMask ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index aa804d269e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmPerformanceLib/SmmPerformanceLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 5394fb9e97..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/ReportStatusCodeLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,545 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Report Status Code Library for SMM Phase.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2010, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/ReportStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/SmmServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeId.h>
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeDebug.h>
-#include <Protocol/SmmStatusCode.h>
-
-EFI_SMM_REPORT_STATUS_CODE mReportStatusCode = NULL;
-EFI_SMM_STATUS_CODE_PROTOCOL *mStatusCodeProtocol = NULL;
-
-
-/**
- Locate the report status code service.
-
- @return Function pointer to the report status code service.
- NULL is returned if no status code service is available.
-
-**/
-EFI_SMM_REPORT_STATUS_CODE
-InternalGetReportStatusCode (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = gSmst->SmmLocateProtocol (&gEfiSmmStatusCodeProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID**)&mStatusCodeProtocol);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && mStatusCodeProtocol != NULL) {
- return mStatusCodeProtocol->ReportStatusCode;
- }
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal worker function that reports a status code through the status code service.
-
- If status code service is not cached, then this function checks if status code service is
- available in system. If status code service is not available, then EFI_UNSUPPORTED is
- returned. If status code service is present, then it is cached in mReportStatusCode.
- Finally this function reports status code through the status code service.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. This is an optional parameter that may be
- NULL.
- @param Data Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Status code service is not available.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Status code type is not supported.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- if ((ReportProgressCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- (ReportErrorCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ||
- (ReportDebugCodeEnabled() && ((Type) & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_DEBUG_CODE)) {
- //
- // If mReportStatusCode is NULL, then check if status code service is available in system.
- //
- if (mReportStatusCode == NULL) {
- mReportStatusCode = InternalGetReportStatusCode ();
- if (mReportStatusCode == NULL) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // A status code service is present in system, so pass in all the parameters to the service.
- //
- return (*mReportStatusCode) (mStatusCodeProtocol, Type, Value, Instance, (EFI_GUID *)CallerId, Data);
- }
-
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Converts a status code to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType and Value to an 8-bit POST code
- and returns the 8-bit POST code in PostCode. If CodeType is an
- EFI_PROGRESS_CODE or CodeType is an EFI_ERROR_CODE, then bits 0..4 of PostCode
- are set to bits 16..20 of Value, and bits 5..7 of PostCode are set to bits
- 24..26 of Value., and TRUE is returned. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param PostCode A pointer to the 8-bit POST code value to return.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType and Value was converted
- to an 8-bit POST code and returned in PostCode.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType and Value could not be
- converted to an 8-bit POST code value.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-CodeTypeToPostCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- OUT UINT8 *PostCode
- )
-{
- //
- // If PostCode is NULL, then ASSERT()
- //
- ASSERT (PostCode != NULL);
-
- //
- // Convert Value to an 8 bit post code
- //
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_PROGRESS_CODE) ||
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) ) {
- *PostCode = (UINT8) ((((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_CLASS_MASK) >> 24) << 5) |
- (((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SUBCLASS_MASK) >> 16) & 0x1f));
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts ASSERT() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data to the ASSERT()
- arguments specified by Filename, Description, and LineNumber. If CodeType is
- an EFI_ERROR_CODE, and CodeType has a severity of EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED, and
- Value has an operation mask of EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE, extract
- Filename, Description, and LineNumber from the optional data area of the
- status code buffer specified by Data. The optional data area of Data contains
- a Null-terminated ASCII string for the FileName, followed by a Null-terminated
- ASCII string for the Description, followed by a 32-bit LineNumber. If the
- ASSERT() information could be extracted from Data, then return TRUE.
- Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Filename is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Description is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If LineNumber is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param CodeType The type of status code being converted.
- @param Value The status code value being converted.
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param Filename Pointer to the source file name that generated the ASSERT().
- @param Description Pointer to the description of the ASSERT().
- @param LineNumber Pointer to source line number that generated the ASSERT().
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data was
- converted ASSERT() arguments specified by Filename, Description,
- and LineNumber.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by CodeType, Value, and Data could
- not be converted to ASSERT() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractAssertInfo (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE CodeType,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT CHAR8 **Filename,
- OUT CHAR8 **Description,
- OUT UINT32 *LineNumber
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *AssertData;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (Filename != NULL);
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
- ASSERT (LineNumber != NULL);
-
- if (((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_CODE) &&
- ((CodeType & EFI_STATUS_CODE_SEVERITY_MASK) == EFI_ERROR_UNRECOVERED) &&
- ((Value & EFI_STATUS_CODE_OPERATION_MASK) == EFI_SW_EC_ILLEGAL_SOFTWARE_STATE)) {
- AssertData = (EFI_DEBUG_ASSERT_DATA *)(Data + 1);
- *Filename = (CHAR8 *)(AssertData + 1);
- *Description = *Filename + AsciiStrLen (*Filename) + 1;
- *LineNumber = AssertData->LineNumber;
- return TRUE;
- }
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Extracts DEBUG() information from a status code structure.
-
- Converts the status code specified by Data to the DEBUG() arguments specified
- by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format. If type GUID in Data is
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID, then extract ErrorLevel, Marker, and
- Format from the optional data area of the status code buffer specified by Data.
- The optional data area of Data contains a 32-bit ErrorLevel followed by Marker
- which is 12 UINTN parameters, followed by a Null-terminated ASCII string for
- the Format. If the DEBUG() information could be extracted from Data, then
- return TRUE. Otherwise, FALSE is returned.
-
- If Data is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ErrorLevel is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Marker is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Format is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Data Pointer to status code data buffer.
- @param ErrorLevel Pointer to error level mask for a debug message.
- @param Marker Pointer to the variable argument list associated with Format.
- @param Format Pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII format string of a
- debug message.
-
- @retval TRUE The status code specified by Data was converted DEBUG() arguments
- specified by ErrorLevel, Marker, and Format.
- @retval FALSE The status code specified by Data could not be converted to
- DEBUG() arguments.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeExtractDebugInfo (
- IN CONST EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *Data,
- OUT UINT32 *ErrorLevel,
- OUT BASE_LIST *Marker,
- OUT CHAR8 **Format
- )
-{
- EFI_DEBUG_INFO *DebugInfo;
-
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- ASSERT (ErrorLevel != NULL);
- ASSERT (Marker != NULL);
- ASSERT (Format != NULL);
-
- //
- // If the GUID type is not EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA_TYPE_DEBUG_GUID then return FALSE
- //
- if (!CompareGuid (&Data->Type, &gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the debug information from the status code record
- //
- DebugInfo = (EFI_DEBUG_INFO *)(Data + 1);
-
- *ErrorLevel = DebugInfo->ErrorLevel;
-
- //
- // The first 12 * sizeof (UINT64) bytes following EFI_DEBUG_INFO are for variable arguments
- // of format in DEBUG string. Its address is returned in Marker and has to be 64-bit aligned.
- // It must be noticed that EFI_DEBUG_INFO follows EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA, whose size is
- // 20 bytes. The size of EFI_DEBUG_INFO is 4 bytes, so we can ensure that Marker
- // returned is 64-bit aligned.
- // 64-bit aligned is a must, otherwise retrieving 64-bit parameter from BASE_LIST will
- // cause unalignment exception.
- //
- *Marker = (BASE_LIST) (DebugInfo + 1);
- *Format = (CHAR8 *)(((UINT64 *)*Marker) + 12);
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code.
-
- Reports the status code specified by the parameters Type and Value. Status
- code also require an instance, caller ID, and extended data. This function
- passed in a zero instance, NULL extended data, and a caller ID of
- gEfiCallerIdGuid, which is the GUID for the module.
-
- ReportStatusCode()must actively prevent recusrsion. If ReportStatusCode()
- is called while processing another any other Report Status Code Library function,
- then ReportStatusCode() must return immediately.
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR There status code could not be reported due to a
- device error.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCode (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value
- )
-{
- return InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, 0, &gEfiCallerIdGuid, NULL);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with an extended data buffer.
-
- Allocates and fills in the extended data section of a status code with the
- extended data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize. ExtendedData
- is assumed to be one of the data structures specified in Related Definitions.
- These data structure do not have the standard header, so this function is
- responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled
- in with a GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid. The status code is reported
- with a zero instance and a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid.
-
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData() is called while processing another any other
- Report Status Code Library function, then ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData()
- must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedDataSize is 0, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer to be reported.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer to
- be reported.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported with the extended
- data specified by ExtendedData and ExtendedDataSize.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate the
- extended data section.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeWithExtendedData (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- ASSERT (ExtendedData != NULL);
- ASSERT (ExtendedDataSize != 0);
- return ReportStatusCodeEx (
- Type,
- Value,
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- ExtendedData,
- ExtendedDataSize
- );
-}
-
-
-/**
- Reports a status code with full parameters.
-
- The function reports a status code. If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize
- is 0, then an extended data buffer is not reported. If ExtendedData is not
- NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not 0, then an extended data buffer is allocated.
- ExtendedData is assumed not have the standard status code header, so this function
- is responsible for allocating a buffer large enough for the standard header and
- the extended data passed into this function. The standard header is filled in
- with a GUID specified by ExtendedDataGuid. If ExtendedDataGuid is NULL, then a
- GUID of gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid is used. The status code is reported with
- an instance specified by Instance and a caller ID specified by CallerId. If
- CallerId is NULL, then a caller ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
-
- ReportStatusCodeEx()must actively prevent recursion. If
- ReportStatusCodeEx() is called while processing another any
- other Report Status Code Library function, then
- ReportStatusCodeEx() must return EFI_DEVICE_ERROR immediately.
-
- If ExtendedData is NULL and ExtendedDataSize is not zero, then ASSERT().
- If ExtendedData is not NULL and ExtendedDataSize is zero, then ASSERT().
-
- @param Type Status code type.
- @param Value Status code value.
- @param Instance Status code instance number.
- @param CallerId Pointer to a GUID that identifies the caller of this
- function. If this parameter is NULL, then a caller
- ID of gEfiCallerIdGuid is used.
- @param ExtendedDataGuid Pointer to the GUID for the extended data buffer.
- If this parameter is NULL, then a the status code
- standard header is filled in with
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid.
- @param ExtendedData Pointer to the extended data buffer. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param ExtendedDataSize The size, in bytes, of the extended data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The status code was reported.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There were not enough resources to allocate
- the extended data section if it was specified.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED Report status code is not supported
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-ReportStatusCodeEx (
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_TYPE Type,
- IN EFI_STATUS_CODE_VALUE Value,
- IN UINT32 Instance,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *CallerId OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *ExtendedDataGuid OPTIONAL,
- IN CONST VOID *ExtendedData OPTIONAL,
- IN UINTN ExtendedDataSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA *StatusCodeData;
-
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData == NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize != 0)));
- ASSERT (!((ExtendedData != NULL) && (ExtendedDataSize == 0)));
-
- //
- // Allocate space for the Status Code Header and its buffer
- //
- StatusCodeData = AllocatePool (sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA) + ExtendedDataSize);
- if (StatusCodeData == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Fill in the extended data header
- //
- StatusCodeData->HeaderSize = (UINT16) sizeof (EFI_STATUS_CODE_DATA);
- StatusCodeData->Size = (UINT16) ExtendedDataSize;
- if (ExtendedDataGuid == NULL) {
- ExtendedDataGuid = &gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid;
- }
- CopyGuid (&StatusCodeData->Type, ExtendedDataGuid);
-
- //
- // Fill in the extended data buffer
- //
- if (ExtendedData != NULL) {
- CopyMem (StatusCodeData + 1, ExtendedData, ExtendedDataSize);
- }
-
- //
- // Report the status code
- //
- if (CallerId == NULL) {
- CallerId = &gEfiCallerIdGuid;
- }
- Status = InternalReportStatusCode (Type, Value, Instance, CallerId, StatusCodeData);
-
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer
- //
- FreePool (StatusCodeData);
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_PROGRESS_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportProgressCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_PROGRESS_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_ERROR_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportErrorCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_ERROR_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Returns TRUE if status codes of type EFI_DEBUG_CODE are enabled
-
- This function returns TRUE if the REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED
- bit of PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set. Otherwise FALSE is returned.
-
- @retval TRUE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is set.
- @retval FALSE The REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED bit of
- PcdReportStatusCodeProperyMask is clear.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-ReportDebugCodeEnabled (
- VOID
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((PcdGet8 (PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask) & REPORT_STATUS_CODE_PROPERTY_DEBUG_CODE_ENABLED) != 0);
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/SmmReportStatusCodeLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/SmmReportStatusCodeLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 15799299fc..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/SmmReportStatusCodeLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,56 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# SMM report status code library.
-#
-# Retrieve status code and report status code in SMM phase.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = SmmReportStatusCodeLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = SmmReportStatusCodeLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 67089D19-B3D6-4d9e-A0EB-FEDC1F83A1EE
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- PI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x0001000A
- LIBRARY_CLASS = ReportStatusCodeLib|DXE_SMM_DRIVER SMM_CORE
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- ReportStatusCodeLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- PcdLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- SmmServicesTableLib
- DebugLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiStatusCodeSpecificDataGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
- gEfiStatusCodeDataTypeDebugGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## UNDEFINED
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiSmmStatusCodeProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdReportStatusCodePropertyMask ## CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/SmmReportStatusCodeLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/SmmReportStatusCodeLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 99cfab569d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/SmmReportStatusCodeLib/SmmReportStatusCodeLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.c deleted file mode 100644 index 8a0377b7a4..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,45 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This library is used by other modules to measure data to TPM.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved. <BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-/**
- Tpm measure and log data, and extend the measurement result into a specific PCR.
-
- @param[in] PcrIndex PCR Index.
- @param[in] EventType Event type.
- @param[in] EventLog Measurement event log.
- @param[in] LogLen Event log length in bytes.
- @param[in] HashData The start of the data buffer to be hashed, extended.
- @param[in] HashDataLen The length, in bytes, of the buffer referenced by HashData
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Operation completed successfully.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED TPM device not available.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Out of memory.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The operation was unsuccessful.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-TpmMeasureAndLogData (
- IN UINT32 PcrIndex,
- IN UINT32 EventType,
- IN VOID *EventLog,
- IN UINT32 LogLen,
- IN VOID *HashData,
- IN UINT64 HashDataLen
- )
-{
- //
- // Do nothing, just return EFI_SUCCESS.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.inf deleted file mode 100644 index fef783a4f9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,34 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Provides NULL TPM measurement function.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = TpmMeasurementLibNull
- FILE_GUID = 6DFD6E9F-9278-48D8-8F45-B6CFF2C2B69C
- MODULE_TYPE = UEFI_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = TpmMeasurementLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = TpmMeasurementLibNull.uni
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF
-#
-
-[Sources]
- TpmMeasurementLibNull.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 71a2b1f392..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/TpmMeasurementLibNull/TpmMeasurementLibNull.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmBoot.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmBoot.c deleted file mode 100644 index 52f2d038f3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmBoot.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2351 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Library functions which relates with booting.
-
-(C) Copyright 2015 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P.<BR>
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-#define VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_OFFSET 3
-#define VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH 8
-#define PRODUCT_IDENTIFICATION_OFFSET 11
-#define PRODUCT_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH 16
-
-CONST UINT16 mBmUsbLangId = 0x0409; // English
-CHAR16 mBmUefiPrefix[] = L"UEFI ";
-
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_REFRESH_LEGACY_BOOT_OPTION mBmRefreshLegacyBootOption = NULL;
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LEGACY_BOOT mBmLegacyBoot = NULL;
-
-LIST_ENTRY mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers = INITIALIZE_LIST_HEAD_VARIABLE (mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers);
-
-///
-/// This GUID is used for an EFI Variable that stores the front device pathes
-/// for a partial device path that starts with the HD node.
-///
-EFI_GUID mBmHardDriveBootVariableGuid = { 0xfab7e9e1, 0x39dd, 0x4f2b, { 0x84, 0x08, 0xe2, 0x0e, 0x90, 0x6c, 0xb6, 0xde } };
-EFI_GUID mBmAutoCreateBootOptionGuid = { 0x8108ac4e, 0x9f11, 0x4d59, { 0x85, 0x0e, 0xe2, 0x1a, 0x52, 0x2c, 0x59, 0xb2 } };
-
-/**
- The function registers the legacy boot support capabilities.
-
- @param RefreshLegacyBootOption The function pointer to create all the legacy boot options.
- @param LegacyBoot The function pointer to boot the legacy boot option.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerRegisterLegacyBootSupport (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_REFRESH_LEGACY_BOOT_OPTION RefreshLegacyBootOption,
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LEGACY_BOOT LegacyBoot
- )
-{
- mBmRefreshLegacyBootOption = RefreshLegacyBootOption;
- mBmLegacyBoot = LegacyBoot;
-}
-
-/**
- Return TRUE when the boot option is auto-created instead of manually added.
-
- @param BootOption Pointer to the boot option to check.
-
- @retval TRUE The boot option is auto-created.
- @retval FALSE The boot option is manually added.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsAutoCreateBootOption (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOption
- )
-{
- if ((BootOption->OptionalDataSize == sizeof (EFI_GUID)) &&
- CompareGuid ((EFI_GUID *) BootOption->OptionalData, &mBmAutoCreateBootOptionGuid)
- ) {
- return TRUE;
- } else {
- return FALSE;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- For a bootable Device path, return its boot type.
-
- @param DevicePath The bootable device Path to check
-
- @retval AcpiFloppyBoot If given device path contains ACPI_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- which HID is floppy device.
- @retval MessageAtapiBoot If given device path contains MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- and its last device path node's subtype is MSG_ATAPI_DP.
- @retval MessageSataBoot If given device path contains MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- and its last device path node's subtype is MSG_SATA_DP.
- @retval MessageScsiBoot If given device path contains MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- and its last device path node's subtype is MSG_SCSI_DP.
- @retval MessageUsbBoot If given device path contains MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- and its last device path node's subtype is MSG_USB_DP.
- @retval MessageNetworkBoot If given device path contains MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- and its last device path node's subtype is MSG_MAC_ADDR_DP, MSG_VLAN_DP,
- MSG_IPv4_DP or MSG_IPv6_DP.
- @retval MessageHttpBoot If given device path contains MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH type device path node
- and its last device path node's subtype is MSG_URI_DP.
- @retval UnsupportedBoot If tiven device path doesn't match the above condition, it's not supported.
-
-**/
-BM_BOOT_TYPE
-BmDevicePathType (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Node;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *NextNode;
-
- ASSERT (DevicePath != NULL);
-
- for (Node = DevicePath; !IsDevicePathEndType (Node); Node = NextDevicePathNode (Node)) {
- switch (DevicePathType (Node)) {
-
- case ACPI_DEVICE_PATH:
- if (EISA_ID_TO_NUM (((ACPI_HID_DEVICE_PATH *) Node)->HID) == 0x0604) {
- return BmAcpiFloppyBoot;
- }
- break;
-
- case HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH:
- if (DevicePathSubType (Node) == HW_CONTROLLER_DP) {
- return BmHardwareDeviceBoot;
- }
- break;
-
- case MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH:
- //
- // Skip LUN device node
- //
- NextNode = Node;
- do {
- NextNode = NextDevicePathNode (NextNode);
- } while (
- (DevicePathType (NextNode) == MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH) &&
- (DevicePathSubType(NextNode) == MSG_DEVICE_LOGICAL_UNIT_DP)
- );
-
- //
- // If the device path not only point to driver device, it is not a messaging device path,
- //
- if (!IsDevicePathEndType (NextNode)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- switch (DevicePathSubType (Node)) {
- case MSG_ATAPI_DP:
- return BmMessageAtapiBoot;
- break;
-
- case MSG_SATA_DP:
- return BmMessageSataBoot;
- break;
-
- case MSG_USB_DP:
- return BmMessageUsbBoot;
- break;
-
- case MSG_SCSI_DP:
- return BmMessageScsiBoot;
- break;
-
- case MSG_MAC_ADDR_DP:
- case MSG_VLAN_DP:
- case MSG_IPv4_DP:
- case MSG_IPv6_DP:
- return BmMessageNetworkBoot;
- break;
-
- case MSG_URI_DP:
- return BmMessageHttpBoot;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- return BmMiscBoot;
-}
-
-/**
- Find the boot option in the NV storage and return the option number.
-
- @param OptionToFind Boot option to be checked.
-
- @return The option number of the found boot option.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-BmFindBootOptionInVariable (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *OptionToFind
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION BootOption;
- UINTN OptionNumber;
- CHAR16 OptionName[BM_OPTION_NAME_LEN];
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOptions;
- UINTN BootOptionCount;
- UINTN Index;
-
- OptionNumber = LoadOptionNumberUnassigned;
-
- //
- // Try to match the variable exactly if the option number is assigned
- //
- if (OptionToFind->OptionNumber != LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- UnicodeSPrint (
- OptionName, sizeof (OptionName), L"%s%04x",
- mBmLoadOptionName[OptionToFind->OptionType], OptionToFind->OptionNumber
- );
- Status = EfiBootManagerVariableToLoadOption (OptionName, &BootOption);
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (OptionToFind->OptionNumber == BootOption.OptionNumber);
- if ((OptionToFind->Attributes == BootOption.Attributes) &&
- (StrCmp (OptionToFind->Description, BootOption.Description) == 0) &&
- (CompareMem (OptionToFind->FilePath, BootOption.FilePath, GetDevicePathSize (OptionToFind->FilePath)) == 0) &&
- (OptionToFind->OptionalDataSize == BootOption.OptionalDataSize) &&
- (CompareMem (OptionToFind->OptionalData, BootOption.OptionalData, OptionToFind->OptionalDataSize) == 0)
- ) {
- OptionNumber = OptionToFind->OptionNumber;
- }
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOption (&BootOption);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // The option number assigned is either incorrect or unassigned.
- //
- if (OptionNumber == LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- BootOptions = EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions (&BootOptionCount, LoadOptionTypeBoot);
-
- Index = BmFindLoadOption (OptionToFind, BootOptions, BootOptionCount);
- if (Index != -1) {
- OptionNumber = BootOptions[Index].OptionNumber;
- }
-
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (BootOptions, BootOptionCount);
- }
-
- return OptionNumber;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the file buffer using a Memory Mapped Device Path.
-
- FV address may change across reboot. This routine promises the FV file device path is right.
-
- @param DevicePath The Memory Mapped Device Path to get the file buffer.
- @param FullPath Receive the updated FV Device Path pointint to the file.
- @param FileSize Receive the file buffer size.
-
- @return The file buffer.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmGetFileBufferByMemmapFv (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath,
- OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FullPath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FvFileNode;
- EFI_HANDLE FvHandle;
- EFI_LOADED_IMAGE_PROTOCOL *LoadedImage;
- UINT32 AuthenticationStatus;
- UINTN FvHandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *FvHandles;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *NewDevicePath;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
-
- FvFileNode = DevicePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid, &FvFileNode, &FvHandle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FileBuffer = GetFileBufferByFilePath (TRUE, DevicePath, FileSize, &AuthenticationStatus);
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- *FullPath = DuplicateDevicePath (DevicePath);
- }
- return FileBuffer;
- }
-
- FvFileNode = NextDevicePathNode (DevicePath);
-
- //
- // Firstly find the FV file in current FV
- //
- gBS->HandleProtocol (
- gImageHandle,
- &gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &LoadedImage
- );
- NewDevicePath = AppendDevicePathNode (DevicePathFromHandle (LoadedImage->DeviceHandle), FvFileNode);
- FileBuffer = BmGetFileBufferByMemmapFv (NewDevicePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- FreePool (NewDevicePath);
-
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- return FileBuffer;
- }
-
- //
- // Secondly find the FV file in all other FVs
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &FvHandleCount,
- &FvHandles
- );
- for (Index = 0; (Index < FvHandleCount) && (FileBuffer == NULL); Index++) {
- if (FvHandles[Index] == LoadedImage->DeviceHandle) {
- //
- // Skip current FV
- //
- continue;
- }
- NewDevicePath = AppendDevicePathNode (DevicePathFromHandle (FvHandles[Index]), FvFileNode);
- FileBuffer = BmGetFileBufferByMemmapFv (NewDevicePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- FreePool (NewDevicePath);
- }
-
- if (FvHandles != NULL) {
- FreePool (FvHandles);
- }
- return FileBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Check if it's a Memory Mapped FV Device Path.
-
- The function doesn't garentee the device path points to existing FV file.
-
- @param DevicePath Input device path.
-
- @retval TRUE The device path is a Memory Mapped FV Device Path.
- @retval FALSE The device path is NOT a Memory Mapped FV Device Path.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsMemmapFvFilePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FileNode;
-
- if ((DevicePathType (DevicePath) == HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH) && (DevicePathSubType (DevicePath) == HW_MEMMAP_DP)) {
- FileNode = NextDevicePathNode (DevicePath);
- if ((DevicePathType (FileNode) == MEDIA_DEVICE_PATH) && (DevicePathSubType (FileNode) == MEDIA_PIWG_FW_FILE_DP)) {
- return IsDevicePathEnd (NextDevicePathNode (FileNode));
- }
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether a USB device match the specified USB Class device path. This
- function follows "Load Option Processing" behavior in UEFI specification.
-
- @param UsbIo USB I/O protocol associated with the USB device.
- @param UsbClass The USB Class device path to match.
-
- @retval TRUE The USB device match the USB Class device path.
- @retval FALSE The USB device does not match the USB Class device path.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmMatchUsbClass (
- IN EFI_USB_IO_PROTOCOL *UsbIo,
- IN USB_CLASS_DEVICE_PATH *UsbClass
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_USB_DEVICE_DESCRIPTOR DevDesc;
- EFI_USB_INTERFACE_DESCRIPTOR IfDesc;
- UINT8 DeviceClass;
- UINT8 DeviceSubClass;
- UINT8 DeviceProtocol;
-
- if ((DevicePathType (UsbClass) != MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH) ||
- (DevicePathSubType (UsbClass) != MSG_USB_CLASS_DP)){
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Check Vendor Id and Product Id.
- //
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetDeviceDescriptor (UsbIo, &DevDesc);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if ((UsbClass->VendorId != 0xffff) &&
- (UsbClass->VendorId != DevDesc.IdVendor)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if ((UsbClass->ProductId != 0xffff) &&
- (UsbClass->ProductId != DevDesc.IdProduct)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- DeviceClass = DevDesc.DeviceClass;
- DeviceSubClass = DevDesc.DeviceSubClass;
- DeviceProtocol = DevDesc.DeviceProtocol;
- if (DeviceClass == 0) {
- //
- // If Class in Device Descriptor is set to 0, use the Class, SubClass and
- // Protocol in Interface Descriptor instead.
- //
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetInterfaceDescriptor (UsbIo, &IfDesc);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- DeviceClass = IfDesc.InterfaceClass;
- DeviceSubClass = IfDesc.InterfaceSubClass;
- DeviceProtocol = IfDesc.InterfaceProtocol;
- }
-
- //
- // Check Class, SubClass and Protocol.
- //
- if ((UsbClass->DeviceClass != 0xff) &&
- (UsbClass->DeviceClass != DeviceClass)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if ((UsbClass->DeviceSubClass != 0xff) &&
- (UsbClass->DeviceSubClass != DeviceSubClass)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if ((UsbClass->DeviceProtocol != 0xff) &&
- (UsbClass->DeviceProtocol != DeviceProtocol)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Eliminate the extra spaces in the Str to one space.
-
- @param Str Input string info.
-**/
-VOID
-BmEliminateExtraSpaces (
- IN CHAR16 *Str
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN ActualIndex;
-
- for (Index = 0, ActualIndex = 0; Str[Index] != L'\0'; Index++) {
- if ((Str[Index] != L' ') || ((ActualIndex > 0) && (Str[ActualIndex - 1] != L' '))) {
- Str[ActualIndex++] = Str[Index];
- }
- }
- Str[ActualIndex] = L'\0';
-}
-
-/**
- Try to get the controller's ATA/ATAPI description.
-
- @param Handle Controller handle.
-
- @return The description string.
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-BmGetDescriptionFromDiskInfo (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_DISK_INFO_PROTOCOL *DiskInfo;
- UINT32 BufferSize;
- EFI_ATAPI_IDENTIFY_DATA IdentifyData;
- EFI_SCSI_INQUIRY_DATA InquiryData;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- UINTN Length;
- CONST UINTN ModelNameLength = 40;
- CONST UINTN SerialNumberLength = 20;
- CHAR8 *StrPtr;
- UINT8 Temp;
-
- Description = NULL;
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handle,
- &gEfiDiskInfoProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &DiskInfo
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- if (CompareGuid (&DiskInfo->Interface, &gEfiDiskInfoAhciInterfaceGuid) ||
- CompareGuid (&DiskInfo->Interface, &gEfiDiskInfoIdeInterfaceGuid)) {
- BufferSize = sizeof (EFI_ATAPI_IDENTIFY_DATA);
- Status = DiskInfo->Identify (
- DiskInfo,
- &IdentifyData,
- &BufferSize
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Description = AllocateZeroPool ((ModelNameLength + SerialNumberLength + 2) * sizeof (CHAR16));
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
- for (Index = 0; Index + 1 < ModelNameLength; Index += 2) {
- Description[Index] = (CHAR16) IdentifyData.ModelName[Index + 1];
- Description[Index + 1] = (CHAR16) IdentifyData.ModelName[Index];
- }
-
- Length = Index;
- Description[Length++] = L' ';
-
- for (Index = 0; Index + 1 < SerialNumberLength; Index += 2) {
- Description[Length + Index] = (CHAR16) IdentifyData.SerialNo[Index + 1];
- Description[Length + Index + 1] = (CHAR16) IdentifyData.SerialNo[Index];
- }
- Length += Index;
- Description[Length++] = L'\0';
- ASSERT (Length == ModelNameLength + SerialNumberLength + 2);
-
- BmEliminateExtraSpaces (Description);
- }
- } else if (CompareGuid (&DiskInfo->Interface, &gEfiDiskInfoScsiInterfaceGuid)) {
- BufferSize = sizeof (EFI_SCSI_INQUIRY_DATA);
- Status = DiskInfo->Inquiry (
- DiskInfo,
- &InquiryData,
- &BufferSize
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Description = AllocateZeroPool ((VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH + PRODUCT_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH + 2) * sizeof (CHAR16));
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
-
- //
- // Per SCSI spec, EFI_SCSI_INQUIRY_DATA.Reserved_5_95[3 - 10] save the Verdor identification
- // EFI_SCSI_INQUIRY_DATA.Reserved_5_95[11 - 26] save the product identification,
- // Here combine the vendor identification and product identification to the description.
- //
- StrPtr = (CHAR8 *) (&InquiryData.Reserved_5_95[VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_OFFSET]);
- Temp = StrPtr[VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH];
- StrPtr[VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH] = '\0';
- AsciiStrToUnicodeStrS (StrPtr, Description, VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH + 1);
- StrPtr[VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH] = Temp;
-
- //
- // Add one space at the middle of vendor information and product information.
- //
- Description[VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH] = L' ';
-
- StrPtr = (CHAR8 *) (&InquiryData.Reserved_5_95[PRODUCT_IDENTIFICATION_OFFSET]);
- StrPtr[PRODUCT_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH] = '\0';
- AsciiStrToUnicodeStrS (StrPtr, Description + VENDOR_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH + 1, PRODUCT_IDENTIFICATION_LENGTH + 1);
-
- BmEliminateExtraSpaces (Description);
- }
- }
-
- return Description;
-}
-
-/**
- Try to get the controller's USB description.
-
- @param Handle Controller handle.
-
- @return The description string.
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-BmGetUsbDescription (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_USB_IO_PROTOCOL *UsbIo;
- CHAR16 NullChar;
- CHAR16 *Manufacturer;
- CHAR16 *Product;
- CHAR16 *SerialNumber;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- EFI_USB_DEVICE_DESCRIPTOR DevDesc;
- UINTN DescMaxSize;
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handle,
- &gEfiUsbIoProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &UsbIo
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- NullChar = L'\0';
-
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetDeviceDescriptor (UsbIo, &DevDesc);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetStringDescriptor (
- UsbIo,
- mBmUsbLangId,
- DevDesc.StrManufacturer,
- &Manufacturer
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Manufacturer = &NullChar;
- }
-
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetStringDescriptor (
- UsbIo,
- mBmUsbLangId,
- DevDesc.StrProduct,
- &Product
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Product = &NullChar;
- }
-
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetStringDescriptor (
- UsbIo,
- mBmUsbLangId,
- DevDesc.StrSerialNumber,
- &SerialNumber
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- SerialNumber = &NullChar;
- }
-
- if ((Manufacturer == &NullChar) &&
- (Product == &NullChar) &&
- (SerialNumber == &NullChar)
- ) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- DescMaxSize = StrSize (Manufacturer) + StrSize (Product) + StrSize (SerialNumber);
- Description = AllocateZeroPool (DescMaxSize);
- ASSERT (Description != NULL);
- StrCatS (Description, DescMaxSize/sizeof(CHAR16), Manufacturer);
- StrCatS (Description, DescMaxSize/sizeof(CHAR16), L" ");
-
- StrCatS (Description, DescMaxSize/sizeof(CHAR16), Product);
- StrCatS (Description, DescMaxSize/sizeof(CHAR16), L" ");
-
- StrCatS (Description, DescMaxSize/sizeof(CHAR16), SerialNumber);
-
- if (Manufacturer != &NullChar) {
- FreePool (Manufacturer);
- }
- if (Product != &NullChar) {
- FreePool (Product);
- }
- if (SerialNumber != &NullChar) {
- FreePool (SerialNumber);
- }
-
- BmEliminateExtraSpaces (Description);
-
- return Description;
-}
-
-/**
- Return the boot description for the controller based on the type.
-
- @param Handle Controller handle.
-
- @return The description string.
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-BmGetMiscDescription (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL *BlockIo;
- EFI_SIMPLE_FILE_SYSTEM_PROTOCOL *Fs;
-
- switch (BmDevicePathType (DevicePathFromHandle (Handle))) {
- case BmAcpiFloppyBoot:
- Description = L"Floppy";
- break;
-
- case BmMessageAtapiBoot:
- case BmMessageSataBoot:
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Handle, &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &BlockIo);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- //
- // Assume a removable SATA device should be the DVD/CD device
- //
- Description = BlockIo->Media->RemovableMedia ? L"DVD/CDROM" : L"Hard Drive";
- break;
-
- case BmMessageUsbBoot:
- Description = L"USB Device";
- break;
-
- case BmMessageScsiBoot:
- Description = L"SCSI Device";
- break;
-
- case BmHardwareDeviceBoot:
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Handle, &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &BlockIo);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Description = BlockIo->Media->RemovableMedia ? L"Removable Disk" : L"Hard Drive";
- } else {
- Description = L"Misc Device";
- }
- break;
-
- case BmMessageNetworkBoot:
- Description = L"Network";
- break;
-
- case BmMessageHttpBoot:
- Description = L"Http";
- break;
-
- default:
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Handle, &gEfiSimpleFileSystemProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &Fs);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Description = L"Non-Block Boot Device";
- } else {
- Description = L"Misc Device";
- }
- break;
- }
-
- return AllocateCopyPool (StrSize (Description), Description);
-}
-
-/**
- Register the platform provided boot description handler.
-
- @param Handler The platform provided boot description handler
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The handler was registered successfully.
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED The handler was already registered.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is not enough resource to perform the registration.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerRegisterBootDescriptionHandler (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_HANDLER Handler
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY *Entry;
-
- for ( Link = GetFirstNode (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers)
- ; !IsNull (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers, Link)
- ; Link = GetNextNode (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers, Link)
- ) {
- Entry = CR (Link, BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY, Link, BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY_SIGNATURE);
- if (Entry->Handler == Handler) {
- return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
- }
- }
-
- Entry = AllocatePool (sizeof (BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY));
- if (Entry == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- Entry->Signature = BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY_SIGNATURE;
- Entry->Handler = Handler;
- InsertTailList (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers, &Entry->Link);
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-BM_GET_BOOT_DESCRIPTION mBmBootDescriptionHandlers[] = {
- BmGetUsbDescription,
- BmGetDescriptionFromDiskInfo,
- BmGetMiscDescription
-};
-
-/**
- Return the boot description for the controller.
-
- @param Handle Controller handle.
-
- @return The description string.
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-BmGetBootDescription (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY *Entry;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- CHAR16 *DefaultDescription;
- CHAR16 *Temp;
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // Firstly get the default boot description
- //
- DefaultDescription = NULL;
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mBmBootDescriptionHandlers) / sizeof (mBmBootDescriptionHandlers[0]); Index++) {
- DefaultDescription = mBmBootDescriptionHandlers[Index] (Handle);
- if (DefaultDescription != NULL) {
- //
- // Avoid description confusion between UEFI & Legacy boot option by adding "UEFI " prefix
- // ONLY for core provided boot description handler.
- //
- Temp = AllocatePool (StrSize (DefaultDescription) + sizeof (mBmUefiPrefix));
- ASSERT (Temp != NULL);
- StrCpyS ( Temp,
- (StrSize (DefaultDescription) + sizeof (mBmUefiPrefix))/sizeof(CHAR16),
- mBmUefiPrefix
- );
- StrCatS ( Temp,
- (StrSize (DefaultDescription) + sizeof (mBmUefiPrefix))/sizeof(CHAR16),
- DefaultDescription
- );
- FreePool (DefaultDescription);
- DefaultDescription = Temp;
- break;
- }
- }
- ASSERT (DefaultDescription != NULL);
-
- //
- // Secondly query platform for the better boot description
- //
- for ( Link = GetFirstNode (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers)
- ; !IsNull (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers, Link)
- ; Link = GetNextNode (&mPlatformBootDescriptionHandlers, Link)
- ) {
- Entry = CR (Link, BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY, Link, BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY_SIGNATURE);
- Description = Entry->Handler (Handle, DefaultDescription);
- if (Description != NULL) {
- FreePool (DefaultDescription);
- return Description;
- }
- }
-
- return DefaultDescription;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether a USB device match the specified USB WWID device path. This
- function follows "Load Option Processing" behavior in UEFI specification.
-
- @param UsbIo USB I/O protocol associated with the USB device.
- @param UsbWwid The USB WWID device path to match.
-
- @retval TRUE The USB device match the USB WWID device path.
- @retval FALSE The USB device does not match the USB WWID device path.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmMatchUsbWwid (
- IN EFI_USB_IO_PROTOCOL *UsbIo,
- IN USB_WWID_DEVICE_PATH *UsbWwid
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_USB_DEVICE_DESCRIPTOR DevDesc;
- EFI_USB_INTERFACE_DESCRIPTOR IfDesc;
- UINT16 *LangIdTable;
- UINT16 TableSize;
- UINT16 Index;
- CHAR16 *CompareStr;
- UINTN CompareLen;
- CHAR16 *SerialNumberStr;
- UINTN Length;
-
- if ((DevicePathType (UsbWwid) != MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH) ||
- (DevicePathSubType (UsbWwid) != MSG_USB_WWID_DP)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Check Vendor Id and Product Id.
- //
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetDeviceDescriptor (UsbIo, &DevDesc);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
- if ((DevDesc.IdVendor != UsbWwid->VendorId) ||
- (DevDesc.IdProduct != UsbWwid->ProductId)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Check Interface Number.
- //
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetInterfaceDescriptor (UsbIo, &IfDesc);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
- if (IfDesc.InterfaceNumber != UsbWwid->InterfaceNumber) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Check Serial Number.
- //
- if (DevDesc.StrSerialNumber == 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Get all supported languages.
- //
- TableSize = 0;
- LangIdTable = NULL;
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetSupportedLanguages (UsbIo, &LangIdTable, &TableSize);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || (TableSize == 0) || (LangIdTable == NULL)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Serial number in USB WWID device path is the last 64-or-less UTF-16 characters.
- //
- CompareStr = (CHAR16 *) (UINTN) (UsbWwid + 1);
- CompareLen = (DevicePathNodeLength (UsbWwid) - sizeof (USB_WWID_DEVICE_PATH)) / sizeof (CHAR16);
- if (CompareStr[CompareLen - 1] == L'\0') {
- CompareLen--;
- }
-
- //
- // Compare serial number in each supported language.
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < TableSize / sizeof (UINT16); Index++) {
- SerialNumberStr = NULL;
- Status = UsbIo->UsbGetStringDescriptor (
- UsbIo,
- LangIdTable[Index],
- DevDesc.StrSerialNumber,
- &SerialNumberStr
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || (SerialNumberStr == NULL)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- Length = StrLen (SerialNumberStr);
- if ((Length >= CompareLen) &&
- (CompareMem (SerialNumberStr + Length - CompareLen, CompareStr, CompareLen * sizeof (CHAR16)) == 0)) {
- FreePool (SerialNumberStr);
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- FreePool (SerialNumberStr);
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Find a USB device which match the specified short-form device path start with
- USB Class or USB WWID device path. If ParentDevicePath is NULL, this function
- will search in all USB devices of the platform. If ParentDevicePath is not NULL,
- this function will only search in its child devices.
-
- @param DevicePath The device path that contains USB Class or USB WWID device path.
- @param ParentDevicePathSize The length of the device path before the USB Class or
- USB WWID device path.
- @param UsbIoHandleCount A pointer to the count of the returned USB IO handles.
-
- @retval NULL The matched USB IO handles cannot be found.
- @retval other The matched USB IO handles.
-
-**/
-EFI_HANDLE *
-BmFindUsbDevice (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath,
- IN UINTN ParentDevicePathSize,
- OUT UINTN *UsbIoHandleCount
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE *UsbIoHandles;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *UsbIoDevicePath;
- EFI_USB_IO_PROTOCOL *UsbIo;
- UINTN Index;
- BOOLEAN Matched;
-
- ASSERT (UsbIoHandleCount != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get all UsbIo Handles.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiUsbIoProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- UsbIoHandleCount,
- &UsbIoHandles
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- *UsbIoHandleCount = 0;
- UsbIoHandles = NULL;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < *UsbIoHandleCount; ) {
- //
- // Get the Usb IO interface.
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol(
- UsbIoHandles[Index],
- &gEfiUsbIoProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &UsbIo
- );
- UsbIoDevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (UsbIoHandles[Index]);
- Matched = FALSE;
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && (UsbIoDevicePath != NULL)) {
-
- //
- // Compare starting part of UsbIoHandle's device path with ParentDevicePath.
- //
- if (CompareMem (UsbIoDevicePath, DevicePath, ParentDevicePathSize) == 0) {
- if (BmMatchUsbClass (UsbIo, (USB_CLASS_DEVICE_PATH *) ((UINTN) DevicePath + ParentDevicePathSize)) ||
- BmMatchUsbWwid (UsbIo, (USB_WWID_DEVICE_PATH *) ((UINTN) DevicePath + ParentDevicePathSize))) {
- Matched = TRUE;
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (!Matched) {
- (*UsbIoHandleCount) --;
- CopyMem (&UsbIoHandles[Index], &UsbIoHandles[Index + 1], (*UsbIoHandleCount - Index) * sizeof (EFI_HANDLE));
- } else {
- Index++;
- }
- }
-
- return UsbIoHandles;
-}
-
-/**
- Expand USB Class or USB WWID device path node to be full device path of a USB
- device in platform.
-
- This function support following 4 cases:
- 1) Boot Option device path starts with a USB Class or USB WWID device path,
- and there is no Media FilePath device path in the end.
- In this case, it will follow Removable Media Boot Behavior.
- 2) Boot Option device path starts with a USB Class or USB WWID device path,
- and ended with Media FilePath device path.
- 3) Boot Option device path starts with a full device path to a USB Host Controller,
- contains a USB Class or USB WWID device path node, while not ended with Media
- FilePath device path. In this case, it will follow Removable Media Boot Behavior.
- 4) Boot Option device path starts with a full device path to a USB Host Controller,
- contains a USB Class or USB WWID device path node, and ended with Media
- FilePath device path.
-
- @param FilePath The device path pointing to a load option.
- It could be a short-form device path.
- @param FullPath Return the full device path of the load option after
- short-form device path expanding.
- Caller is responsible to free it.
- @param FileSize Return the load option size.
- @param ShortformNode Pointer to the USB short-form device path node in the FilePath buffer.
-
- @return The load option buffer. Caller is responsible to free the memory.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmExpandUsbDevicePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath,
- OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FullPath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *ShortformNode
- )
-{
- UINTN ParentDevicePathSize;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *RemainingDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FullDevicePath;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- UINTN Index;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
-
- ParentDevicePathSize = (UINTN) ShortformNode - (UINTN) FilePath;
- RemainingDevicePath = NextDevicePathNode (ShortformNode);
- FileBuffer = NULL;
- Handles = BmFindUsbDevice (FilePath, ParentDevicePathSize, &HandleCount);
-
- for (Index = 0; (Index < HandleCount) && (FileBuffer == NULL); Index++) {
- FullDevicePath = AppendDevicePath (DevicePathFromHandle (Handles[Index]), RemainingDevicePath);
- FileBuffer = BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (FullDevicePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- FreePool (FullDevicePath);
- }
-
- if (Handles != NULL) {
- FreePool (Handles);
- }
-
- return FileBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Save the partition DevicePath to the CachedDevicePath as the first instance.
-
- @param CachedDevicePath The device path cache.
- @param DevicePath The partition device path to be cached.
-**/
-VOID
-BmCachePartitionDevicePath (
- IN OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **CachedDevicePath,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempDevicePath;
- UINTN Count;
-
- if (BmMatchDevicePaths (*CachedDevicePath, DevicePath)) {
- TempDevicePath = *CachedDevicePath;
- *CachedDevicePath = BmDelPartMatchInstance (*CachedDevicePath, DevicePath);
- FreePool (TempDevicePath);
- }
-
- if (*CachedDevicePath == NULL) {
- *CachedDevicePath = DuplicateDevicePath (DevicePath);
- return;
- }
-
- TempDevicePath = *CachedDevicePath;
- *CachedDevicePath = AppendDevicePathInstance (DevicePath, *CachedDevicePath);
- if (TempDevicePath != NULL) {
- FreePool (TempDevicePath);
- }
-
- //
- // Here limit the device path instance number to 12, which is max number for a system support 3 IDE controller
- // If the user try to boot many OS in different HDs or partitions, in theory, the 'HDDP' variable maybe become larger and larger.
- //
- Count = 0;
- TempDevicePath = *CachedDevicePath;
- while (!IsDevicePathEnd (TempDevicePath)) {
- TempDevicePath = NextDevicePathNode (TempDevicePath);
- //
- // Parse one instance
- //
- while (!IsDevicePathEndType (TempDevicePath)) {
- TempDevicePath = NextDevicePathNode (TempDevicePath);
- }
- Count++;
- //
- // If the CachedDevicePath variable contain too much instance, only remain 12 instances.
- //
- if (Count == 12) {
- SetDevicePathEndNode (TempDevicePath);
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Expand a device path that starts with a hard drive media device path node to be a
- full device path that includes the full hardware path to the device. We need
- to do this so it can be booted. As an optimization the front match (the part point
- to the partition node. E.g. ACPI() /PCI()/ATA()/Partition() ) is saved in a variable
- so a connect all is not required on every boot. All successful history device path
- which point to partition node (the front part) will be saved.
-
- @param FilePath The device path pointing to a load option.
- It could be a short-form device path.
- @param FullPath Return the full device path of the load option after
- short-form device path expanding.
- Caller is responsible to free it.
- @param FileSize Return the load option size.
-
- @return The load option buffer. Caller is responsible to free the memory.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmExpandPartitionDevicePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath,
- OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FullPath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN BlockIoHandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *BlockIoBuffer;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *BlockIoDevicePath;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *CachedDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempNewDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempDevicePath;
- UINTN CachedDevicePathSize;
- BOOLEAN NeedAdjust;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Instance;
- UINTN Size;
-
- FileBuffer = NULL;
- //
- // Check if there is prestore 'HDDP' variable.
- // If exist, search the front path which point to partition node in the variable instants.
- // If fail to find or 'HDDP' not exist, reconnect all and search in all system
- //
- GetVariable2 (L"HDDP", &mBmHardDriveBootVariableGuid, (VOID **) &CachedDevicePath, &CachedDevicePathSize);
-
- //
- // Delete the invalid 'HDDP' variable.
- //
- if ((CachedDevicePath != NULL) && !IsDevicePathValid (CachedDevicePath, CachedDevicePathSize)) {
- FreePool (CachedDevicePath);
- CachedDevicePath = NULL;
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- L"HDDP",
- &mBmHardDriveBootVariableGuid,
- 0,
- 0,
- NULL
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
-
- if (CachedDevicePath != NULL) {
- TempNewDevicePath = CachedDevicePath;
- NeedAdjust = FALSE;
- do {
- //
- // Check every instance of the variable
- // First, check whether the instance contain the partition node, which is needed for distinguishing multi
- // partial partition boot option. Second, check whether the instance could be connected.
- //
- Instance = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&TempNewDevicePath, &Size);
- if (BmMatchPartitionDevicePathNode (Instance, (HARDDRIVE_DEVICE_PATH *) FilePath)) {
- //
- // Connect the device path instance, the device path point to hard drive media device path node
- // e.g. ACPI() /PCI()/ATA()/Partition()
- //
- Status = EfiBootManagerConnectDevicePath (Instance, NULL);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- TempDevicePath = AppendDevicePath (Instance, NextDevicePathNode (FilePath));
- FileBuffer = BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (TempDevicePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- FreePool (TempDevicePath);
-
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- //
- // Adjust the 'HDDP' instances sequence if the matched one is not first one.
- //
- if (NeedAdjust) {
- BmCachePartitionDevicePath (&CachedDevicePath, Instance);
- //
- // Save the matching Device Path so we don't need to do a connect all next time
- // Failing to save only impacts performance next time expanding the short-form device path
- //
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- L"HDDP",
- &mBmHardDriveBootVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- GetDevicePathSize (CachedDevicePath),
- CachedDevicePath
- );
- }
-
- FreePool (Instance);
- FreePool (CachedDevicePath);
- return FileBuffer;
- }
- }
- }
- //
- // Come here means the first instance is not matched
- //
- NeedAdjust = TRUE;
- FreePool(Instance);
- } while (TempNewDevicePath != NULL);
- }
-
- //
- // If we get here we fail to find or 'HDDP' not exist, and now we need
- // to search all devices in the system for a matched partition
- //
- EfiBootManagerConnectAll ();
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (ByProtocol, &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid, NULL, &BlockIoHandleCount, &BlockIoBuffer);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- BlockIoHandleCount = 0;
- BlockIoBuffer = NULL;
- }
- //
- // Loop through all the device handles that support the BLOCK_IO Protocol
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < BlockIoHandleCount; Index++) {
- BlockIoDevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (BlockIoBuffer[Index]);
- if (BlockIoDevicePath == NULL) {
- continue;
- }
-
- if (BmMatchPartitionDevicePathNode (BlockIoDevicePath, (HARDDRIVE_DEVICE_PATH *) FilePath)) {
- //
- // Find the matched partition device path
- //
- TempDevicePath = AppendDevicePath (BlockIoDevicePath, NextDevicePathNode (FilePath));
- FileBuffer = BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (TempDevicePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- FreePool (TempDevicePath);
-
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- BmCachePartitionDevicePath (&CachedDevicePath, BlockIoDevicePath);
-
- //
- // Save the matching Device Path so we don't need to do a connect all next time
- // Failing to save only impacts performance next time expanding the short-form device path
- //
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- L"HDDP",
- &mBmHardDriveBootVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- GetDevicePathSize (CachedDevicePath),
- CachedDevicePath
- );
-
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (CachedDevicePath != NULL) {
- FreePool (CachedDevicePath);
- }
- if (BlockIoBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (BlockIoBuffer);
- }
- return FileBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Expand the media device path which points to a BlockIo or SimpleFileSystem instance
- by appending EFI_REMOVABLE_MEDIA_FILE_NAME.
-
- @param DevicePath The media device path pointing to a BlockIo or SimpleFileSystem instance.
- @param FullPath Return the full device path pointing to the load option.
- @param FileSize Return the size of the load option.
-
- @return The load option buffer.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmExpandMediaDevicePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath,
- OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FullPath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
- EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL *BlockIo;
- VOID *Buffer;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempDevicePath;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN TempSize;
- EFI_HANDLE *SimpleFileSystemHandles;
- UINTN NumberSimpleFileSystemHandles;
- UINTN Index;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
- UINT32 AuthenticationStatus;
-
- //
- // Check whether the device is connected
- //
- TempDevicePath = DevicePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiSimpleFileSystemProtocolGuid, &TempDevicePath, &Handle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- ASSERT (IsDevicePathEnd (TempDevicePath));
-
- TempDevicePath = FileDevicePath (Handle, EFI_REMOVABLE_MEDIA_FILE_NAME);
- FileBuffer = GetFileBufferByFilePath (TRUE, TempDevicePath, FileSize, &AuthenticationStatus);
- if (FileBuffer == NULL) {
- FreePool (TempDevicePath);
- TempDevicePath = NULL;
- }
- *FullPath = TempDevicePath;
- return FileBuffer;
- }
-
- //
- // For device boot option only pointing to the removable device handle,
- // should make sure all its children handles (its child partion or media handles) are created and connected.
- //
- gBS->ConnectController (Handle, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
-
- //
- // Issue a dummy read to the device to check for media change.
- // When the removable media is changed, any Block IO read/write will
- // cause the BlockIo protocol be reinstalled and EFI_MEDIA_CHANGED is
- // returned. After the Block IO protocol is reinstalled, subsequent
- // Block IO read/write will success.
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid, &TempDevicePath, &Handle);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Handle, &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &BlockIo);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Buffer = AllocatePool (BlockIo->Media->BlockSize);
- if (Buffer != NULL) {
- BlockIo->ReadBlocks (
- BlockIo,
- BlockIo->Media->MediaId,
- 0,
- BlockIo->Media->BlockSize,
- Buffer
- );
- FreePool (Buffer);
- }
-
- //
- // Detect the the default boot file from removable Media
- //
- FileBuffer = NULL;
- *FullPath = NULL;
- Size = GetDevicePathSize (DevicePath) - END_DEVICE_PATH_LENGTH;
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleFileSystemProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &NumberSimpleFileSystemHandles,
- &SimpleFileSystemHandles
- );
- for (Index = 0; Index < NumberSimpleFileSystemHandles; Index++) {
- //
- // Get the device path size of SimpleFileSystem handle
- //
- TempDevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (SimpleFileSystemHandles[Index]);
- TempSize = GetDevicePathSize (TempDevicePath) - END_DEVICE_PATH_LENGTH;
- //
- // Check whether the device path of boot option is part of the SimpleFileSystem handle's device path
- //
- if ((Size <= TempSize) && (CompareMem (TempDevicePath, DevicePath, Size) == 0)) {
- TempDevicePath = FileDevicePath (SimpleFileSystemHandles[Index], EFI_REMOVABLE_MEDIA_FILE_NAME);
- FileBuffer = GetFileBufferByFilePath (TRUE, TempDevicePath, FileSize, &AuthenticationStatus);
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- *FullPath = TempDevicePath;
- break;
- }
- FreePool (TempDevicePath);
- }
- }
-
- if (SimpleFileSystemHandles != NULL) {
- FreePool (SimpleFileSystemHandles);
- }
-
- return FileBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the load option by its device path.
-
- @param FilePath The device path pointing to a load option.
- It could be a short-form device path.
- @param FullPath Return the full device path of the load option after
- short-form device path expanding.
- Caller is responsible to free it.
- @param FileSize Return the load option size.
-
- @return The load option buffer. Caller is responsible to free the memory.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath,
- OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FullPath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize
- )
-{
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
- UINT32 AuthenticationStatus;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Node;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT ((FilePath != NULL) && (FullPath != NULL) && (FileSize != NULL));
-
- EfiBootManagerConnectDevicePath (FilePath, NULL);
-
- *FullPath = NULL;
- *FileSize = 0;
- FileBuffer = NULL;
-
- //
- // Boot from media device by adding a default file name \EFI\BOOT\BOOT{machine type short-name}.EFI
- //
- Node = FilePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiSimpleFileSystemProtocolGuid, &Node, &Handle);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid, &Node, &Handle);
- }
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && IsDevicePathEnd (Node)) {
- return BmExpandMediaDevicePath (FilePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- }
-
- //
- // Expand the short-form device path to full device path
- //
- if ((DevicePathType (FilePath) == MEDIA_DEVICE_PATH) &&
- (DevicePathSubType (FilePath) == MEDIA_HARDDRIVE_DP)) {
- //
- // Expand the Harddrive device path
- //
- return BmExpandPartitionDevicePath (FilePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- } else {
- for (Node = FilePath; !IsDevicePathEnd (Node); Node = NextDevicePathNode (Node)) {
- if ((DevicePathType (Node) == MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH) &&
- ((DevicePathSubType (Node) == MSG_USB_CLASS_DP) || (DevicePathSubType (Node) == MSG_USB_WWID_DP))) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (!IsDevicePathEnd (Node)) {
- //
- // Expand the USB WWID/Class device path
- //
- FileBuffer = BmExpandUsbDevicePath (FilePath, FullPath, FileSize, Node);
- if ((FileBuffer == NULL) && (FilePath == Node)) {
- //
- // Boot Option device path starts with USB Class or USB WWID device path.
- // For Boot Option device path which doesn't begin with the USB Class or
- // USB WWID device path, it's not needed to connect again here.
- //
- BmConnectUsbShortFormDevicePath (FilePath);
- FileBuffer = BmExpandUsbDevicePath (FilePath, FullPath, FileSize, Node);
- }
- return FileBuffer;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Fix up the boot option path if it points to a FV in memory map style of device path
- //
- if (BmIsMemmapFvFilePath (FilePath)) {
- return BmGetFileBufferByMemmapFv (FilePath, FullPath, FileSize);
- }
-
- //
- // Directly reads the load option when it doesn't reside in simple file system instance (LoadFile/LoadFile2),
- // or it directly points to a file in simple file system instance.
- //
- Node = FilePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiLoadFileProtocolGuid, &Node, &Handle);
- FileBuffer = GetFileBufferByFilePath (TRUE, FilePath, FileSize, &AuthenticationStatus);
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- *FullPath = DuplicateDevicePath (FilePath);
- } else {
- //
- // LoadFile () may cause the device path of the Handle be updated.
- //
- *FullPath = AppendDevicePath (DevicePathFromHandle (Handle), Node);
- }
- }
-
- return FileBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Attempt to boot the EFI boot option. This routine sets L"BootCurent" and
- also signals the EFI ready to boot event. If the device path for the option
- starts with a BBS device path a legacy boot is attempted via the registered
- gLegacyBoot function. Short form device paths are also supported via this
- rountine. A device path starting with MEDIA_HARDDRIVE_DP, MSG_USB_WWID_DP,
- MSG_USB_CLASS_DP gets expaned out to find the first device that matches.
- If the BootOption Device Path fails the removable media boot algorithm
- is attempted (\EFI\BOOTIA32.EFI, \EFI\BOOTX64.EFI,... only one file type
- is tried per processor type)
-
- @param BootOption Boot Option to try and boot.
- On return, BootOption->Status contains the boot status.
- EFI_SUCCESS BootOption was booted
- EFI_UNSUPPORTED A BBS device path was found with no valid callback
- registered via EfiBootManagerInitialize().
- EFI_NOT_FOUND The BootOption was not found on the system
- !EFI_SUCCESS BootOption failed with this error status
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerBoot (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOption
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle;
- EFI_LOADED_IMAGE_PROTOCOL *ImageInfo;
- UINT16 Uint16;
- UINTN OptionNumber;
- UINTN OriginalOptionNumber;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Node;
- EFI_HANDLE FvHandle;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
- UINTN FileSize;
- EFI_BOOT_LOGO_PROTOCOL *BootLogo;
- EFI_EVENT LegacyBootEvent;
-
- if (BootOption == NULL) {
- return;
- }
-
- if (BootOption->FilePath == NULL || BootOption->OptionType != LoadOptionTypeBoot) {
- BootOption->Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // 1. Create Boot#### for a temporary boot if there is no match Boot#### (i.e. a boot by selected a EFI Shell using "Boot From File")
- //
- OptionNumber = BmFindBootOptionInVariable (BootOption);
- if (OptionNumber == LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- Status = BmGetFreeOptionNumber (LoadOptionTypeBoot, &Uint16);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Save the BootOption->OptionNumber to restore later
- //
- OptionNumber = Uint16;
- OriginalOptionNumber = BootOption->OptionNumber;
- BootOption->OptionNumber = OptionNumber;
- Status = EfiBootManagerLoadOptionToVariable (BootOption);
- BootOption->OptionNumber = OriginalOptionNumber;
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "[Bds] Failed to create Boot#### for a temporary boot - %r!\n", Status));
- BootOption->Status = Status;
- return ;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // 2. Set BootCurrent
- //
- Uint16 = (UINT16) OptionNumber;
- BmSetVariableAndReportStatusCodeOnError (
- L"BootCurrent",
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- &Uint16
- );
-
- //
- // 3. Signal the EVT_SIGNAL_READY_TO_BOOT event when we are about to load and execute
- // the boot option.
- //
- Node = BootOption->FilePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid, &Node, &FvHandle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && CompareGuid (
- EfiGetNameGuidFromFwVolDevicePathNode ((CONST MEDIA_FW_VOL_FILEPATH_DEVICE_PATH *) Node),
- PcdGetPtr (PcdBootManagerMenuFile)
- )) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds] Booting Boot Manager Menu.\n"));
- BmStopHotkeyService (NULL, NULL);
- } else {
- EfiSignalEventReadyToBoot();
- //
- // Report Status Code to indicate ReadyToBoot was signalled
- //
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE (EFI_PROGRESS_CODE, (EFI_SOFTWARE_DXE_BS_DRIVER | EFI_SW_DXE_BS_PC_READY_TO_BOOT_EVENT));
- //
- // 4. Repair system through DriverHealth protocol
- //
- BmRepairAllControllers ();
- }
-
- PERF_START_EX (gImageHandle, "BdsAttempt", NULL, 0, (UINT32) OptionNumber);
-
- //
- // 5. Load EFI boot option to ImageHandle
- //
- ImageHandle = NULL;
- if (DevicePathType (BootOption->FilePath) != BBS_DEVICE_PATH) {
- Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- FileBuffer = BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (BootOption->FilePath, &FilePath, &FileSize);
- DEBUG_CODE (
- if (FileBuffer != NULL && CompareMem (BootOption->FilePath, FilePath, GetDevicePathSize (FilePath)) != 0) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds] DevicePath expand: "));
- BmPrintDp (BootOption->FilePath);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " -> "));
- BmPrintDp (FilePath);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "\n"));
- }
- );
- if (BmIsLoadOptionPeHeaderValid (BootOption->OptionType, FileBuffer, FileSize)) {
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE (EFI_PROGRESS_CODE, PcdGet32 (PcdProgressCodeOsLoaderLoad));
- Status = gBS->LoadImage (
- TRUE,
- gImageHandle,
- FilePath,
- FileBuffer,
- FileSize,
- &ImageHandle
- );
- }
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (FileBuffer);
- }
- if (FilePath != NULL) {
- FreePool (FilePath);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Report Status Code to indicate that the failure to load boot option
- //
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE (
- EFI_ERROR_CODE | EFI_ERROR_MINOR,
- (EFI_SOFTWARE_DXE_BS_DRIVER | EFI_SW_DXE_BS_EC_BOOT_OPTION_LOAD_ERROR)
- );
- BootOption->Status = Status;
- return;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // 6. Adjust the different type memory page number just before booting
- // and save the updated info into the variable for next boot to use
- //
- BmSetMemoryTypeInformationVariable (
- (BOOLEAN) ((BootOption->Attributes & LOAD_OPTION_CATEGORY) == LOAD_OPTION_CATEGORY_BOOT)
- );
-
- DEBUG_CODE_BEGIN();
- if (BootOption->Description == NULL) {
- DEBUG ((DEBUG_INFO | DEBUG_LOAD, "[Bds]Booting from unknown device path\n"));
- } else {
- DEBUG ((DEBUG_INFO | DEBUG_LOAD, "[Bds]Booting %s\n", BootOption->Description));
- }
- DEBUG_CODE_END();
-
- //
- // Check to see if we should legacy BOOT. If yes then do the legacy boot
- // Write boot to OS performance data for Legacy boot
- //
- if ((DevicePathType (BootOption->FilePath) == BBS_DEVICE_PATH) && (DevicePathSubType (BootOption->FilePath) == BBS_BBS_DP)) {
- if (mBmLegacyBoot != NULL) {
- //
- // Write boot to OS performance data for legacy boot.
- //
- PERF_CODE (
- //
- // Create an event to be signalled when Legacy Boot occurs to write performance data.
- //
- Status = EfiCreateEventLegacyBootEx(
- TPL_NOTIFY,
- BmWriteBootToOsPerformanceData,
- NULL,
- &LegacyBootEvent
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- );
-
- mBmLegacyBoot (BootOption);
- } else {
- BootOption->Status = EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- PERF_END_EX (gImageHandle, "BdsAttempt", NULL, 0, (UINT32) OptionNumber);
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Provide the image with its load options
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (ImageHandle, &gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &ImageInfo);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- if (!BmIsAutoCreateBootOption (BootOption)) {
- ImageInfo->LoadOptionsSize = BootOption->OptionalDataSize;
- ImageInfo->LoadOptions = BootOption->OptionalData;
- }
-
- //
- // Clean to NULL because the image is loaded directly from the firmwares boot manager.
- //
- ImageInfo->ParentHandle = NULL;
-
- //
- // Before calling the image, enable the Watchdog Timer for 5 minutes period
- //
- gBS->SetWatchdogTimer (5 * 60, 0x0000, 0x00, NULL);
-
- //
- // Write boot to OS performance data for UEFI boot
- //
- PERF_CODE (
- BmWriteBootToOsPerformanceData (NULL, NULL);
- );
-
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE (EFI_PROGRESS_CODE, PcdGet32 (PcdProgressCodeOsLoaderStart));
-
- Status = gBS->StartImage (ImageHandle, &BootOption->ExitDataSize, &BootOption->ExitData);
- DEBUG ((DEBUG_INFO | DEBUG_LOAD, "Image Return Status = %r\n", Status));
- BootOption->Status = Status;
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Report Status Code to indicate that boot failure
- //
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE (
- EFI_ERROR_CODE | EFI_ERROR_MINOR,
- (EFI_SOFTWARE_DXE_BS_DRIVER | EFI_SW_DXE_BS_EC_BOOT_OPTION_FAILED)
- );
- }
- PERF_END_EX (gImageHandle, "BdsAttempt", NULL, 0, (UINT32) OptionNumber);
-
- //
- // Clear the Watchdog Timer after the image returns
- //
- gBS->SetWatchdogTimer (0x0000, 0x0000, 0x0000, NULL);
-
- //
- // Set Logo status invalid after trying one boot option
- //
- BootLogo = NULL;
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiBootLogoProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &BootLogo);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && (BootLogo != NULL)) {
- Status = BootLogo->SetBootLogo (BootLogo, NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
-
- //
- // Clear Boot Current
- //
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- L"BootCurrent",
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- 0,
- 0,
- NULL
- );
- //
- // Deleting variable with current variable implementation shouldn't fail.
- // When BootXXXX (e.g.: BootManagerMenu) boots BootYYYY, exiting BootYYYY causes BootCurrent deleted,
- // exiting BootXXXX causes deleting BootCurrent returns EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- //
- ASSERT (Status == EFI_SUCCESS || Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND);
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether there is a instance in BlockIoDevicePath, which contain multi device path
- instances, has the same partition node with HardDriveDevicePath device path
-
- @param BlockIoDevicePath Multi device path instances which need to check
- @param HardDriveDevicePath A device path which starts with a hard drive media
- device path.
-
- @retval TRUE There is a matched device path instance.
- @retval FALSE There is no matched device path instance.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmMatchPartitionDevicePathNode (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *BlockIoDevicePath,
- IN HARDDRIVE_DEVICE_PATH *HardDriveDevicePath
- )
-{
- HARDDRIVE_DEVICE_PATH *Node;
-
- if ((BlockIoDevicePath == NULL) || (HardDriveDevicePath == NULL)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // find the partition device path node
- //
- while (!IsDevicePathEnd (BlockIoDevicePath)) {
- if ((DevicePathType (BlockIoDevicePath) == MEDIA_DEVICE_PATH) &&
- (DevicePathSubType (BlockIoDevicePath) == MEDIA_HARDDRIVE_DP)
- ) {
- break;
- }
-
- BlockIoDevicePath = NextDevicePathNode (BlockIoDevicePath);
- }
-
- if (IsDevicePathEnd (BlockIoDevicePath)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // See if the harddrive device path in blockio matches the orig Hard Drive Node
- //
- Node = (HARDDRIVE_DEVICE_PATH *) BlockIoDevicePath;
-
- //
- // Match Signature and PartitionNumber.
- // Unused bytes in Signature are initiaized with zeros.
- //
- return (BOOLEAN) (
- (Node->PartitionNumber == HardDriveDevicePath->PartitionNumber) &&
- (Node->MBRType == HardDriveDevicePath->MBRType) &&
- (Node->SignatureType == HardDriveDevicePath->SignatureType) &&
- (CompareMem (Node->Signature, HardDriveDevicePath->Signature, sizeof (Node->Signature)) == 0)
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Enumerate all boot option descriptions and append " 2"/" 3"/... to make
- unique description.
-
- @param BootOptions Array of boot options.
- @param BootOptionCount Count of boot options.
-**/
-VOID
-BmMakeBootOptionDescriptionUnique (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOptions,
- UINTN BootOptionCount
- )
-{
- UINTN Base;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN DescriptionSize;
- UINTN MaxSuffixSize;
- BOOLEAN *Visited;
- UINTN MatchCount;
-
- if (BootOptionCount == 0) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Calculate the maximum buffer size for the number suffix.
- // The initial sizeof (CHAR16) is for the blank space before the number.
- //
- MaxSuffixSize = sizeof (CHAR16);
- for (Index = BootOptionCount; Index != 0; Index = Index / 10) {
- MaxSuffixSize += sizeof (CHAR16);
- }
-
- Visited = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (BOOLEAN) * BootOptionCount);
- ASSERT (Visited != NULL);
-
- for (Base = 0; Base < BootOptionCount; Base++) {
- if (!Visited[Base]) {
- MatchCount = 1;
- Visited[Base] = TRUE;
- DescriptionSize = StrSize (BootOptions[Base].Description);
- for (Index = Base + 1; Index < BootOptionCount; Index++) {
- if (!Visited[Index] && StrCmp (BootOptions[Base].Description, BootOptions[Index].Description) == 0) {
- Visited[Index] = TRUE;
- MatchCount++;
- FreePool (BootOptions[Index].Description);
- BootOptions[Index].Description = AllocatePool (DescriptionSize + MaxSuffixSize);
- UnicodeSPrint (
- BootOptions[Index].Description, DescriptionSize + MaxSuffixSize,
- L"%s %d",
- BootOptions[Base].Description, MatchCount
- );
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- FreePool (Visited);
-}
-
-/**
- Emuerate all possible bootable medias in the following order:
- 1. Removable BlockIo - The boot option only points to the removable media
- device, like USB key, DVD, Floppy etc.
- 2. Fixed BlockIo - The boot option only points to a Fixed blockIo device,
- like HardDisk.
- 3. Non-BlockIo SimpleFileSystem - The boot option points to a device supporting
- SimpleFileSystem Protocol, but not supporting BlockIo
- protocol.
- 4. LoadFile - The boot option points to the media supporting
- LoadFile protocol.
- Reference: UEFI Spec chapter 3.3 Boot Option Variables Default Boot Behavior
-
- @param BootOptionCount Return the boot option count which has been found.
-
- @retval Pointer to the boot option array.
-**/
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *
-BmEnumerateBootOptions (
- UINTN *BootOptionCount
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOptions;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL *BlkIo;
- UINTN Removable;
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR16 *Description;
-
- ASSERT (BootOptionCount != NULL);
-
- *BootOptionCount = 0;
- BootOptions = NULL;
-
- //
- // Parse removable block io followed by fixed block io
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
-
- for (Removable = 0; Removable < 2; Removable++) {
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handles[Index],
- &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &BlkIo
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // Skip the logical partitions
- //
- if (BlkIo->Media->LogicalPartition) {
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // Skip the fixed block io then the removable block io
- //
- if (BlkIo->Media->RemovableMedia == ((Removable == 0) ? FALSE : TRUE)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- Description = BmGetBootDescription (Handles[Index]);
- BootOptions = ReallocatePool (
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION) * (*BootOptionCount),
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION) * (*BootOptionCount + 1),
- BootOptions
- );
- ASSERT (BootOptions != NULL);
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- &BootOptions[(*BootOptionCount)++],
- LoadOptionNumberUnassigned,
- LoadOptionTypeBoot,
- LOAD_OPTION_ACTIVE,
- Description,
- DevicePathFromHandle (Handles[Index]),
- NULL,
- 0
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- FreePool (Description);
- }
- }
-
- if (HandleCount != 0) {
- FreePool (Handles);
- }
-
- //
- // Parse simple file system not based on block io
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleFileSystemProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handles[Index],
- &gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &BlkIo
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Skip if the file system handle supports a BlkIo protocol, which we've handled in above
- //
- continue;
- }
- Description = BmGetBootDescription (Handles[Index]);
- BootOptions = ReallocatePool (
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION) * (*BootOptionCount),
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION) * (*BootOptionCount + 1),
- BootOptions
- );
- ASSERT (BootOptions != NULL);
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- &BootOptions[(*BootOptionCount)++],
- LoadOptionNumberUnassigned,
- LoadOptionTypeBoot,
- LOAD_OPTION_ACTIVE,
- Description,
- DevicePathFromHandle (Handles[Index]),
- NULL,
- 0
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- FreePool (Description);
- }
-
- if (HandleCount != 0) {
- FreePool (Handles);
- }
-
- //
- // Parse load file, assuming UEFI Network boot option
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiLoadFileProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
-
- Description = BmGetBootDescription (Handles[Index]);
- BootOptions = ReallocatePool (
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION) * (*BootOptionCount),
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION) * (*BootOptionCount + 1),
- BootOptions
- );
- ASSERT (BootOptions != NULL);
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- &BootOptions[(*BootOptionCount)++],
- LoadOptionNumberUnassigned,
- LoadOptionTypeBoot,
- LOAD_OPTION_ACTIVE,
- Description,
- DevicePathFromHandle (Handles[Index]),
- NULL,
- 0
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- FreePool (Description);
- }
-
- if (HandleCount != 0) {
- FreePool (Handles);
- }
-
- BmMakeBootOptionDescriptionUnique (BootOptions, *BootOptionCount);
- return BootOptions;
-}
-
-/**
- The function enumerates all boot options, creates them and registers them in the BootOrder variable.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerRefreshAllBootOption (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *NvBootOptions;
- UINTN NvBootOptionCount;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOptions;
- UINTN BootOptionCount;
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // Optionally refresh the legacy boot option
- //
- if (mBmRefreshLegacyBootOption != NULL) {
- mBmRefreshLegacyBootOption ();
- }
-
- BootOptions = BmEnumerateBootOptions (&BootOptionCount);
- NvBootOptions = EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions (&NvBootOptionCount, LoadOptionTypeBoot);
-
- //
- // Mark the boot option as added by BDS by setting OptionalData to a special GUID
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < BootOptionCount; Index++) {
- BootOptions[Index].OptionalData = AllocateCopyPool (sizeof (EFI_GUID), &mBmAutoCreateBootOptionGuid);
- BootOptions[Index].OptionalDataSize = sizeof (EFI_GUID);
- }
-
- //
- // Remove invalid EFI boot options from NV
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < NvBootOptionCount; Index++) {
- if (((DevicePathType (NvBootOptions[Index].FilePath) != BBS_DEVICE_PATH) ||
- (DevicePathSubType (NvBootOptions[Index].FilePath) != BBS_BBS_DP)
- ) && BmIsAutoCreateBootOption (&NvBootOptions[Index])
- ) {
- //
- // Only check those added by BDS
- // so that the boot options added by end-user or OS installer won't be deleted
- //
- if (BmFindLoadOption (&NvBootOptions[Index], BootOptions, BootOptionCount) == (UINTN) -1) {
- Status = EfiBootManagerDeleteLoadOptionVariable (NvBootOptions[Index].OptionNumber, LoadOptionTypeBoot);
- //
- // Deleting variable with current variable implementation shouldn't fail.
- //
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Add new EFI boot options to NV
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < BootOptionCount; Index++) {
- if (BmFindLoadOption (&BootOptions[Index], NvBootOptions, NvBootOptionCount) == (UINTN) -1) {
- EfiBootManagerAddLoadOptionVariable (&BootOptions[Index], (UINTN) -1);
- //
- // Try best to add the boot options so continue upon failure.
- //
- }
- }
-
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (BootOptions, BootOptionCount);
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (NvBootOptions, NvBootOptionCount);
-}
-
-/**
- This function is called to create the boot option for the Boot Manager Menu.
-
- The Boot Manager Menu is shown after successfully booting a boot option.
- Assume the BootManagerMenuFile is in the same FV as the module links to this library.
-
- @param BootOption Return the boot option of the Boot Manager Menu
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully register the Boot Manager Menu.
- @retval Status Return status of gRT->SetVariable (). BootOption still points
- to the Boot Manager Menu even the Status is not EFI_SUCCESS.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmRegisterBootManagerMenu (
- OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOption
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- UINTN DescriptionLength;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- EFI_LOADED_IMAGE_PROTOCOL *LoadedImage;
- MEDIA_FW_VOL_FILEPATH_DEVICE_PATH FileNode;
-
- Status = GetSectionFromFv (
- PcdGetPtr (PcdBootManagerMenuFile),
- EFI_SECTION_USER_INTERFACE,
- 0,
- (VOID **) &Description,
- &DescriptionLength
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Description = NULL;
- }
-
- EfiInitializeFwVolDevicepathNode (&FileNode, PcdGetPtr (PcdBootManagerMenuFile));
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- gImageHandle,
- &gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &LoadedImage
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- DevicePath = AppendDevicePathNode (
- DevicePathFromHandle (LoadedImage->DeviceHandle),
- (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) &FileNode
- );
- ASSERT (DevicePath != NULL);
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- BootOption,
- LoadOptionNumberUnassigned,
- LoadOptionTypeBoot,
- LOAD_OPTION_CATEGORY_APP | LOAD_OPTION_ACTIVE | LOAD_OPTION_HIDDEN,
- (Description != NULL) ? Description : L"Boot Manager Menu",
- DevicePath,
- NULL,
- 0
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- FreePool (DevicePath);
- if (Description != NULL) {
- FreePool (Description);
- }
-
- DEBUG_CODE (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOptions;
- UINTN BootOptionCount;
-
- BootOptions = EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions (&BootOptionCount, LoadOptionTypeBoot);
- ASSERT (BmFindLoadOption (BootOption, BootOptions, BootOptionCount) == -1);
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (BootOptions, BootOptionCount);
- );
-
- return EfiBootManagerAddLoadOptionVariable (BootOption, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Return the boot option corresponding to the Boot Manager Menu.
- It may automatically create one if the boot option hasn't been created yet.
-
- @param BootOption Return the Boot Manager Menu.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The Boot Manager Menu is successfully returned.
- @retval Status Return status of gRT->SetVariable (). BootOption still points
- to the Boot Manager Menu even the Status is not EFI_SUCCESS.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerGetBootManagerMenu (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOption
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN BootOptionCount;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *BootOptions;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Node;
- EFI_HANDLE FvHandle;
-
- BootOptions = EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions (&BootOptionCount, LoadOptionTypeBoot);
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < BootOptionCount; Index++) {
- Node = BootOptions[Index].FilePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid, &Node, &FvHandle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- if (CompareGuid (
- EfiGetNameGuidFromFwVolDevicePathNode ((CONST MEDIA_FW_VOL_FILEPATH_DEVICE_PATH *) Node),
- PcdGetPtr (PcdBootManagerMenuFile)
- )
- ) {
- Status = EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- BootOption,
- BootOptions[Index].OptionNumber,
- BootOptions[Index].OptionType,
- BootOptions[Index].Attributes,
- BootOptions[Index].Description,
- BootOptions[Index].FilePath,
- BootOptions[Index].OptionalData,
- BootOptions[Index].OptionalDataSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (BootOptions, BootOptionCount);
-
- //
- // Automatically create the Boot#### for Boot Manager Menu when not found.
- //
- if (Index == BootOptionCount) {
- return BmRegisterBootManagerMenu (BootOption);
- } else {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmConnect.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmConnect.c deleted file mode 100644 index b1c94ad9d9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmConnect.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,321 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Library functions which relate with connecting the device.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-/**
- Connect all the drivers to all the controllers.
-
- This function makes sure all the current system drivers manage the correspoinding
- controllers if have. And at the same time, makes sure all the system controllers
- have driver to manage it if have.
-**/
-VOID
-BmConnectAllDriversToAllControllers (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
- UINTN Index;
-
- do {
- //
- // Connect All EFI 1.10 drivers following EFI 1.10 algorithm
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- AllHandles,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &HandleBuffer
- );
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- gBS->ConnectController (HandleBuffer[Index], NULL, NULL, TRUE);
- }
-
- if (HandleBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (HandleBuffer);
- }
-
- //
- // Check to see if it's possible to dispatch an more DXE drivers.
- // The above code may have made new DXE drivers show up.
- // If any new driver is dispatched (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) and we will try
- // the connect again.
- //
- Status = gDS->Dispatch ();
-
- } while (!EFI_ERROR (Status));
-}
-
-/**
- This function will connect all the system driver to controller
- first, and then special connect the default console, this make
- sure all the system controller available and the platform default
- console connected.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerConnectAll (
- VOID
- )
-{
- //
- // Connect the platform console first
- //
- EfiBootManagerConnectAllDefaultConsoles ();
-
- //
- // Generic way to connect all the drivers
- //
- BmConnectAllDriversToAllControllers ();
-
- //
- // Here we have the assumption that we have already had
- // platform default console
- //
- EfiBootManagerConnectAllDefaultConsoles ();
-}
-
-/**
- This function will create all handles associate with every device
- path node. If the handle associate with one device path node can not
- be created successfully, then still give chance to do the dispatch,
- which load the missing drivers if possible.
-
- @param DevicePathToConnect The device path which will be connected, it can be
- a multi-instance device path
- @param MatchingHandle Return the controller handle closest to the DevicePathToConnect
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS All handles associate with every device path node
- have been created.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is no resource to create new handles.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Create the handle associate with one device path
- node failed.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION The user has no permission to start UEFI device
- drivers on the DevicePath.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerConnectDevicePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePathToConnect,
- OUT EFI_HANDLE *MatchingHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *RemainingDevicePath;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
- EFI_HANDLE PreviousHandle;
- EFI_TPL CurrentTpl;
-
- if (DevicePathToConnect == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- CurrentTpl = EfiGetCurrentTpl ();
- //
- // Start the real work of connect with RemainingDevicePath
- //
- PreviousHandle = NULL;
- do {
- //
- // Find the handle that best matches the Device Path. If it is only a
- // partial match the remaining part of the device path is returned in
- // RemainingDevicePath.
- //
- RemainingDevicePath = DevicePathToConnect;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid, &RemainingDevicePath, &Handle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- if (Handle == PreviousHandle) {
- //
- // If no forward progress is made try invoking the Dispatcher.
- // A new FV may have been added to the system an new drivers
- // may now be found.
- // Status == EFI_SUCCESS means a driver was dispatched
- // Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND means no new drivers were dispatched
- //
- if (CurrentTpl == TPL_APPLICATION) {
- Status = gDS->Dispatch ();
- } else {
- //
- // Always return EFI_NOT_FOUND here
- // to prevent dead loop when control handle is found but connection failded case
- //
- Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- }
-
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- PreviousHandle = Handle;
- //
- // Connect all drivers that apply to Handle and RemainingDevicePath,
- // the Recursive flag is FALSE so only one level will be expanded.
- //
- // If ConnectController fails to find a driver, then still give the chance to
- // do dispatch, because partial RemainingDevicePath may be in the new FV
- //
- // 1. If the connect fail, RemainingDevicepath and handle will not
- // change, so next time will do the dispatch, then dispatch's status
- // will take effect
- // 2. If the connect success, the RemainingDevicepath and handle will
- // change, then avoid the dispatch, we have chance to continue the
- // next connection
- //
- Status = gBS->ConnectController (Handle, NULL, RemainingDevicePath, FALSE);
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND) {
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- if (MatchingHandle != NULL) {
- *MatchingHandle = Handle;
- }
- }
- }
- //
- // Loop until RemainingDevicePath is an empty device path
- //
- } while (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && !IsDevicePathEnd (RemainingDevicePath));
-
- ASSERT (EFI_ERROR (Status) || IsDevicePathEnd (RemainingDevicePath));
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will disconnect all current system handles.
-
- gBS->DisconnectController() is invoked for each handle exists in system handle buffer.
- If handle is a bus type handle, all childrens also are disconnected recursively by
- gBS->DisconnectController().
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerDisconnectAll (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINTN HandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // Disconnect all
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- AllHandles,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &HandleBuffer
- );
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- gBS->DisconnectController (HandleBuffer[Index], NULL, NULL);
- }
-
- if (HandleBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (HandleBuffer);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Connect the specific Usb device which match the short form device path,
- and whose bus is determined by Host Controller (Uhci or Ehci).
-
- @param DevicePath A short-form device path that starts with the first
- element being a USB WWID or a USB Class device
- path
-
- @return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER DevicePath is NULL pointer.
- DevicePath is not a USB device path.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS Success to connect USB device
- @return EFI_NOT_FOUND Fail to find handle for USB controller to connect.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmConnectUsbShortFormDevicePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_PCI_IO_PROTOCOL *PciIo;
- UINT8 Class[3];
- BOOLEAN AtLeastOneConnected;
-
- //
- // Check the passed in parameters
- //
- if (DevicePath == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if ((DevicePathType (DevicePath) != MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH) ||
- ((DevicePathSubType (DevicePath) != MSG_USB_CLASS_DP) && (DevicePathSubType (DevicePath) != MSG_USB_WWID_DP))
- ) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Find the usb host controller firstly, then connect with the remaining device path
- //
- AtLeastOneConnected = FALSE;
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiPciIoProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handles[Index],
- &gEfiPciIoProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &PciIo
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Check whether the Pci device is the wanted usb host controller
- //
- Status = PciIo->Pci.Read (PciIo, EfiPciIoWidthUint8, 0x09, 3, &Class);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) &&
- ((PCI_CLASS_SERIAL == Class[2]) && (PCI_CLASS_SERIAL_USB == Class[1]))
- ) {
- Status = gBS->ConnectController (
- Handles[Index],
- NULL,
- DevicePath,
- FALSE
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
- AtLeastOneConnected = TRUE;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (Handles != NULL) {
- FreePool (Handles);
- }
- }
-
- return AtLeastOneConnected ? EFI_SUCCESS : EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmConsole.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmConsole.c deleted file mode 100644 index 86b4fac424..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmConsole.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,764 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Library functions which contain all the code to connect console device.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-CHAR16 *mConVarName[] = {
- L"ConIn",
- L"ConOut",
- L"ErrOut",
- L"ConInDev",
- L"ConOutDev",
- L"ErrOutDev"
-};
-
-/**
- Search out the video controller.
-
- @return PCI device path of the video controller.
-**/
-EFI_HANDLE
-BmGetVideoController (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN RootBridgeHandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *RootBridgeHandleBuffer;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
- UINTN RootBridgeIndex;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_HANDLE VideoController;
- EFI_PCI_IO_PROTOCOL *PciIo;
- PCI_TYPE00 Pci;
-
- //
- // Make all the PCI_IO protocols show up
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &RootBridgeHandleCount,
- &RootBridgeHandleBuffer
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || (RootBridgeHandleCount == 0)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- VideoController = NULL;
- for (RootBridgeIndex = 0; RootBridgeIndex < RootBridgeHandleCount; RootBridgeIndex++) {
- gBS->ConnectController (RootBridgeHandleBuffer[RootBridgeIndex], NULL, NULL, FALSE);
-
- //
- // Start to check all the pci io to find the first video controller
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiPciIoProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &HandleBuffer
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (HandleBuffer[Index], &gEfiPciIoProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &PciIo);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Check for all video controller
- //
- Status = PciIo->Pci.Read (
- PciIo,
- EfiPciIoWidthUint32,
- 0,
- sizeof (Pci) / sizeof (UINT32),
- &Pci
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && IS_PCI_VGA (&Pci)) {
- // TODO: use IS_PCI_DISPLAY??
- VideoController = HandleBuffer[Index];
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- FreePool (HandleBuffer);
-
- if (VideoController != NULL) {
- break;
- }
- }
- FreePool (RootBridgeHandleBuffer);
-
- return VideoController;
-}
-
-/**
- Query all the children of VideoController and return the device paths of all the
- children that support GraphicsOutput protocol.
-
- @param VideoController PCI handle of video controller.
-
- @return Device paths of all the children that support GraphicsOutput protocol.
-**/
-EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerGetGopDevicePath (
- IN EFI_HANDLE VideoController
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_GUID **ProtocolBuffer;
- UINTN ProtocolBufferCount;
- UINTN ProtocolIndex;
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_INFORMATION_ENTRY *OpenInfoBuffer;
- UINTN EntryCount;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Next;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Previous;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *GopPool;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *ReturnDevicePath;
-
-
- Status = gBS->ProtocolsPerHandle (
- VideoController,
- &ProtocolBuffer,
- &ProtocolBufferCount
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- GopPool = NULL;
-
- for (ProtocolIndex = 0; ProtocolIndex < ProtocolBufferCount; ProtocolIndex++) {
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocolInformation (
- VideoController,
- ProtocolBuffer[ProtocolIndex],
- &OpenInfoBuffer,
- &EntryCount
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < EntryCount; Index++) {
- //
- // Query all the children
- //
- if ((OpenInfoBuffer[Index].Attributes & EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_CHILD_CONTROLLER) != 0) {
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- OpenInfoBuffer[Index].ControllerHandle,
- &gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &DevicePath,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_GET_PROTOCOL
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- Previous = NULL;
- for (Next = DevicePath; !IsDevicePathEnd (Next); Next = NextDevicePathNode (Next)) {
- Previous = Next;
- }
- ASSERT (Previous != NULL);
-
- if (DevicePathType (Previous) == ACPI_DEVICE_PATH && DevicePathSubType (Previous) == ACPI_ADR_DP) {
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- OpenInfoBuffer[Index].ControllerHandle,
- &gEfiGraphicsOutputProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_TEST_PROTOCOL
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Append the device path to GOP pool when there is GOP protocol installed.
- //
- TempDevicePath = GopPool;
- GopPool = AppendDevicePathInstance (GopPool, DevicePath);
- gBS->FreePool (TempDevicePath);
- }
- }
-
- if (DevicePathType (Previous) == HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH && DevicePathSubType (Previous) == HW_CONTROLLER_DP) {
- //
- // Recursively look for GOP child in this frame buffer handle
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds] Looking for GOP child deeper ... \n"));
- TempDevicePath = GopPool;
- ReturnDevicePath = EfiBootManagerGetGopDevicePath (OpenInfoBuffer[Index].ControllerHandle);
- GopPool = AppendDevicePathInstance (GopPool, ReturnDevicePath);
- gBS->FreePool (ReturnDevicePath);
- gBS->FreePool (TempDevicePath);
- }
- }
- }
-
- FreePool (OpenInfoBuffer);
- }
-
- FreePool (ProtocolBuffer);
-
- return GopPool;
-}
-
-/**
- Connect the platform active active video controller.
-
- @param VideoController PCI handle of video controller.
-
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND There is no active video controller.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The video controller is connected.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerConnectVideoController (
- EFI_HANDLE VideoController OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Gop;
-
- if (VideoController == NULL) {
- //
- // Get the platform vga device
- //
- VideoController = BmGetVideoController ();
- }
-
- if (VideoController == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // Try to connect the PCI device path, so that GOP dirver could start on this
- // device and create child handles with GraphicsOutput Protocol installed
- // on them, then we get device paths of these child handles and select
- // them as possible console device.
- //
- gBS->ConnectController (VideoController, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
-
- Gop = EfiBootManagerGetGopDevicePath (VideoController);
- if (Gop == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- EfiBootManagerUpdateConsoleVariable (ConOut, Gop, NULL);
- FreePool (Gop);
-
- //
- // Necessary for ConPlatform and ConSplitter driver to start up again after ConOut is updated.
- //
- return gBS->ConnectController (VideoController, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
-}
-
-/**
- Fill console handle in System Table if there are no valid console handle in.
-
- Firstly, check the validation of console handle in System Table. If it is invalid,
- update it by the first console device handle from EFI console variable.
-
- @param VarName The name of the EFI console variable.
- @param ConsoleGuid Specified Console protocol GUID.
- @param ConsoleHandle On IN, console handle in System Table to be checked.
- On OUT, new console handle in system table.
- @param ProtocolInterface On IN, console protocol on console handle in System Table to be checked.
- On OUT, new console protocol on new console handle in system table.
-
- @retval TRUE System Table has been updated.
- @retval FALSE System Table hasn't been updated.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmUpdateSystemTableConsole (
- IN CHAR16 *VarName,
- IN EFI_GUID *ConsoleGuid,
- IN OUT EFI_HANDLE *ConsoleHandle,
- IN OUT VOID **ProtocolInterface
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN DevicePathSize;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FullDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *VarConsole;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Instance;
- VOID *Interface;
- EFI_HANDLE NewHandle;
- EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL *TextOut;
-
- ASSERT (VarName != NULL);
- ASSERT (ConsoleHandle != NULL);
- ASSERT (ConsoleGuid != NULL);
- ASSERT (ProtocolInterface != NULL);
-
- if (*ConsoleHandle != NULL) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- *ConsoleHandle,
- ConsoleGuid,
- &Interface
- );
- if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS && Interface == *ProtocolInterface) {
- //
- // If ConsoleHandle is valid and console protocol on this handle also
- // also matched, just return.
- //
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Get all possible consoles device path from EFI variable
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (VarName, (VOID **) &VarConsole, NULL);
- if (VarConsole == NULL) {
- //
- // If there is no any console device, just return.
- //
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- FullDevicePath = VarConsole;
-
- do {
- //
- // Check every instance of the console variable
- //
- Instance = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&VarConsole, &DevicePathSize);
- if (Instance == NULL) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "[Bds] No valid console instance is found for %s!\n", VarName));
- // We should not ASSERT when all the console devices are removed.
- // ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (EFI_NOT_FOUND);
- FreePool (FullDevicePath);
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Find console device handle by device path instance
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (
- ConsoleGuid,
- &Instance,
- &NewHandle
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Get the console protocol on this console device handle
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- NewHandle,
- ConsoleGuid,
- &Interface
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Update new console handle in System Table.
- //
- *ConsoleHandle = NewHandle;
- *ProtocolInterface = Interface;
- if (CompareGuid (ConsoleGuid, &gEfiSimpleTextOutProtocolGuid)) {
- //
- // If it is console out device, set console mode 80x25 if current mode is invalid.
- //
- TextOut = (EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL *) Interface;
- if (TextOut->Mode->Mode == -1) {
- TextOut->SetMode (TextOut, 0);
- }
- }
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- } while (Instance != NULL);
-
- //
- // No any available console devcie found.
- //
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- This function updates the console variable based on ConVarName. It can
- add or remove one specific console device path from the variable
-
- @param ConsoleType ConIn, ConOut, ErrOut, ConInDev, ConOutDev or ErrOutDev.
- @param CustomizedConDevicePath The console device path to be added to
- the console variable. Cannot be multi-instance.
- @param ExclusiveDevicePath The console device path to be removed
- from the console variable. Cannot be multi-instance.
-
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The added device path is the same as a removed one.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully added or removed the device path from the
- console variable.
- @retval others Return status of RT->SetVariable().
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerUpdateConsoleVariable (
- IN CONSOLE_TYPE ConsoleType,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *CustomizedConDevicePath,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *ExclusiveDevicePath
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *VarConsole;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *NewDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempNewDevicePath;
-
- if (ConsoleType >= sizeof (mConVarName) / sizeof (mConVarName[0])) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Notes: check the device path point, here should check
- // with compare memory
- //
- if (CustomizedConDevicePath == ExclusiveDevicePath) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
- //
- // Delete the ExclusiveDevicePath from current default console
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (mConVarName[ConsoleType], (VOID **) &VarConsole, NULL);
- //
- // Initialize NewDevicePath
- //
- NewDevicePath = VarConsole;
-
- //
- // If ExclusiveDevicePath is even the part of the instance in VarConsole, delete it.
- // In the end, NewDevicePath is the final device path.
- //
- if (ExclusiveDevicePath != NULL && VarConsole != NULL) {
- NewDevicePath = BmDelPartMatchInstance (VarConsole, ExclusiveDevicePath);
- }
- //
- // Try to append customized device path to NewDevicePath.
- //
- if (CustomizedConDevicePath != NULL) {
- if (!BmMatchDevicePaths (NewDevicePath, CustomizedConDevicePath)) {
- //
- // Check if there is part of CustomizedConDevicePath in NewDevicePath, delete it.
- //
- NewDevicePath = BmDelPartMatchInstance (NewDevicePath, CustomizedConDevicePath);
- //
- // In the first check, the default console variable will be _ModuleEntryPoint,
- // just append current customized device path
- //
- TempNewDevicePath = NewDevicePath;
- NewDevicePath = AppendDevicePathInstance (NewDevicePath, CustomizedConDevicePath);
- if (TempNewDevicePath != NULL) {
- FreePool(TempNewDevicePath);
- }
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Finally, Update the variable of the default console by NewDevicePath
- //
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- mConVarName[ConsoleType],
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS
- | ((ConsoleType < ConInDev) ? EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE : 0),
- GetDevicePathSize (NewDevicePath),
- NewDevicePath
- );
-
- if (VarConsole == NewDevicePath) {
- if (VarConsole != NULL) {
- FreePool(VarConsole);
- }
- } else {
- if (VarConsole != NULL) {
- FreePool(VarConsole);
- }
- if (NewDevicePath != NULL) {
- FreePool(NewDevicePath);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Connect the console device base on the variable ConsoleType.
-
- @param ConsoleType ConIn, ConOut or ErrOut.
-
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND There is not any console devices connected
- success
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Success connect any one instance of the console
- device path base on the variable ConVarName.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerConnectConsoleVariable (
- IN CONSOLE_TYPE ConsoleType
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *StartDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Instance;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Next;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *CopyOfDevicePath;
- UINTN Size;
- BOOLEAN DeviceExist;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
-
- if ((ConsoleType != ConIn) && (ConsoleType != ConOut) && (ConsoleType != ErrOut)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- DeviceExist = FALSE;
- Handle = NULL;
-
- //
- // Check if the console variable exist
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (mConVarName[ConsoleType], (VOID **) &StartDevicePath, NULL);
- if (StartDevicePath == NULL) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- CopyOfDevicePath = StartDevicePath;
- do {
- //
- // Check every instance of the console variable
- //
- Instance = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&CopyOfDevicePath, &Size);
- if (Instance == NULL) {
- FreePool (StartDevicePath);
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- Next = Instance;
- while (!IsDevicePathEndType (Next)) {
- Next = NextDevicePathNode (Next);
- }
-
- SetDevicePathEndNode (Next);
- //
- // Connect the USB console
- // USB console device path is a short-form device path that
- // starts with the first element being a USB WWID
- // or a USB Class device path
- //
- if ((DevicePathType (Instance) == MESSAGING_DEVICE_PATH) &&
- ((DevicePathSubType (Instance) == MSG_USB_CLASS_DP) || (DevicePathSubType (Instance) == MSG_USB_WWID_DP))
- ) {
- Status = BmConnectUsbShortFormDevicePath (Instance);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DeviceExist = TRUE;
- }
- } else {
- for (Next = Instance; !IsDevicePathEnd (Next); Next = NextDevicePathNode (Next)) {
- if (DevicePathType (Next) == ACPI_DEVICE_PATH && DevicePathSubType (Next) == ACPI_ADR_DP) {
- break;
- } else if (DevicePathType (Next) == HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH &&
- DevicePathSubType (Next) == HW_CONTROLLER_DP &&
- DevicePathType (NextDevicePathNode (Next)) == ACPI_DEVICE_PATH &&
- DevicePathSubType (NextDevicePathNode (Next)) == ACPI_ADR_DP
- ) {
- break;
- }
- }
- if (!IsDevicePathEnd (Next)) {
- //
- // For GOP device path, start the video driver with NULL remaining device path
- //
- SetDevicePathEndNode (Next);
- Status = EfiBootManagerConnectDevicePath (Instance, &Handle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- gBS->ConnectController (Handle, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
- }
- } else {
- Status = EfiBootManagerConnectDevicePath (Instance, NULL);
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Delete the instance from the console varialbe
- //
- EfiBootManagerUpdateConsoleVariable (ConsoleType, NULL, Instance);
- } else {
- DeviceExist = TRUE;
- }
- }
- FreePool(Instance);
- } while (CopyOfDevicePath != NULL);
-
- FreePool (StartDevicePath);
-
- if (!DeviceExist) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- This function will search every input/output device in current system,
- and make every input/output device as potential console device.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerConnectAllConsoles (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *ConDevicePath;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
-
- Index = 0;
- HandleCount = 0;
- HandleBuffer = NULL;
- ConDevicePath = NULL;
-
- //
- // Update all the console variables
- //
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleTextInProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &HandleBuffer
- );
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- gBS->HandleProtocol (
- HandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &ConDevicePath
- );
- EfiBootManagerUpdateConsoleVariable (ConIn, ConDevicePath, NULL);
- }
-
- if (HandleBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool(HandleBuffer);
- HandleBuffer = NULL;
- }
-
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleTextOutProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &HandleBuffer
- );
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- gBS->HandleProtocol (
- HandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &ConDevicePath
- );
- EfiBootManagerUpdateConsoleVariable (ConOut, ConDevicePath, NULL);
- EfiBootManagerUpdateConsoleVariable (ErrOut, ConDevicePath, NULL);
- }
-
- if (HandleBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool(HandleBuffer);
- }
-
- //
- // Connect all console variables
- //
- EfiBootManagerConnectAllDefaultConsoles ();
-}
-
-
-/**
- This function will connect all the console devices base on the console
- device variable ConIn, ConOut and ErrOut.
-
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR All the consoles were not connected due to an error.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Success connect any one instance of the console
- device path base on the variable ConVarName.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerConnectAllDefaultConsoles (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- BOOLEAN OneConnected;
- BOOLEAN SystemTableUpdated;
-
- OneConnected = FALSE;
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerConnectConsoleVariable (ConOut);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- OneConnected = TRUE;
- }
- PERF_START (NULL, "ConOutReady", "BDS", 1);
- PERF_END (NULL, "ConOutReady", "BDS", 0);
-
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerConnectConsoleVariable (ConIn);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- OneConnected = TRUE;
- }
- PERF_START (NULL, "ConInReady", "BDS", 1);
- PERF_END (NULL, "ConInReady", "BDS", 0);
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerConnectConsoleVariable (ErrOut);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- OneConnected = TRUE;
- }
- PERF_START (NULL, "ErrOutReady", "BDS", 1);
- PERF_END (NULL, "ErrOutReady", "BDS", 0);
-
- SystemTableUpdated = FALSE;
- //
- // Fill console handles in System Table if no console device assignd.
- //
- if (BmUpdateSystemTableConsole (L"ConIn", &gEfiSimpleTextInProtocolGuid, &gST->ConsoleInHandle, (VOID **) &gST->ConIn)) {
- SystemTableUpdated = TRUE;
- }
- if (BmUpdateSystemTableConsole (L"ConOut", &gEfiSimpleTextOutProtocolGuid, &gST->ConsoleOutHandle, (VOID **) &gST->ConOut)) {
- SystemTableUpdated = TRUE;
- }
- if (BmUpdateSystemTableConsole (L"ErrOut", &gEfiSimpleTextOutProtocolGuid, &gST->StandardErrorHandle, (VOID **) &gST->StdErr)) {
- SystemTableUpdated = TRUE;
- }
-
- if (SystemTableUpdated) {
- //
- // Update the CRC32 in the EFI System Table header
- //
- gST->Hdr.CRC32 = 0;
- gBS->CalculateCrc32 (
- (UINT8 *) &gST->Hdr,
- gST->Hdr.HeaderSize,
- &gST->Hdr.CRC32
- );
- }
-
- return OneConnected ? EFI_SUCCESS : EFI_DEVICE_ERROR;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmDriverHealth.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmDriverHealth.c deleted file mode 100644 index bffbedaf84..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmDriverHealth.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,576 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Library functions which relates with driver health.
-
-(C) Copyright 2015 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P.<BR>
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED
- CHAR16 *mBmHealthStatusText[] = {
- L"Healthy",
- L"Repair Required",
- L"Configuration Required",
- L"Failed",
- L"Reconnect Required",
- L"Reboot Required"
- };
-
-/**
- Return the controller name.
-
- @param DriverHealthHandle The handle on which the Driver Health protocol instance is retrieved.
- @param ControllerHandle The handle of a controller that the driver specified by DriverBindingHandle is managing.
- This handle specifies the controller whose name is to be returned.
- @param ChildHandle The handle of the child controller to retrieve the name of. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL. It will be NULL for device drivers.
- It will also be NULL for bus drivers that attempt to retrieve the name
- of the bus controller. It will not be NULL for a bus driver that attempts
- to retrieve the name of a child controller.
-
- @return A pointer to the Unicode string to return. This Unicode string is the name of the controller
- specified by ControllerHandle and ChildHandle.
-**/
-CHAR16 *
-BmGetControllerName (
- IN EFI_HANDLE DriverHealthHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ControllerHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ChildHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- CHAR16 *ControllerName;
- CHAR8 *LanguageVariable;
- CHAR8 *BestLanguage;
- BOOLEAN Iso639Language;
- EFI_COMPONENT_NAME_PROTOCOL *ComponentName;
-
- ControllerName = NULL;
-
- //
- // Locate Component Name (2) protocol on the driver binging handle.
- //
- Iso639Language = FALSE;
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DriverHealthHandle,
- &gEfiComponentName2ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &ComponentName
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DriverHealthHandle,
- &gEfiComponentNameProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &ComponentName
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Iso639Language = TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (Iso639Language ? L"Lang" : L"PlatformLang", (VOID**)&LanguageVariable, NULL);
- BestLanguage = GetBestLanguage(
- ComponentName->SupportedLanguages,
- Iso639Language,
- (LanguageVariable != NULL) ? LanguageVariable : "",
- Iso639Language ? "eng" : "en-US",
- NULL
- );
- if (LanguageVariable != NULL) {
- FreePool (LanguageVariable);
- }
-
- Status = ComponentName->GetControllerName (
- ComponentName,
- ControllerHandle,
- ChildHandle,
- BestLanguage,
- &ControllerName
- );
- }
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return AllocateCopyPool (StrSize (ControllerName), ControllerName);
- } else {
- return ConvertDevicePathToText (
- DevicePathFromHandle (ChildHandle != NULL ? ChildHandle : ControllerHandle),
- FALSE,
- FALSE
- );
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Display a set of messages returned by the GetHealthStatus () service of the EFI Driver Health Protocol
-
- @param DriverHealthInfo Pointer to the Driver Health information entry.
-**/
-VOID
-BmDisplayMessages (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO *DriverHealthInfo
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_STRING String;
- CHAR16 *ControllerName;
-
- if (DriverHealthInfo->MessageList == NULL ||
- DriverHealthInfo->MessageList[0].HiiHandle == NULL) {
- return;
- }
-
- ControllerName = BmGetControllerName (
- DriverHealthInfo->DriverHealthHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo->ControllerHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo->ChildHandle
- );
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Controller: %s\n", ControllerName));
- Print (L"Controller: %s\n", ControllerName);
- for (Index = 0; DriverHealthInfo->MessageList[Index].HiiHandle != NULL; Index++) {
- String = HiiGetString (
- DriverHealthInfo->MessageList[Index].HiiHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo->MessageList[Index].StringId,
- NULL
- );
- if (String != NULL) {
- Print (L" %s\n", String);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " %s\n", String));
- FreePool (String);
- }
- }
-
- if (ControllerName != NULL) {
- FreePool (ControllerName);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- The repair notify function.
- @param Value A value between 0 and Limit that identifies the current progress
- of the repair operation.
- @param Limit The maximum value of Value for the current repair operation.
- If Limit is 0, then the completion progress is indeterminate.
- For example, a driver that wants to specify progress in percent
- would use a Limit value of 100.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully return from the notify function.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-BmRepairNotify (
- IN UINTN Value,
- IN UINTN Limit
- )
-{
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[BDS]RepairNotify: %d/%d\n", Value, Limit));
- Print (L"[BDS]RepairNotify: %d/%d\n", Value, Limit);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Collect the Driver Health status of a single controller.
-
- @param DriverHealthInfo A pointer to the array containing all of the platform driver health information.
- @param Count Return the updated array count.
- @param DriverHealthHandle The handle on which the Driver Health protocol instance is retrieved.
- @param ControllerHandle The handle of the controller..
- @param ChildHandle The handle of the child controller to retrieve the health
- status on. This is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval Status The status returned from GetHealthStatus.
- @retval EFI_ABORTED The health status is healthy so no further query is needed.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmGetSingleControllerHealthStatus (
- IN OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO **DriverHealthInfo,
- IN OUT UINTN *Count,
- IN EFI_HANDLE DriverHealthHandle,
- IN EFI_HANDLE ControllerHandle, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_HANDLE ChildHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_DRIVER_HEALTH_PROTOCOL *DriverHealth;
- EFI_DRIVER_HEALTH_HII_MESSAGE *MessageList;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE FormHiiHandle;
- EFI_DRIVER_HEALTH_STATUS HealthStatus;
-
- ASSERT (DriverHealthHandle != NULL);
- //
- // Retrieve the Driver Health Protocol from DriverHandle
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DriverHealthHandle,
- &gEfiDriverHealthProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &DriverHealth
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
-
- if (ControllerHandle == NULL) {
- //
- // If ControllerHandle is NULL, the return the cumulative health status of the driver
- //
- Status = DriverHealth->GetHealthStatus (DriverHealth, NULL, NULL, &HealthStatus, NULL, NULL);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && HealthStatus == EfiDriverHealthStatusHealthy) {
- *DriverHealthInfo = ReallocatePool (
- (*Count) * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO),
- (*Count + 1) * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO),
- *DriverHealthInfo
- );
- ASSERT (*DriverHealthInfo != NULL);
-
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].DriverHealthHandle = DriverHealthHandle;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].DriverHealth = DriverHealth;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].HealthStatus = HealthStatus;
-
- *Count = *Count + 1;
-
- Status = EFI_ABORTED;
- }
- return Status;
- }
-
- MessageList = NULL;
- FormHiiHandle = NULL;
-
- //
- // Collect the health status with the optional HII message list
- //
- Status = DriverHealth->GetHealthStatus (DriverHealth, ControllerHandle, ChildHandle, &HealthStatus, &MessageList, &FormHiiHandle);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- *DriverHealthInfo = ReallocatePool (
- (*Count) * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO),
- (*Count + 1) * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO),
- *DriverHealthInfo
- );
- ASSERT (*DriverHealthInfo != NULL);
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].DriverHealth = DriverHealth;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].DriverHealthHandle = DriverHealthHandle;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].ControllerHandle = ControllerHandle;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].ChildHandle = ChildHandle;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].HiiHandle = FormHiiHandle;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].MessageList = MessageList;
- (*DriverHealthInfo)[*Count].HealthStatus = HealthStatus;
-
- *Count = *Count + 1;
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Return all the Driver Health information.
-
- When the cumulative health status of all the controllers managed by the
- driver who produces the EFI_DRIVER_HEALTH_PROTOCOL is healthy, only one
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO entry is created for such
- EFI_DRIVER_HEALTH_PROTOCOL instance.
- Otherwise, every controller creates one EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO
- entry. Additionally every child controller creates one
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO entry if the driver is a bus driver.
-
- @param Count Return the count of the Driver Health information.
-
- @retval NULL No Driver Health information is returned.
- @retval !NULL Pointer to the Driver Health information array.
-**/
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO *
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerGetDriverHealthInfo (
- UINTN *Count
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN NumHandles;
- EFI_HANDLE *DriverHealthHandles;
- UINTN DriverHealthIndex;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- UINTN ControllerIndex;
- UINTN ChildIndex;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO *DriverHealthInfo;
-
- //
- // Initialize local variables
- //
- *Count = 0;
- DriverHealthInfo = NULL;
- Handles = NULL;
- DriverHealthHandles = NULL;
- NumHandles = 0;
- HandleCount = 0;
-
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiDriverHealthProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &NumHandles,
- &DriverHealthHandles
- );
-
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND || NumHandles == 0) {
- //
- // If there are no Driver Health Protocols handles, then return EFI_NOT_FOUND
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- ASSERT (DriverHealthHandles != NULL);
-
- //
- // Check the health status of all controllers in the platform
- // Start by looping through all the Driver Health Protocol handles in the handle database
- //
- for (DriverHealthIndex = 0; DriverHealthIndex < NumHandles; DriverHealthIndex++) {
- //
- // Get the cumulative health status of the driver
- //
- Status = BmGetSingleControllerHealthStatus (&DriverHealthInfo, Count, DriverHealthHandles[DriverHealthIndex], NULL, NULL);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // See if the list of all handles in the handle database has been retrieved
- //
- //
- if (Handles == NULL) {
- //
- // Retrieve the list of all handles from the handle database
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- AllHandles,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- }
- //
- // Loop through all the controller handles in the handle database
- //
- for (ControllerIndex = 0; ControllerIndex < HandleCount; ControllerIndex++) {
- Status = BmGetSingleControllerHealthStatus (&DriverHealthInfo, Count, DriverHealthHandles[DriverHealthIndex], Handles[ControllerIndex], NULL);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // Loop through all the child handles in the handle database
- //
- for (ChildIndex = 0; ChildIndex < HandleCount; ChildIndex++) {
- Status = BmGetSingleControllerHealthStatus (&DriverHealthInfo, Count, DriverHealthHandles[DriverHealthIndex], Handles[ControllerIndex], Handles[ChildIndex]);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- continue;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
-
- if (Handles != NULL) {
- FreePool (Handles);
- }
- if (DriverHealthHandles != NULL) {
- FreePool (DriverHealthHandles);
- }
-
- return DriverHealthInfo;
-}
-
-/**
- Free the Driver Health information array.
-
- @param DriverHealthInfo Pointer to array of the Driver Health information.
- @param Count Count of the array.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The array is freed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The array is NULL.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerFreeDriverHealthInfo (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO *DriverHealthInfo,
- UINTN Count
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Count; Index++) {
- if (DriverHealthInfo[Index].MessageList != NULL) {
- FreePool (DriverHealthInfo[Index].MessageList);
- }
- }
- return gBS->FreePool (DriverHealthInfo);
-}
-
-/**
- Repair all the controllers according to the Driver Health status queried.
-**/
-VOID
-BmRepairAllControllers (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_DRIVER_HEALTH_INFO *DriverHealthInfo;
- EFI_DRIVER_HEALTH_STATUS HealthStatus;
- UINTN Count;
- UINTN Index;
- BOOLEAN RepairRequired;
- BOOLEAN ConfigurationRequired;
- BOOLEAN ReconnectRequired;
- BOOLEAN RebootRequired;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE *HiiHandles;
- EFI_FORM_BROWSER2_PROTOCOL *FormBrowser2;
-
- //
- // Configure PcdDriverHealthConfigureForm to ZeroGuid to disable driver health check.
- //
- if (CompareGuid (PcdGetPtr (PcdDriverHealthConfigureForm), &gZeroGuid)) {
- return;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiFormBrowser2ProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &FormBrowser2);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- do {
- RepairRequired = FALSE;
- ConfigurationRequired = FALSE;
-
- //
- // Deal with Repair Required
- //
- DriverHealthInfo = EfiBootManagerGetDriverHealthInfo (&Count);
- for (Index = 0; Index < Count; Index++) {
- if (DriverHealthInfo[Index].HealthStatus == EfiDriverHealthStatusConfigurationRequired) {
- ConfigurationRequired = TRUE;
- }
-
- if (DriverHealthInfo[Index].HealthStatus == EfiDriverHealthStatusRepairRequired) {
- RepairRequired = TRUE;
-
- BmDisplayMessages (&DriverHealthInfo[Index]);
-
- Status = DriverHealthInfo[Index].DriverHealth->Repair (
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].DriverHealth,
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].ControllerHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].ChildHandle,
- BmRepairNotify
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && !ConfigurationRequired) {
- Status = DriverHealthInfo[Index].DriverHealth->GetHealthStatus (
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].DriverHealth,
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].ControllerHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].ChildHandle,
- &HealthStatus,
- NULL,
- NULL
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status) && (HealthStatus == EfiDriverHealthStatusConfigurationRequired)) {
- ConfigurationRequired = TRUE;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (ConfigurationRequired) {
- HiiHandles = HiiGetHiiHandles (NULL);
- if (HiiHandles != NULL) {
- for (Index = 0; HiiHandles[Index] != NULL; Index++) {
- Status = FormBrowser2->SendForm (
- FormBrowser2,
- &HiiHandles[Index],
- 1,
- PcdGetPtr (PcdDriverHealthConfigureForm),
- 0,
- NULL,
- NULL
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- break;
- }
- }
- FreePool (HiiHandles);
- }
- }
-
- EfiBootManagerFreeDriverHealthInfo (DriverHealthInfo, Count);
- } while (RepairRequired || ConfigurationRequired);
-
- RebootRequired = FALSE;
- ReconnectRequired = FALSE;
- DriverHealthInfo = EfiBootManagerGetDriverHealthInfo (&Count);
- for (Index = 0; Index < Count; Index++) {
-
- BmDisplayMessages (&DriverHealthInfo[Index]);
-
- if (DriverHealthInfo[Index].HealthStatus == EfiDriverHealthStatusReconnectRequired) {
- Status = gBS->DisconnectController (DriverHealthInfo[Index].ControllerHandle, NULL, NULL);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Disconnect failed. Need to promote reconnect to a reboot.
- //
- RebootRequired = TRUE;
- } else {
- gBS->ConnectController (DriverHealthInfo[Index].ControllerHandle, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
- ReconnectRequired = TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- if (DriverHealthInfo[Index].HealthStatus == EfiDriverHealthStatusRebootRequired) {
- RebootRequired = TRUE;
- }
- }
- EfiBootManagerFreeDriverHealthInfo (DriverHealthInfo, Count);
-
-
- if (ReconnectRequired) {
- BmRepairAllControllers ();
- }
-
- DEBUG_CODE (
- CHAR16 *ControllerName;
-
- DriverHealthInfo = EfiBootManagerGetDriverHealthInfo (&Count);
- for (Index = 0; Index < Count; Index++) {
- ControllerName = BmGetControllerName (
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].DriverHealthHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].ControllerHandle,
- DriverHealthInfo[Index].ChildHandle
- );
- DEBUG ((
- EFI_D_INFO,
- "%02d: %s - %s\n",
- Index,
- ControllerName,
- mBmHealthStatusText[DriverHealthInfo[Index].HealthStatus]
- ));
- if (ControllerName != NULL) {
- FreePool (ControllerName);
- }
- }
- EfiBootManagerFreeDriverHealthInfo (DriverHealthInfo, Count);
- );
-
- if (RebootRequired) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[BDS] One of the Driver Health instances requires rebooting.\n"));
- gRT->ResetSystem (EfiResetWarm, EFI_SUCCESS, 0, NULL);
- }
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmHotkey.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmHotkey.c deleted file mode 100644 index 8d398fb4c6..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmHotkey.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1101 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Hotkey library functions.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-//
-// Lock for linked list
-//
-EFI_LOCK mBmHotkeyLock = EFI_INITIALIZE_LOCK_VARIABLE (TPL_NOTIFY);
-LIST_ENTRY mBmHotkeyList = INITIALIZE_LIST_HEAD_VARIABLE (mBmHotkeyList);
-EFI_EVENT mBmHotkeyTriggered = NULL;
-BOOLEAN mBmHotkeyServiceStarted = FALSE;
-UINTN mBmHotkeySupportCount = 0;
-
-//
-// Set OptionNumber as unassigned value to indicate the option isn't initialized
-//
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION mBmHotkeyBootOption = { LoadOptionNumberUnassigned };
-
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *mBmContinueKeyOption = NULL;
-VOID *mBmTxtInExRegistration = NULL;
-
-/**
-
- Check whether the input key option is valid.
-
- @param KeyOption Input key option info.
-
- @retval TRUE Input key option is valid.
- @retval FALSE Input key option is not valid.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsKeyOptionValid (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOption
-)
-{
- UINT16 OptionName[sizeof (L"Boot####")];
- UINT8 *BootOption;
- UINTN BootOptionSize;
- UINT32 Crc;
-
- //
- // Check whether corresponding Boot Option exist
- //
- UnicodeSPrint (OptionName, sizeof (OptionName), L"Boot%04x", KeyOption->BootOption);
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (OptionName, (VOID **) &BootOption, &BootOptionSize);
-
- if (BootOption == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Check CRC for Boot Option
- //
- gBS->CalculateCrc32 (BootOption, BootOptionSize, &Crc);
- FreePool (BootOption);
-
- return (BOOLEAN) (KeyOption->BootOptionCrc == Crc);
-}
-
-/**
-
- Check whether the input variable is an key option variable.
-
- @param Name Input variable name.
- @param Guid Input variable guid.
- @param OptionNumber The option number of this key option variable.
-
- @retval TRUE Input variable is a key option variable.
- @retval FALSE Input variable is not a key option variable.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsKeyOptionVariable (
- CHAR16 *Name,
- EFI_GUID *Guid,
- UINT16 *OptionNumber
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- if (!CompareGuid (Guid, &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid) ||
- (StrSize (Name) != sizeof (L"Key####")) ||
- (StrnCmp (Name, L"Key", 3) != 0)
- ) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- *OptionNumber = 0;
- for (Index = 3; Index < 7; Index++) {
- if ((Name[Index] >= L'0') && (Name[Index] <= L'9')) {
- *OptionNumber = *OptionNumber * 16 + Name[Index] - L'0';
- } else if ((Name[Index] >= L'A') && (Name[Index] <= L'F')) {
- *OptionNumber = *OptionNumber * 16 + Name[Index] - L'A' + 10;
- } else {
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Return the buffer size of the EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION data.
-
- @param KeyOption The input key option info.
-
- @retval The buffer size of the key option data.
-**/
-UINTN
-BmSizeOfKeyOption (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOption
- )
-{
- return OFFSET_OF (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION, Keys)
- + KeyOption->KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount * sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY);
-}
-
-/**
- Return the array of key options.
-
- @param Count Return the number of key options.
-
- @retval NULL No key option.
- @retval Other Pointer to the key options.
-**/
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *
-BmGetKeyOptions (
- OUT UINTN *Count
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR16 *Name;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- UINTN NameSize;
- UINTN NewNameSize;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOptions;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOption;
- UINT16 OptionNumber;
-
- if (Count == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- *Count = 0;
- KeyOptions = NULL;
-
- NameSize = sizeof (CHAR16);
- Name = AllocateZeroPool (NameSize);
- ASSERT (Name != NULL);
- while (TRUE) {
- NewNameSize = NameSize;
- Status = gRT->GetNextVariableName (&NewNameSize, Name, &Guid);
- if (Status == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- Name = ReallocatePool (NameSize, NewNameSize, Name);
- ASSERT (Name != NULL);
- Status = gRT->GetNextVariableName (&NewNameSize, Name, &Guid);
- NameSize = NewNameSize;
- }
-
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND) {
- break;
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- if (BmIsKeyOptionVariable (Name ,&Guid, &OptionNumber)) {
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (Name, (VOID**) &KeyOption, NULL);
- ASSERT (KeyOption != NULL);
- if (BmIsKeyOptionValid (KeyOption)) {
- KeyOptions = ReallocatePool (
- *Count * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION),
- (*Count + 1) * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION),
- KeyOptions
- );
- ASSERT (KeyOptions != NULL);
- //
- // Insert the key option in order
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < *Count; Index++) {
- if (OptionNumber < KeyOptions[Index].OptionNumber) {
- break;
- }
- }
- CopyMem (&KeyOptions[Index + 1], &KeyOptions[Index], (*Count - Index) * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION));
- CopyMem (&KeyOptions[Index], KeyOption, BmSizeOfKeyOption (KeyOption));
- KeyOptions[Index].OptionNumber = OptionNumber;
- (*Count)++;
- }
- FreePool (KeyOption);
- }
- }
-
- FreePool (Name);
-
- return KeyOptions;
-}
-
-/**
- Callback function for event.
-
- @param Event Event for this callback function.
- @param Context Context pass to this function.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-BmEmptyFunction (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the bit is set in the value.
-
- @param Value The value need to be check.
- @param Bit The bit filed need to be check.
-
- @retval TRUE The bit is set.
- @retval FALSE The bit is not set.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmBitSet (
- IN UINT32 Value,
- IN UINT32 Bit
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((Value & Bit) != 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Initialize the KeyData and Key[] in the EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION.
-
- @param Modifier Input key info.
- @param Args Va_list info.
- @param KeyOption Key info which need to update.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Succeed to initialize the KeyData and Key[].
- @return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Input parameter error.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmInitializeKeyFields (
- IN UINT32 Modifier,
- IN VA_LIST Args,
- OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOption
- )
-{
- EFI_INPUT_KEY *Key;
-
- if (KeyOption == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Key = NULL;
- while (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount < sizeof (KeyOption->Keys) / sizeof (KeyOption->Keys[0])) {
- Key = VA_ARG (Args, EFI_INPUT_KEY *);
- if (Key == NULL) {
- break;
- }
- CopyMem (
- &KeyOption->Keys[KeyOption->KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount],
- Key,
- sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY)
- );
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount++;
- }
-
- if (Key != NULL) {
- //
- // Too many keys
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if ((Modifier & ~(EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_SHIFT_PRESSED
- | EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_CONTROL_PRESSED
- | EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_ALT_PRESSED
- | EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOGO_PRESSED
- | EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_MENU_KEY_PRESSED
- | EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_SYS_REQ_PRESSED
- )) != 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (BmBitSet (Modifier, EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_SHIFT_PRESSED)) {
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.ShiftPressed = 1;
- }
- if (BmBitSet (Modifier, EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_CONTROL_PRESSED)) {
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.ControlPressed = 1;
- }
- if (BmBitSet (Modifier, EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_ALT_PRESSED)) {
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.AltPressed = 1;
- }
- if (BmBitSet (Modifier, EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOGO_PRESSED)) {
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.LogoPressed = 1;
- }
- if (BmBitSet (Modifier, EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_MENU_KEY_PRESSED)) {
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.MenuPressed = 1;
- }
- if (BmBitSet (Modifier, EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_SYS_REQ_PRESSED)) {
- KeyOption->KeyData.Options.SysReqPressed = 1;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Try to boot the boot option triggered by hot key.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerHotkeyBoot (
- VOID
- )
-{
- if (mBmHotkeyBootOption.OptionNumber != LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- EfiBootManagerBoot (&mBmHotkeyBootOption);
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOption (&mBmHotkeyBootOption);
- mBmHotkeyBootOption.OptionNumber = LoadOptionNumberUnassigned;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- This is the common notification function for HotKeys, it will be registered
- with SimpleTextInEx protocol interface - RegisterKeyNotify() of ConIn handle.
-
- @param KeyData A pointer to a buffer that is filled in with the keystroke
- information for the key that was pressed.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS KeyData is successfully processed.
- @return EFI_NOT_FOUND Fail to find boot option variable.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-BmHotkeyCallback (
- IN EFI_KEY_DATA *KeyData
-)
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- BM_HOTKEY *Hotkey;
- CHAR16 OptionName[sizeof ("Boot####")];
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_KEY_DATA *HotkeyData;
-
- if (mBmHotkeyBootOption.OptionNumber != LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- //
- // Do not process sequential hotkey stroke until the current boot option returns
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds]BmHotkeyCallback: %04x:%04x\n", KeyData->Key.ScanCode, KeyData->Key.UnicodeChar));
-
- EfiAcquireLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
- for ( Link = GetFirstNode (&mBmHotkeyList)
- ; !IsNull (&mBmHotkeyList, Link)
- ; Link = GetNextNode (&mBmHotkeyList, Link)
- ) {
- Hotkey = BM_HOTKEY_FROM_LINK (Link);
-
- //
- // Is this Key Stroke we are waiting for?
- //
- ASSERT (Hotkey->WaitingKey < (sizeof (Hotkey->KeyData) / sizeof (Hotkey->KeyData[0])));
- HotkeyData = &Hotkey->KeyData[Hotkey->WaitingKey];
- if ((KeyData->Key.ScanCode == HotkeyData->Key.ScanCode) &&
- (KeyData->Key.UnicodeChar == HotkeyData->Key.UnicodeChar) &&
- (((KeyData->KeyState.KeyShiftState & EFI_SHIFT_STATE_VALID) != 0) ?
- (KeyData->KeyState.KeyShiftState == HotkeyData->KeyState.KeyShiftState) : TRUE
- )
- ) {
-
- //
- // Receive an expecting key stroke, transit to next waiting state
- //
- Hotkey->WaitingKey++;
-
- if (Hotkey->WaitingKey == Hotkey->CodeCount) {
- //
- // Reset to initial waiting state
- //
- Hotkey->WaitingKey = 0;
- //
- // Received the whole key stroke sequence
- //
- Status = gBS->SignalEvent (mBmHotkeyTriggered);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- if (!Hotkey->IsContinue) {
- //
- // Launch its BootOption
- //
- UnicodeSPrint (OptionName, sizeof (OptionName), L"Boot%04x", Hotkey->BootOption);
- Status = EfiBootManagerVariableToLoadOption (OptionName, &mBmHotkeyBootOption);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds]Hotkey for %s pressed - %r\n", OptionName, Status));
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- mBmHotkeyBootOption.OptionNumber = LoadOptionNumberUnassigned;
- }
- } else {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds]Continue key pressed!\n"));
- }
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Receive an unexpected key stroke, reset to initial waiting state
- //
- Hotkey->WaitingKey = 0;
- }
-
- }
- EfiReleaseLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Unregister hotkey notify list.
-
- @param Hotkey Hotkey list.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Unregister hotkey notify success.
- @retval Others Unregister hotkey notify failed.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmUnregisterHotkeyNotify (
- IN BM_HOTKEY *Hotkey
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN KeyIndex;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_INPUT_EX_PROTOCOL *TxtInEx;
- VOID *NotifyHandle;
-
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Handles[Index], &gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &TxtInEx);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- for (KeyIndex = 0; KeyIndex < Hotkey->CodeCount; KeyIndex++) {
- Status = TxtInEx->RegisterKeyNotify (
- TxtInEx,
- &Hotkey->KeyData[KeyIndex],
- BmHotkeyCallback,
- &NotifyHandle
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = TxtInEx->UnregisterKeyNotify (TxtInEx, NotifyHandle);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds]UnregisterKeyNotify: %04x/%04x %r\n", Hotkey->KeyData[KeyIndex].Key.ScanCode, Hotkey->KeyData[KeyIndex].Key.UnicodeChar, Status));
- }
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Register hotkey notify list.
-
- @param TxtInEx Pointer to EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_INPUT_EX_PROTOCOL protocol.
- @param Hotkey Hotkey list.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Register hotkey notify success.
- @retval Others Register hotkey notify failed.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmRegisterHotkeyNotify (
- IN EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_INPUT_EX_PROTOCOL *TxtInEx,
- IN BM_HOTKEY *Hotkey
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- VOID *NotifyHandle;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Hotkey->CodeCount; Index++) {
- Status = TxtInEx->RegisterKeyNotify (
- TxtInEx,
- &Hotkey->KeyData[Index],
- BmHotkeyCallback,
- &NotifyHandle
- );
- DEBUG ((
- EFI_D_INFO,
- "[Bds]RegisterKeyNotify: %04x/%04x %08x/%02x %r\n",
- Hotkey->KeyData[Index].Key.ScanCode,
- Hotkey->KeyData[Index].Key.UnicodeChar,
- Hotkey->KeyData[Index].KeyState.KeyShiftState,
- Hotkey->KeyData[Index].KeyState.KeyToggleState,
- Status
- ));
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // some of the hotkey registry failed
- // do not unregister all in case we have both CTRL-ALT-P and CTRL-ALT-P-R
- //
- break;
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Generate key shift state base on the input key option info.
-
- @param Depth Which key is checked.
- @param KeyOption Input key option info.
- @param KeyShiftState Input key shift state.
- @param KeyShiftStates Return possible key shift state array.
- @param KeyShiftStateCount Possible key shift state count.
-**/
-VOID
-BmGenerateKeyShiftState (
- IN UINTN Depth,
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOption,
- IN UINT32 KeyShiftState,
- IN UINT32 *KeyShiftStates,
- IN UINTN *KeyShiftStateCount
- )
-{
- switch (Depth) {
- case 0:
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.ShiftPressed) {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_RIGHT_SHIFT_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_LEFT_SHIFT_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- } else {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- }
- break;
-
- case 1:
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.ControlPressed) {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_RIGHT_CONTROL_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_LEFT_CONTROL_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- } else {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- }
- break;
-
- case 2:
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.AltPressed) {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_RIGHT_ALT_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_LEFT_ALT_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- } else {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- }
- break;
- case 3:
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.LogoPressed) {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_RIGHT_LOGO_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState | EFI_LEFT_LOGO_PRESSED, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- } else {
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (Depth + 1, KeyOption, KeyShiftState, KeyShiftStates, KeyShiftStateCount);
- }
- break;
- case 4:
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.MenuPressed) {
- KeyShiftState |= EFI_MENU_KEY_PRESSED;
- }
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.SysReqPressed) {
- KeyShiftState |= EFI_SYS_REQ_PRESSED;
- }
- KeyShiftStates[*KeyShiftStateCount] = KeyShiftState;
- (*KeyShiftStateCount)++;
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Add it to hot key database, register it to existing TxtInEx.
- New TxtInEx will be automatically registered with all the hot key in dababase
-
- @param KeyOption Input key option info.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmProcessKeyOption (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOption
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_INPUT_EX_PROTOCOL *TxtInEx;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- UINTN HandleIndex;
- UINTN Index;
- BM_HOTKEY *Hotkey;
- UINTN KeyIndex;
- //
- // 16 is enough to enumerate all the possible combination of LEFT_XXX and RIGHT_XXX
- //
- UINT32 KeyShiftStates[16];
- UINTN KeyShiftStateCount;
-
- if (KeyOption->KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount > mBmHotkeySupportCount) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- KeyShiftStateCount = 0;
- BmGenerateKeyShiftState (0, KeyOption, EFI_SHIFT_STATE_VALID, KeyShiftStates, &KeyShiftStateCount);
- ASSERT (KeyShiftStateCount <= sizeof (KeyShiftStates) / sizeof (KeyShiftStates[0]));
-
- EfiAcquireLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < KeyShiftStateCount; Index++) {
- Hotkey = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (BM_HOTKEY));
- ASSERT (Hotkey != NULL);
-
- Hotkey->Signature = BM_HOTKEY_SIGNATURE;
- Hotkey->BootOption = KeyOption->BootOption;
- Hotkey->IsContinue = (BOOLEAN) (KeyOption == mBmContinueKeyOption);
- Hotkey->CodeCount = (UINT8) KeyOption->KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount;
-
- for (KeyIndex = 0; KeyIndex < Hotkey->CodeCount; KeyIndex++) {
- CopyMem (&Hotkey->KeyData[KeyIndex].Key, &KeyOption->Keys[KeyIndex], sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY));
- Hotkey->KeyData[KeyIndex].KeyState.KeyShiftState = KeyShiftStates[Index];
- }
- InsertTailList (&mBmHotkeyList, &Hotkey->Link);
-
- gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &Handles
- );
- for (HandleIndex = 0; HandleIndex < HandleCount; HandleIndex++) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (Handles[HandleIndex], &gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &TxtInEx);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- BmRegisterHotkeyNotify (TxtInEx, Hotkey);
- }
- }
-
- EfiReleaseLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Callback function for SimpleTextInEx protocol install events
-
- @param Event the event that is signaled.
- @param Context not used here.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-BmTxtInExCallback (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN BufferSize;
- EFI_HANDLE Handle;
- EFI_SIMPLE_TEXT_INPUT_EX_PROTOCOL *TxtInEx;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
-
- while (TRUE) {
- BufferSize = sizeof (EFI_HANDLE);
- Status = gBS->LocateHandle (
- ByRegisterNotify,
- NULL,
- mBmTxtInExRegistration,
- &BufferSize,
- &Handle
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // If no more notification events exist
- //
- return ;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handle,
- &gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &TxtInEx
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Register the hot key notification for the existing items in the list
- //
- EfiAcquireLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
- for (Link = GetFirstNode (&mBmHotkeyList); !IsNull (&mBmHotkeyList, Link); Link = GetNextNode (&mBmHotkeyList, Link)) {
- BmRegisterHotkeyNotify (TxtInEx, BM_HOTKEY_FROM_LINK (Link));
- }
- EfiReleaseLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Free the key options returned from BmGetKeyOptions.
-
- @param KeyOptions Pointer to the key options.
- @param KeyOptionCount Number of the key options.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The key options are freed.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND KeyOptions is NULL.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmFreeKeyOptions (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOptions,
- IN UINTN KeyOptionCount
- )
-{
- if (KeyOptions != NULL) {
- FreePool (KeyOptions);
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Register the key option to exit the waiting of the Boot Manager timeout.
- Platform should ensure that the continue key option isn't conflict with
- other boot key options.
-
- @param Modifier Key shift state.
- @param ... Parameter list of pointer of EFI_INPUT_KEY.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully register the continue key option.
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED The continue key option is already registered.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerRegisterContinueKeyOption (
- IN UINT32 Modifier,
- ...
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION KeyOption;
- VA_LIST Args;
-
- if (mBmContinueKeyOption != NULL) {
- return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
- }
-
- ZeroMem (&KeyOption, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION));
- VA_START (Args, Modifier);
- Status = BmInitializeKeyFields (Modifier, Args, &KeyOption);
- VA_END (Args);
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- mBmContinueKeyOption = AllocateCopyPool (sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION), &KeyOption);
- ASSERT (mBmContinueKeyOption != NULL);
- if (mBmHotkeyServiceStarted) {
- BmProcessKeyOption (mBmContinueKeyOption);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Stop the hotkey processing.
-
- @param Event Event pointer related to hotkey service.
- @param Context Context pass to this function.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-BmStopHotkeyService (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- BM_HOTKEY *Hotkey;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds]Stop Hotkey Service!\n"));
- gBS->CloseEvent (Event);
-
- EfiAcquireLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
- for (Link = GetFirstNode (&mBmHotkeyList); !IsNull (&mBmHotkeyList, Link); ) {
- Hotkey = BM_HOTKEY_FROM_LINK (Link);
- BmUnregisterHotkeyNotify (Hotkey);
- Link = RemoveEntryList (Link);
- FreePool (Hotkey);
- }
- EfiReleaseLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
-}
-
-/**
- Start the hot key service so that the key press can trigger the boot option.
-
- @param HotkeyTriggered Return the waitable event and it will be signaled
- when a valid hot key is pressed.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The hot key service is started.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerStartHotkeyService (
- IN EFI_EVENT *HotkeyTriggered
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOptions;
- UINTN KeyOptionCount;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_EVENT Event;
- UINT32 *BootOptionSupport;
-
- Status = GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (EFI_BOOT_OPTION_SUPPORT_VARIABLE_NAME, (VOID **) &BootOptionSupport, NULL);
- ASSERT (BootOptionSupport != NULL);
-
- if ((*BootOptionSupport & EFI_BOOT_OPTION_SUPPORT_KEY) != 0) {
- mBmHotkeySupportCount = ((*BootOptionSupport & EFI_BOOT_OPTION_SUPPORT_COUNT) >> LowBitSet32 (EFI_BOOT_OPTION_SUPPORT_COUNT));
- }
- FreePool (BootOptionSupport);
-
- if (mBmHotkeySupportCount == 0) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Bds: BootOptionSupport NV variable forbids starting the hotkey service.\n"));
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
- EVT_NOTIFY_WAIT,
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- BmEmptyFunction,
- NULL,
- &mBmHotkeyTriggered
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- if (HotkeyTriggered != NULL) {
- *HotkeyTriggered = mBmHotkeyTriggered;
- }
-
- KeyOptions = BmGetKeyOptions (&KeyOptionCount);
- for (Index = 0; Index < KeyOptionCount; Index ++) {
- BmProcessKeyOption (&KeyOptions[Index]);
- }
- BmFreeKeyOptions (KeyOptions, KeyOptionCount);
-
- if (mBmContinueKeyOption != NULL) {
- BmProcessKeyOption (mBmContinueKeyOption);
- }
-
- EfiCreateProtocolNotifyEvent (
- &gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid,
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- BmTxtInExCallback,
- NULL,
- &mBmTxtInExRegistration
- );
-
- Status = EfiCreateEventReadyToBootEx (
- TPL_CALLBACK,
- BmStopHotkeyService,
- NULL,
- &Event
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
-
- mBmHotkeyServiceStarted = TRUE;
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Add the key option.
- It adds the key option variable and the key option takes affect immediately.
-
- @param AddedOption Return the added key option.
- @param BootOptionNumber The boot option number for the key option.
- @param Modifier Key shift state.
- @param ... Parameter list of pointer of EFI_INPUT_KEY.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The key option is added.
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED The hot key is already used by certain key option.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerAddKeyOptionVariable (
- OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *AddedOption, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT16 BootOptionNumber,
- IN UINT32 Modifier,
- ...
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VA_LIST Args;
- VOID *BootOption;
- UINTN BootOptionSize;
- CHAR16 BootOptionName[sizeof (L"Boot####")];
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION KeyOption;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOptions;
- UINTN KeyOptionCount;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN KeyOptionNumber;
- CHAR16 KeyOptionName[sizeof (L"Key####")];
-
- UnicodeSPrint (BootOptionName, sizeof (BootOptionName), L"Boot%04x", BootOptionNumber);
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (BootOptionName, &BootOption, &BootOptionSize);
-
- if (BootOption == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- ZeroMem (&KeyOption, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION));
- KeyOption.BootOption = BootOptionNumber;
- Status = gBS->CalculateCrc32 (BootOption, BootOptionSize, &KeyOption.BootOptionCrc);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- FreePool (BootOption);
-
- VA_START (Args, Modifier);
- Status = BmInitializeKeyFields (Modifier, Args, &KeyOption);
- VA_END (Args);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- KeyOptionNumber = LoadOptionNumberUnassigned;
- //
- // Check if the hot key sequence was defined already
- //
- KeyOptions = BmGetKeyOptions (&KeyOptionCount);
- for (Index = 0; Index < KeyOptionCount; Index++) {
- if ((KeyOptions[Index].KeyData.PackedValue == KeyOption.KeyData.PackedValue) &&
- (CompareMem (KeyOptions[Index].Keys, KeyOption.Keys, KeyOption.KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount * sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY)) == 0)) {
- break;
- }
-
- if ((KeyOptionNumber == LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) &&
- (KeyOptions[Index].OptionNumber > Index)
- ){
- KeyOptionNumber = Index;
- }
- }
- BmFreeKeyOptions (KeyOptions, KeyOptionCount);
-
- if (Index < KeyOptionCount) {
- return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
- }
-
- if (KeyOptionNumber == LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- KeyOptionNumber = KeyOptionCount;
- }
-
- UnicodeSPrint (KeyOptionName, sizeof (KeyOptionName), L"Key%04x", KeyOptionNumber);
-
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- KeyOptionName,
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- BmSizeOfKeyOption (&KeyOption),
- &KeyOption
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Return the Key Option in case needed by caller
- //
- if (AddedOption != NULL) {
- CopyMem (AddedOption, &KeyOption, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION));
- }
-
- //
- // Register the newly added hot key
- // Calling this function before EfiBootManagerStartHotkeyService doesn't
- // need to call BmProcessKeyOption
- //
- if (mBmHotkeyServiceStarted) {
- BmProcessKeyOption (&KeyOption);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Delete the Key Option variable and unregister the hot key
-
- @param DeletedOption Return the deleted key options.
- @param Modifier Key shift state.
- @param ... Parameter list of pointer of EFI_INPUT_KEY.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The key option is deleted.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The key option cannot be found.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerDeleteKeyOptionVariable (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *DeletedOption, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT32 Modifier,
- ...
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- VA_LIST Args;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION KeyOption;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION *KeyOptions;
- UINTN KeyOptionCount;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- BM_HOTKEY *Hotkey;
- UINT32 ShiftState;
- BOOLEAN Match;
- CHAR16 KeyOptionName[sizeof (L"Key####")];
-
- ZeroMem (&KeyOption, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION));
- VA_START (Args, Modifier);
- Status = BmInitializeKeyFields (Modifier, Args, &KeyOption);
- VA_END (Args);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- EfiAcquireLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
- //
- // Delete the key option from active hot key list
- // Could have multiple entries when modifier isn't 0 because we map the ShiftPressed to RIGHT_SHIFT and RIGHT_SHIFT
- //
- for (Link = GetFirstNode (&mBmHotkeyList); !IsNull (&mBmHotkeyList, Link); ) {
- Hotkey = BM_HOTKEY_FROM_LINK (Link);
- Match = (BOOLEAN) (Hotkey->CodeCount == KeyOption.KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount);
-
- for (Index = 0; Match && (Index < Hotkey->CodeCount); Index++) {
- ShiftState = Hotkey->KeyData[Index].KeyState.KeyShiftState;
- if (
- (BmBitSet (ShiftState, EFI_RIGHT_SHIFT_PRESSED | EFI_LEFT_SHIFT_PRESSED) != KeyOption.KeyData.Options.ShiftPressed) ||
- (BmBitSet (ShiftState, EFI_RIGHT_CONTROL_PRESSED | EFI_LEFT_CONTROL_PRESSED) != KeyOption.KeyData.Options.ControlPressed) ||
- (BmBitSet (ShiftState, EFI_RIGHT_ALT_PRESSED | EFI_LEFT_ALT_PRESSED) != KeyOption.KeyData.Options.AltPressed) ||
- (BmBitSet (ShiftState, EFI_RIGHT_LOGO_PRESSED | EFI_LEFT_LOGO_PRESSED) != KeyOption.KeyData.Options.LogoPressed) ||
- (BmBitSet (ShiftState, EFI_MENU_KEY_PRESSED) != KeyOption.KeyData.Options.MenuPressed) ||
- (BmBitSet (ShiftState, EFI_SYS_REQ_PRESSED) != KeyOption.KeyData.Options.SysReqPressed) ||
- (CompareMem (&Hotkey->KeyData[Index].Key, &KeyOption.Keys[Index], sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY)) != 0)
- ) {
- //
- // Break when any field doesn't match
- //
- Match = FALSE;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (Match) {
- Link = RemoveEntryList (Link);
- FreePool (Hotkey);
- } else {
- Link = GetNextNode (&mBmHotkeyList, Link);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Delete the key option from the variable
- //
- Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- KeyOptions = BmGetKeyOptions (&KeyOptionCount);
- for (Index = 0; Index < KeyOptionCount; Index++) {
- if ((KeyOptions[Index].KeyData.PackedValue == KeyOption.KeyData.PackedValue) &&
- (CompareMem (
- KeyOptions[Index].Keys, KeyOption.Keys,
- KeyOption.KeyData.Options.InputKeyCount * sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY)) == 0)
- ) {
- UnicodeSPrint (KeyOptionName, sizeof (KeyOptionName), L"Key%04x", KeyOptions[Index].OptionNumber);
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- KeyOptionName,
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- 0,
- NULL
- );
- //
- // Return the deleted key option in case needed by caller
- //
- if (DeletedOption != NULL) {
- CopyMem (DeletedOption, &KeyOptions[Index], sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_KEY_OPTION));
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- BmFreeKeyOptions (KeyOptions, KeyOptionCount);
-
- EfiReleaseLock (&mBmHotkeyLock);
-
- return Status;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmLoadOption.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmLoadOption.c deleted file mode 100644 index 6b9690a37c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmLoadOption.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1253 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Load option library functions which relate with creating and processing load options.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED
- CHAR16 *mBmLoadOptionName[] = {
- L"Driver",
- L"SysPrep",
- L"Boot"
- };
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED
- CHAR16 *mBmLoadOptionOrderName[] = {
- EFI_DRIVER_ORDER_VARIABLE_NAME,
- EFI_SYS_PREP_ORDER_VARIABLE_NAME,
- EFI_BOOT_ORDER_VARIABLE_NAME
- };
-
-/**
- Call Visitor function for each variable in variable storage.
-
- @param Visitor Visitor function.
- @param Context The context passed to Visitor function.
-**/
-VOID
-BmForEachVariable (
- VARIABLE_VISITOR Visitor,
- VOID *Context
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- CHAR16 *Name;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- UINTN NameSize;
- UINTN NewNameSize;
-
- NameSize = sizeof (CHAR16);
- Name = AllocateZeroPool (NameSize);
- ASSERT (Name != NULL);
- while (TRUE) {
- NewNameSize = NameSize;
- Status = gRT->GetNextVariableName (&NewNameSize, Name, &Guid);
- if (Status == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- Name = ReallocatePool (NameSize, NewNameSize, Name);
- ASSERT (Name != NULL);
- Status = gRT->GetNextVariableName (&NewNameSize, Name, &Guid);
- NameSize = NewNameSize;
- }
-
- if (Status == EFI_NOT_FOUND) {
- break;
- }
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- Visitor (Name, &Guid, Context);
- }
-
- FreePool (Name);
-}
-
-/**
- Get the Option Number that wasn't used.
-
- @param LoadOptionType The load option type.
- @param FreeOptionNumber Return the minimal free option number.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The option number is found and will be returned.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is no free option number that can be used.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER FreeOptionNumber is NULL
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmGetFreeOptionNumber (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE LoadOptionType,
- OUT UINT16 *FreeOptionNumber
- )
-{
-
- UINTN OptionNumber;
- UINTN Index;
- UINT16 *OptionOrder;
- UINTN OptionOrderSize;
- UINT16 *BootNext;
-
- ASSERT (FreeOptionNumber != NULL);
- ASSERT (LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeDriver ||
- LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeBoot ||
- LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeSysPrep);
-
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (mBmLoadOptionOrderName[LoadOptionType], (VOID **) &OptionOrder, &OptionOrderSize);
- ASSERT ((OptionOrder != NULL && OptionOrderSize != 0) || (OptionOrder == NULL && OptionOrderSize == 0));
-
- BootNext = NULL;
- if (LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeBoot) {
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (L"BootNext", (VOID**) &BootNext, NULL);
- }
-
- for (OptionNumber = 0;
- OptionNumber < OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16)
- + ((BootNext != NULL) ? 1 : 0);
- OptionNumber++
- ) {
- //
- // Search in OptionOrder whether the OptionNumber exists
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16); Index++) {
- if (OptionNumber == OptionOrder[Index]) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // We didn't find it in the ****Order array and it doesn't equal to BootNext
- // Otherwise, OptionNumber equals to OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16) + 1
- //
- if ((Index == OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16)) &&
- ((BootNext == NULL) || (OptionNumber != *BootNext))
- ) {
- break;
- }
- }
- if (OptionOrder != NULL) {
- FreePool (OptionOrder);
- }
-
- if (BootNext != NULL) {
- FreePool (BootNext);
- }
-
- //
- // When BootOrder & BootNext conver all numbers in the range [0 ... 0xffff],
- // OptionNumber equals to 0x10000 which is not valid.
- //
- ASSERT (OptionNumber <= 0x10000);
- if (OptionNumber == 0x10000) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- } else {
- *FreeOptionNumber = (UINT16) OptionNumber;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Create the Boot####, Driver####, SysPrep####, variable from the load option.
-
- @param LoadOption Pointer to the load option.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The variable was created.
- @retval Others Error status returned by RT->SetVariable.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerLoadOptionToVariable (
- IN CONST EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Option
- )
-{
- UINTN VariableSize;
- UINT8 *Variable;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
- CHAR16 OptionName[BM_OPTION_NAME_LEN];
- CHAR16 *Description;
- CHAR16 NullChar;
- UINT32 VariableAttributes;
-
- if ((Option->OptionNumber == LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) ||
- (Option->FilePath == NULL) ||
- ((UINT32) Option->OptionType >= LoadOptionTypeMax)
- ) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Convert NULL description to empty description
- //
- NullChar = L'\0';
- Description = Option->Description;
- if (Description == NULL) {
- Description = &NullChar;
- }
-
- /*
- UINT32 Attributes;
- UINT16 FilePathListLength;
- CHAR16 Description[];
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL FilePathList[];
- UINT8 OptionalData[];
-TODO: FilePathList[] IS:
-A packed array of UEFI device paths. The first element of the
-array is a device path that describes the device and location of the
-Image for this load option. The FilePathList[0] is specific
-to the device type. Other device paths may optionally exist in the
-FilePathList, but their usage is OSV specific. Each element
-in the array is variable length, and ends at the device path end
-structure.
- */
- VariableSize = sizeof (Option->Attributes)
- + sizeof (UINT16)
- + StrSize (Description)
- + GetDevicePathSize (Option->FilePath)
- + Option->OptionalDataSize;
-
- Variable = AllocatePool (VariableSize);
- ASSERT (Variable != NULL);
-
- Ptr = Variable;
- WriteUnaligned32 ((UINT32 *) Ptr, Option->Attributes);
- Ptr += sizeof (Option->Attributes);
-
- WriteUnaligned16 ((UINT16 *) Ptr, (UINT16) GetDevicePathSize (Option->FilePath));
- Ptr += sizeof (UINT16);
-
- CopyMem (Ptr, Description, StrSize (Description));
- Ptr += StrSize (Description);
-
- CopyMem (Ptr, Option->FilePath, GetDevicePathSize (Option->FilePath));
- Ptr += GetDevicePathSize (Option->FilePath);
-
- CopyMem (Ptr, Option->OptionalData, Option->OptionalDataSize);
-
- UnicodeSPrint (OptionName, sizeof (OptionName), L"%s%04x", mBmLoadOptionName[Option->OptionType], Option->OptionNumber);
-
- VariableAttributes = EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE;
-
- return gRT->SetVariable (
- OptionName,
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- VariableAttributes,
- VariableSize,
- Variable
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Update order variable .
-
- @param OptionOrderName Order variable name which need to be updated.
- @param OptionNumber Option number for the new option.
- @param Position Position of the new load option to put in the ****Order variable.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The boot#### or driver#### have been successfully registered.
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED The option number of Option is being used already.
- @retval EFI_STATUS Return the status of gRT->SetVariable ().
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmAddOptionNumberToOrderVariable (
- IN CHAR16 *OptionOrderName,
- IN UINT16 OptionNumber,
- IN UINTN Position
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- UINT16 *OptionOrder;
- UINT16 *NewOptionOrder;
- UINTN OptionOrderSize;
- //
- // Update the option order variable
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (OptionOrderName, (VOID **) &OptionOrder, &OptionOrderSize);
- ASSERT ((OptionOrder != NULL && OptionOrderSize != 0) || (OptionOrder == NULL && OptionOrderSize == 0));
-
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- for (Index = 0; Index < OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16); Index++) {
- if (OptionOrder[Index] == OptionNumber) {
- Status = EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Position = MIN (Position, OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16));
-
- NewOptionOrder = AllocatePool (OptionOrderSize + sizeof (UINT16));
- ASSERT (NewOptionOrder != NULL);
- if (OptionOrderSize != 0) {
- CopyMem (NewOptionOrder, OptionOrder, Position * sizeof (UINT16));
- CopyMem (&NewOptionOrder[Position + 1], &OptionOrder[Position], OptionOrderSize - Position * sizeof (UINT16));
- }
- NewOptionOrder[Position] = OptionNumber;
-
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- OptionOrderName,
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- OptionOrderSize + sizeof (UINT16),
- NewOptionOrder
- );
- FreePool (NewOptionOrder);
- }
-
- if (OptionOrder != NULL) {
- FreePool (OptionOrder);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This function will register the new Boot####, Driver#### or SysPrep#### option.
- After the *#### is updated, the *Order will also be updated.
-
- @param Option Pointer to load option to add.
- @param Position Position of the new load option to put in the ****Order variable.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The *#### have been successfully registered.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The option number exceeds 0xFFFF.
- @retval EFI_ALREADY_STARTED The option number of Option is being used already.
- Note: this API only adds new load option, no replacement support.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is no free option number that can be used when the
- option number specified in the Option is LoadOptionNumberUnassigned.
- @retval EFI_STATUS Return the status of gRT->SetVariable ().
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerAddLoadOptionVariable (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Option,
- IN UINTN Position
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT16 OptionNumber;
-
- if (Option == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (Option->OptionType != LoadOptionTypeDriver &&
- Option->OptionType != LoadOptionTypeSysPrep &&
- Option->OptionType != LoadOptionTypeBoot
- ) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the free option number if the option number is unassigned
- //
- if (Option->OptionNumber == LoadOptionNumberUnassigned) {
- Status = BmGetFreeOptionNumber (Option->OptionType, &OptionNumber);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- Option->OptionNumber = OptionNumber;
- }
-
- if (Option->OptionNumber >= LoadOptionNumberMax) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Status = BmAddOptionNumberToOrderVariable (mBmLoadOptionOrderName[Option->OptionType], (UINT16) Option->OptionNumber, Position);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Save the Boot#### or Driver#### variable
- //
- Status = EfiBootManagerLoadOptionToVariable (Option);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Remove the #### from *Order variable when the Driver####/SysPrep####/Boot#### cannot be saved.
- //
- EfiBootManagerDeleteLoadOptionVariable (Option->OptionNumber, Option->OptionType);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Sort the load option. The DriverOrder or BootOrder will be re-created to
- reflect the new order.
-
- @param OptionType Load option type
- @param CompareFunction The comparator
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerSortLoadOptionVariable (
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE OptionType,
- SORT_COMPARE CompareFunction
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *LoadOption;
- UINTN LoadOptionCount;
- UINTN Index;
- UINT16 *OptionOrder;
-
- LoadOption = EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions (&LoadOptionCount, OptionType);
-
- //
- // Insertion sort algorithm
- //
- PerformQuickSort (
- LoadOption,
- LoadOptionCount,
- sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION),
- CompareFunction
- );
-
- //
- // Create new ****Order variable
- //
- OptionOrder = AllocatePool (LoadOptionCount * sizeof (UINT16));
- ASSERT (OptionOrder != NULL);
- for (Index = 0; Index < LoadOptionCount; Index++) {
- OptionOrder[Index] = (UINT16) LoadOption[Index].OptionNumber;
- }
-
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- mBmLoadOptionOrderName[OptionType],
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- LoadOptionCount * sizeof (UINT16),
- OptionOrder
- );
- //
- // Changing the *Order content without increasing its size with current variable implementation shouldn't fail.
- //
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- FreePool (OptionOrder);
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (LoadOption, LoadOptionCount);
-}
-
-/**
- Initialize a load option.
-
- @param Option Pointer to the load option to be initialized.
- @param OptionNumber Option number of the load option.
- @param OptionType Type of the load option.
- @param Attributes Attributes of the load option.
- @param Description Description of the load option.
- @param FilePath Device path of the load option.
- @param OptionalData Optional data of the load option.
- @param OptionalDataSize Size of the optional data of the load option.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The load option was initialized successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Option, Description or FilePath is NULL.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- IN OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Option,
- IN UINTN OptionNumber,
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE OptionType,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN CHAR16 *Description,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath,
- IN UINT8 *OptionalData, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT32 OptionalDataSize
- )
-{
- if ((Option == NULL) || (Description == NULL) || (FilePath == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (((OptionalData != NULL) && (OptionalDataSize == 0)) ||
- ((OptionalData == NULL) && (OptionalDataSize != 0))) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if ((UINT32) OptionType >= LoadOptionTypeMax) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- ZeroMem (Option, sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION));
- Option->OptionNumber = OptionNumber;
- Option->OptionType = OptionType;
- Option->Attributes = Attributes;
- Option->Description = AllocateCopyPool (StrSize (Description), Description);
- Option->FilePath = DuplicateDevicePath (FilePath);
- if (OptionalData != NULL) {
- Option->OptionalData = AllocateCopyPool (OptionalDataSize, OptionalData);
- Option->OptionalDataSize = OptionalDataSize;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Return the index of the load option in the load option array.
-
- The function consider two load options are equal when the
- OptionType, Attributes, Description, FilePath and OptionalData are equal.
-
- @param Key Pointer to the load option to be found.
- @param Array Pointer to the array of load options to be found.
- @param Count Number of entries in the Array.
-
- @retval -1 Key wasn't found in the Array.
- @retval 0 ~ Count-1 The index of the Key in the Array.
-**/
-INTN
-BmFindLoadOption (
- IN CONST EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Key,
- IN CONST EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Array,
- IN UINTN Count
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Count; Index++) {
- if ((Key->OptionType == Array[Index].OptionType) &&
- (Key->Attributes == Array[Index].Attributes) &&
- (StrCmp (Key->Description, Array[Index].Description) == 0) &&
- (CompareMem (Key->FilePath, Array[Index].FilePath, GetDevicePathSize (Key->FilePath)) == 0) &&
- (Key->OptionalDataSize == Array[Index].OptionalDataSize) &&
- (CompareMem (Key->OptionalData, Array[Index].OptionalData, Key->OptionalDataSize) == 0)) {
- return (INTN) Index;
- }
- }
-
- return -1;
-}
-
-/**
- Delete the load option.
-
- @param OptionNumber Indicate the option number of load option
- @param OptionType Indicate the type of load option
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER OptionType or OptionNumber is invalid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The load option cannot be found
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The load option was deleted
- @retval others Status of RT->SetVariable()
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerDeleteLoadOptionVariable (
- IN UINTN OptionNumber,
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE OptionType
- )
-{
- UINT16 *OptionOrder;
- UINTN OptionOrderSize;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
-
- if (((UINT32) OptionType >= LoadOptionTypeMax) || (OptionNumber >= LoadOptionNumberMax)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-
- if (OptionType == LoadOptionTypeDriver || OptionType == LoadOptionTypeSysPrep || OptionType == LoadOptionTypeBoot) {
- //
- // If the associated *Order exists, just remove the reference in *Order.
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (mBmLoadOptionOrderName[OptionType], (VOID **) &OptionOrder, &OptionOrderSize);
- ASSERT ((OptionOrder != NULL && OptionOrderSize != 0) || (OptionOrder == NULL && OptionOrderSize == 0));
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16); Index++) {
- if (OptionOrder[Index] == OptionNumber) {
- OptionOrderSize -= sizeof (UINT16);
- CopyMem (&OptionOrder[Index], &OptionOrder[Index + 1], OptionOrderSize - Index * sizeof (UINT16));
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- mBmLoadOptionOrderName[OptionType],
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_RUNTIME_ACCESS | EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE,
- OptionOrderSize,
- OptionOrder
- );
- break;
- }
- }
- if (OptionOrder != NULL) {
- FreePool (OptionOrder);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Convert a single character to number.
- It assumes the input Char is in the scope of L'0' ~ L'9' and L'A' ~ L'F'
-
- @param Char The input char which need to convert to int.
-**/
-UINTN
-BmCharToUint (
- IN CHAR16 Char
- )
-{
- if ((Char >= L'0') && (Char <= L'9')) {
- return (UINTN) (Char - L'0');
- }
-
- if ((Char >= L'A') && (Char <= L'F')) {
- return (UINTN) (Char - L'A' + 0xA);
- }
-
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return (UINTN) -1;
-}
-
-/**
- Returns the size of a device path in bytes.
-
- This function returns the size, in bytes, of the device path data structure
- specified by DevicePath including the end of device path node. If DevicePath
- is NULL, then 0 is returned. If the length of the device path is bigger than
- MaxSize, also return 0 to indicate this is an invalidate device path.
-
- @param DevicePath A pointer to a device path data structure.
- @param MaxSize Max valid device path size. If big than this size,
- return error.
-
- @retval 0 An invalid device path.
- @retval Others The size of a device path in bytes.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-BmGetDevicePathSizeEx (
- IN CONST EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath,
- IN UINTN MaxSize
- )
-{
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN NodeSize;
-
- if (DevicePath == NULL) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- //
- // Search for the end of the device path structure
- //
- Size = 0;
- while (!IsDevicePathEnd (DevicePath)) {
- NodeSize = DevicePathNodeLength (DevicePath);
- if (NodeSize == 0) {
- return 0;
- }
- Size += NodeSize;
- if (Size > MaxSize) {
- return 0;
- }
- DevicePath = NextDevicePathNode (DevicePath);
- }
- Size += DevicePathNodeLength (DevicePath);
- if (Size > MaxSize) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- return Size;
-}
-
-/**
- Returns the length of a Null-terminated Unicode string. If the length is
- bigger than MaxStringLen, return length 0 to indicate that this is an
- invalidate string.
-
- This function returns the number of Unicode characters in the Null-terminated
- Unicode string specified by String.
-
- If String is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If String is not aligned on a 16-bit boundary, then ASSERT().
-
- @param String A pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string.
- @param MaxStringLen Max string len in this string.
-
- @retval 0 An invalid string.
- @retval Others The length of String.
-
-**/
-UINTN
-BmStrSizeEx (
- IN CONST CHAR16 *String,
- IN UINTN MaxStringLen
- )
-{
- UINTN Length;
-
- ASSERT (String != NULL && MaxStringLen != 0);
- ASSERT (((UINTN) String & BIT0) == 0);
-
- for (Length = 0; *String != L'\0' && MaxStringLen != Length; String++, Length+=2);
-
- if (*String != L'\0' && MaxStringLen == Length) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- return Length + 2;
-}
-
-/**
- Validate the Boot####, Driver####, SysPrep#### variable (VendorGuid/Name)
-
- @param Variable The variable data.
- @param VariableSize The variable size.
-
- @retval TRUE The variable data is correct.
- @retval FALSE The variable data is corrupted.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmValidateOption (
- UINT8 *Variable,
- UINTN VariableSize
- )
-{
- UINT16 FilePathSize;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- UINTN DescriptionSize;
-
- if (VariableSize <= sizeof (UINT16) + sizeof (UINT32)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Skip the option attribute
- //
- Variable += sizeof (UINT32);
-
- //
- // Get the option's device path size
- //
- FilePathSize = ReadUnaligned16 ((UINT16 *) Variable);
- Variable += sizeof (UINT16);
-
- //
- // Get the option's description string size
- //
- DescriptionSize = BmStrSizeEx ((CHAR16 *) Variable, VariableSize - sizeof (UINT16) - sizeof (UINT32));
- Variable += DescriptionSize;
-
- //
- // Get the option's device path
- //
- DevicePath = (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) Variable;
-
- //
- // Validation boot option variable.
- //
- if ((FilePathSize == 0) || (DescriptionSize == 0)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if (sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINT16) + DescriptionSize + FilePathSize > VariableSize) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return (BOOLEAN) (BmGetDevicePathSizeEx (DevicePath, FilePathSize) != 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the VariableName is a valid load option variable name
- and return the load option type and option number.
-
- @param VariableName The name of the load option variable.
- @param OptionType Return the load option type.
- @param OptionNumber Return the load option number.
-
- @retval TRUE The variable name is valid; The load option type and
- load option number is returned.
- @retval FALSE The variable name is NOT valid.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsValidLoadOptionVariableName (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE *OptionType,
- OUT UINT16 *OptionNumber
- )
-{
- UINTN VariableNameLen;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Uint;
-
- VariableNameLen = StrLen (VariableName);
-
- if (VariableNameLen <= 4) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mBmLoadOptionName) / sizeof (mBmLoadOptionName[0]); Index++) {
- if ((VariableNameLen - 4 == StrLen (mBmLoadOptionName[Index])) &&
- (StrnCmp (VariableName, mBmLoadOptionName[Index], VariableNameLen - 4) == 0)
- ) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (Index == sizeof (mBmLoadOptionName) / sizeof (mBmLoadOptionName[0])) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- *OptionType = (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE) Index;
- *OptionNumber = 0;
- for (Index = VariableNameLen - 4; Index < VariableNameLen; Index++) {
- Uint = BmCharToUint (VariableName[Index]);
- if (Uint == -1) {
- break;
- } else {
- *OptionNumber = (UINT16) Uint + *OptionNumber * 0x10;
- }
- }
-
- return (BOOLEAN) (Index == VariableNameLen);
-}
-
-/**
- Build the Boot#### or Driver#### option from the VariableName.
-
- @param VariableName Variable name of the load option
- @param VendorGuid Variable GUID of the load option
- @param Option Return the load option.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Get the option just been created
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Failed to get the new option
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerVariableToLoadOptionEx (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Option
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 Attribute;
- UINT16 FilePathSize;
- UINT8 *Variable;
- UINT8 *VariablePtr;
- UINTN VariableSize;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath;
- UINT8 *OptionalData;
- UINT32 OptionalDataSize;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE OptionType;
- UINT16 OptionNumber;
-
- if ((VariableName == NULL) || (Option == NULL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (!BmIsValidLoadOptionVariableName (VariableName, &OptionType, &OptionNumber)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Read the variable
- //
- GetVariable2 (VariableName, VendorGuid, (VOID **) &Variable, &VariableSize);
- if (Variable == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- //
- // Validate *#### variable data.
- //
- if (!BmValidateOption(Variable, VariableSize)) {
- FreePool (Variable);
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the option attribute
- //
- VariablePtr = Variable;
- Attribute = ReadUnaligned32 ((UINT32 *) VariablePtr);
- VariablePtr += sizeof (UINT32);
-
- //
- // Get the option's device path size
- //
- FilePathSize = ReadUnaligned16 ((UINT16 *) VariablePtr);
- VariablePtr += sizeof (UINT16);
-
- //
- // Get the option's description string
- //
- Description = (CHAR16 *) VariablePtr;
-
- //
- // Get the option's description string size
- //
- VariablePtr += StrSize ((CHAR16 *) VariablePtr);
-
- //
- // Get the option's device path
- //
- FilePath = (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) VariablePtr;
- VariablePtr += FilePathSize;
-
- OptionalDataSize = (UINT32) (VariableSize - (UINTN) (VariablePtr - Variable));
- if (OptionalDataSize == 0) {
- OptionalData = NULL;
- } else {
- OptionalData = VariablePtr;
- }
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerInitializeLoadOption (
- Option,
- OptionNumber,
- OptionType,
- Attribute,
- Description,
- FilePath,
- OptionalData,
- OptionalDataSize
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- CopyGuid (&Option->VendorGuid, VendorGuid);
-
- FreePool (Variable);
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
-Build the Boot#### or Driver#### option from the VariableName.
-
-@param VariableName EFI Variable name indicate if it is Boot#### or Driver####
-@param Option Return the Boot#### or Driver#### option.
-
-@retval EFI_SUCCESS Get the option just been created
-@retval EFI_NOT_FOUND Failed to get the new option
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerVariableToLoadOption (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN OUT EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Option
- )
-{
- return EfiBootManagerVariableToLoadOptionEx (VariableName, &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid, Option);
-}
-
-/**
- Returns an array of load options based on the EFI variable
- L"BootOrder"/L"DriverOrder" and the L"Boot####"/L"Driver####" variables impled by it.
- #### is the hex value of the UINT16 in each BootOrder/DriverOrder entry.
-
- @param LoadOptionCount Returns number of entries in the array.
- @param LoadOptionType The type of the load option.
-
- @retval NULL No load options exist.
- @retval !NULL Array of load option entries.
-
-**/
-EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions (
- OUT UINTN *OptionCount,
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE LoadOptionType
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT16 *OptionOrder;
- UINTN OptionOrderSize;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN OptionIndex;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Options;
- CHAR16 OptionName[BM_OPTION_NAME_LEN];
- UINT16 OptionNumber;
-
- *OptionCount = 0;
-
- if (LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeDriver || LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeSysPrep || LoadOptionType == LoadOptionTypeBoot) {
- //
- // Read the BootOrder, or DriverOrder variable.
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (mBmLoadOptionOrderName[LoadOptionType], (VOID **) &OptionOrder, &OptionOrderSize);
- if (OptionOrder == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- *OptionCount = OptionOrderSize / sizeof (UINT16);
-
- Options = AllocatePool (*OptionCount * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION));
- ASSERT (Options != NULL);
-
- OptionIndex = 0;
- for (Index = 0; Index < *OptionCount; Index++) {
- OptionNumber = OptionOrder[Index];
- UnicodeSPrint (OptionName, sizeof (OptionName), L"%s%04x", mBmLoadOptionName[LoadOptionType], OptionNumber);
-
- Status = EfiBootManagerVariableToLoadOption (OptionName, &Options[OptionIndex]);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds] %s doesn't exist - Update ****Order variable to remove the reference!!", OptionName));
- EfiBootManagerDeleteLoadOptionVariable (OptionNumber, LoadOptionType);
- } else {
- ASSERT (Options[OptionIndex].OptionNumber == OptionNumber);
- OptionIndex++;
- }
- }
-
- if (OptionOrder != NULL) {
- FreePool (OptionOrder);
- }
-
- if (OptionIndex < *OptionCount) {
- Options = ReallocatePool (*OptionCount * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION), OptionIndex * sizeof (EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION), Options);
- ASSERT (Options != NULL);
- *OptionCount = OptionIndex;
- }
-
- } else {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- return Options;
-}
-
-/**
- Free an EFI_BOOT_MANGER_LOAD_OPTION entry that was allocate by the library.
-
- @param LoadOption Pointer to boot option to Free.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS BootOption was freed
- @return EFI_NOT_FOUND BootOption == NULL
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOption (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *LoadOption
- )
-{
- if (LoadOption == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- if (LoadOption->Description != NULL) {
- FreePool (LoadOption->Description);
- }
- if (LoadOption->FilePath != NULL) {
- FreePool (LoadOption->FilePath);
- }
- if (LoadOption->OptionalData != NULL) {
- FreePool (LoadOption->OptionalData);
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Free an EFI_BOOT_MANGER_LOAD_OPTION array that was allocated by
- EfiBootManagerGetLoadOptions().
-
- @param Option Pointer to boot option array to free.
- @param OptionCount Number of array entries in BootOption
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS BootOption was freed
- @return EFI_NOT_FOUND BootOption == NULL
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOptions (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Option,
- IN UINTN OptionCount
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- if (Option == NULL) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0;Index < OptionCount; Index++) {
- EfiBootManagerFreeLoadOption (&Option[Index]);
- }
-
- FreePool (Option);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Return whether the PE header of the load option is valid or not.
-
- @param[in] Type The load option type.
- @param[in] FileBuffer The PE file buffer of the load option.
- @param[in] FileSize The size of the load option file.
-
- @retval TRUE The PE header of the load option is valid.
- @retval FALSE The PE header of the load option is not valid.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsLoadOptionPeHeaderValid (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE Type,
- IN VOID *FileBuffer,
- IN UINTN FileSize
- )
-{
- EFI_IMAGE_DOS_HEADER *DosHeader;
- EFI_IMAGE_OPTIONAL_HEADER_UNION *PeHeader;
- EFI_IMAGE_OPTIONAL_HEADER32 *OptionalHeader;
- UINT16 Subsystem;
-
- if (FileBuffer == NULL || FileSize == 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Read dos header
- //
- DosHeader = (EFI_IMAGE_DOS_HEADER *) FileBuffer;
- if (FileSize >= sizeof (EFI_IMAGE_DOS_HEADER) &&
- FileSize > DosHeader->e_lfanew && DosHeader->e_magic == EFI_IMAGE_DOS_SIGNATURE
- ) {
- //
- // Read and check PE signature
- //
- PeHeader = (EFI_IMAGE_OPTIONAL_HEADER_UNION *) ((UINT8 *) FileBuffer + DosHeader->e_lfanew);
- if (FileSize >= DosHeader->e_lfanew + sizeof (EFI_IMAGE_OPTIONAL_HEADER_UNION) &&
- PeHeader->Pe32.Signature == EFI_IMAGE_NT_SIGNATURE
- ) {
- //
- // Check PE32 or PE32+ magic, and machine type
- //
- OptionalHeader = (EFI_IMAGE_OPTIONAL_HEADER32 *) &PeHeader->Pe32.OptionalHeader;
- if ((OptionalHeader->Magic == EFI_IMAGE_NT_OPTIONAL_HDR32_MAGIC ||
- OptionalHeader->Magic == EFI_IMAGE_NT_OPTIONAL_HDR64_MAGIC) &&
- EFI_IMAGE_MACHINE_TYPE_SUPPORTED (PeHeader->Pe32.FileHeader.Machine)
- ) {
- //
- // Check the Subsystem:
- // Driver#### must be of type BootServiceDriver or RuntimeDriver
- // SysPrep####, Boot####, OsRecovery####, PlatformRecovery#### must be of type Application
- //
- Subsystem = OptionalHeader->Subsystem;
- if ((Type == LoadOptionTypeDriver && Subsystem == EFI_IMAGE_SUBSYSTEM_EFI_BOOT_SERVICE_DRIVER) ||
- (Type == LoadOptionTypeDriver && Subsystem == EFI_IMAGE_SUBSYSTEM_EFI_RUNTIME_DRIVER) ||
- (Type == LoadOptionTypeSysPrep && Subsystem == EFI_IMAGE_SUBSYSTEM_EFI_APPLICATION) ||
- (Type == LoadOptionTypeBoot && Subsystem == EFI_IMAGE_SUBSYSTEM_EFI_APPLICATION)
- ) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Process (load and execute) the load option.
-
- @param LoadOption Pointer to the load option.
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The load option type is invalid,
- or the load option file path doesn't point to a valid file.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED The load option type is of LoadOptionTypeBoot.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The load option is inactive, or successfully loaded and executed.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-EfiBootManagerProcessLoadOption (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *LoadOption
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath;
- EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle;
- EFI_LOADED_IMAGE_PROTOCOL *ImageInfo;
- VOID *FileBuffer;
- UINTN FileSize;
-
- if ((UINT32) LoadOption->OptionType >= LoadOptionTypeMax) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (LoadOption->OptionType == LoadOptionTypeBoot) {
- return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
- }
-
- //
- // If a load option is not marked as LOAD_OPTION_ACTIVE,
- // the boot manager will not automatically load the option.
- //
- if ((LoadOption->Attributes & LOAD_OPTION_ACTIVE) == 0) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
-
- //
- // Load and start the load option.
- //
- DEBUG ((
- DEBUG_INFO | DEBUG_LOAD, "Process Load Option (%s%04x) ...\n",
- mBmLoadOptionName[LoadOption->OptionType], LoadOption->OptionNumber
- ));
- ImageHandle = NULL;
- FileBuffer = BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (LoadOption->FilePath, &FilePath, &FileSize);
- DEBUG_CODE (
- if (FileBuffer != NULL && CompareMem (LoadOption->FilePath, FilePath, GetDevicePathSize (FilePath)) != 0) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[Bds] DevicePath expand: "));
- BmPrintDp (LoadOption->FilePath);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " -> "));
- BmPrintDp (FilePath);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "\n"));
- }
- );
- if (BmIsLoadOptionPeHeaderValid (LoadOption->OptionType, FileBuffer, FileSize)) {
- Status = gBS->LoadImage (
- FALSE,
- gImageHandle,
- FilePath,
- FileBuffer,
- FileSize,
- &ImageHandle
- );
- }
- if (FilePath != NULL) {
- FreePool (FilePath);
- }
- if (FileBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (FileBuffer);
- }
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (ImageHandle, &gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid, (VOID **) &ImageInfo);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- ImageInfo->LoadOptionsSize = LoadOption->OptionalDataSize;
- ImageInfo->LoadOptions = LoadOption->OptionalData;
- //
- // Before calling the image, enable the Watchdog Timer for the 5-minute period
- //
- gBS->SetWatchdogTimer (5 * 60, 0, 0, NULL);
-
- LoadOption->Status = gBS->StartImage (ImageHandle, &LoadOption->ExitDataSize, &LoadOption->ExitData);
- DEBUG ((
- DEBUG_INFO | DEBUG_LOAD, "Load Option (%s%04x) Return Status = %r\n",
- mBmLoadOptionName[LoadOption->OptionType], LoadOption->OptionNumber, LoadOption->Status
- ));
-
- //
- // Clear the Watchdog Timer after the image returns
- //
- gBS->SetWatchdogTimer (0, 0, 0, NULL);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmMisc.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmMisc.c deleted file mode 100644 index e675904857..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmMisc.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,391 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Misc library functions.
-
-Copyright (c) 2011 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-/**
- Delete the instance in Multi which matches partly with Single instance
-
- @param Multi A pointer to a multi-instance device path data
- structure.
- @param Single A pointer to a single-instance device path data
- structure.
-
- @return This function will remove the device path instances in Multi which partly
- match with the Single, and return the result device path. If there is no
- remaining device path as a result, this function will return NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *
-BmDelPartMatchInstance (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Multi,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Single
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Instance;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *NewDevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempNewDevicePath;
- UINTN InstanceSize;
- UINTN SingleDpSize;
-
- NewDevicePath = NULL;
- TempNewDevicePath = NULL;
-
- if (Multi == NULL || Single == NULL) {
- return Multi;
- }
-
- Instance = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&Multi, &InstanceSize);
- SingleDpSize = GetDevicePathSize (Single) - END_DEVICE_PATH_LENGTH;
- InstanceSize -= END_DEVICE_PATH_LENGTH;
-
- while (Instance != NULL) {
-
- if (CompareMem (Instance, Single, MIN (SingleDpSize, InstanceSize)) != 0) {
- //
- // Append the device path instance which does not match with Single
- //
- TempNewDevicePath = NewDevicePath;
- NewDevicePath = AppendDevicePathInstance (NewDevicePath, Instance);
- if (TempNewDevicePath != NULL) {
- FreePool(TempNewDevicePath);
- }
- }
- FreePool(Instance);
- Instance = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&Multi, &InstanceSize);
- InstanceSize -= END_DEVICE_PATH_LENGTH;
- }
-
- return NewDevicePath;
-}
-
-/**
- Function compares a device path data structure to that of all the nodes of a
- second device path instance.
-
- @param Multi A pointer to a multi-instance device path data
- structure.
- @param Single A pointer to a single-instance device path data
- structure.
-
- @retval TRUE If the Single device path is contained within Multi device path.
- @retval FALSE The Single device path is not match within Multi device path.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmMatchDevicePaths (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Multi,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Single
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePathInst;
- UINTN Size;
-
- if (Multi == NULL || Single == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- DevicePath = Multi;
- DevicePathInst = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&DevicePath, &Size);
-
- //
- // Search for the match of 'Single' in 'Multi'
- //
- while (DevicePathInst != NULL) {
- //
- // If the single device path is found in multiple device paths,
- // return success
- //
- if (CompareMem (Single, DevicePathInst, Size) == 0) {
- FreePool (DevicePathInst);
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- FreePool (DevicePathInst);
- DevicePathInst = GetNextDevicePathInstance (&DevicePath, &Size);
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- This routine adjust the memory information for different memory type and
- save them into the variables for next boot. It resets the system when
- memory information is updated and the current boot option belongs to
- boot category instead of application category.
-
- @param Boot TRUE if current boot option belongs to boot category instead of
- application category.
-**/
-VOID
-BmSetMemoryTypeInformationVariable (
- IN BOOLEAN Boot
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_MEMORY_TYPE_INFORMATION *PreviousMemoryTypeInformation;
- EFI_MEMORY_TYPE_INFORMATION *CurrentMemoryTypeInformation;
- UINTN VariableSize;
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Index1;
- UINT32 Previous;
- UINT32 Current;
- UINT32 Next;
- EFI_HOB_GUID_TYPE *GuidHob;
- BOOLEAN MemoryTypeInformationModified;
- BOOLEAN MemoryTypeInformationVariableExists;
- EFI_BOOT_MODE BootMode;
-
- MemoryTypeInformationModified = FALSE;
- MemoryTypeInformationVariableExists = FALSE;
-
-
- BootMode = GetBootModeHob ();
- //
- // In BOOT_IN_RECOVERY_MODE, Variable region is not reliable.
- //
- if (BootMode == BOOT_IN_RECOVERY_MODE) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Only check the the Memory Type Information variable in the boot mode
- // other than BOOT_WITH_DEFAULT_SETTINGS because the Memory Type
- // Information is not valid in this boot mode.
- //
- if (BootMode != BOOT_WITH_DEFAULT_SETTINGS) {
- VariableSize = 0;
- Status = gRT->GetVariable (
- EFI_MEMORY_TYPE_INFORMATION_VARIABLE_NAME,
- &gEfiMemoryTypeInformationGuid,
- NULL,
- &VariableSize,
- NULL
- );
- if (Status == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- MemoryTypeInformationVariableExists = TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the current memory usage statistics. If they are not found, then
- // no adjustments can be made to the Memory Type Information variable.
- //
- Status = EfiGetSystemConfigurationTable (
- &gEfiMemoryTypeInformationGuid,
- (VOID **) &CurrentMemoryTypeInformation
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || CurrentMemoryTypeInformation == NULL) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the Memory Type Information settings from Hob if they exist,
- // PEI is responsible for getting them from variable and build a Hob to save them.
- // If the previous Memory Type Information is not available, then set defaults
- //
- GuidHob = GetFirstGuidHob (&gEfiMemoryTypeInformationGuid);
- if (GuidHob == NULL) {
- //
- // If Platform has not built Memory Type Info into the Hob, just return.
- //
- return;
- }
- PreviousMemoryTypeInformation = GET_GUID_HOB_DATA (GuidHob);
- VariableSize = GET_GUID_HOB_DATA_SIZE (GuidHob);
-
- //
- // Use a heuristic to adjust the Memory Type Information for the next boot
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Memory Previous Current Next \n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Type Pages Pages Pages \n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "====== ======== ======== ========\n"));
-
- for (Index = 0; PreviousMemoryTypeInformation[Index].Type != EfiMaxMemoryType; Index++) {
-
- for (Index1 = 0; CurrentMemoryTypeInformation[Index1].Type != EfiMaxMemoryType; Index1++) {
- if (PreviousMemoryTypeInformation[Index].Type == CurrentMemoryTypeInformation[Index1].Type) {
- break;
- }
- }
- if (CurrentMemoryTypeInformation[Index1].Type == EfiMaxMemoryType) {
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // Previous is the number of pages pre-allocated
- // Current is the number of pages actually needed
- //
- Previous = PreviousMemoryTypeInformation[Index].NumberOfPages;
- Current = CurrentMemoryTypeInformation[Index1].NumberOfPages;
- Next = Previous;
-
- //
- // Inconsistent Memory Reserved across bootings may lead to S4 fail
- // Write next varible to 125% * current when the pre-allocated memory is:
- // 1. More than 150% of needed memory and boot mode is BOOT_WITH_DEFAULT_SETTING
- // 2. Less than the needed memory
- //
- if ((Current + (Current >> 1)) < Previous) {
- if (BootMode == BOOT_WITH_DEFAULT_SETTINGS) {
- Next = Current + (Current >> 2);
- }
- } else if (Current > Previous) {
- Next = Current + (Current >> 2);
- }
- if (Next > 0 && Next < 4) {
- Next = 4;
- }
-
- if (Next != Previous) {
- PreviousMemoryTypeInformation[Index].NumberOfPages = Next;
- MemoryTypeInformationModified = TRUE;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " %02x %08x %08x %08x\n", PreviousMemoryTypeInformation[Index].Type, Previous, Current, Next));
- }
-
- //
- // If any changes were made to the Memory Type Information settings, then set the new variable value;
- // Or create the variable in first boot.
- //
- if (MemoryTypeInformationModified || !MemoryTypeInformationVariableExists) {
- Status = BmSetVariableAndReportStatusCodeOnError (
- EFI_MEMORY_TYPE_INFORMATION_VARIABLE_NAME,
- &gEfiMemoryTypeInformationGuid,
- EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE | EFI_VARIABLE_BOOTSERVICE_ACCESS,
- VariableSize,
- PreviousMemoryTypeInformation
- );
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // If the Memory Type Information settings have been modified and the boot option belongs to boot category,
- // then reset the platform so the new Memory Type Information setting will be used to guarantee that an S4
- // entry/resume cycle will not fail.
- //
- if (MemoryTypeInformationModified && Boot && PcdGetBool (PcdResetOnMemoryTypeInformationChange)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Memory Type Information settings change. Warm Reset!!!\n"));
- gRT->ResetSystem (EfiResetWarm, EFI_SUCCESS, 0, NULL);
- }
- } else {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "Memory Type Information settings cannot be saved. OS S4 may fail!\n"));
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Set the variable and report the error through status code upon failure.
-
- @param VariableName A Null-terminated string that is the name of the vendor's variable.
- Each VariableName is unique for each VendorGuid. VariableName must
- contain 1 or more characters. If VariableName is an empty string,
- then EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
- @param VendorGuid A unique identifier for the vendor.
- @param Attributes Attributes bitmask to set for the variable.
- @param DataSize The size in bytes of the Data buffer. Unless the EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE,
- EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS, or
- EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS attribute is set, a size of zero
- causes the variable to be deleted. When the EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE attribute is
- set, then a SetVariable() call with a DataSize of zero will not cause any change to
- the variable value (the timestamp associated with the variable may be updated however
- even if no new data value is provided,see the description of the
- EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2 descriptor below. In this case the DataSize will not
- be zero since the EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2 descriptor will be populated).
- @param Data The contents for the variable.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The firmware has successfully stored the variable and its data as
- defined by the Attributes.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER An invalid combination of attribute bits, name, and GUID was supplied, or the
- DataSize exceeds the maximum allowed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER VariableName is an empty string.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough storage is available to hold the variable and its data.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The variable could not be retrieved due to a hardware error.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED The variable in question is read-only.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED The variable in question cannot be deleted.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION The variable could not be written due to EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS
- or EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACESS being set, but the AuthInfo
- does NOT pass the validation check carried out by the firmware.
-
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The variable trying to be updated or deleted was not found.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmSetVariableAndReportStatusCodeOnError (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EDKII_SET_VARIABLE_STATUS *SetVariableStatus;
- UINTN NameSize;
-
- Status = gRT->SetVariable (
- VariableName,
- VendorGuid,
- Attributes,
- DataSize,
- Data
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- NameSize = StrSize (VariableName);
- SetVariableStatus = AllocatePool (sizeof (EDKII_SET_VARIABLE_STATUS) + NameSize + DataSize);
- if (SetVariableStatus != NULL) {
- CopyGuid (&SetVariableStatus->Guid, VendorGuid);
- SetVariableStatus->NameSize = NameSize;
- SetVariableStatus->DataSize = DataSize;
- SetVariableStatus->SetStatus = Status;
- SetVariableStatus->Attributes = Attributes;
- CopyMem (SetVariableStatus + 1, VariableName, NameSize);
- CopyMem (((UINT8 *) (SetVariableStatus + 1)) + NameSize, Data, DataSize);
-
- REPORT_STATUS_CODE_EX (
- EFI_ERROR_CODE,
- PcdGet32 (PcdErrorCodeSetVariable),
- 0,
- NULL,
- &gEdkiiStatusCodeDataTypeVariableGuid,
- SetVariableStatus,
- sizeof (EDKII_SET_VARIABLE_STATUS) + NameSize + DataSize
- );
-
- FreePool (SetVariableStatus);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-
-/**
- Print the device path info.
-
- @param DevicePath The device path need to print.
-**/
-VOID
-BmPrintDp (
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- )
-{
- CHAR16 *Str;
-
- Str = ConvertDevicePathToText (DevicePath, FALSE, FALSE);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%s", Str));
- if (Str != NULL) {
- FreePool (Str);
- }
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmPerformance.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmPerformance.c deleted file mode 100644 index 0abd019440..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/BmPerformance.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,317 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This file include the file which can help to get the system
- performance, all the function will only include if the performance
- switch is set.
-
-Copyright (c) 2004 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalBm.h"
-
-PERF_HEADER mBmPerfHeader;
-PERF_DATA mBmPerfData;
-EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS mBmAcpiLowMemoryBase = 0x0FFFFFFFFULL;
-
-/**
- Get the short verion of PDB file name to be
- used in performance data logging.
-
- @param PdbFileName The long PDB file name.
- @param GaugeString The output string to be logged by performance logger.
- @param StringSize The buffer size of GaugeString in bytes.
-
-**/
-VOID
-BmGetShortPdbFileName (
- IN CONST CHAR8 *PdbFileName,
- OUT CHAR8 *GaugeString,
- IN UINTN StringSize
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN Index1;
- UINTN StartIndex;
- UINTN EndIndex;
-
- if (PdbFileName == NULL) {
- AsciiStrCpyS (GaugeString, StringSize, " ");
- } else {
- StartIndex = 0;
- for (EndIndex = 0; PdbFileName[EndIndex] != 0; EndIndex++)
- ;
-
- for (Index = 0; PdbFileName[Index] != 0; Index++) {
- if (PdbFileName[Index] == '\\') {
- StartIndex = Index + 1;
- }
-
- if (PdbFileName[Index] == '.') {
- EndIndex = Index;
- }
- }
-
- Index1 = 0;
- for (Index = StartIndex; Index < EndIndex; Index++) {
- GaugeString[Index1] = PdbFileName[Index];
- Index1++;
- if (Index1 == StringSize - 1) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- GaugeString[Index1] = 0;
- }
-
- return ;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the name from the Driver handle, which can be a handle with
- EFI_LOADED_IMAGE_PROTOCOL or EFI_DRIVER_BINDING_PROTOCOL installed.
- This name can be used in performance data logging.
-
- @param Handle Driver handle.
- @param GaugeString The output string to be logged by performance logger.
- @param StringSize The buffer size of GaugeString in bytes.
-
-**/
-VOID
-BmGetNameFromHandle (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle,
- OUT CHAR8 *GaugeString,
- IN UINTN StringSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_LOADED_IMAGE_PROTOCOL *Image;
- CHAR8 *PdbFileName;
- EFI_DRIVER_BINDING_PROTOCOL *DriverBinding;
-
- AsciiStrCpyS (GaugeString, StringSize, " ");
-
- //
- // Get handle name from image protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- Handle,
- &gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &Image
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = gBS->OpenProtocol (
- Handle,
- &gEfiDriverBindingProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &DriverBinding,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_GET_PROTOCOL
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return ;
- }
- //
- // Get handle name from image protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- DriverBinding->ImageHandle,
- &gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &Image
- );
- }
-
- PdbFileName = PeCoffLoaderGetPdbPointer (Image->ImageBase);
-
- if (PdbFileName != NULL) {
- BmGetShortPdbFileName (PdbFileName, GaugeString, StringSize);
- }
-
- return ;
-}
-
-/**
-
- Writes performance data of booting into the allocated memory.
- OS can process these records.
-
- @param Event The triggered event.
- @param Context Context for this event.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-BmWriteBootToOsPerformanceData (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINT32 LimitCount;
- EFI_HANDLE *Handles;
- UINTN NoHandles;
- CHAR8 GaugeString[PERF_TOKEN_SIZE];
- UINT8 *Ptr;
- UINT32 Index;
- UINT64 Ticker;
- UINT64 Freq;
- UINT32 Duration;
- UINTN LogEntryKey;
- CONST VOID *Handle;
- CONST CHAR8 *Token;
- CONST CHAR8 *Module;
- UINT64 StartTicker;
- UINT64 EndTicker;
- UINT64 StartValue;
- UINT64 EndValue;
- BOOLEAN CountUp;
- UINTN VarSize;
- BOOLEAN Found;
-
- //
- // Record the performance data for End of BDS
- //
- PERF_END(NULL, "BDS", NULL, 0);
-
- //
- // Retrieve time stamp count as early as possible
- //
- Ticker = GetPerformanceCounter ();
-
- Freq = GetPerformanceCounterProperties (&StartValue, &EndValue);
-
- Freq = DivU64x32 (Freq, 1000);
-
- mBmPerfHeader.CpuFreq = Freq;
-
- //
- // Record BDS raw performance data
- //
- if (EndValue >= StartValue) {
- mBmPerfHeader.BDSRaw = Ticker - StartValue;
- CountUp = TRUE;
- } else {
- mBmPerfHeader.BDSRaw = StartValue - Ticker;
- CountUp = FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Reset the entry count
- //
- mBmPerfHeader.Count = 0;
-
- if (mBmAcpiLowMemoryBase == 0x0FFFFFFFF) {
- VarSize = sizeof (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS);
- Status = gRT->GetVariable (
- L"PerfDataMemAddr",
- &gPerformanceProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &VarSize,
- &mBmAcpiLowMemoryBase
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Fail to get the variable, return.
- //
- return;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Put Detailed performance data into memory
- //
- Handles = NULL;
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- AllHandles,
- NULL,
- NULL,
- &NoHandles,
- &Handles
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return ;
- }
-
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((UINT32) mBmAcpiLowMemoryBase + sizeof (PERF_HEADER));
- LimitCount = (UINT32) (PERF_DATA_MAX_LENGTH - sizeof (PERF_HEADER)) / sizeof (PERF_DATA);
-
- //
- // Get performance data
- //
- LogEntryKey = 0;
- while ((LogEntryKey = GetPerformanceMeasurement (
- LogEntryKey,
- &Handle,
- &Token,
- &Module,
- &StartTicker,
- &EndTicker)) != 0) {
- if (EndTicker != 0) {
- if (StartTicker == 1) {
- StartTicker = StartValue;
- }
- if (EndTicker == 1) {
- EndTicker = StartValue;
- }
- Ticker = CountUp ? (EndTicker - StartTicker) : (StartTicker - EndTicker);
-
- Duration = (UINT32) DivU64x32 (Ticker, (UINT32) Freq);
- if (Duration == 0) {
- continue;
- }
-
- ZeroMem (&mBmPerfData, sizeof (PERF_DATA));
-
- mBmPerfData.Duration = Duration;
-
- //
- // See if the Handle is in the handle buffer
- //
- Found = FALSE;
- for (Index = 0; Index < NoHandles; Index++) {
- if (Handle == Handles[Index]) {
- BmGetNameFromHandle (Handles[Index], GaugeString, PERF_TOKEN_SIZE);
- AsciiStrCpyS (mBmPerfData.Token, PERF_TOKEN_SIZE, GaugeString);
- Found = TRUE;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- if (!Found) {
- AsciiStrnCpyS (mBmPerfData.Token, PERF_TOKEN_SIZE, Token, PERF_TOKEN_LENGTH);
- }
-
- CopyMem (Ptr, &mBmPerfData, sizeof (PERF_DATA));
- Ptr += sizeof (PERF_DATA);
-
- mBmPerfHeader.Count++;
- if (mBmPerfHeader.Count == LimitCount) {
- goto Done;
- }
- }
- }
-
-Done:
-
- FreePool (Handles);
-
- mBmPerfHeader.Signiture = PERFORMANCE_SIGNATURE;
-
- //
- // Put performance data to Reserved memory
- //
- CopyMem (
- (UINTN *) (UINTN) mBmAcpiLowMemoryBase,
- &mBmPerfHeader,
- sizeof (PERF_HEADER)
- );
-
- return ;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/InternalBm.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/InternalBm.h deleted file mode 100644 index c808ed2ffe..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/InternalBm.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,454 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- BDS library definition, include the file and data structure
-
-Copyright (c) 2004 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _INTERNAL_BM_H_
-#define _INTERNAL_BM_H_
-
-#include <PiDxe.h>
-
-#include <IndustryStandard/Pci.h>
-#include <IndustryStandard/PeImage.h>
-#include <IndustryStandard/Atapi.h>
-#include <IndustryStandard/Scsi.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/PciRootBridgeIo.h>
-#include <Protocol/BlockIo.h>
-#include <Protocol/LoadedImage.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleFileSystem.h>
-#include <Protocol/LoadFile.h>
-#include <Protocol/DevicePath.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleTextIn.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleTextInEx.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleTextOut.h>
-#include <Protocol/SimpleNetwork.h>
-#include <Protocol/FirmwareVolume2.h>
-#include <Protocol/PciIo.h>
-#include <Protocol/GraphicsOutput.h>
-#include <Protocol/UsbIo.h>
-#include <Protocol/DiskInfo.h>
-#include <Protocol/IdeControllerInit.h>
-#include <Protocol/BootLogo.h>
-#include <Protocol/DriverHealth.h>
-#include <Protocol/FormBrowser2.h>
-
-#include <Guid/ZeroGuid.h>
-#include <Guid/MemoryTypeInformation.h>
-#include <Guid/FileInfo.h>
-#include <Guid/GlobalVariable.h>
-#include <Guid/Performance.h>
-#include <Guid/StatusCodeDataTypeVariable.h>
-
-#include <Library/PrintLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/DxeServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/HobLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
-#include <Library/PeCoffGetEntryPointLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootManagerLib.h>
-#include <Library/TimerLib.h>
-#include <Library/DxeServicesLib.h>
-#include <Library/ReportStatusCodeLib.h>
-#include <Library/CapsuleLib.h>
-#include <Library/PerformanceLib.h>
-#include <Library/HiiLib.h>
-
-#if !defined (EFI_REMOVABLE_MEDIA_FILE_NAME)
- #if defined (MDE_CPU_EBC)
- //
- // Uefi specification only defines the default boot file name for IA32, X64
- // and IPF processor, so need define boot file name for EBC architecture here.
- //
- #define EFI_REMOVABLE_MEDIA_FILE_NAME L"\\EFI\\BOOT\\BOOTEBC.EFI"
- #else
- #error "Can not determine the default boot file name for unknown processor type!"
- #endif
-#endif
-
-typedef enum {
- BmAcpiFloppyBoot,
- BmHardwareDeviceBoot,
- BmMessageAtapiBoot,
- BmMessageSataBoot,
- BmMessageUsbBoot,
- BmMessageScsiBoot,
- BmMessageNetworkBoot,
- BmMessageHttpBoot,
- BmMiscBoot
-} BM_BOOT_TYPE;
-
-typedef
-CHAR16 *
-(* BM_GET_BOOT_DESCRIPTION) (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Handle
- );
-
-#define BM_OPTION_NAME_LEN sizeof ("SysPrep####")
-extern CHAR16 *mBmLoadOptionName[];
-
-typedef
-VOID
-(*VARIABLE_VISITOR) (
- CHAR16 *Name,
- EFI_GUID *Guid,
- VOID *Context
- );
-
-/**
- Call Visitor function for each variable in variable storage.
-
- @param Visitor Visitor function.
- @param Context The context passed to Visitor function.
-**/
-VOID
-ForEachVariable (
- VARIABLE_VISITOR Visitor,
- VOID *Context
- );
-
-#define BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('b', 'm', 'd', 'h')
-typedef struct {
- UINT32 Signature;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
- EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_HANDLER Handler;
-} BM_BOOT_DESCRIPTION_ENTRY;
-
-/**
- Repair all the controllers according to the Driver Health status queried.
-**/
-VOID
-BmRepairAllControllers (
- VOID
- );
-
-#define BM_HOTKEY_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('b', 'm', 'h', 'k')
-typedef struct {
- UINT32 Signature;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
-
- BOOLEAN IsContinue;
- UINT16 BootOption;
- UINT8 CodeCount;
- UINT8 WaitingKey;
- EFI_KEY_DATA KeyData[3];
-} BM_HOTKEY;
-
-#define BM_HOTKEY_FROM_LINK(a) CR (a, BM_HOTKEY, Link, BM_HOTKEY_SIGNATURE)
-
-/**
- Get the image file buffer data and buffer size by its device path.
-
- @param FilePath On input, a pointer to an allocated buffer containing the device
- path of the file.
- On output the pointer could be NULL when the function fails to
- load the boot option, or could point to an allocated buffer containing
- the device path of the file.
- It could be updated by either short-form device path expanding,
- or default boot file path appending.
- Caller is responsible to free it when it's non-NULL.
- @param FileSize A pointer to the size of the file buffer.
-
- @retval NULL File is NULL, or FileSize is NULL. Or, the file can't be found.
- @retval other The file buffer. The caller is responsible to free the memory.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmLoadEfiBootOption (
- IN OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FilePath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize
- );
-
-/**
- Get the Option Number that wasn't used.
-
- @param LoadOptionType Load option type.
- @param FreeOptionNumber To receive the minimal free option number.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The option number is found
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is no free option number that can be used.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER FreeOptionNumber is NULL
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmGetFreeOptionNumber (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE LoadOptionType,
- OUT UINT16 *FreeOptionNumber
- );
-
-/**
-
- Writes performance data of booting into the allocated memory.
- OS can process these records.
-
- @param Event The triggered event.
- @param Context Context for this event.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-BmWriteBootToOsPerformanceData (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- );
-
-
-/**
- Get the headers (dos, image, optional header) from an image
-
- @param Device SimpleFileSystem device handle
- @param FileName File name for the image
- @param DosHeader Pointer to dos header
- @param Hdr The buffer in which to return the PE32, PE32+, or TE header.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully get the machine type.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The file is not found.
- @retval EFI_LOAD_ERROR File is not a valid image file.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmGetImageHeader (
- IN EFI_HANDLE Device,
- IN CHAR16 *FileName,
- OUT EFI_IMAGE_DOS_HEADER *DosHeader,
- OUT EFI_IMAGE_OPTIONAL_HEADER_PTR_UNION Hdr
- );
-
-/**
- This routine adjust the memory information for different memory type and
- save them into the variables for next boot. It resets the system when
- memory information is updated and the current boot option belongs to
- boot category instead of application category.
-
- @param Boot TRUE if current boot option belongs to boot category instead of
- application category.
-**/
-VOID
-BmSetMemoryTypeInformationVariable (
- IN BOOLEAN Boot
- );
-
-/**
- Check whether there is a instance in BlockIoDevicePath, which contain multi device path
- instances, has the same partition node with HardDriveDevicePath device path
-
- @param BlockIoDevicePath Multi device path instances which need to check
- @param HardDriveDevicePath A device path which starts with a hard drive media
- device path.
-
- @retval TRUE There is a matched device path instance.
- @retval FALSE There is no matched device path instance.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmMatchPartitionDevicePathNode (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *BlockIoDevicePath,
- IN HARDDRIVE_DEVICE_PATH *HardDriveDevicePath
- );
-
-/**
- Connect the specific Usb device which match the short form device path.
-
- @param DevicePath A short-form device path that starts with the first
- element being a USB WWID or a USB Class device
- path
-
- @return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER DevicePath is NULL pointer.
- DevicePath is not a USB device path.
-
- @return EFI_SUCCESS Success to connect USB device
- @return EFI_NOT_FOUND Fail to find handle for USB controller to connect.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmConnectUsbShortFormDevicePath (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- );
-
-/**
- Stop the hotkey processing.
-
- @param Event Event pointer related to hotkey service.
- @param Context Context pass to this function.
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-BmStopHotkeyService (
- IN EFI_EVENT Event,
- IN VOID *Context
- );
-
-/**
- Set the variable and report the error through status code upon failure.
-
- @param VariableName A Null-terminated string that is the name of the vendor's variable.
- Each VariableName is unique for each VendorGuid. VariableName must
- contain 1 or more characters. If VariableName is an empty string,
- then EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER is returned.
- @param VendorGuid A unique identifier for the vendor.
- @param Attributes Attributes bitmask to set for the variable.
- @param DataSize The size in bytes of the Data buffer. Unless the EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE,
- EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS, or
- EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS attribute is set, a size of zero
- causes the variable to be deleted. When the EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE attribute is
- set, then a SetVariable() call with a DataSize of zero will not cause any change to
- the variable value (the timestamp associated with the variable may be updated however
- even if no new data value is provided,see the description of the
- EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2 descriptor below. In this case the DataSize will not
- be zero since the EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATION_2 descriptor will be populated).
- @param Data The contents for the variable.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The firmware has successfully stored the variable and its data as
- defined by the Attributes.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER An invalid combination of attribute bits, name, and GUID was supplied, or the
- DataSize exceeds the maximum allowed.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER VariableName is an empty string.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Not enough storage is available to hold the variable and its data.
- @retval EFI_DEVICE_ERROR The variable could not be retrieved due to a hardware error.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED The variable in question is read-only.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED The variable in question cannot be deleted.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION The variable could not be written due to EFI_VARIABLE_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS
- or EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACESS being set, but the AuthInfo
- does NOT pass the validation check carried out by the firmware.
-
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The variable trying to be updated or deleted was not found.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-BmSetVariableAndReportStatusCodeOnError (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- );
-
-/**
- Get the load option by its device path.
-
- @param FilePath The device path pointing to a load option.
- It could be a short-form device path.
- @param FullPath Return the full device path of the load option after
- short-form device path expanding.
- Caller is responsible to free it.
- @param FileSize Return the load option size.
-
- @return The load option buffer. Caller is responsible to free the memory.
-**/
-VOID *
-BmGetLoadOptionBuffer (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePath,
- OUT EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL **FullPath,
- OUT UINTN *FileSize
- );
-
-/**
- Return whether the PE header of the load option is valid or not.
-
- @param[in] Type The load option type.
- @param[in] FileBuffer The PE file buffer of the load option.
- @param[in] FileSize The size of the load option file.
-
- @retval TRUE The PE header of the load option is valid.
- @retval FALSE The PE header of the load option is not valid.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmIsLoadOptionPeHeaderValid (
- IN EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION_TYPE Type,
- IN VOID *FileBuffer,
- IN UINTN FileSize
- );
-
-/**
- Function compares a device path data structure to that of all the nodes of a
- second device path instance.
-
- @param Multi A pointer to a multi-instance device path data
- structure.
- @param Single A pointer to a single-instance device path data
- structure.
-
- @retval TRUE If the Single device path is contained within Multi device path.
- @retval FALSE The Single device path is not match within Multi device path.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BmMatchDevicePaths (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Multi,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Single
- );
-
-/**
- Delete the instance in Multi which matches partly with Single instance
-
- @param Multi A pointer to a multi-instance device path data
- structure.
- @param Single A pointer to a single-instance device path data
- structure.
-
- @return This function will remove the device path instances in Multi which partly
- match with the Single, and return the result device path. If there is no
- remaining device path as a result, this function will return NULL.
-
-**/
-EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *
-BmDelPartMatchInstance (
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Multi,
- IN EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *Single
- );
-
-
-/**
- Return the index of the load option in the load option array.
-
- The function consider two load options are equal when the
- OptionType, Attributes, Description, FilePath and OptionalData are equal.
-
- @param Key Pointer to the load option to be found.
- @param Array Pointer to the array of load options to be found.
- @param Count Number of entries in the Array.
-
- @retval -1 Key wasn't found in the Array.
- @retval 0 ~ Count-1 The index of the Key in the Array.
-**/
-INTN
-BmFindLoadOption (
- IN CONST EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Key,
- IN CONST EFI_BOOT_MANAGER_LOAD_OPTION *Array,
- IN UINTN Count
- );
-
-/**
- Repair all the controllers according to the Driver Health status queried.
-**/
-VOID
-BmRepairAllControllers (
- VOID
- );
-
-/**
- Print the device path info.
-
- @param DevicePath The device path need to print.
-**/
-VOID
-BmPrintDp (
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath
- );
-
-#endif // _INTERNAL_BM_H_
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/UefiBootManagerLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/UefiBootManagerLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index a2c6441dbe..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/UefiBootManagerLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,117 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Define and produce general Boot Manager related interfaces.
-#
-# The implementation provides richful library functions supporting load option
-# manipulation, hotkey registration, UEFI boot, connect/disconnect, console
-# manipulation, driver health checking and etc.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2007 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = UefiBootManagerLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = UefiBootManagerLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 8D4752BC-595E-49a2-B4AF-F3F57B601DE9
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = UefiBootManagerLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- BmPerformance.c
- BmConnect.c
- BmMisc.c
- BmConsole.c
- BmBoot.c
- BmLoadOption.c
- BmHotkey.c
- BmDriverHealth.c
- InternalBm.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- HobLib
- PcdLib
- BaseLib
- UefiLib
- TimerLib
- DebugLib
- PrintLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DevicePathLib
- PerformanceLib
- PeCoffGetEntryPointLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- UefiRuntimeServicesTableLib
- DxeServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- DxeServicesLib
- ReportStatusCodeLib
- PerformanceLib
- HiiLib
- SortLib
-
-[Guids]
- gEfiMemoryTypeInformationGuid ## CONSUMES ## GUID (The identifier of memory type information type in system table)
- ## CONSUMES ## GUID HOB (The hob holding memory type information)
- gEfiGlobalVariableGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## Variable:L"BootCurrent" (The boot option of current boot)
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"BootXX" (Boot option variable)
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Timeout" (The time out value in second of showing progress bar)
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"BootOrder" (The boot option array)
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"DriverOrder" (The driver order list)
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ConIn" (The device path of console in device)
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ConOut" (The device path of console out device)
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ErrOut" (The device path of error out device)
- gEfiFileInfoGuid ## CONSUMES ## GUID
- gPerformanceProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_PRODUCES ## Variable:L"PerfDataMemAddr" (The ACPI address of performance data)
- gEdkiiStatusCodeDataTypeVariableGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
- gEfiDiskInfoAhciInterfaceGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
- gEfiDiskInfoIdeInterfaceGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
- gEfiDiskInfoScsiInterfaceGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
- gZeroGuid ## CONSUMES ## GUID
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiSimpleFileSystemProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiLoadFileProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiSimpleTextOutProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiPciIoProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiLoadedImageProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiSimpleNetworkProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiSimpleTextInProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiBlockIoProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiBootLogoProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiSimpleTextInputExProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiGraphicsOutputProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiUsbIoProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiDiskInfoProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiDriverHealthProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiFormBrowser2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdResetOnMemoryTypeInformationChange ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdProgressCodeOsLoaderLoad ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdProgressCodeOsLoaderStart ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdErrorCodeSetVariable ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdBootManagerMenuFile ## CONSUMES
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdDriverHealthConfigureForm ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/UefiBootManagerLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/UefiBootManagerLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 961fdcada2..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiBootManagerLib/UefiBootManagerLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiLanguage.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiLanguage.c deleted file mode 100644 index 2519afa7d4..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiLanguage.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,96 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Language related HII Library implementation.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2008, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include "InternalHiiLib.h"
-
-/**
- Retrieves a pointer to the a Null-terminated ASCII string containing the list
- of languages that an HII handle in the HII Database supports. The returned
- string is allocated using AllocatePool(). The caller is responsible for freeing
- the returned string using FreePool(). The format of the returned string follows
- the language format assumed the HII Database.
-
- If HiiHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] HiiHandle A handle that was previously registered in the HII Database.
-
- @retval NULL HiiHandle is not registered in the HII database
- @retval NULL There are not enough resources available to retrieve the suported
- languages.
- @retval NULL The list of suported languages could not be retrieved.
- @retval Other A pointer to the Null-terminated ASCII string of supported languages.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiGetSupportedLanguages (
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN LanguageSize;
- CHAR8 TempSupportedLanguages;
- CHAR8 *SupportedLanguages;
-
- ASSERT (HiiHandle != NULL);
-
- //
- // Retrieve the size required for the supported languages buffer.
- //
- LanguageSize = 0;
- Status = gHiiString->GetLanguages (gHiiString, HiiHandle, &TempSupportedLanguages, &LanguageSize);
-
- //
- // If GetLanguages() returns EFI_SUCCESS for a zero size,
- // then there are no supported languages registered for HiiHandle. If GetLanguages()
- // returns an error other than EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL, then HiiHandle is not present
- // in the HII Database
- //
- if (Status != EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- //
- // Return NULL if the size can not be retrieved, or if HiiHandle is not in the HII Database
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate the supported languages buffer.
- //
- SupportedLanguages = AllocateZeroPool (LanguageSize);
- if (SupportedLanguages == NULL) {
- //
- // Return NULL if allocation fails.
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the supported languages string
- //
- Status = gHiiString->GetLanguages (gHiiString, HiiHandle, SupportedLanguages, &LanguageSize);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Free the buffer and return NULL if the supported languages can not be retrieved.
- //
- FreePool (SupportedLanguages);
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Return the Null-terminated ASCII string of supported languages
- //
- return SupportedLanguages;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 66d72acf27..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,4231 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- HII Library implementation that uses DXE protocols and services.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "InternalHiiLib.h"
-
-#define GUID_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE 0x00
-#define NAME_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE 0x01
-#define PATH_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE 0x02
-
-#define ACTION_SET_DEFAUTL_VALUE 0x01
-#define ACTION_VALIDATE_SETTING 0x02
-
-#define HII_LIB_DEFAULT_VARSTORE_SIZE 0x200
-
-typedef struct {
- LIST_ENTRY Entry; // Link to Block array
- UINT16 Offset;
- UINT16 Width;
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Scope;
-} IFR_BLOCK_DATA;
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId;
- UINT16 Size;
-} IFR_VARSTORAGE_DATA;
-
-//
-// <ConfigHdr> Template
-//
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST CHAR16 mConfigHdrTemplate[] = L"GUID=00000000000000000000000000000000&NAME=0000&PATH=00";
-
-EFI_FORM_BROWSER2_PROTOCOL *mUefiFormBrowser2 = NULL;
-
-//
-// Template used to mark the end of a list of packages
-//
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER mEndOfPakageList = {
- sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER),
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_END
-};
-
-/**
- Extract Hii package list GUID for given HII handle.
-
- If HiiHandle could not be found in the HII database, then ASSERT.
- If Guid is NULL, then ASSERT.
-
- @param Handle Hii handle
- @param Guid Package list GUID
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Successfully extract GUID from Hii database.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiExtractGuidFromHiiHandle (
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE Handle,
- OUT EFI_GUID *Guid
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN BufferSize;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageList;
-
- ASSERT (Guid != NULL);
- ASSERT (Handle != NULL);
-
- //
- // Get HII PackageList
- //
- BufferSize = 0;
- HiiPackageList = NULL;
-
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (gHiiDatabase, Handle, &BufferSize, HiiPackageList);
- ASSERT (Status != EFI_NOT_FOUND);
-
- if (Status == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- HiiPackageList = AllocatePool (BufferSize);
- ASSERT (HiiPackageList != NULL);
-
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (gHiiDatabase, Handle, &BufferSize, HiiPackageList);
- }
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (HiiPackageList);
- return Status;
- }
-
- //
- // Extract GUID
- //
- CopyGuid (Guid, &HiiPackageList->PackageListGuid);
-
- FreePool (HiiPackageList);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Registers a list of packages in the HII Database and returns the HII Handle
- associated with that registration. If an HII Handle has already been registered
- with the same PackageListGuid and DeviceHandle, then NULL is returned. If there
- are not enough resources to perform the registration, then NULL is returned.
- If an empty list of packages is passed in, then NULL is returned. If the size of
- the list of package is 0, then NULL is returned.
-
- The variable arguments are pointers which point to package header that defined
- by UEFI VFR compiler and StringGather tool.
-
- #pragma pack (push, 1)
- typedef struct {
- UINT32 BinaryLength;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER PackageHeader;
- } EDKII_AUTOGEN_PACKAGES_HEADER;
- #pragma pack (pop)
-
- @param[in] PackageListGuid The GUID of the package list.
- @param[in] DeviceHandle If not NULL, the Device Handle on which
- an instance of DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL is installed.
- This Device Handle uniquely defines the device that
- the added packages are associated with.
- @param[in] ... The variable argument list that contains pointers
- to packages terminated by a NULL.
-
- @retval NULL A HII Handle has already been registered in the HII Database with
- the same PackageListGuid and DeviceHandle.
- @retval NULL The HII Handle could not be created.
- @retval NULL An empty list of packages was passed in.
- @retval NULL All packages are empty.
- @retval Other The HII Handle associated with the newly registered package list.
-
-**/
-EFI_HII_HANDLE
-EFIAPI
-HiiAddPackages (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *PackageListGuid,
- IN EFI_HANDLE DeviceHandle OPTIONAL,
- ...
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VA_LIST Args;
- UINT32 *Package;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *PackageListHeader;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle;
- UINT32 Length;
- UINT8 *Data;
-
- ASSERT (PackageListGuid != NULL);
-
- //
- // Calculate the length of all the packages in the variable argument list
- //
- for (Length = 0, VA_START (Args, DeviceHandle); (Package = VA_ARG (Args, UINT32 *)) != NULL; ) {
- Length += (ReadUnaligned32 (Package) - sizeof (UINT32));
- }
- VA_END (Args);
-
- //
- // If there are no packages in the variable argument list or all the packages
- // are empty, then return a NULL HII Handle
- //
- if (Length == 0) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Add the length of the Package List Header and the terminating Package Header
- //
- Length += sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER) + sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER);
-
- //
- // Allocate the storage for the entire Package List
- //
- PackageListHeader = AllocateZeroPool (Length);
-
- //
- // If the Package List can not be allocated, then return a NULL HII Handle
- //
- if (PackageListHeader == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Fill in the GUID and Length of the Package List Header
- //
- CopyGuid (&PackageListHeader->PackageListGuid, PackageListGuid);
- PackageListHeader->PackageLength = Length;
-
- //
- // Initialize a pointer to the beginning if the Package List data
- //
- Data = (UINT8 *)(PackageListHeader + 1);
-
- //
- // Copy the data from each package in the variable argument list
- //
- for (VA_START (Args, DeviceHandle); (Package = VA_ARG (Args, UINT32 *)) != NULL; ) {
- Length = ReadUnaligned32 (Package) - sizeof (UINT32);
- CopyMem (Data, Package + 1, Length);
- Data += Length;
- }
- VA_END (Args);
-
- //
- // Append a package of type EFI_HII_PACKAGE_END to mark the end of the package list
- //
- CopyMem (Data, &mEndOfPakageList, sizeof (mEndOfPakageList));
-
- //
- // Register the package list with the HII Database
- //
- Status = gHiiDatabase->NewPackageList (
- gHiiDatabase,
- PackageListHeader,
- DeviceHandle,
- &HiiHandle
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- HiiHandle = NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Free the allocated package list
- //
- FreePool (PackageListHeader);
-
- //
- // Return the new HII Handle
- //
- return HiiHandle;
-}
-
-/**
- Removes a package list from the HII database.
-
- If HiiHandle is NULL, then ASSERT.
- If HiiHandle is not a valid EFI_HII_HANDLE in the HII database, then ASSERT.
-
- @param[in] HiiHandle The handle that was previously registered in the HII database
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-HiiRemovePackages (
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- ASSERT (HiiHandle != NULL);
- Status = gHiiDatabase->RemovePackageList (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandle);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-
-/**
- Retrieves the array of all the HII Handles or the HII handles of a specific
- package list GUID in the HII Database.
- This array is terminated with a NULL HII Handle.
- This function allocates the returned array using AllocatePool().
- The caller is responsible for freeing the array with FreePool().
-
- @param[in] PackageListGuid An optional parameter that is used to request
- HII Handles associated with a specific
- Package List GUID. If this parameter is NULL,
- then all the HII Handles in the HII Database
- are returned. If this parameter is not NULL,
- then zero or more HII Handles associated with
- PackageListGuid are returned.
-
- @retval NULL No HII handles were found in the HII database
- @retval NULL The array of HII Handles could not be retrieved
- @retval Other A pointer to the NULL terminated array of HII Handles
-
-**/
-EFI_HII_HANDLE *
-EFIAPI
-HiiGetHiiHandles (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *PackageListGuid OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN HandleBufferLength;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE TempHiiHandleBuffer;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE *HiiHandleBuffer;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- UINTN Index1;
- UINTN Index2;
-
- //
- // Retrieve the size required for the buffer of all HII handles.
- //
- HandleBufferLength = 0;
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ListPackageLists (
- gHiiDatabase,
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_ALL,
- NULL,
- &HandleBufferLength,
- &TempHiiHandleBuffer
- );
-
- //
- // If ListPackageLists() returns EFI_SUCCESS for a zero size,
- // then there are no HII handles in the HII database. If ListPackageLists()
- // returns an error other than EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL, then there are no HII
- // handles in the HII database.
- //
- if (Status != EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- //
- // Return NULL if the size can not be retrieved, or if there are no HII
- // handles in the HII Database
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate the array of HII handles to hold all the HII Handles and a NULL terminator
- //
- HiiHandleBuffer = AllocateZeroPool (HandleBufferLength + sizeof (EFI_HII_HANDLE));
- if (HiiHandleBuffer == NULL) {
- //
- // Return NULL if allocation fails.
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the array of HII Handles in the HII Database
- //
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ListPackageLists (
- gHiiDatabase,
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_ALL,
- NULL,
- &HandleBufferLength,
- HiiHandleBuffer
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Free the buffer and return NULL if the HII handles can not be retrieved.
- //
- FreePool (HiiHandleBuffer);
- return NULL;
- }
-
- if (PackageListGuid == NULL) {
- //
- // Return the NULL terminated array of HII handles in the HII Database
- //
- return HiiHandleBuffer;
- } else {
- for (Index1 = 0, Index2 = 0; HiiHandleBuffer[Index1] != NULL; Index1++) {
- Status = InternalHiiExtractGuidFromHiiHandle (HiiHandleBuffer[Index1], &Guid);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- if (CompareGuid (&Guid, PackageListGuid)) {
- HiiHandleBuffer[Index2++] = HiiHandleBuffer[Index1];
- }
- }
- if (Index2 > 0) {
- HiiHandleBuffer[Index2] = NULL;
- return HiiHandleBuffer;
- } else {
- FreePool (HiiHandleBuffer);
- return NULL;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Converts all hex dtring characters in range ['A'..'F'] to ['a'..'f'] for
- hex digits that appear between a '=' and a '&' in a config string.
-
- If ConfigString is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] ConfigString Pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string.
-
- @return Pointer to the Null-terminated Unicode result string.
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiLowerConfigString (
- IN EFI_STRING ConfigString
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING String;
- BOOLEAN Lower;
-
- ASSERT (ConfigString != NULL);
-
- //
- // Convert all hex digits in range [A-F] in the configuration header to [a-f]
- //
- for (String = ConfigString, Lower = FALSE; *String != L'\0'; String++) {
- if (*String == L'=') {
- Lower = TRUE;
- } else if (*String == L'&') {
- Lower = FALSE;
- } else if (Lower && *String >= L'A' && *String <= L'F') {
- *String = (CHAR16) (*String - L'A' + L'a');
- }
- }
-
- return ConfigString;
-}
-
-/**
- Uses the BlockToConfig() service of the Config Routing Protocol to
- convert <ConfigRequest> and a buffer to a <ConfigResp>
-
- If ConfigRequest is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Block is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] ConfigRequest Pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string.
- @param[in] Block Pointer to a block of data.
- @param[in] BlockSize The zie, in bytes, of Block.
-
- @retval NULL The <ConfigResp> string could not be generated.
- @retval Other Pointer to the Null-terminated Unicode <ConfigResp> string.
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiBlockToConfig (
- IN CONST EFI_STRING ConfigRequest,
- IN CONST UINT8 *Block,
- IN UINTN BlockSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_STRING ConfigResp;
- CHAR16 *Progress;
-
- ASSERT (ConfigRequest != NULL);
- ASSERT (Block != NULL);
-
- //
- // Convert <ConfigRequest> to <ConfigResp>
- //
- Status = gHiiConfigRouting->BlockToConfig (
- gHiiConfigRouting,
- ConfigRequest,
- Block,
- BlockSize,
- &ConfigResp,
- &Progress
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
- return ConfigResp;
-}
-
-/**
- Uses the BrowserCallback() service of the Form Browser Protocol to retrieve
- or set uncommitted data. If sata i being retrieved, then the buffer is
- allocated using AllocatePool(). The caller is then responsible for freeing
- the buffer using FreePool().
-
- @param[in] VariableGuid Pointer to an EFI_GUID structure. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] VariableName Pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] SetResultsData If not NULL, then this parameter specified the buffer
- of uncommited data to set. If this parameter is NULL,
- then the caller is requesting to get the uncommited data
- from the Form Browser.
-
- @retval NULL The uncommitted data could not be retrieved.
- @retval Other A pointer to a buffer containing the uncommitted data.
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiBrowserCallback (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *VariableGuid, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR16 *VariableName, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST EFI_STRING SetResultsData OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN ResultsDataSize;
- EFI_STRING ResultsData;
- CHAR16 TempResultsData;
-
- //
- // Locate protocols
- //
- if (mUefiFormBrowser2 == NULL) {
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiFormBrowser2ProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &mUefiFormBrowser2);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || mUefiFormBrowser2 == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
- }
-
- ResultsDataSize = 0;
-
- if (SetResultsData != NULL) {
- //
- // Request to to set data in the uncommitted browser state information
- //
- ResultsData = SetResultsData;
- } else {
- //
- // Retrieve the length of the buffer required ResultsData from the Browser Callback
- //
- Status = mUefiFormBrowser2->BrowserCallback (
- mUefiFormBrowser2,
- &ResultsDataSize,
- &TempResultsData,
- TRUE,
- VariableGuid,
- VariableName
- );
-
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // No Resluts Data, only allocate one char for '\0'
- //
- ResultsData = AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (CHAR16));
- return ResultsData;
- }
-
- if (Status != EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate the ResultsData buffer
- //
- ResultsData = AllocateZeroPool (ResultsDataSize);
- if (ResultsData == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve or set the ResultsData from the Browser Callback
- //
- Status = mUefiFormBrowser2->BrowserCallback (
- mUefiFormBrowser2,
- &ResultsDataSize,
- ResultsData,
- (BOOLEAN)(SetResultsData == NULL),
- VariableGuid,
- VariableName
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- return ResultsData;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and returns a Null-terminated Unicode <ConfigHdr> string using routing
- information that includes a GUID, an optional Unicode string name, and a device
- path. The string returned is allocated with AllocatePool(). The caller is
- responsible for freeing the allocated string with FreePool().
-
- The format of a <ConfigHdr> is as follows:
-
- GUID=<HexCh>32&NAME=<Char>NameLength&PATH=<HexChar>DevicePathSize<Null>
-
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to an EFI_GUID that is the routing information
- GUID. Each of the 16 bytes in Guid is converted to
- a 2 Unicode character hexidecimal string. This is
- an optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] Name Pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string that is
- the routing information NAME. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL. Each 16-bit Unicode
- character in Name is converted to a 4 character Unicode
- hexidecimal string.
- @param[in] DriverHandle The driver handle which supports a Device Path Protocol
- that is the routing information PATH. Each byte of
- the Device Path associated with DriverHandle is converted
- to a 2 Unicode character hexidecimal string.
-
- @retval NULL DriverHandle does not support the Device Path Protocol.
- @retval Other A pointer to the Null-terminate Unicode <ConfigHdr> string
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING
-EFIAPI
-HiiConstructConfigHdr (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *Guid, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR16 *Name, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_HANDLE DriverHandle
- )
-{
- UINTN NameLength;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- UINTN DevicePathSize;
- CHAR16 *String;
- CHAR16 *ReturnString;
- UINTN Index;
- UINT8 *Buffer;
- UINTN MaxLen;
-
- //
- // Compute the length of Name in Unicode characters.
- // If Name is NULL, then the length is 0.
- //
- NameLength = 0;
- if (Name != NULL) {
- NameLength = StrLen (Name);
- }
-
- DevicePath = NULL;
- DevicePathSize = 0;
- //
- // Retrieve DevicePath Protocol associated with DriverHandle
- //
- if (DriverHandle != NULL) {
- DevicePath = DevicePathFromHandle (DriverHandle);
- if (DevicePath == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
- //
- // Compute the size of the device path in bytes
- //
- DevicePathSize = GetDevicePathSize (DevicePath);
- }
-
- //
- // GUID=<HexCh>32&NAME=<Char>NameLength&PATH=<HexChar>DevicePathSize <Null>
- // | 5 | sizeof (EFI_GUID) * 2 | 6 | NameStrLen*4 | 6 | DevicePathSize * 2 | 1 |
- //
- MaxLen = 5 + sizeof (EFI_GUID) * 2 + 6 + NameLength * 4 + 6 + DevicePathSize * 2 + 1;
- String = AllocateZeroPool (MaxLen * sizeof (CHAR16));
- if (String == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Start with L"GUID="
- //
- StrCpyS (String, MaxLen, L"GUID=");
- ReturnString = String;
- String += StrLen (String);
-
- if (Guid != NULL) {
- //
- // Append Guid converted to <HexCh>32
- //
- for (Index = 0, Buffer = (UINT8 *)Guid; Index < sizeof (EFI_GUID); Index++) {
- String += UnicodeValueToString (String, PREFIX_ZERO | RADIX_HEX, *(Buffer++), 2);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Append L"&NAME="
- //
- StrCatS (ReturnString, MaxLen, L"&NAME=");
- String += StrLen (String);
-
- if (Name != NULL) {
- //
- // Append Name converted to <Char>NameLength
- //
- for (; *Name != L'\0'; Name++) {
- String += UnicodeValueToString (String, PREFIX_ZERO | RADIX_HEX, *Name, 4);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Append L"&PATH="
- //
- StrCatS (ReturnString, MaxLen, L"&PATH=");
- String += StrLen (String);
-
- //
- // Append the device path associated with DriverHandle converted to <HexChar>DevicePathSize
- //
- for (Index = 0, Buffer = (UINT8 *)DevicePath; Index < DevicePathSize; Index++) {
- String += UnicodeValueToString (String, PREFIX_ZERO | RADIX_HEX, *(Buffer++), 2);
- }
-
- //
- // Null terminate the Unicode string
- //
- *String = L'\0';
-
- //
- // Convert all hex digits in range [A-F] in the configuration header to [a-f]
- //
- return InternalHiiLowerConfigString (ReturnString);
-}
-
-/**
- Convert the hex UNICODE encoding string of UEFI GUID, NAME or device path
- to binary buffer from <ConfigHdr>.
-
- This is a internal function.
-
- @param String UEFI configuration string.
- @param Flag Flag specifies what type buffer will be retrieved.
- @param Buffer Binary of Guid, Name or Device path.
-
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Any incoming parameter is invalid.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Lake of resources to store neccesary structures.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The buffer data is retrieved and translated to
- binary format.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-InternalHiiGetBufferFromString (
- IN EFI_STRING String,
- IN UINT8 Flag,
- OUT UINT8 **Buffer
- )
-{
- UINTN Length;
- EFI_STRING ConfigHdr;
- CHAR16 *StringPtr;
- UINT8 *DataBuffer;
- CHAR16 TemStr[5];
- UINTN Index;
- UINT8 DigitUint8;
-
- if (String == NULL || Buffer == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- DataBuffer = NULL;
- StringPtr = NULL;
- ConfigHdr = String;
- //
- // The content between 'GUID', 'NAME', 'PATH' of <ConfigHdr> and '&' of next element
- // or '\0' (end of configuration string) is the UNICODE %02x bytes encoding string.
- //
- for (Length = 0; *String != 0 && *String != L'&'; String++, Length++);
-
- switch (Flag) {
- case GUID_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE:
- case PATH_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE:
- //
- // The data in <ConfigHdr> is encoded as hex UNICODE %02x bytes in the same order
- // as the device path and Guid resides in RAM memory.
- // Translate the data into binary.
- //
- DataBuffer = (UINT8 *) AllocateZeroPool ((Length + 1) / 2);
- if (DataBuffer == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Convert binary byte one by one
- //
- ZeroMem (TemStr, sizeof (TemStr));
- for (Index = 0; Index < Length; Index ++) {
- TemStr[0] = ConfigHdr[Index];
- DigitUint8 = (UINT8) StrHexToUint64 (TemStr);
- if ((Index & 1) == 0) {
- DataBuffer [Index/2] = DigitUint8;
- } else {
- DataBuffer [Index/2] = (UINT8) ((DataBuffer [Index/2] << 4) + DigitUint8);
- }
- }
-
- *Buffer = DataBuffer;
- break;
-
- case NAME_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE:
- //
- // Convert Config String to Unicode String, e.g. "0041004200430044" => "ABCD"
- //
-
- //
- // Add the tailling char L'\0'
- //
- DataBuffer = (UINT8 *) AllocateZeroPool ((Length/4 + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16));
- if (DataBuffer == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- //
- // Convert character one by one
- //
- StringPtr = (CHAR16 *) DataBuffer;
- ZeroMem (TemStr, sizeof (TemStr));
- for (Index = 0; Index < Length; Index += 4) {
- StrnCpyS (TemStr, sizeof (TemStr) / sizeof (CHAR16), ConfigHdr + Index, 4);
- StringPtr[Index/4] = (CHAR16) StrHexToUint64 (TemStr);
- }
- //
- // Add tailing L'\0' character
- //
- StringPtr[Index/4] = L'\0';
-
- *Buffer = DataBuffer;
- break;
-
- default:
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function checks VarOffset and VarWidth is in the block range.
-
- @param BlockArray The block array is to be checked.
- @param VarOffset Offset of var to the structure
- @param VarWidth Width of var.
-
- @retval TRUE This Var is in the block range.
- @retval FALSE This Var is not in the block range.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-BlockArrayCheck (
- IN IFR_BLOCK_DATA *BlockArray,
- IN UINT16 VarOffset,
- IN UINT16 VarWidth
- )
-{
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA *BlockData;
-
- //
- // No Request Block array, all vars are got.
- //
- if (BlockArray == NULL) {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- //
- // Check the input var is in the request block range.
- //
- for (Link = BlockArray->Entry.ForwardLink; Link != &BlockArray->Entry; Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- BlockData = BASE_CR (Link, IFR_BLOCK_DATA, Entry);
- if ((VarOffset >= BlockData->Offset) && ((VarOffset + VarWidth) <= (BlockData->Offset + BlockData->Width))) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- Get the value of <Number> in <BlockConfig> format, i.e. the value of OFFSET
- or WIDTH or VALUE.
- <BlockConfig> ::= 'OFFSET='<Number>&'WIDTH='<Number>&'VALUE'=<Number>
-
- @param ValueString String in <BlockConfig> format and points to the
- first character of <Number>.
- @param ValueData The output value. Caller takes the responsibility
- to free memory.
- @param ValueLength Length of the <Number>, in characters.
-
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES Insufficient resources to store neccessary
- structures.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Value of <Number> is outputted in Number
- successfully.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiGetValueOfNumber (
- IN EFI_STRING ValueString,
- OUT UINT8 **ValueData,
- OUT UINTN *ValueLength
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING StringPtr;
- UINTN Length;
- UINT8 *Buf;
- UINT8 DigitUint8;
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR16 TemStr[2];
-
- ASSERT (ValueString != NULL && ValueData != NULL && ValueLength != NULL);
- ASSERT (*ValueString != L'\0');
-
- //
- // Get the length of value string
- //
- StringPtr = ValueString;
- while (*StringPtr != L'\0' && *StringPtr != L'&') {
- StringPtr++;
- }
- Length = StringPtr - ValueString;
-
- //
- // Allocate buffer to store the value
- //
- Buf = (UINT8 *) AllocateZeroPool ((Length + 1) / 2);
- if (Buf == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Convert character one by one to the value buffer
- //
- ZeroMem (TemStr, sizeof (TemStr));
- for (Index = 0; Index < Length; Index ++) {
- TemStr[0] = ValueString[Length - Index - 1];
- DigitUint8 = (UINT8) StrHexToUint64 (TemStr);
- if ((Index & 1) == 0) {
- Buf [Index/2] = DigitUint8;
- } else {
- Buf [Index/2] = (UINT8) ((DigitUint8 << 4) + Buf [Index/2]);
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Set the converted value and string length.
- //
- *ValueData = Buf;
- *ValueLength = Length;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Get value from config request resp string.
-
- @param ConfigElement ConfigResp string contains the current setting.
- @param VarName The variable name which need to get value.
- @param VarValue The return value.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Get the value for the VarName
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The memory is not enough.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetValueFromRequest (
- IN CHAR16 *ConfigElement,
- IN CHAR16 *VarName,
- OUT UINT64 *VarValue
- )
-{
- UINT8 *TmpBuffer;
- CHAR16 *StringPtr;
- UINTN Length;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Find VarName related string.
- //
- StringPtr = StrStr (ConfigElement, VarName);
- ASSERT (StringPtr != NULL);
-
- //
- // Skip the "VarName=" string
- //
- StringPtr += StrLen (VarName) + 1;
-
- //
- // Get Offset
- //
- Status = InternalHiiGetValueOfNumber (StringPtr, &TmpBuffer, &Length);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- *VarValue = 0;
- CopyMem (VarValue, TmpBuffer, (((Length + 1) / 2) < sizeof (UINT64)) ? ((Length + 1) / 2) : sizeof (UINT64));
-
- FreePool (TmpBuffer);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This internal function parses IFR data to validate current setting.
-
- Base on the NameValueType, if it is TRUE, RequestElement and HiiHandle is valid;
- else the VarBuffer and CurrentBlockArray is valid.
-
- @param HiiPackageList Point to Hii package list.
- @param PackageListLength The length of the pacakge.
- @param VarGuid Guid of the buffer storage.
- @param VarName Name of the buffer storage.
- @param VarBuffer The data buffer for the storage.
- @param CurrentBlockArray The block array from the config Requst string.
- @param RequestElement The config string for this storage.
- @param HiiHandle The HiiHandle for this formset.
- @param NameValueType Whether current storage is name/value varstore or not.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current setting is valid.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The memory is not enough.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The config string or the Hii package is invalid.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-ValidateQuestionFromVfr (
- IN EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageList,
- IN UINTN PackageListLength,
- IN EFI_GUID *VarGuid,
- IN CHAR16 *VarName,
- IN UINT8 *VarBuffer,
- IN IFR_BLOCK_DATA *CurrentBlockArray,
- IN CHAR16 *RequestElement,
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle,
- IN BOOLEAN NameValueType
- )
-{
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA VarBlockData;
- UINT16 Offset;
- UINT16 Width;
- UINT64 VarValue;
- EFI_IFR_TYPE_VALUE TmpValue;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER PacakgeHeader;
- UINT32 PackageOffset;
- UINT8 *PackageData;
- UINTN IfrOffset;
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpHdr;
- EFI_IFR_VARSTORE *IfrVarStore;
- EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_NAME_VALUE *IfrNameValueStore;
- EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *IfrEfiVarStore;
- IFR_VARSTORAGE_DATA VarStoreData;
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *IfrOneOf;
- EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *IfrNumeric;
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION *IfrOneOfOption;
- EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX *IfrCheckBox;
- EFI_IFR_STRING *IfrString;
- CHAR8 *VarStoreName;
- UINTN Index;
- CHAR16 *QuestionName;
- CHAR16 *StringPtr;
-
- //
- // Initialize the local variables.
- //
- Index = 0;
- VarStoreName = NULL;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- VarValue = 0;
- IfrVarStore = NULL;
- IfrNameValueStore = NULL;
- IfrEfiVarStore = NULL;
- ZeroMem (&VarStoreData, sizeof (IFR_VARSTORAGE_DATA));
- ZeroMem (&VarBlockData, sizeof (VarBlockData));
-
- //
- // Check IFR value is in block data, then Validate Value
- //
- PackageOffset = sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER);
- while (PackageOffset < PackageListLength) {
- CopyMem (&PacakgeHeader, (UINT8 *) HiiPackageList + PackageOffset, sizeof (PacakgeHeader));
-
- //
- // Parse IFR opcode from the form package.
- //
- if (PacakgeHeader.Type == EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS) {
- IfrOffset = sizeof (PacakgeHeader);
- PackageData = (UINT8 *) HiiPackageList + PackageOffset;
- while (IfrOffset < PacakgeHeader.Length) {
- IfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) (PackageData + IfrOffset);
- //
- // Validate current setting to the value built in IFR opcode
- //
- switch (IfrOpHdr->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_OP:
- //
- // VarStoreId has been found. No further found.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId != 0) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // Find the matched VarStoreId to the input VarGuid and VarName
- //
- IfrVarStore = (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (CompareGuid ((EFI_GUID *) (VOID *) &IfrVarStore->Guid, VarGuid)) {
- VarStoreName = (CHAR8 *) IfrVarStore->Name;
- for (Index = 0; VarStoreName[Index] != 0; Index ++) {
- if ((CHAR16) VarStoreName[Index] != VarName[Index]) {
- break;
- }
- }
- //
- // The matched VarStore is found.
- //
- if ((VarStoreName[Index] != 0) || (VarName[Index] != 0)) {
- IfrVarStore = NULL;
- }
- } else {
- IfrVarStore = NULL;
- }
-
- if (IfrVarStore != NULL) {
- VarStoreData.VarStoreId = IfrVarStore->VarStoreId;
- VarStoreData.Size = IfrVarStore->Size;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_NAME_VALUE_OP:
- //
- // VarStoreId has been found. No further found.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId != 0) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // Find the matched VarStoreId to the input VarGuid
- //
- IfrNameValueStore = (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_NAME_VALUE *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (!CompareGuid ((EFI_GUID *) (VOID *) &IfrNameValueStore->Guid, VarGuid)) {
- IfrNameValueStore = NULL;
- }
-
- if (IfrNameValueStore != NULL) {
- VarStoreData.VarStoreId = IfrNameValueStore->VarStoreId;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP:
- //
- // VarStore is found. Don't need to search any more.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId != 0) {
- break;
- }
-
- IfrEfiVarStore = (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *) IfrOpHdr;
-
- //
- // If the length is small than the structure, this is from old efi
- // varstore definition. Old efi varstore get config directly from
- // GetVariable function.
- //
- if (IfrOpHdr->Length < sizeof (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI)) {
- break;
- }
-
- if (CompareGuid ((EFI_GUID *) (VOID *) &IfrEfiVarStore->Guid, VarGuid)) {
- VarStoreName = (CHAR8 *) IfrEfiVarStore->Name;
- for (Index = 0; VarStoreName[Index] != 0; Index ++) {
- if ((CHAR16) VarStoreName[Index] != VarName[Index]) {
- break;
- }
- }
- //
- // The matched VarStore is found.
- //
- if ((VarStoreName[Index] != 0) || (VarName[Index] != 0)) {
- IfrEfiVarStore = NULL;
- }
- } else {
- IfrEfiVarStore = NULL;
- }
-
- if (IfrEfiVarStore != NULL) {
- //
- // Find the matched VarStore
- //
- VarStoreData.VarStoreId = IfrEfiVarStore->VarStoreId;
- VarStoreData.Size = IfrEfiVarStore->Size;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_FORM_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_FORM_MAP_OP:
- //
- // Check the matched VarStoreId is found.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId == 0) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- //
- // Check whether current value is the one of option.
- //
-
- //
- // OneOf question is not in IFR Form. This IFR form is not valid.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Check whether this question is for the requested varstore.
- //
- IfrOneOf = (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (IfrOneOf->Question.VarStoreId != VarStoreData.VarStoreId) {
- break;
- }
-
- if (NameValueType) {
- QuestionName = HiiGetString (HiiHandle, IfrOneOf->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarName, NULL);
- ASSERT (QuestionName != NULL);
-
- if (StrStr (RequestElement, QuestionName) == NULL) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
-
- Status = GetValueFromRequest (RequestElement, QuestionName, &VarValue);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Get Offset by Question header and Width by DataType Flags
- //
- Offset = IfrOneOf->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- Width = (UINT16) (1 << (IfrOneOf->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE));
- //
- // Check whether this question is in current block array.
- //
- if (!BlockArrayCheck (CurrentBlockArray, Offset, Width)) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
- //
- // Check this var question is in the var storage
- //
- if ((Offset + Width) > VarStoreData.Size) {
- //
- // This question exceeds the var store size.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the current value for oneof opcode
- //
- VarValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&VarValue, VarBuffer + Offset, Width);
- }
- //
- // Set Block Data, to be checked in the following Oneof option opcode.
- //
- VarBlockData.OpCode = IfrOpHdr->OpCode;
- VarBlockData.Scope = IfrOpHdr->Scope;
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- //
- // Check the current value is in the numeric range.
- //
-
- //
- // Numeric question is not in IFR Form. This IFR form is not valid.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Check whether this question is for the requested varstore.
- //
- IfrNumeric = (EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (IfrNumeric->Question.VarStoreId != VarStoreData.VarStoreId) {
- break;
- }
-
- if (NameValueType) {
- QuestionName = HiiGetString (HiiHandle, IfrNumeric->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarName, NULL);
- ASSERT (QuestionName != NULL);
-
- if (StrStr (RequestElement, QuestionName) == NULL) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
-
- Status = GetValueFromRequest (RequestElement, QuestionName, &VarValue);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Get Offset by Question header and Width by DataType Flags
- //
- Offset = IfrNumeric->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- Width = (UINT16) (1 << (IfrNumeric->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE));
- //
- // Check whether this question is in current block array.
- //
- if (!BlockArrayCheck (CurrentBlockArray, Offset, Width)) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
- //
- // Check this var question is in the var storage
- //
- if ((Offset + Width) > VarStoreData.Size) {
- //
- // This question exceeds the var store size.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check the current value is in the numeric range.
- //
- VarValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&VarValue, VarBuffer + Offset, Width);
- }
- if ((IfrNumeric->Flags & EFI_IFR_DISPLAY) == 0) {
- switch (IfrNumeric->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE) {
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_1:
- if ((INT8) VarValue < (INT8) IfrNumeric->data.u8.MinValue || (INT8) VarValue > (INT8) IfrNumeric->data.u8.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_2:
- if ((INT16) VarValue < (INT16) IfrNumeric->data.u16.MinValue || (INT16) VarValue > (INT16) IfrNumeric->data.u16.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_4:
- if ((INT32) VarValue < (INT32) IfrNumeric->data.u32.MinValue || (INT32) VarValue > (INT32) IfrNumeric->data.u32.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_8:
- if ((INT64) VarValue < (INT64) IfrNumeric->data.u64.MinValue || (INT64) VarValue > (INT64) IfrNumeric->data.u64.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- }
- } else {
- switch (IfrNumeric->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE) {
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_1:
- if ((UINT8) VarValue < IfrNumeric->data.u8.MinValue || (UINT8) VarValue > IfrNumeric->data.u8.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_2:
- if ((UINT16) VarValue < IfrNumeric->data.u16.MinValue || (UINT16) VarValue > IfrNumeric->data.u16.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_4:
- if ((UINT32) VarValue < IfrNumeric->data.u32.MinValue || (UINT32) VarValue > IfrNumeric->data.u32.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_8:
- if ((UINT64) VarValue < IfrNumeric->data.u64.MinValue || (UINT64) VarValue > IfrNumeric->data.u64.MaxValue) {
- //
- // Not in the valid range.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- //
- // Check value is BOOLEAN type, only 0 and 1 is valid.
- //
-
- //
- // CheckBox question is not in IFR Form. This IFR form is not valid.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check whether this question is for the requested varstore.
- //
- IfrCheckBox = (EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (IfrCheckBox->Question.VarStoreId != VarStoreData.VarStoreId) {
- break;
- }
-
- if (NameValueType) {
- QuestionName = HiiGetString (HiiHandle, IfrCheckBox->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarName, NULL);
- ASSERT (QuestionName != NULL);
-
- if (StrStr (RequestElement, QuestionName) == NULL) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
-
- Status = GetValueFromRequest (RequestElement, QuestionName, &VarValue);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Get Offset by Question header
- //
- Offset = IfrCheckBox->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- Width = (UINT16) sizeof (BOOLEAN);
- //
- // Check whether this question is in current block array.
- //
- if (!BlockArrayCheck (CurrentBlockArray, Offset, Width)) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
- //
- // Check this var question is in the var storage
- //
- if ((Offset + Width) > VarStoreData.Size) {
- //
- // This question exceeds the var store size.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- //
- // Check the current value is in the numeric range.
- //
- VarValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&VarValue, VarBuffer + Offset, Width);
- }
- //
- // Boolean type, only 1 and 0 is valid.
- //
- if (VarValue > 1) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_STRING_OP:
- //
- // Check current string length is less than maxsize
- //
-
- //
- // CheckBox question is not in IFR Form. This IFR form is not valid.
- //
- if (VarStoreData.VarStoreId == 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check whether this question is for the requested varstore.
- //
- IfrString = (EFI_IFR_STRING *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (IfrString->Question.VarStoreId != VarStoreData.VarStoreId) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // Get Width by OneOf Flags
- //
- Width = (UINT16) (IfrString->MaxSize * sizeof (UINT16));
- if (NameValueType) {
- QuestionName = HiiGetString (HiiHandle, IfrString->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarName, NULL);
- ASSERT (QuestionName != NULL);
-
- StringPtr = StrStr (RequestElement, QuestionName);
- if (StringPtr == NULL) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Skip the "=".
- //
- StringPtr += 1;
-
- //
- // Check current string length is less than maxsize
- //
- if (StrSize (StringPtr) > Width) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- } else {
- //
- // Get Offset/Width by Question header and OneOf Flags
- //
- Offset = IfrString->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- //
- // Check whether this question is in current block array.
- //
- if (!BlockArrayCheck (CurrentBlockArray, Offset, Width)) {
- //
- // This question is not in the current configuration string. Skip it.
- //
- break;
- }
- //
- // Check this var question is in the var storage
- //
- if ((Offset + Width) > VarStoreData.Size) {
- //
- // This question exceeds the var store size.
- //
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- //
- // Check current string length is less than maxsize
- //
- if (StrSize ((CHAR16 *) (VarBuffer + Offset)) > Width) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP:
- //
- // Opcode Scope is zero. This one of option is not to be checked.
- //
- if (VarBlockData.Scope == 0) {
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Only check for OneOf and OrderList opcode
- //
- IfrOneOfOption = (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION *) IfrOpHdr;
- if (VarBlockData.OpCode == EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP) {
- //
- // Check current value is the value of one of option.
- //
- ASSERT (IfrOneOfOption->Type <= EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_64);
- ZeroMem (&TmpValue, sizeof (EFI_IFR_TYPE_VALUE));
- CopyMem (&TmpValue, &IfrOneOfOption->Value, IfrOneOfOption->Header.Length - OFFSET_OF (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION, Value));
- if (VarValue == TmpValue.u64) {
- //
- // The value is one of option value.
- // Set OpCode to Zero, don't need check again.
- //
- VarBlockData.OpCode = 0;
- }
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_END_OP:
- //
- // Decrease opcode scope for the validated opcode
- //
- if (VarBlockData.Scope > 0) {
- VarBlockData.Scope --;
- }
-
- //
- // OneOf value doesn't belong to one of option value.
- //
- if ((VarBlockData.Scope == 0) && (VarBlockData.OpCode == EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- break;
- default:
- //
- // Increase Scope for the validated opcode
- //
- if (VarBlockData.Scope > 0) {
- VarBlockData.Scope = (UINT8) (VarBlockData.Scope + IfrOpHdr->Scope);
- }
- break;
- }
- //
- // Go to the next opcode
- //
- IfrOffset += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- }
- //
- // Only one form is in a package list.
- //
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Go to next package.
- //
- PackageOffset += PacakgeHeader.Length;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This internal function parses IFR data to validate current setting.
-
- @param ConfigElement ConfigResp element string contains the current setting.
- @param CurrentBlockArray Current block array.
- @param VarBuffer Data buffer for this varstore.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current setting is valid.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The memory is not enough.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The config string or the Hii package is invalid.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetBlockDataInfo (
- IN CHAR16 *ConfigElement,
- OUT IFR_BLOCK_DATA **CurrentBlockArray,
- OUT UINT8 **VarBuffer
- )
-{
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA *BlockData;
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA *NewBlockData;
- EFI_STRING StringPtr;
- UINTN Length;
- UINT8 *TmpBuffer;
- UINT16 Offset;
- UINT16 Width;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
- UINTN MaxBufferSize;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA *BlockArray;
- UINT8 *DataBuffer;
-
- //
- // Initialize the local variables.
- //
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- BlockData = NULL;
- NewBlockData = NULL;
- TmpBuffer = NULL;
- BlockArray = NULL;
- MaxBufferSize = HII_LIB_DEFAULT_VARSTORE_SIZE;
- DataBuffer = AllocateZeroPool (MaxBufferSize);
- if (DataBuffer == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- //
- // Init BlockArray
- //
- BlockArray = (IFR_BLOCK_DATA *) AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (IFR_BLOCK_DATA));
- if (BlockArray == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Done;
- }
- InitializeListHead (&BlockArray->Entry);
-
- StringPtr = StrStr (ConfigElement, L"&OFFSET=");
- ASSERT (StringPtr != NULL);
-
- //
- // Parse each <RequestElement> if exists
- // Only <BlockName> format is supported by this help function.
- // <BlockName> ::= &'OFFSET='<Number>&'WIDTH='<Number>
- //
- while (*StringPtr != 0 && StrnCmp (StringPtr, L"&OFFSET=", StrLen (L"&OFFSET=")) == 0) {
- //
- // Skip the &OFFSET= string
- //
- StringPtr += StrLen (L"&OFFSET=");
-
- //
- // Get Offset
- //
- Status = InternalHiiGetValueOfNumber (StringPtr, &TmpBuffer, &Length);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
- Offset = 0;
- CopyMem (
- &Offset,
- TmpBuffer,
- (((Length + 1) / 2) < sizeof (UINT16)) ? ((Length + 1) / 2) : sizeof (UINT16)
- );
- FreePool (TmpBuffer);
- TmpBuffer = NULL;
-
- StringPtr += Length;
- if (StrnCmp (StringPtr, L"&WIDTH=", StrLen (L"&WIDTH=")) != 0) {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
- StringPtr += StrLen (L"&WIDTH=");
-
- //
- // Get Width
- //
- Status = InternalHiiGetValueOfNumber (StringPtr, &TmpBuffer, &Length);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
- Width = 0;
- CopyMem (
- &Width,
- TmpBuffer,
- (((Length + 1) / 2) < sizeof (UINT16)) ? ((Length + 1) / 2) : sizeof (UINT16)
- );
- FreePool (TmpBuffer);
- TmpBuffer = NULL;
-
- StringPtr += Length;
- if (*StringPtr != 0 && *StringPtr != L'&') {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
-
- if (StrnCmp (StringPtr, L"&VALUE=", StrLen (L"&VALUE=")) != 0) {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
- StringPtr += StrLen (L"&VALUE=");
-
- //
- // Get Value
- //
- Status = InternalHiiGetValueOfNumber (StringPtr, &TmpBuffer, &Length);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- StringPtr += Length;
- if (*StringPtr != 0 && *StringPtr != L'&') {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Check whether VarBuffer is enough
- //
- if ((UINTN) (Offset + Width) > MaxBufferSize) {
- DataBuffer = ReallocatePool (
- MaxBufferSize,
- Offset + Width + HII_LIB_DEFAULT_VARSTORE_SIZE,
- DataBuffer
- );
- if (DataBuffer == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Done;
- }
- MaxBufferSize = Offset + Width + HII_LIB_DEFAULT_VARSTORE_SIZE;
- }
-
- //
- // Update the Block with configuration info
- //
- CopyMem (DataBuffer + Offset, TmpBuffer, Width);
- FreePool (TmpBuffer);
- TmpBuffer = NULL;
-
- //
- // Set new Block Data
- //
- NewBlockData = (IFR_BLOCK_DATA *) AllocateZeroPool (sizeof (IFR_BLOCK_DATA));
- if (NewBlockData == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Done;
- }
- NewBlockData->Offset = Offset;
- NewBlockData->Width = Width;
-
- //
- // Insert the new block data into the block data array.
- //
- for (Link = BlockArray->Entry.ForwardLink; Link != &BlockArray->Entry; Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- BlockData = BASE_CR (Link, IFR_BLOCK_DATA, Entry);
- if (NewBlockData->Offset == BlockData->Offset) {
- if (NewBlockData->Width > BlockData->Width) {
- BlockData->Width = NewBlockData->Width;
- }
- FreePool (NewBlockData);
- break;
- } else if (NewBlockData->Offset < BlockData->Offset) {
- //
- // Insert new block data as the previous one of this link.
- //
- InsertTailList (Link, &NewBlockData->Entry);
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Insert new block data into the array tail.
- //
- if (Link == &BlockArray->Entry) {
- InsertTailList (Link, &NewBlockData->Entry);
- }
-
- //
- // If '\0', parsing is finished.
- //
- if (*StringPtr == 0) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // Go to next ConfigBlock
- //
- }
-
- //
- // Merge the aligned block data into the single block data.
- //
- Link = BlockArray->Entry.ForwardLink;
- while ((Link != &BlockArray->Entry) && (Link->ForwardLink != &BlockArray->Entry)) {
- BlockData = BASE_CR (Link, IFR_BLOCK_DATA, Entry);
- NewBlockData = BASE_CR (Link->ForwardLink, IFR_BLOCK_DATA, Entry);
- if ((NewBlockData->Offset >= BlockData->Offset) && (NewBlockData->Offset <= (BlockData->Offset + BlockData->Width))) {
- if ((NewBlockData->Offset + NewBlockData->Width) > (BlockData->Offset + BlockData->Width)) {
- BlockData->Width = (UINT16) (NewBlockData->Offset + NewBlockData->Width - BlockData->Offset);
- }
- RemoveEntryList (Link->ForwardLink);
- FreePool (NewBlockData);
- continue;
- }
- Link = Link->ForwardLink;
- }
-
- *VarBuffer = DataBuffer;
- *CurrentBlockArray = BlockArray;
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-
-Done:
- if (DataBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (DataBuffer);
- }
-
- if (BlockArray != NULL) {
- //
- // Free Link Array CurrentBlockArray
- //
- while (!IsListEmpty (&BlockArray->Entry)) {
- BlockData = BASE_CR (BlockArray->Entry.ForwardLink, IFR_BLOCK_DATA, Entry);
- RemoveEntryList (&BlockData->Entry);
- FreePool (BlockData);
- }
- FreePool (BlockArray);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- This internal function parses IFR data to validate current setting.
-
- @param ConfigResp ConfigResp string contains the current setting.
- @param HiiPackageList Point to Hii package list.
- @param PackageListLength The length of the pacakge.
- @param VarGuid Guid of the buffer storage.
- @param VarName Name of the buffer storage.
- @param HiiHandle The HiiHandle for this package.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The current setting is valid.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES The memory is not enough.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The config string or the Hii package is invalid.
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiValidateCurrentSetting (
- IN EFI_STRING ConfigResp,
- IN EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageList,
- IN UINTN PackageListLength,
- IN EFI_GUID *VarGuid,
- IN CHAR16 *VarName,
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle
- )
-{
- CHAR16 *StringPtr;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA *CurrentBlockArray;
- IFR_BLOCK_DATA *BlockData;
- UINT8 *VarBuffer;
- BOOLEAN NameValueType;
-
- CurrentBlockArray = NULL;
- VarBuffer = NULL;
- StringPtr = NULL;
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
-
- //
- // If StringPtr != NULL, get the request elements.
- //
- if (StrStr (ConfigResp, L"&OFFSET=") != NULL) {
- Status = GetBlockDataInfo(ConfigResp, &CurrentBlockArray, &VarBuffer);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return Status;
- }
- NameValueType = FALSE;
- } else {
- //
- // Skip header part.
- //
- StringPtr = StrStr (ConfigResp, L"PATH=");
- ASSERT (StringPtr != NULL);
-
- if (StrStr (StringPtr, L"&") != NULL) {
- NameValueType = TRUE;
- } else {
- //
- // Not found Request element, return success.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- }
-
- Status = ValidateQuestionFromVfr(
- HiiPackageList,
- PackageListLength,
- VarGuid,
- VarName,
- VarBuffer,
- CurrentBlockArray,
- ConfigResp,
- HiiHandle,
- NameValueType
- );
-
- if (VarBuffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (VarBuffer);
- }
-
- if (CurrentBlockArray != NULL) {
- //
- // Free Link Array CurrentBlockArray
- //
- while (!IsListEmpty (&CurrentBlockArray->Entry)) {
- BlockData = BASE_CR (CurrentBlockArray->Entry.ForwardLink, IFR_BLOCK_DATA, Entry);
- RemoveEntryList (&BlockData->Entry);
- FreePool (BlockData);
- }
- FreePool (CurrentBlockArray);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Check whether the ConfigRequest string has the request elements.
- For EFI_HII_VARSTORE_BUFFER type, the request has "&OFFSET=****&WIDTH=****..." format.
- For EFI_HII_VARSTORE_NAME_VALUE type, the request has "&NAME1**&NAME2..." format.
-
- @param ConfigRequest The input config request string.
-
- @retval TRUE The input include config request elements.
- @retval FALSE The input string not includes.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-GetElementsFromRequest (
- IN EFI_STRING ConfigRequest
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING TmpRequest;
-
- TmpRequest = StrStr (ConfigRequest, L"PATH=");
- ASSERT (TmpRequest != NULL);
-
- if ((StrStr (TmpRequest, L"&OFFSET=") != NULL) || (StrStr (TmpRequest, L"&") != NULL)) {
- return TRUE;
- }
-
- return FALSE;
-}
-
-/**
- This function parses the input ConfigRequest string and its matched IFR code
- string for setting default value and validating current setting.
-
- 1. For setting default action, Reset the default value specified by DefaultId
- to the driver configuration got by Request string.
- 2. For validating current setting, Validate the current configuration
- by parsing HII form IFR opcode.
-
- NULL request string support depends on the ExportConfig interface of
- HiiConfigRouting protocol in UEFI specification.
-
- @param Request A null-terminated Unicode string in
- <MultiConfigRequest> format. It can be NULL.
- If it is NULL, all current configuration for the
- entirety of the current HII database will be validated.
- If it is NULL, all configuration for the
- entirety of the current HII database will be reset.
- @param DefaultId Specifies the type of defaults to retrieve only for setting default action.
- @param ActionType Action supports setting defaults and validate current setting.
-
- @retval TURE Action runs successfully.
- @retval FALSE Action is not valid or Action can't be executed successfully..
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiIfrValueAction (
- IN CONST EFI_STRING Request, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT16 DefaultId,
- IN UINT8 ActionType
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING ConfigAltResp;
- EFI_STRING ConfigAltHdr;
- EFI_STRING ConfigResp;
- EFI_STRING Progress;
- EFI_STRING StringPtr;
- EFI_STRING StringHdr;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE DriverHandle;
- EFI_HANDLE TempDriverHandle;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE *HiiHandleBuffer;
- EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle;
- UINT32 Index;
- EFI_GUID *VarGuid;
- EFI_STRING VarName;
-
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageList;
- UINTN PackageListLength;
- UINTN MaxLen;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *TempDevicePath;
-
- ConfigAltResp = NULL;
- ConfigResp = NULL;
- VarGuid = NULL;
- VarName = NULL;
- DevicePath = NULL;
- ConfigAltHdr = NULL;
- HiiHandleBuffer = NULL;
- Index = 0;
- TempDriverHandle = NULL;
- HiiHandle = NULL;
- HiiPackageList = NULL;
-
- //
- // Only support set default and validate setting action.
- //
- if ((ActionType != ACTION_SET_DEFAUTL_VALUE) && (ActionType != ACTION_VALIDATE_SETTING)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the full requested value and deault value string.
- //
- if (Request != NULL) {
- Status = gHiiConfigRouting->ExtractConfig (
- gHiiConfigRouting,
- Request,
- &Progress,
- &ConfigAltResp
- );
- } else {
- Status = gHiiConfigRouting->ExportConfig (
- gHiiConfigRouting,
- &ConfigAltResp
- );
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- StringPtr = ConfigAltResp;
-
- while (StringPtr != L'\0') {
- //
- // 1. Find <ConfigHdr> GUID=...&NAME=...&PATH=...
- //
- StringHdr = StringPtr;
-
- //
- // Get Guid value
- //
- if (StrnCmp (StringPtr, L"GUID=", StrLen (L"GUID=")) != 0) {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
- StringPtr += StrLen (L"GUID=");
- Status = InternalHiiGetBufferFromString (StringPtr, GUID_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE, (UINT8 **) &VarGuid);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Get Name value VarName
- //
- while (*StringPtr != L'\0' && StrnCmp (StringPtr, L"&NAME=", StrLen (L"&NAME=")) != 0) {
- StringPtr++;
- }
- if (*StringPtr == L'\0') {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
- StringPtr += StrLen (L"&NAME=");
- Status = InternalHiiGetBufferFromString (StringPtr, NAME_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE, (UINT8 **) &VarName);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Get Path value DevicePath
- //
- while (*StringPtr != L'\0' && StrnCmp (StringPtr, L"&PATH=", StrLen (L"&PATH=")) != 0) {
- StringPtr++;
- }
- if (*StringPtr == L'\0') {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
- StringPtr += StrLen (L"&PATH=");
- Status = InternalHiiGetBufferFromString (StringPtr, PATH_CONFIG_STRING_TYPE, (UINT8 **) &DevicePath);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the Driver handle by the got device path.
- //
- TempDevicePath = DevicePath;
- Status = gBS->LocateDevicePath (&gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid, &TempDevicePath, &DriverHandle);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Find the matched Hii Handle for the found Driver handle
- //
- HiiHandleBuffer = HiiGetHiiHandles (NULL);
- if (HiiHandleBuffer == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- goto Done;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; HiiHandleBuffer[Index] != NULL; Index ++) {
- gHiiDatabase->GetPackageListHandle (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandleBuffer[Index], &TempDriverHandle);
- if (TempDriverHandle == DriverHandle) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- HiiHandle = HiiHandleBuffer[Index];
- FreePool (HiiHandleBuffer);
-
- if (HiiHandle == NULL) {
- //
- // This request string has no its Hii package.
- // Its default value and validating can't execute by parsing IFR data.
- // Directly jump into the next ConfigAltResp string for another pair Guid, Name, and Path.
- //
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- goto NextConfigAltResp;
- }
-
- //
- // 2. Get HiiPackage by HiiHandle
- //
- PackageListLength = 0;
- HiiPackageList = NULL;
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandle, &PackageListLength, HiiPackageList);
-
- //
- // The return status should always be EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL as input buffer's size is 0.
- //
- if (Status != EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- goto Done;
- }
-
- HiiPackageList = AllocatePool (PackageListLength);
- if (HiiPackageList == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // Get PackageList on HiiHandle
- //
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandle, &PackageListLength, HiiPackageList);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
- //
- // 3. Call ConfigRouting GetAltCfg(ConfigRoute, <ConfigResponse>, Guid, Name, DevicePath, AltCfgId, AltCfgResp)
- // Get the default configuration string according to the default ID.
- //
- Status = gHiiConfigRouting->GetAltConfig (
- gHiiConfigRouting,
- ConfigAltResp,
- VarGuid,
- VarName,
- DevicePath,
- (ActionType == ACTION_SET_DEFAUTL_VALUE) ? &DefaultId:NULL, // it can be NULL to get the current setting.
- &ConfigResp
- );
-
- //
- // The required setting can't be found. So, it is not required to be validated and set.
- //
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
- goto NextConfigAltResp;
- }
- //
- // Only the ConfigHdr is found. Not any block data is found. No data is required to be validated and set.
- //
- if (!GetElementsFromRequest (ConfigResp)) {
- goto NextConfigAltResp;
- }
-
- //
- // 4. Set the default configuration information or Validate current setting by parse IFR code.
- // Current Setting is in ConfigResp, will be set into buffer, then check it again.
- //
- if (ActionType == ACTION_SET_DEFAUTL_VALUE) {
- //
- // Set the default configuration information.
- //
- Status = gHiiConfigRouting->RouteConfig (gHiiConfigRouting, ConfigResp, &Progress);
- } else {
- //
- // Current Setting is in ConfigResp, will be set into buffer, then check it again.
- //
- Status = InternalHiiValidateCurrentSetting (ConfigResp, HiiPackageList, PackageListLength, VarGuid, VarName, HiiHandle);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Done;
- }
-
-NextConfigAltResp:
- //
- // Free the allocated pacakge buffer and the got ConfigResp string.
- //
- if (HiiPackageList != NULL) {
- FreePool (HiiPackageList);
- HiiPackageList = NULL;
- }
-
- if (ConfigResp != NULL) {
- FreePool (ConfigResp);
- ConfigResp = NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer.
- //
- FreePool (VarGuid);
- VarGuid = NULL;
-
- FreePool (VarName);
- VarName = NULL;
-
- FreePool (DevicePath);
- DevicePath = NULL;
-
- //
- // 5. Jump to next ConfigAltResp for another Guid, Name, Path.
- //
-
- //
- // Get and Skip ConfigHdr
- //
- while (*StringPtr != L'\0' && *StringPtr != L'&') {
- StringPtr++;
- }
- if (*StringPtr == L'\0') {
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Construct ConfigAltHdr string "&<ConfigHdr>&ALTCFG=\0"
- // | 1 | StrLen (ConfigHdr) | 8 | 1 |
- //
- MaxLen = 1 + StringPtr - StringHdr + 8 + 1;
- ConfigAltHdr = AllocateZeroPool ( MaxLen * sizeof (CHAR16));
- if (ConfigAltHdr == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Done;
- }
- StrCpyS (ConfigAltHdr, MaxLen, L"&");
- StrnCatS (ConfigAltHdr, MaxLen, StringHdr, StringPtr - StringHdr);
- StrCatS (ConfigAltHdr, MaxLen, L"&ALTCFG=");
-
- //
- // Skip all AltResp (AltConfigHdr ConfigBody) for the same ConfigHdr
- //
- while ((StringHdr = StrStr (StringPtr, ConfigAltHdr)) != NULL) {
- StringPtr = StringHdr + StrLen (ConfigAltHdr);
- if (*StringPtr == L'\0') {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Free the allocated ConfigAltHdr string
- //
- FreePool (ConfigAltHdr);
- if (*StringPtr == L'\0') {
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Find &GUID as the next ConfigHdr
- //
- StringPtr = StrStr (StringPtr, L"&GUID");
- if (StringPtr == NULL) {
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Skip char '&'
- //
- StringPtr ++;
- }
-
-Done:
- if (VarGuid != NULL) {
- FreePool (VarGuid);
- }
-
- if (VarName != NULL) {
- FreePool (VarName);
- }
-
- if (DevicePath != NULL) {
- FreePool (DevicePath);
- }
-
- if (ConfigResp != NULL) {
- FreePool (ConfigResp);
- }
-
- if (ConfigAltResp != NULL) {
- FreePool (ConfigAltResp);
- }
-
- if (HiiPackageList != NULL) {
- FreePool (HiiPackageList);
- }
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Validate the current configuration by parsing HII form IFR opcode.
-
- NULL request string support depends on the ExportConfig interface of
- HiiConfigRouting protocol in UEFI specification.
-
- @param Request A null-terminated Unicode string in
- <MultiConfigRequest> format. It can be NULL.
- If it is NULL, all current configuration for the
- entirety of the current HII database will be validated.
-
- @retval TRUE Current configuration is valid.
- @retval FALSE Current configuration is invalid.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-HiiValidateSettings (
- IN CONST EFI_STRING Request OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- return InternalHiiIfrValueAction (Request, 0, ACTION_VALIDATE_SETTING);
-}
-
-/**
- Reset the default value specified by DefaultId to the driver
- configuration got by Request string.
-
- NULL request string support depends on the ExportConfig interface of
- HiiConfigRouting protocol in UEFI specification.
-
- @param Request A null-terminated Unicode string in
- <MultiConfigRequest> format. It can be NULL.
- If it is NULL, all configuration for the
- entirety of the current HII database will be reset.
- @param DefaultId Specifies the type of defaults to retrieve.
-
- @retval TURE The default value is set successfully.
- @retval FALSE The default value can't be found and set.
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-HiiSetToDefaults (
- IN CONST EFI_STRING Request, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT16 DefaultId
- )
-{
- return InternalHiiIfrValueAction (Request, DefaultId, ACTION_SET_DEFAUTL_VALUE);
-}
-
-/**
- Determines if two values in config strings match.
-
- Compares the substring between StartSearchString and StopSearchString in
- FirstString to the substring between StartSearchString and StopSearchString
- in SecondString. If the two substrings match, then TRUE is returned. If the
- two substrings do not match, then FALSE is returned.
-
- If FirstString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If SecondString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartSearchString is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StopSearchString is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param FirstString Pointer to the first Null-terminated Unicode string.
- @param SecondString Pointer to the second Null-terminated Unicode string.
- @param StartSearchString Pointer to the Null-terminated Unicode string that
- marks the start of the value string to compare.
- @param StopSearchString Pointer to the Null-terminated Unicode string that
- marks the end of the value string to compare.
-
- @retval FALSE StartSearchString is not present in FirstString.
- @retval FALSE StartSearchString is not present in SecondString.
- @retval FALSE StopSearchString is not present in FirstString.
- @retval FALSE StopSearchString is not present in SecondString.
- @retval FALSE The length of the substring in FirstString is not the
- same length as the substring in SecondString.
- @retval FALSE The value string in FirstString does not matche the
- value string in SecondString.
- @retval TRUE The value string in FirstString matches the value
- string in SecondString.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiCompareSubString (
- IN CHAR16 *FirstString,
- IN CHAR16 *SecondString,
- IN CHAR16 *StartSearchString,
- IN CHAR16 *StopSearchString
- )
-{
- CHAR16 *EndFirstString;
- CHAR16 *EndSecondString;
-
- ASSERT (FirstString != NULL);
- ASSERT (SecondString != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartSearchString != NULL);
- ASSERT (StopSearchString != NULL);
-
- FirstString = StrStr (FirstString, StartSearchString);
- if (FirstString == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- SecondString = StrStr (SecondString, StartSearchString);
- if (SecondString == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- EndFirstString = StrStr (FirstString, StopSearchString);
- if (EndFirstString == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- EndSecondString = StrStr (SecondString, StopSearchString);
- if (EndSecondString == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- if ((EndFirstString - FirstString) != (EndSecondString - SecondString)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return (BOOLEAN)(StrnCmp (FirstString, SecondString, EndFirstString - FirstString) == 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Determines if the routing data specified by GUID and NAME match a <ConfigHdr>.
-
- If ConfigHdr is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] ConfigHdr Either <ConfigRequest> or <ConfigResp>.
- @param[in] Guid GUID of the storage.
- @param[in] Name NAME of the storage.
-
- @retval TRUE Routing information matches <ConfigHdr>.
- @retval FALSE Routing information does not match <ConfigHdr>.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-HiiIsConfigHdrMatch (
- IN CONST EFI_STRING ConfigHdr,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *Guid, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR16 *Name OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING CompareConfigHdr;
- BOOLEAN Result;
-
- ASSERT (ConfigHdr != NULL);
-
- //
- // Use Guid and Name to generate a <ConfigHdr> string
- //
- CompareConfigHdr = HiiConstructConfigHdr (Guid, Name, NULL);
- if (CompareConfigHdr == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- Result = TRUE;
- if (Guid != NULL) {
- //
- // Compare GUID value strings
- //
- Result = InternalHiiCompareSubString (ConfigHdr, CompareConfigHdr, L"GUID=", L"&NAME=");
- }
-
- if (Result && Name != NULL) {
- //
- // Compare NAME value strings
- //
- Result = InternalHiiCompareSubString (ConfigHdr, CompareConfigHdr, L"&NAME=", L"&PATH=");
- }
-
- //
- // Free the <ConfigHdr> string
- //
- FreePool (CompareConfigHdr);
-
- return Result;
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves uncommitted data from the Form Browser and converts it to a binary
- buffer.
-
- @param[in] VariableGuid Pointer to an EFI_GUID structure. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] VariableName Pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] BufferSize Length in bytes of buffer to hold retrieved data.
- @param[out] Buffer Buffer of data to be updated.
-
- @retval FALSE The uncommitted data could not be retrieved.
- @retval TRUE The uncommitted data was retrieved.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-HiiGetBrowserData (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *VariableGuid, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR16 *VariableName, OPTIONAL
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- OUT UINT8 *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STRING ResultsData;
- UINTN Size;
- EFI_STRING ConfigResp;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- CHAR16 *Progress;
-
- //
- // Retrieve the results data from the Browser Callback
- //
- ResultsData = InternalHiiBrowserCallback (VariableGuid, VariableName, NULL);
- if (ResultsData == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Construct <ConfigResp> mConfigHdrTemplate L'&' ResultsData L'\0'
- //
- Size = (StrLen (mConfigHdrTemplate) + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- Size = Size + (StrLen (ResultsData) + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- ConfigResp = AllocateZeroPool (Size);
- UnicodeSPrint (ConfigResp, Size, L"%s&%s", mConfigHdrTemplate, ResultsData);
-
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer
- //
- FreePool (ResultsData);
- if (ConfigResp == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Convert <ConfigResp> to a buffer
- //
- Status = gHiiConfigRouting->ConfigToBlock (
- gHiiConfigRouting,
- ConfigResp,
- Buffer,
- &BufferSize,
- &Progress
- );
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer
- //
- FreePool (ConfigResp);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Updates uncommitted data in the Form Browser.
-
- If Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] VariableGuid Pointer to an EFI_GUID structure. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] VariableName Pointer to a Null-terminated Unicode string. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
- @param[in] BufferSize Length, in bytes, of Buffer.
- @param[in] Buffer Buffer of data to commit.
- @param[in] RequestElement An optional field to specify which part of the
- buffer data will be send back to Browser. If NULL,
- the whole buffer of data will be committed to
- Browser.
- <RequestElement> ::= &OFFSET=<Number>&WIDTH=<Number>*
-
- @retval FALSE The uncommitted data could not be updated.
- @retval TRUE The uncommitted data was updated.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-HiiSetBrowserData (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *VariableGuid, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST CHAR16 *VariableName, OPTIONAL
- IN UINTN BufferSize,
- IN CONST UINT8 *Buffer,
- IN CONST CHAR16 *RequestElement OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- UINTN Size;
- EFI_STRING ConfigRequest;
- EFI_STRING ConfigResp;
- EFI_STRING ResultsData;
-
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
-
- //
- // Construct <ConfigRequest>
- //
- if (RequestElement == NULL) {
- //
- // Allocate and fill a buffer large enough to hold the <ConfigHdr> template
- // followed by "&OFFSET=0&WIDTH=WWWWWWWWWWWWWWWW" followed by a Null-terminator
- //
- Size = (StrLen (mConfigHdrTemplate) + 32 + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- ConfigRequest = AllocateZeroPool (Size);
- UnicodeSPrint (ConfigRequest, Size, L"%s&OFFSET=0&WIDTH=%016LX", mConfigHdrTemplate, (UINT64)BufferSize);
- } else {
- //
- // Allocate and fill a buffer large enough to hold the <ConfigHdr> template
- // followed by <RequestElement> followed by a Null-terminator
- //
- Size = StrLen (mConfigHdrTemplate) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- Size = Size + (StrLen (RequestElement) + 1) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- ConfigRequest = AllocateZeroPool (Size);
- UnicodeSPrint (ConfigRequest, Size, L"%s%s", mConfigHdrTemplate, RequestElement);
- }
- if (ConfigRequest == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Convert <ConfigRequest> to <ConfigResp>
- //
- ConfigResp = InternalHiiBlockToConfig (ConfigRequest, Buffer, BufferSize);
- FreePool (ConfigRequest);
- if (ConfigResp == NULL) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- //
- // Set data in the uncommitted browser state information
- //
- ResultsData = InternalHiiBrowserCallback (VariableGuid, VariableName, ConfigResp + StrLen(mConfigHdrTemplate) + 1);
- FreePool (ConfigResp);
-
- return (BOOLEAN)(ResultsData != NULL);
-}
-
-/////////////////////////////////////////
-/////////////////////////////////////////
-/// IFR Functions
-/////////////////////////////////////////
-/////////////////////////////////////////
-
-#define HII_LIB_OPCODE_ALLOCATION_SIZE 0x200
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 *Buffer;
- UINTN BufferSize;
- UINTN Position;
-} HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER;
-
-///
-/// Lookup table that converts EFI_IFR_TYPE_X enum values to a width in bytes
-///
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST UINT8 mHiiDefaultTypeToWidth[] = {
- 1, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_8
- 2, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_16
- 4, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_32
- 8, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_64
- 1, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_BOOLEAN
- 3, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_TIME
- 4, // EFI_IFR_TYPE_DATE
- 2 // EFI_IFR_TYPE_STRING
-};
-
-/**
- Allocates and returns a new OpCode Handle. OpCode Handles must be freed with
- HiiFreeOpCodeHandle().
-
- @retval NULL There are not enough resources to allocate a new OpCode Handle.
- @retval Other A new OpCode handle.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-EFIAPI
-HiiAllocateOpCodeHandle (
- VOID
- )
-{
- HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBuffer;
-
- OpCodeBuffer = (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *)AllocatePool (sizeof (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER));
- if (OpCodeBuffer == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
- OpCodeBuffer->Buffer = (UINT8 *)AllocatePool (HII_LIB_OPCODE_ALLOCATION_SIZE);
- if (OpCodeBuffer->Buffer == NULL) {
- FreePool (OpCodeBuffer);
- return NULL;
- }
- OpCodeBuffer->BufferSize = HII_LIB_OPCODE_ALLOCATION_SIZE;
- OpCodeBuffer->Position = 0;
- return (VOID *)OpCodeBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Frees an OpCode Handle that was previously allocated with HiiAllocateOpCodeHandle().
- When an OpCode Handle is freed, all of the opcodes associated with the OpCode
- Handle are also freed.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-HiiFreeOpCodeHandle (
- VOID *OpCodeHandle
- )
-{
- HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBuffer;
-
- ASSERT (OpCodeHandle != NULL);
-
- OpCodeBuffer = (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *)OpCodeHandle;
- if (OpCodeBuffer->Buffer != NULL) {
- FreePool (OpCodeBuffer->Buffer);
- }
- FreePool (OpCodeBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Internal function gets the current position of opcode buffer.
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
-
- @return Current position of opcode buffer.
-**/
-UINTN
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle
- )
-{
- return ((HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *)OpCodeHandle)->Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal function gets the start pointer of opcode buffer.
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
-
- @return Pointer to the opcode buffer base.
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle
- )
-{
- return ((HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *)OpCodeHandle)->Buffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal function reserves the enough buffer for current opcode.
- When the buffer is not enough, Opcode buffer will be extended.
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] Size Size of current opcode.
-
- @return Pointer to the current opcode.
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiGrowOpCodeHandle (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN UINTN Size
- )
-{
- HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBuffer;
- UINT8 *Buffer;
-
- ASSERT (OpCodeHandle != NULL);
-
- OpCodeBuffer = (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *)OpCodeHandle;
- if (OpCodeBuffer->Position + Size > OpCodeBuffer->BufferSize) {
- Buffer = ReallocatePool (
- OpCodeBuffer->BufferSize,
- OpCodeBuffer->BufferSize + (Size + HII_LIB_OPCODE_ALLOCATION_SIZE),
- OpCodeBuffer->Buffer
- );
- ASSERT (Buffer != NULL);
- OpCodeBuffer->Buffer = Buffer;
- OpCodeBuffer->BufferSize += (Size + HII_LIB_OPCODE_ALLOCATION_SIZE);
- }
- Buffer = OpCodeBuffer->Buffer + OpCodeBuffer->Position;
- OpCodeBuffer->Position += Size;
- return Buffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal function creates opcode based on the template opcode.
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] OpCodeTemplate Pointer to the template buffer of opcode.
- @param[in] OpCode OpCode IFR value.
- @param[in] OpCodeSize Size of opcode.
- @param[in] ExtensionSize Size of extended opcode.
- @param[in] Scope Scope bit of opcode.
-
- @return Pointer to the current opcode with opcode data.
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN VOID *OpCodeTemplate,
- IN UINT8 OpCode,
- IN UINTN OpCodeSize,
- IN UINTN ExtensionSize,
- IN UINT8 Scope
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *Header;
- UINT8 *Buffer;
-
- ASSERT (OpCodeTemplate != NULL);
- ASSERT ((OpCodeSize + ExtensionSize) <= 0x7F);
-
- Header = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *)OpCodeTemplate;
- Header->OpCode = OpCode;
- Header->Scope = Scope;
- Header->Length = (UINT8)(OpCodeSize + ExtensionSize);
- Buffer = InternalHiiGrowOpCodeHandle (OpCodeHandle, Header->Length);
- return (UINT8 *)CopyMem (Buffer, Header, OpCodeSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Internal function creates opcode based on the template opcode for the normal opcode.
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] OpCodeTemplate Pointer to the template buffer of opcode.
- @param[in] OpCode OpCode IFR value.
- @param[in] OpCodeSize Size of opcode.
-
- @return Pointer to the current opcode with opcode data.
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiCreateOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN VOID *OpCodeTemplate,
- IN UINT8 OpCode,
- IN UINTN OpCodeSize
- )
-{
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, OpCodeTemplate, OpCode, OpCodeSize, 0, 0);
-}
-
-/**
- Append raw opcodes to an OpCodeHandle.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If RawBuffer is NULL, then ASSERT();
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] RawBuffer Buffer of opcodes to append.
- @param[in] RawBufferSize The size, in bytes, of Buffer.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the appended opcodes.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateRawOpCodes (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN UINT8 *RawBuffer,
- IN UINTN RawBufferSize
- )
-{
- UINT8 *Buffer;
-
- ASSERT (RawBuffer != NULL);
-
- Buffer = InternalHiiGrowOpCodeHandle (OpCodeHandle, RawBufferSize);
- return (UINT8 *)CopyMem (Buffer, RawBuffer, RawBufferSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Append opcodes from one OpCode Handle to another OpCode handle.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If RawOpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT();
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] RawOpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the appended opcodes.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN VOID *RawOpCodeHandle
- )
-{
- HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *RawOpCodeBuffer;
-
- ASSERT (RawOpCodeHandle != NULL);
-
- RawOpCodeBuffer = (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *)RawOpCodeHandle;
- return HiiCreateRawOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, RawOpCodeBuffer->Buffer, RawOpCodeBuffer->Position);
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_END_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateEndOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_END OpCode;
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_END_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Type is invalid, then ASSERT().
- If Flags is invalid, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] StringId StringId for the option
- @param[in] Flags Flags for the option
- @param[in] Type Type for the option
- @param[in] Value Value for the option
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateOneOfOptionOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN UINT16 StringId,
- IN UINT8 Flags,
- IN UINT8 Type,
- IN UINT64 Value
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION OpCode;
-
- ASSERT (Type < EFI_IFR_TYPE_OTHER);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Option = StringId;
- OpCode.Flags = (UINT8) (Flags & (EFI_IFR_OPTION_DEFAULT | EFI_IFR_OPTION_DEFAULT_MFG));
- OpCode.Type = Type;
- CopyMem (&OpCode.Value, &Value, mHiiDefaultTypeToWidth[Type]);
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP, OFFSET_OF(EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION, Value) + mHiiDefaultTypeToWidth[Type]);
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_DEFAULT_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Type is invalid, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] DefaultId DefaultId for the default
- @param[in] Type Type for the default
- @param[in] Value Value for the default
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateDefaultOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN UINT16 DefaultId,
- IN UINT8 Type,
- IN UINT64 Value
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_DEFAULT OpCode;
-
- ASSERT (Type < EFI_IFR_TYPE_OTHER);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Type = Type;
- OpCode.DefaultId = DefaultId;
- CopyMem (&OpCode.Value, &Value, mHiiDefaultTypeToWidth[Type]);
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_DEFAULT_OP, OFFSET_OF(EFI_IFR_DEFAULT, Value) + mHiiDefaultTypeToWidth[Type]);
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_GUID opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If Guid is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If OpCodeSize < sizeof (EFI_IFR_GUID), then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to EFI_GUID of this guided opcode.
- @param[in] GuidOpCode Pointer to an EFI_IFR_GUID opcode. This is an
- optional parameter that may be NULL. If this
- parameter is NULL, then the GUID extension
- region of the created opcode is filled with zeros.
- If this parameter is not NULL, then the GUID
- extension region of GuidData will be copied to
- the GUID extension region of the created opcode.
- @param[in] OpCodeSize The size, in bytes, of created opcode. This value
- must be >= sizeof(EFI_IFR_GUID).
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateGuidOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *Guid,
- IN CONST VOID *GuidOpCode, OPTIONAL
- IN UINTN OpCodeSize
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_GUID OpCode;
- EFI_IFR_GUID *OpCodePointer;
-
- ASSERT (Guid != NULL);
- ASSERT (OpCodeSize >= sizeof (OpCode));
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- CopyGuid ((EFI_GUID *)(VOID *)&OpCode.Guid, Guid);
-
- OpCodePointer = (EFI_IFR_GUID *)InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (
- OpCodeHandle,
- &OpCode,
- EFI_IFR_GUID_OP,
- sizeof (OpCode),
- OpCodeSize - sizeof (OpCode),
- 0
- );
- if (OpCodePointer != NULL && GuidOpCode != NULL) {
- CopyMem (OpCodePointer + 1, (EFI_IFR_GUID *)GuidOpCode + 1, OpCodeSize - sizeof (OpCode));
- }
- return (UINT8 *)OpCodePointer;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_ACTION_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] QuestionConfig String ID for configuration
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateActionOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID QuestionConfig
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_ACTION OpCode;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.QuestionConfig = QuestionConfig;
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_ACTION_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_SUBTITLE_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in Flags, then ASSERT().
- If Scope > 1, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] Flags Subtitle opcode flags
- @param[in] Scope 1 if this opcpde is the beginning of a new scope.
- 0 if this opcode is within the current scope.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateSubTitleOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 Flags,
- IN UINT8 Scope
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_SUBTITLE OpCode;
-
- ASSERT (Scope <= 1);
- ASSERT ((Flags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAGS_HORIZONTAL))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Statement.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Statement.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Flags = Flags;
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (
- OpCodeHandle,
- &OpCode,
- EFI_IFR_SUBTITLE_OP,
- sizeof (OpCode),
- 0,
- Scope
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_REF_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] FormId Destination Form ID
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateGotoOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_FORM_ID FormId,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_REF OpCode;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.FormId = FormId;
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_REF_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_REF_OP, EFI_IFR_REF2_OP, EFI_IFR_REF3_OP and EFI_IFR_REF4_OP opcode.
-
- When RefDevicePath is not zero, EFI_IFR_REF4 opcode will be created.
- When RefDevicePath is zero and RefFormSetId is not NULL, EFI_IFR_REF3 opcode will be created.
- When RefDevicePath is zero, RefFormSetId is NULL and RefQuestionId is not zero, EFI_IFR_REF2 opcode will be created.
- When RefDevicePath is zero, RefFormSetId is NULL and RefQuestionId is zero, EFI_IFR_REF opcode will be created.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle The handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] RefFormId The Destination Form ID.
- @param[in] Prompt The string ID for Prompt.
- @param[in] Help The string ID for Help.
- @param[in] QuestionFlags The flags in Question Header
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID.
- @param[in] RefQuestionId The question on the form to which this link is referring.
- If its value is zero, then the link refers to the top of the form.
- @param[in] RefFormSetId The form set to which this link is referring. If its value is NULL, and RefDevicePath is
- zero, then the link is to the current form set.
- @param[in] RefDevicePath The string identifier that specifies the string containing the text representation of
- the device path to which the form set containing the form specified by FormId.
- If its value is zero, then the link refers to the current page.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateGotoExOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_FORM_ID RefFormId,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID RefQuestionId,
- IN EFI_GUID *RefFormSetId, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_STRING_ID RefDevicePath
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_REF4 OpCode;
- UINTN OpCodeSize;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.FormId = RefFormId;
- OpCode.QuestionId = RefQuestionId;
- OpCode.DevicePath = RefDevicePath;
- if (RefFormSetId != NULL) {
- CopyMem (&OpCode.FormSetId, RefFormSetId, sizeof (OpCode.FormSetId));
- }
-
- //
- // Cacluate OpCodeSize based on the input Ref value.
- // Try to use the small OpCode to save size.
- //
- OpCodeSize = sizeof (EFI_IFR_REF);
- if (RefDevicePath != 0) {
- OpCodeSize = sizeof (EFI_IFR_REF4);
- } else if (RefFormSetId != NULL) {
- OpCodeSize = sizeof (EFI_IFR_REF3);
- } else if (RefQuestionId != 0) {
- OpCodeSize = sizeof (EFI_IFR_REF2);
- }
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_REF_OP, OpCodeSize);
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in CheckBoxFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] CheckBoxFlags Flags for checkbox opcode
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateCheckBoxOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId,
- IN UINT16 VarOffset,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 CheckBoxFlags,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.Flags = CheckBoxFlags;
-
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle == NULL) {
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
- }
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP, sizeof (OpCode), 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in NumericFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] NumericFlags Flags for numeric opcode
- @param[in] Minimum Numeric minimum value
- @param[in] Maximum Numeric maximum value
- @param[in] Step Numeric step for edit
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateNumericOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId,
- IN UINT16 VarOffset,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 NumericFlags,
- IN UINT64 Minimum,
- IN UINT64 Maximum,
- IN UINT64 Step,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_NUMERIC OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
- UINTN Length;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
-
- Length = 0;
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.Flags = NumericFlags;
-
- switch (NumericFlags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE) {
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_1:
- OpCode.data.u8.MinValue = (UINT8)Minimum;
- OpCode.data.u8.MaxValue = (UINT8)Maximum;
- OpCode.data.u8.Step = (UINT8)Step;
- Length = 3;
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_2:
- OpCode.data.u16.MinValue = (UINT16)Minimum;
- OpCode.data.u16.MaxValue = (UINT16)Maximum;
- OpCode.data.u16.Step = (UINT16)Step;
- Length = 6;
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_4:
- OpCode.data.u32.MinValue = (UINT32)Minimum;
- OpCode.data.u32.MaxValue = (UINT32)Maximum;
- OpCode.data.u32.Step = (UINT32)Step;
- Length = 12;
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_8:
- OpCode.data.u64.MinValue = Minimum;
- OpCode.data.u64.MaxValue = Maximum;
- OpCode.data.u64.Step = Step;
- Length = 24;
- break;
- }
-
- Length += OFFSET_OF (EFI_IFR_NUMERIC, data);
-
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle == NULL) {
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP, Length);
- }
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP, Length, 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_STRING_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in StringFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] StringFlags Flags for string opcode
- @param[in] MinSize String minimum length
- @param[in] MaxSize String maximum length
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateStringOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId,
- IN UINT16 VarOffset,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 StringFlags,
- IN UINT8 MinSize,
- IN UINT8 MaxSize,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_STRING OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.MinSize = MinSize;
- OpCode.MaxSize = MaxSize;
- OpCode.Flags = (UINT8) (StringFlags & EFI_IFR_STRING_MULTI_LINE);
-
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle == NULL) {
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_STRING_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
- }
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_STRING_OP, sizeof (OpCode), 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in OneOfFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] OneOfFlags Flags for oneof opcode
- @param[in] OptionsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of ONE_OF_OPTION opcodes.
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateOneOfOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId,
- IN UINT16 VarOffset,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 OneOfFlags,
- IN VOID *OptionsOpCodeHandle,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
- UINTN Length;
-
- ASSERT (OptionsOpCodeHandle != NULL);
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED | EFI_IFR_FLAG_OPTIONS_ONLY))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.Flags = OneOfFlags;
-
- Length = OFFSET_OF (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF, data);
- Length += (1 << (OneOfFlags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE)) * 3;
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP, Length, 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, OptionsOpCodeHandle);
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle != NULL) {
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- }
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in OrderedListFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] OrderedListFlags Flags for ordered list opcode
- @param[in] DataType Type for option value
- @param[in] MaxContainers Maximum count for options in this ordered list
- @param[in] OptionsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of ONE_OF_OPTION opcodes.
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateOrderedListOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId,
- IN UINT16 VarOffset,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 OrderedListFlags,
- IN UINT8 DataType,
- IN UINT8 MaxContainers,
- IN VOID *OptionsOpCodeHandle,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
-
- ASSERT (OptionsOpCodeHandle != NULL);
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED | EFI_IFR_FLAG_OPTIONS_ONLY))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.MaxContainers = MaxContainers;
- OpCode.Flags = OrderedListFlags;
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP, sizeof (OpCode), 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, OptionsOpCodeHandle);
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle != NULL) {
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- }
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_TEXT_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt.
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help.
- @param[in] TextTwo String ID for TextTwo.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateTextOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID TextTwo
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_TEXT OpCode;
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Statement.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Statement.Help = Help;
- OpCode.TextTwo = TextTwo;
-
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_TEXT_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_DATE_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in DateFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID, optional. If DateFlags is not
- QF_DATE_STORAGE_NORMAL, this parameter is ignored.
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair, optional. If DateFlags is not
- QF_DATE_STORAGE_NORMAL, this parameter is ignored.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] DateFlags Flags for date opcode
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateDateOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT16 VarOffset, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 DateFlags,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_DATE OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
- ASSERT ((DateFlags & (~(EFI_QF_DATE_YEAR_SUPPRESS | EFI_QF_DATE_MONTH_SUPPRESS | EFI_QF_DATE_DAY_SUPPRESS | EFI_QF_DATE_STORAGE))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.Flags = DateFlags;
-
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle == NULL) {
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_DATE_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
- }
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_DATE_OP, sizeof (OpCode), 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- Create EFI_IFR_TIME_OP opcode.
-
- If OpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in QuestionFlags, then ASSERT().
- If any reserved bits are set in TimeFlags, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] OpCodeHandle Handle to the buffer of opcodes.
- @param[in] QuestionId Question ID
- @param[in] VarStoreId Storage ID, optional. If TimeFlags is not
- QF_TIME_STORAGE_NORMAL, this parameter is ignored.
- @param[in] VarOffset Offset in Storage or String ID of the name (VarName)
- for this name/value pair, optional. If TimeFlags is not
- QF_TIME_STORAGE_NORMAL, this parameter is ignored.
- @param[in] Prompt String ID for Prompt
- @param[in] Help String ID for Help
- @param[in] QuestionFlags Flags in Question Header
- @param[in] TimeFlags Flags for time opcode
- @param[in] DefaultsOpCodeHandle Handle for a buffer of DEFAULT opcodes. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @retval NULL There is not enough space left in Buffer to add the opcode.
- @retval Other A pointer to the created opcode.
-
-**/
-UINT8 *
-EFIAPI
-HiiCreateTimeOpCode (
- IN VOID *OpCodeHandle,
- IN EFI_QUESTION_ID QuestionId,
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId, OPTIONAL
- IN UINT16 VarOffset, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Prompt,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID Help,
- IN UINT8 QuestionFlags,
- IN UINT8 TimeFlags,
- IN VOID *DefaultsOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_TIME OpCode;
- UINTN Position;
-
- ASSERT ((QuestionFlags & (~(EFI_IFR_FLAG_READ_ONLY | EFI_IFR_FLAG_CALLBACK | EFI_IFR_FLAG_RESET_REQUIRED))) == 0);
- ASSERT ((TimeFlags & (~(QF_TIME_HOUR_SUPPRESS | QF_TIME_MINUTE_SUPPRESS | QF_TIME_SECOND_SUPPRESS | QF_TIME_STORAGE))) == 0);
-
- ZeroMem (&OpCode, sizeof (OpCode));
- OpCode.Question.Header.Prompt = Prompt;
- OpCode.Question.Header.Help = Help;
- OpCode.Question.QuestionId = QuestionId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreId = VarStoreId;
- OpCode.Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset = VarOffset;
- OpCode.Question.Flags = QuestionFlags;
- OpCode.Flags = TimeFlags;
-
- if (DefaultsOpCodeHandle == NULL) {
- return InternalHiiCreateOpCode (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_TIME_OP, sizeof (OpCode));
- }
-
- Position = InternalHiiOpCodeHandlePosition (OpCodeHandle);
- InternalHiiCreateOpCodeExtended (OpCodeHandle, &OpCode, EFI_IFR_TIME_OP, sizeof (OpCode), 0, 1);
- InternalHiiAppendOpCodes (OpCodeHandle, DefaultsOpCodeHandle);
- HiiCreateEndOpCode (OpCodeHandle);
- return InternalHiiOpCodeHandleBuffer (OpCodeHandle) + Position;
-}
-
-/**
- This is the internal worker function to update the data in
- a form specified by FormSetGuid, FormId and Label.
-
- @param[in] FormSetGuid The optional Formset GUID.
- @param[in] FormId The Form ID.
- @param[in] Package The package header.
- @param[in] OpCodeBufferStart An OpCode buffer that contains the set of IFR
- opcodes to be inserted or replaced in the form.
- @param[in] OpCodeBufferEnd An OpCcode buffer that contains the IFR opcode
- that marks the end of a replace operation in the form.
- @param[out] TempPackage The resultant package.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The function completes successfully.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The updated opcode or endopcode is not found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalHiiUpdateFormPackageData (
- IN EFI_GUID *FormSetGuid, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_FORM_ID FormId,
- IN EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *Package,
- IN HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBufferStart,
- IN HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBufferEnd, OPTIONAL
- OUT EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *TempPackage
- )
-{
- UINTN AddSize;
- UINT8 *BufferPos;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER PackageHeader;
- UINTN Offset;
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpHdr;
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *UpdateIfrOpHdr;
- BOOLEAN GetFormSet;
- BOOLEAN GetForm;
- BOOLEAN Updated;
- UINTN UpdatePackageLength;
-
- CopyMem (TempPackage, Package, sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER));
- UpdatePackageLength = sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER);
- BufferPos = (UINT8 *) (TempPackage + 1);
-
- CopyMem (&PackageHeader, Package, sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER));
- IfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *)((UINT8 *) Package + sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER));
- Offset = sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER);
- GetFormSet = (BOOLEAN) ((FormSetGuid == NULL) ? TRUE : FALSE);
- GetForm = FALSE;
- Updated = FALSE;
-
- while (Offset < PackageHeader.Length) {
- CopyMem (BufferPos, IfrOpHdr, IfrOpHdr->Length);
- BufferPos += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- UpdatePackageLength += IfrOpHdr->Length;
-
- //
- // Find the matched FormSet and Form
- //
- if ((IfrOpHdr->OpCode == EFI_IFR_FORM_SET_OP) && (FormSetGuid != NULL)) {
- if (CompareGuid((GUID *)(VOID *)&((EFI_IFR_FORM_SET *) IfrOpHdr)->Guid, FormSetGuid)) {
- GetFormSet = TRUE;
- } else {
- GetFormSet = FALSE;
- }
- } else if (IfrOpHdr->OpCode == EFI_IFR_FORM_OP || IfrOpHdr->OpCode == EFI_IFR_FORM_MAP_OP) {
- if (CompareMem (&((EFI_IFR_FORM *) IfrOpHdr)->FormId, &FormId, sizeof (EFI_FORM_ID)) == 0) {
- GetForm = TRUE;
- } else {
- GetForm = FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // The matched Form is found, and Update data in this form
- //
- if (GetFormSet && GetForm) {
- UpdateIfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) OpCodeBufferStart->Buffer;
- if ((UpdateIfrOpHdr->Length == IfrOpHdr->Length) && \
- (CompareMem (IfrOpHdr, UpdateIfrOpHdr, UpdateIfrOpHdr->Length) == 0)) {
- //
- // Remove the original data when End OpCode buffer exist.
- //
- if (OpCodeBufferEnd != NULL) {
- Offset += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- IfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINT8 *) (IfrOpHdr) + IfrOpHdr->Length);
- UpdateIfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) OpCodeBufferEnd->Buffer;
- while (Offset < PackageHeader.Length) {
- //
- // Search the matched end opcode
- //
- if ((UpdateIfrOpHdr->Length == IfrOpHdr->Length) && \
- (CompareMem (IfrOpHdr, UpdateIfrOpHdr, UpdateIfrOpHdr->Length) == 0)) {
- break;
- }
- //
- // Go to the next Op-Code
- //
- Offset += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- IfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINT8 *) (IfrOpHdr) + IfrOpHdr->Length);
- }
-
- if (Offset >= PackageHeader.Length) {
- //
- // The end opcode is not found.
- //
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Insert the updated data
- //
- AddSize = ((EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) OpCodeBufferStart->Buffer)->Length;
- CopyMem (BufferPos, OpCodeBufferStart->Buffer + AddSize, OpCodeBufferStart->Position - AddSize);
- BufferPos += OpCodeBufferStart->Position - AddSize;
- UpdatePackageLength += OpCodeBufferStart->Position - AddSize;
-
- if (OpCodeBufferEnd != NULL) {
- //
- // Add the end opcode
- //
- CopyMem (BufferPos, IfrOpHdr, IfrOpHdr->Length);
- BufferPos += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- UpdatePackageLength += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- }
-
- //
- // Copy the left package data.
- //
- Offset += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- CopyMem (BufferPos, (UINT8 *) Package + Offset, PackageHeader.Length - Offset);
- UpdatePackageLength += PackageHeader.Length - Offset;
-
- //
- // Set update flag
- //
- Updated = TRUE;
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Go to the next Op-Code
- //
- Offset += IfrOpHdr->Length;
- IfrOpHdr = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((CHAR8 *) (IfrOpHdr) + IfrOpHdr->Length);
- }
-
- if (!Updated) {
- //
- // The updated opcode buffer is not found.
- //
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- //
- // Update the package length.
- //
- PackageHeader.Length = (UINT32) UpdatePackageLength;
- CopyMem (TempPackage, &PackageHeader, sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER));
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- This function updates a form that has previously been registered with the HII
- Database. This function will perform at most one update operation.
-
- The form to update is specified by Handle, FormSetGuid, and FormId. Binary
- comparisons of IFR opcodes are performed from the beginning of the form being
- updated until an IFR opcode is found that exactly matches the first IFR opcode
- specified by StartOpCodeHandle. The following rules are used to determine if
- an insert, replace, or delete operation is performed.
-
- 1) If no matches are found, then NULL is returned.
- 2) If a match is found, and EndOpCodeHandle is NULL, then all of the IFR opcodes
- from StartOpCodeHandle except the first opcode are inserted immediately after
- the matching IFR opcode in the form to be updated.
- 3) If a match is found, and EndOpCodeHandle is not NULL, then a search is made
- from the matching IFR opcode until an IFR opcode exactly matches the first
- IFR opcode specified by EndOpCodeHandle. If no match is found for the first
- IFR opcode specified by EndOpCodeHandle, then NULL is returned. If a match
- is found, then all of the IFR opcodes between the start match and the end
- match are deleted from the form being updated and all of the IFR opcodes
- from StartOpCodeHandle except the first opcode are inserted immediately after
- the matching start IFR opcode. If StartOpCcodeHandle only contains one
- IFR instruction, then the result of this operation will delete all of the IFR
- opcodes between the start end matches.
-
- If HiiHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StartOpCodeHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] HiiHandle The HII Handle of the form to update.
- @param[in] FormSetGuid The Formset GUID of the form to update. This
- is an optional parameter that may be NULL.
- If it is NULL, all FormSet will be updated.
- @param[in] FormId The ID of the form to update.
- @param[in] StartOpCodeHandle An OpCode Handle that contains the set of IFR
- opcodes to be inserted or replaced in the form.
- The first IFR instruction in StartOpCodeHandle
- is used to find matching IFR opcode in the
- form.
- @param[in] EndOpCodeHandle An OpCcode Handle that contains the IFR opcode
- that marks the end of a replace operation in
- the form. This is an optional parameter that
- may be NULL. If it is NULL, then an the IFR
- opcodes specified by StartOpCodeHandle are
- inserted into the form.
-
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory resource is allocated.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The following cases will return EFI_NOT_FOUND.
- 1) The form specified by HiiHandle, FormSetGuid,
- and FormId could not be found in the HII Database.
- 2) No IFR opcodes in the target form match the first
- IFR opcode in StartOpCodeHandle.
- 3) EndOpCOde is not NULL, and no IFR opcodes in the
- target form following a matching start opcode match
- the first IFR opcode in EndOpCodeHandle.
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The matched form is updated by StartOpcode.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-HiiUpdateForm (
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle,
- IN EFI_GUID *FormSetGuid, OPTIONAL
- IN EFI_FORM_ID FormId,
- IN VOID *StartOpCodeHandle,
- IN VOID *EndOpCodeHandle OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageList;
- UINT32 PackageListLength;
- UINT32 Offset;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *UpdatePackageList;
- UINTN BufferSize;
- UINT8 *UpdateBufferPos;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *Package;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *TempPacakge;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER PackageHeader;
- BOOLEAN Updated;
- HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBufferStart;
- HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *OpCodeBufferEnd;
-
- //
- // Input update data can't be NULL.
- //
- ASSERT (HiiHandle != NULL);
- ASSERT (StartOpCodeHandle != NULL);
- UpdatePackageList = NULL;
- TempPacakge = NULL;
- HiiPackageList = NULL;
-
- //
- // Retrieve buffer data from Opcode Handle
- //
- OpCodeBufferStart = (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *) StartOpCodeHandle;
- OpCodeBufferEnd = (HII_LIB_OPCODE_BUFFER *) EndOpCodeHandle;
-
- //
- // Get the original package list
- //
- BufferSize = 0;
- HiiPackageList = NULL;
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandle, &BufferSize, HiiPackageList);
- //
- // The return status should always be EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL as input buffer's size is 0.
- //
- if (Status != EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- HiiPackageList = AllocatePool (BufferSize);
- if (HiiPackageList == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Finish;
- }
-
- Status = gHiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandle, &BufferSize, HiiPackageList);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- goto Finish;
- }
-
- //
- // Calculate and allocate space for retrieval of IFR data
- //
- BufferSize += OpCodeBufferStart->Position;
- UpdatePackageList = AllocateZeroPool (BufferSize);
- if (UpdatePackageList == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Finish;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate temp buffer to store the temp updated package buffer
- //
- TempPacakge = AllocateZeroPool (BufferSize);
- if (TempPacakge == NULL) {
- Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- goto Finish;
- }
-
- UpdateBufferPos = (UINT8 *) UpdatePackageList;
-
- //
- // Copy the package list header
- //
- CopyMem (UpdateBufferPos, HiiPackageList, sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER));
- UpdateBufferPos += sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER);
-
- //
- // Go through each package to find the matched package and update one by one
- //
- Updated = FALSE;
- Offset = sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER);
- PackageListLength = ReadUnaligned32 (&HiiPackageList->PackageLength);
- while (Offset < PackageListLength) {
- Package = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) (((UINT8 *) HiiPackageList) + Offset);
- CopyMem (&PackageHeader, Package, sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER));
- Offset += Package->Length;
-
- if (Package->Type == EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS) {
- //
- // Check this package is the matched package.
- //
- Status = InternalHiiUpdateFormPackageData (FormSetGuid, FormId, Package, OpCodeBufferStart, OpCodeBufferEnd, TempPacakge);
- //
- // The matched package is found. Its package buffer will be updated by the input new data.
- //
- if (!EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
- //
- // Set Update Flag
- //
- Updated = TRUE;
- //
- // Add updated package buffer
- //
- Package = TempPacakge;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Add pacakge buffer
- //
- CopyMem (&PackageHeader, Package, sizeof (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER));
- CopyMem (UpdateBufferPos, Package, PackageHeader.Length);
- UpdateBufferPos += PackageHeader.Length;
- }
-
- if (Updated) {
- //
- // Update package list length
- //
- BufferSize = UpdateBufferPos - (UINT8 *) UpdatePackageList;
- WriteUnaligned32 (&UpdatePackageList->PackageLength, (UINT32) BufferSize);
-
- //
- // Update Package to show form
- //
- Status = gHiiDatabase->UpdatePackageList (gHiiDatabase, HiiHandle, UpdatePackageList);
- } else {
- //
- // Not matched form is found and updated.
- //
- Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
-Finish:
- if (HiiPackageList != NULL) {
- FreePool (HiiPackageList);
- }
-
- if (UpdatePackageList != NULL) {
- FreePool (UpdatePackageList);
- }
-
- if (TempPacakge != NULL) {
- FreePool (TempPacakge);
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiString.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiString.c deleted file mode 100644 index bfae3f8fc0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/HiiString.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,355 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- HII Library implementation that uses DXE protocols and services.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-
-#include "InternalHiiLib.h"
-
-/**
- This function create a new string in String Package or updates an existing
- string in a String Package. If StringId is 0, then a new string is added to
- a String Package. If StringId is not zero, then a string in String Package is
- updated. If SupportedLanguages is NULL, then the string is added or updated
- for all the languages that the String Package supports. If SupportedLanguages
- is not NULL, then the string is added or updated for the set of languages
- specified by SupportedLanguages.
-
- If HiiHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If String is NULL, then ASSERT().
-
- @param[in] HiiHandle A handle that was previously registered in the
- HII Database.
- @param[in] StringId If zero, then a new string is created in the
- String Package associated with HiiHandle. If
- non-zero, then the string specified by StringId
- is updated in the String Package associated
- with HiiHandle.
- @param[in] String A pointer to the Null-terminated Unicode string
- to add or update in the String Package associated
- with HiiHandle.
- @param[in] SupportedLanguages A pointer to a Null-terminated ASCII string of
- language codes. If this parameter is NULL, then
- String is added or updated in the String Package
- associated with HiiHandle for all the languages
- that the String Package supports. If this
- parameter is not NULL, then then String is added
- or updated in the String Package associated with
- HiiHandle for the set oflanguages specified by
- SupportedLanguages. The format of
- SupportedLanguages must follow the language
- format assumed the HII Database.
-
- @retval 0 The string could not be added or updated in the String Package.
- @retval Other The EFI_STRING_ID of the newly added or updated string.
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING_ID
-EFIAPI
-HiiSetString (
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID StringId, OPTIONAL
- IN CONST EFI_STRING String,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *SupportedLanguages OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- CHAR8 *AllocatedLanguages;
- CHAR8 *Supported;
- CHAR8 *Language;
-
- ASSERT (HiiHandle != NULL);
- ASSERT (String != NULL);
-
- if (SupportedLanguages == NULL) {
- //
- // Retrieve the languages that the package specified by HiiHandle supports
- //
- AllocatedLanguages = HiiGetSupportedLanguages (HiiHandle);
- } else {
- //
- // Allocate a copy of the SupportLanguages string that passed in
- //
- AllocatedLanguages = AllocateCopyPool (AsciiStrSize (SupportedLanguages), SupportedLanguages);
- }
-
- //
- // If there are not enough resources for the supported languages string, then return a StringId of 0
- //
- if (AllocatedLanguages == NULL) {
- return (EFI_STRING_ID)(0);
- }
-
- Status = EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- //
- // Loop through each language that the string supports
- //
- for (Supported = AllocatedLanguages; *Supported != '\0'; ) {
- //
- // Cache a pointer to the beginning of the current language in the list of languages
- //
- Language = Supported;
-
- //
- // Search for the next language seperator and replace it with a Null-terminator
- //
- for (; *Supported != 0 && *Supported != ';'; Supported++);
- if (*Supported != 0) {
- *(Supported++) = '\0';
- }
-
- if ((SupportedLanguages == NULL) && AsciiStrnCmp (Language, UEFI_CONFIG_LANG, AsciiStrLen (UEFI_CONFIG_LANG)) == 0) {
- //
- // Skip string package used for keyword protocol.
- //
- continue;
- }
-
- //
- // If StringId is 0, then call NewString(). Otherwise, call SetString()
- //
- if (StringId == (EFI_STRING_ID)(0)) {
- Status = gHiiString->NewString (gHiiString, HiiHandle, &StringId, Language, NULL, String, NULL);
- } else {
- Status = gHiiString->SetString (gHiiString, HiiHandle, StringId, Language, String, NULL);
- }
-
- //
- // If there was an error, then break out of the loop and return a StringId of 0
- //
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- break;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Free the buffer of supported languages
- //
- FreePool (AllocatedLanguages);
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return (EFI_STRING_ID)(0);
- } else {
- return StringId;
- }
-}
-
-
-/**
- Retrieves a string from a string package names by GUID in a specific language.
- If the language is not specified, then a string from a string package in the
- current platform language is retrieved. If the string can not be retrieved
- using the specified language or the current platform language, then the string
- is retrieved from the string package in the first language the string package
- supports. The returned string is allocated using AllocatePool(). The caller
- is responsible for freeing the allocated buffer using FreePool().
-
- If PackageListGuid is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StringId is 0, then ASSERT.
-
- @param[in] PackageListGuid The GUID of a package list that was previously
- registered in the HII Database.
- @param[in] StringId The identifier of the string to retrieved from the
- string package associated with PackageListGuid.
- @param[in] Language The language of the string to retrieve. If this
- parameter is NULL, then the current platform
- language is used. The format of Language must
- follow the language format assumed the HII Database.
-
- @retval NULL The package list specified by PackageListGuid is not present in the
- HII Database.
- @retval NULL The string specified by StringId is not present in the string package.
- @retval Other The string was returned.
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING
-EFIAPI
-HiiGetPackageString (
- IN CONST EFI_GUID *PackageListGuid,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID StringId,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Language OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_HANDLE *HiiHandleBuffer;
- EFI_HANDLE HiiHandle;
-
- ASSERT (PackageListGuid != NULL);
-
- HiiHandleBuffer = HiiGetHiiHandles (PackageListGuid);
- if (HiiHandleBuffer == NULL) {
- return NULL;
- }
-
- HiiHandle = HiiHandleBuffer[0];
- FreePool (HiiHandleBuffer);
-
- return HiiGetString (HiiHandle, StringId, Language);
-}
-
-/**
- Retrieves a string from a string package in a specific language. If the language
- is not specified, then a string from a string package in the current platform
- language is retrieved. If the string can not be retrieved using the specified
- language or the current platform language, then the string is retrieved from
- the string package in the first language the string package supports. The
- returned string is allocated using AllocatePool(). The caller is responsible
- for freeing the allocated buffer using FreePool().
-
- If HiiHandle is NULL, then ASSERT().
- If StringId is 0, then ASSET.
-
- @param[in] HiiHandle A handle that was previously registered in the HII Database.
- @param[in] StringId The identifier of the string to retrieved from the string
- package associated with HiiHandle.
- @param[in] Language The language of the string to retrieve. If this parameter
- is NULL, then the current platform language is used. The
- format of Language must follow the language format assumed
- the HII Database.
-
- @retval NULL The string specified by StringId is not present in the string package.
- @retval Other The string was returned.
-
-**/
-EFI_STRING
-EFIAPI
-HiiGetString (
- IN EFI_HII_HANDLE HiiHandle,
- IN EFI_STRING_ID StringId,
- IN CONST CHAR8 *Language OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN StringSize;
- CHAR16 TempString;
- EFI_STRING String;
- CHAR8 *SupportedLanguages;
- CHAR8 *PlatformLanguage;
- CHAR8 *BestLanguage;
-
- ASSERT (HiiHandle != NULL);
- ASSERT (StringId != 0);
-
- //
- // Initialize all allocated buffers to NULL
- //
- SupportedLanguages = NULL;
- PlatformLanguage = NULL;
- BestLanguage = NULL;
- String = NULL;
-
- //
- // Get the languages that the package specified by HiiHandle supports
- //
- SupportedLanguages = HiiGetSupportedLanguages (HiiHandle);
- if (SupportedLanguages == NULL) {
- goto Error;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the current platform language setting
- //
- GetEfiGlobalVariable2 (L"PlatformLang", (VOID**)&PlatformLanguage, NULL);
-
- //
- // If Languag is NULL, then set it to an empty string, so it will be
- // skipped by GetBestLanguage()
- //
- if (Language == NULL) {
- Language = "";
- }
-
- //
- // Get the best matching language from SupportedLanguages
- //
- BestLanguage = GetBestLanguage (
- SupportedLanguages,
- FALSE, // RFC 4646 mode
- Language, // Highest priority
- PlatformLanguage != NULL ? PlatformLanguage : "", // Next highest priority
- SupportedLanguages, // Lowest priority
- NULL
- );
- if (BestLanguage == NULL) {
- goto Error;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the size of the string in the string package for the BestLanguage
- //
- StringSize = 0;
- Status = gHiiString->GetString (
- gHiiString,
- BestLanguage,
- HiiHandle,
- StringId,
- &TempString,
- &StringSize,
- NULL
- );
- //
- // If GetString() returns EFI_SUCCESS for a zero size,
- // then there are no supported languages registered for HiiHandle. If GetString()
- // returns an error other than EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL, then HiiHandle is not present
- // in the HII Database
- //
- if (Status != EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- goto Error;
- }
-
- //
- // Allocate a buffer for the return string
- //
- String = AllocateZeroPool (StringSize);
- if (String == NULL) {
- goto Error;
- }
-
- //
- // Retrieve the string from the string package
- //
- Status = gHiiString->GetString (
- gHiiString,
- BestLanguage,
- HiiHandle,
- StringId,
- String,
- &StringSize,
- NULL
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // Free the buffer and return NULL if the supported languages can not be retrieved.
- //
- FreePool (String);
- String = NULL;
- }
-
-Error:
- //
- // Free allocated buffers
- //
- if (SupportedLanguages != NULL) {
- FreePool (SupportedLanguages);
- }
- if (PlatformLanguage != NULL) {
- FreePool (PlatformLanguage);
- }
- if (BestLanguage != NULL) {
- FreePool (BestLanguage);
- }
-
- //
- // Return the Null-terminated Unicode string
- //
- return String;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/InternalHiiLib.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/InternalHiiLib.h deleted file mode 100644 index 9bf7696ea3..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/InternalHiiLib.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,34 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Internal include file for the HII Library instance.
-
- Copyright (c) 2007, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef __INTERNAL_HII_LIB_H__
-#define __INTERNAL_HII_LIB_H__
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/DevicePath.h>
-#include <Protocol/FormBrowser2.h>
-
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/HiiLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiHiiServicesLib.h>
-#include <Library/PrintLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiLib.h>
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/UefiHiiLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/UefiHiiLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 62f435a089..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/UefiHiiLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,53 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# HII Library implementation using UEFI HII protocols and services.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = UefiHiiLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = UefiHiiLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 3143687A-7C80-404e-B5FE-2D88980E1B1C
- MODULE_TYPE = UEFI_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = HiiLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- HiiLib.c
- HiiString.c
- HiiLanguage.c
- InternalHiiLib.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- DevicePathLib
- UefiLib
- UefiHiiServicesLib
- PrintLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiFormBrowser2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/UefiHiiLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/UefiHiiLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 7385c4db9d..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiLib/UefiHiiLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index bd3a125603..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,113 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- This library retrieves pointers to the UEFI HII Protocol instances in the
- library's constructor. All of the UEFI HII related protocols are optional,
- so the consumers of this library class must verify that the global variable
- pointers are not NULL before use.
-
- Copyright (c) 2006 - 2009, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Library/UefiHiiServicesLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/HiiFont.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiString.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiImage.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiDatabase.h>
-#include <Protocol/HiiConfigRouting.h>
-
-///
-/// Pointer to the UEFI HII Font Protocol
-///
-EFI_HII_FONT_PROTOCOL *gHiiFont = NULL;
-
-///
-/// Pointer to the UEFI HII String Protocol
-///
-EFI_HII_STRING_PROTOCOL *gHiiString = NULL;
-
-///
-/// Pointer to the UEFI HII Image Protocol
-///
-EFI_HII_IMAGE_PROTOCOL *gHiiImage = NULL;
-
-///
-/// Pointer to the UEFI HII Database Protocol
-///
-EFI_HII_DATABASE_PROTOCOL *gHiiDatabase = NULL;
-
-///
-/// Pointer to the UEFI HII Config Rounting Protocol
-///
-EFI_HII_CONFIG_ROUTING_PROTOCOL *gHiiConfigRouting = NULL;
-
-/**
- The constructor function retrieves pointers to the UEFI HII protocol instances
-
- The constructor function retrieves pointers to the four UEFI HII protocols from the
- handle database. These include the UEFI HII Font Protocol, the UEFI HII String
- Protocol, the UEFI HII Image Protocol, the UEFI HII Database Protocol, and the
- UEFI HII Config Routing Protocol. This function always return EFI_SUCCESS.
- All of these protocols are optional if the platform does not support configuration
- and the UEFI HII Image Protocol and the UEFI HII Font Protocol are optional if
- the platform does not support a graphical console. As a result, the consumers
- of this library much check the protocol pointers againt NULL before using them,
- or use dependency expressions to guarantee that some of them are present before
- assuming they are not NULL.
-
- @param ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor always returns EFI_SUCCESS.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-UefiHiiServicesLibConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- //
- // Retrieve the pointer to the UEFI HII String Protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiHiiStringProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &gHiiString);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Retrieve the pointer to the UEFI HII Database Protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &gHiiDatabase);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Retrieve the pointer to the UEFI HII Config Routing Protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &gHiiConfigRouting);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- //
- // Retrieve the pointer to the optional UEFI HII Font Protocol
- //
- gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiHiiFontProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &gHiiFont);
-
- //
- // Retrieve the pointer to the optional UEFI HII Image Protocol
- //
- gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiHiiImageProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &gHiiImage);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index a009e9a715..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,67 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# UEFI HII Services Library implementation.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2007 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = UefiHiiServicesLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = UefiHiiServicesLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 894DC1B6-07A3-4a9d-8CDD-333580B3D4B1
- MODULE_TYPE = UEFI_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = UefiHiiServicesLib|DXE_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SAL_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER
-
- CONSTRUCTOR = UefiHiiServicesLibConstructor
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources]
- UefiHiiServicesLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- DebugLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiHiiFontProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiHiiStringProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiHiiImageProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_DRIVER]
- gEfiHiiStringProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER]
- gEfiHiiStringProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_SAL_DRIVER]
- gEfiHiiStringProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid
-
-[Depex.common.DXE_SMM_DRIVER]
- gEfiHiiStringProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid AND
- gEfiHiiConfigRoutingProtocolGuid
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index f7ad669b8e..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiHiiServicesLib/UefiHiiServicesLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 8a45cd0d9f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,322 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Library used for sorting routines.
-
- Copyright (c) 2009 - 2014, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved. <BR>
- This program and the accompanying materials
- are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
- which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
- http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
- THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
- WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Uefi.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/UnicodeCollation.h>
-#include <Protocol/DevicePath.h>
-
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/SortLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-
-STATIC EFI_UNICODE_COLLATION_PROTOCOL *mUnicodeCollation = NULL;
-
-#define USL_FREE_NON_NULL(Pointer) \
-{ \
- if ((Pointer) != NULL) { \
- FreePool((Pointer)); \
- (Pointer) = NULL; \
- } \
-}
-
-/**
- Worker function for QuickSorting. This function is identical to PerformQuickSort,
- except that is uses the pre-allocated buffer so the in place sorting does not need to
- allocate and free buffers constantly.
-
- Each element must be equal sized.
-
- if BufferToSort is NULL, then ASSERT.
- if CompareFunction is NULL, then ASSERT.
- if Buffer is NULL, then ASSERT.
-
- if Count is < 2 then perform no action.
- if Size is < 1 then perform no action.
-
- @param[in, out] BufferToSort on call a Buffer of (possibly sorted) elements
- on return a buffer of sorted elements
- @param[in] Count the number of elements in the buffer to sort
- @param[in] ElementSize Size of an element in bytes
- @param[in] CompareFunction The function to call to perform the comparison
- of any 2 elements
- @param[in] Buffer Buffer of size ElementSize for use in swapping
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-QuickSortWorker (
- IN OUT VOID *BufferToSort,
- IN CONST UINTN Count,
- IN CONST UINTN ElementSize,
- IN SORT_COMPARE CompareFunction,
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- VOID *Pivot;
- UINTN LoopCount;
- UINTN NextSwapLocation;
-
- ASSERT(BufferToSort != NULL);
- ASSERT(CompareFunction != NULL);
- ASSERT(Buffer != NULL);
-
- if ( Count < 2
- || ElementSize < 1
- ){
- return;
- }
-
- NextSwapLocation = 0;
-
- //
- // pick a pivot (we choose last element)
- //
- Pivot = ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+((Count-1)*ElementSize));
-
- //
- // Now get the pivot such that all on "left" are below it
- // and everything "right" are above it
- //
- for ( LoopCount = 0
- ; LoopCount < Count -1
- ; LoopCount++
- ){
- //
- // if the element is less than the pivot
- //
- if (CompareFunction((VOID*)((UINT8*)BufferToSort+((LoopCount)*ElementSize)),Pivot) <= 0){
- //
- // swap
- //
- CopyMem (Buffer, (UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), ElementSize);
- CopyMem ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), (UINT8*)BufferToSort+((LoopCount)*ElementSize), ElementSize);
- CopyMem ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+((LoopCount)*ElementSize), Buffer, ElementSize);
-
- //
- // increment NextSwapLocation
- //
- NextSwapLocation++;
- }
- }
- //
- // swap pivot to it's final position (NextSwapLocaiton)
- //
- CopyMem (Buffer, Pivot, ElementSize);
- CopyMem (Pivot, (UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), ElementSize);
- CopyMem ((UINT8*)BufferToSort+(NextSwapLocation*ElementSize), Buffer, ElementSize);
-
- //
- // Now recurse on 2 paritial lists. neither of these will have the 'pivot' element
- // IE list is sorted left half, pivot element, sorted right half...
- //
- if (NextSwapLocation >= 2) {
- QuickSortWorker(
- BufferToSort,
- NextSwapLocation,
- ElementSize,
- CompareFunction,
- Buffer);
- }
-
- if ((Count - NextSwapLocation - 1) >= 2) {
- QuickSortWorker(
- (UINT8 *)BufferToSort + (NextSwapLocation+1) * ElementSize,
- Count - NextSwapLocation - 1,
- ElementSize,
- CompareFunction,
- Buffer);
- }
-
- return;
-}
-/**
- Function to perform a Quick Sort alogrithm on a buffer of comparable elements.
-
- Each element must be equal sized.
-
- if BufferToSort is NULL, then ASSERT.
- if CompareFunction is NULL, then ASSERT.
-
- if Count is < 2 then perform no action.
- if Size is < 1 then perform no action.
-
- @param[in, out] BufferToSort on call a Buffer of (possibly sorted) elements
- on return a buffer of sorted elements
- @param[in] Count the number of elements in the buffer to sort
- @param[in] ElementSize Size of an element in bytes
- @param[in] CompareFunction The function to call to perform the comparison
- of any 2 elements
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-PerformQuickSort (
- IN OUT VOID *BufferToSort,
- IN CONST UINTN Count,
- IN CONST UINTN ElementSize,
- IN SORT_COMPARE CompareFunction
- )
-{
- VOID *Buffer;
-
- ASSERT(BufferToSort != NULL);
- ASSERT(CompareFunction != NULL);
-
- Buffer = AllocateZeroPool(ElementSize);
- ASSERT(Buffer != NULL);
-
- QuickSortWorker(
- BufferToSort,
- Count,
- ElementSize,
- CompareFunction,
- Buffer);
-
- FreePool(Buffer);
- return;
-}
-
-/**
- Function to compare 2 device paths for use in QuickSort.
-
- @param[in] Buffer1 pointer to Device Path poiner to compare
- @param[in] Buffer2 pointer to second DevicePath pointer to compare
-
- @retval 0 Buffer1 equal to Buffer2
- @retval <0 Buffer1 is less than Buffer2
- @retval >0 Buffer1 is greater than Buffer2
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-DevicePathCompare (
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer1,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer2
- )
-{
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath1;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *DevicePath2;
- CHAR16 *TextPath1;
- CHAR16 *TextPath2;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- INTN RetVal;
-
- DevicePath1 = *(EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL**)Buffer1;
- DevicePath2 = *(EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL**)Buffer2;
-
- if (DevicePath1 == NULL) {
- if (DevicePath2 == NULL) {
- return 0;
- }
-
- return -1;
- }
-
- if (DevicePath2 == NULL) {
- return 1;
- }
-
- if (mUnicodeCollation == NULL) {
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol(
- &gEfiUnicodeCollation2ProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID**)&mUnicodeCollation);
-
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR(Status);
- }
-
- TextPath1 = ConvertDevicePathToText(
- DevicePath1,
- FALSE,
- FALSE);
-
- TextPath2 = ConvertDevicePathToText(
- DevicePath2,
- FALSE,
- FALSE);
-
- if (TextPath1 == NULL) {
- RetVal = -1;
- } else if (TextPath2 == NULL) {
- RetVal = 1;
- } else {
- RetVal = mUnicodeCollation->StriColl(
- mUnicodeCollation,
- TextPath1,
- TextPath2);
- }
-
- USL_FREE_NON_NULL(TextPath1);
- USL_FREE_NON_NULL(TextPath2);
-
- return (RetVal);
-}
-
-/**
- Function to compare 2 strings without regard to case of the characters.
-
- @param[in] Buffer1 Pointer to String to compare.
- @param[in] Buffer2 Pointer to second String to compare.
-
- @retval 0 Buffer1 equal to Buffer2.
- @retval <0 Buffer1 is less than Buffer2.
- @retval >0 Buffer1 is greater than Buffer2.
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-StringNoCaseCompare (
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer1,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer2
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- if (mUnicodeCollation == NULL) {
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol(
- &gEfiUnicodeCollation2ProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- (VOID**)&mUnicodeCollation);
-
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR(Status);
- }
-
- return (mUnicodeCollation->StriColl(
- mUnicodeCollation,
- *(CHAR16**)Buffer1,
- *(CHAR16**)Buffer2));
-}
-
-
-/**
- Function to compare 2 strings.
-
- @param[in] Buffer1 Pointer to String to compare (CHAR16**).
- @param[in] Buffer2 Pointer to second String to compare (CHAR16**).
-
- @retval 0 Buffer1 equal to Buffer2.
- @retval <0 Buffer1 is less than Buffer2.
- @retval >0 Buffer1 is greater than Buffer2.
-**/
-INTN
-EFIAPI
-StringCompare (
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer1,
- IN CONST VOID *Buffer2
- )
-{
- return (StrCmp(
- *(CHAR16**)Buffer1,
- *(CHAR16**)Buffer2));
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 32c02b012f..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,47 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Library used for sorting routines.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2009 - 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved. <BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010006
- BASE_NAME = UefiSortLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = UefiSortLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 4264A823-45A3-42db-B92C-AA078555CBD3
- MODULE_TYPE = UEFI_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = SortLib|UEFI_APPLICATION UEFI_DRIVER UEFI_DRIVER DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_DRIVER
-
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
-#
-
-[Sources.common]
- UefiSortLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- MemoryAllocationLib
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DebugLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- DevicePathLib
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiUnicodeCollation2ProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
- gEfiDevicePathProtocolGuid ## CONSUMES
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 2163301c42..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/UefiSortLib/UefiSortLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/InternalVarCheckStructure.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/InternalVarCheckStructure.h deleted file mode 100644 index a9faed48d9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/InternalVarCheckStructure.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,82 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Internal structure for Var Check Hii.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _VAR_CHECK_STRUCTURE_H_
-#define _VAR_CHECK_STRUCTURE_H_
-
-//
-// Alignment for Hii Variable and Question header.
-//
-#define HEADER_ALIGNMENT 4
-#define HEADER_ALIGN(Header) (((UINTN) (Header) + HEADER_ALIGNMENT - 1) & (~(HEADER_ALIGNMENT - 1)))
-
-#pragma pack (1)
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_HII_REVISION 0x0001
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 Revision;
- UINT16 HeaderLength;
- UINT32 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Reserved;
- UINT16 Size;
- UINT32 Attributes;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
-//CHAR16 Name[];
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-//UINTx Data[]; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_CHECKBOX;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-//UINTx Minimum; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64;
-//UINTx Maximum; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 OpCode;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
- UINT8 MaxContainers;
-//UINTx Data[]; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST;
-
-#pragma pack ()
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHii.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHii.h deleted file mode 100644 index d770785490..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHii.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,63 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Include file for Var Check Hii handler and bin.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _VAR_CHECK_HII_H_
-#define _VAR_CHECK_HII_H_
-
-#include <Library/VarCheckLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-
-#include <Guid/ZeroGuid.h>
-
-#include <Protocol/HiiDatabase.h>
-#include <Protocol/FirmwareVolume2.h>
-#include <Protocol/FirmwareVolumeBlock.h>
-
-#include "InternalVarCheckStructure.h"
-#include "VarCheckHiiGen.h"
-
-//#define DUMP_VAR_CHECK_HII
-//#define DUMP_HII_DATA
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 HiiOpCode;
- CHAR8 *HiiOpCodeStr;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_OPCODE_STRING;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 PackageType;
- CHAR8 *PackageTypeStr;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_STRING;
-
-/**
- Dump Var Check HII.
-
- @param[in] VarCheckHiiBin Pointer to VarCheckHiiBin.
- @param[in] VarCheckHiiBinSize VarCheckHiiBin size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpVarCheckHii (
- IN VOID *VarCheckHiiBin,
- IN UINTN VarCheckHiiBinSize
- );
-
-extern VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *mVarCheckHiiBin;
-extern UINTN mVarCheckHiiBinSize;
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGen.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGen.c deleted file mode 100644 index cab92967aa..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGen.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1483 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Var Check Hii bin generation.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015 - 2016, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "VarCheckHiiGen.h"
-
-LIST_ENTRY mVarCheckHiiList = INITIALIZE_LIST_HEAD_VARIABLE (mVarCheckHiiList);
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('V', 'C', 'H', 'V')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINTN Signature;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *HiiVariable;
- EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId;
-
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER **HiiQuestionArray;
-} VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE;
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK(a) CR (a, VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE, Link, VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE_SIGNATURE)
-
-CHAR16 *mVarName = NULL;
-UINTN mMaxVarNameSize = 0;
-
-#ifdef DUMP_HII_DATA
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED VAR_CHECK_HII_OPCODE_STRING mIfrOpCodeStringTable[] = {
- {EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_OP, "EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_OP"},
- {EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP, "EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP"},
- {EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP, "EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP"},
- {EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP, "EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP"},
- {EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP, "EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP"},
- {EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP, "EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP"},
- {EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP, "EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP"},
-};
-
-/**
- Ifr opcode to string.
-
- @param[in] IfrOpCode Ifr OpCode.
-
- @return Pointer to string.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-IfrOpCodeToStr (
- IN UINT8 IfrOpCode
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mIfrOpCodeStringTable) / sizeof (mIfrOpCodeStringTable[0]); Index++) {
- if (mIfrOpCodeStringTable[Index].HiiOpCode == IfrOpCode) {
- return mIfrOpCodeStringTable[Index].HiiOpCodeStr;
- }
- }
-
- return "<UnknownIfrOpCode>";
-}
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED VAR_CHECK_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_STRING mPackageTypeStringTable[] = {
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_ALL, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_ALL"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_GUID, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_GUID"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_STRINGS, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_STRINGS"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FONTS, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FONTS"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_IMAGES, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_IMAGES"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_SIMPLE_FONTS, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_SIMPLE_FONTS"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_DEVICE_PATH, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_DEVICE_PATH"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_KEYBOARD_LAYOUT, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_KEYBOARD_LAYOUT"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_ANIMATIONS, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_ANIMATIONS"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_END, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_END"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_SYSTEM_BEGIN, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_SYSTEM_BEGIN"},
- {EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_SYSTEM_END, "EFI_HII_PACKAGE_TYPE_SYSTEM_END"},
-};
-
-/**
- Hii Package type to string.
-
- @param[in] PackageType Package Type
-
- @return Pointer to string.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-HiiPackageTypeToStr (
- IN UINT8 PackageType
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mPackageTypeStringTable) / sizeof (mPackageTypeStringTable[0]); Index++) {
- if (mPackageTypeStringTable[Index].PackageType == PackageType) {
- return mPackageTypeStringTable[Index].PackageTypeStr;
- }
- }
-
- return "<UnknownPackageType>";
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Hii Package.
-
- @param[in] HiiPackage Pointer to Hii Package.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpHiiPackage (
- IN VOID *HiiPackage
- )
-{
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *HiiPackageHeader;
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader;
- EFI_IFR_VARSTORE *IfrVarStore;
- EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *IfrEfiVarStore;
-
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) HiiPackage;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " HiiPackageHeader->Type - 0x%02x (%a)\n", HiiPackageHeader->Type, HiiPackageTypeToStr ((UINT8) HiiPackageHeader->Type)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " HiiPackageHeader->Length - 0x%06x\n", HiiPackageHeader->Length));
-
- switch (HiiPackageHeader->Type) {
- case EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS:
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) (HiiPackageHeader + 1);
-
- while ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader < ((UINTN) HiiPackageHeader + HiiPackageHeader->Length)) {
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_OP:
- IfrVarStore = (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode - 0x%02x (%a)\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode, IfrOpCodeToStr (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->Length - 0x%02x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope - 0x%02x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Guid - %g\n", &IfrVarStore->Guid));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VarStoreId - 0x%04x\n", IfrVarStore->VarStoreId));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Size - 0x%04x\n", IfrVarStore->Size));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Name - %a\n", IfrVarStore->Name));
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP:
- IfrEfiVarStore = (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- if (IfrEfiVarStore->Header.Length >= sizeof (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode - 0x%02x (%a)\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode, IfrOpCodeToStr (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->Length - 0x02%x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope - 0x02%x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Guid - %g\n", &IfrEfiVarStore->Guid));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VarStoreId - 0x%04x\n", IfrEfiVarStore->VarStoreId));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Size - 0x%04x\n", IfrEfiVarStore->Size));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Attributes - 0x%08x\n", IfrEfiVarStore->Attributes));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Name - %a\n", IfrEfiVarStore->Name));
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode - 0x%02x (%a)\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode, IfrOpCodeToStr (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->Length - 0x02%x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope - 0x02%x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Prompt - 0x%04x\n", ((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.Header.Prompt));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Help - 0x%04x\n", ((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.Header.Help));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " QuestionId - 0x%04x\n", ((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.QuestionId));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VarStoreId - 0x%04x\n", ((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.VarStoreId));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VarStoreInfo - 0x%04x\n", ((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF * )IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset));
- {
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *IfrOneOf;
- EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX *IfrCheckBox;
- EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *IfrNumeric;
- EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST *IfrOrderedList;
-
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- IfrOneOf = (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Flags - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOf->Flags));
- switch (IfrOneOf->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE) {
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_1:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u8.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u8.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u8.Step));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_2:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%04x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u16.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%04x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u16.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%04x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u16.Step));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_4:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%08x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u32.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%08x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u32.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%08x\n", IfrOneOf->data.u32.Step));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%016lx\n", IfrOneOf->data.u64.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%016lx\n", IfrOneOf->data.u64.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%016lx\n", IfrOneOf->data.u64.Step));
- break;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- IfrCheckBox = (EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Flags - 0x%02x\n", IfrCheckBox->Flags));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- IfrNumeric = (EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Flags - 0x%02x\n", IfrNumeric->Flags));
- switch (IfrNumeric->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE) {
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_1:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%02x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u8.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%02x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u8.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%02x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u8.Step));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_2:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%04x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u16.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%04x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u16.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%04x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u16.Step));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_4:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%08x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u32.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%08x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u32.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%08x\n", IfrNumeric->data.u32.Step));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE_8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MinValue - 0x%016lx\n", IfrNumeric->data.u64.MinValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxValue - 0x%016lx\n", IfrNumeric->data.u64.MaxValue));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Step - 0x%016lx\n", IfrNumeric->data.u64.Step));
- break;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- IfrOrderedList = (EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxContainers - 0x%02x\n", IfrOrderedList->MaxContainers));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Flags - 0x%02x\n", IfrOrderedList->Flags));
- break;
- default:
- break;
- }
-
- if (IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope != 0) {
- UINTN Scope;
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION *IfrOneOfOption;
-
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- Scope = 1;
- while (Scope != 0) {
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP:
- IfrOneOfOption = (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION *)IfrOpCodeHeader;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode - 0x%02x (%a)\n", (UINTN)IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode, IfrOpCodeToStr (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope - 0x%02x\n", IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Option - 0x%04x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Option));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Flags - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Flags));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Type - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Type));
- switch (IfrOneOfOption->Type) {
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_8:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Value - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Value.u8));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_16:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Value - 0x%04x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Value.u16));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_32:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Value - 0x%08x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Value.u32));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_64:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Value - 0x%016lx\n", IfrOneOfOption->Value.u64));
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_BOOLEAN:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "!!!! Value - 0x%02x\n", IfrOneOfOption->Value.b));
- break;
- default:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- if (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode == EFI_IFR_END_OP) {
- ASSERT (Scope > 0);
- Scope--;
- if (Scope == 0) {
- break;
- }
- } else if (IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope != 0) {
- Scope++;
- }
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- }
- }
- }
- default:
- break;
- }
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- }
- break;
- default:
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Hii Database.
-
- @param[in] HiiDatabase Pointer to Hii Database.
- @param[in] HiiDatabaseSize Hii Database size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpHiiDatabase (
- IN VOID *HiiDatabase,
- IN UINTN HiiDatabaseSize
- )
-{
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageListHeader;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *HiiPackageHeader;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "HiiDatabaseSize - 0x%x\n", HiiDatabaseSize));
- HiiPackageListHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *) HiiDatabase;
-
- while ((UINTN) HiiPackageListHeader < ((UINTN) HiiDatabase + HiiDatabaseSize)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "HiiPackageListHeader->PackageListGuid - %g\n", &HiiPackageListHeader->PackageListGuid));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "HiiPackageListHeader->PackageLength - 0x%x\n", (UINTN)HiiPackageListHeader->PackageLength));
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *)(HiiPackageListHeader + 1);
-
- while ((UINTN) HiiPackageHeader < (UINTN) HiiPackageListHeader + HiiPackageListHeader->PackageLength) {
-
- DumpHiiPackage (HiiPackageHeader);
-
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) ((UINTN) HiiPackageHeader + HiiPackageHeader->Length);
- }
-
- HiiPackageListHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *) ((UINTN) HiiPackageListHeader + HiiPackageListHeader->PackageLength);
- }
-
- return ;
-}
-#endif
-
-/**
- Allocates a buffer of a certain pool type.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of a certain pool type and returns a
- pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is
- returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param MemoryType The type of memory to allocate.
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalVarCheckAllocatePool (
- IN EFI_MEMORY_TYPE MemoryType,
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VOID *Memory;
-
- Status = gBS->AllocatePool (MemoryType, AllocationSize, &Memory);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Memory = NULL;
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiBootServicesData, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- )
-{
- VOID *Memory;
-
- Memory = InternalVarCheckAllocatePool (EfiBootServicesData, AllocationSize);
- if (Memory != NULL) {
- Memory = ZeroMem (Memory, AllocationSize);
- }
- return Memory;
-}
-
-/**
- Frees a buffer that was previously allocated with one of the pool allocation functions in the
- Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer must have been allocated on a previous call to the
- pool allocation services of the Memory Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free pool
- resources, then this function will perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with a pool allocation function in the Memory Allocation Library,
- then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer The pointer to the buffer to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckFreePool (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- Status = gBS->FreePool (Buffer);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-}
-
-/**
- Reallocates a buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates and zeros the number bytes specified by NewSize from memory of type
- EfiBootServicesData. If OldBuffer is not NULL, then the smaller of OldSize and
- NewSize bytes are copied from OldBuffer to the newly allocated buffer, and
- OldBuffer is freed. A pointer to the newly allocated buffer is returned.
- If NewSize is 0, then a valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not
- enough memory remaining to satisfy the request, then NULL is returned.
-
- If the allocation of the new buffer is successful and the smaller of NewSize and OldSize
- is greater than (MAX_ADDRESS - OldBuffer + 1), then ASSERT().
-
- @param OldSize The size, in bytes, of OldBuffer.
- @param NewSize The size, in bytes, of the buffer to reallocate.
- @param OldBuffer The buffer to copy to the allocated buffer. This is an optional
- parameter that may be NULL.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalVarCheckReallocatePool (
- IN UINTN OldSize,
- IN UINTN NewSize,
- IN VOID *OldBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- VOID *NewBuffer;
-
- NewBuffer = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (NewSize);
- if (NewBuffer != NULL && OldBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (NewBuffer, OldBuffer, MIN (OldSize, NewSize));
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (OldBuffer);
- }
- return NewBuffer;
-}
-
-/**
- Merge Hii Question.
-
- @param[in, out] HiiVariableNode Pointer to Hii Variable node.
- @param[in] HiiQuestion Pointer to Hii Question.
- @param[in] FromFv Hii Question from FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-MergeHiiQuestion (
- IN OUT VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode,
- IN VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion,
- IN BOOLEAN FromFv
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion1;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion2;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *NewHiiQuestion;
- UINT8 NewLength;
- UINT64 Minimum1;
- UINT64 Maximum1;
- UINT64 OneValue1;
- UINT64 Minimum2;
- UINT64 Maximum2;
- UINT64 OneValue2;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
- UINT8 *Ptr1;
- UINT8 *Ptr2;
-
- //
- // Hii Question from Hii Database has high priority.
- // Do not to merge Hii Question from Fv to Hii Question from Hii Database.
- //
- if (FromFv) {
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiQuestion);
- return;
- }
-
- HiiQuestion1 = HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[HiiQuestion->VarOffset];
- HiiQuestion2 = HiiQuestion;
-
- ASSERT ((HiiQuestion1->OpCode == HiiQuestion2->OpCode) && (HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth == HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth));
-
- switch (HiiQuestion1->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "MergeHiiQuestion - EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP VarOffset = 0x%04x\n", HiiQuestion1->VarOffset));
- //
- // Get the length of Hii Question 1.
- //
- NewLength = HiiQuestion1->Length;
-
- //
- // Check if the one of options in Hii Question 2 have been in Hii Question 1.
- //
- Ptr2 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *) HiiQuestion2 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr2 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion2 + HiiQuestion2->Length) {
- OneValue2 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue2, Ptr2, HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth);
-
- Ptr1 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *) HiiQuestion1 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr1 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length) {
- OneValue1 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue1, Ptr1, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- if (OneValue2 == OneValue1) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr1 += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr1 >= ((UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- NewLength = (UINT8) (NewLength + HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- }
- Ptr2 += HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth;
- }
-
- if (NewLength > HiiQuestion1->Length) {
- //
- // Merge the one of options of Hii Question 2 and Hii Question 1.
- //
- NewHiiQuestion = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (NewLength);
- ASSERT (NewHiiQuestion != NULL);
- CopyMem (NewHiiQuestion, HiiQuestion1, HiiQuestion1->Length);
- //
- // Use the new length.
- //
- NewHiiQuestion->Length = NewLength;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) NewHiiQuestion + HiiQuestion1->Length;
-
- Ptr2 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *) HiiQuestion2 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr2 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion2 + HiiQuestion2->Length) {
- OneValue2 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue2, Ptr2, HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth);
-
- Ptr1 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *) HiiQuestion1 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr1 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length) {
- OneValue1 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue1, Ptr1, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- if (OneValue2 == OneValue1) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr1 += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr1 >= ((UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- CopyMem (Ptr, &OneValue2, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- }
- Ptr2 += HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth;
- }
-
- HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[HiiQuestion1->VarOffset] = NewHiiQuestion;
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiQuestion1);
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "MergeHiiQuestion - EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP VarOffset = 0x%04x\n", HiiQuestion1->VarOffset));
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "MergeHiiQuestion - EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP VarOffset = 0x%04x\n", HiiQuestion1->VarOffset));
- //
- // Get minimum and maximum of Hii Question 1.
- //
- Minimum1 = 0;
- Maximum1 = 0;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC *) HiiQuestion1 + 1);
- CopyMem (&Minimum1, Ptr, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- CopyMem (&Maximum1, Ptr, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
-
- //
- // Get minimum and maximum of Hii Question 2.
- //
- Minimum2 = 0;
- Maximum2 = 0;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC *) HiiQuestion2 + 1);
- CopyMem (&Minimum2, Ptr, HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth;
- CopyMem (&Maximum2, Ptr, HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth);
-
- //
- // Update minimum.
- //
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC *) HiiQuestion1 + 1);
- if (Minimum2 < Minimum1) {
- Minimum1 = Minimum2;
- CopyMem (Ptr, &Minimum1, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- }
- //
- // Update maximum.
- //
- Ptr += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- if (Maximum2 > Maximum1) {
- Maximum1 = Maximum2;
- CopyMem (Ptr, &Maximum1, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "MergeHiiQuestion - EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP VarOffset = 0x%04x\n", HiiQuestion1->VarOffset));
- //
- // Get the length of Hii Question 1.
- //
- NewLength = HiiQuestion1->Length;
-
- //
- // Check if the one of options in Hii Question 2 have been in Hii Question 1.
- //
- Ptr2 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion2 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr2 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion2 + HiiQuestion2->Length) {
- OneValue2 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue2, Ptr2, HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth);
-
- Ptr1 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion1 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr1 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length) {
- OneValue1 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue1, Ptr1, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- if (OneValue2 == OneValue1) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr1 += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr1 >= ((UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- NewLength = (UINT8) (NewLength + HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- }
- Ptr2 += HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth;
- }
-
- if (NewLength > HiiQuestion1->Length) {
- //
- // Merge the one of options of Hii Question 2 and Hii Question 1.
- //
- NewHiiQuestion = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (NewLength);
- ASSERT (NewHiiQuestion != NULL);
- CopyMem (NewHiiQuestion, HiiQuestion1, HiiQuestion1->Length);
- //
- // Use the new length.
- //
- NewHiiQuestion->Length = NewLength;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) NewHiiQuestion + HiiQuestion1->Length;
-
- Ptr2 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion2 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr2 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion2 + HiiQuestion2->Length) {
- OneValue2 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue2, Ptr2, HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth);
-
- Ptr1 = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion1 + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr1 < (UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length) {
- OneValue1 = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue1, Ptr1, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- if (OneValue2 == OneValue1) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr1 += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr1 >= ((UINTN) HiiQuestion1 + HiiQuestion1->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- CopyMem (Ptr, &OneValue2, HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion1->StorageWidth;
- }
- Ptr2 += HiiQuestion2->StorageWidth;
- }
-
- HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[HiiQuestion1->VarOffset] = NewHiiQuestion;
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiQuestion1);
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return;
- break;
- }
-
- //
- //
- // Hii Question 2 has been merged with Hii Question 1.
- //
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiQuestion2);
-}
-
-/**
- Get OneOf option data.
-
- @param[in] IfrOpCodeHeader Pointer to Ifr OpCode header.
- @param[out] Count Pointer to option count.
- @param[out] Width Pointer to option width.
- @param[out] OptionBuffer Pointer to option buffer.
-
-**/
-VOID
-GetOneOfOption (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader,
- OUT UINTN *Count,
- OUT UINT8 *Width,
- OUT VOID *OptionBuffer OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- UINTN Scope;
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION *IfrOneOfOption;
-
- //
- // Assume all OPTION has same Width.
- //
- *Count = 0;
-
- if (IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope != 0) {
- //
- // Nested OpCode.
- //
- Scope = 1;
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- while (Scope != 0) {
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION_OP:
- IfrOneOfOption = (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OPTION *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- switch (IfrOneOfOption->Type) {
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_8:
- *Count = *Count + 1;
- *Width = sizeof (UINT8);
- if (OptionBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (OptionBuffer, &IfrOneOfOption->Value.u8, sizeof (UINT8));
- OptionBuffer = (UINT8 *) OptionBuffer + 1;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_16:
- *Count = *Count + 1;
- *Width = sizeof (UINT16);
- if (OptionBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (OptionBuffer, &IfrOneOfOption->Value.u16, sizeof (UINT16));
- OptionBuffer = (UINT16 *) OptionBuffer + 1;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_32:
- *Count = *Count + 1;
- *Width = sizeof (UINT32);
- if (OptionBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (OptionBuffer, &IfrOneOfOption->Value.u32, sizeof (UINT32));
- OptionBuffer = (UINT32 *) OptionBuffer + 1;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_NUM_SIZE_64:
- *Count = *Count + 1;
- *Width = sizeof (UINT64);
- if (OptionBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (OptionBuffer, &IfrOneOfOption->Value.u64, sizeof (UINT64));
- OptionBuffer = (UINT64 *) OptionBuffer + 1;
- }
- break;
- case EFI_IFR_TYPE_BOOLEAN:
- *Count = *Count + 1;
- *Width = sizeof (BOOLEAN);
- if (OptionBuffer != NULL) {
- CopyMem (OptionBuffer, &IfrOneOfOption->Value.b, sizeof (BOOLEAN));
- OptionBuffer = (BOOLEAN *) OptionBuffer + 1;
- }
- break;
- default:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- //
- // Until End OpCode.
- //
- if (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode == EFI_IFR_END_OP) {
- ASSERT (Scope > 0);
- Scope--;
- if (Scope == 0) {
- break;
- }
- } else if (IfrOpCodeHeader->Scope != 0) {
- //
- // Nested OpCode.
- //
- Scope++;
- }
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- }
- }
-
- return ;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse Hii Question Oneof.
-
- @param[in] IfrOpCodeHeader Pointer to Ifr OpCode header.
-
- return Pointer to Hii Question.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *
-ParseHiiQuestionOneOf (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *IfrOneOf;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *OneOf;
- UINTN Length;
- UINT8 Width;
- UINTN OptionCount;
- UINT8 OptionWidth;
-
- IfrOneOf = (EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
-
- Width = (UINT8) (1 << (IfrOneOf->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE));
-
- GetOneOfOption (IfrOpCodeHeader, &OptionCount, &OptionWidth, NULL);
- ASSERT (Width == OptionWidth);
-
- Length = sizeof (*OneOf) + OptionCount * Width;
-
- OneOf = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (Length);
- ASSERT (OneOf != NULL);
- OneOf->OpCode = EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP;
- OneOf->Length = (UINT8) Length;
- OneOf->VarOffset = IfrOneOf->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- OneOf->StorageWidth = Width;
-
- GetOneOfOption (IfrOpCodeHeader, &OptionCount, &OptionWidth, OneOf + 1);
-
- return (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) OneOf;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse Hii Question CheckBox.
-
- @param[in] IfrOpCodeHeader Pointer to Ifr OpCode header.
-
- return Pointer to Hii Question.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *
-ParseHiiQuestionCheckBox (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX *IfrCheckBox;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_CHECKBOX *CheckBox;
-
- IfrCheckBox = (EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
-
- CheckBox = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (sizeof (*CheckBox));
- ASSERT (CheckBox != NULL);
- CheckBox->OpCode = EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP;
- CheckBox->Length = (UINT8) sizeof (*CheckBox);;
- CheckBox->VarOffset = IfrCheckBox->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- CheckBox->StorageWidth = (UINT8) sizeof (BOOLEAN);
-
- return (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) CheckBox;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse Hii Question Numeric.
-
- @param[in] IfrOpCodeHeader Pointer to Ifr OpCode header.
-
- return Pointer to Hii Question.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *
-ParseHiiQuestionNumeric (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *IfrNumeric;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC *Numeric;
- UINT8 Width;
-
- IfrNumeric = (EFI_IFR_NUMERIC *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
-
- Numeric = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (sizeof (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC) + 2 * sizeof (UINT64));
- ASSERT (Numeric != NULL);
-
- Width = (UINT8) (1 << (IfrNumeric->Flags & EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_SIZE));
-
- Numeric->OpCode = EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP;
- Numeric->Length = (UINT8) (sizeof (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC) + 2 * Width);
- Numeric->VarOffset = IfrNumeric->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- Numeric->StorageWidth = Width;
-
- CopyMem (Numeric + 1, &IfrNumeric->data, Width * 2);
-
- return (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) Numeric;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse Hii Question OrderedList.
-
- @param[in] IfrOpCodeHeader Pointer to Ifr OpCode header.
-
- return Pointer to Hii Question.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *
-ParseHiiQuestionOrderedList (
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader
- )
-{
- EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST *IfrOrderedList;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *OrderedList;
- UINTN Length;
- UINTN OptionCount;
- UINT8 OptionWidth;
-
- IfrOrderedList = (EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
-
- GetOneOfOption (IfrOpCodeHeader, &OptionCount, &OptionWidth, NULL);
-
- Length = sizeof (*OrderedList) + OptionCount * OptionWidth;
-
- OrderedList = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (Length);
- ASSERT (OrderedList != NULL);
- OrderedList->OpCode = EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP;
- OrderedList->Length = (UINT8) Length;
- OrderedList->VarOffset = IfrOrderedList->Question.VarStoreInfo.VarOffset;
- OrderedList->StorageWidth = OptionWidth;
- OrderedList->MaxContainers = IfrOrderedList->MaxContainers;
-
- GetOneOfOption (IfrOpCodeHeader, &OptionCount, &OptionWidth, OrderedList + 1);
-
- return (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) OrderedList;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse and create Hii Question node.
-
- @param[in] HiiVariableNode Pointer to Hii Variable node.
- @param[in] IfrOpCodeHeader Pointer to Ifr OpCode header.
- @param[in] FromFv Hii Question from FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-ParseHiiQuestion (
- IN VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode,
- IN EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader,
- IN BOOLEAN FromFv
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion;
-
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- HiiQuestion = ParseHiiQuestionOneOf (IfrOpCodeHeader);
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- HiiQuestion = ParseHiiQuestionCheckBox (IfrOpCodeHeader);
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- HiiQuestion = ParseHiiQuestionNumeric (IfrOpCodeHeader);
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- HiiQuestion = ParseHiiQuestionOrderedList (IfrOpCodeHeader);
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- return;
- break;
- }
-
- if (HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[HiiQuestion->VarOffset] != NULL) {
- MergeHiiQuestion (HiiVariableNode, HiiQuestion, FromFv);
- } else {
- HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[HiiQuestion->VarOffset] = HiiQuestion;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Find Hii variable node by name and GUID.
-
- @param[in] Name Pointer to variable name.
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to vendor GUID.
-
- @return Pointer to Hii Variable node.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *
-FindHiiVariableNode (
- IN CHAR16 *Name,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
-
- for (Link = mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink
- ;Link != &mVarCheckHiiList
- ;Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- HiiVariableNode = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
-
- if ((StrCmp (Name, (CHAR16 *) (HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable + 1)) == 0) &&
- CompareGuid (Guid, &HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->Guid)) {
- return HiiVariableNode;
- }
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Find Hii variable node by var store id.
-
- @param[in] VarStoreId Var store id.
-
- @return Pointer to Hii Variable node.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *
-FindHiiVariableNodeByVarStoreId (
- IN EFI_VARSTORE_ID VarStoreId
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
-
- if (VarStoreId == 0) {
- //
- // The variable store identifier, which is unique within the current form set.
- // A value of zero is invalid.
- //
- return NULL;
- }
-
- for (Link = mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink
- ;Link != &mVarCheckHiiList
- ;Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- HiiVariableNode = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
- //
- // The variable store identifier, which is unique within the current form set.
- //
- if (VarStoreId == HiiVariableNode->VarStoreId) {
- return HiiVariableNode;
- }
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Destroy var store id in the Hii Variable node after parsing one Hii Package.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DestroyVarStoreId (
- VOID
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *Link;
-
- for (Link = mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink
- ;Link != &mVarCheckHiiList
- ;Link = Link->ForwardLink) {
- HiiVariableNode = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (Link);
- //
- // The variable store identifier, which is unique within the current form set.
- // A value of zero is invalid.
- //
- HiiVariableNode->VarStoreId = 0;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Create Hii Variable node.
-
- @param[in] IfrEfiVarStore Pointer to EFI VARSTORE.
-
-**/
-VOID
-CreateHiiVariableNode (
- IN EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *IfrEfiVarStore
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *HiiVariable;
- UINTN HeaderLength;
- CHAR16 *VarName;
- UINTN VarNameSize;
-
- //
- // Get variable name.
- //
- VarNameSize = AsciiStrSize ((CHAR8 *) IfrEfiVarStore->Name) * sizeof (CHAR16);
- if (VarNameSize > mMaxVarNameSize) {
- mVarName = InternalVarCheckReallocatePool (mMaxVarNameSize, VarNameSize, mVarName);
- ASSERT (mVarName != NULL);
- mMaxVarNameSize = VarNameSize;
- }
- AsciiStrToUnicodeStrS ((CHAR8 *) IfrEfiVarStore->Name, mVarName, mMaxVarNameSize / sizeof (CHAR16));
- VarName = mVarName;
-
- HiiVariableNode = FindHiiVariableNode (
- VarName,
- &IfrEfiVarStore->Guid
- );
- if (HiiVariableNode == NULL) {
- //
- // Not found, then create new.
- //
- HeaderLength = sizeof (*HiiVariable) + VarNameSize;
- HiiVariable = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (HeaderLength);
- ASSERT (HiiVariable != NULL);
- HiiVariable->Revision = VAR_CHECK_HII_REVISION;
- HiiVariable->OpCode = EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP;
- HiiVariable->HeaderLength = (UINT16) HeaderLength;
- HiiVariable->Size = IfrEfiVarStore->Size;
- HiiVariable->Attributes = IfrEfiVarStore->Attributes;
- CopyGuid (&HiiVariable->Guid, &IfrEfiVarStore->Guid);
- StrCpyS ((CHAR16 *) (HiiVariable + 1), VarNameSize / sizeof (CHAR16), VarName);
-
- HiiVariableNode = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (sizeof (*HiiVariableNode));
- ASSERT (HiiVariableNode != NULL);
- HiiVariableNode->Signature = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE_SIGNATURE;
- HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable = HiiVariable;
- //
- // The variable store identifier, which is unique within the current form set.
- //
- HiiVariableNode->VarStoreId = IfrEfiVarStore->VarStoreId;
- HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (IfrEfiVarStore->Size * sizeof (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *));
-
- InsertTailList (&mVarCheckHiiList, &HiiVariableNode->Link);
- } else {
- HiiVariableNode->VarStoreId = IfrEfiVarStore->VarStoreId;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Parse and create Hii Variable node list.
-
- @param[in] HiiPackage Pointer to Hii Package.
-
-**/
-VOID
-ParseHiiVariable (
- IN VOID *HiiPackage
- )
-{
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *HiiPackageHeader;
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader;
- EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *IfrEfiVarStore;
-
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) HiiPackage;
-
- switch (HiiPackageHeader->Type) {
- case EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS:
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) (HiiPackageHeader + 1);
-
- while ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader < (UINTN) HiiPackageHeader + HiiPackageHeader->Length) {
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP:
- //
- // Come to EFI VARSTORE in Form Package.
- //
- IfrEfiVarStore = (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI *) IfrOpCodeHeader;
- if ((IfrEfiVarStore->Header.Length >= sizeof (EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI)) &&
- ((IfrEfiVarStore->Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_NON_VOLATILE) != 0)) {
- //
- // Only create node list for Hii Variable with NV attribute.
- //
- CreateHiiVariableNode (IfrEfiVarStore);
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Var Check Parse Hii Package.
-
- @param[in] HiiPackage Pointer to Hii Package.
- @param[in] FromFv Hii Package from FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckParseHiiPackage (
- IN VOID *HiiPackage,
- IN BOOLEAN FromFv
- )
-{
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *HiiPackageHeader;
- EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *IfrOpCodeHeader;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
-
- //
- // Parse and create Hii Variable node list for this Hii Package.
- //
- ParseHiiVariable (HiiPackage);
-
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) HiiPackage;
-
- switch (HiiPackageHeader->Type) {
- case EFI_HII_PACKAGE_FORMS:
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) (HiiPackageHeader + 1);
-
- while ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader < (UINTN) HiiPackageHeader + HiiPackageHeader->Length) {
- switch (IfrOpCodeHeader->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- HiiVariableNode = FindHiiVariableNodeByVarStoreId (((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.VarStoreId);
- if ((HiiVariableNode == NULL) ||
- //
- // No related Hii Variable node found.
- //
- ((((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.Header.Prompt == 0) && (((EFI_IFR_ONE_OF *) IfrOpCodeHeader)->Question.Header.Help == 0))) {
- //
- // meanless IFR item introduced by ECP.
- //
- } else {
- //
- // Normal IFR
- //
- ParseHiiQuestion (HiiVariableNode, IfrOpCodeHeader, FromFv);
- }
- default:
- break;
- }
- IfrOpCodeHeader = (EFI_IFR_OP_HEADER *) ((UINTN) IfrOpCodeHeader + IfrOpCodeHeader->Length);
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- DestroyVarStoreId ();
-}
-
-/**
- Var Check Parse Hii Database.
-
- @param[in] HiiDatabase Pointer to Hii Database.
- @param[in] HiiDatabaseSize Hii Database size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckParseHiiDatabase (
- IN VOID *HiiDatabase,
- IN UINTN HiiDatabaseSize
- )
-{
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *HiiPackageListHeader;
- EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *HiiPackageHeader;
-
- HiiPackageListHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *) HiiDatabase;
-
- while ((UINTN) HiiPackageListHeader < ((UINTN) HiiDatabase + HiiDatabaseSize)) {
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) (HiiPackageListHeader + 1);
-
- while ((UINTN) HiiPackageHeader < ((UINTN) HiiPackageListHeader + HiiPackageListHeader->PackageLength)) {
- //
- // Parse Hii Pacakge.
- //
- VarCheckParseHiiPackage (HiiPackageHeader, FALSE);
-
- HiiPackageHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_HEADER *) ((UINTN) HiiPackageHeader + HiiPackageHeader->Length);
- }
-
- HiiPackageListHeader = (EFI_HII_PACKAGE_LIST_HEADER *) ((UINTN) HiiPackageListHeader + HiiPackageListHeader->PackageLength);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Destroy Hii Variable node.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DestroyHiiVariableNode (
- VOID
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *HiiVariableLink;
- UINTN Index;
-
- while (mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink != &mVarCheckHiiList) {
- HiiVariableLink = mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink;
- HiiVariableNode = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (HiiVariableLink);
-
- RemoveEntryList (&HiiVariableNode->Link);
-
- //
- // Free the allocated buffer.
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->Size; Index++) {
- if (HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index] != NULL) {
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index]);
- }
- }
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray);
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable);
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (HiiVariableNode);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Build VarCheckHiiBin.
-
- @param[out] Size Pointer to VarCheckHii size.
-
- @return Pointer to VarCheckHiiBin.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-BuildVarCheckHiiBin (
- OUT UINTN *Size
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_NODE *HiiVariableNode;
- LIST_ENTRY *HiiVariableLink;
- UINTN Index;
- VOID *Data;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
- UINT32 BinSize;
- UINT32 HiiVariableLength;
-
- //
- // Get Size
- //
- BinSize = 0;
-
- for (HiiVariableLink = mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink
- ;HiiVariableLink != &mVarCheckHiiList
- ;HiiVariableLink = HiiVariableLink->ForwardLink) {
- //
- // For Hii Variable header align.
- //
- BinSize = (UINT32) HEADER_ALIGN (BinSize);
-
- HiiVariableNode = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (HiiVariableLink);
- HiiVariableLength = HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->HeaderLength;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->Size; Index++) {
- if (HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index] != NULL) {
- //
- // For Hii Question header align.
- //
- HiiVariableLength = (UINT32) HEADER_ALIGN (HiiVariableLength);
- HiiVariableLength += HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index]->Length;
- }
- }
-
- HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->Length = HiiVariableLength;
- BinSize += HiiVariableLength;
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiBin - size = 0x%x\n", BinSize));
- if (BinSize == 0) {
- *Size = BinSize;
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // AllocatePages () and AllocatePool () from gBS are used for the process of VarCheckHiiBin generation.
- // Only here AllocateRuntimeZeroPool () from MemoryAllocateLib is used for runtime access
- // in SetVariable check handler.
- //
- Data = AllocateRuntimeZeroPool (BinSize);
- ASSERT (Data != NULL);
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiBin - built at 0x%x\n", Data));
-
- //
- // Gen Data
- //
- Ptr = Data;
- for (HiiVariableLink = mVarCheckHiiList.ForwardLink
- ;HiiVariableLink != &mVarCheckHiiList
- ;HiiVariableLink = HiiVariableLink->ForwardLink) {
- //
- // For Hii Variable header align.
- //
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) HEADER_ALIGN (Ptr);
-
- HiiVariableNode = VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_FROM_LINK (HiiVariableLink);
- CopyMem (Ptr, HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable, HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->HeaderLength);
- Ptr += HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->HeaderLength;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < HiiVariableNode->HiiVariable->Size; Index++) {
- if (HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index] != NULL) {
- //
- // For Hii Question header align.
- //
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) HEADER_ALIGN (Ptr);
- CopyMem (Ptr, HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index], HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index]->Length);
- Ptr += HiiVariableNode->HiiQuestionArray[Index]->Length;
- }
- }
- }
-
- *Size = BinSize;
- return Data;
-}
-
-/**
- Generate VarCheckHiiBin from Hii Database and FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckHiiGen (
- VOID
- )
-{
- VarCheckHiiGenFromHiiDatabase ();
- VarCheckHiiGenFromFv ();
-
- mVarCheckHiiBin = BuildVarCheckHiiBin (&mVarCheckHiiBinSize);
- if (mVarCheckHiiBin == NULL) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[VarCheckHii] This driver could be removed from *.dsc and *.fdf\n"));
- return;
- }
-
- DestroyHiiVariableNode ();
- if (mVarName != NULL) {
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (mVarName);
- }
-
-#ifdef DUMP_VAR_CHECK_HII
- DEBUG_CODE (
- DumpVarCheckHii (mVarCheckHiiBin, mVarCheckHiiBinSize);
- );
-#endif
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGen.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGen.h deleted file mode 100644 index f81be2ea88..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGen.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,136 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Include file for Var Check Hii bin generation.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _VAR_CHECK_HII_GEN_H_
-#define _VAR_CHECK_HII_GEN_H_
-
-#include "VarCheckHii.h"
-
-/**
- Dump Hii Package.
-
- @param[in] HiiPackage Pointer to Hii Package.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpHiiPackage (
- IN VOID *HiiPackage
- );
-
-/**
- Dump Hii Database.
-
- @param[in] HiiDatabase Pointer to Hii Database.
- @param[in] HiiDatabaseSize Hii Database size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpHiiDatabase (
- IN VOID *HiiDatabase,
- IN UINTN HiiDatabaseSize
- );
-
-/**
- Allocates and zeros a buffer of type EfiBootServicesData.
-
- Allocates the number bytes specified by AllocationSize of type EfiBootServicesData, clears the
- buffer with zeros, and returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. If AllocationSize is 0, then a
- valid buffer of 0 size is returned. If there is not enough memory remaining to satisfy the
- request, then NULL is returned.
-
- @param AllocationSize The number of bytes to allocate and zero.
-
- @return A pointer to the allocated buffer or NULL if allocation fails.
-
-**/
-VOID *
-InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (
- IN UINTN AllocationSize
- );
-
-/**
- Frees a buffer that was previously allocated with one of the pool allocation functions in the
- Memory Allocation Library.
-
- Frees the buffer specified by Buffer. Buffer must have been allocated on a previous call to the
- pool allocation services of the Memory Allocation Library. If it is not possible to free pool
- resources, then this function will perform no actions.
-
- If Buffer was not allocated with a pool allocation function in the Memory Allocation Library,
- then ASSERT().
-
- @param Buffer The pointer to the buffer to free.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckFreePool (
- IN VOID *Buffer
- );
-
-/**
- Var Check Parse Hii Package.
-
- @param[in] HiiPackage Pointer to Hii Package.
- @param[in] FromFv Hii Package from FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckParseHiiPackage (
- IN VOID *HiiPackage,
- IN BOOLEAN FromFv
- );
-
-/**
- Var Check Parse Hii Database.
-
- @param[in] HiiDatabase Pointer to Hii Database.
- @param[in] HiiDatabaseSize Hii Database size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckParseHiiDatabase (
- IN VOID *HiiDatabase,
- IN UINTN HiiDatabaseSize
- );
-
-/**
- Generate from FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckHiiGenFromFv (
- VOID
- );
-
-/**
- Generate from Hii Database.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckHiiGenFromHiiDatabase (
- VOID
- );
-
-/**
- Generate VarCheckHiiBin from Hii Database and FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckHiiGen (
- VOID
- );
-
-#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGenFromFv.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGenFromFv.c deleted file mode 100644 index 21fc80e89c..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGenFromFv.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,443 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Var Check Hii generation from FV.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "VarCheckHiiGen.h"
-
-// {d0bc7cb4-6a47-495f-aa11-710746da06a2}
-#define EFI_VFR_ATTRACT_GUID \
-{ 0xd0bc7cb4, 0x6a47, 0x495f, { 0xaa, 0x11, 0x71, 0x7, 0x46, 0xda, 0x6, 0xa2 } }
-
-EFI_GUID gVfrArrayAttractGuid = EFI_VFR_ATTRACT_GUID;
-
-#define ALL_FF_GUID \
-{ 0xFFFFFFFF, 0xFFFF, 0xFFFF, { 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF } }
-
-EFI_GUID mAllFfGuid = ALL_FF_GUID;
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO_SIGNATURE SIGNATURE_32 ('V', 'D', 'R', 'I')
-
-typedef struct {
- UINTN Signature;
- LIST_ENTRY Link;
- EFI_GUID *DriverGuid;
-} VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO;
-
-LIST_ENTRY mVfrDriverList = INITIALIZE_LIST_HEAD_VARIABLE (mVfrDriverList);
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO_FROM_LINK(a) CR (a, VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO, Link, VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO_SIGNATURE)
-
-#define MAX_MATCH_GUID_NUM 100
-
-/**
- Get the address by Guid.
-
- Parse the FFS and find the GUID address.
- There may be multiple Guids matching the searched Guid.
-
- @param Ffs Pointer to the FFS.
- @param Guid Guid to find.
- @param Length The length of FFS.
- @param Offset Pointer to pointer to the offset.
- @param NumOfMatchingGuid The number of matching Guid.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS One or multiple Guids matching the searched Guid.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No Guid matching the searched Guid.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-GetAddressByGuid (
- IN VOID *Ffs,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid,
- IN UINTN Length,
- OUT UINTN **Offset,
- OUT UINT8 *NumOfMatchingGuid
- )
-{
- UINTN LoopControl;
- BOOLEAN Found;
-
- if((Ffs == NULL) || (Guid == NULL) || (Length == 0)){
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
-
- if (NumOfMatchingGuid != NULL) {
- *NumOfMatchingGuid = 0;
- }
-
- Found = FALSE;
- for (LoopControl = 0; LoopControl < Length; LoopControl++) {
- if (CompareGuid (Guid, (EFI_GUID *) ((UINT8 *) Ffs + LoopControl))) {
- Found = TRUE;
- //
- // If NumOfMatchGuid or Offset are NULL, means user only want
- // to check whether current FFS includes this Guid or not.
- //
- if ((NumOfMatchingGuid != NULL) && (Offset != NULL)) {
- if (*NumOfMatchingGuid == 0) {
- *Offset = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (sizeof (UINTN) * MAX_MATCH_GUID_NUM);
- ASSERT (*Offset != NULL);
- }
- *(*Offset + *NumOfMatchingGuid) = LoopControl + sizeof (EFI_GUID);
- (*NumOfMatchingGuid)++;
- } else {
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-
- return (Found ? EFI_SUCCESS : EFI_NOT_FOUND);
-}
-
-/**
- Search the VfrBin Base address.
-
- According to the known GUID gVfrArrayAttractGuid to get the base address from FFS.
-
- @param Ffs Pointer to the FFS.
- @param EfiAddr Pointer to the EFI in FFS
- @param Length The length of FFS.
- @param Offset Pointer to pointer to the Addr (Offset).
- @param NumOfMatchingOffset The number of Addr (Offset).
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Get the address successfully.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND No VfrBin found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-SearchVfrBinInFfs (
- IN VOID *Ffs,
- IN VOID *EfiAddr,
- IN UINTN Length,
- OUT UINTN **Offset,
- OUT UINT8 *NumOfMatchingOffset
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN VirOffValue;
-
- if ((Ffs == NULL) || (Offset == NULL)) {
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
- }
- Status = GetAddressByGuid (
- Ffs,
- &gVfrArrayAttractGuid,
- Length,
- Offset,
- NumOfMatchingOffset
- );
- if (Status != EFI_SUCCESS) {
- return Status;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < *NumOfMatchingOffset; Index++) {
- //
- // Got the virOffset after the GUID
- //
- VirOffValue = *(UINTN *) ((UINTN) Ffs + *(*Offset + Index));
- //
- // Transfer the offset to the VA address. One modules may own multiple VfrBin address.
- //
- *(*Offset + Index) = (UINTN) EfiAddr + VirOffValue;
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse FFS.
-
- @param[in] Fv2 Pointer to Fv2 protocol.
- @param[in] DriverGuid Pointer to driver GUID.
-
- @return Found the driver in the FV or not.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-ParseFfs (
- IN EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME2_PROTOCOL *Fv2,
- IN EFI_GUID *DriverGuid
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_FV_FILETYPE FoundType;
- EFI_FV_FILE_ATTRIBUTES FileAttributes;
- UINT32 AuthenticationStatus;
- UINTN Size;
- VOID *Buffer;
- UINTN SectionSize;
- VOID *SectionBuffer;
- UINTN VfrBinIndex;
- UINT8 NumberofMatchingVfrBin;
- UINTN *VfrBinBaseAddress;
-
- Status = Fv2->ReadFile (
- Fv2,
- DriverGuid,
- NULL,
- &Size,
- &FoundType,
- &FileAttributes,
- &AuthenticationStatus
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- Buffer = NULL;
- Status = Fv2->ReadSection (
- Fv2,
- DriverGuid,
- EFI_SECTION_RAW,
- 0, // Instance
- &Buffer,
- &Size,
- &AuthenticationStatus
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- Status = SearchVfrBinInFfs (Buffer, 0, Size, &VfrBinBaseAddress, &NumberofMatchingVfrBin);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- SectionBuffer = NULL;
- Status = Fv2->ReadSection (
- Fv2,
- DriverGuid,
- EFI_SECTION_PE32,
- 0, // Instance
- &SectionBuffer,
- &SectionSize,
- &AuthenticationStatus
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "FfsNameGuid - %g\n", DriverGuid));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "NumberofMatchingVfrBin - 0x%02x\n", NumberofMatchingVfrBin));
-
- for (VfrBinIndex = 0; VfrBinIndex < NumberofMatchingVfrBin; VfrBinIndex++) {
-#ifdef DUMP_HII_DATA
- DEBUG_CODE (
- DumpHiiPackage ((UINT8 *) (UINTN) SectionBuffer + VfrBinBaseAddress[VfrBinIndex] + sizeof (UINT32));
- );
-#endif
- VarCheckParseHiiPackage ((UINT8 *) (UINTN) SectionBuffer + VfrBinBaseAddress[VfrBinIndex] + sizeof (UINT32), TRUE);
- }
-
- FreePool (SectionBuffer);
- }
-
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (VfrBinBaseAddress);
- }
-
- FreePool (Buffer);
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Parse FVs.
-
- @param[in] ScanAll Scan all modules in all FVs or not.
-
-**/
-VOID
-ParseFv (
- IN BOOLEAN ScanAll
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
- UINTN HandleCount;
- UINTN Index;
- EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME2_PROTOCOL *Fv2;
- VOID *Key;
- EFI_FV_FILETYPE FileType;
- EFI_GUID NameGuid;
- EFI_FV_FILE_ATTRIBUTES FileAttributes;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN FfsIndex;
- VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO *VfrDriverInfo;
- LIST_ENTRY *VfrDriverLink;
-
- HandleBuffer = NULL;
- Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
- ByProtocol,
- &gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid,
- NULL,
- &HandleCount,
- &HandleBuffer
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Search all FVs
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index++) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "FvIndex - %x\n", Index));
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- HandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &Fv2
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- DEBUG_CODE (
- EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK2_PROTOCOL *Fvb2;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS FvAddress;
- UINT64 FvSize;
-
- Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
- HandleBuffer[Index],
- &gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlock2ProtocolGuid,
- (VOID **) &Fvb2
- );
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Status = Fvb2->GetPhysicalAddress (Fvb2, &FvAddress);
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "FvAddress - 0x%08x\n", FvAddress));
- FvSize = ((EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_HEADER *) (UINTN) FvAddress)->FvLength;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "FvSize - 0x%08x\n", FvSize));
- }
- );
-
- if (ScanAll) {
- //
- // Need to parse all modules in all FVs.
- //
- Key = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (Fv2->KeySize);
- ASSERT (Key != NULL);
-
- for (FfsIndex = 0; ; FfsIndex++) {
- FileType = EFI_FV_FILETYPE_ALL;
- Status = Fv2->GetNextFile (
- Fv2,
- Key,
- &FileType,
- &NameGuid,
- &FileAttributes,
- &Size
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- break;
- }
-
- ParseFfs (Fv2, &NameGuid);
- }
-
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (Key);
- } else {
- //
- // Only parse drivers in the VFR drivers list.
- //
- VfrDriverLink = mVfrDriverList.ForwardLink;
- while (VfrDriverLink != &mVfrDriverList) {
- VfrDriverInfo = VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO_FROM_LINK (VfrDriverLink);
- VfrDriverLink = VfrDriverLink->ForwardLink;
- if (ParseFfs (Fv2, VfrDriverInfo->DriverGuid)) {
- //
- // Found the driver in the FV.
- //
- RemoveEntryList (&VfrDriverInfo->Link);
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (VfrDriverInfo);
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- FreePool (HandleBuffer);
-}
-
-/**
- Create Vfr Driver List.
-
- @param[in] DriverGuidArray Driver Guid Array
-
-**/
-VOID
-CreateVfrDriverList (
- IN EFI_GUID *DriverGuidArray
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO *VfrDriverInfo;
-
- for (Index = 0; !CompareGuid (&DriverGuidArray[Index], &gZeroGuid); Index++) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "CreateVfrDriverList: %g\n", &DriverGuidArray[Index]));
- VfrDriverInfo = InternalVarCheckAllocateZeroPool (sizeof (*VfrDriverInfo));
- ASSERT (VfrDriverInfo != NULL);
- VfrDriverInfo->Signature = VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO_SIGNATURE;
- VfrDriverInfo->DriverGuid = &DriverGuidArray[Index];
- InsertTailList (&mVfrDriverList, &VfrDriverInfo->Link);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Destroy Vfr Driver List.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DestroyVfrDriverList (
- VOID
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO *VfrDriverInfo;
- LIST_ENTRY *VfrDriverLink;
-
- while (mVfrDriverList.ForwardLink != &mVfrDriverList) {
- VfrDriverLink = mVfrDriverList.ForwardLink;
- VfrDriverInfo = VAR_CHECK_VFR_DRIVER_INFO_FROM_LINK (VfrDriverLink);
- RemoveEntryList (&VfrDriverInfo->Link);
- InternalVarCheckFreePool (VfrDriverInfo);
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Generate from FV.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckHiiGenFromFv (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_GUID *DriverGuidArray;
- BOOLEAN ScanAll;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiGenDxeFromFv\n"));
-
- //
- // Get vfr driver guid array from PCD.
- //
- DriverGuidArray = (EFI_GUID *) PcdGetPtr (PcdVarCheckVfrDriverGuidArray);
-
- if (CompareGuid (&DriverGuidArray[0], &gZeroGuid)) {
- //
- // No VFR driver will be parsed from FVs.
- //
- return;
- }
-
- if (CompareGuid (&DriverGuidArray[0], &mAllFfGuid)) {
- ScanAll = TRUE;
- } else {
- ScanAll = FALSE;
- CreateVfrDriverList (DriverGuidArray);
- }
-
- ParseFv (ScanAll);
-
- if (!ScanAll) {
- DestroyVfrDriverList ();
- }
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGenFromHii.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGenFromHii.c deleted file mode 100644 index 41cde34af7..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiGenFromHii.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,73 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Var Check Hii generation from Hii Database.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "VarCheckHiiGen.h"
-
-/**
- Generate from Hii Database.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckHiiGenFromHiiDatabase (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN BufferSize;
- VOID *Buffer;
- EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS BufferAddress;
- EFI_HII_DATABASE_PROTOCOL *HiiDatabase;
-
- //
- // Locate HII Database protocol
- //
- Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &HiiDatabase);
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- return;
- }
-
- //
- // Call first time with zero buffer length.
- // Should fail with EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL.
- //
- BufferSize = 0;
- Buffer = NULL;
- Status = HiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (HiiDatabase, 0, &BufferSize, Buffer);
- if (Status == EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL) {
- //
- // Allocate buffer to hold the HII Database.
- //
- Status = gBS->AllocatePages (AllocateAnyPages, EfiBootServicesData, EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (BufferSize), &BufferAddress);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
- Buffer = (VOID *) (UINTN) BufferAddress;
-
- //
- // Export HII Database into the buffer.
- //
- Status = HiiDatabase->ExportPackageLists (HiiDatabase, 0, &BufferSize, Buffer);
- ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiGenDxeFromHii - HII Database exported at 0x%x, size = 0x%x\n", Buffer, BufferSize));
-
-#ifdef DUMP_HII_DATA
- DEBUG_CODE (
- DumpHiiDatabase (Buffer, BufferSize);
- );
-#endif
-
- VarCheckParseHiiDatabase (Buffer, BufferSize);
-
- gBS->FreePages (BufferAddress, EFI_SIZE_TO_PAGES (BufferSize));
- }
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 24d24c5dd5..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,58 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# NULL class library to register var check HII handler.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = VarCheckHiiLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = VarCheckHiiLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = A34FBDD0-05D3-4AF7-A720-560E91AC8CDF
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = VarCheckHiiLibNullClassConstructor
-
-[Sources]
- VarCheckHiiLibNullClass.c
- VarCheckHii.h
- VarCheckHiiGenFromFv.c
- VarCheckHiiGenFromHii.c
- VarCheckHiiGen.c
- VarCheckHiiGen.h
- InternalVarCheckStructure.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- UefiBootServicesTableLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- PcdLib
- VarCheckLib
-
-[Guids]
- gZeroGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## GUID
-
-[Protocols]
- gEfiFirmwareVolume2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlock2ProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
- gEfiHiiDatabaseProtocolGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
-
-[Pcd]
- gEfiMdeModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid.PcdVarCheckVfrDriverGuidArray ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index e4a0debafa..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLibNullClass.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLibNullClass.c deleted file mode 100644 index 3afa7962aa..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckHiiLib/VarCheckHiiLibNullClass.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,539 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Var Check Hii handler.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include "VarCheckHii.h"
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST CHAR8 mVarCheckHiiHex[] = {'0', '1', '2', '3', '4', '5', '6', '7', '8', '9', 'A', 'B', 'C', 'D', 'E', 'F'};
-
-/**
- Dump some hexadecimal data.
-
- @param[in] Indent How many spaces to indent the output.
- @param[in] Offset The offset of the dump.
- @param[in] DataSize The size in bytes of UserData.
- @param[in] UserData The data to dump.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckHiiInternalDumpHex (
- IN UINTN Indent,
- IN UINTN Offset,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *UserData
- )
-{
- UINT8 *Data;
-
- CHAR8 Val[50];
-
- CHAR8 Str[20];
-
- UINT8 TempByte;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN Index;
-
- Data = UserData;
- while (DataSize != 0) {
- Size = 16;
- if (Size > DataSize) {
- Size = DataSize;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Size; Index += 1) {
- TempByte = Data[Index];
- Val[Index * 3 + 0] = mVarCheckHiiHex[TempByte >> 4];
- Val[Index * 3 + 1] = mVarCheckHiiHex[TempByte & 0xF];
- Val[Index * 3 + 2] = (CHAR8) ((Index == 7) ? '-' : ' ');
- Str[Index] = (CHAR8) ((TempByte < ' ' || TempByte > 'z') ? '.' : TempByte);
- }
-
- Val[Index * 3] = 0;
- Str[Index] = 0;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%*a%08X: %-48a *%a*\r\n", Indent, "", Offset, Val, Str));
-
- Data += Size;
- Offset += Size;
- DataSize -= Size;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Var Check Hii Question.
-
- @param[in] HiiQuestion Pointer to Hii Question
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data to set.
-
- @retval TRUE Check pass
- @retval FALSE Check fail.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-VarCheckHiiQuestion (
- IN VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN UINTN DataSize
- )
-{
- UINT64 OneData;
- UINT64 Minimum;
- UINT64 Maximum;
- UINT64 OneValue;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
- UINT8 Index;
- UINT8 MaxContainers;
-
- if ((UINTN) (HiiQuestion->VarOffset + HiiQuestion->StorageWidth) > DataSize) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiQuestion fail: (VarOffset(0x%04x) + StorageWidth(0x%02x)) > Size(0x%x)\n", HiiQuestion->VarOffset, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth, DataSize));
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- OneData = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneData, (UINT8 *) Data + HiiQuestion->VarOffset, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
-
- switch (HiiQuestion->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *) HiiQuestion + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < (UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length) {
- OneValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- if (OneData == OneValue) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr >= ((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiQuestion fail: OneOf mismatch (0x%lx)\n", OneData));
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckHiiInternalDumpHex (2, 0, HiiQuestion->Length, (UINT8 *) HiiQuestion););
- return FALSE;
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- if ((OneData != 0) && (OneData != 1)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiQuestion fail: CheckBox mismatch (0x%lx)\n", OneData));
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckHiiInternalDumpHex (2, 0, HiiQuestion->Length, (UINT8 *) HiiQuestion););
- return FALSE;
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- Minimum = 0;
- Maximum = 0;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC *) HiiQuestion + 1);
- CopyMem (&Minimum, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
- CopyMem (&Maximum, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
-
- //
- // No need to check Step, because it is ONLY for UI.
- //
- if ((OneData < Minimum) || (OneData > Maximum)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiQuestion fail: Numeric mismatch (0x%lx)\n", OneData));
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckHiiInternalDumpHex (2, 0, HiiQuestion->Length, (UINT8 *) HiiQuestion););
- return FALSE;
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- MaxContainers = ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion)->MaxContainers;
- if ((UINTN) (HiiQuestion->VarOffset + HiiQuestion->StorageWidth * MaxContainers) > DataSize) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiQuestion fail: (VarOffset(0x%04x) + StorageWidth(0x%02x) * MaxContainers(0x%02x)) > Size(0x%x)\n", HiiQuestion->VarOffset, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth, MaxContainers, DataSize));
- return FALSE;
- }
- for (Index = 0; Index < MaxContainers; Index++) {
- OneData = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneData, (UINT8 *) Data + HiiQuestion->VarOffset + HiiQuestion->StorageWidth * Index, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- if (OneData == 0) {
- //
- // The value of 0 is used to determine if a particular "slot" in the array is empty.
- //
- continue;
- }
-
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < ((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length)) {
- OneValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- if (OneData == OneValue) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr >= ((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiQuestion fail: OrderedList mismatch\n"));
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckHiiInternalDumpHex (2, 0, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth * MaxContainers, (UINT8 *) Data + HiiQuestion->VarOffset););
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckHiiInternalDumpHex (2, 0, HiiQuestion->Length, (UINT8 *) HiiQuestion););
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *mVarCheckHiiBin = NULL;
-UINTN mVarCheckHiiBinSize = 0;
-
-/**
- SetVariable check handler HII.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Name of Variable to set.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Variable vendor GUID.
- @param[in] Attributes Attribute value of the variable.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data to set.
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION Check fail.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetVariableCheckHandlerHii (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *HiiVariable;
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion;
-
- if (mVarCheckHiiBin == NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if ((((Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE) == 0) && (DataSize == 0)) || (Attributes == 0)) {
- //
- // Do not check delete variable.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // For Hii Variable header align.
- //
- HiiVariable = (VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (mVarCheckHiiBin);
- while ((UINTN) HiiVariable < ((UINTN) mVarCheckHiiBin + mVarCheckHiiBinSize)) {
- if ((StrCmp ((CHAR16 *) (HiiVariable + 1), VariableName) == 0) &&
- (CompareGuid (&HiiVariable->Guid, VendorGuid))) {
- //
- // Found the Hii Variable that could be used to do check.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiVariable - %s:%g with Attributes = 0x%08x Size = 0x%x\n", VariableName, VendorGuid, Attributes, DataSize));
- if (HiiVariable->Attributes != Attributes) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiVariable fail for Attributes - 0x%08x\n", HiiVariable->Attributes));
- return EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION;
- }
-
- if (DataSize == 0) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiVariable - CHECK PASS with DataSize == 0 !\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if (HiiVariable->Size != DataSize) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiVariable fail for Size - 0x%x\n", HiiVariable->Size));
- return EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION;
- }
-
- //
- // Do the check.
- // For Hii Question header align.
- //
- HiiQuestion = (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) HiiVariable + HiiVariable->HeaderLength));
- while ((UINTN) HiiQuestion < ((UINTN) HiiVariable + HiiVariable->Length)) {
- if (!VarCheckHiiQuestion (HiiQuestion, Data, DataSize)) {
- return EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION;
- }
- //
- // For Hii Question header align.
- //
- HiiQuestion = (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length));
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckHiiVariable - ALL CHECK PASS!\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- //
- // For Hii Variable header align.
- //
- HiiVariable = (VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) HiiVariable + HiiVariable->Length));
- }
-
- // Not found, so pass.
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-#ifdef DUMP_VAR_CHECK_HII
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED VAR_CHECK_HII_OPCODE_STRING mHiiOpCodeStringTable[] = {
- {EFI_IFR_VARSTORE_EFI_OP, "EfiVarStore"},
- {EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP, "OneOf"},
- {EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP, "CheckBox"},
- {EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP, "Numeric"},
- {EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP, "OrderedList"},
-};
-
-/**
- HII opcode to string.
-
- @param[in] HiiOpCode Hii OpCode.
-
- @return Pointer to string.
-
-**/
-CHAR8 *
-HiiOpCodeToStr (
- IN UINT8 HiiOpCode
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mHiiOpCodeStringTable) / sizeof (mHiiOpCodeStringTable[0]); Index++) {
- if (mHiiOpCodeStringTable[Index].HiiOpCode == HiiOpCode) {
- return mHiiOpCodeStringTable[Index].HiiOpCodeStr;
- }
- }
-
- return "<UnknownHiiOpCode>";
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Hii Question.
-
- @param[in] HiiQuestion Pointer to Hii Question.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpHiiQuestion (
- IN VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion
- )
-{
- UINT64 Minimum;
- UINT64 Maximum;
- UINT64 OneValue;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OpCode - 0x%02x (%a)\n", HiiQuestion->OpCode, HiiOpCodeToStr (HiiQuestion->OpCode)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Length - 0x%02x\n", HiiQuestion->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VarOffset - 0x%04x\n", HiiQuestion->VarOffset));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " StorageWidth - 0x%02x\n", HiiQuestion->StorageWidth));
-
- switch (HiiQuestion->OpCode) {
- case EFI_IFR_ONE_OF_OP:
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ONEOF *) HiiQuestion + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < ((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length)) {
- OneValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- switch (HiiQuestion->StorageWidth) {
- case sizeof (UINT8):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%02x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT16):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%04x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT32):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%08x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT64):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%016lx\n", OneValue));
- break;
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_CHECKBOX_OP:
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_NUMERIC_OP:
- Minimum = 0;
- Maximum = 0;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_NUMERIC *) HiiQuestion + 1);
- CopyMem (&Minimum, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
- CopyMem (&Maximum, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
-
- switch (HiiQuestion->StorageWidth) {
- case sizeof (UINT8):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%02x\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%02x\n", Maximum));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT16):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%04x\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%04x\n", Maximum));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT32):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%08x\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%08x\n", Maximum));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT64):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%016lx\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%016lx\n", Maximum));
- break;
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
- break;
-
- case EFI_IFR_ORDERED_LIST_OP:
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " MaxContainers - 0x%02x\n", ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion)->MaxContainers));
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_ORDEREDLIST *) HiiQuestion + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < ((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length)) {
- OneValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue, Ptr, HiiQuestion->StorageWidth);
- switch (HiiQuestion->StorageWidth) {
- case sizeof (UINT8):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%02x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT16):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%04x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT32):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%08x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT64):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OneOfOption - 0x%016lx\n", OneValue));
- break;
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
- Ptr += HiiQuestion->StorageWidth;
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Hii Variable.
-
- @param[in] HiiVariable Pointer to Hii Variable.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpHiiVariable (
- IN VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *HiiVariable
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *HiiQuestion;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Revision - 0x%04x\n", HiiVariable->Revision));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " HeaderLength - 0x%04x\n", HiiVariable->HeaderLength));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Length - 0x%08x\n", HiiVariable->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " OpCode - 0x%02x (%a)\n", HiiVariable->OpCode, HiiOpCodeToStr (HiiVariable->OpCode)));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Size - 0x%04x\n", HiiVariable->Size));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Attributes - 0x%08x\n", HiiVariable->Attributes));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Guid - %g\n", &HiiVariable->Guid));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Name - %s\n", HiiVariable + 1));
-
- //
- // For Hii Question header align.
- //
- HiiQuestion = (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) HiiVariable + HiiVariable->HeaderLength));
- while ((UINTN) HiiQuestion < ((UINTN) HiiVariable + HiiVariable->Length)) {
- //
- // Dump Hii Question related to the Hii Variable.
- //
- DumpHiiQuestion (HiiQuestion);
- //
- // For Hii Question header align.
- //
- HiiQuestion = (VAR_CHECK_HII_QUESTION_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) HiiQuestion + HiiQuestion->Length));
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Var Check HII.
-
- @param[in] VarCheckHiiBin Pointer to VarCheckHiiBin.
- @param[in] VarCheckHiiBinSize VarCheckHiiBin size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpVarCheckHii (
- IN VOID *VarCheckHiiBin,
- IN UINTN VarCheckHiiBinSize
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *HiiVariable;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "DumpVarCheckHii\n"));
-
- //
- // For Hii Variable header align.
- //
- HiiVariable = (VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (VarCheckHiiBin);
- while ((UINTN) HiiVariable < ((UINTN) VarCheckHiiBin + VarCheckHiiBinSize)) {
- DumpHiiVariable (HiiVariable);
- //
- // For Hii Variable header align.
- //
- HiiVariable = (VAR_CHECK_HII_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) HiiVariable + HiiVariable->Length));
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-/**
- Constructor function of VarCheckHiiLib to register var check HII handler.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param[in] SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor executed correctly.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckHiiLibNullClassConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- VarCheckLibRegisterEndOfDxeCallback (VarCheckHiiGen);
- VarCheckLibRegisterAddressPointer ((VOID **) &mVarCheckHiiBin);
- VarCheckLibRegisterSetVariableCheckHandler (SetVariableCheckHandlerHii);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.c deleted file mode 100644 index 60c141a6b9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,663 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Implementation functions and structures for var check services.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/VarCheckLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-
-#include <Guid/GlobalVariable.h>
-#include <Guid/HardwareErrorVariable.h>
-
-BOOLEAN mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe = FALSE;
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_TABLE_SIZE 0x8
-
-UINTN mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackCount = 0;
-UINTN mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackMaxCount = 0;
-VAR_CHECK_END_OF_DXE_CALLBACK *mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallback = NULL;
-
-UINTN mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount = 0;
-UINTN mVarCheckLibAddressPointerMaxCount = 0;
-VOID ***mVarCheckLibAddressPointer = NULL;
-
-UINTN mNumberOfVarCheckHandler = 0;
-UINTN mMaxNumberOfVarCheckHandler = 0;
-VAR_CHECK_SET_VARIABLE_CHECK_HANDLER *mVarCheckHandlerTable = NULL;
-
-typedef struct {
- EFI_GUID Guid;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY VariableProperty;
- //CHAR16 *Name;
-} VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_ENTRY;
-
-UINTN mNumberOfVarCheckVariable = 0;
-UINTN mMaxNumberOfVarCheckVariable = 0;
-VARIABLE_ENTRY_PROPERTY **mVarCheckVariableTable = NULL;
-
-//
-// Handle variables with wildcard name specially.
-//
-VARIABLE_ENTRY_PROPERTY mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[] = {
- {
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- L"Boot####",
- {
- 0
- },
- },
- {
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- L"Driver####",
- {
- 0
- },
- },
- {
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- L"SysPrep####",
- {
- 0
- },
- },
- {
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- L"Key####",
- {
- 0
- },
- },
- {
- &gEfiHardwareErrorVariableGuid,
- L"HwErrRec####",
- {
- 0
- },
- },
-};
-
-/**
- Check if a Unicode character is a hexadecimal character.
-
- This function checks if a Unicode character is a
- hexadecimal character. The valid hexadecimal character is
- L'0' to L'9', L'a' to L'f', or L'A' to L'F'.
-
-
- @param[in] Char The character to check against.
-
- @retval TRUE If the Char is a hexadecmial character.
- @retval FALSE If the Char is not a hexadecmial character.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckInternalIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (
- IN CHAR16 Char
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((Char >= L'0' && Char <= L'9') || (Char >= L'A' && Char <= L'F') || (Char >= L'a' && Char <= L'f'));
-}
-
-/**
- Variable property get with wildcard name.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Pointer to variable name.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Pointer to variable vendor GUID.
- @param[in] WildcardMatch Try wildcard match or not.
-
- @return Pointer to variable property.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *
-VariablePropertyGetWithWildcardName (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN BOOLEAN WildcardMatch
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN NameLength;
-
- NameLength = StrLen (VariableName) - 4;
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName)/sizeof (mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[0]); Index++) {
- if (CompareGuid (mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[Index].Guid, VendorGuid)){
- if (WildcardMatch) {
- if ((StrLen (VariableName) == StrLen (mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[Index].Name)) &&
- (StrnCmp (VariableName, mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[Index].Name, NameLength) == 0) &&
- VarCheckInternalIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength]) &&
- VarCheckInternalIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength + 1]) &&
- VarCheckInternalIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength + 2]) &&
- VarCheckInternalIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength + 3])) {
- return &mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[Index].VariableProperty;
- }
- }
- if (StrCmp (mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[Index].Name, VariableName) == 0) {
- return &mVarCheckVariableWithWildcardName[Index].VariableProperty;
- }
- }
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- Variable property get function.
-
- @param[in] Name Pointer to the variable name.
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to the vendor GUID.
- @param[in] WildcardMatch Try wildcard match or not.
-
- @return Pointer to the property of variable specified by the Name and Guid.
-
-**/
-VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *
-VariablePropertyGetFunction (
- IN CHAR16 *Name,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid,
- IN BOOLEAN WildcardMatch
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_ENTRY *Entry;
- CHAR16 *VariableName;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < mNumberOfVarCheckVariable; Index++) {
- Entry = (VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_ENTRY *) mVarCheckVariableTable[Index];
- VariableName = (CHAR16 *) ((UINTN) Entry + sizeof (*Entry));
- if (CompareGuid (&Entry->Guid, Guid) && (StrCmp (VariableName, Name) == 0)) {
- return &Entry->VariableProperty;
- }
- }
-
- return VariablePropertyGetWithWildcardName (Name, Guid, WildcardMatch);
-}
-
-/**
- Var check add table entry.
-
- @param[in, out] Table Pointer to table buffer.
- @param[in, out] MaxNumber Pointer to maximum number of entry in the table.
- @param[in, out] CurrentNumber Pointer to current number of entry in the table.
- @param[in] Entry Entry will be added to the table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS Reallocate memory successfully.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES No enough memory to allocate.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-VarCheckAddTableEntry (
- IN OUT UINTN **Table,
- IN OUT UINTN *MaxNumber,
- IN OUT UINTN *CurrentNumber,
- IN UINTN Entry
- )
-{
- UINTN *TempTable;
-
- //
- // Check whether the table is enough to store new entry.
- //
- if (*CurrentNumber == *MaxNumber) {
- //
- // Reallocate memory for the table.
- //
- TempTable = ReallocateRuntimePool (
- *MaxNumber * sizeof (UINTN),
- (*MaxNumber + VAR_CHECK_TABLE_SIZE) * sizeof (UINTN),
- *Table
- );
-
- //
- // No enough resource to allocate.
- //
- if (TempTable == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
-
- *Table = TempTable;
- //
- // Increase max number.
- //
- *MaxNumber += VAR_CHECK_TABLE_SIZE;
- }
-
- //
- // Add entry to the table.
- //
- (*Table)[*CurrentNumber] = Entry;
- (*CurrentNumber)++;
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Register END_OF_DXE callback.
- The callback will be invoked by VarCheckLibInitializeAtEndOfDxe().
-
- @param[in] Callback END_OF_DXE callback.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The callback was registered successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Callback is NULL.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED EFI_END_OF_DXE_EVENT_GROUP_GUID or EFI_EVENT_GROUP_READY_TO_BOOT has
- already been signaled.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is not enough resource for the callback register request.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibRegisterEndOfDxeCallback (
- IN VAR_CHECK_END_OF_DXE_CALLBACK Callback
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (Callback == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe) {
- return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- }
-
- Status = VarCheckAddTableEntry (
- (UINTN **) &mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallback,
- &mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackMaxCount,
- &mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackCount,
- (UINTN) Callback
- );
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckLibRegisterEndOfDxeCallback - 0x%x %r\n", Callback, Status));
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Var check initialize at END_OF_DXE.
-
- This function needs to be called at END_OF_DXE.
- Address pointers may be returned,
- and caller needs to ConvertPointer() for the pointers.
-
- @param[in, out] AddressPointerCount Output pointer to address pointer count.
-
- @return Address pointer buffer, NULL if input AddressPointerCount is NULL.
-
-**/
-VOID ***
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibInitializeAtEndOfDxe (
- IN OUT UINTN *AddressPointerCount OPTIONAL
- )
-{
- VOID *TempTable;
- UINTN TotalCount;
- UINTN Index;
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackCount; Index++) {
- //
- // Invoke the callback registered by VarCheckLibRegisterEndOfDxeCallback().
- //
- mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallback[Index] ();
- }
- if (mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallback != NULL) {
- //
- // Free the callback buffer.
- //
- mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackCount = 0;
- mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallbackMaxCount = 0;
- FreePool ((VOID *) mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallback);
- mVarCheckLibEndOfDxeCallback = NULL;
- }
-
- mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe = TRUE;
-
- if (AddressPointerCount == NULL) {
- if (mVarCheckLibAddressPointer != NULL) {
- //
- // Free the address pointer buffer.
- //
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount = 0;
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointerMaxCount = 0;
- FreePool ((VOID *) mVarCheckLibAddressPointer);
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointer = NULL;
- }
- return NULL;
- }
-
- //
- // Get the total count needed.
- // Also cover VarCheckHandler and the entries, and VarCheckVariable and the entries.
- //
- TotalCount = mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount + (mNumberOfVarCheckHandler + 1) + (mNumberOfVarCheckVariable + 1);
- TempTable = ReallocateRuntimePool (
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointerMaxCount * sizeof (VOID **),
- TotalCount * sizeof (VOID **),
- (VOID *) mVarCheckLibAddressPointer
- );
-
- if (TempTable != NULL) {
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointer = (VOID ***) TempTable;
-
- //
- // Cover VarCheckHandler and the entries.
- //
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointer[mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount++] = (VOID **) &mVarCheckHandlerTable;
- for (Index = 0; Index < mNumberOfVarCheckHandler; Index++) {
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointer[mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount++] = (VOID **) &mVarCheckHandlerTable[Index];
- }
-
- //
- // Cover VarCheckVariable and the entries.
- //
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointer[mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount++] = (VOID **) &mVarCheckVariableTable;
- for (Index = 0; Index < mNumberOfVarCheckVariable; Index++) {
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointer[mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount++] = (VOID **) &mVarCheckVariableTable[Index];
- }
-
- ASSERT (mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount == TotalCount);
- mVarCheckLibAddressPointerMaxCount = mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount;
- }
-
- *AddressPointerCount = mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount;
- return mVarCheckLibAddressPointer;
-}
-
-/**
- Register address pointer.
- The AddressPointer may be returned by VarCheckLibInitializeAtEndOfDxe().
-
- @param[in] AddressPointer Address pointer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The address pointer was registered successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER AddressPointer is NULL.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED EFI_END_OF_DXE_EVENT_GROUP_GUID or EFI_EVENT_GROUP_READY_TO_BOOT has
- already been signaled.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is not enough resource for the address pointer register request.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibRegisterAddressPointer (
- IN VOID **AddressPointer
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (AddressPointer == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe) {
- return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- }
-
- Status = VarCheckAddTableEntry(
- (UINTN **) &mVarCheckLibAddressPointer,
- &mVarCheckLibAddressPointerMaxCount,
- &mVarCheckLibAddressPointerCount,
- (UINTN) AddressPointer
- );
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckLibRegisterAddressPointer - 0x%x %r\n", AddressPointer, Status));
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Register SetVariable check handler.
-
- @param[in] Handler Pointer to check handler.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check handler was registered successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Handler is NULL.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED EFI_END_OF_DXE_EVENT_GROUP_GUID or EFI_EVENT_GROUP_READY_TO_BOOT has
- already been signaled.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is not enough resource for the SetVariable check handler register request.
- @retval EFI_UNSUPPORTED This interface is not implemented.
- For example, it is unsupported in VarCheck protocol if both VarCheck and SmmVarCheck protocols are present.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibRegisterSetVariableCheckHandler (
- IN VAR_CHECK_SET_VARIABLE_CHECK_HANDLER Handler
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
-
- if (Handler == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe) {
- return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- }
-
- Status = VarCheckAddTableEntry(
- (UINTN **) &mVarCheckHandlerTable,
- &mMaxNumberOfVarCheckHandler,
- &mNumberOfVarCheckHandler,
- (UINTN) Handler
- );
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckLibRegisterSetVariableCheckHandler - 0x%x %r\n", Handler, Status));
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Variable property set.
-
- @param[in] Name Pointer to the variable name.
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to the vendor GUID.
- @param[in] VariableProperty Pointer to the input variable property.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The property of variable specified by the Name and Guid was set successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Name, Guid or VariableProperty is NULL, or Name is an empty string,
- or the fields of VariableProperty are not valid.
- @retval EFI_ACCESS_DENIED EFI_END_OF_DXE_EVENT_GROUP_GUID or EFI_EVENT_GROUP_READY_TO_BOOT has
- already been signaled.
- @retval EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES There is not enough resource for the variable property set request.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibVariablePropertySet (
- IN CHAR16 *Name,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid,
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariableProperty
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_ENTRY *Entry;
- CHAR16 *VariableName;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *Property;
-
- if (Name == NULL || Name[0] == 0 || Guid == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (VariableProperty == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (VariableProperty->Revision != VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe) {
- return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
- }
-
- Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
-
- //
- // Get the pointer of property data for set.
- //
- Property = VariablePropertyGetFunction (Name, Guid, FALSE);
- if (Property != NULL) {
- CopyMem (Property, VariableProperty, sizeof (*VariableProperty));
- } else {
- Entry = AllocateRuntimeZeroPool (sizeof (*Entry) + StrSize (Name));
- if (Entry == NULL) {
- return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
- }
- VariableName = (CHAR16 *) ((UINTN) Entry + sizeof (*Entry));
- StrCpyS (VariableName, StrSize (Name)/sizeof (CHAR16), Name);
- CopyGuid (&Entry->Guid, Guid);
- CopyMem (&Entry->VariableProperty, VariableProperty, sizeof (*VariableProperty));
-
- Status = VarCheckAddTableEntry(
- (UINTN **) &mVarCheckVariableTable,
- &mMaxNumberOfVarCheckVariable,
- &mNumberOfVarCheckVariable,
- (UINTN) Entry
- );
-
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- FreePool (Entry);
- }
- }
-
- return Status;
-}
-
-/**
- Variable property get.
-
- @param[in] Name Pointer to the variable name.
- @param[in] Guid Pointer to the vendor GUID.
- @param[out] VariableProperty Pointer to the output variable property.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The property of variable specified by the Name and Guid was got successfully.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER Name, Guid or VariableProperty is NULL, or Name is an empty string.
- @retval EFI_NOT_FOUND The property of variable specified by the Name and Guid was not found.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibVariablePropertyGet (
- IN CHAR16 *Name,
- IN EFI_GUID *Guid,
- OUT VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariableProperty
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *Property;
-
- if (Name == NULL || Name[0] == 0 || Guid == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- if (VariableProperty == NULL) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- Property = VariablePropertyGetFunction (Name, Guid, TRUE);
- //
- // Also check the property revision before using the property data.
- // There is no property set to this variable(wildcard name)
- // if the revision is not VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION.
- //
- if ((Property != NULL) && (Property->Revision == VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION)) {
- CopyMem (VariableProperty, Property, sizeof (*VariableProperty));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
-}
-
-/**
- SetVariable check.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Name of Variable to set.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Variable vendor GUID.
- @param[in] Attributes Attribute value of the variable.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data to set.
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
- @param[in] RequestSource Request source.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER An invalid combination of attribute bits, name, GUID,
- DataSize and Data value was supplied.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED The variable in question is read-only.
- @retval Others The other return status from check handler.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckLibSetVariableCheck (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN VAR_CHECK_REQUEST_SOURCE RequestSource
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *Property;
-
- if (!mVarCheckLibEndOfDxe) {
- //
- // Only do check after End Of Dxe.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- Property = VariablePropertyGetFunction (VariableName, VendorGuid, TRUE);
- //
- // Also check the property revision before using the property data.
- // There is no property set to this variable(wildcard name)
- // if the revision is not VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION.
- //
- if ((Property != NULL) && (Property->Revision == VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION)) {
- if ((RequestSource != VarCheckFromTrusted) && ((Property->Property & VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY) != 0)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Variable Check ReadOnly variable fail %r - %g:%s\n", EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED, VendorGuid, VariableName));
- return EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED;
- }
- if (!((((Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE) == 0) && (DataSize == 0)) || (Attributes == 0))) {
- //
- // Not to delete variable.
- //
- if ((Property->Attributes != 0) && ((Attributes & (~EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE)) != Property->Attributes)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Variable Check Attributes(0x%08x to 0x%08x) fail %r - %g:%s\n", Property->Attributes, Attributes, EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER, VendorGuid, VariableName));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (DataSize != 0) {
- if ((DataSize < Property->MinSize) || (DataSize > Property->MaxSize)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Variable Check DataSize fail(0x%x not in 0x%x - 0x%x) %r - %g:%s\n", DataSize, Property->MinSize, Property->MaxSize, EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER, VendorGuid, VariableName));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < mNumberOfVarCheckHandler; Index++) {
- Status = mVarCheckHandlerTable[Index] (
- VariableName,
- VendorGuid,
- Attributes,
- DataSize,
- Data
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "Variable Check handler fail %r - %g:%s\n", Status, VendorGuid, VariableName));
- return Status;
- }
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 099f83dd6a..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,51 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# Provides variable check services and database management.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = VarCheckLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = VarCheckLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = 63E12D08-0C5D-47F8-95E4-09F89D7506C5
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = VarCheckLib|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- VarCheckLib.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DebugLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
-
-[Guids]
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Boot####"
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Driver####"
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"SysPrep####"
- ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Key####"
- gEfiGlobalVariableGuid
- gEfiHardwareErrorVariableGuid ## SOMETIMES_CONSUMES ## Variable:L"HwErrRec####"
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index d9761a1103..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckLib/VarCheckLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index b9d235be60..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,65 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# NULL class library to register var check PCD handler.
-#
-# In platform *.fdf, the example build rule for the driver this library linked to.
-# [Rule.Common.DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER.VARCHECKPCD]
-# FILE DRIVER = $(NAMED_GUID) {
-# RAW BIN $(WORKSPACE)/$(OUTPUT_DIRECTORY)/$(TARGET)_$(TOOL_CHAIN_TAG)/FV/PcdVarCheck.bin
-# DXE_DEPEX DXE_DEPEX Optional $(INF_OUTPUT)/$(MODULE_NAME).depex
-# PE32 PE32 $(INF_OUTPUT)/$(MODULE_NAME).efi
-# UI STRING="$(MODULE_NAME)" Optional
-# VERSION STRING="$(INF_VERSION)" Optional BUILD_NUM=$(BUILD_NUMBER)
-# }
-#
-# or
-#
-# [Rule.Common.DXE_SMM_DRIVER.VARCHECKPCD]
-# FILE SMM = $(NAMED_GUID) {
-# RAW BIN $(WORKSPACE)/$(OUTPUT_DIRECTORY)/$(TARGET)_$(TOOL_CHAIN_TAG)/FV/PcdVarCheck.bin
-# DXE_DEPEX DXE_DEPEX Optional $(INF_OUTPUT)/$(MODULE_NAME).depex
-# PE32 PE32 $(INF_OUTPUT)/$(MODULE_NAME).efi
-# UI STRING="$(MODULE_NAME)" Optional
-# VERSION STRING="$(INF_VERSION)" Optional BUILD_NUM=$(BUILD_NUMBER)
-# }
-#
-# In platform *.dsc, also need add one line below to enable PcdVarCheck.bin generation by BaseTools.
-# PCD_VAR_CHECK_GENERATION = TRUE
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = VarCheckPcdLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = VarCheckPcdLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = D4FA5311-5F1F-4B1E-9AC3-90C4DFC029F1
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = VarCheckPcdLibNullClassConstructor
-
-[Sources]
- VarCheckPcdLibNullClass.c
- VarCheckPcdStructure.h
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- DebugLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DxeServicesLib
- MemoryAllocationLib
- VarCheckLib
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 4a3d932be9..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLibNullClass.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLibNullClass.c deleted file mode 100644 index 72b0363b19..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdLibNullClass.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,474 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Var Check PCD handler.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/VarCheckLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
-#include <Library/DxeServicesLib.h>
-
-#include "VarCheckPcdStructure.h"
-
-//#define DUMP_VAR_CHECK_PCD
-
-GLOBAL_REMOVE_IF_UNREFERENCED CONST CHAR8 mVarCheckPcdHex[] = {'0', '1', '2', '3', '4', '5', '6', '7', '8', '9', 'A', 'B', 'C', 'D', 'E', 'F'};
-
-/**
- Dump some hexadecimal data.
-
- @param[in] Indent How many spaces to indent the output.
- @param[in] Offset The offset of the dump.
- @param[in] DataSize The size in bytes of UserData.
- @param[in] UserData The data to dump.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VarCheckPcdInternalDumpHex (
- IN UINTN Indent,
- IN UINTN Offset,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *UserData
- )
-{
- UINT8 *Data;
-
- CHAR8 Val[50];
-
- CHAR8 Str[20];
-
- UINT8 TempByte;
- UINTN Size;
- UINTN Index;
-
- Data = UserData;
- while (DataSize != 0) {
- Size = 16;
- if (Size > DataSize) {
- Size = DataSize;
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < Size; Index += 1) {
- TempByte = Data[Index];
- Val[Index * 3 + 0] = mVarCheckPcdHex[TempByte >> 4];
- Val[Index * 3 + 1] = mVarCheckPcdHex[TempByte & 0xF];
- Val[Index * 3 + 2] = (CHAR8) ((Index == 7) ? '-' : ' ');
- Str[Index] = (CHAR8) ((TempByte < ' ' || TempByte > 'z') ? '.' : TempByte);
- }
-
- Val[Index * 3] = 0;
- Str[Index] = 0;
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "%*a%08X: %-48a *%a*\r\n", Indent, "", Offset, Val, Str));
-
- Data += Size;
- Offset += Size;
- DataSize -= Size;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Var Check Pcd ValidData.
-
- @param[in] PcdValidData Pointer to Pcd ValidData
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data to set.
-
- @retval TRUE Check pass
- @retval FALSE Check fail.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-VarCheckPcdValidData (
- IN VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *PcdValidData,
- IN VOID *Data,
- IN UINTN DataSize
- )
-{
- UINT64 OneData;
- UINT64 Minimum;
- UINT64 Maximum;
- UINT64 OneValue;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
-
- OneData = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneData, (UINT8 *) Data + PcdValidData->VarOffset, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
-
- switch (PcdValidData->Type) {
- case VarCheckPcdValidList:
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_LIST *) PcdValidData + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < (UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length) {
- OneValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue, Ptr, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
- if (OneData == OneValue) {
- //
- // Match
- //
- break;
- }
- Ptr += PcdValidData->StorageWidth;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Ptr >= ((UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length)) {
- //
- // No match
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdValidData fail: ValidList mismatch (0x%lx)\n", OneData));
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckPcdInternalDumpHex (2, 0, PcdValidData->Length, (UINT8 *) PcdValidData););
- return FALSE;
- }
- break;
-
- case VarCheckPcdValidRange:
- Minimum = 0;
- Maximum = 0;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_RANGE *) PcdValidData + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < (UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length) {
- CopyMem (&Minimum, Ptr, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += PcdValidData->StorageWidth;
- CopyMem (&Maximum, Ptr, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += PcdValidData->StorageWidth;
-
- if ((OneData >= Minimum) && (OneData <= Maximum)) {
- return TRUE;
- }
- }
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdValidData fail: ValidRange mismatch (0x%lx)\n", OneData));
- DEBUG_CODE (VarCheckPcdInternalDumpHex (2, 0, PcdValidData->Length, (UINT8 *) PcdValidData););
- return FALSE;
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *mVarCheckPcdBin = NULL;
-UINTN mVarCheckPcdBinSize = 0;
-
-/**
- SetVariable check handler PCD.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Name of Variable to set.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Variable vendor GUID.
- @param[in] Attributes Attribute value of the variable.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data to set.
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION Check fail.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetVariableCheckHandlerPcd (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *PcdVariable;
- VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *PcdValidData;
-
- if (mVarCheckPcdBin == NULL) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if ((((Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE) == 0) && (DataSize == 0)) || (Attributes == 0)) {
- //
- // Do not check delete variable.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // For Pcd Variable header align.
- //
- PcdVariable = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (mVarCheckPcdBin);
- while ((UINTN) PcdVariable < ((UINTN) mVarCheckPcdBin + mVarCheckPcdBinSize)) {
- if ((StrCmp ((CHAR16 *) (PcdVariable + 1), VariableName) == 0) &&
- (CompareGuid (&PcdVariable->Guid, VendorGuid))) {
- //
- // Found the Pcd Variable that could be used to do check.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdVariable - %s:%g with Attributes = 0x%08x Size = 0x%x\n", VariableName, VendorGuid, Attributes, DataSize));
- if ((PcdVariable->Attributes != 0) && PcdVariable->Attributes != Attributes) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdVariable fail for Attributes - 0x%08x\n", PcdVariable->Attributes));
- return EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION;
- }
-
- if (DataSize == 0) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdVariable - CHECK PASS with DataSize == 0 !\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- //
- // Do the check.
- // For Pcd ValidData header align.
- //
- PcdValidData = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) PcdVariable + PcdVariable->HeaderLength));
- while ((UINTN) PcdValidData < ((UINTN) PcdVariable + PcdVariable->Length)) {
- if (((UINTN) PcdValidData->VarOffset + PcdValidData->StorageWidth) <= DataSize) {
- if (!VarCheckPcdValidData (PcdValidData, Data, DataSize)) {
- return EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION;
- }
- }
- //
- // For Pcd ValidData header align.
- //
- PcdValidData = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length));
- }
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdVariable - ALL CHECK PASS!\n"));
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
- //
- // For Pcd Variable header align.
- //
- PcdVariable = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) PcdVariable + PcdVariable->Length));
- }
-
- // Not found, so pass.
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-#ifdef DUMP_VAR_CHECK_PCD
-/**
- Dump Pcd ValidData.
-
- @param[in] PcdValidData Pointer to Pcd ValidData.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpPcdValidData (
- IN VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *PcdValidData
- )
-{
- UINT64 Minimum;
- UINT64 Maximum;
- UINT64 OneValue;
- UINT8 *Ptr;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Type - 0x%02x\n", PcdValidData->Type));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Length - 0x%02x\n", PcdValidData->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " VarOffset - 0x%04x\n", PcdValidData->VarOffset));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " StorageWidth - 0x%02x\n", PcdValidData->StorageWidth));
-
- switch (PcdValidData->Type) {
- case VarCheckPcdValidList:
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_LIST *) PcdValidData + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < ((UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length)) {
- OneValue = 0;
- CopyMem (&OneValue, Ptr, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
- switch (PcdValidData->StorageWidth) {
- case sizeof (UINT8):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " ValidList - 0x%02x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT16):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " ValidList - 0x%04x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT32):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " ValidList - 0x%08x\n", OneValue));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT64):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " ValidList - 0x%016lx\n", OneValue));
- break;
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
- Ptr += PcdValidData->StorageWidth;
- }
- break;
-
- case VarCheckPcdValidRange:
- Minimum = 0;
- Maximum = 0;
- Ptr = (UINT8 *) ((VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_RANGE *) PcdValidData + 1);
- while ((UINTN) Ptr < (UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length) {
- CopyMem (&Minimum, Ptr, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += PcdValidData->StorageWidth;
- CopyMem (&Maximum, Ptr, PcdValidData->StorageWidth);
- Ptr += PcdValidData->StorageWidth;
-
- switch (PcdValidData->StorageWidth) {
- case sizeof (UINT8):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%02x\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%02x\n", Maximum));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT16):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%04x\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%04x\n", Maximum));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT32):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%08x\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%08x\n", Maximum));
- break;
- case sizeof (UINT64):
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Minimum - 0x%016lx\n", Minimum));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Maximum - 0x%016lx\n", Maximum));
- break;
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
- }
- break;
-
- default:
- ASSERT (FALSE);
- break;
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Pcd Variable.
-
- @param[in] PcdVariable Pointer to Pcd Variable.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpPcdVariable (
- IN VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *PcdVariable
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *PcdValidData;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER\n"));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Revision - 0x%04x\n", PcdVariable->Revision));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " HeaderLength - 0x%04x\n", PcdVariable->HeaderLength));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Length - 0x%08x\n", PcdVariable->Length));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Type - 0x%02x\n", PcdVariable->Type));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Attributes - 0x%08x\n", PcdVariable->Attributes));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Guid - %g\n", &PcdVariable->Guid));
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, " Name - %s\n", PcdVariable + 1));
-
- //
- // For Pcd ValidData header align.
- //
- PcdValidData = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) PcdVariable + PcdVariable->HeaderLength));
- while ((UINTN) PcdValidData < ((UINTN) PcdVariable + PcdVariable->Length)) {
- //
- // Dump Pcd ValidData related to the Pcd Variable.
- //
- DumpPcdValidData (PcdValidData);
- //
- // For Pcd ValidData header align.
- //
- PcdValidData = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) PcdValidData + PcdValidData->Length));
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Dump Var Check PCD.
-
- @param[in] VarCheckPcdBin Pointer to VarCheckPcdBin.
- @param[in] VarCheckPcdBinSize VarCheckPcdBin size.
-
-**/
-VOID
-DumpVarCheckPcd (
- IN VOID *VarCheckPcdBin,
- IN UINTN VarCheckPcdBinSize
- )
-{
- VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *PcdVariable;
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "DumpVarCheckPcd\n"));
-
- //
- // For Pcd Variable header align.
- //
- PcdVariable = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (VarCheckPcdBin);
- while ((UINTN) PcdVariable < ((UINTN) VarCheckPcdBin + VarCheckPcdBinSize)) {
- DumpPcdVariable (PcdVariable);
- //
- // For Pcd Variable header align.
- //
- PcdVariable = (VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *) HEADER_ALIGN (((UINTN) PcdVariable + PcdVariable->Length));
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-/**
- Locate VarCheckPcdBin.
-
-**/
-VOID
-EFIAPI
-LocateVarCheckPcdBin (
- VOID
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER *VarCheckPcdBin;
- UINTN VarCheckPcdBinSize;
-
- //
- // Search the VarCheckPcdBin from the first RAW section of current FFS.
- //
- Status = GetSectionFromFfs (
- EFI_SECTION_RAW,
- 0,
- (VOID **) &VarCheckPcdBin,
- &VarCheckPcdBinSize
- );
- if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- //
- // AllocateRuntimeZeroPool () from MemoryAllocateLib is used for runtime access
- // in SetVariable check handler.
- //
- mVarCheckPcdBin = AllocateRuntimeCopyPool (VarCheckPcdBinSize, VarCheckPcdBin);
- ASSERT (mVarCheckPcdBin != NULL);
- mVarCheckPcdBinSize = VarCheckPcdBinSize;
- FreePool (VarCheckPcdBin);
-
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "VarCheckPcdBin - at 0x%x size = 0x%x\n", mVarCheckPcdBin, mVarCheckPcdBinSize));
-
-#ifdef DUMP_VAR_CHECK_PCD
- DEBUG_CODE (
- DumpVarCheckPcd (mVarCheckPcdBin, mVarCheckPcdBinSize);
- );
-#endif
- } else {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "[VarCheckPcd] No VarCheckPcdBin found at the first RAW section\n"));
- }
-}
-
-/**
- Constructor function of VarCheckPcdLib to register var check PCD handler.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param[in] SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor executed correctly.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckPcdLibNullClassConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- LocateVarCheckPcdBin ();
- VarCheckLibRegisterAddressPointer ((VOID **) &mVarCheckPcdBin);
- VarCheckLibRegisterSetVariableCheckHandler (SetVariableCheckHandlerPcd);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdStructure.h b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdStructure.h deleted file mode 100644 index 8180bc5cfd..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckPcdLib/VarCheckPcdStructure.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,76 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Internal structure for Var Check Pcd.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#ifndef _VAR_CHECK_STRUCTURE_H_
-#define _VAR_CHECK_STRUCTURE_H_
-
-//
-// Alignment for PCD Variable and check data header.
-//
-#define HEADER_ALIGNMENT 4
-#define HEADER_ALIGN(Header) (((UINTN) (Header) + HEADER_ALIGNMENT - 1) & (~(HEADER_ALIGNMENT - 1)))
-
-#pragma pack (1)
-
-#define VAR_CHECK_PCD_REVISION 0x0001
-
-typedef enum {
- VarCheckPcdVariableHeader,
- VarCheckPcdValidList,
- VarCheckPcdValidRange,
- VarCheckPcdCheckTypeMax,
-} VAR_CHECK_PCD_CHECK_TYPE;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT16 Revision;
- UINT16 HeaderLength;
- UINT32 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT8 Type;
- UINT8 Reserved[3];
- UINT32 Attributes;
- EFI_GUID Guid;
-//CHAR16 Name[];
-} VAR_CHECK_PCD_VARIABLE_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 Type;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-} VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_DATA_HEADER;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 Type;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-//UINTx Data[]; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64;
-} VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_LIST;
-
-//typedef struct {
-// UINTx Minimum; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64
-// UINTx Maximum; // x = UINT8/UINT16/UINT32/UINT64
-//} VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_RANGE_DATA;
-
-typedef struct {
- UINT8 Type;
- UINT8 Length; // Length include this header
- UINT16 VarOffset;
- UINT8 StorageWidth;
-// VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_RANGE_DATA ValidRange[];
-} VAR_CHECK_PCD_VALID_RANGE;
-
-#pragma pack ()
-
-#endif
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLib.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLib.inf deleted file mode 100644 index 77ef210fb2..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLib.inf +++ /dev/null @@ -1,88 +0,0 @@ -## @file
-# NULL class library to register var check handler and variable property set for UEFI defined variables.
-#
-# Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-#
-# This program and the accompanying materials
-# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions
-# of the BSD License which accompanies this distribution. The
-# full text of the license may be found at
-# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-#
-# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-#
-##
-
-[Defines]
- INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
- BASE_NAME = VarCheckUefiLib
- MODULE_UNI_FILE = VarCheckUefiLib.uni
- FILE_GUID = AC24A4C7-F845-4665-90E5-6431D6E28DC0
- MODULE_TYPE = DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER
- VERSION_STRING = 1.0
- LIBRARY_CLASS = NULL|DXE_RUNTIME_DRIVER DXE_SMM_DRIVER
- CONSTRUCTOR = VarCheckUefiLibNullClassConstructor
-
-#
-# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
-#
-# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64
-#
-
-[Sources]
- VarCheckUefiLibNullClass.c
-
-[Packages]
- MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
-
-[LibraryClasses]
- BaseLib
- BaseMemoryLib
- DebugLib
- DevicePathLib
- VarCheckLib
-
-[Guids]
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"LangCodes"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Lang"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Timeout"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"PlatformLangCodes"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"PlatformLang"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ConIn"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ConOut"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ErrOut"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ConInDev"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ConOutDev"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"ErrOutDev"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"BootOrder"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"BootNext"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"BootCurrent"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"BootOptionSupport"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"DriverOrder"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"SysPrepOrder"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"HwErrRecSupport"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"SetupMode"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"PK"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"KEK"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"SignatureSupport"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"SecureBoot"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"KEKDefault"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"PKDefault"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"dbDefault"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"dbxDefault"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"dbtDefault"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"OsIndicationsSupported"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"OsIndications"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"VendorKeys"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Boot####"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Driver####"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"SysPrep####"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"Key####"
- gEfiGlobalVariableGuid
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"DB"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"DBX"
- ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"DBT"
- gEfiImageSecurityDatabaseGuid
- gEfiHardwareErrorVariableGuid ## CONSUMES ## Variable:L"HwErrRec####"
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLib.uni b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLib.uni Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index a18cbfa5a8..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLib.uni +++ /dev/null diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLibNullClass.c b/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLibNullClass.c deleted file mode 100644 index 15144bd4c0..0000000000 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Library/VarCheckUefiLib/VarCheckUefiLibNullClass.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,930 +0,0 @@ -/** @file
- Implementation functions and structures for var check uefi library.
-
-Copyright (c) 2015, Intel Corporation. All rights reserved.<BR>
-This program and the accompanying materials
-are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
-which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
-http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
-
-THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
-WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
-
-**/
-
-#include <Library/VarCheckLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
-#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
-#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
-#include <Library/DevicePathLib.h>
-
-#include <Guid/VariableFormat.h>
-#include <Guid/GlobalVariable.h>
-#include <Guid/HardwareErrorVariable.h>
-#include <Guid/ImageAuthentication.h>
-
-typedef
-EFI_STATUS
-(EFIAPI *INTERNAL_VAR_CHECK_FUNCTION) (
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *Propery,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- );
-
-typedef struct {
- CHAR16 *Name;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY VariableProperty;
- INTERNAL_VAR_CHECK_FUNCTION CheckFunction;
-} UEFI_DEFINED_VARIABLE_ENTRY;
-
-/**
- Internal check for load option.
-
- @param[in] VariablePropery Pointer to variable property.
- @param[in] DataSize Data size.
- @param[in] Data Pointer to data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The data buffer is not a valid load option.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckLoadOption (
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariablePropery,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- UINT16 FilePathListLength;
- CHAR16 *Description;
- EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *FilePathList;
-
- FilePathListLength = *((UINT16 *) ((UINTN) Data + sizeof (UINT32)));
-
- //
- // Check Description
- //
- Description = (CHAR16 *) ((UINTN) Data + sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINT16));
- while (Description < (CHAR16 *) ((UINTN) Data + DataSize)) {
- if (*Description == L'\0') {
- break;
- }
- Description++;
- }
- if ((UINTN) Description >= ((UINTN) Data + DataSize)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- Description++;
-
- //
- // Check FilePathList
- //
- FilePathList = (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) Description;
- if ((UINTN) FilePathList > (MAX_ADDRESS - FilePathListLength)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (((UINTN) FilePathList + FilePathListLength) > ((UINTN) Data + DataSize)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (FilePathListLength < sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- if (!IsDevicePathValid (FilePathList, FilePathListLength)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal check for key option.
-
- @param[in] VariablePropery Pointer to variable property.
- @param[in] DataSize Data size.
- @param[in] Data Pointer to data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The data buffer is not a valid key option.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckKeyOption (
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariablePropery,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- if (((DataSize - sizeof (EFI_KEY_OPTION)) % sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY)) != 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal check for device path.
-
- @param[in] VariablePropery Pointer to variable property.
- @param[in] DataSize Data size.
- @param[in] Data Pointer to data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The data buffer is not a valid device path.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckDevicePath (
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariablePropery,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- if (!IsDevicePathValid ((EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL *) Data, DataSize)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal check for ASCII string.
-
- @param[in] VariablePropery Pointer to variable property.
- @param[in] DataSize Data size.
- @param[in] Data Pointer to data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The data buffer is not a Null-terminated ASCII string.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckAsciiString (
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariablePropery,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- CHAR8 *String;
- UINTN Index;
-
- String = (CHAR8 *) Data;
- if (String[DataSize - 1] == '\0') {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- } else {
- for (Index = 1; Index < DataSize && (String[DataSize - 1 - Index] != '\0'); Index++);
- if (Index == DataSize) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Internal check for size array.
-
- @param[in] VariablePropery Pointer to variable property.
- @param[in] DataSize Data size.
- @param[in] Data Pointer to data buffer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER The DataSize is not size array.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-InternalVarCheckSizeArray (
- IN VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VariablePropery,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- if ((DataSize % VariablePropery->MinSize) != 0) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-//
-// To prevent name collisions with possible future globally defined variables,
-// other internal firmware data variables that are not defined here must be
-// saved with a unique VendorGuid other than EFI_GLOBAL_VARIABLE or
-// any other GUID defined by the UEFI Specification. Implementations must
-// only permit the creation of variables with a UEFI Specification-defined
-// VendorGuid when these variables are documented in the UEFI Specification.
-//
-UEFI_DEFINED_VARIABLE_ENTRY mGlobalVariableList[] = {
- {
- EFI_LANG_CODES_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckAsciiString
- },
- {
- EFI_LANG_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckAsciiString
- },
- {
- EFI_TIME_OUT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- sizeof (UINT16)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_PLATFORM_LANG_CODES_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckAsciiString
- },
- {
- EFI_PLATFORM_LANG_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckAsciiString
- },
- {
- EFI_CON_IN_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckDevicePath
- },
- {
- EFI_CON_OUT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckDevicePath
- },
- {
- EFI_ERR_OUT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckDevicePath
- },
- {
- EFI_CON_IN_DEV_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckDevicePath
- },
- {
- EFI_CON_OUT_DEV_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckDevicePath
- },
- {
- EFI_ERR_OUT_DEV_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_DEVICE_PATH_PROTOCOL),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckDevicePath
- },
- {
- EFI_BOOT_ORDER_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckSizeArray
- },
- {
- EFI_BOOT_NEXT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- sizeof (UINT16)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_BOOT_CURRENT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- sizeof (UINT16)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_BOOT_OPTION_SUPPORT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT32),
- sizeof (UINT32)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_DRIVER_ORDER_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckSizeArray
- },
- {
- EFI_SYS_PREP_ORDER_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckSizeArray
- },
- {
- EFI_HW_ERR_REC_SUPPORT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT16),
- sizeof (UINT16)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_SETUP_MODE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT8),
- sizeof (UINT8)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_KEY_EXCHANGE_KEY_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT_AT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_PLATFORM_KEY_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT_AT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_SIGNATURE_SUPPORT_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_GUID),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckSizeArray
- },
- {
- EFI_SECURE_BOOT_MODE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT8),
- sizeof (UINT8)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_KEK_DEFAULT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_PK_DEFAULT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_DB_DEFAULT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_DBX_DEFAULT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_DBT_DEFAULT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_OS_INDICATIONS_SUPPORT_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT64),
- sizeof (UINT64)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_OS_INDICATIONS_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT64),
- sizeof (UINT64)
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_VENDOR_KEYS_VARIABLE_NAME,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_READ_ONLY,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT8),
- sizeof (UINT8)
- },
- NULL
- },
-};
-
-UEFI_DEFINED_VARIABLE_ENTRY mGlobalVariableList2[] = {
- {
- L"Boot####",
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINT16),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckLoadOption
- },
- {
- L"Driver####",
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINT16),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckLoadOption
- },
- {
- L"SysPrep####",
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (UINT32) + sizeof (UINT16),
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- InternalVarCheckLoadOption
- },
- {
- L"Key####",
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT,
- sizeof (EFI_KEY_OPTION),
- sizeof (EFI_KEY_OPTION) + 3 * sizeof (EFI_INPUT_KEY)
- },
- InternalVarCheckKeyOption
- },
-};
-
-//
-// EFI_IMAGE_SECURITY_DATABASE_GUID
-//
-UEFI_DEFINED_VARIABLE_ENTRY mImageSecurityVariableList[] = {
- {
- EFI_IMAGE_SECURITY_DATABASE,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT_AT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_IMAGE_SECURITY_DATABASE1,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT_AT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
- {
- EFI_IMAGE_SECURITY_DATABASE2,
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT_AT,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
- },
-};
-
-//
-// EFI_HARDWARE_ERROR_VARIABLE
-//
-UEFI_DEFINED_VARIABLE_ENTRY mHwErrRecVariable = {
- L"HwErrRec####",
- {
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY_REVISION,
- 0,
- VARIABLE_ATTRIBUTE_NV_BS_RT_HR,
- 1,
- MAX_UINTN
- },
- NULL
-};
-
-EFI_GUID *mUefiDefinedGuid[] = {
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- &gEfiImageSecurityDatabaseGuid,
- &gEfiHardwareErrorVariableGuid
-};
-
-/**
- Check if a Unicode character is a hexadecimal character.
-
- This function checks if a Unicode character is a
- hexadecimal character. The valid hexadecimal character is
- L'0' to L'9', L'a' to L'f', or L'A' to L'F'.
-
-
- @param[in] Char The character to check against.
-
- @retval TRUE If the Char is a hexadecmial character.
- @retval FALSE If the Char is not a hexadecmial character.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (
- IN CHAR16 Char
- )
-{
- return (BOOLEAN) ((Char >= L'0' && Char <= L'9') || (Char >= L'A' && Char <= L'F') || (Char >= L'a' && Char <= L'f'));
-}
-
-/**
-
- This code checks if variable is hardware error record variable or not.
-
- According to UEFI spec, hardware error record variable should use the EFI_HARDWARE_ERROR_VARIABLE VendorGuid
- and have the L"HwErrRec####" name convention, #### is a printed hex value and no 0x or h is included in the hex value.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Pointer to variable name.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Variable Vendor Guid.
-
- @retval TRUE Variable is hardware error record variable.
- @retval FALSE Variable is not hardware error record variable.
-
-**/
-BOOLEAN
-EFIAPI
-IsHwErrRecVariable (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid
- )
-{
- if (!CompareGuid (VendorGuid, &gEfiHardwareErrorVariableGuid) ||
- (StrLen (VariableName) != StrLen (L"HwErrRec####")) ||
- (StrnCmp(VariableName, L"HwErrRec", StrLen (L"HwErrRec")) != 0) ||
- !VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[0x8]) ||
- !VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[0x9]) ||
- !VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[0xA]) ||
- !VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[0xB])) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- return TRUE;
-}
-
-/**
- Get UEFI defined var check function.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Pointer to variable name.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Pointer to variable vendor GUID.
- @param[out] VariableProperty Pointer to variable property.
-
- @return Internal var check function, NULL if no specific check function.
-
-**/
-INTERNAL_VAR_CHECK_FUNCTION
-GetUefiDefinedVarCheckFunction (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- OUT VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY **VariableProperty
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
- UINTN NameLength;
-
- if (CompareGuid (VendorGuid, &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid)) {
- //
- // Try list 1, exactly match.
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mGlobalVariableList)/sizeof (mGlobalVariableList[0]); Index++) {
- if (StrCmp (mGlobalVariableList[Index].Name, VariableName) == 0) {
- *VariableProperty = &(mGlobalVariableList[Index].VariableProperty);
- return mGlobalVariableList[Index].CheckFunction;
- }
- }
-
- //
- // Try list 2.
- //
- NameLength = StrLen (VariableName) - 4;
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mGlobalVariableList2)/sizeof (mGlobalVariableList2[0]); Index++) {
- if ((StrLen (VariableName) == StrLen (mGlobalVariableList2[Index].Name)) &&
- (StrnCmp (VariableName, mGlobalVariableList2[Index].Name, NameLength) == 0) &&
- VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength]) &&
- VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength + 1]) &&
- VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength + 2]) &&
- VarCheckUefiIsHexaDecimalDigitCharacter (VariableName[NameLength + 3])) {
- *VariableProperty = &(mGlobalVariableList2[Index].VariableProperty);
- return mGlobalVariableList2[Index].CheckFunction;
- }
- }
- }
-
- return NULL;
-}
-
-/**
- SetVariable check handler UEFI defined.
-
- @param[in] VariableName Name of Variable to set.
- @param[in] VendorGuid Variable vendor GUID.
- @param[in] Attributes Attribute value of the variable.
- @param[in] DataSize Size of Data to set.
- @param[in] Data Data pointer.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The SetVariable check result was success.
- @retval EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER An invalid combination of attribute bits, name, GUID,
- DataSize and Data value was supplied.
- @retval EFI_WRITE_PROTECTED The variable in question is read-only.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-SetVariableCheckHandlerUefiDefined (
- IN CHAR16 *VariableName,
- IN EFI_GUID *VendorGuid,
- IN UINT32 Attributes,
- IN UINTN DataSize,
- IN VOID *Data
- )
-{
- EFI_STATUS Status;
- UINTN Index;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY Property;
- VAR_CHECK_VARIABLE_PROPERTY *VarCheckProperty;
- INTERNAL_VAR_CHECK_FUNCTION VarCheckFunction;
-
- if ((((Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_APPEND_WRITE) == 0) && (DataSize == 0)) || (Attributes == 0)) {
- //
- // Do not check delete variable.
- //
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- if ((Attributes & EFI_VARIABLE_HARDWARE_ERROR_RECORD) == EFI_VARIABLE_HARDWARE_ERROR_RECORD) {
- if (!IsHwErrRecVariable (VariableName, VendorGuid)) {
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
-
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mUefiDefinedGuid)/sizeof (mUefiDefinedGuid[0]); Index++) {
- if (CompareGuid (VendorGuid, mUefiDefinedGuid[Index])) {
- if (VarCheckLibVariablePropertyGet (VariableName, VendorGuid, &Property) == EFI_NOT_FOUND) {
- //
- // To prevent name collisions with possible future globally defined variables,
- // other internal firmware data variables that are not defined here must be
- // saved with a unique VendorGuid other than EFI_GLOBAL_VARIABLE or
- // any other GUID defined by the UEFI Specification. Implementations must
- // only permit the creation of variables with a UEFI Specification-defined
- // VendorGuid when these variables are documented in the UEFI Specification.
- //
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "UEFI Variable Check fail %r - %s not in %g namespace\n", EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER, VariableName, VendorGuid));
- return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (DataSize == 0) {
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
- }
-
- VarCheckProperty = NULL;
- VarCheckFunction = GetUefiDefinedVarCheckFunction (VariableName, VendorGuid, &VarCheckProperty);
- if (VarCheckFunction != NULL) {
- Status = VarCheckFunction (
- VarCheckProperty,
- DataSize,
- Data
- );
- if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
- DEBUG ((EFI_D_INFO, "UEFI Variable Check function fail %r - %g:%s\n", Status, VendorGuid, VariableName));
- return Status;
- }
- }
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
-
-/**
- Variable property set for UEFI defined variables.
-
-**/
-VOID
-VariablePropertySetUefiDefined (
- VOID
- )
-{
- UINTN Index;
-
- //
- // EFI_GLOBAL_VARIABLE
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mGlobalVariableList)/sizeof (mGlobalVariableList[0]); Index++) {
- VarCheckLibVariablePropertySet (
- mGlobalVariableList[Index].Name,
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- &mGlobalVariableList[Index].VariableProperty
- );
- }
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mGlobalVariableList2)/sizeof (mGlobalVariableList2[0]); Index++) {
- VarCheckLibVariablePropertySet (
- mGlobalVariableList2[Index].Name,
- &gEfiGlobalVariableGuid,
- &mGlobalVariableList2[Index].VariableProperty
- );
- }
-
- //
- // EFI_IMAGE_SECURITY_DATABASE_GUID
- //
- for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (mImageSecurityVariableList)/sizeof (mImageSecurityVariableList[0]); Index++) {
- VarCheckLibVariablePropertySet (
- mImageSecurityVariableList[Index].Name,
- &gEfiImageSecurityDatabaseGuid,
- &mImageSecurityVariableList[Index].VariableProperty
- );
- }
-
- //
- // EFI_HARDWARE_ERROR_VARIABLE
- //
- VarCheckLibVariablePropertySet (
- mHwErrRecVariable.Name,
- &gEfiHardwareErrorVariableGuid,
- &mHwErrRecVariable.VariableProperty
- );
-}
-
-/**
- Constructor function of VarCheckUefiLib to set property and
- register SetVariable check handler for UEFI defined variables.
-
- @param[in] ImageHandle The firmware allocated handle for the EFI image.
- @param[in] SystemTable A pointer to the EFI System Table.
-
- @retval EFI_SUCCESS The constructor executed correctly.
-
-**/
-EFI_STATUS
-EFIAPI
-VarCheckUefiLibNullClassConstructor (
- IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
- IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
- )
-{
- VariablePropertySetUefiDefined ();
- VarCheckLibRegisterSetVariableCheckHandler (SetVariableCheckHandlerUefiDefined);
-
- return EFI_SUCCESS;
-}
|